]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - man/calc.texi
Change @LaTeX to La@TeX throughout.
[gnu-emacs] / man / calc.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
3 @c smallbook
4 @setfilename ../info/calc
5 @c [title]
6 @settitle GNU Emacs Calc 2.02g Manual
7 @setchapternewpage odd
8 @comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
9
10 @c The following macros are used for conditional output for single lines.
11 @c @texline foo
12 @c `foo' will appear only in TeX output
13 @c @infoline foo
14 @c `foo' will appear only in non-TeX output
15
16 @c @expr{expr} will typeset an expression;
17 @c $x$ in TeX, @samp{x} otherwise.
18
19 @iftex
20 @macro texline{stuff}
21 \stuff\
22 @end macro
23 @alias infoline=comment
24 @tex
25 \gdef\exprsetup{\tex \let\t\ttfont \turnoffactive}
26 \gdef\expr{\exprsetup$\exprfinish}
27 \gdef\exprfinish#1{#1$\endgroup}
28 @end tex
29 @alias mathit=expr
30 @macro cpi{}
31 @math{@pi{}}
32 @end macro
33 @macro cpiover{den}
34 @math{@pi/\den\}
35 @end macro
36 @end iftex
37
38 @ifnottex
39 @alias texline=comment
40 @macro infoline{stuff}
41 \stuff\
42 @end macro
43 @alias expr=samp
44 @alias mathit=i
45 @macro cpi{}
46 @expr{pi}
47 @end macro
48 @macro cpiover{den}
49 @expr{pi/\den\}
50 @end macro
51 @end ifnottex
52
53
54 @tex
55 % Suggested by Karl Berry <karl@@freefriends.org>
56 \gdef\!{\mskip-\thinmuskip}
57 @end tex
58
59 @c Fix some other things specifically for this manual.
60 @iftex
61 @finalout
62 @mathcode`@:=`@: @c Make Calc fractions come out right in math mode
63 @tex
64 \gdef\coloneq{\mathrel{\mathord:\mathord=}}
65
66 \gdef\beforedisplay{\vskip-10pt}
67 \gdef\afterdisplay{\vskip-5pt}
68 \gdef\beforedisplayh{\vskip-25pt}
69 \gdef\afterdisplayh{\vskip-10pt}
70 @end tex
71 @newdimen@kyvpos @kyvpos=0pt
72 @newdimen@kyhpos @kyhpos=0pt
73 @newcount@calcclubpenalty @calcclubpenalty=1000
74 @ignore
75 @newcount@calcpageno
76 @newtoks@calcoldeverypar @calcoldeverypar=@everypar
77 @everypar={@calceverypar@the@calcoldeverypar}
78 @ifx@turnoffactive@undefinedzzz@def@turnoffactive{}@fi
79 @ifx@ninett@undefinedzzz@font@ninett=cmtt9@fi
80 @catcode`@\=0 \catcode`\@=11
81 \r@ggedbottomtrue
82 \catcode`\@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
83 @end ignore
84 @end iftex
85
86 @copying
87 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator.
88
89 Copyright (C) 1990, 1991, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90
91 @quotation
92 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
93 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
94 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
95 Invariant Sections being just ``GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE'', with the
96 Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and with the Back-Cover
97 Texts as in (a) below.
98
99 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
100 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
101 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
102 @end quotation
103 @end copying
104
105 @dircategory Emacs
106 @direntry
107 * Calc: (calc). Advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool.
108 @end direntry
109
110 @titlepage
111 @sp 6
112 @center @titlefont{Calc Manual}
113 @sp 4
114 @center GNU Emacs Calc Version 2.02g
115 @c [volume]
116 @sp 1
117 @center January 2002
118 @sp 5
119 @center Dave Gillespie
120 @center daveg@@synaptics.com
121 @page
122
123 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
124 Copyright @copyright{} 1990, 1991, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
125 @insertcopying
126 @end titlepage
127
128 @c [begin]
129 @ifinfo
130 @node Top, , (dir), (dir)
131 @chapter The GNU Emacs Calculator
132
133 @noindent
134 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool
135 that runs as part of the GNU Emacs environment.
136
137 This manual is divided into three major parts: ``Getting Started,''
138 the ``Calc Tutorial,'' and the ``Calc Reference.'' The Tutorial
139 introduces all the major aspects of Calculator use in an easy,
140 hands-on way. The remainder of the manual is a complete reference to
141 the features of the Calculator.
142
143 For help in the Emacs Info system (which you are using to read this
144 file), type @kbd{?}. (You can also type @kbd{h} to run through a
145 longer Info tutorial.)
146
147 @end ifinfo
148 @menu
149 * Copying:: How you can copy and share Calc.
150
151 * Getting Started:: General description and overview.
152 * Interactive Tutorial::
153 * Tutorial:: A step-by-step introduction for beginners.
154
155 * Introduction:: Introduction to the Calc reference manual.
156 * Data Types:: Types of objects manipulated by Calc.
157 * Stack and Trail:: Manipulating the stack and trail buffers.
158 * Mode Settings:: Adjusting display format and other modes.
159 * Arithmetic:: Basic arithmetic functions.
160 * Scientific Functions:: Transcendentals and other scientific functions.
161 * Matrix Functions:: Operations on vectors and matrices.
162 * Algebra:: Manipulating expressions algebraically.
163 * Units:: Operations on numbers with units.
164 * Store and Recall:: Storing and recalling variables.
165 * Graphics:: Commands for making graphs of data.
166 * Kill and Yank:: Moving data into and out of Calc.
167 * Embedded Mode:: Working with formulas embedded in a file.
168 * Programming:: Calc as a programmable calculator.
169
170 * Installation:: Installing Calc as a part of GNU Emacs.
171 * Reporting Bugs:: How to report bugs and make suggestions.
172
173 * Summary:: Summary of Calc commands and functions.
174
175 * Key Index:: The standard Calc key sequences.
176 * Command Index:: The interactive Calc commands.
177 * Function Index:: Functions (in algebraic formulas).
178 * Concept Index:: General concepts.
179 * Variable Index:: Variables used by Calc (both user and internal).
180 * Lisp Function Index:: Internal Lisp math functions.
181 @end menu
182
183 @node Copying, Getting Started, Top, Top
184 @unnumbered GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
185 @center Version 1, February 1989
186
187 @display
188 Copyright @copyright{} 1989 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
189 675 Mass Ave, Cambridge, MA 02139, USA
190
191 Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
192 of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
193 @end display
194
195 @unnumberedsec Preamble
196
197 The license agreements of most software companies try to keep users
198 at the mercy of those companies. By contrast, our General Public
199 License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free
200 software---to make sure the software is free for all its users. The
201 General Public License applies to the Free Software Foundation's
202 software and to any other program whose authors commit to using it.
203 You can use it for your programs, too.
204
205 When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
206 price. Specifically, the General Public License is designed to make
207 sure that you have the freedom to give away or sell copies of free
208 software, that you receive source code or can get it if you want it,
209 that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new free
210 programs; and that you know you can do these things.
211
212 To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid
213 anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights.
214 These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you
215 distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.
216
217 For example, if you distribute copies of a such a program, whether
218 gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that
219 you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the
220 source code. And you must tell them their rights.
221
222 We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and
223 (2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy,
224 distribute and/or modify the software.
225
226 Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain
227 that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free
228 software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we
229 want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so
230 that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original
231 authors' reputations.
232
233 The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
234 modification follow.
235
236 @iftex
237 @unnumberedsec TERMS AND CONDITIONS
238 @end iftex
239 @ifinfo
240 @center TERMS AND CONDITIONS
241 @end ifinfo
242
243 @enumerate
244 @item
245 This License Agreement applies to any program or other work which
246 contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be
247 distributed under the terms of this General Public License. The
248 ``Program'', below, refers to any such program or work, and a ``work based
249 on the Program'' means either the Program or any work containing the
250 Program or a portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications. Each
251 licensee is addressed as ``you''.
252
253 @item
254 You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program's source
255 code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and
256 appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and
257 disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the notices that refer to this
258 General Public License and to the absence of any warranty; and give any
259 other recipients of the Program a copy of this General Public License
260 along with the Program. You may charge a fee for the physical act of
261 transferring a copy.
262
263 @item
264 You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion of
265 it, and copy and distribute such modifications under the terms of Paragraph
266 1 above, provided that you also do the following:
267
268 @itemize @bullet
269 @item
270 cause the modified files to carry prominent notices stating that
271 you changed the files and the date of any change; and
272
273 @item
274 cause the whole of any work that you distribute or publish, that
275 in whole or in part contains the Program or any part thereof, either
276 with or without modifications, to be licensed at no charge to all
277 third parties under the terms of this General Public License (except
278 that you may choose to grant warranty protection to some or all
279 third parties, at your option).
280
281 @item
282 If the modified program normally reads commands interactively when
283 run, you must cause it, when started running for such interactive use
284 in the simplest and most usual way, to print or display an
285 announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a notice
286 that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide a
287 warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under these
288 conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this General
289 Public License.
290
291 @item
292 You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a
293 copy, and you may at your option offer warranty protection in
294 exchange for a fee.
295 @end itemize
296
297 Mere aggregation of another independent work with the Program (or its
298 derivative) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium does not bring
299 the other work under the scope of these terms.
300
301 @item
302 You may copy and distribute the Program (or a portion or derivative of
303 it, under Paragraph 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of
304 Paragraphs 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following:
305
306 @itemize @bullet
307 @item
308 accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable
309 source code, which must be distributed under the terms of
310 Paragraphs 1 and 2 above; or,
311
312 @item
313 accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three
314 years, to give any third party free (except for a nominal charge
315 for the cost of distribution) a complete machine-readable copy of the
316 corresponding source code, to be distributed under the terms of
317 Paragraphs 1 and 2 above; or,
318
319 @item
320 accompany it with the information you received as to where the
321 corresponding source code may be obtained. (This alternative is
322 allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you
323 received the program in object code or executable form alone.)
324 @end itemize
325
326 Source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for making
327 modifications to it. For an executable file, complete source code means
328 all the source code for all modules it contains; but, as a special
329 exception, it need not include source code for modules which are standard
330 libraries that accompany the operating system on which the executable
331 file runs, or for standard header files or definitions files that
332 accompany that operating system.
333
334 @item
335 You may not copy, modify, sublicense, distribute or transfer the
336 Program except as expressly provided under this General Public License.
337 Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, distribute or transfer
338 the Program is void, and will automatically terminate your rights to use
339 the Program under this License. However, parties who have received
340 copies, or rights to use copies, from you under this General Public
341 License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such parties
342 remain in full compliance.
343
344 @item
345 By copying, distributing or modifying the Program (or any work based
346 on the Program) you indicate your acceptance of this license to do so,
347 and all its terms and conditions.
348
349 @item
350 Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the
351 Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the original
352 licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to these
353 terms and conditions. You may not impose any further restrictions on the
354 recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
355
356 @item
357 The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions
358 of the General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will
359 be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
360 address new problems or concerns.
361
362 Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program
363 specifies a version number of the license which applies to it and ``any
364 later version'', you have the option of following the terms and conditions
365 either of that version or of any later version published by the Free
366 Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of
367 the license, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software
368 Foundation.
369
370 @item
371 If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free
372 programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author
373 to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free
374 Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes
375 make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals
376 of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and
377 of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
378
379 @iftex
380 @heading NO WARRANTY
381 @end iftex
382 @ifinfo
383 @center NO WARRANTY
384 @end ifinfo
385
386 @item
387 BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY
388 FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN
389 OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES
390 PROVIDE THE PROGRAM ``AS IS'' WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED
391 OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
392 MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS
393 TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
394 PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING,
395 REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
396
397 @item
398 IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL
399 ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR
400 REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES,
401 INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
402 ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT
403 LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES
404 SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE
405 WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN
406 ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
407 @end enumerate
408
409 @node Getting Started, Tutorial, Copying, Top
410 @chapter Getting Started
411 @noindent
412 This chapter provides a general overview of Calc, the GNU Emacs
413 Calculator: What it is, how to start it and how to exit from it,
414 and what are the various ways that it can be used.
415
416 @menu
417 * What is Calc::
418 * About This Manual::
419 * Notations Used in This Manual::
420 * Using Calc::
421 * Demonstration of Calc::
422 * History and Acknowledgements::
423 @end menu
424
425 @node What is Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started, Getting Started
426 @section What is Calc?
427
428 @noindent
429 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced calculator and mathematical tool that runs as
430 part of the GNU Emacs environment. Very roughly based on the HP-28/48
431 series of calculators, its many features include:
432
433 @itemize @bullet
434 @item
435 Choice of algebraic or RPN (stack-based) entry of calculations.
436
437 @item
438 Arbitrary precision integers and floating-point numbers.
439
440 @item
441 Arithmetic on rational numbers, complex numbers (rectangular and polar),
442 error forms with standard deviations, open and closed intervals, vectors
443 and matrices, dates and times, infinities, sets, quantities with units,
444 and algebraic formulas.
445
446 @item
447 Mathematical operations such as logarithms and trigonometric functions.
448
449 @item
450 Programmer's features (bitwise operations, non-decimal numbers).
451
452 @item
453 Financial functions such as future value and internal rate of return.
454
455 @item
456 Number theoretical features such as prime factorization and arithmetic
457 modulo @var{m} for any @var{m}.
458
459 @item
460 Algebraic manipulation features, including symbolic calculus.
461
462 @item
463 Moving data to and from regular editing buffers.
464
465 @item
466 Embedded mode for manipulating Calc formulas and data directly
467 inside any editing buffer.
468
469 @item
470 Graphics using GNUPLOT, a versatile (and free) plotting program.
471
472 @item
473 Easy programming using keyboard macros, algebraic formulas,
474 algebraic rewrite rules, or extended Emacs Lisp.
475 @end itemize
476
477 Calc tries to include a little something for everyone; as a result it is
478 large and might be intimidating to the first-time user. If you plan to
479 use Calc only as a traditional desk calculator, all you really need to
480 read is the ``Getting Started'' chapter of this manual and possibly the
481 first few sections of the tutorial. As you become more comfortable with
482 the program you can learn its additional features. In terms of efficiency,
483 scope and depth, Calc cannot replace a powerful tool like Mathematica.
484 But Calc has the advantages of convenience, portability, and availability
485 of the source code. And, of course, it's free!
486
487 @node About This Manual, Notations Used in This Manual, What is Calc, Getting Started
488 @section About This Manual
489
490 @noindent
491 This document serves as a complete description of the GNU Emacs
492 Calculator. It works both as an introduction for novices, and as
493 a reference for experienced users. While it helps to have some
494 experience with GNU Emacs in order to get the most out of Calc,
495 this manual ought to be readable even if you don't know or use Emacs
496 regularly.
497
498 @ifinfo
499 The manual is divided into three major parts:@: the ``Getting
500 Started'' chapter you are reading now, the Calc tutorial (chapter 2),
501 and the Calc reference manual (the remaining chapters and appendices).
502 @end ifinfo
503 @iftex
504 The manual is divided into three major parts:@: the ``Getting
505 Started'' chapter you are reading now, the Calc tutorial (chapter 2),
506 and the Calc reference manual (the remaining chapters and appendices).
507 @c [when-split]
508 @c This manual has been printed in two volumes, the @dfn{Tutorial} and the
509 @c @dfn{Reference}. Both volumes include a copy of the ``Getting Started''
510 @c chapter.
511 @end iftex
512
513 If you are in a hurry to use Calc, there is a brief ``demonstration''
514 below which illustrates the major features of Calc in just a couple of
515 pages. If you don't have time to go through the full tutorial, this
516 will show you everything you need to know to begin.
517 @xref{Demonstration of Calc}.
518
519 The tutorial chapter walks you through the various parts of Calc
520 with lots of hands-on examples and explanations. If you are new
521 to Calc and you have some time, try going through at least the
522 beginning of the tutorial. The tutorial includes about 70 exercises
523 with answers. These exercises give you some guided practice with
524 Calc, as well as pointing out some interesting and unusual ways
525 to use its features.
526
527 The reference section discusses Calc in complete depth. You can read
528 the reference from start to finish if you want to learn every aspect
529 of Calc. Or, you can look in the table of contents or the Concept
530 Index to find the parts of the manual that discuss the things you
531 need to know.
532
533 @cindex Marginal notes
534 Every Calc keyboard command is listed in the Calc Summary, and also
535 in the Key Index. Algebraic functions, @kbd{M-x} commands, and
536 variables also have their own indices.
537 @texline Each
538 @infoline In the printed manual, each
539 paragraph that is referenced in the Key or Function Index is marked
540 in the margin with its index entry.
541
542 @c [fix-ref Help Commands]
543 You can access this manual on-line at any time within Calc by
544 pressing the @kbd{h i} key sequence. Outside of the Calc window,
545 you can press @kbd{M-# i} to read the manual on-line. Also, you
546 can jump directly to the Tutorial by pressing @kbd{h t} or @kbd{M-# t},
547 or to the Summary by pressing @kbd{h s} or @kbd{M-# s}. Within Calc,
548 you can also go to the part of the manual describing any Calc key,
549 function, or variable using @w{@kbd{h k}}, @kbd{h f}, or @kbd{h v},
550 respectively. @xref{Help Commands}.
551
552 Printed copies of this manual are also available from the Free Software
553 Foundation.
554
555 @node Notations Used in This Manual, Demonstration of Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started
556 @section Notations Used in This Manual
557
558 @noindent
559 This section describes the various notations that are used
560 throughout the Calc manual.
561
562 In keystroke sequences, uppercase letters mean you must hold down
563 the shift key while typing the letter. Keys pressed with Control
564 held down are shown as @kbd{C-x}. Keys pressed with Meta held down
565 are shown as @kbd{M-x}. Other notations are @key{RET} for the
566 Return key, @key{SPC} for the space bar, @key{TAB} for the Tab key,
567 @key{DEL} for the Delete key, and @key{LFD} for the Line-Feed key.
568 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards, it is
569 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
570 regularly using Emacs.
571
572 (If you don't have the @key{LFD} or @key{TAB} keys on your keyboard,
573 the @kbd{C-j} and @kbd{C-i} keys are equivalent to them, respectively.
574 If you don't have a Meta key, look for Alt or Extend Char. You can
575 also press @key{ESC} or @key{C-[} first to get the same effect, so
576 that @kbd{M-x}, @kbd{@key{ESC} x}, and @kbd{C-[ x} are all equivalent.)
577
578 Sometimes the @key{RET} key is not shown when it is ``obvious''
579 that you must press @key{RET} to proceed. For example, the @key{RET}
580 is usually omitted in key sequences like @kbd{M-x calc-keypad @key{RET}}.
581
582 Commands are generally shown like this: @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision})
583 or @kbd{M-# k} (@code{calc-keypad}). This means that the command is
584 normally used by pressing the @kbd{p} key or @kbd{M-# k} key sequence,
585 but it also has the full-name equivalent shown, e.g., @kbd{M-x calc-precision}.
586
587 Commands that correspond to functions in algebraic notation
588 are written: @kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}]. This means
589 the @kbd{C} key is equivalent to @kbd{M-x calc-cos}, and that
590 the corresponding function in an algebraic-style formula would
591 be @samp{cos(@var{x})}.
592
593 A few commands don't have key equivalents: @code{calc-sincos}
594 [@code{sincos}].
595
596 @node Demonstration of Calc, Using Calc, Notations Used in This Manual, Getting Started
597 @section A Demonstration of Calc
598
599 @noindent
600 @cindex Demonstration of Calc
601 This section will show some typical small problems being solved with
602 Calc. The focus is more on demonstration than explanation, but
603 everything you see here will be covered more thoroughly in the
604 Tutorial.
605
606 To begin, start Emacs if necessary (usually the command @code{emacs}
607 does this), and type @kbd{M-# c} (or @kbd{@key{ESC} # c}) to start the
608 Calculator. (@xref{Starting Calc}, if this doesn't work for you.)
609
610 Be sure to type all the sample input exactly, especially noting the
611 difference between lower-case and upper-case letters. Remember,
612 @key{RET}, @key{TAB}, @key{DEL}, and @key{SPC} are the Return, Tab,
613 Delete, and Space keys.
614
615 @strong{RPN calculation.} In RPN, you type the input number(s) first,
616 then the command to operate on the numbers.
617
618 @noindent
619 Type @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + Q} to compute
620 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3} = 2.2360679775}.
621 @infoline the square root of 2+3, which is 2.2360679775.
622
623 @noindent
624 Type @kbd{P 2 ^} to compute
625 @texline @math{\pi^2 = 9.86960440109}.
626 @infoline the value of `pi' squared, 9.86960440109.
627
628 @noindent
629 Type @key{TAB} to exchange the order of these two results.
630
631 @noindent
632 Type @kbd{- I H S} to subtract these results and compute the Inverse
633 Hyperbolic sine of the difference, 2.72996136574.
634
635 @noindent
636 Type @key{DEL} to erase this result.
637
638 @strong{Algebraic calculation.} You can also enter calculations using
639 conventional ``algebraic'' notation. To enter an algebraic formula,
640 use the apostrophe key.
641
642 @noindent
643 Type @kbd{' sqrt(2+3) @key{RET}} to compute
644 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3}}.
645 @infoline the square root of 2+3.
646
647 @noindent
648 Type @kbd{' pi^2 @key{RET}} to enter
649 @texline @math{\pi^2}.
650 @infoline `pi' squared.
651 To evaluate this symbolic formula as a number, type @kbd{=}.
652
653 @noindent
654 Type @kbd{' arcsinh($ - $$) @key{RET}} to subtract the second-most-recent
655 result from the most-recent and compute the Inverse Hyperbolic sine.
656
657 @strong{Keypad mode.} If you are using the X window system, press
658 @w{@kbd{M-# k}} to get Keypad mode. (If you don't use X, skip to
659 the next section.)
660
661 @noindent
662 Click on the @key{2}, @key{ENTER}, @key{3}, @key{+}, and @key{SQRT}
663 ``buttons'' using your left mouse button.
664
665 @noindent
666 Click on @key{PI}, @key{2}, and @t{y^x}.
667
668 @noindent
669 Click on @key{INV}, then @key{ENTER} to swap the two results.
670
671 @noindent
672 Click on @key{-}, @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, and @key{SIN}.
673
674 @noindent
675 Click on @key{<-} to erase the result, then click @key{OFF} to turn
676 the Keypad Calculator off.
677
678 @strong{Grabbing data.} Type @kbd{M-# x} if necessary to exit Calc.
679 Now select the following numbers as an Emacs region: ``Mark'' the
680 front of the list by typing @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or @kbd{C-@@} there,
681 then move to the other end of the list. (Either get this list from
682 the on-line copy of this manual, accessed by @w{@kbd{M-# i}}, or just
683 type these numbers into a scratch file.) Now type @kbd{M-# g} to
684 ``grab'' these numbers into Calc.
685
686 @example
687 @group
688 1.23 1.97
689 1.6 2
690 1.19 1.08
691 @end group
692 @end example
693
694 @noindent
695 The result @samp{[1.23, 1.97, 1.6, 2, 1.19, 1.08]} is a Calc ``vector.''
696 Type @w{@kbd{V R +}} to compute the sum of these numbers.
697
698 @noindent
699 Type @kbd{U} to Undo this command, then type @kbd{V R *} to compute
700 the product of the numbers.
701
702 @noindent
703 You can also grab data as a rectangular matrix. Place the cursor on
704 the upper-leftmost @samp{1} and set the mark, then move to just after
705 the lower-right @samp{8} and press @kbd{M-# r}.
706
707 @noindent
708 Type @kbd{v t} to transpose this
709 @texline @math{3\times2}
710 @infoline 3x2
711 matrix into a
712 @texline @math{2\times3}
713 @infoline 2x3
714 matrix. Type @w{@kbd{v u}} to unpack the rows into two separate
715 vectors. Now type @w{@kbd{V R + @key{TAB} V R +}} to compute the sums
716 of the two original columns. (There is also a special
717 grab-and-sum-columns command, @kbd{M-# :}.)
718
719 @strong{Units conversion.} Units are entered algebraically.
720 Type @w{@kbd{' 43 mi/hr @key{RET}}} to enter the quantity 43 miles-per-hour.
721 Type @w{@kbd{u c km/hr @key{RET}}}. Type @w{@kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}}}.
722
723 @strong{Date arithmetic.} Type @kbd{t N} to get the current date and
724 time. Type @kbd{90 +} to find the date 90 days from now. Type
725 @kbd{' <25 dec 87> @key{RET}} to enter a date, then @kbd{- 7 /} to see how
726 many weeks have passed since then.
727
728 @strong{Algebra.} Algebraic entries can also include formulas
729 or equations involving variables. Type @kbd{@w{' [x + y} = a, x y = 1] @key{RET}}
730 to enter a pair of equations involving three variables.
731 (Note the leading apostrophe in this example; also, note that the space
732 between @samp{x y} is required.) Type @w{@kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}}} to solve
733 these equations for the variables @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
734
735 @noindent
736 Type @kbd{d B} to view the solutions in more readable notation.
737 Type @w{@kbd{d C}} to view them in C language notation, @kbd{d T}
738 to view them in the notation for the @TeX{} typesetting system,
739 and @kbd{d L} to view them in the notation for the La@TeX{} typesetting
740 system. Type @kbd{d N} to return to normal notation.
741
742 @noindent
743 Type @kbd{7.5}, then @kbd{s l a @key{RET}} to let @expr{a = 7.5} in these formulas.
744 (That's a letter @kbd{l}, not a numeral @kbd{1}.)
745
746 @iftex
747 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
748 manual. Type @kbd{M-# c} to return to Calc after each of these
749 commands: @kbd{h k t N} to read about the @kbd{t N} command,
750 @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the @code{sqrt} function, and
751 @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
752 @end iftex
753 @ifinfo
754 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
755 manual. Remember to type the letter @kbd{l}, then @kbd{M-# c}, to
756 return here after each of these commands: @w{@kbd{h k t N}} to read
757 about the @w{@kbd{t N}} command, @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the
758 @code{sqrt} function, and @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
759 @end ifinfo
760
761 Press @key{DEL} repeatedly to remove any leftover results from the stack.
762 To exit from Calc, press @kbd{q} or @kbd{M-# c} again.
763
764 @node Using Calc, History and Acknowledgements, Demonstration of Calc, Getting Started
765 @section Using Calc
766
767 @noindent
768 Calc has several user interfaces that are specialized for
769 different kinds of tasks. As well as Calc's standard interface,
770 there are Quick mode, Keypad mode, and Embedded mode.
771
772 @menu
773 * Starting Calc::
774 * The Standard Interface::
775 * Quick Mode Overview::
776 * Keypad Mode Overview::
777 * Standalone Operation::
778 * Embedded Mode Overview::
779 * Other M-# Commands::
780 @end menu
781
782 @node Starting Calc, The Standard Interface, Using Calc, Using Calc
783 @subsection Starting Calc
784
785 @noindent
786 On most systems, you can type @kbd{M-#} to start the Calculator.
787 The notation @kbd{M-#} is short for Meta-@kbd{#}. On most
788 keyboards this means holding down the Meta (or Alt) and
789 Shift keys while typing @kbd{3}.
790
791 @cindex META key
792 Once again, if you don't have a Meta key on your keyboard you can type
793 @key{ESC} first, then @kbd{#}, to accomplish the same thing. If you
794 don't even have an @key{ESC} key, you can fake it by holding down
795 Control or @key{CTRL} while typing a left square bracket
796 (that's @kbd{C-[} in Emacs notation).
797
798 @kbd{M-#} is a @dfn{prefix key}; when you press it, Emacs waits for
799 you to press a second key to complete the command. In this case,
800 you will follow @kbd{M-#} with a letter (upper- or lower-case, it
801 doesn't matter for @kbd{M-#}) that says which Calc interface you
802 want to use.
803
804 To get Calc's standard interface, type @kbd{M-# c}. To get
805 Keypad mode, type @kbd{M-# k}. Type @kbd{M-# ?} to get a brief
806 list of the available options, and type a second @kbd{?} to get
807 a complete list.
808
809 To ease typing, @kbd{M-# M-#} (or @kbd{M-# #} if that's easier)
810 also works to start Calc. It starts the same interface (either
811 @kbd{M-# c} or @w{@kbd{M-# k}}) that you last used, selecting the
812 @kbd{M-# c} interface by default. (If your installation has
813 a special function key set up to act like @kbd{M-#}, hitting that
814 function key twice is just like hitting @kbd{M-# M-#}.)
815
816 If @kbd{M-#} doesn't work for you, you can always type explicit
817 commands like @kbd{M-x calc} (for the standard user interface) or
818 @w{@kbd{M-x calc-keypad}} (for Keypad mode). First type @kbd{M-x}
819 (that's Meta with the letter @kbd{x}), then, at the prompt,
820 type the full command (like @kbd{calc-keypad}) and press Return.
821
822 The same commands (like @kbd{M-# c} or @kbd{M-# M-#}) that start
823 the Calculator also turn it off if it is already on.
824
825 @node The Standard Interface, Quick Mode Overview, Starting Calc, Using Calc
826 @subsection The Standard Calc Interface
827
828 @noindent
829 @cindex Standard user interface
830 Calc's standard interface acts like a traditional RPN calculator,
831 operated by the normal Emacs keyboard. When you type @kbd{M-# c}
832 to start the Calculator, the Emacs screen splits into two windows
833 with the file you were editing on top and Calc on the bottom.
834
835 @smallexample
836 @group
837
838 ...
839 --**-Emacs: myfile (Fundamental)----All----------------------
840 --- Emacs Calculator Mode --- |Emacs Calc Mode v2.00...
841 2: 17.3 | 17.3
842 1: -5 | 3
843 . | 2
844 | 4
845 | * 8
846 | ->-5
847 |
848 --%%-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All----- --%%-Emacs: *Calc Trail*
849 @end group
850 @end smallexample
851
852 In this figure, the mode-line for @file{myfile} has moved up and the
853 ``Calculator'' window has appeared below it. As you can see, Calc
854 actually makes two windows side-by-side. The lefthand one is
855 called the @dfn{stack window} and the righthand one is called the
856 @dfn{trail window.} The stack holds the numbers involved in the
857 calculation you are currently performing. The trail holds a complete
858 record of all calculations you have done. In a desk calculator with
859 a printer, the trail corresponds to the paper tape that records what
860 you do.
861
862 In this case, the trail shows that four numbers (17.3, 3, 2, and 4)
863 were first entered into the Calculator, then the 2 and 4 were
864 multiplied to get 8, then the 3 and 8 were subtracted to get @mathit{-5}.
865 (The @samp{>} symbol shows that this was the most recent calculation.)
866 The net result is the two numbers 17.3 and @mathit{-5} sitting on the stack.
867
868 Most Calculator commands deal explicitly with the stack only, but
869 there is a set of commands that allow you to search back through
870 the trail and retrieve any previous result.
871
872 Calc commands use the digits, letters, and punctuation keys.
873 Shifted (i.e., upper-case) letters are different from lowercase
874 letters. Some letters are @dfn{prefix} keys that begin two-letter
875 commands. For example, @kbd{e} means ``enter exponent'' and shifted
876 @kbd{E} means @expr{e^x}. With the @kbd{d} (``display modes'') prefix
877 the letter ``e'' takes on very different meanings: @kbd{d e} means
878 ``engineering notation'' and @kbd{d E} means ``@dfn{eqn} language mode.''
879
880 There is nothing stopping you from switching out of the Calc
881 window and back into your editing window, say by using the Emacs
882 @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window}) command. When the cursor is
883 inside a regular window, Emacs acts just like normal. When the
884 cursor is in the Calc stack or trail windows, keys are interpreted
885 as Calc commands.
886
887 When you quit by pressing @kbd{M-# c} a second time, the Calculator
888 windows go away but the actual Stack and Trail are not gone, just
889 hidden. When you press @kbd{M-# c} once again you will get the
890 same stack and trail contents you had when you last used the
891 Calculator.
892
893 The Calculator does not remember its state between Emacs sessions.
894 Thus if you quit Emacs and start it again, @kbd{M-# c} will give you
895 a fresh stack and trail. There is a command (@kbd{m m}) that lets
896 you save your favorite mode settings between sessions, though.
897 One of the things it saves is which user interface (standard or
898 Keypad) you last used; otherwise, a freshly started Emacs will
899 always treat @kbd{M-# M-#} the same as @kbd{M-# c}.
900
901 The @kbd{q} key is another equivalent way to turn the Calculator off.
902
903 If you type @kbd{M-# b} first and then @kbd{M-# c}, you get a
904 full-screen version of Calc (@code{full-calc}) in which the stack and
905 trail windows are still side-by-side but are now as tall as the whole
906 Emacs screen. When you press @kbd{q} or @kbd{M-# c} again to quit,
907 the file you were editing before reappears. The @kbd{M-# b} key
908 switches back and forth between ``big'' full-screen mode and the
909 normal partial-screen mode.
910
911 Finally, @kbd{M-# o} (@code{calc-other-window}) is like @kbd{M-# c}
912 except that the Calc window is not selected. The buffer you were
913 editing before remains selected instead. @kbd{M-# o} is a handy
914 way to switch out of Calc momentarily to edit your file; type
915 @kbd{M-# c} to switch back into Calc when you are done.
916
917 @node Quick Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, The Standard Interface, Using Calc
918 @subsection Quick Mode (Overview)
919
920 @noindent
921 @dfn{Quick mode} is a quick way to use Calc when you don't need the
922 full complexity of the stack and trail. To use it, type @kbd{M-# q}
923 (@code{quick-calc}) in any regular editing buffer.
924
925 Quick mode is very simple: It prompts you to type any formula in
926 standard algebraic notation (like @samp{4 - 2/3}) and then displays
927 the result at the bottom of the Emacs screen (@mathit{3.33333333333}
928 in this case). You are then back in the same editing buffer you
929 were in before, ready to continue editing or to type @kbd{M-# q}
930 again to do another quick calculation. The result of the calculation
931 will also be in the Emacs ``kill ring'' so that a @kbd{C-y} command
932 at this point will yank the result into your editing buffer.
933
934 Calc mode settings affect Quick mode, too, though you will have to
935 go into regular Calc (with @kbd{M-# c}) to change the mode settings.
936
937 @c [fix-ref Quick Calculator mode]
938 @xref{Quick Calculator}, for further information.
939
940 @node Keypad Mode Overview, Standalone Operation, Quick Mode Overview, Using Calc
941 @subsection Keypad Mode (Overview)
942
943 @noindent
944 @dfn{Keypad mode} is a mouse-based interface to the Calculator.
945 It is designed for use with terminals that support a mouse. If you
946 don't have a mouse, you will have to operate Keypad mode with your
947 arrow keys (which is probably more trouble than it's worth).
948
949 Type @kbd{M-# k} to turn Keypad mode on or off. Once again you
950 get two new windows, this time on the righthand side of the screen
951 instead of at the bottom. The upper window is the familiar Calc
952 Stack; the lower window is a picture of a typical calculator keypad.
953
954 @tex
955 \dimen0=\pagetotal%
956 \advance \dimen0 by 24\baselineskip%
957 \ifdim \dimen0>\pagegoal \vfill\eject \fi%
958 \medskip
959 @end tex
960 @smallexample
961 |--- Emacs Calculator Mode ---
962 |2: 17.3
963 |1: -5
964 | .
965 |--%%-Calc: 12 Deg (Calcul
966 |----+-----Calc 2.00-----+----1
967 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
968 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
969 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
970 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
971 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
972 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
973 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
974 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
975 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
976 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
977 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
978 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
979 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
980 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
981 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
982 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
983 @end smallexample
984
985 Keypad mode is much easier for beginners to learn, because there
986 is no need to memorize lots of obscure key sequences. But not all
987 commands in regular Calc are available on the Keypad. You can
988 always switch the cursor into the Calc stack window to use
989 standard Calc commands if you need. Serious Calc users, though,
990 often find they prefer the standard interface over Keypad mode.
991
992 To operate the Calculator, just click on the ``buttons'' of the
993 keypad using your left mouse button. To enter the two numbers
994 shown here you would click @w{@kbd{1 7 .@: 3 ENTER 5 +/- ENTER}}; to
995 add them together you would then click @kbd{+} (to get 12.3 on
996 the stack).
997
998 If you click the right mouse button, the top three rows of the
999 keypad change to show other sets of commands, such as advanced
1000 math functions, vector operations, and operations on binary
1001 numbers.
1002
1003 Because Keypad mode doesn't use the regular keyboard, Calc leaves
1004 the cursor in your original editing buffer. You can type in
1005 this buffer in the usual way while also clicking on the Calculator
1006 keypad. One advantage of Keypad mode is that you don't need an
1007 explicit command to switch between editing and calculating.
1008
1009 If you press @kbd{M-# b} first, you get a full-screen Keypad mode
1010 (@code{full-calc-keypad}) with three windows: The keypad in the lower
1011 left, the stack in the lower right, and the trail on top.
1012
1013 @c [fix-ref Keypad Mode]
1014 @xref{Keypad Mode}, for further information.
1015
1016 @node Standalone Operation, Embedded Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, Using Calc
1017 @subsection Standalone Operation
1018
1019 @noindent
1020 @cindex Standalone Operation
1021 If you are not in Emacs at the moment but you wish to use Calc,
1022 you must start Emacs first. If all you want is to run Calc, you
1023 can give the commands:
1024
1025 @example
1026 emacs -f full-calc
1027 @end example
1028
1029 @noindent
1030 or
1031
1032 @example
1033 emacs -f full-calc-keypad
1034 @end example
1035
1036 @noindent
1037 which run a full-screen Calculator (as if by @kbd{M-# b M-# c}) or
1038 a full-screen X-based Calculator (as if by @kbd{M-# b M-# k}).
1039 In standalone operation, quitting the Calculator (by pressing
1040 @kbd{q} or clicking on the keypad @key{EXIT} button) quits Emacs
1041 itself.
1042
1043 @node Embedded Mode Overview, Other M-# Commands, Standalone Operation, Using Calc
1044 @subsection Embedded Mode (Overview)
1045
1046 @noindent
1047 @dfn{Embedded mode} is a way to use Calc directly from inside an
1048 editing buffer. Suppose you have a formula written as part of a
1049 document like this:
1050
1051 @smallexample
1052 @group
1053 The derivative of
1054
1055 ln(ln(x))
1056
1057 is
1058 @end group
1059 @end smallexample
1060
1061 @noindent
1062 and you wish to have Calc compute and format the derivative for
1063 you and store this derivative in the buffer automatically. To
1064 do this with Embedded mode, first copy the formula down to where
1065 you want the result to be:
1066
1067 @smallexample
1068 @group
1069 The derivative of
1070
1071 ln(ln(x))
1072
1073 is
1074
1075 ln(ln(x))
1076 @end group
1077 @end smallexample
1078
1079 Now, move the cursor onto this new formula and press @kbd{M-# e}.
1080 Calc will read the formula (using the surrounding blank lines to
1081 tell how much text to read), then push this formula (invisibly)
1082 onto the Calc stack. The cursor will stay on the formula in the
1083 editing buffer, but the buffer's mode line will change to look
1084 like the Calc mode line (with mode indicators like @samp{12 Deg}
1085 and so on). Even though you are still in your editing buffer,
1086 the keyboard now acts like the Calc keyboard, and any new result
1087 you get is copied from the stack back into the buffer. To take
1088 the derivative, you would type @kbd{a d x @key{RET}}.
1089
1090 @smallexample
1091 @group
1092 The derivative of
1093
1094 ln(ln(x))
1095
1096 is
1097
1098 1 / ln(x) x
1099 @end group
1100 @end smallexample
1101
1102 To make this look nicer, you might want to press @kbd{d =} to center
1103 the formula, and even @kbd{d B} to use Big display mode.
1104
1105 @smallexample
1106 @group
1107 The derivative of
1108
1109 ln(ln(x))
1110
1111 is
1112 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
1113 % [calc-mode: language: big]
1114
1115 1
1116 -------
1117 ln(x) x
1118 @end group
1119 @end smallexample
1120
1121 Calc has added annotations to the file to help it remember the modes
1122 that were used for this formula. They are formatted like comments
1123 in the @TeX{} typesetting language, just in case you are using @TeX{} or
1124 La@TeX{}. (In this example @TeX{} is not being used, so you might want
1125 to move these comments up to the top of the file or otherwise put them
1126 out of the way.)
1127
1128 As an extra flourish, we can add an equation number using a
1129 righthand label: Type @kbd{d @} (1) @key{RET}}.
1130
1131 @smallexample
1132 @group
1133 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
1134 % [calc-mode: language: big]
1135 % [calc-mode: right-label: " (1)"]
1136
1137 1
1138 ------- (1)
1139 ln(x) x
1140 @end group
1141 @end smallexample
1142
1143 To leave Embedded mode, type @kbd{M-# e} again. The mode line
1144 and keyboard will revert to the way they were before. (If you have
1145 actually been trying this as you read along, you'll want to press
1146 @kbd{M-# 0} [with the digit zero] now to reset the modes you changed.)
1147
1148 The related command @kbd{M-# w} operates on a single word, which
1149 generally means a single number, inside text. It uses any
1150 non-numeric characters rather than blank lines to delimit the
1151 formula it reads. Here's an example of its use:
1152
1153 @smallexample
1154 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 1 degrees.
1155 @end smallexample
1156
1157 Place the cursor on the @samp{1}, then type @kbd{M-# w} to enable
1158 Embedded mode on that number. Now type @kbd{3 /} (to get one-third),
1159 and @kbd{I T} (the Inverse Tangent converts a slope into an angle),
1160 then @w{@kbd{M-# w}} again to exit Embedded mode.
1161
1162 @smallexample
1163 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 18.4349488229 degrees.
1164 @end smallexample
1165
1166 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
1167 @xref{Embedded Mode}, for full details.
1168
1169 @node Other M-# Commands, , Embedded Mode Overview, Using Calc
1170 @subsection Other @kbd{M-#} Commands
1171
1172 @noindent
1173 Two more Calc-related commands are @kbd{M-# g} and @kbd{M-# r},
1174 which ``grab'' data from a selected region of a buffer into the
1175 Calculator. The region is defined in the usual Emacs way, by
1176 a ``mark'' placed at one end of the region, and the Emacs
1177 cursor or ``point'' placed at the other.
1178
1179 The @kbd{M-# g} command reads the region in the usual left-to-right,
1180 top-to-bottom order. The result is packaged into a Calc vector
1181 of numbers and placed on the stack. Calc (in its standard
1182 user interface) is then started. Type @kbd{v u} if you want
1183 to unpack this vector into separate numbers on the stack. Also,
1184 @kbd{C-u M-# g} interprets the region as a single number or
1185 formula.
1186
1187 The @kbd{M-# r} command reads a rectangle, with the point and
1188 mark defining opposite corners of the rectangle. The result
1189 is a matrix of numbers on the Calculator stack.
1190
1191 Complementary to these is @kbd{M-# y}, which ``yanks'' the
1192 value at the top of the Calc stack back into an editing buffer.
1193 If you type @w{@kbd{M-# y}} while in such a buffer, the value is
1194 yanked at the current position. If you type @kbd{M-# y} while
1195 in the Calc buffer, Calc makes an educated guess as to which
1196 editing buffer you want to use. The Calc window does not have
1197 to be visible in order to use this command, as long as there
1198 is something on the Calc stack.
1199
1200 Here, for reference, is the complete list of @kbd{M-#} commands.
1201 The shift, control, and meta keys are ignored for the keystroke
1202 following @kbd{M-#}.
1203
1204 @noindent
1205 Commands for turning Calc on and off:
1206
1207 @table @kbd
1208 @item #
1209 Turn Calc on or off, employing the same user interface as last time.
1210
1211 @item C
1212 Turn Calc on or off using its standard bottom-of-the-screen
1213 interface. If Calc is already turned on but the cursor is not
1214 in the Calc window, move the cursor into the window.
1215
1216 @item O
1217 Same as @kbd{C}, but don't select the new Calc window. If
1218 Calc is already turned on and the cursor is in the Calc window,
1219 move it out of that window.
1220
1221 @item B
1222 Control whether @kbd{M-# c} and @kbd{M-# k} use the full screen.
1223
1224 @item Q
1225 Use Quick mode for a single short calculation.
1226
1227 @item K
1228 Turn Calc Keypad mode on or off.
1229
1230 @item E
1231 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current formula.
1232
1233 @item J
1234 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off, select the interesting part.
1235
1236 @item W
1237 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current word (number).
1238
1239 @item Z
1240 Turn Calc on in a user-defined way, as defined by a @kbd{Z I} command.
1241
1242 @item X
1243 Quit Calc; turn off standard, Keypad, or Embedded mode if on.
1244 (This is like @kbd{q} or @key{OFF} inside of Calc.)
1245 @end table
1246 @iftex
1247 @sp 2
1248 @end iftex
1249
1250 @noindent
1251 Commands for moving data into and out of the Calculator:
1252
1253 @table @kbd
1254 @item G
1255 Grab the region into the Calculator as a vector.
1256
1257 @item R
1258 Grab the rectangular region into the Calculator as a matrix.
1259
1260 @item :
1261 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its columns.
1262
1263 @item _
1264 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its rows.
1265
1266 @item Y
1267 Yank a value from the Calculator into the current editing buffer.
1268 @end table
1269 @iftex
1270 @sp 2
1271 @end iftex
1272
1273 @noindent
1274 Commands for use with Embedded mode:
1275
1276 @table @kbd
1277 @item A
1278 ``Activate'' the current buffer. Locate all formulas that
1279 contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols and record their locations
1280 so that they can be updated automatically as variables are changed.
1281
1282 @item D
1283 Duplicate the current formula immediately below and select
1284 the duplicate.
1285
1286 @item F
1287 Insert a new formula at the current point.
1288
1289 @item N
1290 Move the cursor to the next active formula in the buffer.
1291
1292 @item P
1293 Move the cursor to the previous active formula in the buffer.
1294
1295 @item U
1296 Update (i.e., as if by the @kbd{=} key) the formula at the current point.
1297
1298 @item `
1299 Edit (as if by @code{calc-edit}) the formula at the current point.
1300 @end table
1301 @iftex
1302 @sp 2
1303 @end iftex
1304
1305 @noindent
1306 Miscellaneous commands:
1307
1308 @table @kbd
1309 @item I
1310 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc manual.
1311 (This is the same as @kbd{h i} inside of Calc.)
1312
1313 @item T
1314 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Tutorial.
1315
1316 @item S
1317 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Summary.
1318
1319 @item L
1320 Load Calc entirely into memory. (Normally the various parts
1321 are loaded only as they are needed.)
1322
1323 @item M
1324 Read a region of written keystroke names (like @kbd{C-n a b c @key{RET}})
1325 and record them as the current keyboard macro.
1326
1327 @item 0
1328 (This is the ``zero'' digit key.) Reset the Calculator to
1329 its default state: Empty stack, and default mode settings.
1330 With any prefix argument, reset everything but the stack.
1331 @end table
1332
1333 @node History and Acknowledgements, , Using Calc, Getting Started
1334 @section History and Acknowledgements
1335
1336 @noindent
1337 Calc was originally started as a two-week project to occupy a lull
1338 in the author's schedule. Basically, a friend asked if I remembered
1339 the value of
1340 @texline @math{2^{32}}.
1341 @infoline @expr{2^32}.
1342 I didn't offhand, but I said, ``that's easy, just call up an
1343 @code{xcalc}.'' @code{Xcalc} duly reported that the answer to our
1344 question was @samp{4.294967e+09}---with no way to see the full ten
1345 digits even though we knew they were there in the program's memory! I
1346 was so annoyed, I vowed to write a calculator of my own, once and for
1347 all.
1348
1349 I chose Emacs Lisp, a) because I had always been curious about it
1350 and b) because, being only a text editor extension language after
1351 all, Emacs Lisp would surely reach its limits long before the project
1352 got too far out of hand.
1353
1354 To make a long story short, Emacs Lisp turned out to be a distressingly
1355 solid implementation of Lisp, and the humble task of calculating
1356 turned out to be more open-ended than one might have expected.
1357
1358 Emacs Lisp doesn't have built-in floating point math, so it had to be
1359 simulated in software. In fact, Emacs integers will only comfortably
1360 fit six decimal digits or so---not enough for a decent calculator. So
1361 I had to write my own high-precision integer code as well, and once I had
1362 this I figured that arbitrary-size integers were just as easy as large
1363 integers. Arbitrary floating-point precision was the logical next step.
1364 Also, since the large integer arithmetic was there anyway it seemed only
1365 fair to give the user direct access to it, which in turn made it practical
1366 to support fractions as well as floats. All these features inspired me
1367 to look around for other data types that might be worth having.
1368
1369 Around this time, my friend Rick Koshi showed me his nifty new HP-28
1370 calculator. It allowed the user to manipulate formulas as well as
1371 numerical quantities, and it could also operate on matrices. I decided
1372 that these would be good for Calc to have, too. And once things had
1373 gone this far, I figured I might as well take a look at serious algebra
1374 systems like Mathematica, Macsyma, and Maple for further ideas. Since
1375 these systems did far more than I could ever hope to implement, I decided
1376 to focus on rewrite rules and other programming features so that users
1377 could implement what they needed for themselves.
1378
1379 Rick complained that matrices were hard to read, so I put in code to
1380 format them in a 2D style. Once these routines were in place, Big mode
1381 was obligatory. Gee, what other language modes would be useful?
1382
1383 Scott Hemphill and Allen Knutson, two friends with a strong mathematical
1384 bent, contributed ideas and algorithms for a number of Calc features
1385 including modulo forms, primality testing, and float-to-fraction conversion.
1386
1387 Units were added at the eager insistence of Mass Sivilotti. Later,
1388 Ulrich Mueller at CERN and Przemek Klosowski at NIST provided invaluable
1389 expert assistance with the units table. As far as I can remember, the
1390 idea of using algebraic formulas and variables to represent units dates
1391 back to an ancient article in Byte magazine about muMath, an early
1392 algebra system for microcomputers.
1393
1394 Many people have contributed to Calc by reporting bugs and suggesting
1395 features, large and small. A few deserve special mention: Tim Peters,
1396 who helped develop the ideas that led to the selection commands, rewrite
1397 rules, and many other algebra features;
1398 @texline Fran\c cois
1399 @infoline Francois
1400 Pinard, who contributed an early prototype of the Calc Summary appendix
1401 as well as providing valuable suggestions in many other areas of Calc;
1402 Carl Witty, whose eagle eyes discovered many typographical and factual
1403 errors in the Calc manual; Tim Kay, who drove the development of
1404 Embedded mode; Ove Ewerlid, who made many suggestions relating to the
1405 algebra commands and contributed some code for polynomial operations;
1406 Randal Schwartz, who suggested the @code{calc-eval} function; Robert
1407 J. Chassell, who suggested the Calc Tutorial and exercises; and Juha
1408 Sarlin, who first worked out how to split Calc into quickly-loading
1409 parts. Bob Weiner helped immensely with the Lucid Emacs port.
1410
1411 @cindex Bibliography
1412 @cindex Knuth, Art of Computer Programming
1413 @cindex Numerical Recipes
1414 @c Should these be expanded into more complete references?
1415 Among the books used in the development of Calc were Knuth's @emph{Art
1416 of Computer Programming} (especially volume II, @emph{Seminumerical
1417 Algorithms}); @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky,
1418 and Vetterling; Bevington's @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis for
1419 the Physical Sciences}; @emph{Concrete Mathematics} by Graham, Knuth,
1420 and Patashnik; Steele's @emph{Common Lisp, the Language}; the @emph{CRC
1421 Standard Math Tables} (William H. Beyer, ed.); and Abramowitz and
1422 Stegun's venerable @emph{Handbook of Mathematical Functions}. I
1423 consulted the user's manuals for the HP-28 and HP-48 calculators, as
1424 well as for the programs Mathematica, SMP, Macsyma, Maple, MathCAD,
1425 Gnuplot, and others. Also, of course, Calc could not have been written
1426 without the excellent @emph{GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, by Bil
1427 Lewis and Dan LaLiberte.
1428
1429 Final thanks go to Richard Stallman, without whose fine implementations
1430 of the Emacs editor, language, and environment, Calc would have been
1431 finished in two weeks.
1432
1433 @c [tutorial]
1434
1435 @ifinfo
1436 @c This node is accessed by the `M-# t' command.
1437 @node Interactive Tutorial, , , Top
1438 @chapter Tutorial
1439
1440 @noindent
1441 Some brief instructions on using the Emacs Info system for this tutorial:
1442
1443 Press the space bar and Delete keys to go forward and backward in a
1444 section by screenfuls (or use the regular Emacs scrolling commands
1445 for this).
1446
1447 Press @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to go to the Next or Previous section.
1448 If the section has a @dfn{menu}, press a digit key like @kbd{1}
1449 or @kbd{2} to go to a sub-section from the menu. Press @kbd{u} to
1450 go back up from a sub-section to the menu it is part of.
1451
1452 Exercises in the tutorial all have cross-references to the
1453 appropriate page of the ``answers'' section. Press @kbd{f}, then
1454 the exercise number, to see the answer to an exercise. After
1455 you have followed a cross-reference, you can press the letter
1456 @kbd{l} to return to where you were before.
1457
1458 You can press @kbd{?} at any time for a brief summary of Info commands.
1459
1460 Press @kbd{1} now to enter the first section of the Tutorial.
1461
1462 @menu
1463 * Tutorial::
1464 @end menu
1465 @end ifinfo
1466
1467 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Getting Started, Top
1468 @chapter Tutorial
1469
1470 @noindent
1471 This chapter explains how to use Calc and its many features, in
1472 a step-by-step, tutorial way. You are encouraged to run Calc and
1473 work along with the examples as you read (@pxref{Starting Calc}).
1474 If you are already familiar with advanced calculators, you may wish
1475 @c [not-split]
1476 to skip on to the rest of this manual.
1477 @c [when-split]
1478 @c to skip on to volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}.
1479
1480 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
1481 This tutorial describes the standard user interface of Calc only.
1482 The Quick mode and Keypad mode interfaces are fairly
1483 self-explanatory. @xref{Embedded Mode}, for a description of
1484 the Embedded mode interface.
1485
1486 @ifinfo
1487 The easiest way to read this tutorial on-line is to have two windows on
1488 your Emacs screen, one with Calc and one with the Info system. (If you
1489 have a printed copy of the manual you can use that instead.) Press
1490 @kbd{M-# c} to turn Calc on or to switch into the Calc window, and
1491 press @kbd{M-# i} to start the Info system or to switch into its window.
1492 Or, you may prefer to use the tutorial in printed form.
1493 @end ifinfo
1494 @iftex
1495 The easiest way to read this tutorial on-line is to have two windows on
1496 your Emacs screen, one with Calc and one with the Info system. (If you
1497 have a printed copy of the manual you can use that instead.) Press
1498 @kbd{M-# c} to turn Calc on or to switch into the Calc window, and
1499 press @kbd{M-# i} to start the Info system or to switch into its window.
1500 @end iftex
1501
1502 This tutorial is designed to be done in sequence. But the rest of this
1503 manual does not assume you have gone through the tutorial. The tutorial
1504 does not cover everything in the Calculator, but it touches on most
1505 general areas.
1506
1507 @ifinfo
1508 You may wish to print out a copy of the Calc Summary and keep notes on
1509 it as you learn Calc. @xref{Installation}, to see how to make a printed
1510 summary. @xref{Summary}.
1511 @end ifinfo
1512 @iftex
1513 The Calc Summary at the end of the reference manual includes some blank
1514 space for your own use. You may wish to keep notes there as you learn
1515 Calc.
1516 @end iftex
1517
1518 @menu
1519 * Basic Tutorial::
1520 * Arithmetic Tutorial::
1521 * Vector/Matrix Tutorial::
1522 * Types Tutorial::
1523 * Algebra Tutorial::
1524 * Programming Tutorial::
1525
1526 * Answers to Exercises::
1527 @end menu
1528
1529 @node Basic Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial, Tutorial
1530 @section Basic Tutorial
1531
1532 @noindent
1533 In this section, we learn how RPN and algebraic-style calculations
1534 work, how to undo and redo an operation done by mistake, and how
1535 to control various modes of the Calculator.
1536
1537 @menu
1538 * RPN Tutorial:: Basic operations with the stack.
1539 * Algebraic Tutorial:: Algebraic entry; variables.
1540 * Undo Tutorial:: If you make a mistake: Undo and the trail.
1541 * Modes Tutorial:: Common mode-setting commands.
1542 @end menu
1543
1544 @node RPN Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1545 @subsection RPN Calculations and the Stack
1546
1547 @cindex RPN notation
1548 @ifinfo
1549 @noindent
1550 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1551 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1552 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1553 Jan Lukasiewicz.)
1554 @end ifinfo
1555 @tex
1556 \noindent
1557 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1558 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1559 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1560 Jan \L ukasiewicz.)
1561 @end tex
1562
1563 The central component of an RPN calculator is the @dfn{stack}. A
1564 calculator stack is like a stack of dishes. New dishes (numbers) are
1565 added at the top of the stack, and numbers are normally only removed
1566 from the top of the stack.
1567
1568 @cindex Operators
1569 @cindex Operands
1570 In an operation like @expr{2+3}, the 2 and 3 are called the @dfn{operands}
1571 and the @expr{+} is the @dfn{operator}. In an RPN calculator you always
1572 enter the operands first, then the operator. Each time you type a
1573 number, Calc adds or @dfn{pushes} it onto the top of the Stack.
1574 When you press an operator key like @kbd{+}, Calc @dfn{pops} the appropriate
1575 number of operands from the stack and pushes back the result.
1576
1577 Thus we could add the numbers 2 and 3 in an RPN calculator by typing:
1578 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} +}. (The @key{RET} key, Return, corresponds to
1579 the @key{ENTER} key on traditional RPN calculators.) Try this now if
1580 you wish; type @kbd{M-# c} to switch into the Calc window (you can type
1581 @kbd{M-# c} again or @kbd{M-# o} to switch back to the Tutorial window).
1582 The first four keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 2 and 3 onto the stack.
1583 The @kbd{+} key ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
1584 and pushes the result (5) back onto the stack. Here's how the stack
1585 will look at various points throughout the calculation:
1586
1587 @smallexample
1588 @group
1589 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1590 . 1: 3 .
1591 .
1592
1593 M-# c 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} + @key{DEL}
1594 @end group
1595 @end smallexample
1596
1597 The @samp{.} symbol is a marker that represents the top of the stack.
1598 Note that the ``top'' of the stack is really shown at the bottom of
1599 the Stack window. This may seem backwards, but it turns out to be
1600 less distracting in regular use.
1601
1602 @cindex Stack levels
1603 @cindex Levels of stack
1604 The numbers @samp{1:} and @samp{2:} on the left are @dfn{stack level
1605 numbers}. Old RPN calculators always had four stack levels called
1606 @expr{x}, @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and @expr{t}. Calc's stack can grow
1607 as large as you like, so it uses numbers instead of letters. Some
1608 stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric argument that says
1609 which stack level to work on. Normal commands like @kbd{+} always
1610 work on the top few levels of the stack.
1611
1612 @c [fix-ref Truncating the Stack]
1613 The Stack buffer is just an Emacs buffer, and you can move around in
1614 it using the regular Emacs motion commands. But no matter where the
1615 cursor is, even if you have scrolled the @samp{.} marker out of
1616 view, most Calc commands always move the cursor back down to level 1
1617 before doing anything. It is possible to move the @samp{.} marker
1618 upwards through the stack, temporarily ``hiding'' some numbers from
1619 commands like @kbd{+}. This is called @dfn{stack truncation} and
1620 we will not cover it in this tutorial; @pxref{Truncating the Stack},
1621 if you are interested.
1622
1623 You don't really need the second @key{RET} in @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3
1624 @key{RET} +}. That's because if you type any operator name or
1625 other non-numeric key when you are entering a number, the Calculator
1626 automatically enters that number and then does the requested command.
1627 Thus @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +} will work just as well.
1628
1629 Examples in this tutorial will often omit @key{RET} even when the
1630 stack displays shown would only happen if you did press @key{RET}:
1631
1632 @smallexample
1633 @group
1634 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5
1635 . 1: 3 .
1636 .
1637
1638 2 @key{RET} 3 +
1639 @end group
1640 @end smallexample
1641
1642 @noindent
1643 Here, after pressing @kbd{3} the stack would really show @samp{1: 2}
1644 with @samp{Calc:@: 3} in the minibuffer. In these situations, you can
1645 press the optional @key{RET} to see the stack as the figure shows.
1646
1647 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} (This tutorial will include exercises
1648 at various points. Try them if you wish. Answers to all the exercises
1649 are located at the end of the Tutorial chapter. Each exercise will
1650 include a cross-reference to its particular answer. If you are
1651 reading with the Emacs Info system, press @kbd{f} and the
1652 exercise number to go to the answer, then the letter @kbd{l} to
1653 return to where you were.)
1654
1655 @noindent
1656 Here's the first exercise: What will the keystrokes @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2
1657 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -} compute? (@samp{*} is the symbol for
1658 multiplication.) Figure it out by hand, then try it with Calc to see
1659 if you're right. @xref{RPN Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1660
1661 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Compute
1662 @texline @math{(2\times4) + (7\times9.4) + {5\over4}}
1663 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4}
1664 using the stack. @xref{RPN Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
1665
1666 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards. It is
1667 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
1668 regularly using Emacs. The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the
1669 top value on the stack. (You can still get that value back from
1670 the Trail if you should need it later on.) There are many places
1671 in this tutorial where we assume you have used @key{DEL} to erase the
1672 results of the previous example at the beginning of a new example.
1673 In the few places where it is really important to use @key{DEL} to
1674 clear away old results, the text will remind you to do so.
1675
1676 (It won't hurt to let things accumulate on the stack, except that
1677 whenever you give a display-mode-changing command Calc will have to
1678 spend a long time reformatting such a large stack.)
1679
1680 Since the @kbd{-} key is also an operator (it subtracts the top two
1681 stack elements), how does one enter a negative number? Calc uses
1682 the @kbd{_} (underscore) key to act like the minus sign in a number.
1683 So, typing @kbd{-5 @key{RET}} won't work because the @kbd{-} key
1684 will try to do a subtraction, but @kbd{_5 @key{RET}} works just fine.
1685
1686 You can also press @kbd{n}, which means ``change sign.'' It changes
1687 the number at the top of the stack (or the number being entered)
1688 from positive to negative or vice-versa: @kbd{5 n @key{RET}}.
1689
1690 @cindex Duplicating a stack entry
1691 If you press @key{RET} when you're not entering a number, the effect
1692 is to duplicate the top number on the stack. Consider this calculation:
1693
1694 @smallexample
1695 @group
1696 1: 3 2: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 81
1697 . 1: 3 . 1: 9 .
1698 . .
1699
1700 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * @key{RET} *
1701 @end group
1702 @end smallexample
1703
1704 @noindent
1705 (Of course, an easier way to do this would be @kbd{3 @key{RET} 4 ^},
1706 to raise 3 to the fourth power.)
1707
1708 The space-bar key (denoted @key{SPC} here) performs the same function
1709 as @key{RET}; you could replace all three occurrences of @key{RET} in
1710 the above example with @key{SPC} and the effect would be the same.
1711
1712 @cindex Exchanging stack entries
1713 Another stack manipulation key is @key{TAB}. This exchanges the top
1714 two stack entries. Suppose you have computed @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +}
1715 to get 5, and then you realize what you really wanted to compute
1716 was @expr{20 / (2+3)}.
1717
1718 @smallexample
1719 @group
1720 1: 5 2: 5 2: 20 1: 4
1721 . 1: 20 1: 5 .
1722 . .
1723
1724 2 @key{RET} 3 + 20 @key{TAB} /
1725 @end group
1726 @end smallexample
1727
1728 @noindent
1729 Planning ahead, the calculation would have gone like this:
1730
1731 @smallexample
1732 @group
1733 1: 20 2: 20 3: 20 2: 20 1: 4
1734 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1735 . 1: 3 .
1736 .
1737
1738 20 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 + /
1739 @end group
1740 @end smallexample
1741
1742 A related stack command is @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (hold @key{META} and type
1743 @key{TAB}). It rotates the top three elements of the stack upward,
1744 bringing the object in level 3 to the top.
1745
1746 @smallexample
1747 @group
1748 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 20 3: 30
1749 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 30 2: 10
1750 . 1: 30 1: 10 1: 20
1751 . . .
1752
1753 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
1754 @end group
1755 @end smallexample
1756
1757 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Suppose the numbers 10, 20, and 30 are
1758 on the stack. Figure out how to add one to the number in level 2
1759 without affecting the rest of the stack. Also figure out how to add
1760 one to the number in level 3. @xref{RPN Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
1761
1762 Operations like @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/}, and @kbd{^} pop two
1763 arguments from the stack and push a result. Operations like @kbd{n} and
1764 @kbd{Q} (square root) pop a single number and push the result. You can
1765 think of them as simply operating on the top element of the stack.
1766
1767 @smallexample
1768 @group
1769 1: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 25 1: 5
1770 . . 1: 16 . .
1771 .
1772
1773 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} @key{RET} * + Q
1774 @end group
1775 @end smallexample
1776
1777 @noindent
1778 (Note that capital @kbd{Q} means to hold down the Shift key while
1779 typing @kbd{q}. Remember, plain unshifted @kbd{q} is the Quit command.)
1780
1781 @cindex Pythagorean Theorem
1782 Here we've used the Pythagorean Theorem to determine the hypotenuse of a
1783 right triangle. Calc actually has a built-in command for that called
1784 @kbd{f h}, but let's suppose we can't remember the necessary keystrokes.
1785 We can still enter it by its full name using @kbd{M-x} notation:
1786
1787 @smallexample
1788 @group
1789 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1790 . 1: 4 .
1791 .
1792
1793 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} M-x calc-hypot
1794 @end group
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 All Calculator commands begin with the word @samp{calc-}. Since it
1798 gets tiring to type this, Calc provides an @kbd{x} key which is just
1799 like the regular Emacs @kbd{M-x} key except that it types the @samp{calc-}
1800 prefix for you:
1801
1802 @smallexample
1803 @group
1804 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1805 . 1: 4 .
1806 .
1807
1808 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} x hypot
1809 @end group
1810 @end smallexample
1811
1812 What happens if you take the square root of a negative number?
1813
1814 @smallexample
1815 @group
1816 1: 4 1: -4 1: (0, 2)
1817 . . .
1818
1819 4 @key{RET} n Q
1820 @end group
1821 @end smallexample
1822
1823 @noindent
1824 The notation @expr{(a, b)} represents a complex number.
1825 Complex numbers are more traditionally written @expr{a + b i};
1826 Calc can display in this format, too, but for now we'll stick to the
1827 @expr{(a, b)} notation.
1828
1829 If you don't know how complex numbers work, you can safely ignore this
1830 feature. Complex numbers only arise from operations that would be
1831 errors in a calculator that didn't have complex numbers. (For example,
1832 taking the square root or logarithm of a negative number produces a
1833 complex result.)
1834
1835 Complex numbers are entered in the notation shown. The @kbd{(} and
1836 @kbd{,} and @kbd{)} keys manipulate ``incomplete complex numbers.''
1837
1838 @smallexample
1839 @group
1840 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
1841 . 1: 2 . 3 .
1842 . .
1843
1844 ( 2 , 3 )
1845 @end group
1846 @end smallexample
1847
1848 You can perform calculations while entering parts of incomplete objects.
1849 However, an incomplete object cannot actually participate in a calculation:
1850
1851 @smallexample
1852 @group
1853 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 3: ( ... 1: ( ... 1: ( ...
1854 . 1: 2 2: 2 5 5
1855 . 1: 3 . .
1856 .
1857 (error)
1858 ( 2 @key{RET} 3 + +
1859 @end group
1860 @end smallexample
1861
1862 @noindent
1863 Adding 5 to an incomplete object makes no sense, so the last command
1864 produces an error message and leaves the stack the same.
1865
1866 Incomplete objects can't participate in arithmetic, but they can be
1867 moved around by the regular stack commands.
1868
1869 @smallexample
1870 @group
1871 2: 2 3: 2 3: 3 1: ( ... 1: (2, 3)
1872 1: 3 2: 3 2: ( ... 2 .
1873 . 1: ( ... 1: 2 3
1874 . . .
1875
1876 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} ( M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} )
1877 @end group
1878 @end smallexample
1879
1880 @noindent
1881 Note that the @kbd{,} (comma) key did not have to be used here.
1882 When you press @kbd{)} all the stack entries between the incomplete
1883 entry and the top are collected, so there's never really a reason
1884 to use the comma. It's up to you.
1885
1886 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} To enter the complex number @expr{(2, 3)},
1887 your friend Joe typed @kbd{( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )}. What happened?
1888 (Joe thought of a clever way to correct his mistake in only two
1889 keystrokes, but it didn't quite work. Try it to find out why.)
1890 @xref{RPN Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
1891
1892 Vectors are entered the same way as complex numbers, but with square
1893 brackets in place of parentheses. We'll meet vectors again later in
1894 the tutorial.
1895
1896 Any Emacs command can be given a @dfn{numeric prefix argument} by
1897 typing a series of @key{META}-digits beforehand. If @key{META} is
1898 awkward for you, you can instead type @kbd{C-u} followed by the
1899 necessary digits. Numeric prefix arguments can be negative, as in
1900 @kbd{M-- M-3 M-5} or @w{@kbd{C-u - 3 5}}. Calc commands use numeric
1901 prefix arguments in a variety of ways. For example, a numeric prefix
1902 on the @kbd{+} operator adds any number of stack entries at once:
1903
1904 @smallexample
1905 @group
1906 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 1: 60
1907 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 .
1908 . 1: 30 1: 30
1909 . .
1910
1911 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u 3 +
1912 @end group
1913 @end smallexample
1914
1915 For stack manipulation commands like @key{RET}, a positive numeric
1916 prefix argument operates on the top @var{n} stack entries at once. A
1917 negative argument operates on the entry in level @var{n} only. An
1918 argument of zero operates on the entire stack. In this example, we copy
1919 the second-to-top element of the stack:
1920
1921 @smallexample
1922 @group
1923 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10
1924 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 3: 20
1925 . 1: 30 1: 30 2: 30
1926 . . 1: 20
1927 .
1928
1929 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u -2 @key{RET}
1930 @end group
1931 @end smallexample
1932
1933 @cindex Clearing the stack
1934 @cindex Emptying the stack
1935 Another common idiom is @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}, which clears the stack.
1936 (The @kbd{M-0} numeric prefix tells @key{DEL} to operate on the
1937 entire stack.)
1938
1939 @node Algebraic Tutorial, Undo Tutorial, RPN Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1940 @subsection Algebraic-Style Calculations
1941
1942 @noindent
1943 If you are not used to RPN notation, you may prefer to operate the
1944 Calculator in Algebraic mode, which is closer to the way
1945 non-RPN calculators work. In Algebraic mode, you enter formulas
1946 in traditional @expr{2+3} notation.
1947
1948 You don't really need any special ``mode'' to enter algebraic formulas.
1949 You can enter a formula at any time by pressing the apostrophe (@kbd{'})
1950 key. Answer the prompt with the desired formula, then press @key{RET}.
1951 The formula is evaluated and the result is pushed onto the RPN stack.
1952 If you don't want to think in RPN at all, you can enter your whole
1953 computation as a formula, read the result from the stack, then press
1954 @key{DEL} to delete it from the stack.
1955
1956 Try pressing the apostrophe key, then @kbd{2+3+4}, then @key{RET}.
1957 The result should be the number 9.
1958
1959 Algebraic formulas use the operators @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*},
1960 @samp{/}, and @samp{^}. You can use parentheses to make the order
1961 of evaluation clear. In the absence of parentheses, @samp{^} is
1962 evaluated first, then @samp{*}, then @samp{/}, then finally
1963 @samp{+} and @samp{-}. For example, the expression
1964
1965 @example
1966 2 + 3*4*5 / 6*7^8 - 9
1967 @end example
1968
1969 @noindent
1970 is equivalent to
1971
1972 @example
1973 2 + ((3*4*5) / (6*(7^8)) - 9
1974 @end example
1975
1976 @noindent
1977 or, in large mathematical notation,
1978
1979 @ifinfo
1980 @example
1981 @group
1982 3 * 4 * 5
1983 2 + --------- - 9
1984 8
1985 6 * 7
1986 @end group
1987 @end example
1988 @end ifinfo
1989 @tex
1990 \turnoffactive
1991 \beforedisplay
1992 $$ 2 + { 3 \times 4 \times 5 \over 6 \times 7^8 } - 9 $$
1993 \afterdisplay
1994 @end tex
1995
1996 @noindent
1997 The result of this expression will be the number @mathit{-6.99999826533}.
1998
1999 Calc's order of evaluation is the same as for most computer languages,
2000 except that @samp{*} binds more strongly than @samp{/}, as the above
2001 example shows. As in normal mathematical notation, the @samp{*} symbol
2002 can often be omitted: @samp{2 a} is the same as @samp{2*a}.
2003
2004 Operators at the same level are evaluated from left to right, except
2005 that @samp{^} is evaluated from right to left. Thus, @samp{2-3-4} is
2006 equivalent to @samp{(2-3)-4} or @mathit{-5}, whereas @samp{2^3^4} is equivalent
2007 to @samp{2^(3^4)} (a very large integer; try it!).
2008
2009 If you tire of typing the apostrophe all the time, there is
2010 Algebraic mode, where Calc automatically senses
2011 when you are about to type an algebraic expression. To enter this
2012 mode, press the two letters @w{@kbd{m a}}. (An @samp{Alg} indicator
2013 should appear in the Calc window's mode line.)
2014
2015 Press @kbd{m a}, then @kbd{2+3+4} with no apostrophe, then @key{RET}.
2016
2017 In Algebraic mode, when you press any key that would normally begin
2018 entering a number (such as a digit, a decimal point, or the @kbd{_}
2019 key), or if you press @kbd{(} or @kbd{[}, Calc automatically begins
2020 an algebraic entry.
2021
2022 Functions which do not have operator symbols like @samp{+} and @samp{*}
2023 must be entered in formulas using function-call notation. For example,
2024 the function name corresponding to the square-root key @kbd{Q} is
2025 @code{sqrt}. To compute a square root in a formula, you would use
2026 the notation @samp{sqrt(@var{x})}.
2027
2028 Press the apostrophe, then type @kbd{sqrt(5*2) - 3}. The result should
2029 be @expr{0.16227766017}.
2030
2031 Note that if the formula begins with a function name, you need to use
2032 the apostrophe even if you are in Algebraic mode. If you type @kbd{arcsin}
2033 out of the blue, the @kbd{a r} will be taken as an Algebraic Rewrite
2034 command, and the @kbd{csin} will be taken as the name of the rewrite
2035 rule to use!
2036
2037 Some people prefer to enter complex numbers and vectors in algebraic
2038 form because they find RPN entry with incomplete objects to be too
2039 distracting, even though they otherwise use Calc as an RPN calculator.
2040
2041 Still in Algebraic mode, type:
2042
2043 @smallexample
2044 @group
2045 1: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (8, -1) 2: (8, -1) 1: (9, -1)
2046 . 1: (1, -2) . 1: 1 .
2047 . .
2048
2049 (2,3) @key{RET} (1,-2) @key{RET} * 1 @key{RET} +
2050 @end group
2051 @end smallexample
2052
2053 Algebraic mode allows us to enter complex numbers without pressing
2054 an apostrophe first, but it also means we need to press @key{RET}
2055 after every entry, even for a simple number like @expr{1}.
2056
2057 (You can type @kbd{C-u m a} to enable a special Incomplete Algebraic
2058 mode in which the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys use algebraic entry even
2059 though regular numeric keys still use RPN numeric entry. There is also
2060 Total Algebraic mode, started by typing @kbd{m t}, in which all
2061 normal keys begin algebraic entry. You must then use the @key{META} key
2062 to type Calc commands: @kbd{M-m t} to get back out of Total Algebraic
2063 mode, @kbd{M-q} to quit, etc.)
2064
2065 If you're still in Algebraic mode, press @kbd{m a} again to turn it off.
2066
2067 Actual non-RPN calculators use a mixture of algebraic and RPN styles.
2068 In general, operators of two numbers (like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*})
2069 use algebraic form, but operators of one number (like @kbd{n} and @kbd{Q})
2070 use RPN form. Also, a non-RPN calculator allows you to see the
2071 intermediate results of a calculation as you go along. You can
2072 accomplish this in Calc by performing your calculation as a series
2073 of algebraic entries, using the @kbd{$} sign to tie them together.
2074 In an algebraic formula, @kbd{$} represents the number on the top
2075 of the stack. Here, we perform the calculation
2076 @texline @math{\sqrt{2\times4+1}},
2077 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2*4+1)},
2078 which on a traditional calculator would be done by pressing
2079 @kbd{2 * 4 + 1 =} and then the square-root key.
2080
2081 @smallexample
2082 @group
2083 1: 8 1: 9 1: 3
2084 . . .
2085
2086 ' 2*4 @key{RET} $+1 @key{RET} Q
2087 @end group
2088 @end smallexample
2089
2090 @noindent
2091 Notice that we didn't need to press an apostrophe for the @kbd{$+1},
2092 because the dollar sign always begins an algebraic entry.
2093
2094 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} How could you get the same effect as
2095 pressing @kbd{Q} but using an algebraic entry instead? How about
2096 if the @kbd{Q} key on your keyboard were broken?
2097 @xref{Algebraic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2098
2099 The notations @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on stand for higher stack
2100 entries. For example, @kbd{' $$+$ @key{RET}} is just like typing @kbd{+}.
2101
2102 Algebraic formulas can include @dfn{variables}. To store in a
2103 variable, press @kbd{s s}, then type the variable name, then press
2104 @key{RET}. (There are actually two flavors of store command:
2105 @kbd{s s} stores a number in a variable but also leaves the number
2106 on the stack, while @w{@kbd{s t}} removes a number from the stack and
2107 stores it in the variable.) A variable name should consist of one
2108 or more letters or digits, beginning with a letter.
2109
2110 @smallexample
2111 @group
2112 1: 17 . 1: a + a^2 1: 306
2113 . . .
2114
2115 17 s t a @key{RET} ' a+a^2 @key{RET} =
2116 @end group
2117 @end smallexample
2118
2119 @noindent
2120 The @kbd{=} key @dfn{evaluates} a formula by replacing all its
2121 variables by the values that were stored in them.
2122
2123 For RPN calculations, you can recall a variable's value on the
2124 stack either by entering its name as a formula and pressing @kbd{=},
2125 or by using the @kbd{s r} command.
2126
2127 @smallexample
2128 @group
2129 1: 17 2: 17 3: 17 2: 17 1: 306
2130 . 1: 17 2: 17 1: 289 .
2131 . 1: 2 .
2132 .
2133
2134 s r a @key{RET} ' a @key{RET} = 2 ^ +
2135 @end group
2136 @end smallexample
2137
2138 If you press a single digit for a variable name (as in @kbd{s t 3}, you
2139 get one of ten @dfn{quick variables} @code{q0} through @code{q9}.
2140 They are ``quick'' simply because you don't have to type the letter
2141 @code{q} or the @key{RET} after their names. In fact, you can type
2142 simply @kbd{s 3} as a shorthand for @kbd{s s 3}, and likewise for
2143 @kbd{t 3} and @w{@kbd{r 3}}.
2144
2145 Any variables in an algebraic formula for which you have not stored
2146 values are left alone, even when you evaluate the formula.
2147
2148 @smallexample
2149 @group
2150 1: 2 a + 2 b 1: 34 + 2 b
2151 . .
2152
2153 ' 2a+2b @key{RET} =
2154 @end group
2155 @end smallexample
2156
2157 Calls to function names which are undefined in Calc are also left
2158 alone, as are calls for which the value is undefined.
2159
2160 @smallexample
2161 @group
2162 1: 2 + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5, 6) + foo(3)
2163 .
2164
2165 ' log10(100) + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5,6) + foo(3) @key{RET}
2166 @end group
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 In this example, the first call to @code{log10} works, but the other
2171 calls are not evaluated. In the second call, the logarithm is
2172 undefined for that value of the argument; in the third, the argument
2173 is symbolic, and in the fourth, there are too many arguments. In the
2174 fifth case, there is no function called @code{foo}. You will see a
2175 ``Wrong number of arguments'' message referring to @samp{log10(5,6)}.
2176 Press the @kbd{w} (``why'') key to see any other messages that may
2177 have arisen from the last calculation. In this case you will get
2178 ``logarithm of zero,'' then ``number expected: @code{x}''. Calc
2179 automatically displays the first message only if the message is
2180 sufficiently important; for example, Calc considers ``wrong number
2181 of arguments'' and ``logarithm of zero'' to be important enough to
2182 report automatically, while a message like ``number expected: @code{x}''
2183 will only show up if you explicitly press the @kbd{w} key.
2184
2185 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Joe entered the formula @samp{2 x y},
2186 stored 5 in @code{x}, pressed @kbd{=}, and got the expected result,
2187 @samp{10 y}. He then tried the same for the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)},
2188 expecting @samp{10 (1+y)}, but it didn't work. Why not?
2189 @xref{Algebraic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2190
2191 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} What result would you expect
2192 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} to give? What if you then type @kbd{0 *}?
2193 @xref{Algebraic Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2194
2195 One interesting way to work with variables is to use the
2196 @dfn{evaluates-to} (@samp{=>}) operator. It works like this:
2197 Enter a formula algebraically in the usual way, but follow
2198 the formula with an @samp{=>} symbol. (There is also an @kbd{s =}
2199 command which builds an @samp{=>} formula using the stack.) On
2200 the stack, you will see two copies of the formula with an @samp{=>}
2201 between them. The lefthand formula is exactly like you typed it;
2202 the righthand formula has been evaluated as if by typing @kbd{=}.
2203
2204 @smallexample
2205 @group
2206 2: 2 + 3 => 5 2: 2 + 3 => 5
2207 1: 2 a + 2 b => 34 + 2 b 1: 2 a + 2 b => 20 + 2 b
2208 . .
2209
2210 ' 2+3 => @key{RET} ' 2a+2b @key{RET} s = 10 s t a @key{RET}
2211 @end group
2212 @end smallexample
2213
2214 @noindent
2215 Notice that the instant we stored a new value in @code{a}, all
2216 @samp{=>} operators already on the stack that referred to @expr{a}
2217 were updated to use the new value. With @samp{=>}, you can push a
2218 set of formulas on the stack, then change the variables experimentally
2219 to see the effects on the formulas' values.
2220
2221 You can also ``unstore'' a variable when you are through with it:
2222
2223 @smallexample
2224 @group
2225 2: 2 + 5 => 5
2226 1: 2 a + 2 b => 2 a + 2 b
2227 .
2228
2229 s u a @key{RET}
2230 @end group
2231 @end smallexample
2232
2233 We will encounter formulas involving variables and functions again
2234 when we discuss the algebra and calculus features of the Calculator.
2235
2236 @node Undo Tutorial, Modes Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2237 @subsection Undo and Redo
2238
2239 @noindent
2240 If you make a mistake, you can usually correct it by pressing shift-@kbd{U},
2241 the ``undo'' command. First, clear the stack (@kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}) and exit
2242 and restart Calc (@kbd{M-# M-# M-# M-#}) to make sure things start off
2243 with a clean slate. Now:
2244
2245 @smallexample
2246 @group
2247 1: 2 2: 2 1: 8 2: 2 1: 6
2248 . 1: 3 . 1: 3 .
2249 . .
2250
2251 2 @key{RET} 3 ^ U *
2252 @end group
2253 @end smallexample
2254
2255 You can undo any number of times. Calc keeps a complete record of
2256 all you have done since you last opened the Calc window. After the
2257 above example, you could type:
2258
2259 @smallexample
2260 @group
2261 1: 6 2: 2 1: 2 . .
2262 . 1: 3 .
2263 .
2264 (error)
2265 U U U U
2266 @end group
2267 @end smallexample
2268
2269 You can also type @kbd{D} to ``redo'' a command that you have undone
2270 mistakenly.
2271
2272 @smallexample
2273 @group
2274 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 6 1: 6
2275 . 1: 3 . .
2276 .
2277 (error)
2278 D D D D
2279 @end group
2280 @end smallexample
2281
2282 @noindent
2283 It was not possible to redo past the @expr{6}, since that was placed there
2284 by something other than an undo command.
2285
2286 @cindex Time travel
2287 You can think of undo and redo as a sort of ``time machine.'' Press
2288 @kbd{U} to go backward in time, @kbd{D} to go forward. If you go
2289 backward and do something (like @kbd{*}) then, as any science fiction
2290 reader knows, you have changed your future and you cannot go forward
2291 again. Thus, the inability to redo past the @expr{6} even though there
2292 was an earlier undo command.
2293
2294 You can always recall an earlier result using the Trail. We've ignored
2295 the trail so far, but it has been faithfully recording everything we
2296 did since we loaded the Calculator. If the Trail is not displayed,
2297 press @kbd{t d} now to turn it on.
2298
2299 Let's try grabbing an earlier result. The @expr{8} we computed was
2300 undone by a @kbd{U} command, and was lost even to Redo when we pressed
2301 @kbd{*}, but it's still there in the trail. There should be a little
2302 @samp{>} arrow (the @dfn{trail pointer}) resting on the last trail
2303 entry. If there isn't, press @kbd{t ]} to reset the trail pointer.
2304 Now, press @w{@kbd{t p}} to move the arrow onto the line containing
2305 @expr{8}, and press @w{@kbd{t y}} to ``yank'' that number back onto the
2306 stack.
2307
2308 If you press @kbd{t ]} again, you will see that even our Yank command
2309 went into the trail.
2310
2311 Let's go further back in time. Earlier in the tutorial we computed
2312 a huge integer using the formula @samp{2^3^4}. We don't remember
2313 what it was, but the first digits were ``241''. Press @kbd{t r}
2314 (which stands for trail-search-reverse), then type @kbd{241}.
2315 The trail cursor will jump back to the next previous occurrence of
2316 the string ``241'' in the trail. This is just a regular Emacs
2317 incremental search; you can now press @kbd{C-s} or @kbd{C-r} to
2318 continue the search forwards or backwards as you like.
2319
2320 To finish the search, press @key{RET}. This halts the incremental
2321 search and leaves the trail pointer at the thing we found. Now we
2322 can type @kbd{t y} to yank that number onto the stack. If we hadn't
2323 remembered the ``241'', we could simply have searched for @kbd{2^3^4},
2324 then pressed @kbd{@key{RET} t n} to halt and then move to the next item.
2325
2326 You may have noticed that all the trail-related commands begin with
2327 the letter @kbd{t}. (The store-and-recall commands, on the other hand,
2328 all began with @kbd{s}.) Calc has so many commands that there aren't
2329 enough keys for all of them, so various commands are grouped into
2330 two-letter sequences where the first letter is called the @dfn{prefix}
2331 key. If you type a prefix key by accident, you can press @kbd{C-g}
2332 to cancel it. (In fact, you can press @kbd{C-g} to cancel almost
2333 anything in Emacs.) To get help on a prefix key, press that key
2334 followed by @kbd{?}. Some prefixes have several lines of help,
2335 so you need to press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see them all.
2336 You can also type @kbd{h h} to see all the help at once.
2337
2338 Try pressing @kbd{t ?} now. You will see a line of the form,
2339
2340 @smallexample
2341 trail/time: Display; Fwd, Back; Next, Prev, Here, [, ]; Yank: [MORE] t-
2342 @end smallexample
2343
2344 @noindent
2345 The word ``trail'' indicates that the @kbd{t} prefix key contains
2346 trail-related commands. Each entry on the line shows one command,
2347 with a single capital letter showing which letter you press to get
2348 that command. We have used @kbd{t n}, @kbd{t p}, @kbd{t ]}, and
2349 @kbd{t y} so far. The @samp{[MORE]} means you can press @kbd{?}
2350 again to see more @kbd{t}-prefix commands. Notice that the commands
2351 are roughly divided (by semicolons) into related groups.
2352
2353 When you are in the help display for a prefix key, the prefix is
2354 still active. If you press another key, like @kbd{y} for example,
2355 it will be interpreted as a @kbd{t y} command. If all you wanted
2356 was to look at the help messages, press @kbd{C-g} afterwards to cancel
2357 the prefix.
2358
2359 One more way to correct an error is by editing the stack entries.
2360 The actual Stack buffer is marked read-only and must not be edited
2361 directly, but you can press @kbd{`} (the backquote or accent grave)
2362 to edit a stack entry.
2363
2364 Try entering @samp{3.141439} now. If this is supposed to represent
2365 @cpi{}, it's got several errors. Press @kbd{`} to edit this number.
2366 Now use the normal Emacs cursor motion and editing keys to change
2367 the second 4 to a 5, and to transpose the 3 and the 9. When you
2368 press @key{RET}, the number on the stack will be replaced by your
2369 new number. This works for formulas, vectors, and all other types
2370 of values you can put on the stack. The @kbd{`} key also works
2371 during entry of a number or algebraic formula.
2372
2373 @node Modes Tutorial, , Undo Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2374 @subsection Mode-Setting Commands
2375
2376 @noindent
2377 Calc has many types of @dfn{modes} that affect the way it interprets
2378 your commands or the way it displays data. We have already seen one
2379 mode, namely Algebraic mode. There are many others, too; we'll
2380 try some of the most common ones here.
2381
2382 Perhaps the most fundamental mode in Calc is the current @dfn{precision}.
2383 Notice the @samp{12} on the Calc window's mode line:
2384
2385 @smallexample
2386 --%%-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All------
2387 @end smallexample
2388
2389 @noindent
2390 Most of the symbols there are Emacs things you don't need to worry
2391 about, but the @samp{12} and the @samp{Deg} are mode indicators.
2392 The @samp{12} means that calculations should always be carried to
2393 12 significant figures. That is why, when we type @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /},
2394 we get @expr{0.142857142857} with exactly 12 digits, not counting
2395 leading and trailing zeros.
2396
2397 You can set the precision to anything you like by pressing @kbd{p},
2398 then entering a suitable number. Try pressing @kbd{p 30 @key{RET}},
2399 then doing @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /} again:
2400
2401 @smallexample
2402 @group
2403 1: 0.142857142857
2404 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2405 .
2406 @end group
2407 @end smallexample
2408
2409 Although the precision can be set arbitrarily high, Calc always
2410 has to have @emph{some} value for the current precision. After
2411 all, the true value @expr{1/7} is an infinitely repeating decimal;
2412 Calc has to stop somewhere.
2413
2414 Of course, calculations are slower the more digits you request.
2415 Press @w{@kbd{p 12}} now to set the precision back down to the default.
2416
2417 Calculations always use the current precision. For example, even
2418 though we have a 30-digit value for @expr{1/7} on the stack, if
2419 we use it in a calculation in 12-digit mode it will be rounded
2420 down to 12 digits before it is used. Try it; press @key{RET} to
2421 duplicate the number, then @w{@kbd{1 +}}. Notice that the @key{RET}
2422 key didn't round the number, because it doesn't do any calculation.
2423 But the instant we pressed @kbd{+}, the number was rounded down.
2424
2425 @smallexample
2426 @group
2427 1: 0.142857142857
2428 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2429 3: 1.14285714286
2430 .
2431 @end group
2432 @end smallexample
2433
2434 @noindent
2435 In fact, since we added a digit on the left, we had to lose one
2436 digit on the right from even the 12-digit value of @expr{1/7}.
2437
2438 How did we get more than 12 digits when we computed @samp{2^3^4}? The
2439 answer is that Calc makes a distinction between @dfn{integers} and
2440 @dfn{floating-point} numbers, or @dfn{floats}. An integer is a number
2441 that does not contain a decimal point. There is no such thing as an
2442 ``infinitely repeating fraction integer,'' so Calc doesn't have to limit
2443 itself. If you asked for @samp{2^10000} (don't try this!), you would
2444 have to wait a long time but you would eventually get an exact answer.
2445 If you ask for @samp{2.^10000}, you will quickly get an answer which is
2446 correct only to 12 places. The decimal point tells Calc that it should
2447 use floating-point arithmetic to get the answer, not exact integer
2448 arithmetic.
2449
2450 You can use the @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) command to convert a
2451 floating-point value to an integer, and @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float})
2452 to convert an integer to floating-point form.
2453
2454 Let's try entering that last calculation:
2455
2456 @smallexample
2457 @group
2458 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311689e3010
2459 . 1: 10000 .
2460 .
2461
2462 2.0 @key{RET} 10000 @key{RET} ^
2463 @end group
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 @cindex Scientific notation, entry of
2468 Notice the letter @samp{e} in there. It represents ``times ten to the
2469 power of,'' and is used by Calc automatically whenever writing the
2470 number out fully would introduce more extra zeros than you probably
2471 want to see. You can enter numbers in this notation, too.
2472
2473 @smallexample
2474 @group
2475 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311678e3010
2476 . 1: 10000. .
2477 .
2478
2479 2.0 @key{RET} 1e4 @key{RET} ^
2480 @end group
2481 @end smallexample
2482
2483 @cindex Round-off errors
2484 @noindent
2485 Hey, the answer is different! Look closely at the middle columns
2486 of the two examples. In the first, the stack contained the
2487 exact integer @expr{10000}, but in the second it contained
2488 a floating-point value with a decimal point. When you raise a
2489 number to an integer power, Calc uses repeated squaring and
2490 multiplication to get the answer. When you use a floating-point
2491 power, Calc uses logarithms and exponentials. As you can see,
2492 a slight error crept in during one of these methods. Which
2493 one should we trust? Let's raise the precision a bit and find
2494 out:
2495
2496 @smallexample
2497 @group
2498 . 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.995063116880828e3010
2499 . 1: 10000. .
2500 .
2501
2502 p 16 @key{RET} 2. @key{RET} 1e4 ^ p 12 @key{RET}
2503 @end group
2504 @end smallexample
2505
2506 @noindent
2507 @cindex Guard digits
2508 Presumably, it doesn't matter whether we do this higher-precision
2509 calculation using an integer or floating-point power, since we
2510 have added enough ``guard digits'' to trust the first 12 digits
2511 no matter what. And the verdict is@dots{} Integer powers were more
2512 accurate; in fact, the result was only off by one unit in the
2513 last place.
2514
2515 @cindex Guard digits
2516 Calc does many of its internal calculations to a slightly higher
2517 precision, but it doesn't always bump the precision up enough.
2518 In each case, Calc added about two digits of precision during
2519 its calculation and then rounded back down to 12 digits
2520 afterward. In one case, it was enough; in the other, it
2521 wasn't. If you really need @var{x} digits of precision, it
2522 never hurts to do the calculation with a few extra guard digits.
2523
2524 What if we want guard digits but don't want to look at them?
2525 We can set the @dfn{float format}. Calc supports four major
2526 formats for floating-point numbers, called @dfn{normal},
2527 @dfn{fixed-point}, @dfn{scientific notation}, and @dfn{engineering
2528 notation}. You get them by pressing @w{@kbd{d n}}, @kbd{d f},
2529 @kbd{d s}, and @kbd{d e}, respectively. In each case, you can
2530 supply a numeric prefix argument which says how many digits
2531 should be displayed. As an example, let's put a few numbers
2532 onto the stack and try some different display modes. First,
2533 use @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}} to clear the stack, then enter the four
2534 numbers shown here:
2535
2536 @smallexample
2537 @group
2538 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2539 3: 12345. 3: 12300. 3: 1.2345e4 3: 1.23e4 3: 12345.000
2540 2: 123.45 2: 123. 2: 1.2345e2 2: 1.23e2 2: 123.450
2541 1: 12.345 1: 12.3 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.23e1 1: 12.345
2542 . . . . .
2543
2544 d n M-3 d n d s M-3 d s M-3 d f
2545 @end group
2546 @end smallexample
2547
2548 @noindent
2549 Notice that when we typed @kbd{M-3 d n}, the numbers were rounded down
2550 to three significant digits, but then when we typed @kbd{d s} all
2551 five significant figures reappeared. The float format does not
2552 affect how numbers are stored, it only affects how they are
2553 displayed. Only the current precision governs the actual rounding
2554 of numbers in the Calculator's memory.
2555
2556 Engineering notation, not shown here, is like scientific notation
2557 except the exponent (the power-of-ten part) is always adjusted to be
2558 a multiple of three (as in ``kilo,'' ``micro,'' etc.). As a result
2559 there will be one, two, or three digits before the decimal point.
2560
2561 Whenever you change a display-related mode, Calc redraws everything
2562 in the stack. This may be slow if there are many things on the stack,
2563 so Calc allows you to type shift-@kbd{H} before any mode command to
2564 prevent it from updating the stack. Anything Calc displays after the
2565 mode-changing command will appear in the new format.
2566
2567 @smallexample
2568 @group
2569 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2570 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 1.2345e4 3: 12345.
2571 2: 123.450 2: 123.450 2: 1.2345e1 2: 1.2345e1 2: 123.45
2572 1: 12.345 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.2345e2 1: 1.2345e2 1: 12.345
2573 . . . . .
2574
2575 H d s @key{DEL} U @key{TAB} d @key{SPC} d n
2576 @end group
2577 @end smallexample
2578
2579 @noindent
2580 Here the @kbd{H d s} command changes to scientific notation but without
2581 updating the screen. Deleting the top stack entry and undoing it back
2582 causes it to show up in the new format; swapping the top two stack
2583 entries reformats both entries. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command refreshes the
2584 whole stack. The @kbd{d n} command changes back to the normal float
2585 format; since it doesn't have an @kbd{H} prefix, it also updates all
2586 the stack entries to be in @kbd{d n} format.
2587
2588 Notice that the integer @expr{12345} was not affected by any
2589 of the float formats. Integers are integers, and are always
2590 displayed exactly.
2591
2592 @cindex Large numbers, readability
2593 Large integers have their own problems. Let's look back at
2594 the result of @kbd{2^3^4}.
2595
2596 @example
2597 2417851639229258349412352
2598 @end example
2599
2600 @noindent
2601 Quick---how many digits does this have? Try typing @kbd{d g}:
2602
2603 @example
2604 2,417,851,639,229,258,349,412,352
2605 @end example
2606
2607 @noindent
2608 Now how many digits does this have? It's much easier to tell!
2609 We can actually group digits into clumps of any size. Some
2610 people prefer @kbd{M-5 d g}:
2611
2612 @example
2613 24178,51639,22925,83494,12352
2614 @end example
2615
2616 Let's see what happens to floating-point numbers when they are grouped.
2617 First, type @kbd{p 25 @key{RET}} to make sure we have enough precision
2618 to get ourselves into trouble. Now, type @kbd{1e13 /}:
2619
2620 @example
2621 24,17851,63922.9258349412352
2622 @end example
2623
2624 @noindent
2625 The integer part is grouped but the fractional part isn't. Now try
2626 @kbd{M-- M-5 d g} (that's meta-minus-sign, meta-five):
2627
2628 @example
2629 24,17851,63922.92583,49412,352
2630 @end example
2631
2632 If you find it hard to tell the decimal point from the commas, try
2633 changing the grouping character to a space with @kbd{d , @key{SPC}}:
2634
2635 @example
2636 24 17851 63922.92583 49412 352
2637 @end example
2638
2639 Type @kbd{d , ,} to restore the normal grouping character, then
2640 @kbd{d g} again to turn grouping off. Also, press @kbd{p 12} to
2641 restore the default precision.
2642
2643 Press @kbd{U} enough times to get the original big integer back.
2644 (Notice that @kbd{U} does not undo each mode-setting command; if
2645 you want to undo a mode-setting command, you have to do it yourself.)
2646 Now, type @kbd{d r 16 @key{RET}}:
2647
2648 @example
2649 16#200000000000000000000
2650 @end example
2651
2652 @noindent
2653 The number is now displayed in @dfn{hexadecimal}, or ``base-16'' form.
2654 Suddenly it looks pretty simple; this should be no surprise, since we
2655 got this number by computing a power of two, and 16 is a power of 2.
2656 In fact, we can use @w{@kbd{d r 2 @key{RET}}} to see it in actual binary
2657 form:
2658
2659 @example
2660 2#1000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 @dots{}
2661 @end example
2662
2663 @noindent
2664 We don't have enough space here to show all the zeros! They won't
2665 fit on a typical screen, either, so you will have to use horizontal
2666 scrolling to see them all. Press @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} to scroll the
2667 stack window left and right by half its width. Another way to view
2668 something large is to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the top of
2669 stack in a separate window. (Press @kbd{C-c C-c} when you are done.)
2670
2671 You can enter non-decimal numbers using the @kbd{#} symbol, too.
2672 Let's see what the hexadecimal number @samp{5FE} looks like in
2673 binary. Type @kbd{16#5FE} (the letters can be typed in upper or
2674 lower case; they will always appear in upper case). It will also
2675 help to turn grouping on with @kbd{d g}:
2676
2677 @example
2678 2#101,1111,1110
2679 @end example
2680
2681 Notice that @kbd{d g} groups by fours by default if the display radix
2682 is binary or hexadecimal, but by threes if it is decimal, octal, or any
2683 other radix.
2684
2685 Now let's see that number in decimal; type @kbd{d r 10}:
2686
2687 @example
2688 1,534
2689 @end example
2690
2691 Numbers are not @emph{stored} with any particular radix attached. They're
2692 just numbers; they can be entered in any radix, and are always displayed
2693 in whatever radix you've chosen with @kbd{d r}. The current radix applies
2694 to integers, fractions, and floats.
2695
2696 @cindex Roundoff errors, in non-decimal numbers
2697 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Your friend Joe tried to enter one-third
2698 as @samp{3#0.1} in @kbd{d r 3} mode with a precision of 12. He got
2699 @samp{3#0.0222222...} (with 25 2's) in the display. When he multiplied
2700 that by three, he got @samp{3#0.222222...} instead of the expected
2701 @samp{3#1}. Next, Joe entered @samp{3#0.2} and, to his great relief,
2702 saw @samp{3#0.2} on the screen. But when he typed @kbd{2 /}, he got
2703 @samp{3#0.10000001} (some zeros omitted). What's going on here?
2704 @xref{Modes Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2705
2706 @cindex Scientific notation, in non-decimal numbers
2707 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Scientific notation works in non-decimal
2708 modes in the natural way (the exponent is a power of the radix instead of
2709 a power of ten, although the exponent itself is always written in decimal).
2710 Thus @samp{8#1.23e3 = 8#1230.0}. Suppose we have the hexadecimal number
2711 @samp{f.e8f} times 16 to the 15th power: We write @samp{16#f.e8fe15}.
2712 What is wrong with this picture? What could we write instead that would
2713 work better? @xref{Modes Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2714
2715 The @kbd{m} prefix key has another set of modes, relating to the way
2716 Calc interprets your inputs and does computations. Whereas @kbd{d}-prefix
2717 modes generally affect the way things look, @kbd{m}-prefix modes affect
2718 the way they are actually computed.
2719
2720 The most popular @kbd{m}-prefix mode is the @dfn{angular mode}. Notice
2721 the @samp{Deg} indicator in the mode line. This means that if you use
2722 a command that interprets a number as an angle, it will assume the
2723 angle is measured in degrees. For example,
2724
2725 @smallexample
2726 @group
2727 1: 45 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001 1: 0.5
2728 . . . .
2729
2730 45 S 2 ^ c 1
2731 @end group
2732 @end smallexample
2733
2734 @noindent
2735 The shift-@kbd{S} command computes the sine of an angle. The sine
2736 of 45 degrees is
2737 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2};
2738 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2};
2739 squaring this yields @expr{2/4 = 0.5}. However, there has been a slight
2740 roundoff error because the representation of
2741 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2}
2742 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2}
2743 wasn't exact. The @kbd{c 1} command is a handy way to clean up numbers
2744 in this case; it temporarily reduces the precision by one digit while it
2745 re-rounds the number on the top of the stack.
2746
2747 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2748 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe computed the sine
2749 of 45 degrees as shown above, then, hoping to avoid an inexact
2750 result, he increased the precision to 16 digits before squaring.
2751 What happened? @xref{Modes Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2752
2753 To do this calculation in radians, we would type @kbd{m r} first.
2754 (The indicator changes to @samp{Rad}.) 45 degrees corresponds to
2755 @cpiover{4} radians. To get @cpi{}, press the @kbd{P} key. (Once
2756 again, this is a shifted capital @kbd{P}. Remember, unshifted
2757 @kbd{p} sets the precision.)
2758
2759 @smallexample
2760 @group
2761 1: 3.14159265359 1: 0.785398163398 1: 0.707106781187
2762 . . .
2763
2764 P 4 / m r S
2765 @end group
2766 @end smallexample
2767
2768 Likewise, inverse trigonometric functions generate results in
2769 either radians or degrees, depending on the current angular mode.
2770
2771 @smallexample
2772 @group
2773 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.785398163398 1: 45.
2774 . . .
2775
2776 .5 Q m r I S m d U I S
2777 @end group
2778 @end smallexample
2779
2780 @noindent
2781 Here we compute the Inverse Sine of
2782 @texline @math{\sqrt{0.5}},
2783 @infoline @expr{sqrt(0.5)},
2784 first in radians, then in degrees.
2785
2786 Use @kbd{c d} and @kbd{c r} to convert a number from radians to degrees
2787 and vice-versa.
2788
2789 @smallexample
2790 @group
2791 1: 45 1: 0.785398163397 1: 45.
2792 . . .
2793
2794 45 c r c d
2795 @end group
2796 @end smallexample
2797
2798 Another interesting mode is @dfn{Fraction mode}. Normally,
2799 dividing two integers produces a floating-point result if the
2800 quotient can't be expressed as an exact integer. Fraction mode
2801 causes integer division to produce a fraction, i.e., a rational
2802 number, instead.
2803
2804 @smallexample
2805 @group
2806 2: 12 1: 1.33333333333 1: 4:3
2807 1: 9 . .
2808 .
2809
2810 12 @key{RET} 9 / m f U / m f
2811 @end group
2812 @end smallexample
2813
2814 @noindent
2815 In the first case, we get an approximate floating-point result.
2816 In the second case, we get an exact fractional result (four-thirds).
2817
2818 You can enter a fraction at any time using @kbd{:} notation.
2819 (Calc uses @kbd{:} instead of @kbd{/} as the fraction separator
2820 because @kbd{/} is already used to divide the top two stack
2821 elements.) Calculations involving fractions will always
2822 produce exact fractional results; Fraction mode only says
2823 what to do when dividing two integers.
2824
2825 @cindex Fractions vs. floats
2826 @cindex Floats vs. fractions
2827 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} If fractional arithmetic is exact,
2828 why would you ever use floating-point numbers instead?
2829 @xref{Modes Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
2830
2831 Typing @kbd{m f} doesn't change any existing values in the stack.
2832 In the above example, we had to Undo the division and do it over
2833 again when we changed to Fraction mode. But if you use the
2834 evaluates-to operator you can get commands like @kbd{m f} to
2835 recompute for you.
2836
2837 @smallexample
2838 @group
2839 1: 12 / 9 => 1.33333333333 1: 12 / 9 => 1.333 1: 12 / 9 => 4:3
2840 . . .
2841
2842 ' 12/9 => @key{RET} p 4 @key{RET} m f
2843 @end group
2844 @end smallexample
2845
2846 @noindent
2847 In this example, the righthand side of the @samp{=>} operator
2848 on the stack is recomputed when we change the precision, then
2849 again when we change to Fraction mode. All @samp{=>} expressions
2850 on the stack are recomputed every time you change any mode that
2851 might affect their values.
2852
2853 @node Arithmetic Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Tutorial
2854 @section Arithmetic Tutorial
2855
2856 @noindent
2857 In this section, we explore the arithmetic and scientific functions
2858 available in the Calculator.
2859
2860 The standard arithmetic commands are @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/},
2861 and @kbd{^}. Each normally takes two numbers from the top of the stack
2862 and pushes back a result. The @kbd{n} and @kbd{&} keys perform
2863 change-sign and reciprocal operations, respectively.
2864
2865 @smallexample
2866 @group
2867 1: 5 1: 0.2 1: 5. 1: -5. 1: 5.
2868 . . . . .
2869
2870 5 & & n n
2871 @end group
2872 @end smallexample
2873
2874 @cindex Binary operators
2875 You can apply a ``binary operator'' like @kbd{+} across any number of
2876 stack entries by giving it a numeric prefix. You can also apply it
2877 pairwise to several stack elements along with the top one if you use
2878 a negative prefix.
2879
2880 @smallexample
2881 @group
2882 3: 2 1: 9 3: 2 4: 2 3: 12
2883 2: 3 . 2: 3 3: 3 2: 13
2884 1: 4 1: 4 2: 4 1: 14
2885 . . 1: 10 .
2886 .
2887
2888 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 + U 10 M-- M-3 +
2889 @end group
2890 @end smallexample
2891
2892 @cindex Unary operators
2893 You can apply a ``unary operator'' like @kbd{&} to the top @var{n}
2894 stack entries with a numeric prefix, too.
2895
2896 @smallexample
2897 @group
2898 3: 2 3: 0.5 3: 0.5
2899 2: 3 2: 0.333333333333 2: 3.
2900 1: 4 1: 0.25 1: 4.
2901 . . .
2902
2903 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 & M-2 &
2904 @end group
2905 @end smallexample
2906
2907 Notice that the results here are left in floating-point form.
2908 We can convert them back to integers by pressing @kbd{F}, the
2909 ``floor'' function. This function rounds down to the next lower
2910 integer. There is also @kbd{R}, which rounds to the nearest
2911 integer.
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 @group
2915 7: 2. 7: 2 7: 2
2916 6: 2.4 6: 2 6: 2
2917 5: 2.5 5: 2 5: 3
2918 4: 2.6 4: 2 4: 3
2919 3: -2. 3: -2 3: -2
2920 2: -2.4 2: -3 2: -2
2921 1: -2.6 1: -3 1: -3
2922 . . .
2923
2924 M-7 F U M-7 R
2925 @end group
2926 @end smallexample
2927
2928 Since dividing-and-flooring (i.e., ``integer quotient'') is such a
2929 common operation, Calc provides a special command for that purpose, the
2930 backslash @kbd{\}. Another common arithmetic operator is @kbd{%}, which
2931 computes the remainder that would arise from a @kbd{\} operation, i.e.,
2932 the ``modulo'' of two numbers. For example,
2933
2934 @smallexample
2935 @group
2936 2: 1234 1: 12 2: 1234 1: 34
2937 1: 100 . 1: 100 .
2938 . .
2939
2940 1234 @key{RET} 100 \ U %
2941 @end group
2942 @end smallexample
2943
2944 These commands actually work for any real numbers, not just integers.
2945
2946 @smallexample
2947 @group
2948 2: 3.1415 1: 3 2: 3.1415 1: 0.1415
2949 1: 1 . 1: 1 .
2950 . .
2951
2952 3.1415 @key{RET} 1 \ U %
2953 @end group
2954 @end smallexample
2955
2956 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The @kbd{\} command would appear to be a
2957 frill, since you could always do the same thing with @kbd{/ F}. Think
2958 of a situation where this is not true---@kbd{/ F} would be inadequate.
2959 Now think of a way you could get around the problem if Calc didn't
2960 provide a @kbd{\} command. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2961
2962 We've already seen the @kbd{Q} (square root) and @kbd{S} (sine)
2963 commands. Other commands along those lines are @kbd{C} (cosine),
2964 @kbd{T} (tangent), @kbd{E} (@expr{e^x}) and @kbd{L} (natural
2965 logarithm). These can be modified by the @kbd{I} (inverse) and
2966 @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix keys.
2967
2968 Let's compute the sine and cosine of an angle, and verify the
2969 identity
2970 @texline @math{\sin^2x + \cos^2x = 1}.
2971 @infoline @expr{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}.
2972 We'll arbitrarily pick @mathit{-64} degrees as a good value for @expr{x}.
2973 With the angular mode set to degrees (type @w{@kbd{m d}}), do:
2974
2975 @smallexample
2976 @group
2977 2: -64 2: -64 2: -0.89879 2: -0.89879 1: 1.
2978 1: -64 1: -0.89879 1: -64 1: 0.43837 .
2979 . . . .
2980
2981 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} S @key{TAB} C f h
2982 @end group
2983 @end smallexample
2984
2985 @noindent
2986 (For brevity, we're showing only five digits of the results here.
2987 You can of course do these calculations to any precision you like.)
2988
2989 Remember, @kbd{f h} is the @code{calc-hypot}, or square-root of sum
2990 of squares, command.
2991
2992 Another identity is
2993 @texline @math{\displaystyle\tan x = {\sin x \over \cos x}}.
2994 @infoline @expr{tan(x) = sin(x) / cos(x)}.
2995 @smallexample
2996 @group
2997
2998 2: -0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2999 1: 0.43837 . .
3000 .
3001
3002 U / I T
3003 @end group
3004 @end smallexample
3005
3006 A physical interpretation of this calculation is that if you move
3007 @expr{0.89879} units downward and @expr{0.43837} units to the right,
3008 your direction of motion is @mathit{-64} degrees from horizontal. Suppose
3009 we move in the opposite direction, up and to the left:
3010
3011 @smallexample
3012 @group
3013 2: -0.89879 2: 0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
3014 1: 0.43837 1: -0.43837 . .
3015 . .
3016
3017 U U M-2 n / I T
3018 @end group
3019 @end smallexample
3020
3021 @noindent
3022 How can the angle be the same? The answer is that the @kbd{/} operation
3023 loses information about the signs of its inputs. Because the quotient
3024 is negative, we know exactly one of the inputs was negative, but we
3025 can't tell which one. There is an @kbd{f T} [@code{arctan2}] function which
3026 computes the inverse tangent of the quotient of a pair of numbers.
3027 Since you feed it the two original numbers, it has enough information
3028 to give you a full 360-degree answer.
3029
3030 @smallexample
3031 @group
3032 2: 0.89879 1: 116. 3: 116. 2: 116. 1: 180.
3033 1: -0.43837 . 2: -0.89879 1: -64. .
3034 . 1: 0.43837 .
3035 .
3036
3037 U U f T M-@key{RET} M-2 n f T -
3038 @end group
3039 @end smallexample
3040
3041 @noindent
3042 The resulting angles differ by 180 degrees; in other words, they
3043 point in opposite directions, just as we would expect.
3044
3045 The @key{META}-@key{RET} we used in the third step is the
3046 ``last-arguments'' command. It is sort of like Undo, except that it
3047 restores the arguments of the last command to the stack without removing
3048 the command's result. It is useful in situations like this one,
3049 where we need to do several operations on the same inputs. We could
3050 have accomplished the same thing by using @kbd{M-2 @key{RET}} to duplicate
3051 the top two stack elements right after the @kbd{U U}, then a pair of
3052 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} commands to cycle the 116 up around the duplicates.
3053
3054 A similar identity is supposed to hold for hyperbolic sines and cosines,
3055 except that it is the @emph{difference}
3056 @texline @math{\cosh^2x - \sinh^2x}
3057 @infoline @expr{cosh(x)^2 - sinh(x)^2}
3058 that always equals one. Let's try to verify this identity.
3059
3060 @smallexample
3061 @group
3062 2: -64 2: -64 2: -64 2: 9.7192e54 2: 9.7192e54
3063 1: -64 1: -3.1175e27 1: 9.7192e54 1: -64 1: 9.7192e54
3064 . . . . .
3065
3066 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} H C 2 ^ @key{TAB} H S 2 ^
3067 @end group
3068 @end smallexample
3069
3070 @noindent
3071 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
3072 Something's obviously wrong, because when we subtract these numbers
3073 the answer will clearly be zero! But if you think about it, if these
3074 numbers @emph{did} differ by one, it would be in the 55th decimal
3075 place. The difference we seek has been lost entirely to roundoff
3076 error.
3077
3078 We could verify this hypothesis by doing the actual calculation with,
3079 say, 60 decimal places of precision. This will be slow, but not
3080 enormously so. Try it if you wish; sure enough, the answer is
3081 0.99999, reasonably close to 1.
3082
3083 Of course, a more reasonable way to verify the identity is to use
3084 a more reasonable value for @expr{x}!
3085
3086 @cindex Common logarithm
3087 Some Calculator commands use the Hyperbolic prefix for other purposes.
3088 The logarithm and exponential functions, for example, work to the base
3089 @expr{e} normally but use base-10 instead if you use the Hyperbolic
3090 prefix.
3091
3092 @smallexample
3093 @group
3094 1: 1000 1: 6.9077 1: 1000 1: 3
3095 . . . .
3096
3097 1000 L U H L
3098 @end group
3099 @end smallexample
3100
3101 @noindent
3102 First, we mistakenly compute a natural logarithm. Then we undo
3103 and compute a common logarithm instead.
3104
3105 The @kbd{B} key computes a general base-@var{b} logarithm for any
3106 value of @var{b}.
3107
3108 @smallexample
3109 @group
3110 2: 1000 1: 3 1: 1000. 2: 1000. 1: 6.9077
3111 1: 10 . . 1: 2.71828 .
3112 . .
3113
3114 1000 @key{RET} 10 B H E H P B
3115 @end group
3116 @end smallexample
3117
3118 @noindent
3119 Here we first use @kbd{B} to compute the base-10 logarithm, then use
3120 the ``hyperbolic'' exponential as a cheap hack to recover the number
3121 1000, then use @kbd{B} again to compute the natural logarithm. Note
3122 that @kbd{P} with the hyperbolic prefix pushes the constant @expr{e}
3123 onto the stack.
3124
3125 You may have noticed that both times we took the base-10 logarithm
3126 of 1000, we got an exact integer result. Calc always tries to give
3127 an exact rational result for calculations involving rational numbers
3128 where possible. But when we used @kbd{H E}, the result was a
3129 floating-point number for no apparent reason. In fact, if we had
3130 computed @kbd{10 @key{RET} 3 ^} we @emph{would} have gotten an
3131 exact integer 1000. But the @kbd{H E} command is rigged to generate
3132 a floating-point result all of the time so that @kbd{1000 H E} will
3133 not waste time computing a thousand-digit integer when all you
3134 probably wanted was @samp{1e1000}.
3135
3136 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Find a pair of integer inputs to
3137 the @kbd{B} command for which Calc could find an exact rational
3138 result but doesn't. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3139
3140 The Calculator also has a set of functions relating to combinatorics
3141 and statistics. You may be familiar with the @dfn{factorial} function,
3142 which computes the product of all the integers up to a given number.
3143
3144 @smallexample
3145 @group
3146 1: 100 1: 93326215443... 1: 100. 1: 9.3326e157
3147 . . . .
3148
3149 100 ! U c f !
3150 @end group
3151 @end smallexample
3152
3153 @noindent
3154 Recall, the @kbd{c f} command converts the integer or fraction at the
3155 top of the stack to floating-point format. If you take the factorial
3156 of a floating-point number, you get a floating-point result
3157 accurate to the current precision. But if you give @kbd{!} an
3158 exact integer, you get an exact integer result (158 digits long
3159 in this case).
3160
3161 If you take the factorial of a non-integer, Calc uses a generalized
3162 factorial function defined in terms of Euler's Gamma function
3163 @texline @math{\Gamma(n)}
3164 @infoline @expr{gamma(n)}
3165 (which is itself available as the @kbd{f g} command).
3166
3167 @smallexample
3168 @group
3169 3: 4. 3: 24. 1: 5.5 1: 52.342777847
3170 2: 4.5 2: 52.3427777847 . .
3171 1: 5. 1: 120.
3172 . .
3173
3174 M-3 ! M-0 @key{DEL} 5.5 f g
3175 @end group
3176 @end smallexample
3177
3178 @noindent
3179 Here we verify the identity
3180 @texline @math{n! = \Gamma(n+1)}.
3181 @infoline @expr{@var{n}!@: = gamma(@var{n}+1)}.
3182
3183 The binomial coefficient @var{n}-choose-@var{m}
3184 @texline or @math{\displaystyle {n \choose m}}
3185 is defined by
3186 @texline @math{\displaystyle {n! \over m! \, (n-m)!}}
3187 @infoline @expr{n!@: / m!@: (n-m)!}
3188 for all reals @expr{n} and @expr{m}. The intermediate results in this
3189 formula can become quite large even if the final result is small; the
3190 @kbd{k c} command computes a binomial coefficient in a way that avoids
3191 large intermediate values.
3192
3193 The @kbd{k} prefix key defines several common functions out of
3194 combinatorics and number theory. Here we compute the binomial
3195 coefficient 30-choose-20, then determine its prime factorization.
3196
3197 @smallexample
3198 @group
3199 2: 30 1: 30045015 1: [3, 3, 5, 7, 11, 13, 23, 29]
3200 1: 20 . .
3201 .
3202
3203 30 @key{RET} 20 k c k f
3204 @end group
3205 @end smallexample
3206
3207 @noindent
3208 You can verify these prime factors by using @kbd{v u} to ``unpack''
3209 this vector into 8 separate stack entries, then @kbd{M-8 *} to
3210 multiply them back together. The result is the original number,
3211 30045015.
3212
3213 @cindex Hash tables
3214 Suppose a program you are writing needs a hash table with at least
3215 10000 entries. It's best to use a prime number as the actual size
3216 of a hash table. Calc can compute the next prime number after 10000:
3217
3218 @smallexample
3219 @group
3220 1: 10000 1: 10007 1: 9973
3221 . . .
3222
3223 10000 k n I k n
3224 @end group
3225 @end smallexample
3226
3227 @noindent
3228 Just for kicks we've also computed the next prime @emph{less} than
3229 10000.
3230
3231 @c [fix-ref Financial Functions]
3232 @xref{Financial Functions}, for a description of the Calculator
3233 commands that deal with business and financial calculations (functions
3234 like @code{pv}, @code{rate}, and @code{sln}).
3235
3236 @c [fix-ref Binary Number Functions]
3237 @xref{Binary Functions}, to read about the commands for operating
3238 on binary numbers (like @code{and}, @code{xor}, and @code{lsh}).
3239
3240 @node Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial
3241 @section Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3242
3243 @noindent
3244 A @dfn{vector} is a list of numbers or other Calc data objects.
3245 Calc provides a large set of commands that operate on vectors. Some
3246 are familiar operations from vector analysis. Others simply treat
3247 a vector as a list of objects.
3248
3249 @menu
3250 * Vector Analysis Tutorial::
3251 * Matrix Tutorial::
3252 * List Tutorial::
3253 @end menu
3254
3255 @node Vector Analysis Tutorial, Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3256 @subsection Vector Analysis
3257
3258 @noindent
3259 If you add two vectors, the result is a vector of the sums of the
3260 elements, taken pairwise.
3261
3262 @smallexample
3263 @group
3264 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [8, 8, 3]
3265 . 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3266 .
3267
3268 [1,2,3] s 1 [7 6 0] s 2 +
3269 @end group
3270 @end smallexample
3271
3272 @noindent
3273 Note that we can separate the vector elements with either commas or
3274 spaces. This is true whether we are using incomplete vectors or
3275 algebraic entry. The @kbd{s 1} and @kbd{s 2} commands save these
3276 vectors so we can easily reuse them later.
3277
3278 If you multiply two vectors, the result is the sum of the products
3279 of the elements taken pairwise. This is called the @dfn{dot product}
3280 of the vectors.
3281
3282 @smallexample
3283 @group
3284 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 19
3285 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3286 .
3287
3288 r 1 r 2 *
3289 @end group
3290 @end smallexample
3291
3292 @cindex Dot product
3293 The dot product of two vectors is equal to the product of their
3294 lengths times the cosine of the angle between them. (Here the vector
3295 is interpreted as a line from the origin @expr{(0,0,0)} to the
3296 specified point in three-dimensional space.) The @kbd{A}
3297 (absolute value) command can be used to compute the length of a
3298 vector.
3299
3300 @smallexample
3301 @group
3302 3: 19 3: 19 1: 0.550782 1: 56.579
3303 2: [1, 2, 3] 2: 3.741657 . .
3304 1: [7, 6, 0] 1: 9.219544
3305 . .
3306
3307 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / I C
3308 @end group
3309 @end smallexample
3310
3311 @noindent
3312 First we recall the arguments to the dot product command, then
3313 we compute the absolute values of the top two stack entries to
3314 obtain the lengths of the vectors, then we divide the dot product
3315 by the product of the lengths to get the cosine of the angle.
3316 The inverse cosine finds that the angle between the vectors
3317 is about 56 degrees.
3318
3319 @cindex Cross product
3320 @cindex Perpendicular vectors
3321 The @dfn{cross product} of two vectors is a vector whose length
3322 is the product of the lengths of the inputs times the sine of the
3323 angle between them, and whose direction is perpendicular to both
3324 input vectors. Unlike the dot product, the cross product is
3325 defined only for three-dimensional vectors. Let's double-check
3326 our computation of the angle using the cross product.
3327
3328 @smallexample
3329 @group
3330 2: [1, 2, 3] 3: [-18, 21, -8] 1: [-0.52, 0.61, -0.23] 1: 56.579
3331 1: [7, 6, 0] 2: [1, 2, 3] . .
3332 . 1: [7, 6, 0]
3333 .
3334
3335 r 1 r 2 V C s 3 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / A I S
3336 @end group
3337 @end smallexample
3338
3339 @noindent
3340 First we recall the original vectors and compute their cross product,
3341 which we also store for later reference. Now we divide the vector
3342 by the product of the lengths of the original vectors. The length of
3343 this vector should be the sine of the angle; sure enough, it is!
3344
3345 @c [fix-ref General Mode Commands]
3346 Vector-related commands generally begin with the @kbd{v} prefix key.
3347 Some are uppercase letters and some are lowercase. To make it easier
3348 to type these commands, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix key acts the same as
3349 the @kbd{v} key. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to make all
3350 prefix keys have this property.)
3351
3352 If we take the dot product of two perpendicular vectors we expect
3353 to get zero, since the cosine of 90 degrees is zero. Let's check
3354 that the cross product is indeed perpendicular to both inputs:
3355
3356 @smallexample
3357 @group
3358 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 0 2: [7, 6, 0] 1: 0
3359 1: [-18, 21, -8] . 1: [-18, 21, -8] .
3360 . .
3361
3362 r 1 r 3 * @key{DEL} r 2 r 3 *
3363 @end group
3364 @end smallexample
3365
3366 @cindex Normalizing a vector
3367 @cindex Unit vectors
3368 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Given a vector on the top of the
3369 stack, what keystrokes would you use to @dfn{normalize} the
3370 vector, i.e., to reduce its length to one without changing its
3371 direction? @xref{Vector Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3372
3373 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Suppose a certain particle can be
3374 at any of several positions along a ruler. You have a list of
3375 those positions in the form of a vector, and another list of the
3376 probabilities for the particle to be at the corresponding positions.
3377 Find the average position of the particle.
3378 @xref{Vector Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3379
3380 @node Matrix Tutorial, List Tutorial, Vector Analysis Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3381 @subsection Matrices
3382
3383 @noindent
3384 A @dfn{matrix} is just a vector of vectors, all the same length.
3385 This means you can enter a matrix using nested brackets. You can
3386 also use the semicolon character to enter a matrix. We'll show
3387 both methods here:
3388
3389 @smallexample
3390 @group
3391 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3392 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3393 . .
3394
3395 [[1 2 3] [4 5 6]] ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6] @key{RET}
3396 @end group
3397 @end smallexample
3398
3399 @noindent
3400 We'll be using this matrix again, so type @kbd{s 4} to save it now.
3401
3402 Note that semicolons work with incomplete vectors, but they work
3403 better in algebraic entry. That's why we use the apostrophe in
3404 the second example.
3405
3406 When two matrices are multiplied, the lefthand matrix must have
3407 the same number of columns as the righthand matrix has rows.
3408 Row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of the result is effectively the
3409 dot product of row @expr{i} of the left matrix by column @expr{j}
3410 of the right matrix.
3411
3412 If we try to duplicate this matrix and multiply it by itself,
3413 the dimensions are wrong and the multiplication cannot take place:
3414
3415 @smallexample
3416 @group
3417 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] * [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3418 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3419 .
3420
3421 @key{RET} *
3422 @end group
3423 @end smallexample
3424
3425 @noindent
3426 Though rather hard to read, this is a formula which shows the product
3427 of two matrices. The @samp{*} function, having invalid arguments, has
3428 been left in symbolic form.
3429
3430 We can multiply the matrices if we @dfn{transpose} one of them first.
3431
3432 @smallexample
3433 @group
3434 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 14, 32 ] 1: [ [ 17, 22, 27 ]
3435 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 32, 77 ] ] [ 22, 29, 36 ]
3436 1: [ [ 1, 4 ] . [ 27, 36, 45 ] ]
3437 [ 2, 5 ] .
3438 [ 3, 6 ] ]
3439 .
3440
3441 U v t * U @key{TAB} *
3442 @end group
3443 @end smallexample
3444
3445 Matrix multiplication is not commutative; indeed, switching the
3446 order of the operands can even change the dimensions of the result
3447 matrix, as happened here!
3448
3449 If you multiply a plain vector by a matrix, it is treated as a
3450 single row or column depending on which side of the matrix it is
3451 on. The result is a plain vector which should also be interpreted
3452 as a row or column as appropriate.
3453
3454 @smallexample
3455 @group
3456 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [14, 32]
3457 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] .
3458 1: [1, 2, 3]
3459 .
3460
3461 r 4 r 1 *
3462 @end group
3463 @end smallexample
3464
3465 Multiplying in the other order wouldn't work because the number of
3466 rows in the matrix is different from the number of elements in the
3467 vector.
3468
3469 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Use @samp{*} to sum along the rows
3470 of the above
3471 @texline @math{2\times3}
3472 @infoline 2x3
3473 matrix to get @expr{[6, 15]}. Now use @samp{*} to sum along the columns
3474 to get @expr{[5, 7, 9]}.
3475 @xref{Matrix Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3476
3477 @cindex Identity matrix
3478 An @dfn{identity matrix} is a square matrix with ones along the
3479 diagonal and zeros elsewhere. It has the property that multiplication
3480 by an identity matrix, on the left or on the right, always produces
3481 the original matrix.
3482
3483 @smallexample
3484 @group
3485 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3486 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3487 . 1: [ [ 1, 0, 0 ] .
3488 [ 0, 1, 0 ]
3489 [ 0, 0, 1 ] ]
3490 .
3491
3492 r 4 v i 3 @key{RET} *
3493 @end group
3494 @end smallexample
3495
3496 If a matrix is square, it is often possible to find its @dfn{inverse},
3497 that is, a matrix which, when multiplied by the original matrix, yields
3498 an identity matrix. The @kbd{&} (reciprocal) key also computes the
3499 inverse of a matrix.
3500
3501 @smallexample
3502 @group
3503 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ -2.4, 1.2, -0.2 ]
3504 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2.8, -1.4, 0.4 ]
3505 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ -0.73333, 0.53333, -0.2 ] ]
3506 . .
3507
3508 r 4 r 2 | s 5 &
3509 @end group
3510 @end smallexample
3511
3512 @noindent
3513 The vertical bar @kbd{|} @dfn{concatenates} numbers, vectors, and
3514 matrices together. Here we have used it to add a new row onto
3515 our matrix to make it square.
3516
3517 We can multiply these two matrices in either order to get an identity.
3518
3519 @smallexample
3520 @group
3521 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ] 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ]
3522 [ 0., 1., 0. ] [ 0., 1., 0. ]
3523 [ 0., 0., 1. ] ] [ 0., 0., 1. ] ]
3524 . .
3525
3526 M-@key{RET} * U @key{TAB} *
3527 @end group
3528 @end smallexample
3529
3530 @cindex Systems of linear equations
3531 @cindex Linear equations, systems of
3532 Matrix inverses are related to systems of linear equations in algebra.
3533 Suppose we had the following set of equations:
3534
3535 @ifinfo
3536 @group
3537 @example
3538 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3539 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3540 7a + 6b = 3
3541 @end example
3542 @end group
3543 @end ifinfo
3544 @tex
3545 \turnoffactive
3546 \beforedisplayh
3547 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3548 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3549 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3550 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3551 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3552 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3553 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3554 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr}
3555 $$
3556 \afterdisplayh
3557 @end tex
3558
3559 @noindent
3560 This can be cast into the matrix equation,
3561
3562 @ifinfo
3563 @group
3564 @example
3565 [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] [ [ a ] [ [ 6 ]
3566 [ 4, 5, 6 ] * [ b ] = [ 2 ]
3567 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ c ] ] [ 3 ] ]
3568 @end example
3569 @end group
3570 @end ifinfo
3571 @tex
3572 \turnoffactive
3573 \beforedisplay
3574 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 \cr 4 & 5 & 6 \cr 7 & 6 & 0 }
3575 \times
3576 \pmatrix{ a \cr b \cr c } = \pmatrix{ 6 \cr 2 \cr 3 }
3577 $$
3578 \afterdisplay
3579 @end tex
3580
3581 We can solve this system of equations by multiplying both sides by the
3582 inverse of the matrix. Calc can do this all in one step:
3583
3584 @smallexample
3585 @group
3586 2: [6, 2, 3] 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3587 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
3588 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
3589 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3590 .
3591
3592 [6,2,3] r 5 /
3593 @end group
3594 @end smallexample
3595
3596 @noindent
3597 The result is the @expr{[a, b, c]} vector that solves the equations.
3598 (Dividing by a square matrix is equivalent to multiplying by its
3599 inverse.)
3600
3601 Let's verify this solution:
3602
3603 @smallexample
3604 @group
3605 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [6., 2., 3.]
3606 [ 4, 5, 6 ] .
3607 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3608 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3609 .
3610
3611 r 5 @key{TAB} *
3612 @end group
3613 @end smallexample
3614
3615 @noindent
3616 Note that we had to be careful about the order in which we multiplied
3617 the matrix and vector. If we multiplied in the other order, Calc would
3618 assume the vector was a row vector in order to make the dimensions
3619 come out right, and the answer would be incorrect. If you
3620 don't feel safe letting Calc take either interpretation of your
3621 vectors, use explicit
3622 @texline @math{N\times1}
3623 @infoline Nx1
3624 or
3625 @texline @math{1\times N}
3626 @infoline 1xN
3627 matrices instead. In this case, you would enter the original column
3628 vector as @samp{[[6], [2], [3]]} or @samp{[6; 2; 3]}.
3629
3630 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Algebraic entry allows you to make
3631 vectors and matrices that include variables. Solve the following
3632 system of equations to get expressions for @expr{x} and @expr{y}
3633 in terms of @expr{a} and @expr{b}.
3634
3635 @ifinfo
3636 @group
3637 @example
3638 x + a y = 6
3639 x + b y = 10
3640 @end example
3641 @end group
3642 @end ifinfo
3643 @tex
3644 \turnoffactive
3645 \beforedisplay
3646 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
3647 x &+ b y = 10}
3648 $$
3649 \afterdisplay
3650 @end tex
3651
3652 @noindent
3653 @xref{Matrix Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3654
3655 @cindex Least-squares for over-determined systems
3656 @cindex Over-determined systems of equations
3657 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} A system of equations is ``over-determined''
3658 if it has more equations than variables. It is often the case that
3659 there are no values for the variables that will satisfy all the
3660 equations at once, but it is still useful to find a set of values
3661 which ``nearly'' satisfy all the equations. In terms of matrix equations,
3662 you can't solve @expr{A X = B} directly because the matrix @expr{A}
3663 is not square for an over-determined system. Matrix inversion works
3664 only for square matrices. One common trick is to multiply both sides
3665 on the left by the transpose of @expr{A}:
3666 @ifinfo
3667 @samp{trn(A)*A*X = trn(A)*B}.
3668 @end ifinfo
3669 @tex
3670 \turnoffactive
3671 $A^T A \, X = A^T B$, where $A^T$ is the transpose \samp{trn(A)}.
3672 @end tex
3673 Now
3674 @texline @math{A^T A}
3675 @infoline @expr{trn(A)*A}
3676 is a square matrix so a solution is possible. It turns out that the
3677 @expr{X} vector you compute in this way will be a ``least-squares''
3678 solution, which can be regarded as the ``closest'' solution to the set
3679 of equations. Use Calc to solve the following over-determined
3680 system:
3681
3682 @ifinfo
3683 @group
3684 @example
3685 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3686 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3687 7a + 6b = 3
3688 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
3689 @end example
3690 @end group
3691 @end ifinfo
3692 @tex
3693 \turnoffactive
3694 \beforedisplayh
3695 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3696 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3697 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3698 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3699 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3700 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3701 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3702 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
3703 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
3704 $$
3705 \afterdisplayh
3706 @end tex
3707
3708 @noindent
3709 @xref{Matrix Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
3710
3711 @node List Tutorial, , Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3712 @subsection Vectors as Lists
3713
3714 @noindent
3715 @cindex Lists
3716 Although Calc has a number of features for manipulating vectors and
3717 matrices as mathematical objects, you can also treat vectors as
3718 simple lists of values. For example, we saw that the @kbd{k f}
3719 command returns a vector which is a list of the prime factors of a
3720 number.
3721
3722 You can pack and unpack stack entries into vectors:
3723
3724 @smallexample
3725 @group
3726 3: 10 1: [10, 20, 30] 3: 10
3727 2: 20 . 2: 20
3728 1: 30 1: 30
3729 . .
3730
3731 M-3 v p v u
3732 @end group
3733 @end smallexample
3734
3735 You can also build vectors out of consecutive integers, or out
3736 of many copies of a given value:
3737
3738 @smallexample
3739 @group
3740 1: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4]
3741 . 1: 17 1: [17, 17, 17, 17]
3742 . .
3743
3744 v x 4 @key{RET} 17 v b 4 @key{RET}
3745 @end group
3746 @end smallexample
3747
3748 You can apply an operator to every element of a vector using the
3749 @dfn{map} command.
3750
3751 @smallexample
3752 @group
3753 1: [17, 34, 51, 68] 1: [289, 1156, 2601, 4624] 1: [17, 34, 51, 68]
3754 . . .
3755
3756 V M * 2 V M ^ V M Q
3757 @end group
3758 @end smallexample
3759
3760 @noindent
3761 In the first step, we multiply the vector of integers by the vector
3762 of 17's elementwise. In the second step, we raise each element to
3763 the power two. (The general rule is that both operands must be
3764 vectors of the same length, or else one must be a vector and the
3765 other a plain number.) In the final step, we take the square root
3766 of each element.
3767
3768 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Compute a vector of powers of two
3769 from
3770 @texline @math{2^{-4}}
3771 @infoline @expr{2^-4}
3772 to @expr{2^4}. @xref{List Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3773
3774 You can also @dfn{reduce} a binary operator across a vector.
3775 For example, reducing @samp{*} computes the product of all the
3776 elements in the vector:
3777
3778 @smallexample
3779 @group
3780 1: 123123 1: [3, 7, 11, 13, 41] 1: 123123
3781 . . .
3782
3783 123123 k f V R *
3784 @end group
3785 @end smallexample
3786
3787 @noindent
3788 In this example, we decompose 123123 into its prime factors, then
3789 multiply those factors together again to yield the original number.
3790
3791 We could compute a dot product ``by hand'' using mapping and
3792 reduction:
3793
3794 @smallexample
3795 @group
3796 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [7, 12, 0] 1: 19
3797 1: [7, 6, 0] . .
3798 .
3799
3800 r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
3801 @end group
3802 @end smallexample
3803
3804 @noindent
3805 Recalling two vectors from the previous section, we compute the
3806 sum of pairwise products of the elements to get the same answer
3807 for the dot product as before.
3808
3809 A slight variant of vector reduction is the @dfn{accumulate} operation,
3810 @kbd{V U}. This produces a vector of the intermediate results from
3811 a corresponding reduction. Here we compute a table of factorials:
3812
3813 @smallexample
3814 @group
3815 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] 1: [1, 2, 6, 24, 120, 720]
3816 . .
3817
3818 v x 6 @key{RET} V U *
3819 @end group
3820 @end smallexample
3821
3822 Calc allows vectors to grow as large as you like, although it gets
3823 rather slow if vectors have more than about a hundred elements.
3824 Actually, most of the time is spent formatting these large vectors
3825 for display, not calculating on them. Try the following experiment
3826 (if your computer is very fast you may need to substitute a larger
3827 vector size).
3828
3829 @smallexample
3830 @group
3831 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ... 1: [2, 3, 4, 5, ...
3832 . .
3833
3834 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3835 @end group
3836 @end smallexample
3837
3838 Now press @kbd{v .} (the letter @kbd{v}, then a period) and try the
3839 experiment again. In @kbd{v .} mode, long vectors are displayed
3840 ``abbreviated'' like this:
3841
3842 @smallexample
3843 @group
3844 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 500] 1: [2, 3, 4, ..., 501]
3845 . .
3846
3847 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3848 @end group
3849 @end smallexample
3850
3851 @noindent
3852 (where now the @samp{...} is actually part of the Calc display).
3853 You will find both operations are now much faster. But notice that
3854 even in @w{@kbd{v .}} mode, the full vectors are still shown in the Trail.
3855 Type @w{@kbd{t .}} to cause the trail to abbreviate as well, and try the
3856 experiment one more time. Operations on long vectors are now quite
3857 fast! (But of course if you use @kbd{t .} you will lose the ability
3858 to get old vectors back using the @kbd{t y} command.)
3859
3860 An easy way to view a full vector when @kbd{v .} mode is active is
3861 to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the vector; editing always works
3862 with the full, unabbreviated value.
3863
3864 @cindex Least-squares for fitting a straight line
3865 @cindex Fitting data to a line
3866 @cindex Line, fitting data to
3867 @cindex Data, extracting from buffers
3868 @cindex Columns of data, extracting
3869 As a larger example, let's try to fit a straight line to some data,
3870 using the method of least squares. (Calc has a built-in command for
3871 least-squares curve fitting, but we'll do it by hand here just to
3872 practice working with vectors.) Suppose we have the following list
3873 of values in a file we have loaded into Emacs:
3874
3875 @smallexample
3876 x y
3877 --- ---
3878 1.34 0.234
3879 1.41 0.298
3880 1.49 0.402
3881 1.56 0.412
3882 1.64 0.466
3883 1.73 0.473
3884 1.82 0.601
3885 1.91 0.519
3886 2.01 0.603
3887 2.11 0.637
3888 2.22 0.645
3889 2.33 0.705
3890 2.45 0.917
3891 2.58 1.009
3892 2.71 0.971
3893 2.85 1.062
3894 3.00 1.148
3895 3.15 1.157
3896 3.32 1.354
3897 @end smallexample
3898
3899 @noindent
3900 If you are reading this tutorial in printed form, you will find it
3901 easiest to press @kbd{M-# i} to enter the on-line Info version of
3902 the manual and find this table there. (Press @kbd{g}, then type
3903 @kbd{List Tutorial}, to jump straight to this section.)
3904
3905 Position the cursor at the upper-left corner of this table, just
3906 to the left of the @expr{1.34}. Press @kbd{C-@@} to set the mark.
3907 (On your system this may be @kbd{C-2}, @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}, or @kbd{NUL}.)
3908 Now position the cursor to the lower-right, just after the @expr{1.354}.
3909 You have now defined this region as an Emacs ``rectangle.'' Still
3910 in the Info buffer, type @kbd{M-# r}. This command
3911 (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) will pop you back into the Calculator, with
3912 the contents of the rectangle you specified in the form of a matrix.
3913
3914 @smallexample
3915 @group
3916 1: [ [ 1.34, 0.234 ]
3917 [ 1.41, 0.298 ]
3918 @dots{}
3919 @end group
3920 @end smallexample
3921
3922 @noindent
3923 (You may wish to use @kbd{v .} mode to abbreviate the display of this
3924 large matrix.)
3925
3926 We want to treat this as a pair of lists. The first step is to
3927 transpose this matrix into a pair of rows. Remember, a matrix is
3928 just a vector of vectors. So we can unpack the matrix into a pair
3929 of row vectors on the stack.
3930
3931 @smallexample
3932 @group
3933 1: [ [ 1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3934 [ 0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ] ] 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3935 . .
3936
3937 v t v u
3938 @end group
3939 @end smallexample
3940
3941 @noindent
3942 Let's store these in quick variables 1 and 2, respectively.
3943
3944 @smallexample
3945 @group
3946 1: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] .
3947 .
3948
3949 t 2 t 1
3950 @end group
3951 @end smallexample
3952
3953 @noindent
3954 (Recall that @kbd{t 2} is a variant of @kbd{s 2} that removes the
3955 stored value from the stack.)
3956
3957 In a least squares fit, the slope @expr{m} is given by the formula
3958
3959 @ifinfo
3960 @example
3961 m = (N sum(x y) - sum(x) sum(y)) / (N sum(x^2) - sum(x)^2)
3962 @end example
3963 @end ifinfo
3964 @tex
3965 \turnoffactive
3966 \beforedisplay
3967 $$ m = {N \sum x y - \sum x \sum y \over
3968 N \sum x^2 - \left( \sum x \right)^2} $$
3969 \afterdisplay
3970 @end tex
3971
3972 @noindent
3973 where
3974 @texline @math{\sum x}
3975 @infoline @expr{sum(x)}
3976 represents the sum of all the values of @expr{x}. While there is an
3977 actual @code{sum} function in Calc, it's easier to sum a vector using a
3978 simple reduction. First, let's compute the four different sums that
3979 this formula uses.
3980
3981 @smallexample
3982 @group
3983 1: 41.63 1: 98.0003
3984 . .
3985
3986 r 1 V R + t 3 r 1 2 V M ^ V R + t 4
3987
3988 @end group
3989 @end smallexample
3990 @noindent
3991 @smallexample
3992 @group
3993 1: 13.613 1: 33.36554
3994 . .
3995
3996 r 2 V R + t 5 r 1 r 2 V M * V R + t 6
3997 @end group
3998 @end smallexample
3999
4000 @ifinfo
4001 @noindent
4002 These are @samp{sum(x)}, @samp{sum(x^2)}, @samp{sum(y)}, and @samp{sum(x y)},
4003 respectively. (We could have used @kbd{*} to compute @samp{sum(x^2)} and
4004 @samp{sum(x y)}.)
4005 @end ifinfo
4006 @tex
4007 \turnoffactive
4008 These are $\sum x$, $\sum x^2$, $\sum y$, and $\sum x y$,
4009 respectively. (We could have used \kbd{*} to compute $\sum x^2$ and
4010 $\sum x y$.)
4011 @end tex
4012
4013 Finally, we also need @expr{N}, the number of data points. This is just
4014 the length of either of our lists.
4015
4016 @smallexample
4017 @group
4018 1: 19
4019 .
4020
4021 r 1 v l t 7
4022 @end group
4023 @end smallexample
4024
4025 @noindent
4026 (That's @kbd{v} followed by a lower-case @kbd{l}.)
4027
4028 Now we grind through the formula:
4029
4030 @smallexample
4031 @group
4032 1: 633.94526 2: 633.94526 1: 67.23607
4033 . 1: 566.70919 .
4034 .
4035
4036 r 7 r 6 * r 3 r 5 * -
4037
4038 @end group
4039 @end smallexample
4040 @noindent
4041 @smallexample
4042 @group
4043 2: 67.23607 3: 67.23607 2: 67.23607 1: 0.52141679
4044 1: 1862.0057 2: 1862.0057 1: 128.9488 .
4045 . 1: 1733.0569 .
4046 .
4047
4048 r 7 r 4 * r 3 2 ^ - / t 8
4049 @end group
4050 @end smallexample
4051
4052 That gives us the slope @expr{m}. The y-intercept @expr{b} can now
4053 be found with the simple formula,
4054
4055 @ifinfo
4056 @example
4057 b = (sum(y) - m sum(x)) / N
4058 @end example
4059 @end ifinfo
4060 @tex
4061 \turnoffactive
4062 \beforedisplay
4063 $$ b = {\sum y - m \sum x \over N} $$
4064 \afterdisplay
4065 \vskip10pt
4066 @end tex
4067
4068 @smallexample
4069 @group
4070 1: 13.613 2: 13.613 1: -8.09358 1: -0.425978
4071 . 1: 21.70658 . .
4072 .
4073
4074 r 5 r 8 r 3 * - r 7 / t 9
4075 @end group
4076 @end smallexample
4077
4078 Let's ``plot'' this straight line approximation,
4079 @texline @math{y \approx m x + b},
4080 @infoline @expr{m x + b},
4081 and compare it with the original data.
4082
4083 @smallexample
4084 @group
4085 1: [0.699, 0.735, ... ] 1: [0.273, 0.309, ... ]
4086 . .
4087
4088 r 1 r 8 * r 9 + s 0
4089 @end group
4090 @end smallexample
4091
4092 @noindent
4093 Notice that multiplying a vector by a constant, and adding a constant
4094 to a vector, can be done without mapping commands since these are
4095 common operations from vector algebra. As far as Calc is concerned,
4096 we've just been doing geometry in 19-dimensional space!
4097
4098 We can subtract this vector from our original @expr{y} vector to get
4099 a feel for the error of our fit. Let's find the maximum error:
4100
4101 @smallexample
4102 @group
4103 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: 0.0897
4104 . . .
4105
4106 r 2 - V M A V R X
4107 @end group
4108 @end smallexample
4109
4110 @noindent
4111 First we compute a vector of differences, then we take the absolute
4112 values of these differences, then we reduce the @code{max} function
4113 across the vector. (The @code{max} function is on the two-key sequence
4114 @kbd{f x}; because it is so common to use @code{max} in a vector
4115 operation, the letters @kbd{X} and @kbd{N} are also accepted for
4116 @code{max} and @code{min} in this context. In general, you answer
4117 the @kbd{V M} or @kbd{V R} prompt with the actual key sequence that
4118 invokes the function you want. You could have typed @kbd{V R f x} or
4119 even @kbd{V R x max @key{RET}} if you had preferred.)
4120
4121 If your system has the GNUPLOT program, you can see graphs of your
4122 data and your straight line to see how well they match. (If you have
4123 GNUPLOT 3.0, the following instructions will work regardless of the
4124 kind of display you have. Some GNUPLOT 2.0, non-X-windows systems
4125 may require additional steps to view the graphs.)
4126
4127 Let's start by plotting the original data. Recall the ``@var{x}'' and ``@var{y}''
4128 vectors onto the stack and press @kbd{g f}. This ``fast'' graphing
4129 command does everything you need to do for simple, straightforward
4130 plotting of data.
4131
4132 @smallexample
4133 @group
4134 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
4135 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
4136 .
4137
4138 r 1 r 2 g f
4139 @end group
4140 @end smallexample
4141
4142 If all goes well, you will shortly get a new window containing a graph
4143 of the data. (If not, contact your GNUPLOT or Calc installer to find
4144 out what went wrong.) In the X window system, this will be a separate
4145 graphics window. For other kinds of displays, the default is to
4146 display the graph in Emacs itself using rough character graphics.
4147 Press @kbd{q} when you are done viewing the character graphics.
4148
4149 Next, let's add the line we got from our least-squares fit.
4150 @ifinfo
4151 (If you are reading this tutorial on-line while running Calc, typing
4152 @kbd{g a} may cause the tutorial to disappear from its window and be
4153 replaced by a buffer named @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}. The tutorial
4154 will reappear when you terminate GNUPLOT by typing @kbd{g q}.)
4155 @end ifinfo
4156
4157 @smallexample
4158 @group
4159 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
4160 1: [0.273, 0.309, 0.351, ... ]
4161 .
4162
4163 @key{DEL} r 0 g a g p
4164 @end group
4165 @end smallexample
4166
4167 It's not very useful to get symbols to mark the data points on this
4168 second curve; you can type @kbd{g S g p} to remove them. Type @kbd{g q}
4169 when you are done to remove the X graphics window and terminate GNUPLOT.
4170
4171 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} An earlier exercise showed how to do
4172 least squares fitting to a general system of equations. Our 19 data
4173 points are really 19 equations of the form @expr{y_i = m x_i + b} for
4174 different pairs of @expr{(x_i,y_i)}. Use the matrix-transpose method
4175 to solve for @expr{m} and @expr{b}, duplicating the above result.
4176 @xref{List Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4177
4178 @cindex Geometric mean
4179 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} If the input data do not form a
4180 rectangle, you can use @w{@kbd{M-# g}} (@code{calc-grab-region})
4181 to grab the data the way Emacs normally works with regions---it reads
4182 left-to-right, top-to-bottom, treating line breaks the same as spaces.
4183 Use this command to find the geometric mean of the following numbers.
4184 (The geometric mean is the @var{n}th root of the product of @var{n} numbers.)
4185
4186 @example
4187 2.3 6 22 15.1 7
4188 15 14 7.5
4189 2.5
4190 @end example
4191
4192 @noindent
4193 The @kbd{M-# g} command accepts numbers separated by spaces or commas,
4194 with or without surrounding vector brackets.
4195 @xref{List Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4196
4197 @ifinfo
4198 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4199 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4200 @var{n}-choose-0 minus @var{n}-choose-1 plus @var{n}-choose-2, and so
4201 on up to @var{n}-choose-@var{n},
4202 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4203 for @expr{n=6}.
4204 @end ifinfo
4205 @tex
4206 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4207 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4208 ${n \choose 0} - {n \choose 1} + {n \choose 2} - \cdots \pm {n \choose n}$
4209 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4210 for \cite{n=6}.
4211 @end tex
4212
4213 @smallexample
4214 @group
4215 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7] 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
4216 . .
4217
4218 v x 7 @key{RET} 1 -
4219
4220 @end group
4221 @end smallexample
4222 @noindent
4223 @smallexample
4224 @group
4225 1: [1, -6, 15, -20, 15, -6, 1] 1: 0
4226 . .
4227
4228 V M ' (-1)^$ choose(6,$) @key{RET} V R +
4229 @end group
4230 @end smallexample
4231
4232 The @kbd{V M '} command prompts you to enter any algebraic expression
4233 to define the function to map over the vector. The symbol @samp{$}
4234 inside this expression represents the argument to the function.
4235 The Calculator applies this formula to each element of the vector,
4236 substituting each element's value for the @samp{$} sign(s) in turn.
4237
4238 To define a two-argument function, use @samp{$$} for the first
4239 argument and @samp{$} for the second: @kbd{V M ' $$-$ @key{RET}} is
4240 equivalent to @kbd{V M -}. This is analogous to regular algebraic
4241 entry, where @samp{$$} would refer to the next-to-top stack entry
4242 and @samp{$} would refer to the top stack entry, and @kbd{' $$-$ @key{RET}}
4243 would act exactly like @kbd{-}.
4244
4245 Notice that the @kbd{V M '} command has recorded two things in the
4246 trail: The result, as usual, and also a funny-looking thing marked
4247 @samp{oper} that represents the operator function you typed in.
4248 The function is enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets, and the argument is
4249 denoted by a @samp{#} sign. If there were several arguments, they
4250 would be shown as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on. (For example,
4251 @kbd{V M ' $$-$} will put the function @samp{<#1 - #2>} on the
4252 trail.) This object is a ``nameless function''; you can use nameless
4253 @w{@samp{< >}} notation to answer the @kbd{V M '} prompt if you like.
4254 Nameless function notation has the interesting, occasionally useful
4255 property that a nameless function is not actually evaluated until
4256 it is used. For example, @kbd{V M ' $+random(2.0)} evaluates
4257 @samp{random(2.0)} once and adds that random number to all elements
4258 of the vector, but @kbd{V M ' <#+random(2.0)>} evaluates the
4259 @samp{random(2.0)} separately for each vector element.
4260
4261 Another group of operators that are often useful with @kbd{V M} are
4262 the relational operators: @kbd{a =}, for example, compares two numbers
4263 and gives the result 1 if they are equal, or 0 if not. Similarly,
4264 @w{@kbd{a <}} checks for one number being less than another.
4265
4266 Other useful vector operations include @kbd{v v}, to reverse a
4267 vector end-for-end; @kbd{V S}, to sort the elements of a vector
4268 into increasing order; and @kbd{v r} and @w{@kbd{v c}}, to extract
4269 one row or column of a matrix, or (in both cases) to extract one
4270 element of a plain vector. With a negative argument, @kbd{v r}
4271 and @kbd{v c} instead delete one row, column, or vector element.
4272
4273 @cindex Divisor functions
4274 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The @expr{k}th @dfn{divisor function}
4275 @tex
4276 $\sigma_k(n)$
4277 @end tex
4278 is the sum of the @expr{k}th powers of all the divisors of an
4279 integer @expr{n}. Figure out a method for computing the divisor
4280 function for reasonably small values of @expr{n}. As a test,
4281 the 0th and 1st divisor functions of 30 are 8 and 72, respectively.
4282 @xref{List Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4283
4284 @cindex Square-free numbers
4285 @cindex Duplicate values in a list
4286 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @kbd{k f} command produces a
4287 list of prime factors for a number. Sometimes it is important to
4288 know that a number is @dfn{square-free}, i.e., that no prime occurs
4289 more than once in its list of prime factors. Find a sequence of
4290 keystrokes to tell if a number is square-free; your method should
4291 leave 1 on the stack if it is, or 0 if it isn't.
4292 @xref{List Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4293
4294 @cindex Triangular lists
4295 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Build a list of lists that looks
4296 like the following diagram. (You may wish to use the @kbd{v /}
4297 command to enable multi-line display of vectors.)
4298
4299 @smallexample
4300 @group
4301 1: [ [1],
4302 [1, 2],
4303 [1, 2, 3],
4304 [1, 2, 3, 4],
4305 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5],
4306 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] ]
4307 @end group
4308 @end smallexample
4309
4310 @noindent
4311 @xref{List Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4312
4313 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Build the following list of lists.
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 @group
4317 1: [ [0],
4318 [1, 2],
4319 [3, 4, 5],
4320 [6, 7, 8, 9],
4321 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
4322 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
4323 @end group
4324 @end smallexample
4325
4326 @noindent
4327 @xref{List Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4328
4329 @cindex Maximizing a function over a list of values
4330 @c [fix-ref Numerical Solutions]
4331 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} Compute a list of values of Bessel's
4332 @texline @math{J_1(x)}
4333 @infoline @expr{J1}
4334 function @samp{besJ(1,x)} for @expr{x} from 0 to 5 in steps of 0.25.
4335 Find the value of @expr{x} (from among the above set of values) for
4336 which @samp{besJ(1,x)} is a maximum. Use an ``automatic'' method,
4337 i.e., just reading along the list by hand to find the largest value
4338 is not allowed! (There is an @kbd{a X} command which does this kind
4339 of thing automatically; @pxref{Numerical Solutions}.)
4340 @xref{List Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4341
4342 @cindex Digits, vectors of
4343 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} You are given an integer in the range
4344 @texline @math{0 \le N < 10^m}
4345 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < 10^m}
4346 for @expr{m=12} (i.e., an integer of less than
4347 twelve digits). Convert this integer into a vector of @expr{m}
4348 digits, each in the range from 0 to 9. In vector-of-digits notation,
4349 add one to this integer to produce a vector of @expr{m+1} digits
4350 (since there could be a carry out of the most significant digit).
4351 Convert this vector back into a regular integer. A good integer
4352 to try is 25129925999. @xref{List Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4353
4354 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Your friend Joe tried to use
4355 @kbd{V R a =} to test if all numbers in a list were equal. What
4356 happened? How would you do this test? @xref{List Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4357
4358 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The area of a circle of radius one
4359 is @cpi{}. The area of the
4360 @texline @math{2\times2}
4361 @infoline 2x2
4362 square that encloses that circle is 4. So if we throw @var{n} darts at
4363 random points in the square, about @cpiover{4} of them will land inside
4364 the circle. This gives us an entertaining way to estimate the value of
4365 @cpi{}. The @w{@kbd{k r}}
4366 command picks a random number between zero and the value on the stack.
4367 We could get a random floating-point number between @mathit{-1} and 1 by typing
4368 @w{@kbd{2.0 k r 1 -}}. Build a vector of 100 random @expr{(x,y)} points in
4369 this square, then use vector mapping and reduction to count how many
4370 points lie inside the unit circle. Hint: Use the @kbd{v b} command.
4371 @xref{List Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4372
4373 @cindex Matchstick problem
4374 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} The @dfn{matchstick problem} provides
4375 another way to calculate @cpi{}. Say you have an infinite field
4376 of vertical lines with a spacing of one inch. Toss a one-inch matchstick
4377 onto the field. The probability that the matchstick will land crossing
4378 a line turns out to be
4379 @texline @math{2/\pi}.
4380 @infoline @expr{2/pi}.
4381 Toss 100 matchsticks to estimate @cpi{}. (If you want still more fun,
4382 the probability that the GCD (@w{@kbd{k g}}) of two large integers is
4383 one turns out to be
4384 @texline @math{6/\pi^2}.
4385 @infoline @expr{6/pi^2}.
4386 That provides yet another way to estimate @cpi{}.)
4387 @xref{List Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4388
4389 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} An algebraic entry of a string in
4390 double-quote marks, @samp{"hello"}, creates a vector of the numerical
4391 (ASCII) codes of the characters (here, @expr{[104, 101, 108, 108, 111]}).
4392 Sometimes it is convenient to compute a @dfn{hash code} of a string,
4393 which is just an integer that represents the value of that string.
4394 Two equal strings have the same hash code; two different strings
4395 @dfn{probably} have different hash codes. (For example, Calc has
4396 over 400 function names, but Emacs can quickly find the definition for
4397 any given name because it has sorted the functions into ``buckets'' by
4398 their hash codes. Sometimes a few names will hash into the same bucket,
4399 but it is easier to search among a few names than among all the names.)
4400 One popular hash function is computed as follows: First set @expr{h = 0}.
4401 Then, for each character from the string in turn, set @expr{h = 3h + c_i}
4402 where @expr{c_i} is the character's ASCII code. If we have 511 buckets,
4403 we then take the hash code modulo 511 to get the bucket number. Develop a
4404 simple command or commands for converting string vectors into hash codes.
4405 The hash code for @samp{"Testing, 1, 2, 3"} is 1960915098, which modulo
4406 511 is 121. @xref{List Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4407
4408 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} The @kbd{H V R} and @kbd{H V U}
4409 commands do nested function evaluations. @kbd{H V U} takes a starting
4410 value and a number of steps @var{n} from the stack; it then applies the
4411 function you give to the starting value 0, 1, 2, up to @var{n} times
4412 and returns a vector of the results. Use this command to create a
4413 ``random walk'' of 50 steps. Start with the two-dimensional point
4414 @expr{(0,0)}; then take one step a random distance between @mathit{-1} and 1
4415 in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}; then take another step, and so on. Use the
4416 @kbd{g f} command to display this random walk. Now modify your random
4417 walk to walk a unit distance, but in a random direction, at each step.
4418 (Hint: The @code{sincos} function returns a vector of the cosine and
4419 sine of an angle.) @xref{List Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4420
4421 @node Types Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Tutorial
4422 @section Types Tutorial
4423
4424 @noindent
4425 Calc understands a variety of data types as well as simple numbers.
4426 In this section, we'll experiment with each of these types in turn.
4427
4428 The numbers we've been using so far have mainly been either @dfn{integers}
4429 or @dfn{floats}. We saw that floats are usually a good approximation to
4430 the mathematical concept of real numbers, but they are only approximations
4431 and are susceptible to roundoff error. Calc also supports @dfn{fractions},
4432 which can exactly represent any rational number.
4433
4434 @smallexample
4435 @group
4436 1: 3628800 2: 3628800 1: 518400:7 1: 518414:7 1: 7:518414
4437 . 1: 49 . . .
4438 .
4439
4440 10 ! 49 @key{RET} : 2 + &
4441 @end group
4442 @end smallexample
4443
4444 @noindent
4445 The @kbd{:} command divides two integers to get a fraction; @kbd{/}
4446 would normally divide integers to get a floating-point result.
4447 Notice we had to type @key{RET} between the @kbd{49} and the @kbd{:}
4448 since the @kbd{:} would otherwise be interpreted as part of a
4449 fraction beginning with 49.
4450
4451 You can convert between floating-point and fractional format using
4452 @kbd{c f} and @kbd{c F}:
4453
4454 @smallexample
4455 @group
4456 1: 1.35027217629e-5 1: 7:518414
4457 . .
4458
4459 c f c F
4460 @end group
4461 @end smallexample
4462
4463 The @kbd{c F} command replaces a floating-point number with the
4464 ``simplest'' fraction whose floating-point representation is the
4465 same, to within the current precision.
4466
4467 @smallexample
4468 @group
4469 1: 3.14159265359 1: 1146408:364913 1: 3.1416 1: 355:113
4470 . . . .
4471
4472 P c F @key{DEL} p 5 @key{RET} P c F
4473 @end group
4474 @end smallexample
4475
4476 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} A calculation has produced the
4477 result 1.26508260337. You suspect it is the square root of the
4478 product of @cpi{} and some rational number. Is it? (Be sure
4479 to allow for roundoff error!) @xref{Types Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4480
4481 @dfn{Complex numbers} can be stored in both rectangular and polar form.
4482
4483 @smallexample
4484 @group
4485 1: -9 1: (0, 3) 1: (3; 90.) 1: (6; 90.) 1: (2.4495; 45.)
4486 . . . . .
4487
4488 9 n Q c p 2 * Q
4489 @end group
4490 @end smallexample
4491
4492 @noindent
4493 The square root of @mathit{-9} is by default rendered in rectangular form
4494 (@w{@expr{0 + 3i}}), but we can convert it to polar form (3 with a
4495 phase angle of 90 degrees). All the usual arithmetic and scientific
4496 operations are defined on both types of complex numbers.
4497
4498 Another generalized kind of number is @dfn{infinity}. Infinity
4499 isn't really a number, but it can sometimes be treated like one.
4500 Calc uses the symbol @code{inf} to represent positive infinity,
4501 i.e., a value greater than any real number. Naturally, you can
4502 also write @samp{-inf} for minus infinity, a value less than any
4503 real number. The word @code{inf} can only be input using
4504 algebraic entry.
4505
4506 @smallexample
4507 @group
4508 2: inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 1: nan
4509 1: -17 1: -inf 1: -inf 1: inf .
4510 . . . .
4511
4512 ' inf @key{RET} 17 n * @key{RET} 72 + A +
4513 @end group
4514 @end smallexample
4515
4516 @noindent
4517 Since infinity is infinitely large, multiplying it by any finite
4518 number (like @mathit{-17}) has no effect, except that since @mathit{-17}
4519 is negative, it changes a plus infinity to a minus infinity.
4520 (``A huge positive number, multiplied by @mathit{-17}, yields a huge
4521 negative number.'') Adding any finite number to infinity also
4522 leaves it unchanged. Taking an absolute value gives us plus
4523 infinity again. Finally, we add this plus infinity to the minus
4524 infinity we had earlier. If you work it out, you might expect
4525 the answer to be @mathit{-72} for this. But the 72 has been completely
4526 lost next to the infinities; by the time we compute @w{@samp{inf - inf}}
4527 the finite difference between them, if any, is undetectable.
4528 So we say the result is @dfn{indeterminate}, which Calc writes
4529 with the symbol @code{nan} (for Not A Number).
4530
4531 Dividing by zero is normally treated as an error, but you can get
4532 Calc to write an answer in terms of infinity by pressing @kbd{m i}
4533 to turn on Infinite mode.
4534
4535 @smallexample
4536 @group
4537 3: nan 2: nan 2: nan 2: nan 1: nan
4538 2: 1 1: 1 / 0 1: uinf 1: uinf .
4539 1: 0 . . .
4540 .
4541
4542 1 @key{RET} 0 / m i U / 17 n * +
4543 @end group
4544 @end smallexample
4545
4546 @noindent
4547 Dividing by zero normally is left unevaluated, but after @kbd{m i}
4548 it instead gives an infinite result. The answer is actually
4549 @code{uinf}, ``undirected infinity.'' If you look at a graph of
4550 @expr{1 / x} around @w{@expr{x = 0}}, you'll see that it goes toward
4551 plus infinity as you approach zero from above, but toward minus
4552 infinity as you approach from below. Since we said only @expr{1 / 0},
4553 Calc knows that the answer is infinite but not in which direction.
4554 That's what @code{uinf} means. Notice that multiplying @code{uinf}
4555 by a negative number still leaves plain @code{uinf}; there's no
4556 point in saying @samp{-uinf} because the sign of @code{uinf} is
4557 unknown anyway. Finally, we add @code{uinf} to our @code{nan},
4558 yielding @code{nan} again. It's easy to see that, because
4559 @code{nan} means ``totally unknown'' while @code{uinf} means
4560 ``unknown sign but known to be infinite,'' the more mysterious
4561 @code{nan} wins out when it is combined with @code{uinf}, or, for
4562 that matter, with anything else.
4563
4564 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Predict what Calc will answer
4565 for each of these formulas: @samp{inf / inf}, @samp{exp(inf)},
4566 @samp{exp(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(uinf)},
4567 @samp{abs(uinf)}, @samp{ln(0)}.
4568 @xref{Types Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4569
4570 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} We saw that @samp{inf - inf = nan},
4571 which stands for an unknown value. Can @code{nan} stand for
4572 a complex number? Can it stand for infinity?
4573 @xref{Types Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4574
4575 @dfn{HMS forms} represent a value in terms of hours, minutes, and
4576 seconds.
4577
4578 @smallexample
4579 @group
4580 1: 2@@ 30' 0" 1: 3@@ 30' 0" 2: 3@@ 30' 0" 1: 2.
4581 . . 1: 1@@ 45' 0." .
4582 .
4583
4584 2@@ 30' @key{RET} 1 + @key{RET} 2 / /
4585 @end group
4586 @end smallexample
4587
4588 HMS forms can also be used to hold angles in degrees, minutes, and
4589 seconds.
4590
4591 @smallexample
4592 @group
4593 1: 0.5 1: 26.56505 1: 26@@ 33' 54.18" 1: 0.44721
4594 . . . .
4595
4596 0.5 I T c h S
4597 @end group
4598 @end smallexample
4599
4600 @noindent
4601 First we convert the inverse tangent of 0.5 to degrees-minutes-seconds
4602 form, then we take the sine of that angle. Note that the trigonometric
4603 functions will accept HMS forms directly as input.
4604
4605 @cindex Beatles
4606 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The Beatles' @emph{Abbey Road} is
4607 47 minutes and 26 seconds long, and contains 17 songs. What is the
4608 average length of a song on @emph{Abbey Road}? If the Extended Disco
4609 Version of @emph{Abbey Road} added 20 seconds to the length of each
4610 song, how long would the album be? @xref{Types Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4611
4612 A @dfn{date form} represents a date, or a date and time. Dates must
4613 be entered using algebraic entry. Date forms are surrounded by
4614 @samp{< >} symbols; most standard formats for dates are recognized.
4615
4616 @smallexample
4617 @group
4618 2: <Sun Jan 13, 1991> 1: 2.25
4619 1: <6:00pm Thu Jan 10, 1991> .
4620 .
4621
4622 ' <13 Jan 1991>, <1/10/91, 6pm> @key{RET} -
4623 @end group
4624 @end smallexample
4625
4626 @noindent
4627 In this example, we enter two dates, then subtract to find the
4628 number of days between them. It is also possible to add an
4629 HMS form or a number (of days) to a date form to get another
4630 date form.
4631
4632 @smallexample
4633 @group
4634 1: <4:45:59pm Mon Jan 14, 1991> 1: <2:50:59am Thu Jan 17, 1991>
4635 . .
4636
4637 t N 2 + 10@@ 5' +
4638 @end group
4639 @end smallexample
4640
4641 @c [fix-ref Date Arithmetic]
4642 @noindent
4643 The @kbd{t N} (``now'') command pushes the current date and time on the
4644 stack; then we add two days, ten hours and five minutes to the date and
4645 time. Other date-and-time related commands include @kbd{t J}, which
4646 does Julian day conversions, @kbd{t W}, which finds the beginning of
4647 the week in which a date form lies, and @kbd{t I}, which increments a
4648 date by one or several months. @xref{Date Arithmetic}, for more.
4649
4650 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} How many days until the next
4651 Friday the 13th? @xref{Types Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4652
4653 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} How many leap years will there be
4654 between now and the year 10001 A.D.? @xref{Types Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4655
4656 @cindex Slope and angle of a line
4657 @cindex Angle and slope of a line
4658 An @dfn{error form} represents a mean value with an attached standard
4659 deviation, or error estimate. Suppose our measurements indicate that
4660 a certain telephone pole is about 30 meters away, with an estimated
4661 error of 1 meter, and 8 meters tall, with an estimated error of 0.2
4662 meters. What is the slope of a line from here to the top of the
4663 pole, and what is the equivalent angle in degrees?
4664
4665 @smallexample
4666 @group
4667 1: 8 +/- 0.2 2: 8 +/- 0.2 1: 0.266 +/- 0.011 1: 14.93 +/- 0.594
4668 . 1: 30 +/- 1 . .
4669 .
4670
4671 8 p .2 @key{RET} 30 p 1 / I T
4672 @end group
4673 @end smallexample
4674
4675 @noindent
4676 This means that the angle is about 15 degrees, and, assuming our
4677 original error estimates were valid standard deviations, there is about
4678 a 60% chance that the result is correct within 0.59 degrees.
4679
4680 @cindex Torus, volume of
4681 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} The volume of a torus (a donut shape) is
4682 @texline @math{2 \pi^2 R r^2}
4683 @infoline @w{@expr{2 pi^2 R r^2}}
4684 where @expr{R} is the radius of the circle that
4685 defines the center of the tube and @expr{r} is the radius of the tube
4686 itself. Suppose @expr{R} is 20 cm and @expr{r} is 4 cm, each known to
4687 within 5 percent. What is the volume and the relative uncertainty of
4688 the volume? @xref{Types Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4689
4690 An @dfn{interval form} represents a range of values. While an
4691 error form is best for making statistical estimates, intervals give
4692 you exact bounds on an answer. Suppose we additionally know that
4693 our telephone pole is definitely between 28 and 31 meters away,
4694 and that it is between 7.7 and 8.1 meters tall.
4695
4696 @smallexample
4697 @group
4698 1: [7.7 .. 8.1] 2: [7.7 .. 8.1] 1: [0.24 .. 0.28] 1: [13.9 .. 16.1]
4699 . 1: [28 .. 31] . .
4700 .
4701
4702 [ 7.7 .. 8.1 ] [ 28 .. 31 ] / I T
4703 @end group
4704 @end smallexample
4705
4706 @noindent
4707 If our bounds were correct, then the angle to the top of the pole
4708 is sure to lie in the range shown.
4709
4710 The square brackets around these intervals indicate that the endpoints
4711 themselves are allowable values. In other words, the distance to the
4712 telephone pole is between 28 and 31, @emph{inclusive}. You can also
4713 make an interval that is exclusive of its endpoints by writing
4714 parentheses instead of square brackets. You can even make an interval
4715 which is inclusive (``closed'') on one end and exclusive (``open'') on
4716 the other.
4717
4718 @smallexample
4719 @group
4720 1: [1 .. 10) 1: (0.1 .. 1] 2: (0.1 .. 1] 1: (0.2 .. 3)
4721 . . 1: [2 .. 3) .
4722 .
4723
4724 [ 1 .. 10 ) & [ 2 .. 3 ) *
4725 @end group
4726 @end smallexample
4727
4728 @noindent
4729 The Calculator automatically keeps track of which end values should
4730 be open and which should be closed. You can also make infinite or
4731 semi-infinite intervals by using @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} for one
4732 or both endpoints.
4733
4734 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} What answer would you expect from
4735 @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(0 .. 10)}}? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 0)}}? What
4736 about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{[0 .. 10]}} (where the interval actually includes
4737 zero)? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 10)}}?
4738 @xref{Types Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4739
4740 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} Two easy ways of squaring a number
4741 are @kbd{@key{RET} *} and @w{@kbd{2 ^}}. Normally these produce the same
4742 answer. Would you expect this still to hold true for interval forms?
4743 If not, which of these will result in a larger interval?
4744 @xref{Types Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4745
4746 A @dfn{modulo form} is used for performing arithmetic modulo @var{m}.
4747 For example, arithmetic involving time is generally done modulo 12
4748 or 24 hours.
4749
4750 @smallexample
4751 @group
4752 1: 17 mod 24 1: 3 mod 24 1: 21 mod 24 1: 9 mod 24
4753 . . . .
4754
4755 17 M 24 @key{RET} 10 + n 5 /
4756 @end group
4757 @end smallexample
4758
4759 @noindent
4760 In this last step, Calc has divided by 5 modulo 24; i.e., it has found a
4761 new number which, when multiplied by 5 modulo 24, produces the original
4762 number, 21. If @var{m} is prime and the divisor is not a multiple of
4763 @var{m}, it is always possible to find such a number. For non-prime
4764 @var{m} like 24, it is only sometimes possible.
4765
4766 @smallexample
4767 @group
4768 1: 10 mod 24 1: 16 mod 24 1: 1000000... 1: 16
4769 . . . .
4770
4771 10 M 24 @key{RET} 100 ^ 10 @key{RET} 100 ^ 24 %
4772 @end group
4773 @end smallexample
4774
4775 @noindent
4776 These two calculations get the same answer, but the first one is
4777 much more efficient because it avoids the huge intermediate value
4778 that arises in the second one.
4779
4780 @cindex Fermat, primality test of
4781 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} A theorem of Pierre de Fermat
4782 says that
4783 @texline @w{@math{x^{n-1} \bmod n = 1}}
4784 @infoline @expr{x^(n-1) mod n = 1}
4785 if @expr{n} is a prime number and @expr{x} is an integer less than
4786 @expr{n}. If @expr{n} is @emph{not} a prime number, this will
4787 @emph{not} be true for most values of @expr{x}. Thus we can test
4788 informally if a number is prime by trying this formula for several
4789 values of @expr{x}. Use this test to tell whether the following numbers
4790 are prime: 811749613, 15485863. @xref{Types Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4791
4792 It is possible to use HMS forms as parts of error forms, intervals,
4793 modulo forms, or as the phase part of a polar complex number.
4794 For example, the @code{calc-time} command pushes the current time
4795 of day on the stack as an HMS/modulo form.
4796
4797 @smallexample
4798 @group
4799 1: 17@@ 34' 45" mod 24@@ 0' 0" 1: 6@@ 22' 15" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
4800 . .
4801
4802 x time @key{RET} n
4803 @end group
4804 @end smallexample
4805
4806 @noindent
4807 This calculation tells me it is six hours and 22 minutes until midnight.
4808
4809 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} A rule of thumb is that one year
4810 is about
4811 @texline @math{\pi \times 10^7}
4812 @infoline @w{@expr{pi * 10^7}}
4813 seconds. What time will it be that many seconds from right now?
4814 @xref{Types Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4815
4816 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} You are preparing to order packaging
4817 for the CD release of the Extended Disco Version of @emph{Abbey Road}.
4818 You are told that the songs will actually be anywhere from 20 to 60
4819 seconds longer than the originals. One CD can hold about 75 minutes
4820 of music. Should you order single or double packages?
4821 @xref{Types Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4822
4823 Another kind of data the Calculator can manipulate is numbers with
4824 @dfn{units}. This isn't strictly a new data type; it's simply an
4825 application of algebraic expressions, where we use variables with
4826 suggestive names like @samp{cm} and @samp{in} to represent units
4827 like centimeters and inches.
4828
4829 @smallexample
4830 @group
4831 1: 2 in 1: 5.08 cm 1: 0.027778 fath 1: 0.0508 m
4832 . . . .
4833
4834 ' 2in @key{RET} u c cm @key{RET} u c fath @key{RET} u b
4835 @end group
4836 @end smallexample
4837
4838 @noindent
4839 We enter the quantity ``2 inches'' (actually an algebraic expression
4840 which means two times the variable @samp{in}), then we convert it
4841 first to centimeters, then to fathoms, then finally to ``base'' units,
4842 which in this case means meters.
4843
4844 @smallexample
4845 @group
4846 1: 9 acre 1: 3 sqrt(acre) 1: 190.84 m 1: 190.84 m + 30 cm
4847 . . . .
4848
4849 ' 9 acre @key{RET} Q u s ' $+30 cm @key{RET}
4850
4851 @end group
4852 @end smallexample
4853 @noindent
4854 @smallexample
4855 @group
4856 1: 191.14 m 1: 36536.3046 m^2 1: 365363046 cm^2
4857 . . .
4858
4859 u s 2 ^ u c cgs
4860 @end group
4861 @end smallexample
4862
4863 @noindent
4864 Since units expressions are really just formulas, taking the square
4865 root of @samp{acre} is undefined. After all, @code{acre} might be an
4866 algebraic variable that you will someday assign a value. We use the
4867 ``units-simplify'' command to simplify the expression with variables
4868 being interpreted as unit names.
4869
4870 In the final step, we have converted not to a particular unit, but to a
4871 units system. The ``cgs'' system uses centimeters instead of meters
4872 as its standard unit of length.
4873
4874 There is a wide variety of units defined in the Calculator.
4875
4876 @smallexample
4877 @group
4878 1: 55 mph 1: 88.5139 kph 1: 88.5139 km / hr 1: 8.201407e-8 c
4879 . . . .
4880
4881 ' 55 mph @key{RET} u c kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} u c c @key{RET}
4882 @end group
4883 @end smallexample
4884
4885 @noindent
4886 We express a speed first in miles per hour, then in kilometers per
4887 hour, then again using a slightly more explicit notation, then
4888 finally in terms of fractions of the speed of light.
4889
4890 Temperature conversions are a bit more tricky. There are two ways to
4891 interpret ``20 degrees Fahrenheit''---it could mean an actual
4892 temperature, or it could mean a change in temperature. For normal
4893 units there is no difference, but temperature units have an offset
4894 as well as a scale factor and so there must be two explicit commands
4895 for them.
4896
4897 @smallexample
4898 @group
4899 1: 20 degF 1: 11.1111 degC 1: -20:3 degC 1: -6.666 degC
4900 . . . .
4901
4902 ' 20 degF @key{RET} u c degC @key{RET} U u t degC @key{RET} c f
4903 @end group
4904 @end smallexample
4905
4906 @noindent
4907 First we convert a change of 20 degrees Fahrenheit into an equivalent
4908 change in degrees Celsius (or Centigrade). Then, we convert the
4909 absolute temperature 20 degrees Fahrenheit into Celsius. Since
4910 this comes out as an exact fraction, we then convert to floating-point
4911 for easier comparison with the other result.
4912
4913 For simple unit conversions, you can put a plain number on the stack.
4914 Then @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u t} will prompt for both old and new units.
4915 When you use this method, you're responsible for remembering which
4916 numbers are in which units:
4917
4918 @smallexample
4919 @group
4920 1: 55 1: 88.5139 1: 8.201407e-8
4921 . . .
4922
4923 55 u c mph @key{RET} kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} c @key{RET}
4924 @end group
4925 @end smallexample
4926
4927 To see a complete list of built-in units, type @kbd{u v}. Press
4928 @w{@kbd{M-# c}} again to re-enter the Calculator when you're done looking
4929 at the units table.
4930
4931 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} How many seconds are there really
4932 in a year? @xref{Types Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4933
4934 @cindex Speed of light
4935 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} Supercomputer designs are limited by
4936 the speed of light (and of electricity, which is nearly as fast).
4937 Suppose a computer has a 4.1 ns (nanosecond) clock cycle, and its
4938 cabinet is one meter across. Is speed of light going to be a
4939 significant factor in its design? @xref{Types Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4940
4941 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 15.} Sam the Slug normally travels about
4942 five yards in an hour. He has obtained a supply of Power Pills; each
4943 Power Pill he eats doubles his speed. How many Power Pills can he
4944 swallow and still travel legally on most US highways?
4945 @xref{Types Answer 15, 15}. (@bullet{})
4946
4947 @node Algebra Tutorial, Programming Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Tutorial
4948 @section Algebra and Calculus Tutorial
4949
4950 @noindent
4951 This section shows how to use Calc's algebra facilities to solve
4952 equations, do simple calculus problems, and manipulate algebraic
4953 formulas.
4954
4955 @menu
4956 * Basic Algebra Tutorial::
4957 * Rewrites Tutorial::
4958 @end menu
4959
4960 @node Basic Algebra Tutorial, Rewrites Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
4961 @subsection Basic Algebra
4962
4963 @noindent
4964 If you enter a formula in Algebraic mode that refers to variables,
4965 the formula itself is pushed onto the stack. You can manipulate
4966 formulas as regular data objects.
4967
4968 @smallexample
4969 @group
4970 1: 2 x^2 - 6 1: 6 - 2 x^2 1: (6 - 2 x^2) (3 x^2 + y)
4971 . . .
4972
4973 ' 2x^2-6 @key{RET} n ' 3x^2+y @key{RET} *
4974 @end group
4975 @end smallexample
4976
4977 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Do @kbd{' x @key{RET} Q 2 ^} and
4978 @kbd{' x @key{RET} 2 ^ Q} both wind up with the same result (@samp{x})?
4979 Why or why not? @xref{Algebra Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4980
4981 There are also commands for doing common algebraic operations on
4982 formulas. Continuing with the formula from the last example,
4983
4984 @smallexample
4985 @group
4986 1: 18 x^2 + 6 y - 6 x^4 - 2 x^2 y 1: (18 - 2 y) x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y
4987 . .
4988
4989 a x a c x @key{RET}
4990 @end group
4991 @end smallexample
4992
4993 @noindent
4994 First we ``expand'' using the distributive law, then we ``collect''
4995 terms involving like powers of @expr{x}.
4996
4997 Let's find the value of this expression when @expr{x} is 2 and @expr{y}
4998 is one-half.
4999
5000 @smallexample
5001 @group
5002 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: -25
5003 . .
5004
5005 1:2 s l y @key{RET} 2 s l x @key{RET}
5006 @end group
5007 @end smallexample
5008
5009 @noindent
5010 The @kbd{s l} command means ``let''; it takes a number from the top of
5011 the stack and temporarily assigns it as the value of the variable
5012 you specify. It then evaluates (as if by the @kbd{=} key) the
5013 next expression on the stack. After this command, the variable goes
5014 back to its original value, if any.
5015
5016 (An earlier exercise in this tutorial involved storing a value in the
5017 variable @code{x}; if this value is still there, you will have to
5018 unstore it with @kbd{s u x @key{RET}} before the above example will work
5019 properly.)
5020
5021 @cindex Maximum of a function using Calculus
5022 Let's find the maximum value of our original expression when @expr{y}
5023 is one-half and @expr{x} ranges over all possible values. We can
5024 do this by taking the derivative with respect to @expr{x} and examining
5025 values of @expr{x} for which the derivative is zero. If the second
5026 derivative of the function at that value of @expr{x} is negative,
5027 the function has a local maximum there.
5028
5029 @smallexample
5030 @group
5031 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
5032 . .
5033
5034 U @key{DEL} s 1 a d x @key{RET} s 2
5035 @end group
5036 @end smallexample
5037
5038 @noindent
5039 Well, the derivative is clearly zero when @expr{x} is zero. To find
5040 the other root(s), let's divide through by @expr{x} and then solve:
5041
5042 @smallexample
5043 @group
5044 1: (34 x - 24 x^3) / x 1: 34 x / x - 24 x^3 / x 1: 34 - 24 x^2
5045 . . .
5046
5047 ' x @key{RET} / a x a s
5048
5049 @end group
5050 @end smallexample
5051 @noindent
5052 @smallexample
5053 @group
5054 1: 34 - 24 x^2 = 0 1: x = 1.19023
5055 . .
5056
5057 0 a = s 3 a S x @key{RET}
5058 @end group
5059 @end smallexample
5060
5061 @noindent
5062 Notice the use of @kbd{a s} to ``simplify'' the formula. When the
5063 default algebraic simplifications don't do enough, you can use
5064 @kbd{a s} to tell Calc to spend more time on the job.
5065
5066 Now we compute the second derivative and plug in our values of @expr{x}:
5067
5068 @smallexample
5069 @group
5070 1: 1.19023 2: 1.19023 2: 1.19023
5071 . 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: 34 - 72 x^2
5072 . .
5073
5074 a . r 2 a d x @key{RET} s 4
5075 @end group
5076 @end smallexample
5077
5078 @noindent
5079 (The @kbd{a .} command extracts just the righthand side of an equation.
5080 Another method would have been to use @kbd{v u} to unpack the equation
5081 @w{@samp{x = 1.19}} to @samp{x} and @samp{1.19}, then use @kbd{M-- M-2 @key{DEL}}
5082 to delete the @samp{x}.)
5083
5084 @smallexample
5085 @group
5086 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: -68. 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: 34
5087 1: 1.19023 . 1: 0 .
5088 . .
5089
5090 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET} U @key{DEL} 0 s l x @key{RET}
5091 @end group
5092 @end smallexample
5093
5094 @noindent
5095 The first of these second derivatives is negative, so we know the function
5096 has a maximum value at @expr{x = 1.19023}. (The function also has a
5097 local @emph{minimum} at @expr{x = 0}.)
5098
5099 When we solved for @expr{x}, we got only one value even though
5100 @expr{34 - 24 x^2 = 0} is a quadratic equation that ought to have
5101 two solutions. The reason is that @w{@kbd{a S}} normally returns a
5102 single ``principal'' solution. If it needs to come up with an
5103 arbitrary sign (as occurs in the quadratic formula) it picks @expr{+}.
5104 If it needs an arbitrary integer, it picks zero. We can get a full
5105 solution by pressing @kbd{H} (the Hyperbolic flag) before @kbd{a S}.
5106
5107 @smallexample
5108 @group
5109 1: 34 - 24 x^2 = 0 1: x = 1.19023 s1 1: x = -1.19023
5110 . . .
5111
5112 r 3 H a S x @key{RET} s 5 1 n s l s1 @key{RET}
5113 @end group
5114 @end smallexample
5115
5116 @noindent
5117 Calc has invented the variable @samp{s1} to represent an unknown sign;
5118 it is supposed to be either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}. Here we have used
5119 the ``let'' command to evaluate the expression when the sign is negative.
5120 If we plugged this into our second derivative we would get the same,
5121 negative, answer, so @expr{x = -1.19023} is also a maximum.
5122
5123 To find the actual maximum value, we must plug our two values of @expr{x}
5124 into the original formula.
5125
5126 @smallexample
5127 @group
5128 2: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 24.08333 s1^2 - 12.04166 s1^4 + 3
5129 1: x = 1.19023 s1 .
5130 .
5131
5132 r 1 r 5 s l @key{RET}
5133 @end group
5134 @end smallexample
5135
5136 @noindent
5137 (Here we see another way to use @kbd{s l}; if its input is an equation
5138 with a variable on the lefthand side, then @kbd{s l} treats the equation
5139 like an assignment to that variable if you don't give a variable name.)
5140
5141 It's clear that this will have the same value for either sign of
5142 @code{s1}, but let's work it out anyway, just for the exercise:
5143
5144 @smallexample
5145 @group
5146 2: [-1, 1] 1: [15.04166, 15.04166]
5147 1: 24.08333 s1^2 ... .
5148 .
5149
5150 [ 1 n , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
5151 @end group
5152 @end smallexample
5153
5154 @noindent
5155 Here we have used a vector mapping operation to evaluate the function
5156 at several values of @samp{s1} at once. @kbd{V M $} is like @kbd{V M '}
5157 except that it takes the formula from the top of the stack. The
5158 formula is interpreted as a function to apply across the vector at the
5159 next-to-top stack level. Since a formula on the stack can't contain
5160 @samp{$} signs, Calc assumes the variables in the formula stand for
5161 different arguments. It prompts you for an @dfn{argument list}, giving
5162 the list of all variables in the formula in alphabetical order as the
5163 default list. In this case the default is @samp{(s1)}, which is just
5164 what we want so we simply press @key{RET} at the prompt.
5165
5166 If there had been several different values, we could have used
5167 @w{@kbd{V R X}} to find the global maximum.
5168
5169 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a P} command that solves an equation using
5170 @w{@kbd{H a S}} and returns a vector of all the solutions. It simply
5171 automates the job we just did by hand. Applied to our original
5172 cubic polynomial, it would produce the vector of solutions
5173 @expr{[1.19023, -1.19023, 0]}. (There is also an @kbd{a X} command
5174 which finds a local maximum of a function. It uses a numerical search
5175 method rather than examining the derivatives, and thus requires you
5176 to provide some kind of initial guess to show it where to look.)
5177
5178 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Given a vector of the roots of a
5179 polynomial (such as the output of an @kbd{a P} command), what
5180 sequence of commands would you use to reconstruct the original
5181 polynomial? (The answer will be unique to within a constant
5182 multiple; choose the solution where the leading coefficient is one.)
5183 @xref{Algebra Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5184
5185 The @kbd{m s} command enables Symbolic mode, in which formulas
5186 like @samp{sqrt(5)} that can't be evaluated exactly are left in
5187 symbolic form rather than giving a floating-point approximate answer.
5188 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}) is also useful when doing algebra.
5189
5190 @smallexample
5191 @group
5192 2: 34 x - 24 x^3 2: 34 x - 24 x^3
5193 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0]
5194 . .
5195
5196 r 2 @key{RET} m s m f a P x @key{RET}
5197 @end group
5198 @end smallexample
5199
5200 One more mode that makes reading formulas easier is Big mode.
5201
5202 @smallexample
5203 @group
5204 3
5205 2: 34 x - 24 x
5206
5207 ____ ____
5208 V 51 V 51
5209 1: [-----, -----, 0]
5210 6 -6
5211
5212 .
5213
5214 d B
5215 @end group
5216 @end smallexample
5217
5218 Here things like powers, square roots, and quotients and fractions
5219 are displayed in a two-dimensional pictorial form. Calc has other
5220 language modes as well, such as C mode, FORTRAN mode, @TeX{} mode
5221 and La@TeX{} mode.
5222
5223 @smallexample
5224 @group
5225 2: 34*x - 24*pow(x, 3) 2: 34*x - 24*x**3
5226 1: @{sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0@} 1: /sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0/
5227 . .
5228
5229 d C d F
5230
5231 @end group
5232 @end smallexample
5233 @noindent
5234 @smallexample
5235 @group
5236 3: 34 x - 24 x^3
5237 2: [@{\sqrt@{51@} \over 6@}, @{\sqrt@{51@} \over -6@}, 0]
5238 1: @{2 \over 3@} \sqrt@{5@}
5239 .
5240
5241 d T ' 2 \sqrt@{5@} \over 3 @key{RET}
5242 @end group
5243 @end smallexample
5244
5245 @noindent
5246 As you can see, language modes affect both entry and display of
5247 formulas. They affect such things as the names used for built-in
5248 functions, the set of arithmetic operators and their precedences,
5249 and notations for vectors and matrices.
5250
5251 Notice that @samp{sqrt(51)} may cause problems with older
5252 implementations of C and FORTRAN, which would require something more
5253 like @samp{sqrt(51.0)}. It is always wise to check over the formulas
5254 produced by the various language modes to make sure they are fully
5255 correct.
5256
5257 Type @kbd{m s}, @kbd{m f}, and @kbd{d N} to reset these modes. (You
5258 may prefer to remain in Big mode, but all the examples in the tutorial
5259 are shown in normal mode.)
5260
5261 @cindex Area under a curve
5262 What is the area under the portion of this curve from @expr{x = 1} to @expr{2}?
5263 This is simply the integral of the function:
5264
5265 @smallexample
5266 @group
5267 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 5.6666 x^3 - 1.2 x^5 + 3 x
5268 . .
5269
5270 r 1 a i x
5271 @end group
5272 @end smallexample
5273
5274 @noindent
5275 We want to evaluate this at our two values for @expr{x} and subtract.
5276 One way to do it is again with vector mapping and reduction:
5277
5278 @smallexample
5279 @group
5280 2: [2, 1] 1: [12.93333, 7.46666] 1: 5.46666
5281 1: 5.6666 x^3 ... . .
5282
5283 [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5284 @end group
5285 @end smallexample
5286
5287 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Find the integral from 1 to @expr{y}
5288 of
5289 @texline @math{x \sin \pi x}
5290 @infoline @w{@expr{x sin(pi x)}}
5291 (where the sine is calculated in radians). Find the values of the
5292 integral for integers @expr{y} from 1 to 5. @xref{Algebra Answer 3,
5293 3}. (@bullet{})
5294
5295 Calc's integrator can do many simple integrals symbolically, but many
5296 others are beyond its capabilities. Suppose we wish to find the area
5297 under the curve
5298 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5299 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5300 over the same range of @expr{x}. If you entered this formula and typed
5301 @kbd{a i x @key{RET}} (don't bother to try this), Calc would work for a
5302 long time but would be unable to find a solution. In fact, there is no
5303 closed-form solution to this integral. Now what do we do?
5304
5305 @cindex Integration, numerical
5306 @cindex Numerical integration
5307 One approach would be to do the integral numerically. It is not hard
5308 to do this by hand using vector mapping and reduction. It is rather
5309 slow, though, since the sine and logarithm functions take a long time.
5310 We can save some time by reducing the working precision.
5311
5312 @smallexample
5313 @group
5314 3: 10 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9]
5315 2: 1 .
5316 1: 0.1
5317 .
5318
5319 10 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
5320 @end group
5321 @end smallexample
5322
5323 @noindent
5324 (Note that we have used the extended version of @kbd{v x}; we could
5325 also have used plain @kbd{v x} as follows: @kbd{v x 10 @key{RET} 9 + .1 *}.)
5326
5327 @smallexample
5328 @group
5329 2: [1, 1.1, ... ] 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
5330 1: sin(x) ln(x) .
5331 .
5332
5333 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} s 1 m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
5334
5335 @end group
5336 @end smallexample
5337 @noindent
5338 @smallexample
5339 @group
5340 1: 3.4195 0.34195
5341 . .
5342
5343 V R + 0.1 *
5344 @end group
5345 @end smallexample
5346
5347 @noindent
5348 (If you got wildly different results, did you remember to switch
5349 to Radians mode?)
5350
5351 Here we have divided the curve into ten segments of equal width;
5352 approximating these segments as rectangular boxes (i.e., assuming
5353 the curve is nearly flat at that resolution), we compute the areas
5354 of the boxes (height times width), then sum the areas. (It is
5355 faster to sum first, then multiply by the width, since the width
5356 is the same for every box.)
5357
5358 The true value of this integral turns out to be about 0.374, so
5359 we're not doing too well. Let's try another approach.
5360
5361 @smallexample
5362 @group
5363 1: sin(x) ln(x) 1: 0.84147 x - 0.84147 + 0.11957 (x - 1)^2 - ...
5364 . .
5365
5366 r 1 a t x=1 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET}
5367 @end group
5368 @end smallexample
5369
5370 @noindent
5371 Here we have computed the Taylor series expansion of the function
5372 about the point @expr{x=1}. We can now integrate this polynomial
5373 approximation, since polynomials are easy to integrate.
5374
5375 @smallexample
5376 @group
5377 1: 0.42074 x^2 + ... 1: [-0.0446, -0.42073] 1: 0.3761
5378 . . .
5379
5380 a i x @key{RET} [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5381 @end group
5382 @end smallexample
5383
5384 @noindent
5385 Better! By increasing the precision and/or asking for more terms
5386 in the Taylor series, we can get a result as accurate as we like.
5387 (Taylor series converge better away from singularities in the
5388 function such as the one at @code{ln(0)}, so it would also help to
5389 expand the series about the points @expr{x=2} or @expr{x=1.5} instead
5390 of @expr{x=1}.)
5391
5392 @cindex Simpson's rule
5393 @cindex Integration by Simpson's rule
5394 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Our first method approximated the
5395 curve by stairsteps of width 0.1; the total area was then the sum
5396 of the areas of the rectangles under these stairsteps. Our second
5397 method approximated the function by a polynomial, which turned out
5398 to be a better approximation than stairsteps. A third method is
5399 @dfn{Simpson's rule}, which is like the stairstep method except
5400 that the steps are not required to be flat. Simpson's rule boils
5401 down to the formula,
5402
5403 @ifinfo
5404 @example
5405 (h/3) * (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + ...
5406 + 2 f(a+(n-2)*h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)*h) + f(a+n*h))
5407 @end example
5408 @end ifinfo
5409 @tex
5410 \turnoffactive
5411 \beforedisplay
5412 $$ \displaylines{
5413 \qquad {h \over 3} (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + \cdots
5414 \hfill \cr \hfill {} + 2 f(a+(n-2)h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)h) + f(a+n h)) \qquad
5415 } $$
5416 \afterdisplay
5417 @end tex
5418
5419 @noindent
5420 where @expr{n} (which must be even) is the number of slices and @expr{h}
5421 is the width of each slice. These are 10 and 0.1 in our example.
5422 For reference, here is the corresponding formula for the stairstep
5423 method:
5424
5425 @ifinfo
5426 @example
5427 h * (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + ...
5428 + f(a+(n-2)*h) + f(a+(n-1)*h))
5429 @end example
5430 @end ifinfo
5431 @tex
5432 \turnoffactive
5433 \beforedisplay
5434 $$ h (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + \cdots
5435 + f(a+(n-2)h) + f(a+(n-1)h)) $$
5436 \afterdisplay
5437 @end tex
5438
5439 Compute the integral from 1 to 2 of
5440 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5441 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5442 using Simpson's rule with 10 slices.
5443 @xref{Algebra Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5444
5445 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a I} command for doing numerical integration.
5446 It uses @dfn{Romberg's method}, which is a more sophisticated cousin
5447 of Simpson's rule. In particular, it knows how to keep refining the
5448 result until the current precision is satisfied.
5449
5450 @c [fix-ref Selecting Sub-Formulas]
5451 Aside from the commands we've seen so far, Calc also provides a
5452 large set of commands for operating on parts of formulas. You
5453 indicate the desired sub-formula by placing the cursor on any part
5454 of the formula before giving a @dfn{selection} command. Selections won't
5455 be covered in the tutorial; @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}, for
5456 details and examples.
5457
5458 @c hard exercise: simplify (2^(n r) - 2^(r*(n - 1))) / (2^r - 1) 2^(n - 1)
5459 @c to 2^((n-1)*(r-1)).
5460
5461 @node Rewrites Tutorial, , Basic Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
5462 @subsection Rewrite Rules
5463
5464 @noindent
5465 No matter how many built-in commands Calc provided for doing algebra,
5466 there would always be something you wanted to do that Calc didn't have
5467 in its repertoire. So Calc also provides a @dfn{rewrite rule} system
5468 that you can use to define your own algebraic manipulations.
5469
5470 Suppose we want to simplify this trigonometric formula:
5471
5472 @smallexample
5473 @group
5474 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x)
5475 .
5476
5477 ' 1/cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) @key{RET} s 1
5478 @end group
5479 @end smallexample
5480
5481 @noindent
5482 If we were simplifying this by hand, we'd probably replace the
5483 @samp{tan} with a @samp{sin/cos} first, then combine over a common
5484 denominator. There is no Calc command to do the former; the @kbd{a n}
5485 algebra command will do the latter but we'll do both with rewrite
5486 rules just for practice.
5487
5488 Rewrite rules are written with the @samp{:=} symbol.
5489
5490 @smallexample
5491 @group
5492 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x)^2 / cos(x)
5493 .
5494
5495 a r tan(a) := sin(a)/cos(a) @key{RET}
5496 @end group
5497 @end smallexample
5498
5499 @noindent
5500 (The ``assignment operator'' @samp{:=} has several uses in Calc. All
5501 by itself the formula @samp{tan(a) := sin(a)/cos(a)} doesn't do anything,
5502 but when it is given to the @kbd{a r} command, that command interprets
5503 it as a rewrite rule.)
5504
5505 The lefthand side, @samp{tan(a)}, is called the @dfn{pattern} of the
5506 rewrite rule. Calc searches the formula on the stack for parts that
5507 match the pattern. Variables in a rewrite pattern are called
5508 @dfn{meta-variables}, and when matching the pattern each meta-variable
5509 can match any sub-formula. Here, the meta-variable @samp{a} matched
5510 the actual variable @samp{x}.
5511
5512 When the pattern part of a rewrite rule matches a part of the formula,
5513 that part is replaced by the righthand side with all the meta-variables
5514 substituted with the things they matched. So the result is
5515 @samp{sin(x) / cos(x)}. Calc's normal algebraic simplifications then
5516 mix this in with the rest of the original formula.
5517
5518 To merge over a common denominator, we can use another simple rule:
5519
5520 @smallexample
5521 @group
5522 1: (1 - sin(x)^2) / cos(x)
5523 .
5524
5525 a r a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET}
5526 @end group
5527 @end smallexample
5528
5529 This rule points out several interesting features of rewrite patterns.
5530 First, if a meta-variable appears several times in a pattern, it must
5531 match the same thing everywhere. This rule detects common denominators
5532 because the same meta-variable @samp{x} is used in both of the
5533 denominators.
5534
5535 Second, meta-variable names are independent from variables in the
5536 target formula. Notice that the meta-variable @samp{x} here matches
5537 the subformula @samp{cos(x)}; Calc never confuses the two meanings of
5538 @samp{x}.
5539
5540 And third, rewrite patterns know a little bit about the algebraic
5541 properties of formulas. The pattern called for a sum of two quotients;
5542 Calc was able to match a difference of two quotients by matching
5543 @samp{a = 1}, @samp{b = -sin(x)^2}, and @samp{x = cos(x)}.
5544
5545 @c [fix-ref Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules]
5546 We could just as easily have written @samp{a/x - b/x := (a-b)/x} for
5547 the rule. It would have worked just the same in all cases. (If we
5548 really wanted the rule to apply only to @samp{+} or only to @samp{-},
5549 we could have used the @code{plain} symbol. @xref{Algebraic Properties
5550 of Rewrite Rules}, for some examples of this.)
5551
5552 One more rewrite will complete the job. We want to use the identity
5553 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}, but of course we must first rearrange
5554 the identity in a way that matches our formula. The obvious rule
5555 would be @samp{@w{1 - sin(x)^2} := cos(x)^2}, but a little thought shows
5556 that the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2} will also work. The
5557 latter rule has a more general pattern so it will work in many other
5558 situations, too.
5559
5560 @smallexample
5561 @group
5562 1: (1 + cos(x)^2 - 1) / cos(x) 1: cos(x)
5563 . .
5564
5565 a r sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2 @key{RET} a s
5566 @end group
5567 @end smallexample
5568
5569 You may ask, what's the point of using the most general rule if you
5570 have to type it in every time anyway? The answer is that Calc allows
5571 you to store a rewrite rule in a variable, then give the variable
5572 name in the @kbd{a r} command. In fact, this is the preferred way to
5573 use rewrites. For one, if you need a rule once you'll most likely
5574 need it again later. Also, if the rule doesn't work quite right you
5575 can simply Undo, edit the variable, and run the rule again without
5576 having to retype it.
5577
5578 @smallexample
5579 @group
5580 ' tan(x) := sin(x)/cos(x) @key{RET} s t tsc @key{RET}
5581 ' a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET} s t merge @key{RET}
5582 ' sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2 @key{RET} s t sinsqr @key{RET}
5583
5584 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) 1: cos(x)
5585 . .
5586
5587 r 1 a r tsc @key{RET} a r merge @key{RET} a r sinsqr @key{RET} a s
5588 @end group
5589 @end smallexample
5590
5591 To edit a variable, type @kbd{s e} and the variable name, use regular
5592 Emacs editing commands as necessary, then type @kbd{C-c C-c} to store
5593 the edited value back into the variable.
5594 You can also use @w{@kbd{s e}} to create a new variable if you wish.
5595
5596 Notice that the first time you use each rule, Calc puts up a ``compiling''
5597 message briefly. The pattern matcher converts rules into a special
5598 optimized pattern-matching language rather than using them directly.
5599 This allows @kbd{a r} to apply even rather complicated rules very
5600 efficiently. If the rule is stored in a variable, Calc compiles it
5601 only once and stores the compiled form along with the variable. That's
5602 another good reason to store your rules in variables rather than
5603 entering them on the fly.
5604
5605 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Type @kbd{m s} to get Symbolic
5606 mode, then enter the formula @samp{@w{(2 + sqrt(2))} / @w{(1 + sqrt(2))}}.
5607 Using a rewrite rule, simplify this formula by multiplying both
5608 sides by the conjugate @w{@samp{1 - sqrt(2)}}. The result will have
5609 to be expanded by the distributive law; do this with another
5610 rewrite. @xref{Rewrites Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5611
5612 The @kbd{a r} command can also accept a vector of rewrite rules, or
5613 a variable containing a vector of rules.
5614
5615 @smallexample
5616 @group
5617 1: [tsc, merge, sinsqr] 1: [tan(x) := sin(x) / cos(x), ... ]
5618 . .
5619
5620 ' [tsc,merge,sinsqr] @key{RET} =
5621
5622 @end group
5623 @end smallexample
5624 @noindent
5625 @smallexample
5626 @group
5627 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) 1: cos(x)
5628 . .
5629
5630 s t trig @key{RET} r 1 a r trig @key{RET} a s
5631 @end group
5632 @end smallexample
5633
5634 @c [fix-ref Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules]
5635 Calc tries all the rules you give against all parts of the formula,
5636 repeating until no further change is possible. (The exact order in
5637 which things are tried is rather complex, but for simple rules like
5638 the ones we've used here the order doesn't really matter.
5639 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.)
5640
5641 Calc actually repeats only up to 100 times, just in case your rule set
5642 has gotten into an infinite loop. You can give a numeric prefix argument
5643 to @kbd{a r} to specify any limit. In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} does
5644 only one rewrite at a time.
5645
5646 @smallexample
5647 @group
5648 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x)^2 / cos(x) 1: (1 - sin(x)^2) / cos(x)
5649 . .
5650
5651 r 1 M-1 a r trig @key{RET} M-1 a r trig @key{RET}
5652 @end group
5653 @end smallexample
5654
5655 You can type @kbd{M-0 a r} if you want no limit at all on the number
5656 of rewrites that occur.
5657
5658 Rewrite rules can also be @dfn{conditional}. Simply follow the rule
5659 with a @samp{::} symbol and the desired condition. For example,
5660
5661 @smallexample
5662 @group
5663 1: exp(2 pi i) + exp(3 pi i) + exp(4 pi i)
5664 .
5665
5666 ' exp(2 pi i) + exp(3 pi i) + exp(4 pi i) @key{RET}
5667
5668 @end group
5669 @end smallexample
5670 @noindent
5671 @smallexample
5672 @group
5673 1: 1 + exp(3 pi i) + 1
5674 .
5675
5676 a r exp(k pi i) := 1 :: k % 2 = 0 @key{RET}
5677 @end group
5678 @end smallexample
5679
5680 @noindent
5681 (Recall, @samp{k % 2} is the remainder from dividing @samp{k} by 2,
5682 which will be zero only when @samp{k} is an even integer.)
5683
5684 An interesting point is that the variables @samp{pi} and @samp{i}
5685 were matched literally rather than acting as meta-variables.
5686 This is because they are special-constant variables. The special
5687 constants @samp{e}, @samp{phi}, and so on also match literally.
5688 A common error with rewrite
5689 rules is to write, say, @samp{f(a,b,c,d,e) := g(a+b+c+d+e)}, expecting
5690 to match any @samp{f} with five arguments but in fact matching
5691 only when the fifth argument is literally @samp{e}!
5692
5693 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5694 @ignore
5695 @starindex
5696 @end ignore
5697 @tindex fib
5698 Rewrite rules provide an interesting way to define your own functions.
5699 Suppose we want to define @samp{fib(n)} to produce the @var{n}th
5700 Fibonacci number. The first two Fibonacci numbers are each 1;
5701 later numbers are formed by summing the two preceding numbers in
5702 the sequence. This is easy to express in a set of three rules:
5703
5704 @smallexample
5705 @group
5706 ' [fib(1) := 1, fib(2) := 1, fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2)] @key{RET} s t fib
5707
5708 1: fib(7) 1: 13
5709 . .
5710
5711 ' fib(7) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5712 @end group
5713 @end smallexample
5714
5715 One thing that is guaranteed about the order that rewrites are tried
5716 is that, for any given subformula, earlier rules in the rule set will
5717 be tried for that subformula before later ones. So even though the
5718 first and third rules both match @samp{fib(1)}, we know the first will
5719 be used preferentially.
5720
5721 This rule set has one dangerous bug: Suppose we apply it to the
5722 formula @samp{fib(x)}? (Don't actually try this.) The third rule
5723 will match @samp{fib(x)} and replace it with @w{@samp{fib(x-1) + fib(x-2)}}.
5724 Each of these will then be replaced to get @samp{fib(x-2) + 2 fib(x-3) +
5725 fib(x-4)}, and so on, expanding forever. What we really want is to apply
5726 the third rule only when @samp{n} is an integer greater than two. Type
5727 @w{@kbd{s e fib @key{RET}}}, then edit the third rule to:
5728
5729 @smallexample
5730 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2
5731 @end smallexample
5732
5733 @noindent
5734 Now:
5735
5736 @smallexample
5737 @group
5738 1: fib(6) + fib(x) + fib(0) 1: 8 + fib(x) + fib(0)
5739 . .
5740
5741 ' fib(6)+fib(x)+fib(0) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5742 @end group
5743 @end smallexample
5744
5745 @noindent
5746 We've created a new function, @code{fib}, and a new command,
5747 @w{@kbd{a r fib @key{RET}}}, which means ``evaluate all @code{fib} calls in
5748 this formula.'' To make things easier still, we can tell Calc to
5749 apply these rules automatically by storing them in the special
5750 variable @code{EvalRules}.
5751
5752 @smallexample
5753 @group
5754 1: [fib(1) := ...] . 1: [8, 13]
5755 . .
5756
5757 s r fib @key{RET} s t EvalRules @key{RET} ' [fib(6), fib(7)] @key{RET}
5758 @end group
5759 @end smallexample
5760
5761 It turns out that this rule set has the problem that it does far
5762 more work than it needs to when @samp{n} is large. Consider the
5763 first few steps of the computation of @samp{fib(6)}:
5764
5765 @smallexample
5766 @group
5767 fib(6) =
5768 fib(5) + fib(4) =
5769 fib(4) + fib(3) + fib(3) + fib(2) =
5770 fib(3) + fib(2) + fib(2) + fib(1) + fib(2) + fib(1) + 1 = ...
5771 @end group
5772 @end smallexample
5773
5774 @noindent
5775 Note that @samp{fib(3)} appears three times here. Unless Calc's
5776 algebraic simplifier notices the multiple @samp{fib(3)}s and combines
5777 them (and, as it happens, it doesn't), this rule set does lots of
5778 needless recomputation. To cure the problem, type @code{s e EvalRules}
5779 to edit the rules (or just @kbd{s E}, a shorthand command for editing
5780 @code{EvalRules}) and add another condition:
5781
5782 @smallexample
5783 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2 :: remember
5784 @end smallexample
5785
5786 @noindent
5787 If a @samp{:: remember} condition appears anywhere in a rule, then if
5788 that rule succeeds Calc will add another rule that describes that match
5789 to the front of the rule set. (Remembering works in any rule set, but
5790 for technical reasons it is most effective in @code{EvalRules}.) For
5791 example, if the rule rewrites @samp{fib(7)} to something that evaluates
5792 to 13, then the rule @samp{fib(7) := 13} will be added to the rule set.
5793
5794 Type @kbd{' fib(8) @key{RET}} to compute the eighth Fibonacci number, then
5795 type @kbd{s E} again to see what has happened to the rule set.
5796
5797 With the @code{remember} feature, our rule set can now compute
5798 @samp{fib(@var{n})} in just @var{n} steps. In the process it builds
5799 up a table of all Fibonacci numbers up to @var{n}. After we have
5800 computed the result for a particular @var{n}, we can get it back
5801 (and the results for all smaller @var{n}) later in just one step.
5802
5803 All Calc operations will run somewhat slower whenever @code{EvalRules}
5804 contains any rules. You should type @kbd{s u EvalRules @key{RET}} now to
5805 un-store the variable.
5806
5807 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Sometimes it is possible to reformulate
5808 a problem to reduce the amount of recursion necessary to solve it.
5809 Create a rule that, in about @var{n} simple steps and without recourse
5810 to the @code{remember} option, replaces @samp{fib(@var{n}, 1, 1)} with
5811 @samp{fib(1, @var{x}, @var{y})} where @var{x} and @var{y} are the
5812 @var{n}th and @var{n+1}st Fibonacci numbers, respectively. This rule is
5813 rather clunky to use, so add a couple more rules to make the ``user
5814 interface'' the same as for our first version: enter @samp{fib(@var{n})},
5815 get back a plain number. @xref{Rewrites Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5816
5817 There are many more things that rewrites can do. For example, there
5818 are @samp{&&&} and @samp{|||} pattern operators that create ``and''
5819 and ``or'' combinations of rules. As one really simple example, we
5820 could combine our first two Fibonacci rules thusly:
5821
5822 @example
5823 [fib(1 ||| 2) := 1, fib(n) := ... ]
5824 @end example
5825
5826 @noindent
5827 That means ``@code{fib} of something matching either 1 or 2 rewrites
5828 to 1.''
5829
5830 You can also make meta-variables optional by enclosing them in @code{opt}.
5831 For example, the pattern @samp{a + b x} matches @samp{2 + 3 x} but not
5832 @samp{2 + x} or @samp{3 x} or @samp{x}. The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x}
5833 matches all of these forms, filling in a default of zero for @samp{a}
5834 and one for @samp{b}.
5835
5836 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe had @samp{2 + 3 x}
5837 on the stack and tried to use the rule
5838 @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x := f(a, b, x)}. What happened?
5839 @xref{Rewrites Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5840
5841 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Starting with a positive integer @expr{a},
5842 divide @expr{a} by two if it is even, otherwise compute @expr{3 a + 1}.
5843 Now repeat this step over and over. A famous unproved conjecture
5844 is that for any starting @expr{a}, the sequence always eventually
5845 reaches 1. Given the formula @samp{seq(@var{a}, 0)}, write a set of
5846 rules that convert this into @samp{seq(1, @var{n})} where @var{n}
5847 is the number of steps it took the sequence to reach the value 1.
5848 Now enhance the rules to accept @samp{seq(@var{a})} as a starting
5849 configuration, and to stop with just the number @var{n} by itself.
5850 Now make the result be a vector of values in the sequence, from @var{a}
5851 to 1. (The formula @samp{@var{x}|@var{y}} appends the vectors @var{x}
5852 and @var{y}.) For example, rewriting @samp{seq(6)} should yield the
5853 vector @expr{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
5854 @xref{Rewrites Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5855
5856 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} Define, using rewrite rules, a function
5857 @samp{nterms(@var{x})} that returns the number of terms in the sum
5858 @var{x}, or 1 if @var{x} is not a sum. (A @dfn{sum} for our purposes
5859 is one or more non-sum terms separated by @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
5860 so that @expr{2 - 3 (x + y) + x y} is a sum of three terms.)
5861 @xref{Rewrites Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5862
5863 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} A Taylor series for a function is an
5864 infinite series that exactly equals the value of that function at
5865 values of @expr{x} near zero.
5866
5867 @ifinfo
5868 @example
5869 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + x^4 / 4! - x^6 / 6! + ...
5870 @end example
5871 @end ifinfo
5872 @tex
5873 \turnoffactive
5874 \beforedisplay
5875 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + {x^4 \over 4!} - {x^6 \over 6!} + \cdots $$
5876 \afterdisplay
5877 @end tex
5878
5879 The @kbd{a t} command produces a @dfn{truncated Taylor series} which
5880 is obtained by dropping all the terms higher than, say, @expr{x^2}.
5881 Calc represents the truncated Taylor series as a polynomial in @expr{x}.
5882 Mathematicians often write a truncated series using a ``big-O'' notation
5883 that records what was the lowest term that was truncated.
5884
5885 @ifinfo
5886 @example
5887 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + O(x^3)
5888 @end example
5889 @end ifinfo
5890 @tex
5891 \turnoffactive
5892 \beforedisplay
5893 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + O(x^3) $$
5894 \afterdisplay
5895 @end tex
5896
5897 @noindent
5898 The meaning of @expr{O(x^3)} is ``a quantity which is negligibly small
5899 if @expr{x^3} is considered negligibly small as @expr{x} goes to zero.''
5900
5901 The exercise is to create rewrite rules that simplify sums and products of
5902 power series represented as @samp{@var{polynomial} + O(@var{var}^@var{n})}.
5903 For example, given @samp{1 - x^2 / 2 + O(x^3)} and @samp{x - x^3 / 6 + O(x^4)}
5904 on the stack, we want to be able to type @kbd{*} and get the result
5905 @samp{x - 2:3 x^3 + O(x^4)}. Don't worry if the terms of the sum are
5906 rearranged or if @kbd{a s} needs to be typed after rewriting. (This one
5907 is rather tricky; the solution at the end of this chapter uses 6 rewrite
5908 rules. Hint: The @samp{constant(x)} condition tests whether @samp{x} is
5909 a number.) @xref{Rewrites Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5910
5911 Just for kicks, try adding the rule @code{2+3 := 6} to @code{EvalRules}.
5912 What happens? (Be sure to remove this rule afterward, or you might get
5913 a nasty surprise when you use Calc to balance your checkbook!)
5914
5915 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for the whole story on rewrite rules.
5916
5917 @node Programming Tutorial, Answers to Exercises, Algebra Tutorial, Tutorial
5918 @section Programming Tutorial
5919
5920 @noindent
5921 The Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, a highly extensible
5922 language. If you know Lisp, you can program the Calculator to do
5923 anything you like. Rewrite rules also work as a powerful programming
5924 system. But Lisp and rewrite rules take a while to master, and often
5925 all you want to do is define a new function or repeat a command a few
5926 times. Calc has features that allow you to do these things easily.
5927
5928 One very limited form of programming is defining your own functions.
5929 Calc's @kbd{Z F} command allows you to define a function name and
5930 key sequence to correspond to any formula. Programming commands use
5931 the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix; the user commands they create use the lower
5932 case @kbd{z} prefix.
5933
5934 @smallexample
5935 @group
5936 1: 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 1: 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6
5937 . .
5938
5939 ' 1 + x + x^2/2! + x^3/3! @key{RET} Z F e myexp @key{RET} @key{RET} @key{RET} y
5940 @end group
5941 @end smallexample
5942
5943 This polynomial is a Taylor series approximation to @samp{exp(x)}.
5944 The @kbd{Z F} command asks a number of questions. The above answers
5945 say that the key sequence for our function should be @kbd{z e}; the
5946 @kbd{M-x} equivalent should be @code{calc-myexp}; the name of the
5947 function in algebraic formulas should also be @code{myexp}; the
5948 default argument list @samp{(x)} is acceptable; and finally @kbd{y}
5949 answers the question ``leave it in symbolic form for non-constant
5950 arguments?''
5951
5952 @smallexample
5953 @group
5954 1: 1.3495 2: 1.3495 3: 1.3495
5955 . 1: 1.34986 2: 1.34986
5956 . 1: myexp(a + 1)
5957 .
5958
5959 .3 z e .3 E ' a+1 @key{RET} z e
5960 @end group
5961 @end smallexample
5962
5963 @noindent
5964 First we call our new @code{exp} approximation with 0.3 as an
5965 argument, and compare it with the true @code{exp} function. Then
5966 we note that, as requested, if we try to give @kbd{z e} an
5967 argument that isn't a plain number, it leaves the @code{myexp}
5968 function call in symbolic form. If we had answered @kbd{n} to the
5969 final question, @samp{myexp(a + 1)} would have evaluated by plugging
5970 in @samp{a + 1} for @samp{x} in the defining formula.
5971
5972 @cindex Sine integral Si(x)
5973 @ignore
5974 @starindex
5975 @end ignore
5976 @tindex Si
5977 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The ``sine integral'' function
5978 @texline @math{{\rm Si}(x)}
5979 @infoline @expr{Si(x)}
5980 is defined as the integral of @samp{sin(t)/t} for
5981 @expr{t = 0} to @expr{x} in radians. (It was invented because this
5982 integral has no solution in terms of basic functions; if you give it
5983 to Calc's @kbd{a i} command, it will ponder it for a long time and then
5984 give up.) We can use the numerical integration command, however,
5985 which in algebraic notation is written like @samp{ninteg(f(t), t, 0, x)}
5986 with any integrand @samp{f(t)}. Define a @kbd{z s} command and
5987 @code{Si} function that implement this. You will need to edit the
5988 default argument list a bit. As a test, @samp{Si(1)} should return
5989 0.946083. (If you don't get this answer, you might want to check that
5990 Calc is in Radians mode. Also, @code{ninteg} will run a lot faster if
5991 you reduce the precision to, say, six digits beforehand.)
5992 @xref{Programming Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5993
5994 The simplest way to do real ``programming'' of Emacs is to define a
5995 @dfn{keyboard macro}. A keyboard macro is simply a sequence of
5996 keystrokes which Emacs has stored away and can play back on demand.
5997 For example, if you find yourself typing @kbd{H a S x @key{RET}} often,
5998 you may wish to program a keyboard macro to type this for you.
5999
6000 @smallexample
6001 @group
6002 1: y = sqrt(x) 1: x = y^2
6003 . .
6004
6005 ' y=sqrt(x) @key{RET} C-x ( H a S x @key{RET} C-x )
6006
6007 1: y = cos(x) 1: x = s1 arccos(y) + 2 pi n1
6008 . .
6009
6010 ' y=cos(x) @key{RET} X
6011 @end group
6012 @end smallexample
6013
6014 @noindent
6015 When you type @kbd{C-x (}, Emacs begins recording. But it is also
6016 still ready to execute your keystrokes, so you're really ``training''
6017 Emacs by walking it through the procedure once. When you type
6018 @w{@kbd{C-x )}}, the macro is recorded. You can now type @kbd{X} to
6019 re-execute the same keystrokes.
6020
6021 You can give a name to your macro by typing @kbd{Z K}.
6022
6023 @smallexample
6024 @group
6025 1: . 1: y = x^4 1: x = s2 sqrt(s1 sqrt(y))
6026 . .
6027
6028 Z K x @key{RET} ' y=x^4 @key{RET} z x
6029 @end group
6030 @end smallexample
6031
6032 @noindent
6033 Notice that we use shift-@kbd{Z} to define the command, and lower-case
6034 @kbd{z} to call it up.
6035
6036 Keyboard macros can call other macros.
6037
6038 @smallexample
6039 @group
6040 1: abs(x) 1: x = s1 y 1: 2 / x 1: x = 2 / y
6041 . . . .
6042
6043 ' abs(x) @key{RET} C-x ( ' y @key{RET} a = z x C-x ) ' 2/x @key{RET} X
6044 @end group
6045 @end smallexample
6046
6047 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Define a keyboard macro to negate
6048 the item in level 3 of the stack, without disturbing the rest of
6049 the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
6050
6051 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Define keyboard macros to compute
6052 the following functions:
6053
6054 @enumerate
6055 @item
6056 Compute
6057 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}},
6058 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x},
6059 where @expr{x} is the number on the top of the stack.
6060
6061 @item
6062 Compute the base-@expr{b} logarithm, just like the @kbd{B} key except
6063 the arguments are taken in the opposite order.
6064
6065 @item
6066 Produce a vector of integers from 1 to the integer on the top of
6067 the stack.
6068 @end enumerate
6069 @noindent
6070 @xref{Programming Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
6071
6072 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Define a keyboard macro to compute
6073 the average (mean) value of a list of numbers.
6074 @xref{Programming Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
6075
6076 In many programs, some of the steps must execute several times.
6077 Calc has @dfn{looping} commands that allow this. Loops are useful
6078 inside keyboard macros, but actually work at any time.
6079
6080 @smallexample
6081 @group
6082 1: x^6 2: x^6 1: 360 x^2
6083 . 1: 4 .
6084 .
6085
6086 ' x^6 @key{RET} 4 Z < a d x @key{RET} Z >
6087 @end group
6088 @end smallexample
6089
6090 @noindent
6091 Here we have computed the fourth derivative of @expr{x^6} by
6092 enclosing a derivative command in a ``repeat loop'' structure.
6093 This structure pops a repeat count from the stack, then
6094 executes the body of the loop that many times.
6095
6096 If you make a mistake while entering the body of the loop,
6097 type @w{@kbd{Z C-g}} to cancel the loop command.
6098
6099 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
6100 Here's another example:
6101
6102 @smallexample
6103 @group
6104 3: 1 2: 10946
6105 2: 1 1: 17711
6106 1: 20 .
6107 .
6108
6109 1 @key{RET} @key{RET} 20 Z < @key{TAB} C-j + Z >
6110 @end group
6111 @end smallexample
6112
6113 @noindent
6114 The numbers in levels 2 and 1 should be the 21st and 22nd Fibonacci
6115 numbers, respectively. (To see what's going on, try a few repetitions
6116 of the loop body by hand; @kbd{C-j}, also on the Line-Feed or @key{LFD}
6117 key if you have one, makes a copy of the number in level 2.)
6118
6119 @cindex Golden ratio
6120 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
6121 A fascinating property of the Fibonacci numbers is that the @expr{n}th
6122 Fibonacci number can be found directly by computing
6123 @texline @math{\phi^n / \sqrt{5}}
6124 @infoline @expr{phi^n / sqrt(5)}
6125 and then rounding to the nearest integer, where
6126 @texline @math{\phi} (``phi''),
6127 @infoline @expr{phi},
6128 the ``golden ratio,'' is
6129 @texline @math{(1 + \sqrt{5}) / 2}.
6130 @infoline @expr{(1 + sqrt(5)) / 2}.
6131 (For convenience, this constant is available from the @code{phi}
6132 variable, or the @kbd{I H P} command.)
6133
6134 @smallexample
6135 @group
6136 1: 1.61803 1: 24476.0000409 1: 10945.9999817 1: 10946
6137 . . . .
6138
6139 I H P 21 ^ 5 Q / R
6140 @end group
6141 @end smallexample
6142
6143 @cindex Continued fractions
6144 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @dfn{continued fraction}
6145 representation of
6146 @texline @math{\phi}
6147 @infoline @expr{phi}
6148 is
6149 @texline @math{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( \ldots )))}.
6150 @infoline @expr{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( ...@: )))}.
6151 We can compute an approximate value by carrying this however far
6152 and then replacing the innermost
6153 @texline @math{1/( \ldots )}
6154 @infoline @expr{1/( ...@: )}
6155 by 1. Approximate
6156 @texline @math{\phi}
6157 @infoline @expr{phi}
6158 using a twenty-term continued fraction.
6159 @xref{Programming Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
6160
6161 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Linear recurrences like the one for
6162 Fibonacci numbers can be expressed in terms of matrices. Given a
6163 vector @w{@expr{[a, b]}} determine a matrix which, when multiplied by this
6164 vector, produces the vector @expr{[b, c]}, where @expr{a}, @expr{b} and
6165 @expr{c} are three successive Fibonacci numbers. Now write a program
6166 that, given an integer @expr{n}, computes the @expr{n}th Fibonacci number
6167 using matrix arithmetic. @xref{Programming Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
6168
6169 @cindex Harmonic numbers
6170 A more sophisticated kind of loop is the @dfn{for} loop. Suppose
6171 we wish to compute the 20th ``harmonic'' number, which is equal to
6172 the sum of the reciprocals of the integers from 1 to 20.
6173
6174 @smallexample
6175 @group
6176 3: 0 1: 3.597739
6177 2: 1 .
6178 1: 20
6179 .
6180
6181 0 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & + 1 Z )
6182 @end group
6183 @end smallexample
6184
6185 @noindent
6186 The ``for'' loop pops two numbers, the lower and upper limits, then
6187 repeats the body of the loop as an internal counter increases from
6188 the lower limit to the upper one. Just before executing the loop
6189 body, it pushes the current loop counter. When the loop body
6190 finishes, it pops the ``step,'' i.e., the amount by which to
6191 increment the loop counter. As you can see, our loop always
6192 uses a step of one.
6193
6194 This harmonic number function uses the stack to hold the running
6195 total as well as for the various loop housekeeping functions. If
6196 you find this disorienting, you can sum in a variable instead:
6197
6198 @smallexample
6199 @group
6200 1: 0 2: 1 . 1: 3.597739
6201 . 1: 20 .
6202 .
6203
6204 0 t 7 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & s + 7 1 Z ) r 7
6205 @end group
6206 @end smallexample
6207
6208 @noindent
6209 The @kbd{s +} command adds the top-of-stack into the value in a
6210 variable (and removes that value from the stack).
6211
6212 It's worth noting that many jobs that call for a ``for'' loop can
6213 also be done more easily by Calc's high-level operations. Two
6214 other ways to compute harmonic numbers are to use vector mapping
6215 and reduction (@kbd{v x 20}, then @w{@kbd{V M &}}, then @kbd{V R +}),
6216 or to use the summation command @kbd{a +}. Both of these are
6217 probably easier than using loops. However, there are some
6218 situations where loops really are the way to go:
6219
6220 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Use a ``for'' loop to find the first
6221 harmonic number which is greater than 4.0.
6222 @xref{Programming Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
6223
6224 Of course, if we're going to be using variables in our programs,
6225 we have to worry about the programs clobbering values that the
6226 caller was keeping in those same variables. This is easy to
6227 fix, though:
6228
6229 @smallexample
6230 @group
6231 . 1: 0.6667 1: 0.6667 3: 0.6667
6232 . . 2: 3.597739
6233 1: 0.6667
6234 .
6235
6236 Z ` p 4 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 / s 7 s s a @key{RET} Z ' r 7 s r a @key{RET}
6237 @end group
6238 @end smallexample
6239
6240 @noindent
6241 When we type @kbd{Z `} (that's a back-quote character), Calc saves
6242 its mode settings and the contents of the ten ``quick variables''
6243 for later reference. When we type @kbd{Z '} (that's an apostrophe
6244 now), Calc restores those saved values. Thus the @kbd{p 4} and
6245 @kbd{s 7} commands have no effect outside this sequence. Wrapping
6246 this around the body of a keyboard macro ensures that it doesn't
6247 interfere with what the user of the macro was doing. Notice that
6248 the contents of the stack, and the values of named variables,
6249 survive past the @kbd{Z '} command.
6250
6251 @cindex Bernoulli numbers, approximate
6252 The @dfn{Bernoulli numbers} are a sequence with the interesting
6253 property that all of the odd Bernoulli numbers are zero, and the
6254 even ones, while difficult to compute, can be roughly approximated
6255 by the formula
6256 @texline @math{\displaystyle{2 n! \over (2 \pi)^n}}.
6257 @infoline @expr{2 n!@: / (2 pi)^n}.
6258 Let's write a keyboard macro to compute (approximate) Bernoulli numbers.
6259 (Calc has a command, @kbd{k b}, to compute exact Bernoulli numbers, but
6260 this command is very slow for large @expr{n} since the higher Bernoulli
6261 numbers are very large fractions.)
6262
6263 @smallexample
6264 @group
6265 1: 10 1: 0.0756823
6266 . .
6267
6268 10 C-x ( @key{RET} 2 % Z [ @key{DEL} 0 Z : ' 2 $! / (2 pi)^$ @key{RET} = Z ] C-x )
6269 @end group
6270 @end smallexample
6271
6272 @noindent
6273 You can read @kbd{Z [} as ``then,'' @kbd{Z :} as ``else,'' and
6274 @kbd{Z ]} as ``end-if.'' There is no need for an explicit ``if''
6275 command. For the purposes of @w{@kbd{Z [}}, the condition is ``true''
6276 if the value it pops from the stack is a nonzero number, or ``false''
6277 if it pops zero or something that is not a number (like a formula).
6278 Here we take our integer argument modulo 2; this will be nonzero
6279 if we're asking for an odd Bernoulli number.
6280
6281 The actual tenth Bernoulli number is @expr{5/66}.
6282
6283 @smallexample
6284 @group
6285 3: 0.0756823 1: 0 1: 0.25305 1: 0 1: 1.16659
6286 2: 5:66 . . . .
6287 1: 0.0757575
6288 .
6289
6290 10 k b @key{RET} c f M-0 @key{DEL} 11 X @key{DEL} 12 X @key{DEL} 13 X @key{DEL} 14 X
6291 @end group
6292 @end smallexample
6293
6294 Just to exercise loops a bit more, let's compute a table of even
6295 Bernoulli numbers.
6296
6297 @smallexample
6298 @group
6299 3: [] 1: [0.10132, 0.03079, 0.02340, 0.033197, ...]
6300 2: 2 .
6301 1: 30
6302 .
6303
6304 [ ] 2 @key{RET} 30 Z ( X | 2 Z )
6305 @end group
6306 @end smallexample
6307
6308 @noindent
6309 The vertical-bar @kbd{|} is the vector-concatenation command. When
6310 we execute it, the list we are building will be in stack level 2
6311 (initially this is an empty list), and the next Bernoulli number
6312 will be in level 1. The effect is to append the Bernoulli number
6313 onto the end of the list. (To create a table of exact fractional
6314 Bernoulli numbers, just replace @kbd{X} with @kbd{k b} in the above
6315 sequence of keystrokes.)
6316
6317 With loops and conditionals, you can program essentially anything
6318 in Calc. One other command that makes looping easier is @kbd{Z /},
6319 which takes a condition from the stack and breaks out of the enclosing
6320 loop if the condition is true (non-zero). You can use this to make
6321 ``while'' and ``until'' style loops.
6322
6323 If you make a mistake when entering a keyboard macro, you can edit
6324 it using @kbd{Z E}. First, you must attach it to a key with @kbd{Z K}.
6325 One technique is to enter a throwaway dummy definition for the macro,
6326 then enter the real one in the edit command.
6327
6328 @smallexample
6329 @group
6330 1: 3 1: 3 Calc Macro Edit Mode.
6331 . . Original keys: 1 <return> 2 +
6332
6333 1 ;; calc digits
6334 RET ;; calc-enter
6335 2 ;; calc digits
6336 + ;; calc-plus
6337
6338 C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 2 + C-x ) Z K h @key{RET} Z E h
6339 @end group
6340 @end smallexample
6341
6342 @noindent
6343 A keyboard macro is stored as a pure keystroke sequence. The
6344 @file{edmacro} package (invoked by @kbd{Z E}) scans along the
6345 macro and tries to decode it back into human-readable steps.
6346 Descriptions of the keystrokes are given as comments, which begin with
6347 @samp{;;}, and which are ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6348 Spaces and line breaks are also ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6349 To enter a space into the macro, type @code{SPC}. All the special
6350 characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC}, @code{DEL},
6351 and @code{NUL} must be written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes
6352 @code{C-} and @code{M-}.
6353
6354 Let's edit in a new definition, for computing harmonic numbers.
6355 First, erase the four lines of the old definition. Then, type
6356 in the new definition (or use Emacs @kbd{M-w} and @kbd{C-y} commands
6357 to copy it from this page of the Info file; you can of course skip
6358 typing the comments, which begin with @samp{;;}).
6359
6360 @smallexample
6361 Z` ;; calc-kbd-push (Save local values)
6362 0 ;; calc digits (Push a zero onto the stack)
6363 st ;; calc-store-into (Store it in the following variable)
6364 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6365 1 ;; calc digits (Initial value for the loop)
6366 TAB ;; calc-roll-down (Swap initial and final)
6367 Z( ;; calc-kbd-for (Begin the "for" loop)
6368 & ;; calc-inv (Take the reciprocal)
6369 s+ ;; calc-store-plus (Add to the following variable)
6370 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6371 1 ;; calc digits (The loop step is 1)
6372 Z) ;; calc-kbd-end-for (End the "for" loop)
6373 sr ;; calc-recall (Recall the final accumulated value)
6374 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6375 Z' ;; calc-kbd-pop (Restore values)
6376 @end smallexample
6377
6378 @noindent
6379 Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and return to the Calculator.
6380
6381 @smallexample
6382 @group
6383 1: 20 1: 3.597739
6384 . .
6385
6386 20 z h
6387 @end group
6388 @end smallexample
6389
6390 The @file{edmacro} package defines a handy @code{read-kbd-macro} command
6391 which reads the current region of the current buffer as a sequence of
6392 keystroke names, and defines that sequence on the @kbd{X}
6393 (and @kbd{C-x e}) key. Because this is so useful, Calc puts this
6394 command on the @kbd{M-# m} key. Try reading in this macro in the
6395 following form: Press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}) at
6396 one end of the text below, then type @kbd{M-# m} at the other.
6397
6398 @example
6399 @group
6400 Z ` 0 t 1
6401 1 TAB
6402 Z ( & s + 1 1 Z )
6403 r 1
6404 Z '
6405 @end group
6406 @end example
6407
6408 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} A general algorithm for solving
6409 equations numerically is @dfn{Newton's Method}. Given the equation
6410 @expr{f(x) = 0} for any function @expr{f}, and an initial guess
6411 @expr{x_0} which is reasonably close to the desired solution, apply
6412 this formula over and over:
6413
6414 @ifinfo
6415 @example
6416 new_x = x - f(x)/f'(x)
6417 @end example
6418 @end ifinfo
6419 @tex
6420 \beforedisplay
6421 $$ x_{\rm new} = x - {f(x) \over f'(x)} $$
6422 \afterdisplay
6423 @end tex
6424
6425 @noindent
6426 where @expr{f'(x)} is the derivative of @expr{f}. The @expr{x}
6427 values will quickly converge to a solution, i.e., eventually
6428 @texline @math{x_{\rm new}}
6429 @infoline @expr{new_x}
6430 and @expr{x} will be equal to within the limits
6431 of the current precision. Write a program which takes a formula
6432 involving the variable @expr{x}, and an initial guess @expr{x_0},
6433 on the stack, and produces a value of @expr{x} for which the formula
6434 is zero. Use it to find a solution of
6435 @texline @math{\sin(\cos x) = 0.5}
6436 @infoline @expr{sin(cos(x)) = 0.5}
6437 near @expr{x = 4.5}. (Use angles measured in radians.) Note that
6438 the built-in @w{@kbd{a R}} (@code{calc-find-root}) command uses Newton's
6439 method when it is able. @xref{Programming Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
6440
6441 @cindex Digamma function
6442 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
6443 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
6444 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} The @dfn{digamma} function
6445 @texline @math{\psi(z) (``psi'')}
6446 @infoline @expr{psi(z)}
6447 is defined as the derivative of
6448 @texline @math{\ln \Gamma(z)}.
6449 @infoline @expr{ln(gamma(z))}.
6450 For large values of @expr{z}, it can be approximated by the infinite sum
6451
6452 @ifinfo
6453 @example
6454 psi(z) ~= ln(z) - 1/2z - sum(bern(2 n) / 2 n z^(2 n), n, 1, inf)
6455 @end example
6456 @end ifinfo
6457 @tex
6458 \beforedisplay
6459 $$ \psi(z) \approx \ln z - {1\over2z} -
6460 \sum_{n=1}^\infty {\code{bern}(2 n) \over 2 n z^{2n}}
6461 $$
6462 \afterdisplay
6463 @end tex
6464
6465 @noindent
6466 where
6467 @texline @math{\sum}
6468 @infoline @expr{sum}
6469 represents the sum over @expr{n} from 1 to infinity
6470 (or to some limit high enough to give the desired accuracy), and
6471 the @code{bern} function produces (exact) Bernoulli numbers.
6472 While this sum is not guaranteed to converge, in practice it is safe.
6473 An interesting mathematical constant is Euler's gamma, which is equal
6474 to about 0.5772. One way to compute it is by the formula,
6475 @texline @math{\gamma = -\psi(1)}.
6476 @infoline @expr{gamma = -psi(1)}.
6477 Unfortunately, 1 isn't a large enough argument
6478 for the above formula to work (5 is a much safer value for @expr{z}).
6479 Fortunately, we can compute
6480 @texline @math{\psi(1)}
6481 @infoline @expr{psi(1)}
6482 from
6483 @texline @math{\psi(5)}
6484 @infoline @expr{psi(5)}
6485 using the recurrence
6486 @texline @math{\psi(z+1) = \psi(z) + {1 \over z}}.
6487 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1) = psi(z) + 1/z}.
6488 Your task: Develop a program to compute
6489 @texline @math{\psi(z)};
6490 @infoline @expr{psi(z)};
6491 it should ``pump up'' @expr{z}
6492 if necessary to be greater than 5, then use the above summation
6493 formula. Use looping commands to compute the sum. Use your function
6494 to compute
6495 @texline @math{\gamma}
6496 @infoline @expr{gamma}
6497 to twelve decimal places. (Calc has a built-in command
6498 for Euler's constant, @kbd{I P}, which you can use to check your answer.)
6499 @xref{Programming Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
6500
6501 @cindex Polynomial, list of coefficients
6502 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Given a polynomial in @expr{x} and
6503 a number @expr{m} on the stack, where the polynomial is of degree
6504 @expr{m} or less (i.e., does not have any terms higher than @expr{x^m}),
6505 write a program to convert the polynomial into a list-of-coefficients
6506 notation. For example, @expr{5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2} with @expr{m = 6}
6507 should produce the list @expr{[1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]}. Also develop
6508 a way to convert from this form back to the standard algebraic form.
6509 @xref{Programming Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
6510
6511 @cindex Recursion
6512 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The @dfn{Stirling numbers of the
6513 first kind} are defined by the recurrences,
6514
6515 @ifinfo
6516 @example
6517 s(n,n) = 1 for n >= 0,
6518 s(n,0) = 0 for n > 0,
6519 s(n+1,m) = s(n,m-1) - n s(n,m) for n >= m >= 1.
6520 @end example
6521 @end ifinfo
6522 @tex
6523 \turnoffactive
6524 \beforedisplay
6525 $$ \eqalign{ s(n,n) &= 1 \qquad \hbox{for } n \ge 0, \cr
6526 s(n,0) &= 0 \qquad \hbox{for } n > 0, \cr
6527 s(n+1,m) &= s(n,m-1) - n \, s(n,m) \qquad
6528 \hbox{for } n \ge m \ge 1.}
6529 $$
6530 \afterdisplay
6531 \vskip5pt
6532 (These numbers are also sometimes written $\displaystyle{n \brack m}$.)
6533 @end tex
6534
6535 This can be implemented using a @dfn{recursive} program in Calc; the
6536 program must invoke itself in order to calculate the two righthand
6537 terms in the general formula. Since it always invokes itself with
6538 ``simpler'' arguments, it's easy to see that it must eventually finish
6539 the computation. Recursion is a little difficult with Emacs keyboard
6540 macros since the macro is executed before its definition is complete.
6541 So here's the recommended strategy: Create a ``dummy macro'' and assign
6542 it to a key with, e.g., @kbd{Z K s}. Now enter the true definition,
6543 using the @kbd{z s} command to call itself recursively, then assign it
6544 to the same key with @kbd{Z K s}. Now the @kbd{z s} command will run
6545 the complete recursive program. (Another way is to use @w{@kbd{Z E}}
6546 or @kbd{M-# m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the whole macro at once,
6547 thus avoiding the ``training'' phase.) The task: Write a program
6548 that computes Stirling numbers of the first kind, given @expr{n} and
6549 @expr{m} on the stack. Test it with @emph{small} inputs like
6550 @expr{s(4,2)}. (There is a built-in command for Stirling numbers,
6551 @kbd{k s}, which you can use to check your answers.)
6552 @xref{Programming Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
6553
6554 The programming commands we've seen in this part of the tutorial
6555 are low-level, general-purpose operations. Often you will find
6556 that a higher-level function, such as vector mapping or rewrite
6557 rules, will do the job much more easily than a detailed, step-by-step
6558 program can:
6559
6560 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} Write another program for
6561 computing Stirling numbers of the first kind, this time using
6562 rewrite rules. Once again, @expr{n} and @expr{m} should be taken
6563 from the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
6564
6565 @example
6566
6567 @end example
6568 This ends the tutorial section of the Calc manual. Now you know enough
6569 about Calc to use it effectively for many kinds of calculations. But
6570 Calc has many features that were not even touched upon in this tutorial.
6571 @c [not-split]
6572 The rest of this manual tells the whole story.
6573 @c [when-split]
6574 @c Volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}, tells the whole story.
6575
6576 @page
6577 @node Answers to Exercises, , Programming Tutorial, Tutorial
6578 @section Answers to Exercises
6579
6580 @noindent
6581 This section includes answers to all the exercises in the Calc tutorial.
6582
6583 @menu
6584 * RPN Answer 1:: 1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -
6585 * RPN Answer 2:: 2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4
6586 * RPN Answer 3:: Operating on levels 2 and 3
6587 * RPN Answer 4:: Joe's complex problems
6588 * Algebraic Answer 1:: Simulating Q command
6589 * Algebraic Answer 2:: Joe's algebraic woes
6590 * Algebraic Answer 3:: 1 / 0
6591 * Modes Answer 1:: 3#0.1 = 3#0.0222222?
6592 * Modes Answer 2:: 16#f.e8fe15
6593 * Modes Answer 3:: Joe's rounding bug
6594 * Modes Answer 4:: Why floating point?
6595 * Arithmetic Answer 1:: Why the \ command?
6596 * Arithmetic Answer 2:: Tripping up the B command
6597 * Vector Answer 1:: Normalizing a vector
6598 * Vector Answer 2:: Average position
6599 * Matrix Answer 1:: Row and column sums
6600 * Matrix Answer 2:: Symbolic system of equations
6601 * Matrix Answer 3:: Over-determined system
6602 * List Answer 1:: Powers of two
6603 * List Answer 2:: Least-squares fit with matrices
6604 * List Answer 3:: Geometric mean
6605 * List Answer 4:: Divisor function
6606 * List Answer 5:: Duplicate factors
6607 * List Answer 6:: Triangular list
6608 * List Answer 7:: Another triangular list
6609 * List Answer 8:: Maximum of Bessel function
6610 * List Answer 9:: Integers the hard way
6611 * List Answer 10:: All elements equal
6612 * List Answer 11:: Estimating pi with darts
6613 * List Answer 12:: Estimating pi with matchsticks
6614 * List Answer 13:: Hash codes
6615 * List Answer 14:: Random walk
6616 * Types Answer 1:: Square root of pi times rational
6617 * Types Answer 2:: Infinities
6618 * Types Answer 3:: What can "nan" be?
6619 * Types Answer 4:: Abbey Road
6620 * Types Answer 5:: Friday the 13th
6621 * Types Answer 6:: Leap years
6622 * Types Answer 7:: Erroneous donut
6623 * Types Answer 8:: Dividing intervals
6624 * Types Answer 9:: Squaring intervals
6625 * Types Answer 10:: Fermat's primality test
6626 * Types Answer 11:: pi * 10^7 seconds
6627 * Types Answer 12:: Abbey Road on CD
6628 * Types Answer 13:: Not quite pi * 10^7 seconds
6629 * Types Answer 14:: Supercomputers and c
6630 * Types Answer 15:: Sam the Slug
6631 * Algebra Answer 1:: Squares and square roots
6632 * Algebra Answer 2:: Building polynomial from roots
6633 * Algebra Answer 3:: Integral of x sin(pi x)
6634 * Algebra Answer 4:: Simpson's rule
6635 * Rewrites Answer 1:: Multiplying by conjugate
6636 * Rewrites Answer 2:: Alternative fib rule
6637 * Rewrites Answer 3:: Rewriting opt(a) + opt(b) x
6638 * Rewrites Answer 4:: Sequence of integers
6639 * Rewrites Answer 5:: Number of terms in sum
6640 * Rewrites Answer 6:: Truncated Taylor series
6641 * Programming Answer 1:: Fresnel's C(x)
6642 * Programming Answer 2:: Negate third stack element
6643 * Programming Answer 3:: Compute sin(x) / x, etc.
6644 * Programming Answer 4:: Average value of a list
6645 * Programming Answer 5:: Continued fraction phi
6646 * Programming Answer 6:: Matrix Fibonacci numbers
6647 * Programming Answer 7:: Harmonic number greater than 4
6648 * Programming Answer 8:: Newton's method
6649 * Programming Answer 9:: Digamma function
6650 * Programming Answer 10:: Unpacking a polynomial
6651 * Programming Answer 11:: Recursive Stirling numbers
6652 * Programming Answer 12:: Stirling numbers with rewrites
6653 @end menu
6654
6655 @c The following kludgery prevents the individual answers from
6656 @c being entered on the table of contents.
6657 @tex
6658 \global\let\oldwrite=\write
6659 \gdef\skipwrite#1#2{\let\write=\oldwrite}
6660 \global\let\oldchapternofonts=\chapternofonts
6661 \gdef\chapternofonts{\let\write=\skipwrite\oldchapternofonts}
6662 @end tex
6663
6664 @node RPN Answer 1, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises, Answers to Exercises
6665 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 1
6666
6667 @noindent
6668 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -}
6669
6670 The result is
6671 @texline @math{1 - (2 \times (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6672 @infoline @expr{1 - (2 * (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6673
6674 @node RPN Answer 2, RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6675 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 2
6676
6677 @noindent
6678 @texline @math{2\times4 + 7\times9.5 + {5\over4} = 75.75}
6679 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4 = 75.75}
6680
6681 After computing the intermediate term
6682 @texline @math{2\times4 = 8},
6683 @infoline @expr{2*4 = 8},
6684 you can leave that result on the stack while you compute the second
6685 term. With both of these results waiting on the stack you can then
6686 compute the final term, then press @kbd{+ +} to add everything up.
6687
6688 @smallexample
6689 @group
6690 2: 2 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8
6691 1: 4 . 2: 7 1: 66.5
6692 . 1: 9.5 .
6693 .
6694
6695 2 @key{RET} 4 * 7 @key{RET} 9.5 *
6696
6697 @end group
6698 @end smallexample
6699 @noindent
6700 @smallexample
6701 @group
6702 4: 8 3: 8 2: 8 1: 75.75
6703 3: 66.5 2: 66.5 1: 67.75 .
6704 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6705 1: 4 .
6706 .
6707
6708 5 @key{RET} 4 / + +
6709 @end group
6710 @end smallexample
6711
6712 Alternatively, you could add the first two terms before going on
6713 with the third term.
6714
6715 @smallexample
6716 @group
6717 2: 8 1: 74.5 3: 74.5 2: 74.5 1: 75.75
6718 1: 66.5 . 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6719 . 1: 4 .
6720 .
6721
6722 ... + 5 @key{RET} 4 / +
6723 @end group
6724 @end smallexample
6725
6726 On an old-style RPN calculator this second method would have the
6727 advantage of using only three stack levels. But since Calc's stack
6728 can grow arbitrarily large this isn't really an issue. Which method
6729 you choose is purely a matter of taste.
6730
6731 @node RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 4, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6732 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 3
6733
6734 @noindent
6735 The @key{TAB} key provides a way to operate on the number in level 2.
6736
6737 @smallexample
6738 @group
6739 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10 3: 10 3: 10
6740 2: 20 2: 30 3: 30 2: 30 2: 21
6741 1: 30 1: 20 2: 20 1: 21 1: 30
6742 . . 1: 1 . .
6743 .
6744
6745 @key{TAB} 1 + @key{TAB}
6746 @end group
6747 @end smallexample
6748
6749 Similarly, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} gives you access to the number in level 3.
6750
6751 @smallexample
6752 @group
6753 3: 10 3: 21 3: 21 3: 30 3: 11
6754 2: 21 2: 30 2: 30 2: 11 2: 21
6755 1: 30 1: 10 1: 11 1: 21 1: 30
6756 . . . . .
6757
6758 M-@key{TAB} 1 + M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
6759 @end group
6760 @end smallexample
6761
6762 @node RPN Answer 4, Algebraic Answer 1, RPN Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6763 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 4
6764
6765 @noindent
6766 Either @kbd{( 2 , 3 )} or @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )} would have worked,
6767 but using both the comma and the space at once yields:
6768
6769 @smallexample
6770 @group
6771 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 2: (2, ... 2: (2, ...
6772 . 1: 2 . 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
6773 . . .
6774
6775 ( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )
6776 @end group
6777 @end smallexample
6778
6779 Joe probably tried to type @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}} to swap the
6780 extra incomplete object to the top of the stack and delete it.
6781 But a feature of Calc is that @key{DEL} on an incomplete object
6782 deletes just one component out of that object, so he had to press
6783 @key{DEL} twice to finish the job.
6784
6785 @smallexample
6786 @group
6787 2: (2, ... 2: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (2, 3)
6788 1: (2, 3) 1: (2, ... 1: ( ... .
6789 . . .
6790
6791 @key{TAB} @key{DEL} @key{DEL}
6792 @end group
6793 @end smallexample
6794
6795 (As it turns out, deleting the second-to-top stack entry happens often
6796 enough that Calc provides a special key, @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, to do just that.
6797 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} is just like @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}}, except that it doesn't exhibit
6798 the ``feature'' that tripped poor Joe.)
6799
6800 @node Algebraic Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, RPN Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6801 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 1
6802
6803 @noindent
6804 Type @kbd{' sqrt($) @key{RET}}.
6805
6806 If the @kbd{Q} key is broken, you could use @kbd{' $^0.5 @key{RET}}.
6807 Or, RPN style, @kbd{0.5 ^}.
6808
6809 (Actually, @samp{$^1:2}, using the fraction one-half as the power, is
6810 a closer equivalent, since @samp{9^0.5} yields @expr{3.0} whereas
6811 @samp{sqrt(9)} and @samp{9^1:2} yield the exact integer @expr{3}.)
6812
6813 @node Algebraic Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Algebraic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6814 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 2
6815
6816 @noindent
6817 In the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)}, @samp{x} was interpreted as a function
6818 name with @samp{1+y} as its argument. Assigning a value to a variable
6819 has no relation to a function by the same name. Joe needed to use an
6820 explicit @samp{*} symbol here: @samp{2 x*(1+y)}.
6821
6822 @node Algebraic Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6823 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 3
6824
6825 @noindent
6826 The result from @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} will be the formula @expr{1 / 0}.
6827 The ``function'' @samp{/} cannot be evaluated when its second argument
6828 is zero, so it is left in symbolic form. When you now type @kbd{0 *},
6829 the result will be zero because Calc uses the general rule that ``zero
6830 times anything is zero.''
6831
6832 @c [fix-ref Infinities]
6833 The @kbd{m i} command enables an @dfn{Infinite mode} in which @expr{1 / 0}
6834 results in a special symbol that represents ``infinity.'' If you
6835 multiply infinity by zero, Calc uses another special new symbol to
6836 show that the answer is ``indeterminate.'' @xref{Infinities}, for
6837 further discussion of infinite and indeterminate values.
6838
6839 @node Modes Answer 1, Modes Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6840 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 1
6841
6842 @noindent
6843 Calc always stores its numbers in decimal, so even though one-third has
6844 an exact base-3 representation (@samp{3#0.1}), it is still stored as
6845 0.3333333 (chopped off after 12 or however many decimal digits) inside
6846 the calculator's memory. When this inexact number is converted back
6847 to base 3 for display, it may still be slightly inexact. When we
6848 multiply this number by 3, we get 0.999999, also an inexact value.
6849
6850 When Calc displays a number in base 3, it has to decide how many digits
6851 to show. If the current precision is 12 (decimal) digits, that corresponds
6852 to @samp{12 / log10(3) = 25.15} base-3 digits. Because 25.15 is not an
6853 exact integer, Calc shows only 25 digits, with the result that stored
6854 numbers carry a little bit of extra information that may not show up on
6855 the screen. When Joe entered @samp{3#0.2}, the stored number 0.666666
6856 happened to round to a pleasing value when it lost that last 0.15 of a
6857 digit, but it was still inexact in Calc's memory. When he divided by 2,
6858 he still got the dreaded inexact value 0.333333. (Actually, he divided
6859 0.666667 by 2 to get 0.333334, which is why he got something a little
6860 higher than @code{3#0.1} instead of a little lower.)
6861
6862 If Joe didn't want to be bothered with all this, he could have typed
6863 @kbd{M-24 d n} to display with one less digit than the default. (If
6864 you give @kbd{d n} a negative argument, it uses default-minus-that,
6865 so @kbd{M-- d n} would be an easier way to get the same effect.) Those
6866 inexact results would still be lurking there, but they would now be
6867 rounded to nice, natural-looking values for display purposes. (Remember,
6868 @samp{0.022222} in base 3 is like @samp{0.099999} in base 10; rounding
6869 off one digit will round the number up to @samp{0.1}.) Depending on the
6870 nature of your work, this hiding of the inexactness may be a benefit or
6871 a danger. With the @kbd{d n} command, Calc gives you the choice.
6872
6873 Incidentally, another consequence of all this is that if you type
6874 @kbd{M-30 d n} to display more digits than are ``really there,''
6875 you'll see garbage digits at the end of the number. (In decimal
6876 display mode, with decimally-stored numbers, these garbage digits are
6877 always zero so they vanish and you don't notice them.) Because Calc
6878 rounds off that 0.15 digit, there is the danger that two numbers could
6879 be slightly different internally but still look the same. If you feel
6880 uneasy about this, set the @kbd{d n} precision to be a little higher
6881 than normal; you'll get ugly garbage digits, but you'll always be able
6882 to tell two distinct numbers apart.
6883
6884 An interesting side note is that most computers store their
6885 floating-point numbers in binary, and convert to decimal for display.
6886 Thus everyday programs have the same problem: Decimal 0.1 cannot be
6887 represented exactly in binary (try it: @kbd{0.1 d 2}), so @samp{0.1 * 10}
6888 comes out as an inexact approximation to 1 on some machines (though
6889 they generally arrange to hide it from you by rounding off one digit as
6890 we did above). Because Calc works in decimal instead of binary, you can
6891 be sure that numbers that look exact @emph{are} exact as long as you stay
6892 in decimal display mode.
6893
6894 It's not hard to show that any number that can be represented exactly
6895 in binary, octal, or hexadecimal is also exact in decimal, so the kinds
6896 of problems we saw in this exercise are likely to be severe only when
6897 you use a relatively unusual radix like 3.
6898
6899 @node Modes Answer 2, Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6900 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 2
6901
6902 If the radix is 15 or higher, we can't use the letter @samp{e} to mark
6903 the exponent because @samp{e} is interpreted as a digit. When Calc
6904 needs to display scientific notation in a high radix, it writes
6905 @samp{16#F.E8F*16.^15}. You can enter a number like this as an
6906 algebraic entry. Also, pressing @kbd{e} without any digits before it
6907 normally types @kbd{1e}, but in a high radix it types @kbd{16.^} and
6908 puts you in algebraic entry: @kbd{16#f.e8f @key{RET} e 15 @key{RET} *} is another
6909 way to enter this number.
6910
6911 The reason Calc puts a decimal point in the @samp{16.^} is to prevent
6912 huge integers from being generated if the exponent is large (consider
6913 @samp{16#1.23*16^1000}, where we compute @samp{16^1000} as a giant
6914 exact integer and then throw away most of the digits when we multiply
6915 it by the floating-point @samp{16#1.23}). While this wouldn't normally
6916 matter for display purposes, it could give you a nasty surprise if you
6917 copied that number into a file and later moved it back into Calc.
6918
6919 @node Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 4, Modes Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6920 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 3
6921
6922 @noindent
6923 The answer he got was @expr{0.5000000000006399}.
6924
6925 The problem is not that the square operation is inexact, but that the
6926 sine of 45 that was already on the stack was accurate to only 12 places.
6927 Arbitrary-precision calculations still only give answers as good as
6928 their inputs.
6929
6930 The real problem is that there is no 12-digit number which, when
6931 squared, comes out to 0.5 exactly. The @kbd{f [} and @kbd{f ]}
6932 commands decrease or increase a number by one unit in the last
6933 place (according to the current precision). They are useful for
6934 determining facts like this.
6935
6936 @smallexample
6937 @group
6938 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001
6939 . .
6940
6941 45 S 2 ^
6942
6943 @end group
6944 @end smallexample
6945 @noindent
6946 @smallexample
6947 @group
6948 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.707106781186 1: 0.499999999999
6949 . . .
6950
6951 U @key{DEL} f [ 2 ^
6952 @end group
6953 @end smallexample
6954
6955 A high-precision calculation must be carried out in high precision
6956 all the way. The only number in the original problem which was known
6957 exactly was the quantity 45 degrees, so the precision must be raised
6958 before anything is done after the number 45 has been entered in order
6959 for the higher precision to be meaningful.
6960
6961 @node Modes Answer 4, Arithmetic Answer 1, Modes Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6962 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 4
6963
6964 @noindent
6965 Many calculations involve real-world quantities, like the width and
6966 height of a piece of wood or the volume of a jar. Such quantities
6967 can't be measured exactly anyway, and if the data that is input to
6968 a calculation is inexact, doing exact arithmetic on it is a waste
6969 of time.
6970
6971 Fractions become unwieldy after too many calculations have been
6972 done with them. For example, the sum of the reciprocals of the
6973 integers from 1 to 10 is 7381:2520. The sum from 1 to 30 is
6974 9304682830147:2329089562800. After a point it will take a long
6975 time to add even one more term to this sum, but a floating-point
6976 calculation of the sum will not have this problem.
6977
6978 Also, rational numbers cannot express the results of all calculations.
6979 There is no fractional form for the square root of two, so if you type
6980 @w{@kbd{2 Q}}, Calc has no choice but to give you a floating-point answer.
6981
6982 @node Arithmetic Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 2, Modes Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6983 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 1
6984
6985 @noindent
6986 Dividing two integers that are larger than the current precision may
6987 give a floating-point result that is inaccurate even when rounded
6988 down to an integer. Consider @expr{123456789 / 2} when the current
6989 precision is 6 digits. The true answer is @expr{61728394.5}, but
6990 with a precision of 6 this will be rounded to
6991 @texline @math{12345700.0/2.0 = 61728500.0}.
6992 @infoline @expr{12345700.@: / 2.@: = 61728500.}.
6993 The result, when converted to an integer, will be off by 106.
6994
6995 Here are two solutions: Raise the precision enough that the
6996 floating-point round-off error is strictly to the right of the
6997 decimal point. Or, convert to Fraction mode so that @expr{123456789 / 2}
6998 produces the exact fraction @expr{123456789:2}, which can be rounded
6999 down by the @kbd{F} command without ever switching to floating-point
7000 format.
7001
7002 @node Arithmetic Answer 2, Vector Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7003 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 2
7004
7005 @noindent
7006 @kbd{27 @key{RET} 9 B} could give the exact result @expr{3:2}, but it
7007 does a floating-point calculation instead and produces @expr{1.5}.
7008
7009 Calc will find an exact result for a logarithm if the result is an integer
7010 or (when in Fraction mode) the reciprocal of an integer. But there is
7011 no efficient way to search the space of all possible rational numbers
7012 for an exact answer, so Calc doesn't try.
7013
7014 @node Vector Answer 1, Vector Answer 2, Arithmetic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7015 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 1
7016
7017 @noindent
7018 Duplicate the vector, compute its length, then divide the vector
7019 by its length: @kbd{@key{RET} A /}.
7020
7021 @smallexample
7022 @group
7023 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [0.27, 0.53, 0.80] 1: 1.
7024 . 1: 3.74165738677 . .
7025 .
7026
7027 r 1 @key{RET} A / A
7028 @end group
7029 @end smallexample
7030
7031 The final @kbd{A} command shows that the normalized vector does
7032 indeed have unit length.
7033
7034 @node Vector Answer 2, Matrix Answer 1, Vector Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7035 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 2
7036
7037 @noindent
7038 The average position is equal to the sum of the products of the
7039 positions times their corresponding probabilities. This is the
7040 definition of the dot product operation. So all you need to do
7041 is to put the two vectors on the stack and press @kbd{*}.
7042
7043 @node Matrix Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Vector Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7044 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 1
7045
7046 @noindent
7047 The trick is to multiply by a vector of ones. Use @kbd{r 4 [1 1 1] *} to
7048 get the row sum. Similarly, use @kbd{[1 1] r 4 *} to get the column sum.
7049
7050 @node Matrix Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Matrix Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7051 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 2
7052
7053 @ifinfo
7054 @example
7055 @group
7056 x + a y = 6
7057 x + b y = 10
7058 @end group
7059 @end example
7060 @end ifinfo
7061 @tex
7062 \turnoffactive
7063 \beforedisplay
7064 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
7065 x &+ b y = 10}
7066 $$
7067 \afterdisplay
7068 @end tex
7069
7070 Just enter the righthand side vector, then divide by the lefthand side
7071 matrix as usual.
7072
7073 @smallexample
7074 @group
7075 1: [6, 10] 2: [6, 10] 1: [6 - 4 a / (b - a), 4 / (b - a) ]
7076 . 1: [ [ 1, a ] .
7077 [ 1, b ] ]
7078 .
7079
7080 ' [6 10] @key{RET} ' [1 a; 1 b] @key{RET} /
7081 @end group
7082 @end smallexample
7083
7084 This can be made more readable using @kbd{d B} to enable Big display
7085 mode:
7086
7087 @smallexample
7088 @group
7089 4 a 4
7090 1: [6 - -----, -----]
7091 b - a b - a
7092 @end group
7093 @end smallexample
7094
7095 Type @kbd{d N} to return to Normal display mode afterwards.
7096
7097 @node Matrix Answer 3, List Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7098 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 3
7099
7100 @noindent
7101 To solve
7102 @texline @math{A^T A \, X = A^T B},
7103 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A * X = trn(A) * B},
7104 first we compute
7105 @texline @math{A' = A^T A}
7106 @infoline @expr{A2 = trn(A) * A}
7107 and
7108 @texline @math{B' = A^T B};
7109 @infoline @expr{B2 = trn(A) * B};
7110 now, we have a system
7111 @texline @math{A' X = B'}
7112 @infoline @expr{A2 * X = B2}
7113 which we can solve using Calc's @samp{/} command.
7114
7115 @ifinfo
7116 @example
7117 @group
7118 a + 2b + 3c = 6
7119 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
7120 7a + 6b = 3
7121 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
7122 @end group
7123 @end example
7124 @end ifinfo
7125 @tex
7126 \turnoffactive
7127 \beforedisplayh
7128 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
7129 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
7130 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
7131 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
7132 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
7133 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
7134 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
7135 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
7136 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
7137 $$
7138 \afterdisplayh
7139 @end tex
7140
7141 The first step is to enter the coefficient matrix. We'll store it in
7142 quick variable number 7 for later reference. Next, we compute the
7143 @texline @math{B'}
7144 @infoline @expr{B2}
7145 vector.
7146
7147 @smallexample
7148 @group
7149 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 4, 7, 2 ] 1: [57, 84, 96]
7150 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2, 5, 6, 4 ] .
7151 [ 7, 6, 0 ] [ 3, 6, 0, 6 ] ]
7152 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ] 1: [6, 2, 3, 11]
7153 . .
7154
7155 ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6; 7 6 0; 2 4 6] @key{RET} s 7 v t [6 2 3 11] *
7156 @end group
7157 @end smallexample
7158
7159 @noindent
7160 Now we compute the matrix
7161 @texline @math{A'}
7162 @infoline @expr{A2}
7163 and divide.
7164
7165 @smallexample
7166 @group
7167 2: [57, 84, 96] 1: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64]
7168 1: [ [ 70, 72, 39 ] .
7169 [ 72, 81, 60 ]
7170 [ 39, 60, 81 ] ]
7171 .
7172
7173 r 7 v t r 7 * /
7174 @end group
7175 @end smallexample
7176
7177 @noindent
7178 (The actual computed answer will be slightly inexact due to
7179 round-off error.)
7180
7181 Notice that the answers are similar to those for the
7182 @texline @math{3\times3}
7183 @infoline 3x3
7184 system solved in the text. That's because the fourth equation that was
7185 added to the system is almost identical to the first one multiplied
7186 by two. (If it were identical, we would have gotten the exact same
7187 answer since the
7188 @texline @math{4\times3}
7189 @infoline 4x3
7190 system would be equivalent to the original
7191 @texline @math{3\times3}
7192 @infoline 3x3
7193 system.)
7194
7195 Since the first and fourth equations aren't quite equivalent, they
7196 can't both be satisfied at once. Let's plug our answers back into
7197 the original system of equations to see how well they match.
7198
7199 @smallexample
7200 @group
7201 2: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64] 1: [5.6, 2., 3., 11.2]
7202 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
7203 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
7204 [ 7, 6, 0 ]
7205 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ]
7206 .
7207
7208 r 7 @key{TAB} *
7209 @end group
7210 @end smallexample
7211
7212 @noindent
7213 This is reasonably close to our original @expr{B} vector,
7214 @expr{[6, 2, 3, 11]}.
7215
7216 @node List Answer 1, List Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7217 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 1
7218
7219 @noindent
7220 We can use @kbd{v x} to build a vector of integers. This needs to be
7221 adjusted to get the range of integers we desire. Mapping @samp{-}
7222 across the vector will accomplish this, although it turns out the
7223 plain @samp{-} key will work just as well.
7224
7225 @smallexample
7226 @group
7227 2: 2 2: 2
7228 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9] 1: [-4, -3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4]
7229 . .
7230
7231 2 v x 9 @key{RET} 5 V M - or 5 -
7232 @end group
7233 @end smallexample
7234
7235 @noindent
7236 Now we use @kbd{V M ^} to map the exponentiation operator across the
7237 vector.
7238
7239 @smallexample
7240 @group
7241 1: [0.0625, 0.125, 0.25, 0.5, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16]
7242 .
7243
7244 V M ^
7245 @end group
7246 @end smallexample
7247
7248 @node List Answer 2, List Answer 3, List Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7249 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 2
7250
7251 @noindent
7252 Given @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors in quick variables 1 and 2 as before,
7253 the first job is to form the matrix that describes the problem.
7254
7255 @ifinfo
7256 @example
7257 m*x + b*1 = y
7258 @end example
7259 @end ifinfo
7260 @tex
7261 \turnoffactive
7262 \beforedisplay
7263 $$ m \times x + b \times 1 = y $$
7264 \afterdisplay
7265 @end tex
7266
7267 Thus we want a
7268 @texline @math{19\times2}
7269 @infoline 19x2
7270 matrix with our @expr{x} vector as one column and
7271 ones as the other column. So, first we build the column of ones, then
7272 we combine the two columns to form our @expr{A} matrix.
7273
7274 @smallexample
7275 @group
7276 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 1: [ [ 1.34, 1 ]
7277 1: [1, 1, 1, ...] [ 1.41, 1 ]
7278 . [ 1.49, 1 ]
7279 @dots{}
7280
7281 r 1 1 v b 19 @key{RET} M-2 v p v t s 3
7282 @end group
7283 @end smallexample
7284
7285 @noindent
7286 Now we compute
7287 @texline @math{A^T y}
7288 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * y}
7289 and
7290 @texline @math{A^T A}
7291 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A}
7292 and divide.
7293
7294 @smallexample
7295 @group
7296 1: [33.36554, 13.613] 2: [33.36554, 13.613]
7297 . 1: [ [ 98.0003, 41.63 ]
7298 [ 41.63, 19 ] ]
7299 .
7300
7301 v t r 2 * r 3 v t r 3 *
7302 @end group
7303 @end smallexample
7304
7305 @noindent
7306 (Hey, those numbers look familiar!)
7307
7308 @smallexample
7309 @group
7310 1: [0.52141679, -0.425978]
7311 .
7312
7313 /
7314 @end group
7315 @end smallexample
7316
7317 Since we were solving equations of the form
7318 @texline @math{m \times x + b \times 1 = y},
7319 @infoline @expr{m*x + b*1 = y},
7320 these numbers should be @expr{m} and @expr{b}, respectively. Sure
7321 enough, they agree exactly with the result computed using @kbd{V M} and
7322 @kbd{V R}!
7323
7324 The moral of this story: @kbd{V M} and @kbd{V R} will probably solve
7325 your problem, but there is often an easier way using the higher-level
7326 arithmetic functions!
7327
7328 @c [fix-ref Curve Fitting]
7329 In fact, there is a built-in @kbd{a F} command that does least-squares
7330 fits. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
7331
7332 @node List Answer 3, List Answer 4, List Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7333 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 3
7334
7335 @noindent
7336 Move to one end of the list and press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or
7337 whatever) to set the mark, then move to the other end of the list
7338 and type @w{@kbd{M-# g}}.
7339
7340 @smallexample
7341 @group
7342 1: [2.3, 6, 22, 15.1, 7, 15, 14, 7.5, 2.5]
7343 .
7344 @end group
7345 @end smallexample
7346
7347 To make things interesting, let's assume we don't know at a glance
7348 how many numbers are in this list. Then we could type:
7349
7350 @smallexample
7351 @group
7352 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ]
7353 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 126356422.5
7354 . .
7355
7356 @key{RET} V R *
7357
7358 @end group
7359 @end smallexample
7360 @noindent
7361 @smallexample
7362 @group
7363 2: 126356422.5 2: 126356422.5 1: 7.94652913734
7364 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 9 .
7365 . .
7366
7367 @key{TAB} v l I ^
7368 @end group
7369 @end smallexample
7370
7371 @noindent
7372 (The @kbd{I ^} command computes the @var{n}th root of a number.
7373 You could also type @kbd{& ^} to take the reciprocal of 9 and
7374 then raise the number to that power.)
7375
7376 @node List Answer 4, List Answer 5, List Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7377 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 4
7378
7379 @noindent
7380 A number @expr{j} is a divisor of @expr{n} if
7381 @texline @math{n \mathbin{\hbox{\code{\%}}} j = 0}.
7382 @infoline @samp{n % j = 0}.
7383 The first step is to get a vector that identifies the divisors.
7384
7385 @smallexample
7386 @group
7387 2: 30 2: [0, 0, 0, 2, ...] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...]
7388 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: 0 .
7389 . .
7390
7391 30 @key{RET} v x 30 @key{RET} s 1 V M % 0 V M a = s 2
7392 @end group
7393 @end smallexample
7394
7395 @noindent
7396 This vector has 1's marking divisors of 30 and 0's marking non-divisors.
7397
7398 The zeroth divisor function is just the total number of divisors.
7399 The first divisor function is the sum of the divisors.
7400
7401 @smallexample
7402 @group
7403 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8 2: 8
7404 2: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: [1, 2, 3, 0, ...] 1: 72
7405 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...] . .
7406 .
7407
7408 V R + r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
7409 @end group
7410 @end smallexample
7411
7412 @noindent
7413 Once again, the last two steps just compute a dot product for which
7414 a simple @kbd{*} would have worked equally well.
7415
7416 @node List Answer 5, List Answer 6, List Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
7417 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 5
7418
7419 @noindent
7420 The obvious first step is to obtain the list of factors with @kbd{k f}.
7421 This list will always be in sorted order, so if there are duplicates
7422 they will be right next to each other. A suitable method is to compare
7423 the list with a copy of itself shifted over by one.
7424
7425 @smallexample
7426 @group
7427 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0]
7428 . 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0] 1: [0, 3, 7, 7, 7, 19]
7429 . .
7430
7431 19551 k f @key{RET} 0 | @key{TAB} 0 @key{TAB} |
7432
7433 @end group
7434 @end smallexample
7435 @noindent
7436 @smallexample
7437 @group
7438 1: [0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0] 1: 2 1: 0
7439 . . .
7440
7441 V M a = V R + 0 a =
7442 @end group
7443 @end smallexample
7444
7445 @noindent
7446 Note that we have to arrange for both vectors to have the same length
7447 so that the mapping operation works; no prime factor will ever be
7448 zero, so adding zeros on the left and right is safe. From then on
7449 the job is pretty straightforward.
7450
7451 Incidentally, Calc provides the
7452 @texline @dfn{M@"obius} @math{\mu}
7453 @infoline @dfn{Moebius mu}
7454 function which is zero if and only if its argument is square-free. It
7455 would be a much more convenient way to do the above test in practice.
7456
7457 @node List Answer 6, List Answer 7, List Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
7458 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 6
7459
7460 @noindent
7461 First use @kbd{v x 6 @key{RET}} to get a list of integers, then @kbd{V M v x}
7462 to get a list of lists of integers!
7463
7464 @node List Answer 7, List Answer 8, List Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
7465 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 7
7466
7467 @noindent
7468 Here's one solution. First, compute the triangular list from the previous
7469 exercise and type @kbd{1 -} to subtract one from all the elements.
7470
7471 @smallexample
7472 @group
7473 1: [ [0],
7474 [0, 1],
7475 [0, 1, 2],
7476 @dots{}
7477
7478 1 -
7479 @end group
7480 @end smallexample
7481
7482 The numbers down the lefthand edge of the list we desire are called
7483 the ``triangular numbers'' (now you know why!). The @expr{n}th
7484 triangular number is the sum of the integers from 1 to @expr{n}, and
7485 can be computed directly by the formula
7486 @texline @math{n (n+1) \over 2}.
7487 @infoline @expr{n * (n+1) / 2}.
7488
7489 @smallexample
7490 @group
7491 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7492 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7493 . .
7494
7495 v x 6 @key{RET} 1 - V M ' $ ($+1)/2 @key{RET}
7496 @end group
7497 @end smallexample
7498
7499 @noindent
7500 Adding this list to the above list of lists produces the desired
7501 result:
7502
7503 @smallexample
7504 @group
7505 1: [ [0],
7506 [1, 2],
7507 [3, 4, 5],
7508 [6, 7, 8, 9],
7509 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
7510 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
7511 .
7512
7513 V M +
7514 @end group
7515 @end smallexample
7516
7517 If we did not know the formula for triangular numbers, we could have
7518 computed them using a @kbd{V U +} command. We could also have
7519 gotten them the hard way by mapping a reduction across the original
7520 triangular list.
7521
7522 @smallexample
7523 @group
7524 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7525 1: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7526 . .
7527
7528 @key{RET} V M V R +
7529 @end group
7530 @end smallexample
7531
7532 @noindent
7533 (This means ``map a @kbd{V R +} command across the vector,'' and
7534 since each element of the main vector is itself a small vector,
7535 @kbd{V R +} computes the sum of its elements.)
7536
7537 @node List Answer 8, List Answer 9, List Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
7538 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 8
7539
7540 @noindent
7541 The first step is to build a list of values of @expr{x}.
7542
7543 @smallexample
7544 @group
7545 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 21] 1: [0, 1, 2, ..., 20] 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ..., 5]
7546 . . .
7547
7548 v x 21 @key{RET} 1 - 4 / s 1
7549 @end group
7550 @end smallexample
7551
7552 Next, we compute the Bessel function values.
7553
7554 @smallexample
7555 @group
7556 1: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ..., -0.328]
7557 .
7558
7559 V M ' besJ(1,$) @key{RET}
7560 @end group
7561 @end smallexample
7562
7563 @noindent
7564 (Another way to do this would be @kbd{1 @key{TAB} V M f j}.)
7565
7566 A way to isolate the maximum value is to compute the maximum using
7567 @kbd{V R X}, then compare all the Bessel values with that maximum.
7568
7569 @smallexample
7570 @group
7571 2: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ]
7572 1: 0.5801562 . 1: 1
7573 . .
7574
7575 @key{RET} V R X V M a = @key{RET} V R + @key{DEL}
7576 @end group
7577 @end smallexample
7578
7579 @noindent
7580 It's a good idea to verify, as in the last step above, that only
7581 one value is equal to the maximum. (After all, a plot of
7582 @texline @math{\sin x}
7583 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
7584 might have many points all equal to the maximum value, 1.)
7585
7586 The vector we have now has a single 1 in the position that indicates
7587 the maximum value of @expr{x}. Now it is a simple matter to convert
7588 this back into the corresponding value itself.
7589
7590 @smallexample
7591 @group
7592 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0., 0., ... ] 1: 1.75
7593 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ... ] . .
7594 .
7595
7596 r 1 V M * V R +
7597 @end group
7598 @end smallexample
7599
7600 If @kbd{a =} had produced more than one @expr{1} value, this method
7601 would have given the sum of all maximum @expr{x} values; not very
7602 useful! In this case we could have used @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector})
7603 instead. This command deletes all elements of a ``data'' vector that
7604 correspond to zeros in a ``mask'' vector, leaving us with, in this
7605 example, a vector of maximum @expr{x} values.
7606
7607 The built-in @kbd{a X} command maximizes a function using more
7608 efficient methods. Just for illustration, let's use @kbd{a X}
7609 to maximize @samp{besJ(1,x)} over this same interval.
7610
7611 @smallexample
7612 @group
7613 2: besJ(1, x) 1: [1.84115, 0.581865]
7614 1: [0 .. 5] .
7615 .
7616
7617 ' besJ(1,x), [0..5] @key{RET} a X x @key{RET}
7618 @end group
7619 @end smallexample
7620
7621 @noindent
7622 The output from @kbd{a X} is a vector containing the value of @expr{x}
7623 that maximizes the function, and the function's value at that maximum.
7624 As you can see, our simple search got quite close to the right answer.
7625
7626 @node List Answer 9, List Answer 10, List Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
7627 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 9
7628
7629 @noindent
7630 Step one is to convert our integer into vector notation.
7631
7632 @smallexample
7633 @group
7634 1: 25129925999 3: 25129925999
7635 . 2: 10
7636 1: [11, 10, 9, ..., 1, 0]
7637 .
7638
7639 25129925999 @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 12 @key{RET} v x 12 @key{RET} -
7640
7641 @end group
7642 @end smallexample
7643 @noindent
7644 @smallexample
7645 @group
7646 1: 25129925999 1: [0, 2, 25, 251, 2512, ... ]
7647 2: [100000000000, ... ] .
7648 .
7649
7650 V M ^ s 1 V M \
7651 @end group
7652 @end smallexample
7653
7654 @noindent
7655 (Recall, the @kbd{\} command computes an integer quotient.)
7656
7657 @smallexample
7658 @group
7659 1: [0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 5, 9, 9, 9]
7660 .
7661
7662 10 V M % s 2
7663 @end group
7664 @end smallexample
7665
7666 Next we must increment this number. This involves adding one to
7667 the last digit, plus handling carries. There is a carry to the
7668 left out of a digit if that digit is a nine and all the digits to
7669 the right of it are nines.
7670
7671 @smallexample
7672 @group
7673 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, ... ]
7674 . .
7675
7676 9 V M a = v v
7677
7678 @end group
7679 @end smallexample
7680 @noindent
7681 @smallexample
7682 @group
7683 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1]
7684 . .
7685
7686 V U * v v 1 |
7687 @end group
7688 @end smallexample
7689
7690 @noindent
7691 Accumulating @kbd{*} across a vector of ones and zeros will preserve
7692 only the initial run of ones. These are the carries into all digits
7693 except the rightmost digit. Concatenating a one on the right takes
7694 care of aligning the carries properly, and also adding one to the
7695 rightmost digit.
7696
7697 @smallexample
7698 @group
7699 2: [0, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 6, 0, 0, 0]
7700 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] .
7701 .
7702
7703 0 r 2 | V M + 10 V M %
7704 @end group
7705 @end smallexample
7706
7707 @noindent
7708 Here we have concatenated 0 to the @emph{left} of the original number;
7709 this takes care of shifting the carries by one with respect to the
7710 digits that generated them.
7711
7712 Finally, we must convert this list back into an integer.
7713
7714 @smallexample
7715 @group
7716 3: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ]
7717 2: 1000000000000 1: [1000000000000, 100000000000, ... ]
7718 1: [100000000000, ... ] .
7719 .
7720
7721 10 @key{RET} 12 ^ r 1 |
7722
7723 @end group
7724 @end smallexample
7725 @noindent
7726 @smallexample
7727 @group
7728 1: [0, 0, 20000000000, 5000000000, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7729 . .
7730
7731 V M * V R +
7732 @end group
7733 @end smallexample
7734
7735 @noindent
7736 Another way to do this final step would be to reduce the formula
7737 @w{@samp{10 $$ + $}} across the vector of digits.
7738
7739 @smallexample
7740 @group
7741 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7742 . .
7743
7744 V R ' 10 $$ + $ @key{RET}
7745 @end group
7746 @end smallexample
7747
7748 @node List Answer 10, List Answer 11, List Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
7749 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 10
7750
7751 @noindent
7752 For the list @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, the result is @expr{((a = b) = c) = d},
7753 which will compare @expr{a} and @expr{b} to produce a 1 or 0, which is
7754 then compared with @expr{c} to produce another 1 or 0, which is then
7755 compared with @expr{d}. This is not at all what Joe wanted.
7756
7757 Here's a more correct method:
7758
7759 @smallexample
7760 @group
7761 1: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7] 2: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7]
7762 . 1: 7
7763 .
7764
7765 ' [7,7,7,8,7] @key{RET} @key{RET} v r 1 @key{RET}
7766
7767 @end group
7768 @end smallexample
7769 @noindent
7770 @smallexample
7771 @group
7772 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 1] 1: 0
7773 . .
7774
7775 V M a = V R *
7776 @end group
7777 @end smallexample
7778
7779 @node List Answer 11, List Answer 12, List Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
7780 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 11
7781
7782 @noindent
7783 The circle of unit radius consists of those points @expr{(x,y)} for which
7784 @expr{x^2 + y^2 < 1}. We start by generating a vector of @expr{x^2}
7785 and a vector of @expr{y^2}.
7786
7787 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7788 commands.
7789
7790 @smallexample
7791 @group
7792 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.]
7793 1: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [1.16, 1.98, ..., 0.81]
7794 . .
7795
7796 v . t . 2. v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r
7797
7798 @end group
7799 @end smallexample
7800 @noindent
7801 @smallexample
7802 @group
7803 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036]
7804 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036] 2: [0.53, 0.81, ..., 0.094]
7805 . .
7806
7807 1 - 2 V M ^ @key{TAB} V M k r 1 - 2 V M ^
7808 @end group
7809 @end smallexample
7810
7811 Now we sum the @expr{x^2} and @expr{y^2} values, compare with 1 to
7812 get a vector of 1/0 truth values, then sum the truth values.
7813
7814 @smallexample
7815 @group
7816 1: [0.56, 1.78, ..., 0.13] 1: [1, 0, ..., 1] 1: 84
7817 . . .
7818
7819 + 1 V M a < V R +
7820 @end group
7821 @end smallexample
7822
7823 @noindent
7824 The ratio @expr{84/100} should approximate the ratio @cpiover{4}.
7825
7826 @smallexample
7827 @group
7828 1: 0.84 1: 3.36 2: 3.36 1: 1.0695
7829 . . 1: 3.14159 .
7830
7831 100 / 4 * P /
7832 @end group
7833 @end smallexample
7834
7835 @noindent
7836 Our estimate, 3.36, is off by about 7%. We could get a better estimate
7837 by taking more points (say, 1000), but it's clear that this method is
7838 not very efficient!
7839
7840 (Naturally, since this example uses random numbers your own answer
7841 will be slightly different from the one shown here!)
7842
7843 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7844 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7845
7846 @node List Answer 12, List Answer 13, List Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
7847 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 12
7848
7849 @noindent
7850 This problem can be made a lot easier by taking advantage of some
7851 symmetries. First of all, after some thought it's clear that the
7852 @expr{y} axis can be ignored altogether. Just pick a random @expr{x}
7853 component for one end of the match, pick a random direction
7854 @texline @math{\theta},
7855 @infoline @expr{theta},
7856 and see if @expr{x} and
7857 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta}
7858 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)}
7859 (which is the @expr{x} coordinate of the other endpoint) cross a line.
7860 The lines are at integer coordinates, so this happens when the two
7861 numbers surround an integer.
7862
7863 Since the two endpoints are equivalent, we may as well choose the leftmost
7864 of the two endpoints as @expr{x}. Then @expr{theta} is an angle pointing
7865 to the right, in the range -90 to 90 degrees. (We could use radians, but
7866 it would feel like cheating to refer to @cpiover{2} radians while trying
7867 to estimate @cpi{}!)
7868
7869 In fact, since the field of lines is infinite we can choose the
7870 coordinates 0 and 1 for the lines on either side of the leftmost
7871 endpoint. The rightmost endpoint will be between 0 and 1 if the
7872 match does not cross a line, or between 1 and 2 if it does. So:
7873 Pick random @expr{x} and
7874 @texline @math{\theta},
7875 @infoline @expr{theta},
7876 compute
7877 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta},
7878 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)},
7879 and count how many of the results are greater than one. Simple!
7880
7881 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7882 commands.
7883
7884 @smallexample
7885 @group
7886 1: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72]
7887 . 1: [78.4, 64.5, ..., -42.9]
7888 .
7889
7890 v . t . 1. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 180. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 90 -
7891 @end group
7892 @end smallexample
7893
7894 @noindent
7895 (The next step may be slow, depending on the speed of your computer.)
7896
7897 @smallexample
7898 @group
7899 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 1: [0.72, 1.14, ..., 1.45]
7900 1: [0.20, 0.43, ..., 0.73] .
7901 .
7902
7903 m d V M C +
7904
7905 @end group
7906 @end smallexample
7907 @noindent
7908 @smallexample
7909 @group
7910 1: [0, 1, ..., 1] 1: 0.64 1: 3.125
7911 . . .
7912
7913 1 V M a > V R + 100 / 2 @key{TAB} /
7914 @end group
7915 @end smallexample
7916
7917 Let's try the third method, too. We'll use random integers up to
7918 one million. The @kbd{k r} command with an integer argument picks
7919 a random integer.
7920
7921 @smallexample
7922 @group
7923 2: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 2: [78489, 527587, ..., 814975]
7924 1: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 1: [324014, 358783, ..., 955450]
7925 . .
7926
7927 1000000 v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r @key{TAB} V M k r
7928
7929 @end group
7930 @end smallexample
7931 @noindent
7932 @smallexample
7933 @group
7934 1: [1, 1, ..., 25] 1: [1, 1, ..., 0] 1: 0.56
7935 . . .
7936
7937 V M k g 1 V M a = V R + 100 /
7938
7939 @end group
7940 @end smallexample
7941 @noindent
7942 @smallexample
7943 @group
7944 1: 10.714 1: 3.273
7945 . .
7946
7947 6 @key{TAB} / Q
7948 @end group
7949 @end smallexample
7950
7951 For a proof of this property of the GCD function, see section 4.5.2,
7952 exercise 10, of Knuth's @emph{Art of Computer Programming}, volume II.
7953
7954 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7955 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7956
7957 @node List Answer 13, List Answer 14, List Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
7958 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 13
7959
7960 @noindent
7961 First, we put the string on the stack as a vector of ASCII codes.
7962
7963 @smallexample
7964 @group
7965 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7966 .
7967
7968 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET}
7969 @end group
7970 @end smallexample
7971
7972 @noindent
7973 Note that the @kbd{"} key, like @kbd{$}, initiates algebraic entry so
7974 there was no need to type an apostrophe. Also, Calc didn't mind that
7975 we omitted the closing @kbd{"}. (The same goes for all closing delimiters
7976 like @kbd{)} and @kbd{]} at the end of a formula.
7977
7978 We'll show two different approaches here. In the first, we note that
7979 if the input vector is @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, then the hash code is
7980 @expr{3 (3 (3a + b) + c) + d = 27a + 9b + 3c + d}. In other words,
7981 it's a sum of descending powers of three times the ASCII codes.
7982
7983 @smallexample
7984 @group
7985 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7986 1: 16 1: [15, 14, 13, ..., 0]
7987 . .
7988
7989 @key{RET} v l v x 16 @key{RET} -
7990
7991 @end group
7992 @end smallexample
7993 @noindent
7994 @smallexample
7995 @group
7996 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098 1: 121
7997 1: [14348907, ..., 1] . .
7998 .
7999
8000 3 @key{TAB} V M ^ * 511 %
8001 @end group
8002 @end smallexample
8003
8004 @noindent
8005 Once again, @kbd{*} elegantly summarizes most of the computation.
8006 But there's an even more elegant approach: Reduce the formula
8007 @kbd{3 $$ + $} across the vector. Recall that this represents a
8008 function of two arguments that computes its first argument times three
8009 plus its second argument.
8010
8011 @smallexample
8012 @group
8013 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098
8014 . .
8015
8016 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' 3$$+$ @key{RET}
8017 @end group
8018 @end smallexample
8019
8020 @noindent
8021 If you did the decimal arithmetic exercise, this will be familiar.
8022 Basically, we're turning a base-3 vector of digits into an integer,
8023 except that our ``digits'' are much larger than real digits.
8024
8025 Instead of typing @kbd{511 %} again to reduce the result, we can be
8026 cleverer still and notice that rather than computing a huge integer
8027 and taking the modulo at the end, we can take the modulo at each step
8028 without affecting the result. While this means there are more
8029 arithmetic operations, the numbers we operate on remain small so
8030 the operations are faster.
8031
8032 @smallexample
8033 @group
8034 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 121
8035 . .
8036
8037 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' (3$$+$)%511 @key{RET}
8038 @end group
8039 @end smallexample
8040
8041 Why does this work? Think about a two-step computation:
8042 @w{@expr{3 (3a + b) + c}}. Taking a result modulo 511 basically means
8043 subtracting off enough 511's to put the result in the desired range.
8044 So the result when we take the modulo after every step is,
8045
8046 @ifinfo
8047 @example
8048 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n
8049 @end example
8050 @end ifinfo
8051 @tex
8052 \turnoffactive
8053 \beforedisplay
8054 $$ 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n $$
8055 \afterdisplay
8056 @end tex
8057
8058 @noindent
8059 for some suitable integers @expr{m} and @expr{n}. Expanding out by
8060 the distributive law yields
8061
8062 @ifinfo
8063 @example
8064 9 a + 3 b + c - 511*3 m - 511 n
8065 @end example
8066 @end ifinfo
8067 @tex
8068 \turnoffactive
8069 \beforedisplay
8070 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511\times3 m - 511 n $$
8071 \afterdisplay
8072 @end tex
8073
8074 @noindent
8075 The @expr{m} term in the latter formula is redundant because any
8076 contribution it makes could just as easily be made by the @expr{n}
8077 term. So we can take it out to get an equivalent formula with
8078 @expr{n' = 3m + n},
8079
8080 @ifinfo
8081 @example
8082 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n'
8083 @end example
8084 @end ifinfo
8085 @tex
8086 \turnoffactive
8087 \beforedisplay
8088 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n' $$
8089 \afterdisplay
8090 @end tex
8091
8092 @noindent
8093 which is just the formula for taking the modulo only at the end of
8094 the calculation. Therefore the two methods are essentially the same.
8095
8096 Later in the tutorial we will encounter @dfn{modulo forms}, which
8097 basically automate the idea of reducing every intermediate result
8098 modulo some value @var{m}.
8099
8100 @node List Answer 14, Types Answer 1, List Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
8101 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 14
8102
8103 We want to use @kbd{H V U} to nest a function which adds a random
8104 step to an @expr{(x,y)} coordinate. The function is a bit long, but
8105 otherwise the problem is quite straightforward.
8106
8107 @smallexample
8108 @group
8109 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
8110 1: 50 [ 0.4288, -0.1695 ]
8111 . [ -0.4787, -0.9027 ]
8112 ...
8113
8114 [0,0] 50 H V U ' <# + [random(2.0)-1, random(2.0)-1]> @key{RET}
8115 @end group
8116 @end smallexample
8117
8118 Just as the text recommended, we used @samp{< >} nameless function
8119 notation to keep the two @code{random} calls from being evaluated
8120 before nesting even begins.
8121
8122 We now have a vector of @expr{[x, y]} sub-vectors, which by Calc's
8123 rules acts like a matrix. We can transpose this matrix and unpack
8124 to get a pair of vectors, @expr{x} and @expr{y}, suitable for graphing.
8125
8126 @smallexample
8127 @group
8128 2: [ 0, 0.4288, -0.4787, ... ]
8129 1: [ 0, -0.1696, -0.9027, ... ]
8130 .
8131
8132 v t v u g f
8133 @end group
8134 @end smallexample
8135
8136 Incidentally, because the @expr{x} and @expr{y} are completely
8137 independent in this case, we could have done two separate commands
8138 to create our @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers directly.
8139
8140 To make a random walk of unit steps, we note that @code{sincos} of
8141 a random direction exactly gives us an @expr{[x, y]} step of unit
8142 length; in fact, the new nesting function is even briefer, though
8143 we might want to lower the precision a bit for it.
8144
8145 @smallexample
8146 @group
8147 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
8148 1: 50 [ 0.1318, 0.9912 ]
8149 . [ -0.5965, 0.3061 ]
8150 ...
8151
8152 [0,0] 50 m d p 6 @key{RET} H V U ' <# + sincos(random(360.0))> @key{RET}
8153 @end group
8154 @end smallexample
8155
8156 Another @kbd{v t v u g f} sequence will graph this new random walk.
8157
8158 An interesting twist on these random walk functions would be to use
8159 complex numbers instead of 2-vectors to represent points on the plane.
8160 In the first example, we'd use something like @samp{random + random*(0,1)},
8161 and in the second we could use polar complex numbers with random phase
8162 angles. (This exercise was first suggested in this form by Randal
8163 Schwartz.)
8164
8165 @node Types Answer 1, Types Answer 2, List Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
8166 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 1
8167
8168 @noindent
8169 If the number is the square root of @cpi{} times a rational number,
8170 then its square, divided by @cpi{}, should be a rational number.
8171
8172 @smallexample
8173 @group
8174 1: 1.26508260337 1: 0.509433962268 1: 2486645810:4881193627
8175 . . .
8176
8177 2 ^ P / c F
8178 @end group
8179 @end smallexample
8180
8181 @noindent
8182 Technically speaking this is a rational number, but not one that is
8183 likely to have arisen in the original problem. More likely, it just
8184 happens to be the fraction which most closely represents some
8185 irrational number to within 12 digits.
8186
8187 But perhaps our result was not quite exact. Let's reduce the
8188 precision slightly and try again:
8189
8190 @smallexample
8191 @group
8192 1: 0.509433962268 1: 27:53
8193 . .
8194
8195 U p 10 @key{RET} c F
8196 @end group
8197 @end smallexample
8198
8199 @noindent
8200 Aha! It's unlikely that an irrational number would equal a fraction
8201 this simple to within ten digits, so our original number was probably
8202 @texline @math{\sqrt{27 \pi / 53}}.
8203 @infoline @expr{sqrt(27 pi / 53)}.
8204
8205 Notice that we didn't need to re-round the number when we reduced the
8206 precision. Remember, arithmetic operations always round their inputs
8207 to the current precision before they begin.
8208
8209 @node Types Answer 2, Types Answer 3, Types Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8210 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 2
8211
8212 @noindent
8213 @samp{inf / inf = nan}. Perhaps @samp{1} is the ``obvious'' answer.
8214 But if @w{@samp{17 inf = inf}}, then @samp{17 inf / inf = inf / inf = 17}, too.
8215
8216 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}. It's tempting to say that the exponential
8217 of infinity must be ``bigger'' than ``regular'' infinity, but as
8218 far as Calc is concerned all infinities are as just as big.
8219 In other words, as @expr{x} goes to infinity, @expr{e^x} also goes
8220 to infinity, but the fact the @expr{e^x} grows much faster than
8221 @expr{x} is not relevant here.
8222
8223 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. Here we have a finite answer even though
8224 the input is infinite.
8225
8226 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = (0, 1) inf}. Remember that @expr{(0, 1)}
8227 represents the imaginary number @expr{i}. Here's a derivation:
8228 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = @w{sqrt((-1) * inf)} = sqrt(-1) * sqrt(inf)}.
8229 The first part is, by definition, @expr{i}; the second is @code{inf}
8230 because, once again, all infinities are the same size.
8231
8232 @samp{sqrt(uinf) = uinf}. In fact, we do know something about the
8233 direction because @code{sqrt} is defined to return a value in the
8234 right half of the complex plane. But Calc has no notation for this,
8235 so it settles for the conservative answer @code{uinf}.
8236
8237 @samp{abs(uinf) = inf}. No matter which direction @expr{x} points,
8238 @samp{abs(x)} always points along the positive real axis.
8239
8240 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}. Here we have an infinite answer to a finite
8241 input. As in the @expr{1 / 0} case, Calc will only use infinities
8242 here if you have turned on Infinite mode. Otherwise, it will
8243 treat @samp{ln(0)} as an error.
8244
8245 @node Types Answer 3, Types Answer 4, Types Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8246 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 3
8247
8248 @noindent
8249 We can make @samp{inf - inf} be any real number we like, say,
8250 @expr{a}, just by claiming that we added @expr{a} to the first
8251 infinity but not to the second. This is just as true for complex
8252 values of @expr{a}, so @code{nan} can stand for a complex number.
8253 (And, similarly, @code{uinf} can stand for an infinity that points
8254 in any direction in the complex plane, such as @samp{(0, 1) inf}).
8255
8256 In fact, we can multiply the first @code{inf} by two. Surely
8257 @w{@samp{2 inf - inf = inf}}, but also @samp{2 inf - inf = inf - inf = nan}.
8258 So @code{nan} can even stand for infinity. Obviously it's just
8259 as easy to make it stand for minus infinity as for plus infinity.
8260
8261 The moral of this story is that ``infinity'' is a slippery fish
8262 indeed, and Calc tries to handle it by having a very simple model
8263 for infinities (only the direction counts, not the ``size''); but
8264 Calc is careful to write @code{nan} any time this simple model is
8265 unable to tell what the true answer is.
8266
8267 @node Types Answer 4, Types Answer 5, Types Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8268 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 4
8269
8270 @smallexample
8271 @group
8272 2: 0@@ 47' 26" 1: 0@@ 2' 47.411765"
8273 1: 17 .
8274 .
8275
8276 0@@ 47' 26" @key{RET} 17 /
8277 @end group
8278 @end smallexample
8279
8280 @noindent
8281 The average song length is two minutes and 47.4 seconds.
8282
8283 @smallexample
8284 @group
8285 2: 0@@ 2' 47.411765" 1: 0@@ 3' 7.411765" 1: 0@@ 53' 6.000005"
8286 1: 0@@ 0' 20" . .
8287 .
8288
8289 20" + 17 *
8290 @end group
8291 @end smallexample
8292
8293 @noindent
8294 The album would be 53 minutes and 6 seconds long.
8295
8296 @node Types Answer 5, Types Answer 6, Types Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8297 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 5
8298
8299 @noindent
8300 Let's suppose it's January 14, 1991. The easiest thing to do is
8301 to keep trying 13ths of months until Calc reports a Friday.
8302 We can do this by manually entering dates, or by using @kbd{t I}:
8303
8304 @smallexample
8305 @group
8306 1: <Wed Feb 13, 1991> 1: <Wed Mar 13, 1991> 1: <Sat Apr 13, 1991>
8307 . . .
8308
8309 ' <2/13> @key{RET} @key{DEL} ' <3/13> @key{RET} t I
8310 @end group
8311 @end smallexample
8312
8313 @noindent
8314 (Calc assumes the current year if you don't say otherwise.)
8315
8316 This is getting tedious---we can keep advancing the date by typing
8317 @kbd{t I} over and over again, but let's automate the job by using
8318 vector mapping. The @kbd{t I} command actually takes a second
8319 ``how-many-months'' argument, which defaults to one. This
8320 argument is exactly what we want to map over:
8321
8322 @smallexample
8323 @group
8324 2: <Sat Apr 13, 1991> 1: [<Mon May 13, 1991>, <Thu Jun 13, 1991>,
8325 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] <Sat Jul 13, 1991>, <Tue Aug 13, 1991>,
8326 . <Fri Sep 13, 1991>, <Sun Oct 13, 1991>]
8327 .
8328
8329 v x 6 @key{RET} V M t I
8330 @end group
8331 @end smallexample
8332
8333 @noindent
8334 Et voil@`a, September 13, 1991 is a Friday.
8335
8336 @smallexample
8337 @group
8338 1: 242
8339 .
8340
8341 ' <sep 13> - <jan 14> @key{RET}
8342 @end group
8343 @end smallexample
8344
8345 @noindent
8346 And the answer to our original question: 242 days to go.
8347
8348 @node Types Answer 6, Types Answer 7, Types Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8349 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 6
8350
8351 @noindent
8352 The full rule for leap years is that they occur in every year divisible
8353 by four, except that they don't occur in years divisible by 100, except
8354 that they @emph{do} in years divisible by 400. We could work out the
8355 answer by carefully counting the years divisible by four and the
8356 exceptions, but there is a much simpler way that works even if we
8357 don't know the leap year rule.
8358
8359 Let's assume the present year is 1991. Years have 365 days, except
8360 that leap years (whenever they occur) have 366 days. So let's count
8361 the number of days between now and then, and compare that to the
8362 number of years times 365. The number of extra days we find must be
8363 equal to the number of leap years there were.
8364
8365 @smallexample
8366 @group
8367 1: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 2: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 1: 2925593
8368 . 1: <Tue Jan 1, 1991> .
8369 .
8370
8371 ' <jan 1 10001> @key{RET} ' <jan 1 1991> @key{RET} -
8372
8373 @end group
8374 @end smallexample
8375 @noindent
8376 @smallexample
8377 @group
8378 3: 2925593 2: 2925593 2: 2925593 1: 1943
8379 2: 10001 1: 8010 1: 2923650 .
8380 1: 1991 . .
8381 .
8382
8383 10001 @key{RET} 1991 - 365 * -
8384 @end group
8385 @end smallexample
8386
8387 @c [fix-ref Date Forms]
8388 @noindent
8389 There will be 1943 leap years before the year 10001. (Assuming,
8390 of course, that the algorithm for computing leap years remains
8391 unchanged for that long. @xref{Date Forms}, for some interesting
8392 background information in that regard.)
8393
8394 @node Types Answer 7, Types Answer 8, Types Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8395 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 7
8396
8397 @noindent
8398 The relative errors must be converted to absolute errors so that
8399 @samp{+/-} notation may be used.
8400
8401 @smallexample
8402 @group
8403 1: 1. 2: 1.
8404 . 1: 0.2
8405 .
8406
8407 20 @key{RET} .05 * 4 @key{RET} .05 *
8408 @end group
8409 @end smallexample
8410
8411 Now we simply chug through the formula.
8412
8413 @smallexample
8414 @group
8415 1: 19.7392088022 1: 394.78 +/- 19.739 1: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8416 . . .
8417
8418 2 P 2 ^ * 20 p 1 * 4 p .2 @key{RET} 2 ^ *
8419 @end group
8420 @end smallexample
8421
8422 It turns out the @kbd{v u} command will unpack an error form as
8423 well as a vector. This saves us some retyping of numbers.
8424
8425 @smallexample
8426 @group
8427 3: 6316.5 +/- 706.21 2: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8428 2: 6316.5 1: 0.1118
8429 1: 706.21 .
8430 .
8431
8432 @key{RET} v u @key{TAB} /
8433 @end group
8434 @end smallexample
8435
8436 @noindent
8437 Thus the volume is 6316 cubic centimeters, within about 11 percent.
8438
8439 @node Types Answer 8, Types Answer 9, Types Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
8440 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 8
8441
8442 @noindent
8443 The first answer is pretty simple: @samp{1 / (0 .. 10) = (0.1 .. inf)}.
8444 Since a number in the interval @samp{(0 .. 10)} can get arbitrarily
8445 close to zero, its reciprocal can get arbitrarily large, so the answer
8446 is an interval that effectively means, ``any number greater than 0.1''
8447 but with no upper bound.
8448
8449 The second answer, similarly, is @samp{1 / (-10 .. 0) = (-inf .. -0.1)}.
8450
8451 Calc normally treats division by zero as an error, so that the formula
8452 @w{@samp{1 / 0}} is left unsimplified. Our third problem,
8453 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 10]}}, also (potentially) divides by zero because zero
8454 is now a member of the interval. So Calc leaves this one unevaluated, too.
8455
8456 If you turn on Infinite mode by pressing @kbd{m i}, you will
8457 instead get the answer @samp{[0.1 .. inf]}, which includes infinity
8458 as a possible value.
8459
8460 The fourth calculation, @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}, has the same problem.
8461 Zero is buried inside the interval, but it's still a possible value.
8462 It's not hard to see that the actual result of @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}
8463 will be either greater than @mathit{0.1}, or less than @mathit{-0.1}. Thus
8464 the interval goes from minus infinity to plus infinity, with a ``hole''
8465 in it from @mathit{-0.1} to @mathit{0.1}. Calc doesn't have any way to
8466 represent this, so it just reports @samp{[-inf .. inf]} as the answer.
8467 It may be disappointing to hear ``the answer lies somewhere between
8468 minus infinity and plus infinity, inclusive,'' but that's the best
8469 that interval arithmetic can do in this case.
8470
8471 @node Types Answer 9, Types Answer 10, Types Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
8472 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 9
8473
8474 @smallexample
8475 @group
8476 1: [-3 .. 3] 2: [-3 .. 3] 2: [0 .. 9]
8477 . 1: [0 .. 9] 1: [-9 .. 9]
8478 . .
8479
8480 [ 3 n .. 3 ] @key{RET} 2 ^ @key{TAB} @key{RET} *
8481 @end group
8482 @end smallexample
8483
8484 @noindent
8485 In the first case the result says, ``if a number is between @mathit{-3} and
8486 3, its square is between 0 and 9.'' The second case says, ``the product
8487 of two numbers each between @mathit{-3} and 3 is between @mathit{-9} and 9.''
8488
8489 An interval form is not a number; it is a symbol that can stand for
8490 many different numbers. Two identical-looking interval forms can stand
8491 for different numbers.
8492
8493 The same issue arises when you try to square an error form.
8494
8495 @node Types Answer 10, Types Answer 11, Types Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
8496 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 10
8497
8498 @noindent
8499 Testing the first number, we might arbitrarily choose 17 for @expr{x}.
8500
8501 @smallexample
8502 @group
8503 1: 17 mod 811749613 2: 17 mod 811749613 1: 533694123 mod 811749613
8504 . 811749612 .
8505 .
8506
8507 17 M 811749613 @key{RET} 811749612 ^
8508 @end group
8509 @end smallexample
8510
8511 @noindent
8512 Since 533694123 is (considerably) different from 1, the number 811749613
8513 must not be prime.
8514
8515 It's awkward to type the number in twice as we did above. There are
8516 various ways to avoid this, and algebraic entry is one. In fact, using
8517 a vector mapping operation we can perform several tests at once. Let's
8518 use this method to test the second number.
8519
8520 @smallexample
8521 @group
8522 2: [17, 42, 100000] 1: [1 mod 15485863, 1 mod ... ]
8523 1: 15485863 .
8524 .
8525
8526 [17 42 100000] 15485863 @key{RET} V M ' ($$ mod $)^($-1) @key{RET}
8527 @end group
8528 @end smallexample
8529
8530 @noindent
8531 The result is three ones (modulo @expr{n}), so it's very probable that
8532 15485863 is prime. (In fact, this number is the millionth prime.)
8533
8534 Note that the functions @samp{($$^($-1)) mod $} or @samp{$$^($-1) % $}
8535 would have been hopelessly inefficient, since they would have calculated
8536 the power using full integer arithmetic.
8537
8538 Calc has a @kbd{k p} command that does primality testing. For small
8539 numbers it does an exact test; for large numbers it uses a variant
8540 of the Fermat test we used here. You can use @kbd{k p} repeatedly
8541 to prove that a large integer is prime with any desired probability.
8542
8543 @node Types Answer 11, Types Answer 12, Types Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
8544 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 11
8545
8546 @noindent
8547 There are several ways to insert a calculated number into an HMS form.
8548 One way to convert a number of seconds to an HMS form is simply to
8549 multiply the number by an HMS form representing one second:
8550
8551 @smallexample
8552 @group
8553 1: 31415926.5359 2: 31415926.5359 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8554 . 1: 0@@ 0' 1" .
8555 .
8556
8557 P 1e7 * 0@@ 0' 1" *
8558
8559 @end group
8560 @end smallexample
8561 @noindent
8562 @smallexample
8563 @group
8564 2: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359" 1: 6@@ 6' 2.5359" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
8565 1: 15@@ 27' 16" mod 24@@ 0' 0" .
8566 .
8567
8568 x time @key{RET} +
8569 @end group
8570 @end smallexample
8571
8572 @noindent
8573 It will be just after six in the morning.
8574
8575 The algebraic @code{hms} function can also be used to build an
8576 HMS form:
8577
8578 @smallexample
8579 @group
8580 1: hms(0, 0, 10000000. pi) 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8581 . .
8582
8583 ' hms(0, 0, 1e7 pi) @key{RET} =
8584 @end group
8585 @end smallexample
8586
8587 @noindent
8588 The @kbd{=} key is necessary to evaluate the symbol @samp{pi} to
8589 the actual number 3.14159...
8590
8591 @node Types Answer 12, Types Answer 13, Types Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
8592 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 12
8593
8594 @noindent
8595 As we recall, there are 17 songs of about 2 minutes and 47 seconds
8596 each.
8597
8598 @smallexample
8599 @group
8600 2: 0@@ 2' 47" 1: [0@@ 3' 7" .. 0@@ 3' 47"]
8601 1: [0@@ 0' 20" .. 0@@ 1' 0"] .
8602 .
8603
8604 [ 0@@ 20" .. 0@@ 1' ] +
8605
8606 @end group
8607 @end smallexample
8608 @noindent
8609 @smallexample
8610 @group
8611 1: [0@@ 52' 59." .. 1@@ 4' 19."]
8612 .
8613
8614 17 *
8615 @end group
8616 @end smallexample
8617
8618 @noindent
8619 No matter how long it is, the album will fit nicely on one CD.
8620
8621 @node Types Answer 13, Types Answer 14, Types Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
8622 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 13
8623
8624 @noindent
8625 Type @kbd{' 1 yr @key{RET} u c s @key{RET}}. The answer is 31557600 seconds.
8626
8627 @node Types Answer 14, Types Answer 15, Types Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
8628 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 14
8629
8630 @noindent
8631 How long will it take for a signal to get from one end of the computer
8632 to the other?
8633
8634 @smallexample
8635 @group
8636 1: m / c 1: 3.3356 ns
8637 . .
8638
8639 ' 1 m / c @key{RET} u c ns @key{RET}
8640 @end group
8641 @end smallexample
8642
8643 @noindent
8644 (Recall, @samp{c} is a ``unit'' corresponding to the speed of light.)
8645
8646 @smallexample
8647 @group
8648 1: 3.3356 ns 1: 0.81356 ns / ns 1: 0.81356
8649 2: 4.1 ns . .
8650 .
8651
8652 ' 4.1 ns @key{RET} / u s
8653 @end group
8654 @end smallexample
8655
8656 @noindent
8657 Thus a signal could take up to 81 percent of a clock cycle just to
8658 go from one place to another inside the computer, assuming the signal
8659 could actually attain the full speed of light. Pretty tight!
8660
8661 @node Types Answer 15, Algebra Answer 1, Types Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
8662 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 15
8663
8664 @noindent
8665 The speed limit is 55 miles per hour on most highways. We want to
8666 find the ratio of Sam's speed to the US speed limit.
8667
8668 @smallexample
8669 @group
8670 1: 55 mph 2: 55 mph 3: 11 hr mph / yd
8671 . 1: 5 yd / hr .
8672 .
8673
8674 ' 55 mph @key{RET} ' 5 yd/hr @key{RET} /
8675 @end group
8676 @end smallexample
8677
8678 The @kbd{u s} command cancels out these units to get a plain
8679 number. Now we take the logarithm base two to find the final
8680 answer, assuming that each successive pill doubles his speed.
8681
8682 @smallexample
8683 @group
8684 1: 19360. 2: 19360. 1: 14.24
8685 . 1: 2 .
8686 .
8687
8688 u s 2 B
8689 @end group
8690 @end smallexample
8691
8692 @noindent
8693 Thus Sam can take up to 14 pills without a worry.
8694
8695 @node Algebra Answer 1, Algebra Answer 2, Types Answer 15, Answers to Exercises
8696 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 1
8697
8698 @noindent
8699 @c [fix-ref Declarations]
8700 The result @samp{sqrt(x)^2} is simplified back to @expr{x} by the
8701 Calculator, but @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is not. (Consider what happens
8702 if @w{@expr{x = -4}}.) If @expr{x} is real, this formula could be
8703 simplified to @samp{abs(x)}, but for general complex arguments even
8704 that is not safe. (@xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell Calc
8705 that @expr{x} is known to be real.)
8706
8707 @node Algebra Answer 2, Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8708 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 2
8709
8710 @noindent
8711 Suppose our roots are @expr{[a, b, c]}. We want a polynomial which
8712 is zero when @expr{x} is any of these values. The trivial polynomial
8713 @expr{x-a} is zero when @expr{x=a}, so the product @expr{(x-a)(x-b)(x-c)}
8714 will do the job. We can use @kbd{a c x} to write this in a more
8715 familiar form.
8716
8717 @smallexample
8718 @group
8719 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [1.19023, -1.19023, 0]
8720 . .
8721
8722 r 2 a P x @key{RET}
8723
8724 @end group
8725 @end smallexample
8726 @noindent
8727 @smallexample
8728 @group
8729 1: [x - 1.19023, x + 1.19023, x] 1: (x - 1.19023) (x + 1.19023) x
8730 . .
8731
8732 V M ' x-$ @key{RET} V R *
8733
8734 @end group
8735 @end smallexample
8736 @noindent
8737 @smallexample
8738 @group
8739 1: x^3 - 1.41666 x 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
8740 . .
8741
8742 a c x @key{RET} 24 n * a x
8743 @end group
8744 @end smallexample
8745
8746 @noindent
8747 Sure enough, our answer (multiplied by a suitable constant) is the
8748 same as the original polynomial.
8749
8750 @node Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 4, Algebra Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8751 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 3
8752
8753 @smallexample
8754 @group
8755 1: x sin(pi x) 1: (sin(pi x) - pi x cos(pi x)) / pi^2
8756 . .
8757
8758 ' x sin(pi x) @key{RET} m r a i x @key{RET}
8759
8760 @end group
8761 @end smallexample
8762 @noindent
8763 @smallexample
8764 @group
8765 1: [y, 1]
8766 2: (sin(pi x) - pi x cos(pi x)) / pi^2
8767 .
8768
8769 ' [y,1] @key{RET} @key{TAB}
8770
8771 @end group
8772 @end smallexample
8773 @noindent
8774 @smallexample
8775 @group
8776 1: [(sin(pi y) - pi y cos(pi y)) / pi^2, (sin(pi) - pi cos(pi)) / pi^2]
8777 .
8778
8779 V M $ @key{RET}
8780
8781 @end group
8782 @end smallexample
8783 @noindent
8784 @smallexample
8785 @group
8786 1: (sin(pi y) - pi y cos(pi y)) / pi^2 + (pi cos(pi) - sin(pi)) / pi^2
8787 .
8788
8789 V R -
8790
8791 @end group
8792 @end smallexample
8793 @noindent
8794 @smallexample
8795 @group
8796 1: (sin(3.14159 y) - 3.14159 y cos(3.14159 y)) / 9.8696 - 0.3183
8797 .
8798
8799 =
8800
8801 @end group
8802 @end smallexample
8803 @noindent
8804 @smallexample
8805 @group
8806 1: [0., -0.95493, 0.63662, -1.5915, 1.2732]
8807 .
8808
8809 v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
8810 @end group
8811 @end smallexample
8812
8813 @node Algebra Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 1, Algebra Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8814 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 4
8815
8816 @noindent
8817 The hard part is that @kbd{V R +} is no longer sufficient to add up all
8818 the contributions from the slices, since the slices have varying
8819 coefficients. So first we must come up with a vector of these
8820 coefficients. Here's one way:
8821
8822 @smallexample
8823 @group
8824 2: -1 2: 3 1: [4, 2, ..., 4]
8825 1: [1, 2, ..., 9] 1: [-1, 1, ..., -1] .
8826 . .
8827
8828 1 n v x 9 @key{RET} V M ^ 3 @key{TAB} -
8829
8830 @end group
8831 @end smallexample
8832 @noindent
8833 @smallexample
8834 @group
8835 1: [4, 2, ..., 4, 1] 1: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8836 . .
8837
8838 1 | 1 @key{TAB} |
8839 @end group
8840 @end smallexample
8841
8842 @noindent
8843 Now we compute the function values. Note that for this method we need
8844 eleven values, including both endpoints of the desired interval.
8845
8846 @smallexample
8847 @group
8848 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8849 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9, 2.]
8850 .
8851
8852 11 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
8853
8854 @end group
8855 @end smallexample
8856 @noindent
8857 @smallexample
8858 @group
8859 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8860 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
8861 .
8862
8863 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
8864 @end group
8865 @end smallexample
8866
8867 @noindent
8868 Once again this calls for @kbd{V M * V R +}; a simple @kbd{*} does the
8869 same thing.
8870
8871 @smallexample
8872 @group
8873 1: 11.22 1: 1.122 1: 0.374
8874 . . .
8875
8876 * .1 * 3 /
8877 @end group
8878 @end smallexample
8879
8880 @noindent
8881 Wow! That's even better than the result from the Taylor series method.
8882
8883 @node Rewrites Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 2, Algebra Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8884 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 1
8885
8886 @noindent
8887 We'll use Big mode to make the formulas more readable.
8888
8889 @smallexample
8890 @group
8891 ___
8892 2 + V 2
8893 1: (2 + sqrt(2)) / (1 + sqrt(2)) 1: --------
8894 . ___
8895 1 + V 2
8896
8897 .
8898
8899 ' (2+sqrt(2)) / (1+sqrt(2)) @key{RET} d B
8900 @end group
8901 @end smallexample
8902
8903 @noindent
8904 Multiplying by the conjugate helps because @expr{(a+b) (a-b) = a^2 - b^2}.
8905
8906 @smallexample
8907 @group
8908 ___ ___
8909 1: (2 + V 2 ) (V 2 - 1)
8910 .
8911
8912 a r a/(b+c) := a*(b-c) / (b^2-c^2) @key{RET}
8913
8914 @end group
8915 @end smallexample
8916 @noindent
8917 @smallexample
8918 @group
8919 ___ ___
8920 1: 2 + V 2 - 2 1: V 2
8921 . .
8922
8923 a r a*(b+c) := a*b + a*c a s
8924 @end group
8925 @end smallexample
8926
8927 @noindent
8928 (We could have used @kbd{a x} instead of a rewrite rule for the
8929 second step.)
8930
8931 The multiply-by-conjugate rule turns out to be useful in many
8932 different circumstances, such as when the denominator involves
8933 sines and cosines or the imaginary constant @code{i}.
8934
8935 @node Rewrites Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8936 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 2
8937
8938 @noindent
8939 Here is the rule set:
8940
8941 @smallexample
8942 @group
8943 [ fib(n) := fib(n, 1, 1) :: integer(n) :: n >= 1,
8944 fib(1, x, y) := x,
8945 fib(n, x, y) := fib(n-1, y, x+y) ]
8946 @end group
8947 @end smallexample
8948
8949 @noindent
8950 The first rule turns a one-argument @code{fib} that people like to write
8951 into a three-argument @code{fib} that makes computation easier. The
8952 second rule converts back from three-argument form once the computation
8953 is done. The third rule does the computation itself. It basically
8954 says that if @expr{x} and @expr{y} are two consecutive Fibonacci numbers,
8955 then @expr{y} and @expr{x+y} are the next (overlapping) pair of Fibonacci
8956 numbers.
8957
8958 Notice that because the number @expr{n} was ``validated'' by the
8959 conditions on the first rule, there is no need to put conditions on
8960 the other rules because the rule set would never get that far unless
8961 the input were valid. That further speeds computation, since no
8962 extra conditions need to be checked at every step.
8963
8964 Actually, a user with a nasty sense of humor could enter a bad
8965 three-argument @code{fib} call directly, say, @samp{fib(0, 1, 1)},
8966 which would get the rules into an infinite loop. One thing that would
8967 help keep this from happening by accident would be to use something like
8968 @samp{ZzFib} instead of @code{fib} as the name of the three-argument
8969 function.
8970
8971 @node Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8972 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 3
8973
8974 @noindent
8975 He got an infinite loop. First, Calc did as expected and rewrote
8976 @w{@samp{2 + 3 x}} to @samp{f(2, 3, x)}. Then it looked for ways to
8977 apply the rule again, and found that @samp{f(2, 3, x)} looks like
8978 @samp{a + b x} with @w{@samp{a = 0}} and @samp{b = 1}, so it rewrote to
8979 @samp{f(0, 1, f(2, 3, x))}. It then wrapped another @samp{f(0, 1, ...)}
8980 around that, and so on, ad infinitum. Joe should have used @kbd{M-1 a r}
8981 to make sure the rule applied only once.
8982
8983 (Actually, even the first step didn't work as he expected. What Calc
8984 really gives for @kbd{M-1 a r} in this situation is @samp{f(3 x, 1, 2)},
8985 treating 2 as the ``variable,'' and @samp{3 x} as a constant being added
8986 to it. While this may seem odd, it's just as valid a solution as the
8987 ``obvious'' one. One way to fix this would be to add the condition
8988 @samp{:: variable(x)} to the rule, to make sure the thing that matches
8989 @samp{x} is indeed a variable, or to change @samp{x} to @samp{quote(x)}
8990 on the lefthand side, so that the rule matches the actual variable
8991 @samp{x} rather than letting @samp{x} stand for something else.)
8992
8993 @node Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8994 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 4
8995
8996 @noindent
8997 @ignore
8998 @starindex
8999 @end ignore
9000 @tindex seq
9001 Here is a suitable set of rules to solve the first part of the problem:
9002
9003 @smallexample
9004 @group
9005 [ seq(n, c) := seq(n/2, c+1) :: n%2 = 0,
9006 seq(n, c) := seq(3n+1, c+1) :: n%2 = 1 :: n > 1 ]
9007 @end group
9008 @end smallexample
9009
9010 Given the initial formula @samp{seq(6, 0)}, application of these
9011 rules produces the following sequence of formulas:
9012
9013 @example
9014 seq( 3, 1)
9015 seq(10, 2)
9016 seq( 5, 3)
9017 seq(16, 4)
9018 seq( 8, 5)
9019 seq( 4, 6)
9020 seq( 2, 7)
9021 seq( 1, 8)
9022 @end example
9023
9024 @noindent
9025 whereupon neither of the rules match, and rewriting stops.
9026
9027 We can pretty this up a bit with a couple more rules:
9028
9029 @smallexample
9030 @group
9031 [ seq(n) := seq(n, 0),
9032 seq(1, c) := c,
9033 ... ]
9034 @end group
9035 @end smallexample
9036
9037 @noindent
9038 Now, given @samp{seq(6)} as the starting configuration, we get 8
9039 as the result.
9040
9041 The change to return a vector is quite simple:
9042
9043 @smallexample
9044 @group
9045 [ seq(n) := seq(n, []) :: integer(n) :: n > 0,
9046 seq(1, v) := v | 1,
9047 seq(n, v) := seq(n/2, v | n) :: n%2 = 0,
9048 seq(n, v) := seq(3n+1, v | n) :: n%2 = 1 ]
9049 @end group
9050 @end smallexample
9051
9052 @noindent
9053 Given @samp{seq(6)}, the result is @samp{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
9054
9055 Notice that the @expr{n > 1} guard is no longer necessary on the last
9056 rule since the @expr{n = 1} case is now detected by another rule.
9057 But a guard has been added to the initial rule to make sure the
9058 initial value is suitable before the computation begins.
9059
9060 While still a good idea, this guard is not as vitally important as it
9061 was for the @code{fib} function, since calling, say, @samp{seq(x, [])}
9062 will not get into an infinite loop. Calc will not be able to prove
9063 the symbol @samp{x} is either even or odd, so none of the rules will
9064 apply and the rewrites will stop right away.
9065
9066 @node Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 6, Rewrites Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
9067 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 5
9068
9069 @noindent
9070 @ignore
9071 @starindex
9072 @end ignore
9073 @tindex nterms
9074 If @expr{x} is the sum @expr{a + b}, then `@t{nterms(}@var{x}@t{)}' must
9075 be `@t{nterms(}@var{a}@t{)}' plus `@t{nterms(}@var{b}@t{)}'. If @expr{x}
9076 is not a sum, then `@t{nterms(}@var{x}@t{)}' = 1.
9077
9078 @smallexample
9079 @group
9080 [ nterms(a + b) := nterms(a) + nterms(b),
9081 nterms(x) := 1 ]
9082 @end group
9083 @end smallexample
9084
9085 @noindent
9086 Here we have taken advantage of the fact that earlier rules always
9087 match before later rules; @samp{nterms(x)} will only be tried if we
9088 already know that @samp{x} is not a sum.
9089
9090 @node Rewrites Answer 6, Programming Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
9091 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 6
9092
9093 @noindent
9094 Here is a rule set that will do the job:
9095
9096 @smallexample
9097 @group
9098 [ a*(b + c) := a*b + a*c,
9099 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) O(x^m) := O(x^n) :: n <= m
9100 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
9101 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) x^m := O(x^n) :: n <= m
9102 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
9103 a O(x^n) := O(x^n) :: constant(a),
9104 x^opt(m) O(x^n) := O(x^(n+m)),
9105 O(x^n) O(x^m) := O(x^(n+m)) ]
9106 @end group
9107 @end smallexample
9108
9109 If we really want the @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} keys to operate naturally
9110 on power series, we should put these rules in @code{EvalRules}. For
9111 testing purposes, it is better to put them in a different variable,
9112 say, @code{O}, first.
9113
9114 The first rule just expands products of sums so that the rest of the
9115 rules can assume they have an expanded-out polynomial to work with.
9116 Note that this rule does not mention @samp{O} at all, so it will
9117 apply to any product-of-sum it encounters---this rule may surprise
9118 you if you put it into @code{EvalRules}!
9119
9120 In the second rule, the sum of two O's is changed to the smaller O.
9121 The optional constant coefficients are there mostly so that
9122 @samp{O(x^2) - O(x^3)} and @samp{O(x^3) - O(x^2)} are handled
9123 as well as @samp{O(x^2) + O(x^3)}.
9124
9125 The third rule absorbs higher powers of @samp{x} into O's.
9126
9127 The fourth rule says that a constant times a negligible quantity
9128 is still negligible. (This rule will also match @samp{O(x^3) / 4},
9129 with @samp{a = 1/4}.)
9130
9131 The fifth rule rewrites, for example, @samp{x^2 O(x^3)} to @samp{O(x^5)}.
9132 (It is easy to see that if one of these forms is negligible, the other
9133 is, too.) Notice the @samp{x^opt(m)} to pick up terms like
9134 @w{@samp{x O(x^3)}}. Optional powers will match @samp{x} as @samp{x^1}
9135 but not 1 as @samp{x^0}. This turns out to be exactly what we want here.
9136
9137 The sixth rule is the corresponding rule for products of two O's.
9138
9139 Another way to solve this problem would be to create a new ``data type''
9140 that represents truncated power series. We might represent these as
9141 function calls @samp{series(@var{coefs}, @var{x})} where @var{coefs} is
9142 a vector of coefficients for @expr{x^0}, @expr{x^1}, @expr{x^2}, and so
9143 on. Rules would exist for sums and products of such @code{series}
9144 objects, and as an optional convenience could also know how to combine a
9145 @code{series} object with a normal polynomial. (With this, and with a
9146 rule that rewrites @samp{O(x^n)} to the equivalent @code{series} form,
9147 you could still enter power series in exactly the same notation as
9148 before.) Operations on such objects would probably be more efficient,
9149 although the objects would be a bit harder to read.
9150
9151 @c [fix-ref Compositions]
9152 Some other symbolic math programs provide a power series data type
9153 similar to this. Mathematica, for example, has an object that looks
9154 like @samp{PowerSeries[@var{x}, @var{x0}, @var{coefs}, @var{nmin},
9155 @var{nmax}, @var{den}]}, where @var{x0} is the point about which the
9156 power series is taken (we've been assuming this was always zero),
9157 and @var{nmin}, @var{nmax}, and @var{den} allow pseudo-power-series
9158 with fractional or negative powers. Also, the @code{PowerSeries}
9159 objects have a special display format that makes them look like
9160 @samp{2 x^2 + O(x^4)} when they are printed out. (@xref{Compositions},
9161 for a way to do this in Calc, although for something as involved as
9162 this it would probably be better to write the formatting routine
9163 in Lisp.)
9164
9165 @node Programming Answer 1, Programming Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
9166 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 1
9167
9168 @noindent
9169 Just enter the formula @samp{ninteg(sin(t)/t, t, 0, x)}, type
9170 @kbd{Z F}, and answer the questions. Since this formula contains two
9171 variables, the default argument list will be @samp{(t x)}. We want to
9172 change this to @samp{(x)} since @expr{t} is really a dummy variable
9173 to be used within @code{ninteg}.
9174
9175 The exact keystrokes are @kbd{Z F s Si @key{RET} @key{RET} C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL} @key{RET} y}.
9176 (The @kbd{C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL}} are what fix the argument list.)
9177
9178 @node Programming Answer 2, Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
9179 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 2
9180
9181 @noindent
9182 One way is to move the number to the top of the stack, operate on
9183 it, then move it back: @kbd{C-x ( M-@key{TAB} n M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} C-x )}.
9184
9185 Another way is to negate the top three stack entries, then negate
9186 again the top two stack entries: @kbd{C-x ( M-3 n M-2 n C-x )}.
9187
9188 Finally, it turns out that a negative prefix argument causes a
9189 command like @kbd{n} to operate on the specified stack entry only,
9190 which is just what we want: @kbd{C-x ( M-- 3 n C-x )}.
9191
9192 Just for kicks, let's also do it algebraically:
9193 @w{@kbd{C-x ( ' -$$$, $$, $ @key{RET} C-x )}}.
9194
9195 @node Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
9196 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 3
9197
9198 @noindent
9199 Each of these functions can be computed using the stack, or using
9200 algebraic entry, whichever way you prefer:
9201
9202 @noindent
9203 Computing
9204 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}}:
9205 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x}:
9206
9207 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} S @key{TAB} / C-x )}.
9208
9209 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' sin($)/$ @key{RET} C-x )}.
9210
9211 @noindent
9212 Computing the logarithm:
9213
9214 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{TAB} B C-x )}
9215
9216 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' log($,$$) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9217
9218 @noindent
9219 Computing the vector of integers:
9220
9221 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x C-x )}. (Recall that
9222 @kbd{C-u v x} takes the vector size, starting value, and increment
9223 from the stack.)
9224
9225 Alternatively: @kbd{C-x ( ~ v x C-x )}. (The @kbd{~} key pops a
9226 number from the stack and uses it as the prefix argument for the
9227 next command.)
9228
9229 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' index($) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9230
9231 @node Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
9232 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 4
9233
9234 @noindent
9235 Here's one way: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} V R + @key{TAB} v l / C-x )}.
9236
9237 @node Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
9238 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 5
9239
9240 @smallexample
9241 @group
9242 2: 1 1: 1.61803398502 2: 1.61803398502
9243 1: 20 . 1: 1.61803398875
9244 . .
9245
9246 1 @key{RET} 20 Z < & 1 + Z > I H P
9247 @end group
9248 @end smallexample
9249
9250 @noindent
9251 This answer is quite accurate.
9252
9253 @node Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
9254 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 6
9255
9256 @noindent
9257 Here is the matrix:
9258
9259 @example
9260 [ [ 0, 1 ] * [a, b] = [b, a + b]
9261 [ 1, 1 ] ]
9262 @end example
9263
9264 @noindent
9265 Thus @samp{[0, 1; 1, 1]^n * [1, 1]} computes Fibonacci numbers @expr{n+1}
9266 and @expr{n+2}. Here's one program that does the job:
9267
9268 @example
9269 C-x ( ' [0, 1; 1, 1] ^ ($-1) * [1, 1] @key{RET} v u @key{DEL} C-x )
9270 @end example
9271
9272 @noindent
9273 This program is quite efficient because Calc knows how to raise a
9274 matrix (or other value) to the power @expr{n} in only
9275 @texline @math{\log_2 n}
9276 @infoline @expr{log(n,2)}
9277 steps. For example, this program can compute the 1000th Fibonacci
9278 number (a 209-digit integer!) in about 10 steps; even though the
9279 @kbd{Z < ... Z >} solution had much simpler steps, it would have
9280 required so many steps that it would not have been practical.
9281
9282 @node Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
9283 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 7
9284
9285 @noindent
9286 The trick here is to compute the harmonic numbers differently, so that
9287 the loop counter itself accumulates the sum of reciprocals. We use
9288 a separate variable to hold the integer counter.
9289
9290 @smallexample
9291 @group
9292 1: 1 2: 1 1: .
9293 . 1: 4
9294 .
9295
9296 1 t 1 1 @key{RET} 4 Z ( t 2 r 1 1 + s 1 & Z )
9297 @end group
9298 @end smallexample
9299
9300 @noindent
9301 The body of the loop goes as follows: First save the harmonic sum
9302 so far in variable 2. Then delete it from the stack; the for loop
9303 itself will take care of remembering it for us. Next, recall the
9304 count from variable 1, add one to it, and feed its reciprocal to
9305 the for loop to use as the step value. The for loop will increase
9306 the ``loop counter'' by that amount and keep going until the
9307 loop counter exceeds 4.
9308
9309 @smallexample
9310 @group
9311 2: 31 3: 31
9312 1: 3.99498713092 2: 3.99498713092
9313 . 1: 4.02724519544
9314 .
9315
9316 r 1 r 2 @key{RET} 31 & +
9317 @end group
9318 @end smallexample
9319
9320 Thus we find that the 30th harmonic number is 3.99, and the 31st
9321 harmonic number is 4.02.
9322
9323 @node Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
9324 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 8
9325
9326 @noindent
9327 The first step is to compute the derivative @expr{f'(x)} and thus
9328 the formula
9329 @texline @math{\displaystyle{x - {f(x) \over f'(x)}}}.
9330 @infoline @expr{x - f(x)/f'(x)}.
9331
9332 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9333 below. You can use @w{@kbd{M-# m}} to load it from there. While you are
9334 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9335 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9336 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9337 just for purposes of illustration.)
9338
9339 @smallexample
9340 @group
9341 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5 3: 4.5
9342 1: 4.5 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5
9343 . 1: -(sin(x) cos(cos(x)))
9344 .
9345
9346 ' sin(cos(x))-0.5 @key{RET} 4.5 m r C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET}
9347
9348 @end group
9349 @end smallexample
9350 @noindent
9351 @smallexample
9352 @group
9353 2: 4.5
9354 1: x + (sin(cos(x)) - 0.5) / sin(x) cos(cos(x))
9355 .
9356
9357 / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9358 @end group
9359 @end smallexample
9360
9361 Now, we enter the loop. We'll use a repeat loop with a 20-repetition
9362 limit just in case the method fails to converge for some reason.
9363 (Normally, the @w{@kbd{Z /}} command will stop the loop before all 20
9364 repetitions are done.)
9365
9366 @smallexample
9367 @group
9368 1: 4.5 3: 4.5 2: 4.5
9369 . 2: x + (sin(cos(x)) ... 1: 5.24196456928
9370 1: 4.5 .
9371 .
9372
9373 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9374 @end group
9375 @end smallexample
9376
9377 This is the new guess for @expr{x}. Now we compare it with the
9378 old one to see if we've converged.
9379
9380 @smallexample
9381 @group
9382 3: 5.24196 2: 5.24196 1: 5.24196 1: 5.26345856348
9383 2: 5.24196 1: 0 . .
9384 1: 4.5 .
9385 .
9386
9387 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / Z > Z ' C-x )
9388 @end group
9389 @end smallexample
9390
9391 The loop converges in just a few steps to this value. To check
9392 the result, we can simply substitute it back into the equation.
9393
9394 @smallexample
9395 @group
9396 2: 5.26345856348
9397 1: 0.499999999997
9398 .
9399
9400 @key{RET} ' sin(cos($)) @key{RET}
9401 @end group
9402 @end smallexample
9403
9404 Let's test the new definition again:
9405
9406 @smallexample
9407 @group
9408 2: x^2 - 9 1: 3.
9409 1: 1 .
9410 .
9411
9412 ' x^2-9 @key{RET} 1 X
9413 @end group
9414 @end smallexample
9415
9416 Once again, here's the full Newton's Method definition:
9417
9418 @example
9419 @group
9420 C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET} / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9421 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9422 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9423 Z >
9424 Z '
9425 C-x )
9426 @end group
9427 @end example
9428
9429 @c [fix-ref Nesting and Fixed Points]
9430 It turns out that Calc has a built-in command for applying a formula
9431 repeatedly until it converges to a number. @xref{Nesting and Fixed Points},
9432 to see how to use it.
9433
9434 @c [fix-ref Root Finding]
9435 Also, of course, @kbd{a R} is a built-in command that uses Newton's
9436 method (among others) to look for numerical solutions to any equation.
9437 @xref{Root Finding}.
9438
9439 @node Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
9440 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 9
9441
9442 @noindent
9443 The first step is to adjust @expr{z} to be greater than 5. A simple
9444 ``for'' loop will do the job here. If @expr{z} is less than 5, we
9445 reduce the problem using
9446 @texline @math{\psi(z) = \psi(z+1) - 1/z}.
9447 @infoline @expr{psi(z) = psi(z+1) - 1/z}. We go
9448 on to compute
9449 @texline @math{\psi(z+1)},
9450 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1)},
9451 and remember to add back a factor of @expr{-1/z} when we're done. This
9452 step is repeated until @expr{z > 5}.
9453
9454 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9455 below. You can use @w{@kbd{M-# m}} to load it from there. While you are
9456 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9457 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9458 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9459 just for purposes of illustration.)
9460
9461 @smallexample
9462 @group
9463 1: 1. 1: 1.
9464 . .
9465
9466 1.0 @key{RET} C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9467 @end group
9468 @end smallexample
9469
9470 Here, variable 1 holds @expr{z} and variable 2 holds the adjustment
9471 factor. If @expr{z < 5}, we use a loop to increase it.
9472
9473 (By the way, we started with @samp{1.0} instead of the integer 1 because
9474 otherwise the calculation below will try to do exact fractional arithmetic,
9475 and will never converge because fractions compare equal only if they
9476 are exactly equal, not just equal to within the current precision.)
9477
9478 @smallexample
9479 @group
9480 3: 1. 2: 1. 1: 6.
9481 2: 1. 1: 1 .
9482 1: 5 .
9483 .
9484
9485 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9486 @end group
9487 @end smallexample
9488
9489 Now we compute the initial part of the sum:
9490 @texline @math{\ln z - {1 \over 2z}}
9491 @infoline @expr{ln(z) - 1/2z}
9492 minus the adjustment factor.
9493
9494 @smallexample
9495 @group
9496 2: 1.79175946923 2: 1.7084261359 1: -0.57490719743
9497 1: 0.0833333333333 1: 2.28333333333 .
9498 . .
9499
9500 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9501 @end group
9502 @end smallexample
9503
9504 Now we evaluate the series. We'll use another ``for'' loop counting
9505 up the value of @expr{2 n}. (Calc does have a summation command,
9506 @kbd{a +}, but we'll use loops just to get more practice with them.)
9507
9508 @smallexample
9509 @group
9510 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5749 4: -0.5749 2: -0.5749
9511 2: 2 2: 1:6 3: 1:6 1: 2.3148e-3
9512 1: 40 1: 2 2: 2 .
9513 . . 1: 36.
9514 .
9515
9516 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9517
9518 @end group
9519 @end smallexample
9520 @noindent
9521 @smallexample
9522 @group
9523 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5772 2: -0.5772 1: -0.577215664892
9524 2: -0.5749 2: -0.5772 1: 0 .
9525 1: 2.3148e-3 1: -0.5749 .
9526 . .
9527
9528 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / 2 Z ) Z ' C-x )
9529 @end group
9530 @end smallexample
9531
9532 This is the value of
9533 @texline @math{-\gamma},
9534 @infoline @expr{- gamma},
9535 with a slight bit of roundoff error. To get a full 12 digits, let's use
9536 a higher precision:
9537
9538 @smallexample
9539 @group
9540 2: -0.577215664892 2: -0.577215664892
9541 1: 1. 1: -0.577215664901532
9542
9543 1. @key{RET} p 16 @key{RET} X
9544 @end group
9545 @end smallexample
9546
9547 Here's the complete sequence of keystrokes:
9548
9549 @example
9550 @group
9551 C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9552 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9553 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9554 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9555 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9556 2 Z )
9557 Z '
9558 C-x )
9559 @end group
9560 @end example
9561
9562 @node Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
9563 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 10
9564
9565 @noindent
9566 Taking the derivative of a term of the form @expr{x^n} will produce
9567 a term like
9568 @texline @math{n x^{n-1}}.
9569 @infoline @expr{n x^(n-1)}.
9570 Taking the derivative of a constant
9571 produces zero. From this it is easy to see that the @expr{n}th
9572 derivative of a polynomial, evaluated at @expr{x = 0}, will equal the
9573 coefficient on the @expr{x^n} term times @expr{n!}.
9574
9575 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9576 below. You can use @w{@kbd{M-# m}} to load it from there. While you are
9577 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9578 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9579 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9580 just for purposes of illustration.)
9581
9582 @smallexample
9583 @group
9584 2: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2 3: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2
9585 1: 6 2: 0
9586 . 1: 6
9587 .
9588
9589 ' 5 x^4 + (x+1)^2 @key{RET} 6 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9590 @end group
9591 @end smallexample
9592
9593 @noindent
9594 Variable 1 will accumulate the vector of coefficients.
9595
9596 @smallexample
9597 @group
9598 2: 0 3: 0 2: 5 x^4 + ...
9599 1: 5 x^4 + ... 2: 5 x^4 + ... 1: 1
9600 . 1: 1 .
9601 .
9602
9603 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9604 @end group
9605 @end smallexample
9606
9607 @noindent
9608 Note that @kbd{s | 1} appends the top-of-stack value to the vector
9609 in a variable; it is completely analogous to @kbd{s + 1}. We could
9610 have written instead, @kbd{r 1 @key{TAB} | t 1}.
9611
9612 @smallexample
9613 @group
9614 1: 20 x^3 + 2 x + 2 1: 0 1: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9615 . . .
9616
9617 a d x @key{RET} 1 Z ) @key{DEL} r 1 Z ' C-x )
9618 @end group
9619 @end smallexample
9620
9621 To convert back, a simple method is just to map the coefficients
9622 against a table of powers of @expr{x}.
9623
9624 @smallexample
9625 @group
9626 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9627 1: 6 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
9628 . .
9629
9630 6 @key{RET} 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x
9631
9632 @end group
9633 @end smallexample
9634 @noindent
9635 @smallexample
9636 @group
9637 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: 1 + 2 x + x^2 + 5 x^4
9638 1: [1, x, x^2, x^3, ... ] .
9639 .
9640
9641 ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ *
9642 @end group
9643 @end smallexample
9644
9645 Once again, here are the whole polynomial to/from vector programs:
9646
9647 @example
9648 @group
9649 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9650 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9651 a d x @key{RET}
9652 1 Z ) r 1
9653 Z '
9654 C-x )
9655
9656 C-x ( 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ * C-x )
9657 @end group
9658 @end example
9659
9660 @node Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 12, Programming Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
9661 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 11
9662
9663 @noindent
9664 First we define a dummy program to go on the @kbd{z s} key. The true
9665 @w{@kbd{z s}} key is supposed to take two numbers from the stack and
9666 return one number, so @key{DEL} as a dummy definition will make
9667 sure the stack comes out right.
9668
9669 @smallexample
9670 @group
9671 2: 4 1: 4 2: 4
9672 1: 2 . 1: 2
9673 . .
9674
9675 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( @key{DEL} C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} 2
9676 @end group
9677 @end smallexample
9678
9679 The last step replaces the 2 that was eaten during the creation
9680 of the dummy @kbd{z s} command. Now we move on to the real
9681 definition. The recurrence needs to be rewritten slightly,
9682 to the form @expr{s(n,m) = s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m)}.
9683
9684 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9685 below. You can use @kbd{M-# m} to load it from there.)
9686
9687 @smallexample
9688 @group
9689 2: 4 4: 4 3: 4 2: 4
9690 1: 2 3: 2 2: 2 1: 2
9691 . 2: 4 1: 0 .
9692 1: 2 .
9693 .
9694
9695 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1 Z :
9696
9697 @end group
9698 @end smallexample
9699 @noindent
9700 @smallexample
9701 @group
9702 4: 4 2: 4 2: 3 4: 3 4: 3 3: 3
9703 3: 2 1: 2 1: 2 3: 2 3: 2 2: 2
9704 2: 2 . . 2: 3 2: 3 1: 3
9705 1: 0 1: 2 1: 1 .
9706 . . .
9707
9708 @key{RET} 0 a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9709 @end group
9710 @end smallexample
9711
9712 @noindent
9713 (Note that the value 3 that our dummy @kbd{z s} produces is not correct;
9714 it is merely a placeholder that will do just as well for now.)
9715
9716 @smallexample
9717 @group
9718 3: 3 4: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: -6
9719 2: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: 9 .
9720 1: 2 2: 3 1: 3 .
9721 . 1: 2 .
9722 .
9723
9724 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9725
9726 @end group
9727 @end smallexample
9728 @noindent
9729 @smallexample
9730 @group
9731 1: -6 2: 4 1: 11 2: 11
9732 . 1: 2 . 1: 11
9733 . .
9734
9735 Z ] Z ] C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} @key{DEL} 4 @key{RET} 2 z s M-@key{RET} k s
9736 @end group
9737 @end smallexample
9738
9739 Even though the result that we got during the definition was highly
9740 bogus, once the definition is complete the @kbd{z s} command gets
9741 the right answers.
9742
9743 Here's the full program once again:
9744
9745 @example
9746 @group
9747 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a =
9748 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1
9749 Z : @key{RET} 0 a =
9750 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0
9751 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9752 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9753 Z ]
9754 Z ]
9755 C-x )
9756 @end group
9757 @end example
9758
9759 You can read this definition using @kbd{M-# m} (@code{read-kbd-macro})
9760 followed by @kbd{Z K s}, without having to make a dummy definition
9761 first, because @code{read-kbd-macro} doesn't need to execute the
9762 definition as it reads it in. For this reason, @code{M-# m} is often
9763 the easiest way to create recursive programs in Calc.
9764
9765 @node Programming Answer 12, , Programming Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
9766 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 12
9767
9768 @noindent
9769 This turns out to be a much easier way to solve the problem. Let's
9770 denote Stirling numbers as calls of the function @samp{s}.
9771
9772 First, we store the rewrite rules corresponding to the definition of
9773 Stirling numbers in a convenient variable:
9774
9775 @smallexample
9776 s e StirlingRules @key{RET}
9777 [ s(n,n) := 1 :: n >= 0,
9778 s(n,0) := 0 :: n > 0,
9779 s(n,m) := s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m) :: n >= m :: m >= 1 ]
9780 C-c C-c
9781 @end smallexample
9782
9783 Now, it's just a matter of applying the rules:
9784
9785 @smallexample
9786 @group
9787 2: 4 1: s(4, 2) 1: 11
9788 1: 2 . .
9789 .
9790
9791 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( ' s($$,$) @key{RET} a r StirlingRules @key{RET} C-x )
9792 @end group
9793 @end smallexample
9794
9795 As in the case of the @code{fib} rules, it would be useful to put these
9796 rules in @code{EvalRules} and to add a @samp{:: remember} condition to
9797 the last rule.
9798
9799 @c This ends the table-of-contents kludge from above:
9800 @tex
9801 \global\let\chapternofonts=\oldchapternofonts
9802 @end tex
9803
9804 @c [reference]
9805
9806 @node Introduction, Data Types, Tutorial, Top
9807 @chapter Introduction
9808
9809 @noindent
9810 This chapter is the beginning of the Calc reference manual.
9811 It covers basic concepts such as the stack, algebraic and
9812 numeric entry, undo, numeric prefix arguments, etc.
9813
9814 @c [when-split]
9815 @c (Chapter 2, the Tutorial, has been printed in a separate volume.)
9816
9817 @menu
9818 * Basic Commands::
9819 * Help Commands::
9820 * Stack Basics::
9821 * Numeric Entry::
9822 * Algebraic Entry::
9823 * Quick Calculator::
9824 * Keypad Mode::
9825 * Prefix Arguments::
9826 * Undo::
9827 * Error Messages::
9828 * Multiple Calculators::
9829 * Troubleshooting Commands::
9830 @end menu
9831
9832 @node Basic Commands, Help Commands, Introduction, Introduction
9833 @section Basic Commands
9834
9835 @noindent
9836 @pindex calc
9837 @pindex calc-mode
9838 @cindex Starting the Calculator
9839 @cindex Running the Calculator
9840 To start the Calculator in its standard interface, type @kbd{M-x calc}.
9841 By default this creates a pair of small windows, @samp{*Calculator*}
9842 and @samp{*Calc Trail*}. The former displays the contents of the
9843 Calculator stack and is manipulated exclusively through Calc commands.
9844 It is possible (though not usually necessary) to create several Calc
9845 mode buffers each of which has an independent stack, undo list, and
9846 mode settings. There is exactly one Calc Trail buffer; it records a
9847 list of the results of all calculations that have been done. The
9848 Calc Trail buffer uses a variant of Calc mode, so Calculator commands
9849 still work when the trail buffer's window is selected. It is possible
9850 to turn the trail window off, but the @samp{*Calc Trail*} buffer itself
9851 still exists and is updated silently. @xref{Trail Commands}.
9852
9853 @kindex M-# c
9854 @kindex M-# M-#
9855 @ignore
9856 @mindex @null
9857 @end ignore
9858 @kindex M-# #
9859 In most installations, the @kbd{M-# c} key sequence is a more
9860 convenient way to start the Calculator. Also, @kbd{M-# M-#} and
9861 @kbd{M-# #} are synonyms for @kbd{M-# c} unless you last used Calc
9862 in its Keypad mode.
9863
9864 @kindex x
9865 @kindex M-x
9866 @pindex calc-execute-extended-command
9867 Most Calc commands use one or two keystrokes. Lower- and upper-case
9868 letters are distinct. Commands may also be entered in full @kbd{M-x} form;
9869 for some commands this is the only form. As a convenience, the @kbd{x}
9870 key (@code{calc-execute-extended-command})
9871 is like @kbd{M-x} except that it enters the initial string @samp{calc-}
9872 for you. For example, the following key sequences are equivalent:
9873 @kbd{S}, @kbd{M-x calc-sin @key{RET}}, @kbd{x sin @key{RET}}.
9874
9875 @cindex Extensions module
9876 @cindex @file{calc-ext} module
9877 The Calculator exists in many parts. When you type @kbd{M-# c}, the
9878 Emacs ``auto-load'' mechanism will bring in only the first part, which
9879 contains the basic arithmetic functions. The other parts will be
9880 auto-loaded the first time you use the more advanced commands like trig
9881 functions or matrix operations. This is done to improve the response time
9882 of the Calculator in the common case when all you need to do is a
9883 little arithmetic. If for some reason the Calculator fails to load an
9884 extension module automatically, you can force it to load all the
9885 extensions by using the @kbd{M-# L} (@code{calc-load-everything})
9886 command. @xref{Mode Settings}.
9887
9888 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} or @kbd{M-# c} with any numeric prefix argument,
9889 the Calculator is loaded if necessary, but it is not actually started.
9890 If the argument is positive, the @file{calc-ext} extensions are also
9891 loaded if necessary. User-written Lisp code that wishes to make use
9892 of Calc's arithmetic routines can use @samp{(calc 0)} or @samp{(calc 1)}
9893 to auto-load the Calculator.
9894
9895 @kindex M-# b
9896 @pindex full-calc
9897 If you type @kbd{M-# b}, then next time you use @kbd{M-# c} you
9898 will get a Calculator that uses the full height of the Emacs screen.
9899 When full-screen mode is on, @kbd{M-# c} runs the @code{full-calc}
9900 command instead of @code{calc}. From the Unix shell you can type
9901 @samp{emacs -f full-calc} to start a new Emacs specifically for use
9902 as a calculator. When Calc is started from the Emacs command line
9903 like this, Calc's normal ``quit'' commands actually quit Emacs itself.
9904
9905 @kindex M-# o
9906 @pindex calc-other-window
9907 The @kbd{M-# o} command is like @kbd{M-# c} except that the Calc
9908 window is not actually selected. If you are already in the Calc
9909 window, @kbd{M-# o} switches you out of it. (The regular Emacs
9910 @kbd{C-x o} command would also work for this, but it has a
9911 tendency to drop you into the Calc Trail window instead, which
9912 @kbd{M-# o} takes care not to do.)
9913
9914 @ignore
9915 @mindex M-# q
9916 @end ignore
9917 For one quick calculation, you can type @kbd{M-# q} (@code{quick-calc})
9918 which prompts you for a formula (like @samp{2+3/4}). The result is
9919 displayed at the bottom of the Emacs screen without ever creating
9920 any special Calculator windows. @xref{Quick Calculator}.
9921
9922 @ignore
9923 @mindex M-# k
9924 @end ignore
9925 Finally, if you are using the X window system you may want to try
9926 @kbd{M-# k} (@code{calc-keypad}) which runs Calc with a
9927 ``calculator keypad'' picture as well as a stack display. Click on
9928 the keys with the mouse to operate the calculator. @xref{Keypad Mode}.
9929
9930 @kindex q
9931 @pindex calc-quit
9932 @cindex Quitting the Calculator
9933 @cindex Exiting the Calculator
9934 The @kbd{q} key (@code{calc-quit}) exits Calc mode and closes the
9935 Calculator's window(s). It does not delete the Calculator buffers.
9936 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} again, the Calculator will reappear with the
9937 contents of the stack intact. Typing @kbd{M-# c} or @kbd{M-# M-#}
9938 again from inside the Calculator buffer is equivalent to executing
9939 @code{calc-quit}; you can think of @kbd{M-# M-#} as toggling the
9940 Calculator on and off.
9941
9942 @kindex M-# x
9943 The @kbd{M-# x} command also turns the Calculator off, no matter which
9944 user interface (standard, Keypad, or Embedded) is currently active.
9945 It also cancels @code{calc-edit} mode if used from there.
9946
9947 @kindex d @key{SPC}
9948 @pindex calc-refresh
9949 @cindex Refreshing a garbled display
9950 @cindex Garbled displays, refreshing
9951 The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} key sequence (@code{calc-refresh}) redraws the contents
9952 of the Calculator buffer from memory. Use this if the contents of the
9953 buffer have been damaged somehow.
9954
9955 @ignore
9956 @mindex o
9957 @end ignore
9958 The @kbd{o} key (@code{calc-realign}) moves the cursor back to its
9959 ``home'' position at the bottom of the Calculator buffer.
9960
9961 @kindex <
9962 @kindex >
9963 @pindex calc-scroll-left
9964 @pindex calc-scroll-right
9965 @cindex Horizontal scrolling
9966 @cindex Scrolling
9967 @cindex Wide text, scrolling
9968 The @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-left} and
9969 @code{calc-scroll-right}. These are just like the normal horizontal
9970 scrolling commands except that they scroll one half-screen at a time by
9971 default. (Calc formats its output to fit within the bounds of the
9972 window whenever it can.)
9973
9974 @kindex @{
9975 @kindex @}
9976 @pindex calc-scroll-down
9977 @pindex calc-scroll-up
9978 @cindex Vertical scrolling
9979 The @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-down}
9980 and @code{calc-scroll-up}. They scroll up or down by one-half the
9981 height of the Calc window.
9982
9983 @kindex M-# 0
9984 @pindex calc-reset
9985 The @kbd{M-# 0} command (@code{calc-reset}; that's @kbd{M-#} followed
9986 by a zero) resets the Calculator to its initial state. This clears
9987 the stack, resets all the modes to their initial values (the values
9988 that were saved with @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})), clears the
9989 caches (@pxref{Caches}), and so on. (It does @emph{not} erase the
9990 values of any variables.) With an argument of 0, Calc will be reset to
9991 its default state; namely, the modes will be given their default values.
9992 With a positive prefix argument, @kbd{M-# 0} preserves the contents of
9993 the stack but resets everything else to its initial state; with a
9994 negative prefix argument, @kbd{M-# 0} preserves the contents of the
9995 stack but resets everything else to its default state.
9996
9997 @pindex calc-version
9998 The @kbd{M-x calc-version} command displays the current version number
9999 of Calc and the name of the person who installed it on your system.
10000 (This information is also present in the @samp{*Calc Trail*} buffer,
10001 and in the output of the @kbd{h h} command.)
10002
10003 @node Help Commands, Stack Basics, Basic Commands, Introduction
10004 @section Help Commands
10005
10006 @noindent
10007 @cindex Help commands
10008 @kindex ?
10009 @pindex calc-help
10010 The @kbd{?} key (@code{calc-help}) displays a series of brief help messages.
10011 Some keys (such as @kbd{b} and @kbd{d}) are prefix keys, like Emacs'
10012 @key{ESC} and @kbd{C-x} prefixes. You can type
10013 @kbd{?} after a prefix to see a list of commands beginning with that
10014 prefix. (If the message includes @samp{[MORE]}, press @kbd{?} again
10015 to see additional commands for that prefix.)
10016
10017 @kindex h h
10018 @pindex calc-full-help
10019 The @kbd{h h} (@code{calc-full-help}) command displays all the @kbd{?}
10020 responses at once. When printed, this makes a nice, compact (three pages)
10021 summary of Calc keystrokes.
10022
10023 In general, the @kbd{h} key prefix introduces various commands that
10024 provide help within Calc. Many of the @kbd{h} key functions are
10025 Calc-specific analogues to the @kbd{C-h} functions for Emacs help.
10026
10027 @kindex h i
10028 @kindex M-# i
10029 @kindex i
10030 @pindex calc-info
10031 The @kbd{h i} (@code{calc-info}) command runs the Emacs Info system
10032 to read this manual on-line. This is basically the same as typing
10033 @kbd{C-h i} (the regular way to run the Info system), then, if Info
10034 is not already in the Calc manual, selecting the beginning of the
10035 manual. The @kbd{M-# i} command is another way to read the Calc
10036 manual; it is different from @kbd{h i} in that it works any time,
10037 not just inside Calc. The plain @kbd{i} key is also equivalent to
10038 @kbd{h i}, though this key is obsolete and may be replaced with a
10039 different command in a future version of Calc.
10040
10041 @kindex h t
10042 @kindex M-# t
10043 @pindex calc-tutorial
10044 The @kbd{h t} (@code{calc-tutorial}) command runs the Info system on
10045 the Tutorial section of the Calc manual. It is like @kbd{h i},
10046 except that it selects the starting node of the tutorial rather
10047 than the beginning of the whole manual. (It actually selects the
10048 node ``Interactive Tutorial'' which tells a few things about
10049 using the Info system before going on to the actual tutorial.)
10050 The @kbd{M-# t} key is equivalent to @kbd{h t} (but it works at
10051 all times).
10052
10053 @kindex h s
10054 @kindex M-# s
10055 @pindex calc-info-summary
10056 The @kbd{h s} (@code{calc-info-summary}) command runs the Info system
10057 on the Summary node of the Calc manual. @xref{Summary}. The @kbd{M-# s}
10058 key is equivalent to @kbd{h s}.
10059
10060 @kindex h k
10061 @pindex calc-describe-key
10062 The @kbd{h k} (@code{calc-describe-key}) command looks up a key
10063 sequence in the Calc manual. For example, @kbd{h k H a S} looks
10064 up the documentation on the @kbd{H a S} (@code{calc-solve-for})
10065 command. This works by looking up the textual description of
10066 the key(s) in the Key Index of the manual, then jumping to the
10067 node indicated by the index.
10068
10069 Most Calc commands do not have traditional Emacs documentation
10070 strings, since the @kbd{h k} command is both more convenient and
10071 more instructive. This means the regular Emacs @kbd{C-h k}
10072 (@code{describe-key}) command will not be useful for Calc keystrokes.
10073
10074 @kindex h c
10075 @pindex calc-describe-key-briefly
10076 The @kbd{h c} (@code{calc-describe-key-briefly}) command reads a
10077 key sequence and displays a brief one-line description of it at
10078 the bottom of the screen. It looks for the key sequence in the
10079 Summary node of the Calc manual; if it doesn't find the sequence
10080 there, it acts just like its regular Emacs counterpart @kbd{C-h c}
10081 (@code{describe-key-briefly}). For example, @kbd{h c H a S}
10082 gives the description:
10083
10084 @smallexample
10085 H a S runs calc-solve-for: a `H a S' v => fsolve(a,v) (?=notes)
10086 @end smallexample
10087
10088 @noindent
10089 which means the command @kbd{H a S} or @kbd{H M-x calc-solve-for}
10090 takes a value @expr{a} from the stack, prompts for a value @expr{v},
10091 then applies the algebraic function @code{fsolve} to these values.
10092 The @samp{?=notes} message means you can now type @kbd{?} to see
10093 additional notes from the summary that apply to this command.
10094
10095 @kindex h f
10096 @pindex calc-describe-function
10097 The @kbd{h f} (@code{calc-describe-function}) command looks up an
10098 algebraic function or a command name in the Calc manual. Enter an
10099 algebraic function name to look up that function in the Function
10100 Index or enter a command name beginning with @samp{calc-} to look it
10101 up in the Command Index. This command will also look up operator
10102 symbols that can appear in algebraic formulas, like @samp{%} and
10103 @samp{=>}.
10104
10105 @kindex h v
10106 @pindex calc-describe-variable
10107 The @kbd{h v} (@code{calc-describe-variable}) command looks up a
10108 variable in the Calc manual. Enter a variable name like @code{pi} or
10109 @code{PlotRejects}.
10110
10111 @kindex h b
10112 @pindex describe-bindings
10113 The @kbd{h b} (@code{calc-describe-bindings}) command is just like
10114 @kbd{C-h b}, except that only local (Calc-related) key bindings are
10115 listed.
10116
10117 @kindex h n
10118 The @kbd{h n} or @kbd{h C-n} (@code{calc-view-news}) command displays
10119 the ``news'' or change history of Calc. This is kept in the file
10120 @file{README}, which Calc looks for in the same directory as the Calc
10121 source files.
10122
10123 @kindex h C-c
10124 @kindex h C-d
10125 @kindex h C-w
10126 The @kbd{h C-c}, @kbd{h C-d}, and @kbd{h C-w} keys display copying,
10127 distribution, and warranty information about Calc. These work by
10128 pulling up the appropriate parts of the ``Copying'' or ``Reporting
10129 Bugs'' sections of the manual.
10130
10131 @node Stack Basics, Numeric Entry, Help Commands, Introduction
10132 @section Stack Basics
10133
10134 @noindent
10135 @cindex Stack basics
10136 @c [fix-tut RPN Calculations and the Stack]
10137 Calc uses RPN notation. If you are not familiar with RPN, @pxref{RPN
10138 Tutorial}.
10139
10140 To add the numbers 1 and 2 in Calc you would type the keys:
10141 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 +}.
10142 (@key{RET} corresponds to the @key{ENTER} key on most calculators.)
10143 The first three keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 1 and 2 onto the stack. The
10144 @kbd{+} key always ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
10145 and pushes the result (3) back onto the stack. This number is ready for
10146 further calculations: @kbd{5 -} pushes 5 onto the stack, then pops the
10147 3 and 5, subtracts them, and pushes the result (@mathit{-2}).
10148
10149 Note that the ``top'' of the stack actually appears at the @emph{bottom}
10150 of the buffer. A line containing a single @samp{.} character signifies
10151 the end of the buffer; Calculator commands operate on the number(s)
10152 directly above this line. The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack})
10153 command allows you to move the @samp{.} marker up and down in the stack;
10154 @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
10155
10156 @kindex d l
10157 @pindex calc-line-numbering
10158 Stack elements are numbered consecutively, with number 1 being the top of
10159 the stack. These line numbers are ordinarily displayed on the lefthand side
10160 of the window. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) command controls
10161 whether these numbers appear. (Line numbers may be turned off since they
10162 slow the Calculator down a bit and also clutter the display.)
10163
10164 @kindex o
10165 @pindex calc-realign
10166 The unshifted letter @kbd{o} (@code{calc-realign}) command repositions
10167 the cursor to its top-of-stack ``home'' position. It also undoes any
10168 horizontal scrolling in the window. If you give it a numeric prefix
10169 argument, it instead moves the cursor to the specified stack element.
10170
10171 The @key{RET} (or equivalent @key{SPC}) key is only required to separate
10172 two consecutive numbers.
10173 (After all, if you typed @kbd{1 2} by themselves the Calculator
10174 would enter the number 12.) If you press @key{RET} or @key{SPC} @emph{not}
10175 right after typing a number, the key duplicates the number on the top of
10176 the stack. @kbd{@key{RET} *} is thus a handy way to square a number.
10177
10178 The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the top number on the stack.
10179 The @key{TAB} key swaps the top two objects on the stack.
10180 @xref{Stack and Trail}, for descriptions of these and other stack-related
10181 commands.
10182
10183 @node Numeric Entry, Algebraic Entry, Stack Basics, Introduction
10184 @section Numeric Entry
10185
10186 @noindent
10187 @kindex 0-9
10188 @kindex .
10189 @kindex e
10190 @cindex Numeric entry
10191 @cindex Entering numbers
10192 Pressing a digit or other numeric key begins numeric entry using the
10193 minibuffer. The number is pushed on the stack when you press the @key{RET}
10194 or @key{SPC} keys. If you press any other non-numeric key, the number is
10195 pushed onto the stack and the appropriate operation is performed. If
10196 you press a numeric key which is not valid, the key is ignored.
10197
10198 @cindex Minus signs
10199 @cindex Negative numbers, entering
10200 @kindex _
10201 There are three different concepts corresponding to the word ``minus,''
10202 typified by @expr{a-b} (subtraction), @expr{-x}
10203 (change-sign), and @expr{-5} (negative number). Calc uses three
10204 different keys for these operations, respectively:
10205 @kbd{-}, @kbd{n}, and @kbd{_} (the underscore). The @kbd{-} key subtracts
10206 the two numbers on the top of the stack. The @kbd{n} key changes the sign
10207 of the number on the top of the stack or the number currently being entered.
10208 The @kbd{_} key begins entry of a negative number or changes the sign of
10209 the number currently being entered. The following sequences all enter the
10210 number @mathit{-5} onto the stack: @kbd{0 @key{RET} 5 -}, @kbd{5 n @key{RET}},
10211 @kbd{5 @key{RET} n}, @kbd{_ 5 @key{RET}}, @kbd{5 _ @key{RET}}.
10212
10213 Some other keys are active during numeric entry, such as @kbd{#} for
10214 non-decimal numbers, @kbd{:} for fractions, and @kbd{@@} for HMS forms.
10215 These notations are described later in this manual with the corresponding
10216 data types. @xref{Data Types}.
10217
10218 During numeric entry, the only editing key available is @key{DEL}.
10219
10220 @node Algebraic Entry, Quick Calculator, Numeric Entry, Introduction
10221 @section Algebraic Entry
10222
10223 @noindent
10224 @kindex '
10225 @pindex calc-algebraic-entry
10226 @cindex Algebraic notation
10227 @cindex Formulas, entering
10228 Calculations can also be entered in algebraic form. This is accomplished
10229 by typing the apostrophe key, @kbd{'}, followed by the expression in
10230 standard format: @kbd{@key{'} 2+3*4 @key{RET}} computes
10231 @texline @math{2+(3\times4) = 14}
10232 @infoline @expr{2+(3*4) = 14}
10233 and pushes that on the stack. If you wish you can
10234 ignore the RPN aspect of Calc altogether and simply enter algebraic
10235 expressions in this way. You may want to use @key{DEL} every so often to
10236 clear previous results off the stack.
10237
10238 You can press the apostrophe key during normal numeric entry to switch
10239 the half-entered number into Algebraic entry mode. One reason to do this
10240 would be to use the full Emacs cursor motion and editing keys, which are
10241 available during algebraic entry but not during numeric entry.
10242
10243 In the same vein, during either numeric or algebraic entry you can
10244 press @kbd{`} (backquote) to switch to @code{calc-edit} mode, where
10245 you complete your half-finished entry in a separate buffer.
10246 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}.
10247
10248 @kindex m a
10249 @pindex calc-algebraic-mode
10250 @cindex Algebraic Mode
10251 If you prefer algebraic entry, you can use the command @kbd{m a}
10252 (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) to set Algebraic mode. In this mode,
10253 digits and other keys that would normally start numeric entry instead
10254 start full algebraic entry; as long as your formula begins with a digit
10255 you can omit the apostrophe. Open parentheses and square brackets also
10256 begin algebraic entry. You can still do RPN calculations in this mode,
10257 but you will have to press @key{RET} to terminate every number:
10258 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} +} would accomplish the same
10259 thing as @kbd{2*3+4 @key{RET}}.
10260
10261 @cindex Incomplete Algebraic Mode
10262 If you give a numeric prefix argument like @kbd{C-u} to the @kbd{m a}
10263 command, it enables Incomplete Algebraic mode; this is like regular
10264 Algebraic mode except that it applies to the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys
10265 only. Numeric keys still begin a numeric entry in this mode.
10266
10267 @kindex m t
10268 @pindex calc-total-algebraic-mode
10269 @cindex Total Algebraic Mode
10270 The @kbd{m t} (@code{calc-total-algebraic-mode}) gives you an even
10271 stronger algebraic-entry mode, in which @emph{all} regular letter and
10272 punctuation keys begin algebraic entry. Use this if you prefer typing
10273 @w{@kbd{sqrt( )}} instead of @kbd{Q}, @w{@kbd{factor( )}} instead of
10274 @kbd{a f}, and so on. To type regular Calc commands when you are in
10275 Total Algebraic mode, hold down the @key{META} key. Thus @kbd{M-q}
10276 is the command to quit Calc, @kbd{M-p} sets the precision, and
10277 @kbd{M-m t} (or @kbd{M-m M-t}, if you prefer) turns Total Algebraic
10278 mode back off again. Meta keys also terminate algebraic entry, so
10279 that @kbd{2+3 M-S} is equivalent to @kbd{2+3 @key{RET} M-S}. The symbol
10280 @samp{Alg*} will appear in the mode line whenever you are in this mode.
10281
10282 Pressing @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) a second time re-enters the previous
10283 algebraic formula. You can then use the normal Emacs editing keys to
10284 modify this formula to your liking before pressing @key{RET}.
10285
10286 @kindex $
10287 @cindex Formulas, referring to stack
10288 Within a formula entered from the keyboard, the symbol @kbd{$}
10289 represents the number on the top of the stack. If an entered formula
10290 contains any @kbd{$} characters, the Calculator replaces the top of
10291 stack with that formula rather than simply pushing the formula onto the
10292 stack. Thus, @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3 on the stack, and @kbd{$*2
10293 @key{RET}} replaces it with 6. Note that the @kbd{$} key always
10294 initiates algebraic entry; the @kbd{'} is unnecessary if @kbd{$} is the
10295 first character in the new formula.
10296
10297 Higher stack elements can be accessed from an entered formula with the
10298 symbols @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on. The number of stack elements
10299 removed (to be replaced by the entered values) equals the number of dollar
10300 signs in the longest such symbol in the formula. For example, @samp{$$+$$$}
10301 adds the second and third stack elements, replacing the top three elements
10302 with the answer. (All information about the top stack element is thus lost
10303 since no single @samp{$} appears in this formula.)
10304
10305 A slightly different way to refer to stack elements is with a dollar
10306 sign followed by a number: @samp{$1}, @samp{$2}, and so on are much
10307 like @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, etc., except that stack entries referred
10308 to numerically are not replaced by the algebraic entry. That is, while
10309 @samp{$+1} replaces 5 on the stack with 6, @samp{$1+1} leaves the 5
10310 on the stack and pushes an additional 6.
10311
10312 If a sequence of formulas are entered separated by commas, each formula
10313 is pushed onto the stack in turn. For example, @samp{1,2,3} pushes
10314 those three numbers onto the stack (leaving the 3 at the top), and
10315 @samp{$+1,$-1} replaces a 5 on the stack with 4 followed by 6. Also,
10316 @samp{$,$$} exchanges the top two elements of the stack, just like the
10317 @key{TAB} key.
10318
10319 You can finish an algebraic entry with @kbd{M-=} or @kbd{M-@key{RET}} instead
10320 of @key{RET}. This uses @kbd{=} to evaluate the variables in each
10321 formula that goes onto the stack. (Thus @kbd{' pi @key{RET}} pushes
10322 the variable @samp{pi}, but @kbd{' pi M-@key{RET}} pushes 3.1415.)
10323
10324 If you finish your algebraic entry by pressing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j})
10325 instead of @key{RET}, Calc disables the default simplifications
10326 (as if by @kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}) while the entry
10327 is being pushed on the stack. Thus @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3
10328 on the stack, but @kbd{' 1+2 @key{LFD}} pushes the formula @expr{1+2};
10329 you might then press @kbd{=} when it is time to evaluate this formula.
10330
10331 @node Quick Calculator, Prefix Arguments, Algebraic Entry, Introduction
10332 @section ``Quick Calculator'' Mode
10333
10334 @noindent
10335 @kindex M-# q
10336 @pindex quick-calc
10337 @cindex Quick Calculator
10338 There is another way to invoke the Calculator if all you need to do
10339 is make one or two quick calculations. Type @kbd{M-# q} (or
10340 @kbd{M-x quick-calc}), then type any formula as an algebraic entry.
10341 The Calculator will compute the result and display it in the echo
10342 area, without ever actually putting up a Calc window.
10343
10344 You can use the @kbd{$} character in a Quick Calculator formula to
10345 refer to the previous Quick Calculator result. Older results are
10346 not retained; the Quick Calculator has no effect on the full
10347 Calculator's stack or trail. If you compute a result and then
10348 forget what it was, just run @code{M-# q} again and enter
10349 @samp{$} as the formula.
10350
10351 If this is the first time you have used the Calculator in this Emacs
10352 session, the @kbd{M-# q} command will create the @code{*Calculator*}
10353 buffer and perform all the usual initializations; it simply will
10354 refrain from putting that buffer up in a new window. The Quick
10355 Calculator refers to the @code{*Calculator*} buffer for all mode
10356 settings. Thus, for example, to set the precision that the Quick
10357 Calculator uses, simply run the full Calculator momentarily and use
10358 the regular @kbd{p} command.
10359
10360 If you use @code{M-# q} from inside the Calculator buffer, the
10361 effect is the same as pressing the apostrophe key (algebraic entry).
10362
10363 The result of a Quick calculation is placed in the Emacs ``kill ring''
10364 as well as being displayed. A subsequent @kbd{C-y} command will
10365 yank the result into the editing buffer. You can also use this
10366 to yank the result into the next @kbd{M-# q} input line as a more
10367 explicit alternative to @kbd{$} notation, or to yank the result
10368 into the Calculator stack after typing @kbd{M-# c}.
10369
10370 If you finish your formula by typing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j}) instead
10371 of @key{RET}, the result is inserted immediately into the current
10372 buffer rather than going into the kill ring.
10373
10374 Quick Calculator results are actually evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
10375 key (which replaces variable names by their stored values, if any).
10376 If the formula you enter is an assignment to a variable using the
10377 @samp{:=} operator, say, @samp{foo := 2 + 3} or @samp{foo := foo + 1},
10378 then the result of the evaluation is stored in that Calc variable.
10379 @xref{Store and Recall}.
10380
10381 If the result is an integer and the current display radix is decimal,
10382 the number will also be displayed in hex and octal formats. If the
10383 integer is in the range from 1 to 126, it will also be displayed as
10384 an ASCII character.
10385
10386 For example, the quoted character @samp{"x"} produces the vector
10387 result @samp{[120]} (because 120 is the ASCII code of the lower-case
10388 `x'; @pxref{Strings}). Since this is a vector, not an integer, it
10389 is displayed only according to the current mode settings. But
10390 running Quick Calc again and entering @samp{120} will produce the
10391 result @samp{120 (16#78, 8#170, x)} which shows the number in its
10392 decimal, hexadecimal, octal, and ASCII forms.
10393
10394 Please note that the Quick Calculator is not any faster at loading
10395 or computing the answer than the full Calculator; the name ``quick''
10396 merely refers to the fact that it's much less hassle to use for
10397 small calculations.
10398
10399 @node Prefix Arguments, Undo, Quick Calculator, Introduction
10400 @section Numeric Prefix Arguments
10401
10402 @noindent
10403 Many Calculator commands use numeric prefix arguments. Some, such as
10404 @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}), set a parameter to the value of
10405 the prefix argument or use a default if you don't use a prefix.
10406 Others (like @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation})) require an argument
10407 and prompt for a number if you don't give one as a prefix.
10408
10409 As a rule, stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric prefix argument
10410 which is interpreted as an index into the stack. A positive argument
10411 operates on the top @var{n} stack entries; a negative argument operates
10412 on the @var{n}th stack entry in isolation; and a zero argument operates
10413 on the entire stack.
10414
10415 Most commands that perform computations (such as the arithmetic and
10416 scientific functions) accept a numeric prefix argument that allows the
10417 operation to be applied across many stack elements. For unary operations
10418 (that is, functions of one argument like absolute value or complex
10419 conjugate), a positive prefix argument applies that function to the top
10420 @var{n} stack entries simultaneously, and a negative argument applies it
10421 to the @var{n}th stack entry only. For binary operations (functions of
10422 two arguments like addition, GCD, and vector concatenation), a positive
10423 prefix argument ``reduces'' the function across the top @var{n}
10424 stack elements (for example, @kbd{C-u 5 +} sums the top 5 stack entries;
10425 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}), and a negative argument maps the next-to-top
10426 @var{n} stack elements with the top stack element as a second argument
10427 (for example, @kbd{7 c-u -5 +} adds 7 to the top 5 stack elements).
10428 This feature is not available for operations which use the numeric prefix
10429 argument for some other purpose.
10430
10431 Numeric prefixes are specified the same way as always in Emacs: Press
10432 a sequence of @key{META}-digits, or press @key{ESC} followed by digits,
10433 or press @kbd{C-u} followed by digits. Some commands treat plain
10434 @kbd{C-u} (without any actual digits) specially.
10435
10436 @kindex ~
10437 @pindex calc-num-prefix
10438 You can type @kbd{~} (@code{calc-num-prefix}) to pop an integer from the
10439 top of the stack and enter it as the numeric prefix for the next command.
10440 For example, @kbd{C-u 16 p} sets the precision to 16 digits; an alternate
10441 (silly) way to do this would be @kbd{2 @key{RET} 4 ^ ~ p}, i.e., compute 2
10442 to the fourth power and set the precision to that value.
10443
10444 Conversely, if you have typed a numeric prefix argument the @kbd{~} key
10445 pushes it onto the stack in the form of an integer.
10446
10447 @node Undo, Error Messages, Prefix Arguments, Introduction
10448 @section Undoing Mistakes
10449
10450 @noindent
10451 @kindex U
10452 @kindex C-_
10453 @pindex calc-undo
10454 @cindex Mistakes, undoing
10455 @cindex Undoing mistakes
10456 @cindex Errors, undoing
10457 The shift-@kbd{U} key (@code{calc-undo}) undoes the most recent operation.
10458 If that operation added or dropped objects from the stack, those objects
10459 are removed or restored. If it was a ``store'' operation, you are
10460 queried whether or not to restore the variable to its original value.
10461 The @kbd{U} key may be pressed any number of times to undo successively
10462 farther back in time; with a numeric prefix argument it undoes a
10463 specified number of operations. The undo history is cleared only by the
10464 @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command. (Recall that @kbd{M-# c} is
10465 synonymous with @code{calc-quit} while inside the Calculator; this
10466 also clears the undo history.)
10467
10468 Currently the mode-setting commands (like @code{calc-precision}) are not
10469 undoable. You can undo past a point where you changed a mode, but you
10470 will need to reset the mode yourself.
10471
10472 @kindex D
10473 @pindex calc-redo
10474 @cindex Redoing after an Undo
10475 The shift-@kbd{D} key (@code{calc-redo}) redoes an operation that was
10476 mistakenly undone. Pressing @kbd{U} with a negative prefix argument is
10477 equivalent to executing @code{calc-redo}. You can redo any number of
10478 times, up to the number of recent consecutive undo commands. Redo
10479 information is cleared whenever you give any command that adds new undo
10480 information, i.e., if you undo, then enter a number on the stack or make
10481 any other change, then it will be too late to redo.
10482
10483 @kindex M-@key{RET}
10484 @pindex calc-last-args
10485 @cindex Last-arguments feature
10486 @cindex Arguments, restoring
10487 The @kbd{M-@key{RET}} key (@code{calc-last-args}) is like undo in that
10488 it restores the arguments of the most recent command onto the stack;
10489 however, it does not remove the result of that command. Given a numeric
10490 prefix argument, this command applies to the @expr{n}th most recent
10491 command which removed items from the stack; it pushes those items back
10492 onto the stack.
10493
10494 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command provides a related function
10495 to @kbd{M-@key{RET}}. @xref{Stack and Trail}.
10496
10497 It is also possible to recall previous results or inputs using the trail.
10498 @xref{Trail Commands}.
10499
10500 The standard Emacs @kbd{C-_} undo key is recognized as a synonym for @kbd{U}.
10501
10502 @node Error Messages, Multiple Calculators, Undo, Introduction
10503 @section Error Messages
10504
10505 @noindent
10506 @kindex w
10507 @pindex calc-why
10508 @cindex Errors, messages
10509 @cindex Why did an error occur?
10510 Many situations that would produce an error message in other calculators
10511 simply create unsimplified formulas in the Emacs Calculator. For example,
10512 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} pushes the formula @expr{1 / 0}; @w{@kbd{0 L}} pushes
10513 the formula @samp{ln(0)}. Floating-point overflow and underflow are also
10514 reasons for this to happen.
10515
10516 When a function call must be left in symbolic form, Calc usually
10517 produces a message explaining why. Messages that are probably
10518 surprising or indicative of user errors are displayed automatically.
10519 Other messages are simply kept in Calc's memory and are displayed only
10520 if you type @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why}). You can also press @kbd{w} if
10521 the same computation results in several messages. (The first message
10522 will end with @samp{[w=more]} in this case.)
10523
10524 @kindex d w
10525 @pindex calc-auto-why
10526 The @kbd{d w} (@code{calc-auto-why}) command controls when error messages
10527 are displayed automatically. (Calc effectively presses @kbd{w} for you
10528 after your computation finishes.) By default, this occurs only for
10529 ``important'' messages. The other possible modes are to report
10530 @emph{all} messages automatically, or to report none automatically (so
10531 that you must always press @kbd{w} yourself to see the messages).
10532
10533 @node Multiple Calculators, Troubleshooting Commands, Error Messages, Introduction
10534 @section Multiple Calculators
10535
10536 @noindent
10537 @pindex another-calc
10538 It is possible to have any number of Calc mode buffers at once.
10539 Usually this is done by executing @kbd{M-x another-calc}, which
10540 is similar to @kbd{M-# c} except that if a @samp{*Calculator*}
10541 buffer already exists, a new, independent one with a name of the
10542 form @samp{*Calculator*<@var{n}>} is created. You can also use the
10543 command @code{calc-mode} to put any buffer into Calculator mode, but
10544 this would ordinarily never be done.
10545
10546 The @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command does not destroy a Calculator buffer;
10547 it only closes its window. Use @kbd{M-x kill-buffer} to destroy a
10548 Calculator buffer.
10549
10550 Each Calculator buffer keeps its own stack, undo list, and mode settings
10551 such as precision, angular mode, and display formats. In Emacs terms,
10552 variables such as @code{calc-stack} are buffer-local variables. The
10553 global default values of these variables are used only when a new
10554 Calculator buffer is created. The @code{calc-quit} command saves
10555 the stack and mode settings of the buffer being quit as the new defaults.
10556
10557 There is only one trail buffer, @samp{*Calc Trail*}, used by all
10558 Calculator buffers.
10559
10560 @node Troubleshooting Commands, , Multiple Calculators, Introduction
10561 @section Troubleshooting Commands
10562
10563 @noindent
10564 This section describes commands you can use in case a computation
10565 incorrectly fails or gives the wrong answer.
10566
10567 @xref{Reporting Bugs}, if you find a problem that appears to be due
10568 to a bug or deficiency in Calc.
10569
10570 @menu
10571 * Autoloading Problems::
10572 * Recursion Depth::
10573 * Caches::
10574 * Debugging Calc::
10575 @end menu
10576
10577 @node Autoloading Problems, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands, Troubleshooting Commands
10578 @subsection Autoloading Problems
10579
10580 @noindent
10581 The Calc program is split into many component files; components are
10582 loaded automatically as you use various commands that require them.
10583 Occasionally Calc may lose track of when a certain component is
10584 necessary; typically this means you will type a command and it won't
10585 work because some function you've never heard of was undefined.
10586
10587 @kindex M-# L
10588 @pindex calc-load-everything
10589 If this happens, the easiest workaround is to type @kbd{M-# L}
10590 (@code{calc-load-everything}) to force all the parts of Calc to be
10591 loaded right away. This will cause Emacs to take up a lot more
10592 memory than it would otherwise, but it's guaranteed to fix the problem.
10593
10594 If you seem to run into this problem no matter what you do, or if
10595 even the @kbd{M-# L} command crashes, Calc may have been improperly
10596 installed. @xref{Installation}, for details of the installation
10597 process.
10598
10599 @node Recursion Depth, Caches, Autoloading Problems, Troubleshooting Commands
10600 @subsection Recursion Depth
10601
10602 @noindent
10603 @kindex M
10604 @kindex I M
10605 @pindex calc-more-recursion-depth
10606 @pindex calc-less-recursion-depth
10607 @cindex Recursion depth
10608 @cindex ``Computation got stuck'' message
10609 @cindex @code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10610 @cindex @code{max-specpdl-size}
10611 Calc uses recursion in many of its calculations. Emacs Lisp keeps a
10612 variable @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} which limits the amount of recursion
10613 possible in an attempt to recover from program bugs. If a calculation
10614 ever halts incorrectly with the message ``Computation got stuck or
10615 ran too long,'' use the @kbd{M} command (@code{calc-more-recursion-depth})
10616 to increase this limit. (Of course, this will not help if the
10617 calculation really did get stuck due to some problem inside Calc.)
10618
10619 The limit is always increased (multiplied) by a factor of two. There
10620 is also an @kbd{I M} (@code{calc-less-recursion-depth}) command which
10621 decreases this limit by a factor of two, down to a minimum value of 200.
10622 The default value is 1000.
10623
10624 These commands also double or halve @code{max-specpdl-size}, another
10625 internal Lisp recursion limit. The minimum value for this limit is 600.
10626
10627 @node Caches, Debugging Calc, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands
10628 @subsection Caches
10629
10630 @noindent
10631 @cindex Caches
10632 @cindex Flushing caches
10633 Calc saves certain values after they have been computed once. For
10634 example, the @kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}) command initially ``knows'' the
10635 constant @cpi{} to about 20 decimal places; if the current precision
10636 is greater than this, it will recompute @cpi{} using a series
10637 approximation. This value will not need to be recomputed ever again
10638 unless you raise the precision still further. Many operations such as
10639 logarithms and sines make use of similarly cached values such as
10640 @cpiover{4} and
10641 @texline @math{\ln 2}.
10642 @infoline @expr{ln(2)}.
10643 The visible effect of caching is that
10644 high-precision computations may seem to do extra work the first time.
10645 Other things cached include powers of two (for the binary arithmetic
10646 functions), matrix inverses and determinants, symbolic integrals, and
10647 data points computed by the graphing commands.
10648
10649 @pindex calc-flush-caches
10650 If you suspect a Calculator cache has become corrupt, you can use the
10651 @code{calc-flush-caches} command to reset all caches to the empty state.
10652 (This should only be necessary in the event of bugs in the Calculator.)
10653 The @kbd{M-# 0} (with the zero key) command also resets caches along
10654 with all other aspects of the Calculator's state.
10655
10656 @node Debugging Calc, , Caches, Troubleshooting Commands
10657 @subsection Debugging Calc
10658
10659 @noindent
10660 A few commands exist to help in the debugging of Calc commands.
10661 @xref{Programming}, to see the various ways that you can write
10662 your own Calc commands.
10663
10664 @kindex Z T
10665 @pindex calc-timing
10666 The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing}) command turns on and off a mode
10667 in which the timing of slow commands is reported in the Trail.
10668 Any Calc command that takes two seconds or longer writes a line
10669 to the Trail showing how many seconds it took. This value is
10670 accurate only to within one second.
10671
10672 All steps of executing a command are included; in particular, time
10673 taken to format the result for display in the stack and trail is
10674 counted. Some prompts also count time taken waiting for them to
10675 be answered, while others do not; this depends on the exact
10676 implementation of the command. For best results, if you are timing
10677 a sequence that includes prompts or multiple commands, define a
10678 keyboard macro to run the whole sequence at once. Calc's @kbd{X}
10679 command (@pxref{Keyboard Macros}) will then report the time taken
10680 to execute the whole macro.
10681
10682 Another advantage of the @kbd{X} command is that while it is
10683 executing, the stack and trail are not updated from step to step.
10684 So if you expect the output of your test sequence to leave a result
10685 that may take a long time to format and you don't wish to count
10686 this formatting time, end your sequence with a @key{DEL} keystroke
10687 to clear the result from the stack. When you run the sequence with
10688 @kbd{X}, Calc will never bother to format the large result.
10689
10690 Another thing @kbd{Z T} does is to increase the Emacs variable
10691 @code{gc-cons-threshold} to a much higher value (two million; the
10692 usual default in Calc is 250,000) for the duration of each command.
10693 This generally prevents garbage collection during the timing of
10694 the command, though it may cause your Emacs process to grow
10695 abnormally large. (Garbage collection time is a major unpredictable
10696 factor in the timing of Emacs operations.)
10697
10698 Another command that is useful when debugging your own Lisp
10699 extensions to Calc is @kbd{M-x calc-pass-errors}, which disables
10700 the error handler that changes the ``@code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10701 exceeded'' message to the much more friendly ``Computation got
10702 stuck or ran too long.'' This handler interferes with the Emacs
10703 Lisp debugger's @code{debug-on-error} mode. Errors are reported
10704 in the handler itself rather than at the true location of the
10705 error. After you have executed @code{calc-pass-errors}, Lisp
10706 errors will be reported correctly but the user-friendly message
10707 will be lost.
10708
10709 @node Data Types, Stack and Trail, Introduction, Top
10710 @chapter Data Types
10711
10712 @noindent
10713 This chapter discusses the various types of objects that can be placed
10714 on the Calculator stack, how they are displayed, and how they are
10715 entered. (@xref{Data Type Formats}, for information on how these data
10716 types are represented as underlying Lisp objects.)
10717
10718 Integers, fractions, and floats are various ways of describing real
10719 numbers. HMS forms also for many purposes act as real numbers. These
10720 types can be combined to form complex numbers, modulo forms, error forms,
10721 or interval forms. (But these last four types cannot be combined
10722 arbitrarily:@: error forms may not contain modulo forms, for example.)
10723 Finally, all these types of numbers may be combined into vectors,
10724 matrices, or algebraic formulas.
10725
10726 @menu
10727 * Integers:: The most basic data type.
10728 * Fractions:: This and above are called @dfn{rationals}.
10729 * Floats:: This and above are called @dfn{reals}.
10730 * Complex Numbers:: This and above are called @dfn{numbers}.
10731 * Infinities::
10732 * Vectors and Matrices::
10733 * Strings::
10734 * HMS Forms::
10735 * Date Forms::
10736 * Modulo Forms::
10737 * Error Forms::
10738 * Interval Forms::
10739 * Incomplete Objects::
10740 * Variables::
10741 * Formulas::
10742 @end menu
10743
10744 @node Integers, Fractions, Data Types, Data Types
10745 @section Integers
10746
10747 @noindent
10748 @cindex Integers
10749 The Calculator stores integers to arbitrary precision. Addition,
10750 subtraction, and multiplication of integers always yields an exact
10751 integer result. (If the result of a division or exponentiation of
10752 integers is not an integer, it is expressed in fractional or
10753 floating-point form according to the current Fraction mode.
10754 @xref{Fraction Mode}.)
10755
10756 A decimal integer is represented as an optional sign followed by a
10757 sequence of digits. Grouping (@pxref{Grouping Digits}) can be used to
10758 insert a comma at every third digit for display purposes, but you
10759 must not type commas during the entry of numbers.
10760
10761 @kindex #
10762 A non-decimal integer is represented as an optional sign, a radix
10763 between 2 and 36, a @samp{#} symbol, and one or more digits. For radix 11
10764 and above, the letters A through Z (upper- or lower-case) count as
10765 digits and do not terminate numeric entry mode. @xref{Radix Modes}, for how
10766 to set the default radix for display of integers. Numbers of any radix
10767 may be entered at any time. If you press @kbd{#} at the beginning of a
10768 number, the current display radix is used.
10769
10770 @node Fractions, Floats, Integers, Data Types
10771 @section Fractions
10772
10773 @noindent
10774 @cindex Fractions
10775 A @dfn{fraction} is a ratio of two integers. Fractions are traditionally
10776 written ``2/3'' but Calc uses the notation @samp{2:3}. (The @kbd{/} key
10777 performs RPN division; the following two sequences push the number
10778 @samp{2:3} on the stack: @kbd{2 :@: 3 @key{RET}}, or @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 /}
10779 assuming Fraction mode has been enabled.)
10780 When the Calculator produces a fractional result it always reduces it to
10781 simplest form, which may in fact be an integer.
10782
10783 Fractions may also be entered in a three-part form, where @samp{2:3:4}
10784 represents two-and-three-quarters. @xref{Fraction Formats}, for fraction
10785 display formats.
10786
10787 Non-decimal fractions are entered and displayed as
10788 @samp{@var{radix}#@var{num}:@var{denom}} (or in the analogous three-part
10789 form). The numerator and denominator always use the same radix.
10790
10791 @node Floats, Complex Numbers, Fractions, Data Types
10792 @section Floats
10793
10794 @noindent
10795 @cindex Floating-point numbers
10796 A floating-point number or @dfn{float} is a number stored in scientific
10797 notation. The number of significant digits in the fractional part is
10798 governed by the current floating precision (@pxref{Precision}). The
10799 range of acceptable values is from
10800 @texline @math{10^{-3999999}}
10801 @infoline @expr{10^-3999999}
10802 (inclusive) to
10803 @texline @math{10^{4000000}}
10804 @infoline @expr{10^4000000}
10805 (exclusive), plus the corresponding negative values and zero.
10806
10807 Calculations that would exceed the allowable range of values (such
10808 as @samp{exp(exp(20))}) are left in symbolic form by Calc. The
10809 messages ``floating-point overflow'' or ``floating-point underflow''
10810 indicate that during the calculation a number would have been produced
10811 that was too large or too close to zero, respectively, to be represented
10812 by Calc. This does not necessarily mean the final result would have
10813 overflowed, just that an overflow occurred while computing the result.
10814 (In fact, it could report an underflow even though the final result
10815 would have overflowed!)
10816
10817 If a rational number and a float are mixed in a calculation, the result
10818 will in general be expressed as a float. Commands that require an integer
10819 value (such as @kbd{k g} [@code{gcd}]) will also accept integer-valued
10820 floats, i.e., floating-point numbers with nothing after the decimal point.
10821
10822 Floats are identified by the presence of a decimal point and/or an
10823 exponent. In general a float consists of an optional sign, digits
10824 including an optional decimal point, and an optional exponent consisting
10825 of an @samp{e}, an optional sign, and up to seven exponent digits.
10826 For example, @samp{23.5e-2} is 23.5 times ten to the minus-second power,
10827 or 0.235.
10828
10829 Floating-point numbers are normally displayed in decimal notation with
10830 all significant figures shown. Exceedingly large or small numbers are
10831 displayed in scientific notation. Various other display options are
10832 available. @xref{Float Formats}.
10833
10834 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
10835 Floating-point numbers are stored in decimal, not binary. The result
10836 of each operation is rounded to the nearest value representable in the
10837 number of significant digits specified by the current precision,
10838 rounding away from zero in the case of a tie. Thus (in the default
10839 display mode) what you see is exactly what you get. Some operations such
10840 as square roots and transcendental functions are performed with several
10841 digits of extra precision and then rounded down, in an effort to make the
10842 final result accurate to the full requested precision. However,
10843 accuracy is not rigorously guaranteed. If you suspect the validity of a
10844 result, try doing the same calculation in a higher precision. The
10845 Calculator's arithmetic is not intended to be IEEE-conformant in any
10846 way.
10847
10848 While floats are always @emph{stored} in decimal, they can be entered
10849 and displayed in any radix just like integers and fractions. The
10850 notation @samp{@var{radix}#@var{ddd}.@var{ddd}} is a floating-point
10851 number whose digits are in the specified radix. Note that the @samp{.}
10852 is more aptly referred to as a ``radix point'' than as a decimal
10853 point in this case. The number @samp{8#123.4567} is defined as
10854 @samp{8#1234567 * 8^-4}. If the radix is 14 or less, you can use
10855 @samp{e} notation to write a non-decimal number in scientific notation.
10856 The exponent is written in decimal, and is considered to be a power
10857 of the radix: @samp{8#1234567e-4}. If the radix is 15 or above, the
10858 letter @samp{e} is a digit, so scientific notation must be written
10859 out, e.g., @samp{16#123.4567*16^2}. The first two exercises of the
10860 Modes Tutorial explore some of the properties of non-decimal floats.
10861
10862 @node Complex Numbers, Infinities, Floats, Data Types
10863 @section Complex Numbers
10864
10865 @noindent
10866 @cindex Complex numbers
10867 There are two supported formats for complex numbers: rectangular and
10868 polar. The default format is rectangular, displayed in the form
10869 @samp{(@var{real},@var{imag})} where @var{real} is the real part and
10870 @var{imag} is the imaginary part, each of which may be any real number.
10871 Rectangular complex numbers can also be displayed in @samp{@var{a}+@var{b}i}
10872 notation; @pxref{Complex Formats}.
10873
10874 Polar complex numbers are displayed in the form
10875 @texline `@t{(}@var{r}@t{;}@math{\theta}@t{)}'
10876 @infoline `@t{(}@var{r}@t{;}@var{theta}@t{)}'
10877 where @var{r} is the nonnegative magnitude and
10878 @texline @math{\theta}
10879 @infoline @var{theta}
10880 is the argument or phase angle. The range of
10881 @texline @math{\theta}
10882 @infoline @var{theta}
10883 depends on the current angular mode (@pxref{Angular Modes}); it is
10884 generally between @mathit{-180} and @mathit{+180} degrees or the equivalent range
10885 in radians.
10886
10887 Complex numbers are entered in stages using incomplete objects.
10888 @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10889
10890 Operations on rectangular complex numbers yield rectangular complex
10891 results, and similarly for polar complex numbers. Where the two types
10892 are mixed, or where new complex numbers arise (as for the square root of
10893 a negative real), the current @dfn{Polar mode} is used to determine the
10894 type. @xref{Polar Mode}.
10895
10896 A complex result in which the imaginary part is zero (or the phase angle
10897 is 0 or 180 degrees or @cpi{} radians) is automatically converted to a real
10898 number.
10899
10900 @node Infinities, Vectors and Matrices, Complex Numbers, Data Types
10901 @section Infinities
10902
10903 @noindent
10904 @cindex Infinity
10905 @cindex @code{inf} variable
10906 @cindex @code{uinf} variable
10907 @cindex @code{nan} variable
10908 @vindex inf
10909 @vindex uinf
10910 @vindex nan
10911 The word @code{inf} represents the mathematical concept of @dfn{infinity}.
10912 Calc actually has three slightly different infinity-like values:
10913 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan}. These are just regular
10914 variable names (@pxref{Variables}); you should avoid using these
10915 names for your own variables because Calc gives them special
10916 treatment. Infinities, like all variable names, are normally
10917 entered using algebraic entry.
10918
10919 Mathematically speaking, it is not rigorously correct to treat
10920 ``infinity'' as if it were a number, but mathematicians often do
10921 so informally. When they say that @samp{1 / inf = 0}, what they
10922 really mean is that @expr{1 / x}, as @expr{x} becomes larger and
10923 larger, becomes arbitrarily close to zero. So you can imagine
10924 that if @expr{x} got ``all the way to infinity,'' then @expr{1 / x}
10925 would go all the way to zero. Similarly, when they say that
10926 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}, they mean that
10927 @texline @math{e^x}
10928 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
10929 grows without bound as @expr{x} grows. The symbol @samp{-inf} likewise
10930 stands for an infinitely negative real value; for example, we say that
10931 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. You can have an infinity pointing in any
10932 direction on the complex plane: @samp{sqrt(-inf) = i inf}.
10933
10934 The same concept of limits can be used to define @expr{1 / 0}. We
10935 really want the value that @expr{1 / x} approaches as @expr{x}
10936 approaches zero. But if all we have is @expr{1 / 0}, we can't
10937 tell which direction @expr{x} was coming from. If @expr{x} was
10938 positive and decreasing toward zero, then we should say that
10939 @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. But if @expr{x} was negative and increasing
10940 toward zero, the answer is @samp{1 / 0 = -inf}. In fact, @expr{x}
10941 could be an imaginary number, giving the answer @samp{i inf} or
10942 @samp{-i inf}. Calc uses the special symbol @samp{uinf} to mean
10943 @dfn{undirected infinity}, i.e., a value which is infinitely
10944 large but with an unknown sign (or direction on the complex plane).
10945
10946 Calc actually has three modes that say how infinities are handled.
10947 Normally, infinities never arise from calculations that didn't
10948 already have them. Thus, @expr{1 / 0} is treated simply as an
10949 error and left unevaluated. The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode})
10950 command (@pxref{Infinite Mode}) enables a mode in which
10951 @expr{1 / 0} evaluates to @code{uinf} instead. There is also
10952 an alternative type of infinite mode which says to treat zeros
10953 as if they were positive, so that @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. While this
10954 is less mathematically correct, it may be the answer you want in
10955 some cases.
10956
10957 Since all infinities are ``as large'' as all others, Calc simplifies,
10958 e.g., @samp{5 inf} to @samp{inf}. Another example is
10959 @samp{5 - inf = -inf}, where the @samp{-inf} is so large that
10960 adding a finite number like five to it does not affect it.
10961 Note that @samp{a - inf} also results in @samp{-inf}; Calc assumes
10962 that variables like @code{a} always stand for finite quantities.
10963 Just to show that infinities really are all the same size,
10964 note that @samp{sqrt(inf) = inf^2 = exp(inf) = inf} in Calc's
10965 notation.
10966
10967 It's not so easy to define certain formulas like @samp{0 * inf} and
10968 @samp{inf / inf}. Depending on where these zeros and infinities
10969 came from, the answer could be literally anything. The latter
10970 formula could be the limit of @expr{x / x} (giving a result of one),
10971 or @expr{2 x / x} (giving two), or @expr{x^2 / x} (giving @code{inf}),
10972 or @expr{x / x^2} (giving zero). Calc uses the symbol @code{nan}
10973 to represent such an @dfn{indeterminate} value. (The name ``nan''
10974 comes from analogy with the ``NAN'' concept of IEEE standard
10975 arithmetic; it stands for ``Not A Number.'' This is somewhat of a
10976 misnomer, since @code{nan} @emph{does} stand for some number or
10977 infinity, it's just that @emph{which} number it stands for
10978 cannot be determined.) In Calc's notation, @samp{0 * inf = nan}
10979 and @samp{inf / inf = nan}. A few other common indeterminate
10980 expressions are @samp{inf - inf} and @samp{inf ^ 0}. Also,
10981 @samp{0 / 0 = nan} if you have turned on Infinite mode
10982 (as described above).
10983
10984 Infinities are especially useful as parts of @dfn{intervals}.
10985 @xref{Interval Forms}.
10986
10987 @node Vectors and Matrices, Strings, Infinities, Data Types
10988 @section Vectors and Matrices
10989
10990 @noindent
10991 @cindex Vectors
10992 @cindex Plain vectors
10993 @cindex Matrices
10994 The @dfn{vector} data type is flexible and general. A vector is simply a
10995 list of zero or more data objects. When these objects are numbers, the
10996 whole is a vector in the mathematical sense. When these objects are
10997 themselves vectors of equal (nonzero) length, the whole is a @dfn{matrix}.
10998 A vector which is not a matrix is referred to here as a @dfn{plain vector}.
10999
11000 A vector is displayed as a list of values separated by commas and enclosed
11001 in square brackets: @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Thus the following is a 2 row by
11002 3 column matrix: @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}. Vectors, like complex
11003 numbers, are entered as incomplete objects. @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
11004 During algebraic entry, vectors are entered all at once in the usual
11005 brackets-and-commas form. Matrices may be entered algebraically as nested
11006 vectors, or using the shortcut notation @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3; 4, 5, 6]}},
11007 with rows separated by semicolons. The commas may usually be omitted
11008 when entering vectors: @samp{[1 2 3]}. Curly braces may be used in
11009 place of brackets: @samp{@{1, 2, 3@}}, but the commas are required in
11010 this case.
11011
11012 Traditional vector and matrix arithmetic is also supported;
11013 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic} and @pxref{Matrix Functions}.
11014 Many other operations are applied to vectors element-wise. For example,
11015 the complex conjugate of a vector is a vector of the complex conjugates
11016 of its elements.
11017
11018 @ignore
11019 @starindex
11020 @end ignore
11021 @tindex vec
11022 Algebraic functions for building vectors include @samp{vec(a, b, c)}
11023 to build @samp{[a, b, c]}, @samp{cvec(a, n, m)} to build an
11024 @texline @math{n\times m}
11025 @infoline @var{n}x@var{m}
11026 matrix of @samp{a}s, and @samp{index(n)} to build a vector of integers
11027 from 1 to @samp{n}.
11028
11029 @node Strings, HMS Forms, Vectors and Matrices, Data Types
11030 @section Strings
11031
11032 @noindent
11033 @kindex "
11034 @cindex Strings
11035 @cindex Character strings
11036 Character strings are not a special data type in the Calculator.
11037 Rather, a string is represented simply as a vector all of whose
11038 elements are integers in the range 0 to 255 (ASCII codes). You can
11039 enter a string at any time by pressing the @kbd{"} key. Quotation
11040 marks and backslashes are written @samp{\"} and @samp{\\}, respectively,
11041 inside strings. Other notations introduced by backslashes are:
11042
11043 @example
11044 @group
11045 \a 7 \^@@ 0
11046 \b 8 \^a-z 1-26
11047 \e 27 \^[ 27
11048 \f 12 \^\\ 28
11049 \n 10 \^] 29
11050 \r 13 \^^ 30
11051 \t 9 \^_ 31
11052 \^? 127
11053 @end group
11054 @end example
11055
11056 @noindent
11057 Finally, a backslash followed by three octal digits produces any
11058 character from its ASCII code.
11059
11060 @kindex d "
11061 @pindex calc-display-strings
11062 Strings are normally displayed in vector-of-integers form. The
11063 @w{@kbd{d "}} (@code{calc-display-strings}) command toggles a mode in
11064 which any vectors of small integers are displayed as quoted strings
11065 instead.
11066
11067 The backslash notations shown above are also used for displaying
11068 strings. Characters 128 and above are not translated by Calc; unless
11069 you have an Emacs modified for 8-bit fonts, these will show up in
11070 backslash-octal-digits notation. For characters below 32, and
11071 for character 127, Calc uses the backslash-letter combination if
11072 there is one, or otherwise uses a @samp{\^} sequence.
11073
11074 The only Calc feature that uses strings is @dfn{compositions};
11075 @pxref{Compositions}. Strings also provide a convenient
11076 way to do conversions between ASCII characters and integers.
11077
11078 @ignore
11079 @starindex
11080 @end ignore
11081 @tindex string
11082 There is a @code{string} function which provides a different display
11083 format for strings. Basically, @samp{string(@var{s})}, where @var{s}
11084 is a vector of integers in the proper range, is displayed as the
11085 corresponding string of characters with no surrounding quotation
11086 marks or other modifications. Thus @samp{string("ABC")} (or
11087 @samp{string([65 66 67])}) will look like @samp{ABC} on the stack.
11088 This happens regardless of whether @w{@kbd{d "}} has been used. The
11089 only way to turn it off is to use @kbd{d U} (unformatted language
11090 mode) which will display @samp{string("ABC")} instead.
11091
11092 Control characters are displayed somewhat differently by @code{string}.
11093 Characters below 32, and character 127, are shown using @samp{^} notation
11094 (same as shown above, but without the backslash). The quote and
11095 backslash characters are left alone, as are characters 128 and above.
11096
11097 @ignore
11098 @starindex
11099 @end ignore
11100 @tindex bstring
11101 The @code{bstring} function is just like @code{string} except that
11102 the resulting string is breakable across multiple lines if it doesn't
11103 fit all on one line. Potential break points occur at every space
11104 character in the string.
11105
11106 @node HMS Forms, Date Forms, Strings, Data Types
11107 @section HMS Forms
11108
11109 @noindent
11110 @cindex Hours-minutes-seconds forms
11111 @cindex Degrees-minutes-seconds forms
11112 @dfn{HMS} stands for Hours-Minutes-Seconds; when used as an angular
11113 argument, the interpretation is Degrees-Minutes-Seconds. All functions
11114 that operate on angles accept HMS forms. These are interpreted as
11115 degrees regardless of the current angular mode. It is also possible to
11116 use HMS as the angular mode so that calculated angles are expressed in
11117 degrees, minutes, and seconds.
11118
11119 @kindex @@
11120 @ignore
11121 @mindex @null
11122 @end ignore
11123 @kindex ' (HMS forms)
11124 @ignore
11125 @mindex @null
11126 @end ignore
11127 @kindex " (HMS forms)
11128 @ignore
11129 @mindex @null
11130 @end ignore
11131 @kindex h (HMS forms)
11132 @ignore
11133 @mindex @null
11134 @end ignore
11135 @kindex o (HMS forms)
11136 @ignore
11137 @mindex @null
11138 @end ignore
11139 @kindex m (HMS forms)
11140 @ignore
11141 @mindex @null
11142 @end ignore
11143 @kindex s (HMS forms)
11144 The default format for HMS values is
11145 @samp{@var{hours}@@ @var{mins}' @var{secs}"}. During entry, the letters
11146 @samp{h} (for ``hours'') or
11147 @samp{o} (approximating the ``degrees'' symbol) are accepted as well as
11148 @samp{@@}, @samp{m} is accepted in place of @samp{'}, and @samp{s} is
11149 accepted in place of @samp{"}.
11150 The @var{hours} value is an integer (or integer-valued float).
11151 The @var{mins} value is an integer or integer-valued float between 0 and 59.
11152 The @var{secs} value is a real number between 0 (inclusive) and 60
11153 (exclusive). A positive HMS form is interpreted as @var{hours} +
11154 @var{mins}/60 + @var{secs}/3600. A negative HMS form is interpreted
11155 as @mathit{- @var{hours}} @mathit{-} @var{mins}/60 @mathit{-} @var{secs}/3600.
11156 Display format for HMS forms is quite flexible. @xref{HMS Formats}.
11157
11158 HMS forms can be added and subtracted. When they are added to numbers,
11159 the numbers are interpreted according to the current angular mode. HMS
11160 forms can also be multiplied and divided by real numbers. Dividing
11161 two HMS forms produces a real-valued ratio of the two angles.
11162
11163 @pindex calc-time
11164 @cindex Time of day
11165 Just for kicks, @kbd{M-x calc-time} pushes the current time of day on
11166 the stack as an HMS form.
11167
11168 @node Date Forms, Modulo Forms, HMS Forms, Data Types
11169 @section Date Forms
11170
11171 @noindent
11172 @cindex Date forms
11173 A @dfn{date form} represents a date and possibly an associated time.
11174 Simple date arithmetic is supported: Adding a number to a date
11175 produces a new date shifted by that many days; adding an HMS form to
11176 a date shifts it by that many hours. Subtracting two date forms
11177 computes the number of days between them (represented as a simple
11178 number). Many other operations, such as multiplying two date forms,
11179 are nonsensical and are not allowed by Calc.
11180
11181 Date forms are entered and displayed enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets.
11182 The default format is, e.g., @samp{<Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates,
11183 or @samp{<3:32:20pm Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates with times.
11184 Input is flexible; date forms can be entered in any of the usual
11185 notations for dates and times. @xref{Date Formats}.
11186
11187 Date forms are stored internally as numbers, specifically the number
11188 of days since midnight on the morning of January 1 of the year 1 AD.
11189 If the internal number is an integer, the form represents a date only;
11190 if the internal number is a fraction or float, the form represents
11191 a date and time. For example, @samp{<6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991>}
11192 is represented by the number 726842.25. The standard precision of
11193 12 decimal digits is enough to ensure that a (reasonable) date and
11194 time can be stored without roundoff error.
11195
11196 If the current precision is greater than 12, date forms will keep
11197 additional digits in the seconds position. For example, if the
11198 precision is 15, the seconds will keep three digits after the
11199 decimal point. Decreasing the precision below 12 may cause the
11200 time part of a date form to become inaccurate. This can also happen
11201 if astronomically high years are used, though this will not be an
11202 issue in everyday (or even everymillennium) use. Note that date
11203 forms without times are stored as exact integers, so roundoff is
11204 never an issue for them.
11205
11206 You can use the @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) and @kbd{v u}
11207 (@code{calc-unpack}) commands to get at the numerical representation
11208 of a date form. @xref{Packing and Unpacking}.
11209
11210 Date forms can go arbitrarily far into the future or past. Negative
11211 year numbers represent years BC. Calc uses a combination of the
11212 Gregorian and Julian calendars, following the history of Great
11213 Britain and the British colonies. This is the same calendar that
11214 is used by the @code{cal} program in most Unix implementations.
11215
11216 @cindex Julian calendar
11217 @cindex Gregorian calendar
11218 Some historical background: The Julian calendar was created by
11219 Julius Caesar in the year 46 BC as an attempt to fix the gradual
11220 drift caused by the lack of leap years in the calendar used
11221 until that time. The Julian calendar introduced an extra day in
11222 all years divisible by four. After some initial confusion, the
11223 calendar was adopted around the year we call 8 AD. Some centuries
11224 later it became apparent that the Julian year of 365.25 days was
11225 itself not quite right. In 1582 Pope Gregory XIII introduced the
11226 Gregorian calendar, which added the new rule that years divisible
11227 by 100, but not by 400, were not to be considered leap years
11228 despite being divisible by four. Many countries delayed adoption
11229 of the Gregorian calendar because of religious differences;
11230 in Britain it was put off until the year 1752, by which time
11231 the Julian calendar had fallen eleven days behind the true
11232 seasons. So the switch to the Gregorian calendar in early
11233 September 1752 introduced a discontinuity: The day after
11234 Sep 2, 1752 is Sep 14, 1752. Calc follows this convention.
11235 To take another example, Russia waited until 1918 before
11236 adopting the new calendar, and thus needed to remove thirteen
11237 days (between Feb 1, 1918 and Feb 14, 1918). This means that
11238 Calc's reckoning will be inconsistent with Russian history between
11239 1752 and 1918, and similarly for various other countries.
11240
11241 Today's timekeepers introduce an occasional ``leap second'' as
11242 well, but Calc does not take these minor effects into account.
11243 (If it did, it would have to report a non-integer number of days
11244 between, say, @samp{<12:00am Mon Jan 1, 1900>} and
11245 @samp{<12:00am Sat Jan 1, 2000>}.)
11246
11247 Calc uses the Julian calendar for all dates before the year 1752,
11248 including dates BC when the Julian calendar technically had not
11249 yet been invented. Thus the claim that day number @mathit{-10000} is
11250 called ``August 16, 28 BC'' should be taken with a grain of salt.
11251
11252 Please note that there is no ``year 0''; the day before
11253 @samp{<Sat Jan 1, +1>} is @samp{<Fri Dec 31, -1>}. These are
11254 days 0 and @mathit{-1} respectively in Calc's internal numbering scheme.
11255
11256 @cindex Julian day counting
11257 Another day counting system in common use is, confusingly, also
11258 called ``Julian.'' It was invented in 1583 by Joseph Justus
11259 Scaliger, who named it in honor of his father Julius Caesar
11260 Scaliger. For obscure reasons he chose to start his day
11261 numbering on Jan 1, 4713 BC at noon, which in Calc's scheme
11262 is @mathit{-1721423.5} (recall that Calc starts at midnight instead
11263 of noon). Thus to convert a Calc date code obtained by
11264 unpacking a date form into a Julian day number, simply add
11265 1721423.5. The Julian code for @samp{6:00am Jan 9, 1991}
11266 is 2448265.75. The built-in @kbd{t J} command performs
11267 this conversion for you.
11268
11269 @cindex Unix time format
11270 The Unix operating system measures time as an integer number of
11271 seconds since midnight, Jan 1, 1970. To convert a Calc date
11272 value into a Unix time stamp, first subtract 719164 (the code
11273 for @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}), then multiply by 86400 (the number of
11274 seconds in a day) and press @kbd{R} to round to the nearest
11275 integer. If you have a date form, you can simply subtract the
11276 day @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>} instead of unpacking and subtracting
11277 719164. Likewise, divide by 86400 and add @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}
11278 to convert from Unix time to a Calc date form. (Note that
11279 Unix normally maintains the time in the GMT time zone; you may
11280 need to subtract five hours to get New York time, or eight hours
11281 for California time. The same is usually true of Julian day
11282 counts.) The built-in @kbd{t U} command performs these
11283 conversions.
11284
11285 @node Modulo Forms, Error Forms, Date Forms, Data Types
11286 @section Modulo Forms
11287
11288 @noindent
11289 @cindex Modulo forms
11290 A @dfn{modulo form} is a real number which is taken modulo (i.e., within
11291 an integer multiple of) some value @var{M}. Arithmetic modulo @var{M}
11292 often arises in number theory. Modulo forms are written
11293 `@var{a} @t{mod} @var{M}',
11294 where @var{a} and @var{M} are real numbers or HMS forms, and
11295 @texline @math{0 \le a < M}.
11296 @infoline @expr{0 <= a < @var{M}}.
11297 In many applications @expr{a} and @expr{M} will be
11298 integers but this is not required.
11299
11300 Modulo forms are not to be confused with the modulo operator @samp{%}.
11301 The expression @samp{27 % 10} means to compute 27 modulo 10 to produce
11302 the result 7. Further computations treat this 7 as just a regular integer.
11303 The expression @samp{27 mod 10} produces the result @samp{7 mod 10};
11304 further computations with this value are again reduced modulo 10 so that
11305 the result always lies in the desired range.
11306
11307 When two modulo forms with identical @expr{M}'s are added or multiplied,
11308 the Calculator simply adds or multiplies the values, then reduces modulo
11309 @expr{M}. If one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number,
11310 the plain number is treated like a compatible modulo form. It is also
11311 possible to raise modulo forms to powers; the result is the value raised
11312 to the power, then reduced modulo @expr{M}. (When all values involved
11313 are integers, this calculation is done much more efficiently than
11314 actually computing the power and then reducing.)
11315
11316 @cindex Modulo division
11317 Two modulo forms `@var{a} @t{mod} @var{M}' and `@var{b} @t{mod} @var{M}'
11318 can be divided if @expr{a}, @expr{b}, and @expr{M} are all
11319 integers. The result is the modulo form which, when multiplied by
11320 `@var{b} @t{mod} @var{M}', produces `@var{a} @t{mod} @var{M}'. If
11321 there is no solution to this equation (which can happen only when
11322 @expr{M} is non-prime), or if any of the arguments are non-integers, the
11323 division is left in symbolic form. Other operations, such as square
11324 roots, are not yet supported for modulo forms. (Note that, although
11325 @w{`@t{(}@var{a} @t{mod} @var{M}@t{)^.5}'} will compute a ``modulo square root''
11326 in the sense of reducing
11327 @texline @math{\sqrt a}
11328 @infoline @expr{sqrt(a)}
11329 modulo @expr{M}, this is not a useful definition from the
11330 number-theoretical point of view.)
11331
11332 @ignore
11333 @mindex M
11334 @end ignore
11335 @kindex M (modulo forms)
11336 @ignore
11337 @mindex mod
11338 @end ignore
11339 @tindex mod (operator)
11340 To create a modulo form during numeric entry, press the shift-@kbd{M}
11341 key to enter the word @samp{mod}. As a special convenience, pressing
11342 shift-@kbd{M} a second time automatically enters the value of @expr{M}
11343 that was most recently used before. During algebraic entry, either
11344 type @samp{mod} by hand or press @kbd{M-m} (that's @kbd{@key{META}-m}).
11345 Once again, pressing this a second time enters the current modulo.
11346
11347 You can also use @kbd{v p} and @kbd{%} to modify modulo forms.
11348 @xref{Building Vectors}. @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
11349
11350 It is possible to mix HMS forms and modulo forms. For example, an
11351 HMS form modulo 24 could be used to manipulate clock times; an HMS
11352 form modulo 360 would be suitable for angles. Making the modulo @expr{M}
11353 also be an HMS form eliminates troubles that would arise if the angular
11354 mode were inadvertently set to Radians, in which case
11355 @w{@samp{2@@ 0' 0" mod 24}} would be interpreted as two degrees modulo
11356 24 radians!
11357
11358 Modulo forms cannot have variables or formulas for components. If you
11359 enter the formula @samp{(x + 2) mod 5}, Calc propagates the modulus
11360 to each of the coefficients: @samp{(1 mod 5) x + (2 mod 5)}.
11361
11362 @ignore
11363 @starindex
11364 @end ignore
11365 @tindex makemod
11366 The algebraic function @samp{makemod(a, m)} builds the modulo form
11367 @w{@samp{a mod m}}.
11368
11369 @node Error Forms, Interval Forms, Modulo Forms, Data Types
11370 @section Error Forms
11371
11372 @noindent
11373 @cindex Error forms
11374 @cindex Standard deviations
11375 An @dfn{error form} is a number with an associated standard
11376 deviation, as in @samp{2.3 +/- 0.12}. The notation
11377 @texline `@var{x} @t{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11378 @infoline `@var{x} @t{+/-} sigma'
11379 stands for an uncertain value which follows
11380 a normal or Gaussian distribution of mean @expr{x} and standard
11381 deviation or ``error''
11382 @texline @math{\sigma}.
11383 @infoline @expr{sigma}.
11384 Both the mean and the error can be either numbers or
11385 formulas. Generally these are real numbers but the mean may also be
11386 complex. If the error is negative or complex, it is changed to its
11387 absolute value. An error form with zero error is converted to a
11388 regular number by the Calculator.
11389
11390 All arithmetic and transcendental functions accept error forms as input.
11391 Operations on the mean-value part work just like operations on regular
11392 numbers. The error part for any function @expr{f(x)} (such as
11393 @texline @math{\sin x}
11394 @infoline @expr{sin(x)})
11395 is defined by the error of @expr{x} times the derivative of @expr{f}
11396 evaluated at the mean value of @expr{x}. For a two-argument function
11397 @expr{f(x,y)} (such as addition) the error is the square root of the sum
11398 of the squares of the errors due to @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
11399 @tex
11400 $$ \eqalign{
11401 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma)
11402 &= f(x) \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma \left| {df(x) \over dx} \right| \cr
11403 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_x, y \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_y)
11404 &= f(x,y) \hbox{\code{ +/- }}
11405 \sqrt{\left(\sigma_x \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial x}
11406 \right| \right)^2
11407 +\left(\sigma_y \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial y}
11408 \right| \right)^2 } \cr
11409 } $$
11410 @end tex
11411 Note that this
11412 definition assumes the errors in @expr{x} and @expr{y} are uncorrelated.
11413 A side effect of this definition is that @samp{(2 +/- 1) * (2 +/- 1)}
11414 is not the same as @samp{(2 +/- 1)^2}; the former represents the product
11415 of two independent values which happen to have the same probability
11416 distributions, and the latter is the product of one random value with itself.
11417 The former will produce an answer with less error, since on the average
11418 the two independent errors can be expected to cancel out.
11419
11420 Consult a good text on error analysis for a discussion of the proper use
11421 of standard deviations. Actual errors often are neither Gaussian-distributed
11422 nor uncorrelated, and the above formulas are valid only when errors
11423 are small. As an example, the error arising from
11424 @texline `@t{sin(}@var{x} @t{+/-} @math{\sigma}@t{)}'
11425 @infoline `@t{sin(}@var{x} @t{+/-} @var{sigma}@t{)}'
11426 is
11427 @texline `@math{\sigma} @t{abs(cos(}@var{x}@t{))}'.
11428 @infoline `@var{sigma} @t{abs(cos(}@var{x}@t{))}'.
11429 When @expr{x} is close to zero,
11430 @texline @math{\cos x}
11431 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11432 is close to one so the error in the sine is close to
11433 @texline @math{\sigma};
11434 @infoline @expr{sigma};
11435 this makes sense, since
11436 @texline @math{\sin x}
11437 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11438 is approximately @expr{x} near zero, so a given error in @expr{x} will
11439 produce about the same error in the sine. Likewise, near 90 degrees
11440 @texline @math{\cos x}
11441 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11442 is nearly zero and so the computed error is
11443 small: The sine curve is nearly flat in that region, so an error in @expr{x}
11444 has relatively little effect on the value of
11445 @texline @math{\sin x}.
11446 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}.
11447 However, consider @samp{sin(90 +/- 1000)}. The cosine of 90 is zero, so
11448 Calc will report zero error! We get an obviously wrong result because
11449 we have violated the small-error approximation underlying the error
11450 analysis. If the error in @expr{x} had been small, the error in
11451 @texline @math{\sin x}
11452 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11453 would indeed have been negligible.
11454
11455 @ignore
11456 @mindex p
11457 @end ignore
11458 @kindex p (error forms)
11459 @tindex +/-
11460 To enter an error form during regular numeric entry, use the @kbd{p}
11461 (``plus-or-minus'') key to type the @samp{+/-} symbol. (If you try actually
11462 typing @samp{+/-} the @kbd{+} key will be interpreted as the Calculator's
11463 @kbd{+} command!) Within an algebraic formula, you can press @kbd{M-p} to
11464 type the @samp{+/-} symbol, or type it out by hand.
11465
11466 Error forms and complex numbers can be mixed; the formulas shown above
11467 are used for complex numbers, too; note that if the error part evaluates
11468 to a complex number its absolute value (or the square root of the sum of
11469 the squares of the absolute values of the two error contributions) is
11470 used. Mathematically, this corresponds to a radially symmetric Gaussian
11471 distribution of numbers on the complex plane. However, note that Calc
11472 considers an error form with real components to represent a real number,
11473 not a complex distribution around a real mean.
11474
11475 Error forms may also be composed of HMS forms. For best results, both
11476 the mean and the error should be HMS forms if either one is.
11477
11478 @ignore
11479 @starindex
11480 @end ignore
11481 @tindex sdev
11482 The algebraic function @samp{sdev(a, b)} builds the error form @samp{a +/- b}.
11483
11484 @node Interval Forms, Incomplete Objects, Error Forms, Data Types
11485 @section Interval Forms
11486
11487 @noindent
11488 @cindex Interval forms
11489 An @dfn{interval} is a subset of consecutive real numbers. For example,
11490 the interval @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} represents all the numbers from 2 to 4,
11491 inclusive. If you multiply it by the interval @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]} you
11492 obtain @samp{[1 ..@: 8]}. This calculation represents the fact that if
11493 you multiply some number in the range @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} by some other
11494 number in the range @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]}, your result will lie in the range
11495 from 1 to 8. Interval arithmetic is used to get a worst-case estimate
11496 of the possible range of values a computation will produce, given the
11497 set of possible values of the input.
11498
11499 @ifinfo
11500 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including @dfn{closed}
11501 intervals of the type shown above, @dfn{open} intervals such as
11502 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11503 @emph{exclusive}, and @dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11504 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11505 terms,
11506 @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} means @expr{2 <= x <= 4}, whereas
11507 @samp{[2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 <= x < 4},
11508 @samp{(2 ..@: 4]} represents @expr{2 < x <= 4}, and
11509 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 < x < 4}.
11510 @end ifinfo
11511 @tex
11512 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including \dfn{closed}
11513 intervals of the type shown above, \dfn{open} intervals such as
11514 \samp{(2 ..\: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11515 \emph{exclusive}, and \dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11516 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11517 terms,
11518 $$ \eqalign{
11519 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x \le 4 \cr
11520 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x < 4 \cr
11521 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x \le 4 \cr
11522 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x < 4 \cr
11523 } $$
11524 @end tex
11525
11526 The lower and upper limits of an interval must be either real numbers
11527 (or HMS or date forms), or symbolic expressions which are assumed to be
11528 real-valued, or @samp{-inf} and @samp{inf}. In general the lower limit
11529 must be less than the upper limit. A closed interval containing only
11530 one value, @samp{[3 ..@: 3]}, is converted to a plain number (3)
11531 automatically. An interval containing no values at all (such as
11532 @samp{[3 ..@: 2]} or @samp{[2 ..@: 2)}) can be represented but is not
11533 guaranteed to behave well when used in arithmetic. Note that the
11534 interval @samp{[3 .. inf)} represents all real numbers greater than
11535 or equal to 3, and @samp{(-inf .. inf)} represents all real numbers.
11536 In fact, @samp{[-inf .. inf]} represents all real numbers including
11537 the real infinities.
11538
11539 Intervals are entered in the notation shown here, either as algebraic
11540 formulas, or using incomplete forms. (@xref{Incomplete Objects}.)
11541 In algebraic formulas, multiple periods in a row are collected from
11542 left to right, so that @samp{1...1e2} is interpreted as @samp{1.0 ..@: 1e2}
11543 rather than @samp{1 ..@: 0.1e2}. Add spaces or zeros if you want to
11544 get the other interpretation. If you omit the lower or upper limit,
11545 a default of @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} (respectively) is furnished.
11546
11547 Infinite mode also affects operations on intervals
11548 (@pxref{Infinities}). Calc will always introduce an open infinity,
11549 as in @samp{1 / (0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf)}. But closed infinities,
11550 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf]}}, arise only in Infinite mode;
11551 otherwise they are left unevaluated. Note that the ``direction'' of
11552 a zero is not an issue in this case since the zero is always assumed
11553 to be continuous with the rest of the interval. For intervals that
11554 contain zero inside them Calc is forced to give the result,
11555 @samp{1 / (-2 .. 2) = [-inf .. inf]}.
11556
11557 While it may seem that intervals and error forms are similar, they are
11558 based on entirely different concepts of inexact quantities. An error
11559 form
11560 @texline `@var{x} @t{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11561 @infoline `@var{x} @t{+/-} @var{sigma}'
11562 means a variable is random, and its value could
11563 be anything but is ``probably'' within one
11564 @texline @math{\sigma}
11565 @infoline @var{sigma}
11566 of the mean value @expr{x}. An interval
11567 `@t{[}@var{a} @t{..@:} @var{b}@t{]}' means a
11568 variable's value is unknown, but guaranteed to lie in the specified
11569 range. Error forms are statistical or ``average case'' approximations;
11570 interval arithmetic tends to produce ``worst case'' bounds on an
11571 answer.
11572
11573 Intervals may not contain complex numbers, but they may contain
11574 HMS forms or date forms.
11575
11576 @xref{Set Operations}, for commands that interpret interval forms
11577 as subsets of the set of real numbers.
11578
11579 @ignore
11580 @starindex
11581 @end ignore
11582 @tindex intv
11583 The algebraic function @samp{intv(n, a, b)} builds an interval form
11584 from @samp{a} to @samp{b}; @samp{n} is an integer code which must
11585 be 0 for @samp{(..)}, 1 for @samp{(..]}, 2 for @samp{[..)}, or
11586 3 for @samp{[..]}.
11587
11588 Please note that in fully rigorous interval arithmetic, care would be
11589 taken to make sure that the computation of the lower bound rounds toward
11590 minus infinity, while upper bound computations round toward plus
11591 infinity. Calc's arithmetic always uses a round-to-nearest mode,
11592 which means that roundoff errors could creep into an interval
11593 calculation to produce intervals slightly smaller than they ought to
11594 be. For example, entering @samp{[1..2]} and pressing @kbd{Q 2 ^}
11595 should yield the interval @samp{[1..2]} again, but in fact it yields the
11596 (slightly too small) interval @samp{[1..1.9999999]} due to roundoff
11597 error.
11598
11599 @node Incomplete Objects, Variables, Interval Forms, Data Types
11600 @section Incomplete Objects
11601
11602 @noindent
11603 @ignore
11604 @mindex [ ]
11605 @end ignore
11606 @kindex [
11607 @ignore
11608 @mindex ( )
11609 @end ignore
11610 @kindex (
11611 @kindex ,
11612 @ignore
11613 @mindex @null
11614 @end ignore
11615 @kindex ]
11616 @ignore
11617 @mindex @null
11618 @end ignore
11619 @kindex )
11620 @cindex Incomplete vectors
11621 @cindex Incomplete complex numbers
11622 @cindex Incomplete interval forms
11623 When @kbd{(} or @kbd{[} is typed to begin entering a complex number or
11624 vector, respectively, the effect is to push an @dfn{incomplete} complex
11625 number or vector onto the stack. The @kbd{,} key adds the value(s) at
11626 the top of the stack onto the current incomplete object. The @kbd{)}
11627 and @kbd{]} keys ``close'' the incomplete object after adding any values
11628 on the top of the stack in front of the incomplete object.
11629
11630 As a result, the sequence of keystrokes @kbd{[ 2 , 3 @key{RET} 2 * , 9 ]}
11631 pushes the vector @samp{[2, 6, 9]} onto the stack. Likewise, @kbd{( 1 , 2 Q )}
11632 pushes the complex number @samp{(1, 1.414)} (approximately).
11633
11634 If several values lie on the stack in front of the incomplete object,
11635 all are collected and appended to the object. Thus the @kbd{,} key
11636 is redundant: @kbd{[ 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 2 * 9 ]}. Some people
11637 prefer the equivalent @key{SPC} key to @key{RET}.
11638
11639 As a special case, typing @kbd{,} immediately after @kbd{(}, @kbd{[}, or
11640 @kbd{,} adds a zero or duplicates the preceding value in the list being
11641 formed. Typing @key{DEL} during incomplete entry removes the last item
11642 from the list.
11643
11644 @kindex ;
11645 The @kbd{;} key is used in the same way as @kbd{,} to create polar complex
11646 numbers: @kbd{( 1 ; 2 )}. When entering a vector, @kbd{;} is useful for
11647 creating a matrix. In particular, @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ; 3 , 4 ; 5 , 6 ] ]} is
11648 equivalent to @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ] , [ 3 , 4 ] , [ 5 , 6 ] ]}.
11649
11650 @kindex ..
11651 @pindex calc-dots
11652 Incomplete entry is also used to enter intervals. For example,
11653 @kbd{[ 2 ..@: 4 )} enters a semi-open interval. Note that when you type
11654 the first period, it will be interpreted as a decimal point, but when
11655 you type a second period immediately afterward, it is re-interpreted as
11656 part of the interval symbol. Typing @kbd{..} corresponds to executing
11657 the @code{calc-dots} command.
11658
11659 If you find incomplete entry distracting, you may wish to enter vectors
11660 and complex numbers as algebraic formulas by pressing the apostrophe key.
11661
11662 @node Variables, Formulas, Incomplete Objects, Data Types
11663 @section Variables
11664
11665 @noindent
11666 @cindex Variables, in formulas
11667 A @dfn{variable} is somewhere between a storage register on a conventional
11668 calculator, and a variable in a programming language. (In fact, a Calc
11669 variable is really just an Emacs Lisp variable that contains a Calc number
11670 or formula.) A variable's name is normally composed of letters and digits.
11671 Calc also allows apostrophes and @code{#} signs in variable names.
11672 (The Calc variable @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp variable
11673 @code{var-foo}, but unless you access the variable from within Emacs
11674 Lisp, you don't need to worry about it. Variable names in algebraic
11675 formulas implicitly have @samp{var-} prefixed to their names. The
11676 @samp{#} character in variable names used in algebraic formulas
11677 corresponds to a dash @samp{-} in the Lisp variable name. If the name
11678 contains any dashes, the prefix @samp{var-} is @emph{not} automatically
11679 added. Thus the two formulas @samp{foo + 1} and @samp{var#foo + 1} both
11680 refer to the same variable.)
11681
11682 In a command that takes a variable name, you can either type the full
11683 name of a variable, or type a single digit to use one of the special
11684 convenience variables @code{q0} through @code{q9}. For example,
11685 @kbd{3 s s 2} stores the number 3 in variable @code{q2}, and
11686 @w{@kbd{3 s s foo @key{RET}}} stores that number in variable
11687 @code{foo}.
11688
11689 To push a variable itself (as opposed to the variable's value) on the
11690 stack, enter its name as an algebraic expression using the apostrophe
11691 (@key{'}) key.
11692
11693 @kindex =
11694 @pindex calc-evaluate
11695 @cindex Evaluation of variables in a formula
11696 @cindex Variables, evaluation
11697 @cindex Formulas, evaluation
11698 The @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) key ``evaluates'' a formula by
11699 replacing all variables in the formula which have been given values by a
11700 @code{calc-store} or @code{calc-let} command by their stored values.
11701 Other variables are left alone. Thus a variable that has not been
11702 stored acts like an abstract variable in algebra; a variable that has
11703 been stored acts more like a register in a traditional calculator.
11704 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{=} evaluates the top
11705 @var{n} stack entries; with a negative argument, @kbd{=} evaluates
11706 the @var{n}th stack entry.
11707
11708 @cindex @code{e} variable
11709 @cindex @code{pi} variable
11710 @cindex @code{i} variable
11711 @cindex @code{phi} variable
11712 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
11713 @vindex e
11714 @vindex pi
11715 @vindex i
11716 @vindex phi
11717 @vindex gamma
11718 A few variables are called @dfn{special constants}. Their names are
11719 @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and @samp{gamma}.
11720 (@xref{Scientific Functions}.) When they are evaluated with @kbd{=},
11721 their values are calculated if necessary according to the current precision
11722 or complex polar mode. If you wish to use these symbols for other purposes,
11723 simply undefine or redefine them using @code{calc-store}.
11724
11725 The variables @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} stand for
11726 infinite or indeterminate values. It's best not to use them as
11727 regular variables, since Calc uses special algebraic rules when
11728 it manipulates them. Calc displays a warning message if you store
11729 a value into any of these special variables.
11730
11731 @xref{Store and Recall}, for a discussion of commands dealing with variables.
11732
11733 @node Formulas, , Variables, Data Types
11734 @section Formulas
11735
11736 @noindent
11737 @cindex Formulas
11738 @cindex Expressions
11739 @cindex Operators in formulas
11740 @cindex Precedence of operators
11741 When you press the apostrophe key you may enter any expression or formula
11742 in algebraic form. (Calc uses the terms ``expression'' and ``formula''
11743 interchangeably.) An expression is built up of numbers, variable names,
11744 and function calls, combined with various arithmetic operators.
11745 Parentheses may
11746 be used to indicate grouping. Spaces are ignored within formulas, except
11747 that spaces are not permitted within variable names or numbers.
11748 Arithmetic operators, in order from highest to lowest precedence, and
11749 with their equivalent function names, are:
11750
11751 @samp{_} [@code{subscr}] (subscripts);
11752
11753 postfix @samp{%} [@code{percent}] (as in @samp{25% = 0.25});
11754
11755 prefix @samp{+} and @samp{-} [@code{neg}] (as in @samp{-x})
11756 and prefix @samp{!} [@code{lnot}] (logical ``not,'' as in @samp{!x});
11757
11758 @samp{+/-} [@code{sdev}] (the standard deviation symbol) and
11759 @samp{mod} [@code{makemod}] (the symbol for modulo forms);
11760
11761 postfix @samp{!} [@code{fact}] (factorial, as in @samp{n!})
11762 and postfix @samp{!!} [@code{dfact}] (double factorial);
11763
11764 @samp{^} [@code{pow}] (raised-to-the-power-of);
11765
11766 @samp{*} [@code{mul}];
11767
11768 @samp{/} [@code{div}], @samp{%} [@code{mod}] (modulo), and
11769 @samp{\} [@code{idiv}] (integer division);
11770
11771 infix @samp{+} [@code{add}] and @samp{-} [@code{sub}] (as in @samp{x-y});
11772
11773 @samp{|} [@code{vconcat}] (vector concatenation);
11774
11775 relations @samp{=} [@code{eq}], @samp{!=} [@code{neq}], @samp{<} [@code{lt}],
11776 @samp{>} [@code{gt}], @samp{<=} [@code{leq}], and @samp{>=} [@code{geq}];
11777
11778 @samp{&&} [@code{land}] (logical ``and'');
11779
11780 @samp{||} [@code{lor}] (logical ``or'');
11781
11782 the C-style ``if'' operator @samp{a?b:c} [@code{if}];
11783
11784 @samp{!!!} [@code{pnot}] (rewrite pattern ``not'');
11785
11786 @samp{&&&} [@code{pand}] (rewrite pattern ``and'');
11787
11788 @samp{|||} [@code{por}] (rewrite pattern ``or'');
11789
11790 @samp{:=} [@code{assign}] (for assignments and rewrite rules);
11791
11792 @samp{::} [@code{condition}] (rewrite pattern condition);
11793
11794 @samp{=>} [@code{evalto}].
11795
11796 Note that, unlike in usual computer notation, multiplication binds more
11797 strongly than division: @samp{a*b/c*d} is equivalent to
11798 @texline @math{a b \over c d}.
11799 @infoline @expr{(a*b)/(c*d)}.
11800
11801 @cindex Multiplication, implicit
11802 @cindex Implicit multiplication
11803 The multiplication sign @samp{*} may be omitted in many cases. In particular,
11804 if the righthand side is a number, variable name, or parenthesized
11805 expression, the @samp{*} may be omitted. Implicit multiplication has the
11806 same precedence as the explicit @samp{*} operator. The one exception to
11807 the rule is that a variable name followed by a parenthesized expression,
11808 as in @samp{f(x)},
11809 is interpreted as a function call, not an implicit @samp{*}. In many
11810 cases you must use a space if you omit the @samp{*}: @samp{2a} is the
11811 same as @samp{2*a}, and @samp{a b} is the same as @samp{a*b}, but @samp{ab}
11812 is a variable called @code{ab}, @emph{not} the product of @samp{a} and
11813 @samp{b}! Also note that @samp{f (x)} is still a function call.
11814
11815 @cindex Implicit comma in vectors
11816 The rules are slightly different for vectors written with square brackets.
11817 In vectors, the space character is interpreted (like the comma) as a
11818 separator of elements of the vector. Thus @w{@samp{[ 2a b+c d ]}} is
11819 equivalent to @samp{[2*a, b+c, d]}, whereas @samp{2a b+c d} is equivalent
11820 to @samp{2*a*b + c*d}.
11821 Note that spaces around the brackets, and around explicit commas, are
11822 ignored. To force spaces to be interpreted as multiplication you can
11823 enclose a formula in parentheses as in @samp{[(a b) 2(c d)]}, which is
11824 interpreted as @samp{[a*b, 2*c*d]}. An implicit comma is also inserted
11825 between @samp{][}, as in the matrix @samp{[[1 2][3 4]]}.
11826
11827 Vectors that contain commas (not embedded within nested parentheses or
11828 brackets) do not treat spaces specially: @samp{[a b, 2 c d]} is a vector
11829 of two elements. Also, if it would be an error to treat spaces as
11830 separators, but not otherwise, then Calc will ignore spaces:
11831 @w{@samp{[a - b]}} is a vector of one element, but @w{@samp{[a -b]}} is
11832 a vector of two elements. Finally, vectors entered with curly braces
11833 instead of square brackets do not give spaces any special treatment.
11834 When Calc displays a vector that does not contain any commas, it will
11835 insert parentheses if necessary to make the meaning clear:
11836 @w{@samp{[(a b)]}}.
11837
11838 The expression @samp{5%-2} is ambiguous; is this five-percent minus two,
11839 or five modulo minus-two? Calc always interprets the leftmost symbol as
11840 an infix operator preferentially (modulo, in this case), so you would
11841 need to write @samp{(5%)-2} to get the former interpretation.
11842
11843 @cindex Function call notation
11844 A function call is, e.g., @samp{sin(1+x)}. (The Calc algebraic function
11845 @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp function @code{calcFunc-foo},
11846 but unless you access the function from within Emacs Lisp, you don't
11847 need to worry about it.) Most mathematical Calculator commands like
11848 @code{calc-sin} have function equivalents like @code{sin}.
11849 If no Lisp function is defined for a function called by a formula, the
11850 call is left as it is during algebraic manipulation: @samp{f(x+y)} is
11851 left alone. Beware that many innocent-looking short names like @code{in}
11852 and @code{re} have predefined meanings which could surprise you; however,
11853 single letters or single letters followed by digits are always safe to
11854 use for your own function names. @xref{Function Index}.
11855
11856 In the documentation for particular commands, the notation @kbd{H S}
11857 (@code{calc-sinh}) [@code{sinh}] means that the key sequence @kbd{H S}, the
11858 command @kbd{M-x calc-sinh}, and the algebraic function @code{sinh(x)} all
11859 represent the same operation.
11860
11861 Commands that interpret (``parse'') text as algebraic formulas include
11862 algebraic entry (@kbd{'}), editing commands like @kbd{`} which parse
11863 the contents of the editing buffer when you finish, the @kbd{M-# g}
11864 and @w{@kbd{M-# r}} commands, the @kbd{C-y} command, the X window system
11865 ``paste'' mouse operation, and Embedded mode. All of these operations
11866 use the same rules for parsing formulas; in particular, language modes
11867 (@pxref{Language Modes}) affect them all in the same way.
11868
11869 When you read a large amount of text into the Calculator (say a vector
11870 which represents a big set of rewrite rules; @pxref{Rewrite Rules}),
11871 you may wish to include comments in the text. Calc's formula parser
11872 ignores the symbol @samp{%%} and anything following it on a line:
11873
11874 @example
11875 [ a + b, %% the sum of "a" and "b"
11876 c + d,
11877 %% last line is coming up:
11878 e + f ]
11879 @end example
11880
11881 @noindent
11882 This is parsed exactly the same as @samp{[ a + b, c + d, e + f ]}.
11883
11884 @xref{Syntax Tables}, for a way to create your own operators and other
11885 input notations. @xref{Compositions}, for a way to create new display
11886 formats.
11887
11888 @xref{Algebra}, for commands for manipulating formulas symbolically.
11889
11890 @node Stack and Trail, Mode Settings, Data Types, Top
11891 @chapter Stack and Trail Commands
11892
11893 @noindent
11894 This chapter describes the Calc commands for manipulating objects on the
11895 stack and in the trail buffer. (These commands operate on objects of any
11896 type, such as numbers, vectors, formulas, and incomplete objects.)
11897
11898 @menu
11899 * Stack Manipulation::
11900 * Editing Stack Entries::
11901 * Trail Commands::
11902 * Keep Arguments::
11903 @end menu
11904
11905 @node Stack Manipulation, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail, Stack and Trail
11906 @section Stack Manipulation Commands
11907
11908 @noindent
11909 @kindex @key{RET}
11910 @kindex @key{SPC}
11911 @pindex calc-enter
11912 @cindex Duplicating stack entries
11913 To duplicate the top object on the stack, press @key{RET} or @key{SPC}
11914 (two equivalent keys for the @code{calc-enter} command).
11915 Given a positive numeric prefix argument, these commands duplicate
11916 several elements at the top of the stack.
11917 Given a negative argument,
11918 these commands duplicate the specified element of the stack.
11919 Given an argument of zero, they duplicate the entire stack.
11920 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11921 @key{RET} creates @samp{10 20 30 30},
11922 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20 30},
11923 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20}, and
11924 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 10 20 30}.
11925
11926 @kindex @key{LFD}
11927 @pindex calc-over
11928 The @key{LFD} (@code{calc-over}) command (on a key marked Line-Feed if you
11929 have it, else on @kbd{C-j}) is like @code{calc-enter}
11930 except that the sign of the numeric prefix argument is interpreted
11931 oppositely. Also, with no prefix argument the default argument is 2.
11932 Thus with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack, @key{LFD} and @kbd{C-u 2 @key{LFD}}
11933 are both equivalent to @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}}, producing
11934 @samp{10 20 30 20}.
11935
11936 @kindex @key{DEL}
11937 @kindex C-d
11938 @pindex calc-pop
11939 @cindex Removing stack entries
11940 @cindex Deleting stack entries
11941 To remove the top element from the stack, press @key{DEL} (@code{calc-pop}).
11942 The @kbd{C-d} key is a synonym for @key{DEL}.
11943 (If the top element is an incomplete object with at least one element, the
11944 last element is removed from it.) Given a positive numeric prefix argument,
11945 several elements are removed. Given a negative argument, the specified
11946 element of the stack is deleted. Given an argument of zero, the entire
11947 stack is emptied.
11948 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11949 @key{DEL} leaves @samp{10 20},
11950 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10},
11951 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10 30}, and
11952 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{DEL}} leaves an empty stack.
11953
11954 @kindex M-@key{DEL}
11955 @pindex calc-pop-above
11956 The @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} (@code{calc-pop-above}) command is to @key{DEL} what
11957 @key{LFD} is to @key{RET}: It interprets the sign of the numeric
11958 prefix argument in the opposite way, and the default argument is 2.
11959 Thus @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} by itself removes the second-from-top stack element,
11960 leaving the first, third, fourth, and so on; @kbd{M-3 M-@key{DEL}} deletes
11961 the third stack element.
11962
11963 @kindex @key{TAB}
11964 @pindex calc-roll-down
11965 To exchange the top two elements of the stack, press @key{TAB}
11966 (@code{calc-roll-down}). Given a positive numeric prefix argument, the
11967 specified number of elements at the top of the stack are rotated downward.
11968 Given a negative argument, the entire stack is rotated downward the specified
11969 number of times. Given an argument of zero, the entire stack is reversed
11970 top-for-bottom.
11971 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11972 @key{TAB} creates @samp{10 20 30 50 40},
11973 @kbd{C-u 3 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 50 30 40},
11974 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{40 50 10 20 30}, and
11975 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11976
11977 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
11978 @pindex calc-roll-up
11979 The command @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{calc-roll-up}) is analogous to @key{TAB}
11980 except that it rotates upward instead of downward. Also, the default
11981 with no prefix argument is to rotate the top 3 elements.
11982 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11983 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 40 50 30},
11984 @kbd{C-u 4 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 30 40 50 20},
11985 @kbd{C-u - 2 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{30 40 50 10 20}, and
11986 @kbd{C-u 0 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11987
11988 A good way to view the operation of @key{TAB} and @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} is in
11989 terms of moving a particular element to a new position in the stack.
11990 With a positive argument @var{n}, @key{TAB} moves the top stack
11991 element down to level @var{n}, making room for it by pulling all the
11992 intervening stack elements toward the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} moves the
11993 element at level @var{n} up to the top. (Compare with @key{LFD},
11994 which copies instead of moving the element in level @var{n}.)
11995
11996 With a negative argument @mathit{-@var{n}}, @key{TAB} rotates the stack
11997 to move the object in level @var{n} to the deepest place in the
11998 stack, and the object in level @mathit{@var{n}+1} to the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}
11999 rotates the deepest stack element to be in level @mathit{n}, also
12000 putting the top stack element in level @mathit{@var{n}+1}.
12001
12002 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for a way to apply these commands to
12003 any portion of a vector or formula on the stack.
12004
12005 @node Editing Stack Entries, Trail Commands, Stack Manipulation, Stack and Trail
12006 @section Editing Stack Entries
12007
12008 @noindent
12009 @kindex `
12010 @pindex calc-edit
12011 @pindex calc-edit-finish
12012 @cindex Editing the stack with Emacs
12013 The backquote, @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command creates a temporary
12014 buffer (@samp{*Calc Edit*}) for editing the top-of-stack value using
12015 regular Emacs commands. With a numeric prefix argument, it edits the
12016 specified number of stack entries at once. (An argument of zero edits
12017 the entire stack; a negative argument edits one specific stack entry.)
12018
12019 When you are done editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish and return
12020 to Calc. The @key{RET} and @key{LFD} keys also work to finish most
12021 sorts of editing, though in some cases Calc leaves @key{RET} with its
12022 usual meaning (``insert a newline'') if it's a situation where you
12023 might want to insert new lines into the editing buffer.
12024
12025 When you finish editing, the Calculator parses the lines of text in
12026 the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer as numbers or formulas, replaces the
12027 original stack elements in the original buffer with these new values,
12028 then kills the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. The original Calculator buffer
12029 continues to exist during editing, but for best results you should be
12030 careful not to change it until you have finished the edit. You can
12031 also cancel the edit by killing the buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
12032
12033 The formula is normally reevaluated as it is put onto the stack.
12034 For example, editing @samp{a + 2} to @samp{3 + 2} and pressing
12035 @kbd{C-c C-c} will push 5 on the stack. If you use @key{LFD} to
12036 finish, Calc will put the result on the stack without evaluating it.
12037
12038 If you give a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c},
12039 Calc will not kill the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. You can switch
12040 back to that buffer and continue editing if you wish. However, you
12041 should understand that if you initiated the edit with @kbd{`}, the
12042 @kbd{C-c C-c} operation will be programmed to replace the top of the
12043 stack with the new edited value, and it will do this even if you have
12044 rearranged the stack in the meanwhile. This is not so much of a problem
12045 with other editing commands, though, such as @kbd{s e}
12046 (@code{calc-edit-variable}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}).
12047
12048 If the @code{calc-edit} command involves more than one stack entry,
12049 each line of the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer is interpreted as a
12050 separate formula. Otherwise, the entire buffer is interpreted as
12051 one formula, with line breaks ignored. (You can use @kbd{C-o} or
12052 @kbd{C-q C-j} to insert a newline in the buffer without pressing @key{RET}.)
12053
12054 The @kbd{`} key also works during numeric or algebraic entry. The
12055 text entered so far is moved to the @code{*Calc Edit*} buffer for
12056 more extensive editing than is convenient in the minibuffer.
12057
12058 @node Trail Commands, Keep Arguments, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail
12059 @section Trail Commands
12060
12061 @noindent
12062 @cindex Trail buffer
12063 The commands for manipulating the Calc Trail buffer are two-key sequences
12064 beginning with the @kbd{t} prefix.
12065
12066 @kindex t d
12067 @pindex calc-trail-display
12068 The @kbd{t d} (@code{calc-trail-display}) command turns display of the
12069 trail on and off. Normally the trail display is toggled on if it was off,
12070 off if it was on. With a numeric prefix of zero, this command always
12071 turns the trail off; with a prefix of one, it always turns the trail on.
12072 The other trail-manipulation commands described here automatically turn
12073 the trail on. Note that when the trail is off values are still recorded
12074 there; they are simply not displayed. To set Emacs to turn the trail
12075 off by default, type @kbd{t d} and then save the mode settings with
12076 @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}).
12077
12078 @kindex t i
12079 @pindex calc-trail-in
12080 @kindex t o
12081 @pindex calc-trail-out
12082 The @kbd{t i} (@code{calc-trail-in}) and @kbd{t o}
12083 (@code{calc-trail-out}) commands switch the cursor into and out of the
12084 Calc Trail window. In practice they are rarely used, since the commands
12085 shown below are a more convenient way to move around in the
12086 trail, and they work ``by remote control'' when the cursor is still
12087 in the Calculator window.
12088
12089 @cindex Trail pointer
12090 There is a @dfn{trail pointer} which selects some entry of the trail at
12091 any given time. The trail pointer looks like a @samp{>} symbol right
12092 before the selected number. The following commands operate on the
12093 trail pointer in various ways.
12094
12095 @kindex t y
12096 @pindex calc-trail-yank
12097 @cindex Retrieving previous results
12098 The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command reads the selected value in
12099 the trail and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. It allows you to
12100 re-use any previously computed value without retyping. With a numeric
12101 prefix argument @var{n}, it yanks the value @var{n} lines above the current
12102 trail pointer.
12103
12104 @kindex t <
12105 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-left
12106 @kindex t >
12107 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-right
12108 The @kbd{t <} (@code{calc-trail-scroll-left}) and @kbd{t >}
12109 (@code{calc-trail-scroll-right}) commands horizontally scroll the trail
12110 window left or right by one half of its width.
12111
12112 @kindex t n
12113 @pindex calc-trail-next
12114 @kindex t p
12115 @pindex calc-trail-previous
12116 @kindex t f
12117 @pindex calc-trail-forward
12118 @kindex t b
12119 @pindex calc-trail-backward
12120 The @kbd{t n} (@code{calc-trail-next}) and @kbd{t p}
12121 (@code{calc-trail-previous)} commands move the trail pointer down or up
12122 one line. The @kbd{t f} (@code{calc-trail-forward}) and @kbd{t b}
12123 (@code{calc-trail-backward}) commands move the trail pointer down or up
12124 one screenful at a time. All of these commands accept numeric prefix
12125 arguments to move several lines or screenfuls at a time.
12126
12127 @kindex t [
12128 @pindex calc-trail-first
12129 @kindex t ]
12130 @pindex calc-trail-last
12131 @kindex t h
12132 @pindex calc-trail-here
12133 The @kbd{t [} (@code{calc-trail-first}) and @kbd{t ]}
12134 (@code{calc-trail-last}) commands move the trail pointer to the first or
12135 last line of the trail. The @kbd{t h} (@code{calc-trail-here}) command
12136 moves the trail pointer to the cursor position; unlike the other trail
12137 commands, @kbd{t h} works only when Calc Trail is the selected window.
12138
12139 @kindex t s
12140 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-forward
12141 @kindex t r
12142 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-backward
12143 @ifinfo
12144 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12145 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) commands perform an incremental
12146 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12147 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12148 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12149 it was when the search began.
12150 @end ifinfo
12151 @tex
12152 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12153 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) com\-mands perform an incremental
12154 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12155 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12156 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12157 it was when the search began.
12158 @end tex
12159
12160 @kindex t m
12161 @pindex calc-trail-marker
12162 The @kbd{t m} (@code{calc-trail-marker}) command allows you to enter a
12163 line of text of your own choosing into the trail. The text is inserted
12164 after the line containing the trail pointer; this usually means it is
12165 added to the end of the trail. Trail markers are useful mainly as the
12166 targets for later incremental searches in the trail.
12167
12168 @kindex t k
12169 @pindex calc-trail-kill
12170 The @kbd{t k} (@code{calc-trail-kill}) command removes the selected line
12171 from the trail. The line is saved in the Emacs kill ring suitable for
12172 yanking into another buffer, but it is not easy to yank the text back
12173 into the trail buffer. With a numeric prefix argument, this command
12174 kills the @var{n} lines below or above the selected one.
12175
12176 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command is described
12177 elsewhere; @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
12178
12179 @node Keep Arguments, , Trail Commands, Stack and Trail
12180 @section Keep Arguments
12181
12182 @noindent
12183 @kindex K
12184 @pindex calc-keep-args
12185 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command acts like a prefix for
12186 the following command. It prevents that command from removing its
12187 arguments from the stack. For example, after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +},
12188 the stack contains the sole number 5, but after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K +},
12189 the stack contains the arguments and the result: @samp{2 3 5}.
12190
12191 With the exception of keyboard macros, this works for all commands that
12192 take arguments off the stack. (To avoid potentially unpleasant behavior,
12193 a @kbd{K} prefix before a keyboard macro will be ignored. A @kbd{K}
12194 prefix called @emph{within} the keyboard macro will still take effect.)
12195 As another example, @kbd{K a s} simplifies a formula, pushing the
12196 simplified version of the formula onto the stack after the original
12197 formula (rather than replacing the original formula). Note that you
12198 could get the same effect by typing @kbd{@key{RET} a s}, copying the
12199 formula and then simplifying the copy. One difference is that for a very
12200 large formula the time taken to format the intermediate copy in
12201 @kbd{@key{RET} a s} could be noticeable; @kbd{K a s} would avoid this
12202 extra work.
12203
12204 Even stack manipulation commands are affected. @key{TAB} works by
12205 popping two values and pushing them back in the opposite order,
12206 so @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K @key{TAB}} produces @samp{2 3 3 2}.
12207
12208 A few Calc commands provide other ways of doing the same thing.
12209 For example, @kbd{' sin($)} replaces the number on the stack with
12210 its sine using algebraic entry; to push the sine and keep the
12211 original argument you could use either @kbd{' sin($1)} or
12212 @kbd{K ' sin($)}. @xref{Algebraic Entry}. Also, the @kbd{s s}
12213 command is effectively the same as @kbd{K s t}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
12214
12215 If you execute a command and then decide you really wanted to keep
12216 the argument, you can press @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
12217 This command pushes the last arguments that were popped by any command
12218 onto the stack. Note that the order of things on the stack will be
12219 different than with @kbd{K}: @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + M-@key{RET}} leaves
12220 @samp{5 2 3} on the stack instead of @samp{2 3 5}. @xref{Undo}.
12221
12222 @node Mode Settings, Arithmetic, Stack and Trail, Top
12223 @chapter Mode Settings
12224
12225 @noindent
12226 This chapter describes commands that set modes in the Calculator.
12227 They do not affect the contents of the stack, although they may change
12228 the @emph{appearance} or @emph{interpretation} of the stack's contents.
12229
12230 @menu
12231 * General Mode Commands::
12232 * Precision::
12233 * Inverse and Hyperbolic::
12234 * Calculation Modes::
12235 * Simplification Modes::
12236 * Declarations::
12237 * Display Modes::
12238 * Language Modes::
12239 * Modes Variable::
12240 * Calc Mode Line::
12241 @end menu
12242
12243 @node General Mode Commands, Precision, Mode Settings, Mode Settings
12244 @section General Mode Commands
12245
12246 @noindent
12247 @kindex m m
12248 @pindex calc-save-modes
12249 @cindex Continuous memory
12250 @cindex Saving mode settings
12251 @cindex Permanent mode settings
12252 @cindex Calc init file, mode settings
12253 You can save all of the current mode settings in your Calc init file
12254 (the file given by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
12255 @file{~/.calc.el}) with the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command.
12256 This will cause Emacs to reestablish these modes each time it starts up.
12257 The modes saved in the file include everything controlled by the @kbd{m}
12258 and @kbd{d} prefix keys, the current precision and binary word size,
12259 whether or not the trail is displayed, the current height of the Calc
12260 window, and more. The current interface (used when you type @kbd{M-#
12261 M-#}) is also saved. If there were already saved mode settings in the
12262 file, they are replaced. Otherwise, the new mode information is
12263 appended to the end of the file.
12264
12265 @kindex m R
12266 @pindex calc-mode-record-mode
12267 The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command tells Calc to
12268 record the new mode settings (as if by pressing @kbd{m m}) every
12269 time a mode setting changes. If Embedded mode is enabled, other
12270 options are available; @pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.
12271
12272 @kindex m F
12273 @pindex calc-settings-file-name
12274 The @kbd{m F} (@code{calc-settings-file-name}) command allows you to
12275 choose a different file than the current value of @code{calc-settings-file}
12276 for @kbd{m m}, @kbd{Z P}, and similar commands to save permanent information.
12277 You are prompted for a file name. All Calc modes are then reset to
12278 their default values, then settings from the file you named are loaded
12279 if this file exists, and this file becomes the one that Calc will
12280 use in the future for commands like @kbd{m m}. The default settings
12281 file name is @file{~/.calc.el}. You can see the current file name by
12282 giving a blank response to the @kbd{m F} prompt. See also the
12283 discussion of the @code{calc-settings-file} variable; @pxref{Installation}.
12284
12285 If the file name you give is your user init file (typically
12286 @file{~/.emacs}), @kbd{m F} will not automatically load the new file. This
12287 is because your user init file may contain other things you don't want
12288 to reread. You can give
12289 a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{m F} to force it to read the
12290 file no matter what. Conversely, an argument of @mathit{-1} tells
12291 @kbd{m F} @emph{not} to read the new file. An argument of 2 or @mathit{-2}
12292 tells @kbd{m F} not to reset the modes to their defaults beforehand,
12293 which is useful if you intend your new file to have a variant of the
12294 modes present in the file you were using before.
12295
12296 @kindex m x
12297 @pindex calc-always-load-extensions
12298 The @kbd{m x} (@code{calc-always-load-extensions}) command enables a mode
12299 in which the first use of Calc loads the entire program, including all
12300 extensions modules. Otherwise, the extensions modules will not be loaded
12301 until the various advanced Calc features are used. Since this mode only
12302 has effect when Calc is first loaded, @kbd{m x} is usually followed by
12303 @kbd{m m} to make the mode-setting permanent. To load all of Calc just
12304 once, rather than always in the future, you can press @kbd{M-# L}.
12305
12306 @kindex m S
12307 @pindex calc-shift-prefix
12308 The @kbd{m S} (@code{calc-shift-prefix}) command enables a mode in which
12309 all of Calc's letter prefix keys may be typed shifted as well as unshifted.
12310 If you are typing, say, @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) quite often
12311 you might find it easier to turn this mode on so that you can type
12312 @kbd{A S} instead. When this mode is enabled, the commands that used to
12313 be on those single shifted letters (e.g., @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs})) can
12314 now be invoked by pressing the shifted letter twice: @kbd{A A}. Note
12315 that the @kbd{v} prefix key always works both shifted and unshifted, and
12316 the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z} prefix keys are always distinct. Also, the @kbd{h}
12317 prefix is not affected by this mode. Press @kbd{m S} again to disable
12318 shifted-prefix mode.
12319
12320 @node Precision, Inverse and Hyperbolic, General Mode Commands, Mode Settings
12321 @section Precision
12322
12323 @noindent
12324 @kindex p
12325 @pindex calc-precision
12326 @cindex Precision of calculations
12327 The @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision}) command controls the precision to
12328 which floating-point calculations are carried. The precision must be
12329 at least 3 digits and may be arbitrarily high, within the limits of
12330 memory and time. This affects only floats: Integer and rational
12331 calculations are always carried out with as many digits as necessary.
12332
12333 The @kbd{p} key prompts for the current precision. If you wish you
12334 can instead give the precision as a numeric prefix argument.
12335
12336 Many internal calculations are carried to one or two digits higher
12337 precision than normal. Results are rounded down afterward to the
12338 current precision. Unless a special display mode has been selected,
12339 floats are always displayed with their full stored precision, i.e.,
12340 what you see is what you get. Reducing the current precision does not
12341 round values already on the stack, but those values will be rounded
12342 down before being used in any calculation. The @kbd{c 0} through
12343 @kbd{c 9} commands (@pxref{Conversions}) can be used to round an
12344 existing value to a new precision.
12345
12346 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
12347 It is important to distinguish the concepts of @dfn{precision} and
12348 @dfn{accuracy}. In the normal usage of these words, the number
12349 123.4567 has a precision of 7 digits but an accuracy of 4 digits.
12350 The precision is the total number of digits not counting leading
12351 or trailing zeros (regardless of the position of the decimal point).
12352 The accuracy is simply the number of digits after the decimal point
12353 (again not counting trailing zeros). In Calc you control the precision,
12354 not the accuracy of computations. If you were to set the accuracy
12355 instead, then calculations like @samp{exp(100)} would generate many
12356 more digits than you would typically need, while @samp{exp(-100)} would
12357 probably round to zero! In Calc, both these computations give you
12358 exactly 12 (or the requested number of) significant digits.
12359
12360 The only Calc features that deal with accuracy instead of precision
12361 are fixed-point display mode for floats (@kbd{d f}; @pxref{Float Formats}),
12362 and the rounding functions like @code{floor} and @code{round}
12363 (@pxref{Integer Truncation}). Also, @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}
12364 deal with both precision and accuracy depending on the magnitudes
12365 of the numbers involved.
12366
12367 If you need to work with a particular fixed accuracy (say, dollars and
12368 cents with two digits after the decimal point), one solution is to work
12369 with integers and an ``implied'' decimal point. For example, $8.99
12370 divided by 6 would be entered @kbd{899 @key{RET} 6 /}, yielding 149.833
12371 (actually $1.49833 with our implied decimal point); pressing @kbd{R}
12372 would round this to 150 cents, i.e., $1.50.
12373
12374 @xref{Floats}, for still more on floating-point precision and related
12375 issues.
12376
12377 @node Inverse and Hyperbolic, Calculation Modes, Precision, Mode Settings
12378 @section Inverse and Hyperbolic Flags
12379
12380 @noindent
12381 @kindex I
12382 @pindex calc-inverse
12383 There is no single-key equivalent to the @code{calc-arcsin} function.
12384 Instead, you must first press @kbd{I} (@code{calc-inverse}) to set
12385 the @dfn{Inverse Flag}, then press @kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}).
12386 The @kbd{I} key actually toggles the Inverse Flag. When this flag
12387 is set, the word @samp{Inv} appears in the mode line.
12388
12389 @kindex H
12390 @pindex calc-hyperbolic
12391 Likewise, the @kbd{H} key (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) sets or clears the
12392 Hyperbolic Flag, which transforms @code{calc-sin} into @code{calc-sinh}.
12393 If both of these flags are set at once, the effect will be
12394 @code{calc-arcsinh}. (The Hyperbolic flag is also used by some
12395 non-trigonometric commands; for example @kbd{H L} computes a base-10,
12396 instead of base-@mathit{e}, logarithm.)
12397
12398 Command names like @code{calc-arcsin} are provided for completeness, and
12399 may be executed with @kbd{x} or @kbd{M-x}. Their effect is simply to
12400 toggle the Inverse and/or Hyperbolic flags and then execute the
12401 corresponding base command (@code{calc-sin} in this case).
12402
12403 The Inverse and Hyperbolic flags apply only to the next Calculator
12404 command, after which they are automatically cleared. (They are also
12405 cleared if the next keystroke is not a Calc command.) Digits you
12406 type after @kbd{I} or @kbd{H} (or @kbd{K}) are treated as prefix
12407 arguments for the next command, not as numeric entries. The same
12408 is true of @kbd{C-u}, but not of the minus sign (@kbd{K -} means to
12409 subtract and keep arguments).
12410
12411 The third Calc prefix flag, @kbd{K} (keep-arguments), is discussed
12412 elsewhere. @xref{Keep Arguments}.
12413
12414 @node Calculation Modes, Simplification Modes, Inverse and Hyperbolic, Mode Settings
12415 @section Calculation Modes
12416
12417 @noindent
12418 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with
12419 the @kbd{m} prefix. (That's the letter @kbd{m}, not the @key{META} key.)
12420 The @samp{m a} (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) command is described elsewhere
12421 (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
12422
12423 @menu
12424 * Angular Modes::
12425 * Polar Mode::
12426 * Fraction Mode::
12427 * Infinite Mode::
12428 * Symbolic Mode::
12429 * Matrix Mode::
12430 * Automatic Recomputation::
12431 * Working Message::
12432 @end menu
12433
12434 @node Angular Modes, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes, Calculation Modes
12435 @subsection Angular Modes
12436
12437 @noindent
12438 @cindex Angular mode
12439 The Calculator supports three notations for angles: radians, degrees,
12440 and degrees-minutes-seconds. When a number is presented to a function
12441 like @code{sin} that requires an angle, the current angular mode is
12442 used to interpret the number as either radians or degrees. If an HMS
12443 form is presented to @code{sin}, it is always interpreted as
12444 degrees-minutes-seconds.
12445
12446 Functions that compute angles produce a number in radians, a number in
12447 degrees, or an HMS form depending on the current angular mode. If the
12448 result is a complex number and the current mode is HMS, the number is
12449 instead expressed in degrees. (Complex-number calculations would
12450 normally be done in Radians mode, though. Complex numbers are converted
12451 to degrees by calculating the complex result in radians and then
12452 multiplying by 180 over @cpi{}.)
12453
12454 @kindex m r
12455 @pindex calc-radians-mode
12456 @kindex m d
12457 @pindex calc-degrees-mode
12458 @kindex m h
12459 @pindex calc-hms-mode
12460 The @kbd{m r} (@code{calc-radians-mode}), @kbd{m d} (@code{calc-degrees-mode}),
12461 and @kbd{m h} (@code{calc-hms-mode}) commands control the angular mode.
12462 The current angular mode is displayed on the Emacs mode line.
12463 The default angular mode is Degrees.
12464
12465 @node Polar Mode, Fraction Mode, Angular Modes, Calculation Modes
12466 @subsection Polar Mode
12467
12468 @noindent
12469 @cindex Polar mode
12470 The Calculator normally ``prefers'' rectangular complex numbers in the
12471 sense that rectangular form is used when the proper form can not be
12472 decided from the input. This might happen by multiplying a rectangular
12473 number by a polar one, by taking the square root of a negative real
12474 number, or by entering @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )}.
12475
12476 @kindex m p
12477 @pindex calc-polar-mode
12478 The @kbd{m p} (@code{calc-polar-mode}) command toggles complex-number
12479 preference between rectangular and polar forms. In Polar mode, all
12480 of the above example situations would produce polar complex numbers.
12481
12482 @node Fraction Mode, Infinite Mode, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes
12483 @subsection Fraction Mode
12484
12485 @noindent
12486 @cindex Fraction mode
12487 @cindex Division of integers
12488 Division of two integers normally yields a floating-point number if the
12489 result cannot be expressed as an integer. In some cases you would
12490 rather get an exact fractional answer. One way to accomplish this is
12491 to multiply fractions instead: @kbd{6 @key{RET} 1:4 *} produces @expr{3:2}
12492 even though @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 /} produces @expr{1.5}.
12493
12494 @kindex m f
12495 @pindex calc-frac-mode
12496 To set the Calculator to produce fractional results for normal integer
12497 divisions, use the @kbd{m f} (@code{calc-frac-mode}) command.
12498 For example, @expr{8/4} produces @expr{2} in either mode,
12499 but @expr{6/4} produces @expr{3:2} in Fraction mode, @expr{1.5} in
12500 Float mode.
12501
12502 At any time you can use @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) to convert a
12503 fraction to a float, or @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) to convert a
12504 float to a fraction. @xref{Conversions}.
12505
12506 @node Infinite Mode, Symbolic Mode, Fraction Mode, Calculation Modes
12507 @subsection Infinite Mode
12508
12509 @noindent
12510 @cindex Infinite mode
12511 The Calculator normally treats results like @expr{1 / 0} as errors;
12512 formulas like this are left in unsimplified form. But Calc can be
12513 put into a mode where such calculations instead produce ``infinite''
12514 results.
12515
12516 @kindex m i
12517 @pindex calc-infinite-mode
12518 The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode}) command turns this mode
12519 on and off. When the mode is off, infinities do not arise except
12520 in calculations that already had infinities as inputs. (One exception
12521 is that infinite open intervals like @samp{[0 .. inf)} can be
12522 generated; however, intervals closed at infinity (@samp{[0 .. inf]})
12523 will not be generated when Infinite mode is off.)
12524
12525 With Infinite mode turned on, @samp{1 / 0} will generate @code{uinf},
12526 an undirected infinity. @xref{Infinities}, for a discussion of the
12527 difference between @code{inf} and @code{uinf}. Also, @expr{0 / 0}
12528 evaluates to @code{nan}, the ``indeterminate'' symbol. Various other
12529 functions can also return infinities in this mode; for example,
12530 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}, and @samp{gamma(-7) = uinf}. Once again,
12531 note that @samp{exp(inf) = inf} regardless of Infinite mode because
12532 this calculation has infinity as an input.
12533
12534 @cindex Positive Infinite mode
12535 The @kbd{m i} command with a numeric prefix argument of zero,
12536 i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 m i}, turns on a Positive Infinite mode in
12537 which zero is treated as positive instead of being directionless.
12538 Thus, @samp{1 / 0 = inf} and @samp{-1 / 0 = -inf} in this mode.
12539 Note that zero never actually has a sign in Calc; there are no
12540 separate representations for @mathit{+0} and @mathit{-0}. Positive
12541 Infinite mode merely changes the interpretation given to the
12542 single symbol, @samp{0}. One consequence of this is that, while
12543 you might expect @samp{1 / -0 = -inf}, actually @samp{1 / -0}
12544 is equivalent to @samp{1 / 0}, which is equal to positive @code{inf}.
12545
12546 @node Symbolic Mode, Matrix Mode, Infinite Mode, Calculation Modes
12547 @subsection Symbolic Mode
12548
12549 @noindent
12550 @cindex Symbolic mode
12551 @cindex Inexact results
12552 Calculations are normally performed numerically wherever possible.
12553 For example, the @code{calc-sqrt} command, or @code{sqrt} function in an
12554 algebraic expression, produces a numeric answer if the argument is a
12555 number or a symbolic expression if the argument is an expression:
12556 @kbd{2 Q} pushes 1.4142 but @kbd{@key{'} x+1 @key{RET} Q} pushes @samp{sqrt(x+1)}.
12557
12558 @kindex m s
12559 @pindex calc-symbolic-mode
12560 In @dfn{Symbolic mode}, controlled by the @kbd{m s} (@code{calc-symbolic-mode})
12561 command, functions which would produce inexact, irrational results are
12562 left in symbolic form. Thus @kbd{16 Q} pushes 4, but @kbd{2 Q} pushes
12563 @samp{sqrt(2)}.
12564
12565 @kindex N
12566 @pindex calc-eval-num
12567 The shift-@kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) command evaluates numerically
12568 the expression at the top of the stack, by temporarily disabling
12569 @code{calc-symbolic-mode} and executing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
12570 Given a numeric prefix argument, it also
12571 sets the floating-point precision to the specified value for the duration
12572 of the command.
12573
12574 To evaluate a formula numerically without expanding the variables it
12575 contains, you can use the key sequence @kbd{m s a v m s} (this uses
12576 @code{calc-alg-evaluate}, which resimplifies but doesn't evaluate
12577 variables.)
12578
12579 @node Matrix Mode, Automatic Recomputation, Symbolic Mode, Calculation Modes
12580 @subsection Matrix and Scalar Modes
12581
12582 @noindent
12583 @cindex Matrix mode
12584 @cindex Scalar mode
12585 Calc sometimes makes assumptions during algebraic manipulation that
12586 are awkward or incorrect when vectors and matrices are involved.
12587 Calc has two modes, @dfn{Matrix mode} and @dfn{Scalar mode}, which
12588 modify its behavior around vectors in useful ways.
12589
12590 @kindex m v
12591 @pindex calc-matrix-mode
12592 Press @kbd{m v} (@code{calc-matrix-mode}) once to enter Matrix mode.
12593 In this mode, all objects are assumed to be matrices unless provably
12594 otherwise. One major effect is that Calc will no longer consider
12595 multiplication to be commutative. (Recall that in matrix arithmetic,
12596 @samp{A*B} is not the same as @samp{B*A}.) This assumption affects
12597 rewrite rules and algebraic simplification. Another effect of this
12598 mode is that calculations that would normally produce constants like
12599 0 and 1 (e.g., @expr{a - a} and @expr{a / a}, respectively) will now
12600 produce function calls that represent ``generic'' zero or identity
12601 matrices: @samp{idn(0)}, @samp{idn(1)}. The @code{idn} function
12602 @samp{idn(@var{a},@var{n})} returns @var{a} times an @var{n}x@var{n}
12603 identity matrix; if @var{n} is omitted, it doesn't know what
12604 dimension to use and so the @code{idn} call remains in symbolic
12605 form. However, if this generic identity matrix is later combined
12606 with a matrix whose size is known, it will be converted into
12607 a true identity matrix of the appropriate size. On the other hand,
12608 if it is combined with a scalar (as in @samp{idn(1) + 2}), Calc
12609 will assume it really was a scalar after all and produce, e.g., 3.
12610
12611 Press @kbd{m v} a second time to get Scalar mode. Here, objects are
12612 assumed @emph{not} to be vectors or matrices unless provably so.
12613 For example, normally adding a variable to a vector, as in
12614 @samp{[x, y, z] + a}, will leave the sum in symbolic form because
12615 as far as Calc knows, @samp{a} could represent either a number or
12616 another 3-vector. In Scalar mode, @samp{a} is assumed to be a
12617 non-vector, and the addition is evaluated to @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]}.
12618
12619 Press @kbd{m v} a third time to return to the normal mode of operation.
12620
12621 If you press @kbd{m v} with a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, you
12622 get a special ``dimensioned'' Matrix mode in which matrices of
12623 unknown size are assumed to be @var{n}x@var{n} square matrices.
12624 Then, the function call @samp{idn(1)} will expand into an actual
12625 matrix rather than representing a ``generic'' matrix.
12626
12627 @cindex Declaring scalar variables
12628 Of course these modes are approximations to the true state of
12629 affairs, which is probably that some quantities will be matrices
12630 and others will be scalars. One solution is to ``declare''
12631 certain variables or functions to be scalar-valued.
12632 @xref{Declarations}, to see how to make declarations in Calc.
12633
12634 There is nothing stopping you from declaring a variable to be
12635 scalar and then storing a matrix in it; however, if you do, the
12636 results you get from Calc may not be valid. Suppose you let Calc
12637 get the result @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]} shown above, and then stored
12638 @samp{[1, 2, 3]} in @samp{a}. The result would not be the same as
12639 for @samp{[x, y, z] + [1, 2, 3]}, but that's because you have broken
12640 your earlier promise to Calc that @samp{a} would be scalar.
12641
12642 Another way to mix scalars and matrices is to use selections
12643 (@pxref{Selecting Subformulas}). Use Matrix mode when operating on
12644 your formula normally; then, to apply Scalar mode to a certain part
12645 of the formula without affecting the rest just select that part,
12646 change into Scalar mode and press @kbd{=} to resimplify the part
12647 under this mode, then change back to Matrix mode before deselecting.
12648
12649 @node Automatic Recomputation, Working Message, Matrix Mode, Calculation Modes
12650 @subsection Automatic Recomputation
12651
12652 @noindent
12653 The @dfn{evaluates-to} operator, @samp{=>}, has the special
12654 property that any @samp{=>} formulas on the stack are recomputed
12655 whenever variable values or mode settings that might affect them
12656 are changed. @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}.
12657
12658 @kindex m C
12659 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
12660 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns this
12661 automatic recomputation on and off. If you turn it off, Calc will
12662 not update @samp{=>} operators on the stack (nor those in the
12663 attached Embedded mode buffer, if there is one). They will not
12664 be updated unless you explicitly do so by pressing @kbd{=} or until
12665 you press @kbd{m C} to turn recomputation back on. (While automatic
12666 recomputation is off, you can think of @kbd{m C m C} as a command
12667 to update all @samp{=>} operators while leaving recomputation off.)
12668
12669 To update @samp{=>} operators in an Embedded buffer while
12670 automatic recomputation is off, use @w{@kbd{M-# u}}.
12671 @xref{Embedded Mode}.
12672
12673 @node Working Message, , Automatic Recomputation, Calculation Modes
12674 @subsection Working Messages
12675
12676 @noindent
12677 @cindex Performance
12678 @cindex Working messages
12679 Since the Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, which is not
12680 designed for heavy numerical work, many operations are quite slow.
12681 The Calculator normally displays the message @samp{Working...} in the
12682 echo area during any command that may be slow. In addition, iterative
12683 operations such as square roots and trigonometric functions display the
12684 intermediate result at each step. Both of these types of messages can
12685 be disabled if you find them distracting.
12686
12687 @kindex m w
12688 @pindex calc-working
12689 Type @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) with a numeric prefix of 0 to
12690 disable all ``working'' messages. Use a numeric prefix of 1 to enable
12691 only the plain @samp{Working...} message. Use a numeric prefix of 2 to
12692 see intermediate results as well. With no numeric prefix this displays
12693 the current mode.
12694
12695 While it may seem that the ``working'' messages will slow Calc down
12696 considerably, experiments have shown that their impact is actually
12697 quite small. But if your terminal is slow you may find that it helps
12698 to turn the messages off.
12699
12700 @node Simplification Modes, Declarations, Calculation Modes, Mode Settings
12701 @section Simplification Modes
12702
12703 @noindent
12704 The current @dfn{simplification mode} controls how numbers and formulas
12705 are ``normalized'' when being taken from or pushed onto the stack.
12706 Some normalizations are unavoidable, such as rounding floating-point
12707 results to the current precision, and reducing fractions to simplest
12708 form. Others, such as simplifying a formula like @expr{a+a} (or @expr{2+3}),
12709 are done by default but can be turned off when necessary.
12710
12711 When you press a key like @kbd{+} when @expr{2} and @expr{3} are on the
12712 stack, Calc pops these numbers, normalizes them, creates the formula
12713 @expr{2+3}, normalizes it, and pushes the result. Of course the standard
12714 rules for normalizing @expr{2+3} will produce the result @expr{5}.
12715
12716 Simplification mode commands consist of the lower-case @kbd{m} prefix key
12717 followed by a shifted letter.
12718
12719 @kindex m O
12720 @pindex calc-no-simplify-mode
12721 The @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) command turns off all optional
12722 simplifications. These would leave a formula like @expr{2+3} alone. In
12723 fact, nothing except simple numbers are ever affected by normalization
12724 in this mode.
12725
12726 @kindex m N
12727 @pindex calc-num-simplify-mode
12728 The @kbd{m N} (@code{calc-num-simplify-mode}) command turns off simplification
12729 of any formulas except those for which all arguments are constants. For
12730 example, @expr{1+2} is simplified to @expr{3}, and @expr{a+(2-2)} is
12731 simplified to @expr{a+0} but no further, since one argument of the sum
12732 is not a constant. Unfortunately, @expr{(a+2)-2} is @emph{not} simplified
12733 because the top-level @samp{-} operator's arguments are not both
12734 constant numbers (one of them is the formula @expr{a+2}).
12735 A constant is a number or other numeric object (such as a constant
12736 error form or modulo form), or a vector all of whose
12737 elements are constant.
12738
12739 @kindex m D
12740 @pindex calc-default-simplify-mode
12741 The @kbd{m D} (@code{calc-default-simplify-mode}) command restores the
12742 default simplifications for all formulas. This includes many easy and
12743 fast algebraic simplifications such as @expr{a+0} to @expr{a}, and
12744 @expr{a + 2 a} to @expr{3 a}, as well as evaluating functions like
12745 @texline @t{deriv}@expr{(x^2,x)}
12746 @infoline @expr{@t{deriv}(x^2, x)}
12747 to @expr{2 x}.
12748
12749 @kindex m B
12750 @pindex calc-bin-simplify-mode
12751 The @kbd{m B} (@code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}) mode applies the default
12752 simplifications to a result and then, if the result is an integer,
12753 uses the @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip}) command to clip the integer according
12754 to the current binary word size. @xref{Binary Functions}. Real numbers
12755 are rounded to the nearest integer and then clipped; other kinds of
12756 results (after the default simplifications) are left alone.
12757
12758 @kindex m A
12759 @pindex calc-alg-simplify-mode
12760 The @kbd{m A} (@code{calc-alg-simplify-mode}) mode does algebraic
12761 simplification; it applies all the default simplifications, and also
12762 the more powerful (and slower) simplifications made by @kbd{a s}
12763 (@code{calc-simplify}). @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
12764
12765 @kindex m E
12766 @pindex calc-ext-simplify-mode
12767 The @kbd{m E} (@code{calc-ext-simplify-mode}) mode does ``extended''
12768 algebraic simplification, as by the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended})
12769 command. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
12770
12771 @kindex m U
12772 @pindex calc-units-simplify-mode
12773 The @kbd{m U} (@code{calc-units-simplify-mode}) mode does units
12774 simplification; it applies the command @kbd{u s}
12775 (@code{calc-simplify-units}), which in turn
12776 is a superset of @kbd{a s}. In this mode, variable names which
12777 are identifiable as unit names (like @samp{mm} for ``millimeters'')
12778 are simplified with their unit definitions in mind.
12779
12780 A common technique is to set the simplification mode down to the lowest
12781 amount of simplification you will allow to be applied automatically, then
12782 use manual commands like @kbd{a s} and @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) to
12783 perform higher types of simplifications on demand. @xref{Algebraic
12784 Definitions}, for another sample use of No-Simplification mode.
12785
12786 @node Declarations, Display Modes, Simplification Modes, Mode Settings
12787 @section Declarations
12788
12789 @noindent
12790 A @dfn{declaration} is a statement you make that promises you will
12791 use a certain variable or function in a restricted way. This may
12792 give Calc the freedom to do things that it couldn't do if it had to
12793 take the fully general situation into account.
12794
12795 @menu
12796 * Declaration Basics::
12797 * Kinds of Declarations::
12798 * Functions for Declarations::
12799 @end menu
12800
12801 @node Declaration Basics, Kinds of Declarations, Declarations, Declarations
12802 @subsection Declaration Basics
12803
12804 @noindent
12805 @kindex s d
12806 @pindex calc-declare-variable
12807 The @kbd{s d} (@code{calc-declare-variable}) command is the easiest
12808 way to make a declaration for a variable. This command prompts for
12809 the variable name, then prompts for the declaration. The default
12810 at the declaration prompt is the previous declaration, if any.
12811 You can edit this declaration, or press @kbd{C-k} to erase it and
12812 type a new declaration. (Or, erase it and press @key{RET} to clear
12813 the declaration, effectively ``undeclaring'' the variable.)
12814
12815 A declaration is in general a vector of @dfn{type symbols} and
12816 @dfn{range} values. If there is only one type symbol or range value,
12817 you can write it directly rather than enclosing it in a vector.
12818 For example, @kbd{s d foo @key{RET} real @key{RET}} declares @code{foo} to
12819 be a real number, and @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} [int, const, [1..6]] @key{RET}}
12820 declares @code{bar} to be a constant integer between 1 and 6.
12821 (Actually, you can omit the outermost brackets and Calc will
12822 provide them for you: @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} int, const, [1..6] @key{RET}}.)
12823
12824 @cindex @code{Decls} variable
12825 @vindex Decls
12826 Declarations in Calc are kept in a special variable called @code{Decls}.
12827 This variable encodes the set of all outstanding declarations in
12828 the form of a matrix. Each row has two elements: A variable or
12829 vector of variables declared by that row, and the declaration
12830 specifier as described above. You can use the @kbd{s D} command to
12831 edit this variable if you wish to see all the declarations at once.
12832 @xref{Operations on Variables}, for a description of this command
12833 and the @kbd{s p} command that allows you to save your declarations
12834 permanently if you wish.
12835
12836 Items being declared can also be function calls. The arguments in
12837 the call are ignored; the effect is to say that this function returns
12838 values of the declared type for any valid arguments. The @kbd{s d}
12839 command declares only variables, so if you wish to make a function
12840 declaration you will have to edit the @code{Decls} matrix yourself.
12841
12842 For example, the declaration matrix
12843
12844 @smallexample
12845 @group
12846 [ [ foo, real ]
12847 [ [j, k, n], int ]
12848 [ f(1,2,3), [0 .. inf) ] ]
12849 @end group
12850 @end smallexample
12851
12852 @noindent
12853 declares that @code{foo} represents a real number, @code{j}, @code{k}
12854 and @code{n} represent integers, and the function @code{f} always
12855 returns a real number in the interval shown.
12856
12857 @vindex All
12858 If there is a declaration for the variable @code{All}, then that
12859 declaration applies to all variables that are not otherwise declared.
12860 It does not apply to function names. For example, using the row
12861 @samp{[All, real]} says that all your variables are real unless they
12862 are explicitly declared without @code{real} in some other row.
12863 The @kbd{s d} command declares @code{All} if you give a blank
12864 response to the variable-name prompt.
12865
12866 @node Kinds of Declarations, Functions for Declarations, Declaration Basics, Declarations
12867 @subsection Kinds of Declarations
12868
12869 @noindent
12870 The type-specifier part of a declaration (that is, the second prompt
12871 in the @kbd{s d} command) can be a type symbol, an interval, or a
12872 vector consisting of zero or more type symbols followed by zero or
12873 more intervals or numbers that represent the set of possible values
12874 for the variable.
12875
12876 @smallexample
12877 @group
12878 [ [ a, [1, 2, 3, 4, 5] ]
12879 [ b, [1 .. 5] ]
12880 [ c, [int, 1 .. 5] ] ]
12881 @end group
12882 @end smallexample
12883
12884 Here @code{a} is declared to contain one of the five integers shown;
12885 @code{b} is any number in the interval from 1 to 5 (any real number
12886 since we haven't specified), and @code{c} is any integer in that
12887 interval. Thus the declarations for @code{a} and @code{c} are
12888 nearly equivalent (see below).
12889
12890 The type-specifier can be the empty vector @samp{[]} to say that
12891 nothing is known about a given variable's value. This is the same
12892 as not declaring the variable at all except that it overrides any
12893 @code{All} declaration which would otherwise apply.
12894
12895 The initial value of @code{Decls} is the empty vector @samp{[]}.
12896 If @code{Decls} has no stored value or if the value stored in it
12897 is not valid, it is ignored and there are no declarations as far
12898 as Calc is concerned. (The @kbd{s d} command will replace such a
12899 malformed value with a fresh empty matrix, @samp{[]}, before recording
12900 the new declaration.) Unrecognized type symbols are ignored.
12901
12902 The following type symbols describe what sorts of numbers will be
12903 stored in a variable:
12904
12905 @table @code
12906 @item int
12907 Integers.
12908 @item numint
12909 Numerical integers. (Integers or integer-valued floats.)
12910 @item frac
12911 Fractions. (Rational numbers which are not integers.)
12912 @item rat
12913 Rational numbers. (Either integers or fractions.)
12914 @item float
12915 Floating-point numbers.
12916 @item real
12917 Real numbers. (Integers, fractions, or floats. Actually,
12918 intervals and error forms with real components also count as
12919 reals here.)
12920 @item pos
12921 Positive real numbers. (Strictly greater than zero.)
12922 @item nonneg
12923 Nonnegative real numbers. (Greater than or equal to zero.)
12924 @item number
12925 Numbers. (Real or complex.)
12926 @end table
12927
12928 Calc uses this information to determine when certain simplifications
12929 of formulas are safe. For example, @samp{(x^y)^z} cannot be
12930 simplified to @samp{x^(y z)} in general; for example,
12931 @samp{((-3)^2)^1:2} is 3, but @samp{(-3)^(2*1:2) = (-3)^1} is @mathit{-3}.
12932 However, this simplification @emph{is} safe if @code{z} is known
12933 to be an integer, or if @code{x} is known to be a nonnegative
12934 real number. If you have given declarations that allow Calc to
12935 deduce either of these facts, Calc will perform this simplification
12936 of the formula.
12937
12938 Calc can apply a certain amount of logic when using declarations.
12939 For example, @samp{(x^y)^(2n+1)} will be simplified if @code{n}
12940 has been declared @code{int}; Calc knows that an integer times an
12941 integer, plus an integer, must always be an integer. (In fact,
12942 Calc would simplify @samp{(-x)^(2n+1)} to @samp{-(x^(2n+1))} since
12943 it is able to determine that @samp{2n+1} must be an odd integer.)
12944
12945 Similarly, @samp{(abs(x)^y)^z} will be simplified to @samp{abs(x)^(y z)}
12946 because Calc knows that the @code{abs} function always returns a
12947 nonnegative real. If you had a @code{myabs} function that also had
12948 this property, you could get Calc to recognize it by adding the row
12949 @samp{[myabs(), nonneg]} to the @code{Decls} matrix.
12950
12951 One instance of this simplification is @samp{sqrt(x^2)} (since the
12952 @code{sqrt} function is effectively a one-half power). Normally
12953 Calc leaves this formula alone. After the command
12954 @kbd{s d x @key{RET} real @key{RET}}, however, it can simplify the formula to
12955 @samp{abs(x)}. And after @kbd{s d x @key{RET} nonneg @key{RET}}, Calc can
12956 simplify this formula all the way to @samp{x}.
12957
12958 If there are any intervals or real numbers in the type specifier,
12959 they comprise the set of possible values that the variable or
12960 function being declared can have. In particular, the type symbol
12961 @code{real} is effectively the same as the range @samp{[-inf .. inf]}
12962 (note that infinity is included in the range of possible values);
12963 @code{pos} is the same as @samp{(0 .. inf]}, and @code{nonneg} is
12964 the same as @samp{[0 .. inf]}. Saying @samp{[real, [-5 .. 5]]} is
12965 redundant because the fact that the variable is real can be
12966 deduced just from the interval, but @samp{[int, [-5 .. 5]]} and
12967 @samp{[rat, [-5 .. 5]]} are useful combinations.
12968
12969 Note that the vector of intervals or numbers is in the same format
12970 used by Calc's set-manipulation commands. @xref{Set Operations}.
12971
12972 The type specifier @samp{[1, 2, 3]} is equivalent to
12973 @samp{[numint, 1, 2, 3]}, @emph{not} to @samp{[int, 1, 2, 3]}.
12974 In other words, the range of possible values means only that
12975 the variable's value must be numerically equal to a number in
12976 that range, but not that it must be equal in type as well.
12977 Calc's set operations act the same way; @samp{in(2, [1., 2., 3.])}
12978 and @samp{in(1.5, [1:2, 3:2, 5:2])} both report ``true.''
12979
12980 If you use a conflicting combination of type specifiers, the
12981 results are unpredictable. An example is @samp{[pos, [0 .. 5]]},
12982 where the interval does not lie in the range described by the
12983 type symbol.
12984
12985 ``Real'' declarations mostly affect simplifications involving powers
12986 like the one described above. Another case where they are used
12987 is in the @kbd{a P} command which returns a list of all roots of a
12988 polynomial; if the variable has been declared real, only the real
12989 roots (if any) will be included in the list.
12990
12991 ``Integer'' declarations are used for simplifications which are valid
12992 only when certain values are integers (such as @samp{(x^y)^z}
12993 shown above).
12994
12995 Another command that makes use of declarations is @kbd{a s}, when
12996 simplifying equations and inequalities. It will cancel @code{x}
12997 from both sides of @samp{a x = b x} only if it is sure @code{x}
12998 is non-zero, say, because it has a @code{pos} declaration.
12999 To declare specifically that @code{x} is real and non-zero,
13000 use @samp{[[-inf .. 0), (0 .. inf]]}. (There is no way in the
13001 current notation to say that @code{x} is nonzero but not necessarily
13002 real.) The @kbd{a e} command does ``unsafe'' simplifications,
13003 including cancelling @samp{x} from the equation when @samp{x} is
13004 not known to be nonzero.
13005
13006 Another set of type symbols distinguish between scalars and vectors.
13007
13008 @table @code
13009 @item scalar
13010 The value is not a vector.
13011 @item vector
13012 The value is a vector.
13013 @item matrix
13014 The value is a matrix (a rectangular vector of vectors).
13015 @end table
13016
13017 These type symbols can be combined with the other type symbols
13018 described above; @samp{[int, matrix]} describes an object which
13019 is a matrix of integers.
13020
13021 Scalar/vector declarations are used to determine whether certain
13022 algebraic operations are safe. For example, @samp{[a, b, c] + x}
13023 is normally not simplified to @samp{[a + x, b + x, c + x]}, but
13024 it will be if @code{x} has been declared @code{scalar}. On the
13025 other hand, multiplication is usually assumed to be commutative,
13026 but the terms in @samp{x y} will never be exchanged if both @code{x}
13027 and @code{y} are known to be vectors or matrices. (Calc currently
13028 never distinguishes between @code{vector} and @code{matrix}
13029 declarations.)
13030
13031 @xref{Matrix Mode}, for a discussion of Matrix mode and
13032 Scalar mode, which are similar to declaring @samp{[All, matrix]}
13033 or @samp{[All, scalar]} but much more convenient.
13034
13035 One more type symbol that is recognized is used with the @kbd{H a d}
13036 command for taking total derivatives of a formula. @xref{Calculus}.
13037
13038 @table @code
13039 @item const
13040 The value is a constant with respect to other variables.
13041 @end table
13042
13043 Calc does not check the declarations for a variable when you store
13044 a value in it. However, storing @mathit{-3.5} in a variable that has
13045 been declared @code{pos}, @code{int}, or @code{matrix} may have
13046 unexpected effects; Calc may evaluate @samp{sqrt(x^2)} to @expr{3.5}
13047 if it substitutes the value first, or to @expr{-3.5} if @code{x}
13048 was declared @code{pos} and the formula @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is
13049 simplified to @samp{x} before the value is substituted. Before
13050 using a variable for a new purpose, it is best to use @kbd{s d}
13051 or @kbd{s D} to check to make sure you don't still have an old
13052 declaration for the variable that will conflict with its new meaning.
13053
13054 @node Functions for Declarations, , Kinds of Declarations, Declarations
13055 @subsection Functions for Declarations
13056
13057 @noindent
13058 Calc has a set of functions for accessing the current declarations
13059 in a convenient manner. These functions return 1 if the argument
13060 can be shown to have the specified property, or 0 if the argument
13061 can be shown @emph{not} to have that property; otherwise they are
13062 left unevaluated. These functions are suitable for use with rewrite
13063 rules (@pxref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}) or programming constructs
13064 (@pxref{Conditionals in Macros}). They can be entered only using
13065 algebraic notation. @xref{Logical Operations}, for functions
13066 that perform other tests not related to declarations.
13067
13068 For example, @samp{dint(17)} returns 1 because 17 is an integer, as
13069 do @samp{dint(n)} and @samp{dint(2 n - 3)} if @code{n} has been declared
13070 @code{int}, but @samp{dint(2.5)} and @samp{dint(n + 0.5)} return 0.
13071 Calc consults knowledge of its own built-in functions as well as your
13072 own declarations: @samp{dint(floor(x))} returns 1.
13073
13074 @ignore
13075 @starindex
13076 @end ignore
13077 @tindex dint
13078 @ignore
13079 @starindex
13080 @end ignore
13081 @tindex dnumint
13082 @ignore
13083 @starindex
13084 @end ignore
13085 @tindex dnatnum
13086 The @code{dint} function checks if its argument is an integer.
13087 The @code{dnatnum} function checks if its argument is a natural
13088 number, i.e., a nonnegative integer. The @code{dnumint} function
13089 checks if its argument is numerically an integer, i.e., either an
13090 integer or an integer-valued float. Note that these and the other
13091 data type functions also accept vectors or matrices composed of
13092 suitable elements, and that real infinities @samp{inf} and @samp{-inf}
13093 are considered to be integers for the purposes of these functions.
13094
13095 @ignore
13096 @starindex
13097 @end ignore
13098 @tindex drat
13099 The @code{drat} function checks if its argument is rational, i.e.,
13100 an integer or fraction. Infinities count as rational, but intervals
13101 and error forms do not.
13102
13103 @ignore
13104 @starindex
13105 @end ignore
13106 @tindex dreal
13107 The @code{dreal} function checks if its argument is real. This
13108 includes integers, fractions, floats, real error forms, and intervals.
13109
13110 @ignore
13111 @starindex
13112 @end ignore
13113 @tindex dimag
13114 The @code{dimag} function checks if its argument is imaginary,
13115 i.e., is mathematically equal to a real number times @expr{i}.
13116
13117 @ignore
13118 @starindex
13119 @end ignore
13120 @tindex dpos
13121 @ignore
13122 @starindex
13123 @end ignore
13124 @tindex dneg
13125 @ignore
13126 @starindex
13127 @end ignore
13128 @tindex dnonneg
13129 The @code{dpos} function checks for positive (but nonzero) reals.
13130 The @code{dneg} function checks for negative reals. The @code{dnonneg}
13131 function checks for nonnegative reals, i.e., reals greater than or
13132 equal to zero. Note that the @kbd{a s} command can simplify an
13133 expression like @expr{x > 0} to 1 or 0 using @code{dpos}, and that
13134 @kbd{a s} is effectively applied to all conditions in rewrite rules,
13135 so the actual functions @code{dpos}, @code{dneg}, and @code{dnonneg}
13136 are rarely necessary.
13137
13138 @ignore
13139 @starindex
13140 @end ignore
13141 @tindex dnonzero
13142 The @code{dnonzero} function checks that its argument is nonzero.
13143 This includes all nonzero real or complex numbers, all intervals that
13144 do not include zero, all nonzero modulo forms, vectors all of whose
13145 elements are nonzero, and variables or formulas whose values can be
13146 deduced to be nonzero. It does not include error forms, since they
13147 represent values which could be anything including zero. (This is
13148 also the set of objects considered ``true'' in conditional contexts.)
13149
13150 @ignore
13151 @starindex
13152 @end ignore
13153 @tindex deven
13154 @ignore
13155 @starindex
13156 @end ignore
13157 @tindex dodd
13158 The @code{deven} function returns 1 if its argument is known to be
13159 an even integer (or integer-valued float); it returns 0 if its argument
13160 is known not to be even (because it is known to be odd or a non-integer).
13161 The @kbd{a s} command uses this to simplify a test of the form
13162 @samp{x % 2 = 0}. There is also an analogous @code{dodd} function.
13163
13164 @ignore
13165 @starindex
13166 @end ignore
13167 @tindex drange
13168 The @code{drange} function returns a set (an interval or a vector
13169 of intervals and/or numbers; @pxref{Set Operations}) that describes
13170 the set of possible values of its argument. If the argument is
13171 a variable or a function with a declaration, the range is copied
13172 from the declaration. Otherwise, the possible signs of the
13173 expression are determined using a method similar to @code{dpos},
13174 etc., and a suitable set like @samp{[0 .. inf]} is returned. If
13175 the expression is not provably real, the @code{drange} function
13176 remains unevaluated.
13177
13178 @ignore
13179 @starindex
13180 @end ignore
13181 @tindex dscalar
13182 The @code{dscalar} function returns 1 if its argument is provably
13183 scalar, or 0 if its argument is provably non-scalar. It is left
13184 unevaluated if this cannot be determined. (If Matrix mode or Scalar
13185 mode is in effect, this function returns 1 or 0, respectively,
13186 if it has no other information.) When Calc interprets a condition
13187 (say, in a rewrite rule) it considers an unevaluated formula to be
13188 ``false.'' Thus, @samp{dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a} is
13189 provably scalar, and @samp{!dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a}
13190 is provably non-scalar; both are ``false'' if there is insufficient
13191 information to tell.
13192
13193 @node Display Modes, Language Modes, Declarations, Mode Settings
13194 @section Display Modes
13195
13196 @noindent
13197 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with the
13198 @kbd{d} prefix. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) and @kbd{d b}
13199 (@code{calc-line-breaking}) commands are described elsewhere;
13200 @pxref{Stack Basics} and @pxref{Normal Language Modes}, respectively.
13201 Display formats for vectors and matrices are also covered elsewhere;
13202 @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
13203
13204 One thing all display modes have in common is their treatment of the
13205 @kbd{H} prefix. This prefix causes any mode command that would normally
13206 refresh the stack to leave the stack display alone. The word ``Dirty''
13207 will appear in the mode line when Calc thinks the stack display may not
13208 reflect the latest mode settings.
13209
13210 @kindex d @key{RET}
13211 @pindex calc-refresh-top
13212 The @kbd{d @key{RET}} (@code{calc-refresh-top}) command reformats the
13213 top stack entry according to all the current modes. Positive prefix
13214 arguments reformat the top @var{n} entries; negative prefix arguments
13215 reformat the specified entry, and a prefix of zero is equivalent to
13216 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}), which reformats the entire stack.
13217 For example, @kbd{H d s M-2 d @key{RET}} changes to scientific notation
13218 but reformats only the top two stack entries in the new mode.
13219
13220 The @kbd{I} prefix has another effect on the display modes. The mode
13221 is set only temporarily; the top stack entry is reformatted according
13222 to that mode, then the original mode setting is restored. In other
13223 words, @kbd{I d s} is equivalent to @kbd{H d s d @key{RET} H d (@var{old mode})}.
13224
13225 @menu
13226 * Radix Modes::
13227 * Grouping Digits::
13228 * Float Formats::
13229 * Complex Formats::
13230 * Fraction Formats::
13231 * HMS Formats::
13232 * Date Formats::
13233 * Truncating the Stack::
13234 * Justification::
13235 * Labels::
13236 @end menu
13237
13238 @node Radix Modes, Grouping Digits, Display Modes, Display Modes
13239 @subsection Radix Modes
13240
13241 @noindent
13242 @cindex Radix display
13243 @cindex Non-decimal numbers
13244 @cindex Decimal and non-decimal numbers
13245 Calc normally displays numbers in decimal (@dfn{base-10} or @dfn{radix-10})
13246 notation. Calc can actually display in any radix from two (binary) to 36.
13247 When the radix is above 10, the letters @code{A} to @code{Z} are used as
13248 digits. When entering such a number, letter keys are interpreted as
13249 potential digits rather than terminating numeric entry mode.
13250
13251 @kindex d 2
13252 @kindex d 8
13253 @kindex d 6
13254 @kindex d 0
13255 @cindex Hexadecimal integers
13256 @cindex Octal integers
13257 The key sequences @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, @kbd{d 6}, and @kbd{d 0} select
13258 binary, octal, hexadecimal, and decimal as the current display radix,
13259 respectively. Numbers can always be entered in any radix, though the
13260 current radix is used as a default if you press @kbd{#} without any initial
13261 digits. A number entered without a @kbd{#} is @emph{always} interpreted
13262 as decimal.
13263
13264 @kindex d r
13265 @pindex calc-radix
13266 To set the radix generally, use @kbd{d r} (@code{calc-radix}) and enter
13267 an integer from 2 to 36. You can specify the radix as a numeric prefix
13268 argument; otherwise you will be prompted for it.
13269
13270 @kindex d z
13271 @pindex calc-leading-zeros
13272 @cindex Leading zeros
13273 Integers normally are displayed with however many digits are necessary to
13274 represent the integer and no more. The @kbd{d z} (@code{calc-leading-zeros})
13275 command causes integers to be padded out with leading zeros according to the
13276 current binary word size. (@xref{Binary Functions}, for a discussion of
13277 word size.) If the absolute value of the word size is @expr{w}, all integers
13278 are displayed with at least enough digits to represent
13279 @texline @math{2^w-1}
13280 @infoline @expr{(2^w)-1}
13281 in the current radix. (Larger integers will still be displayed in their
13282 entirety.)
13283
13284 @node Grouping Digits, Float Formats, Radix Modes, Display Modes
13285 @subsection Grouping Digits
13286
13287 @noindent
13288 @kindex d g
13289 @pindex calc-group-digits
13290 @cindex Grouping digits
13291 @cindex Digit grouping
13292 Long numbers can be hard to read if they have too many digits. For
13293 example, the factorial of 30 is 33 digits long! Press @kbd{d g}
13294 (@code{calc-group-digits}) to enable @dfn{Grouping} mode, in which digits
13295 are displayed in clumps of 3 or 4 (depending on the current radix)
13296 separated by commas.
13297
13298 The @kbd{d g} command toggles grouping on and off.
13299 With a numerix prefix of 0, this command displays the current state of
13300 the grouping flag; with an argument of minus one it disables grouping;
13301 with a positive argument @expr{N} it enables grouping on every @expr{N}
13302 digits. For floating-point numbers, grouping normally occurs only
13303 before the decimal point. A negative prefix argument @expr{-N} enables
13304 grouping every @expr{N} digits both before and after the decimal point.
13305
13306 @kindex d ,
13307 @pindex calc-group-char
13308 The @kbd{d ,} (@code{calc-group-char}) command allows you to choose any
13309 character as the grouping separator. The default is the comma character.
13310 If you find it difficult to read vectors of large integers grouped with
13311 commas, you may wish to use spaces or some other character instead.
13312 This command takes the next character you type, whatever it is, and
13313 uses it as the digit separator. As a special case, @kbd{d , \} selects
13314 @samp{\,} (@TeX{}'s thin-space symbol) as the digit separator.
13315
13316 Please note that grouped numbers will not generally be parsed correctly
13317 if re-read in textual form, say by the use of @kbd{M-# y} and @kbd{M-# g}.
13318 (@xref{Kill and Yank}, for details on these commands.) One exception is
13319 the @samp{\,} separator, which doesn't interfere with parsing because it
13320 is ignored by @TeX{} language mode.
13321
13322 @node Float Formats, Complex Formats, Grouping Digits, Display Modes
13323 @subsection Float Formats
13324
13325 @noindent
13326 Floating-point quantities are normally displayed in standard decimal
13327 form, with scientific notation used if the exponent is especially high
13328 or low. All significant digits are normally displayed. The commands
13329 in this section allow you to choose among several alternative display
13330 formats for floats.
13331
13332 @kindex d n
13333 @pindex calc-normal-notation
13334 The @kbd{d n} (@code{calc-normal-notation}) command selects the normal
13335 display format. All significant figures in a number are displayed.
13336 With a positive numeric prefix, numbers are rounded if necessary to
13337 that number of significant digits. With a negative numerix prefix,
13338 the specified number of significant digits less than the current
13339 precision is used. (Thus @kbd{C-u -2 d n} displays 10 digits if the
13340 current precision is 12.)
13341
13342 @kindex d f
13343 @pindex calc-fix-notation
13344 The @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation}) command selects fixed-point
13345 notation. The numeric argument is the number of digits after the
13346 decimal point, zero or more. This format will relax into scientific
13347 notation if a nonzero number would otherwise have been rounded all the
13348 way to zero. Specifying a negative number of digits is the same as
13349 for a positive number, except that small nonzero numbers will be rounded
13350 to zero rather than switching to scientific notation.
13351
13352 @kindex d s
13353 @pindex calc-sci-notation
13354 @cindex Scientific notation, display of
13355 The @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}) command selects scientific
13356 notation. A positive argument sets the number of significant figures
13357 displayed, of which one will be before and the rest after the decimal
13358 point. A negative argument works the same as for @kbd{d n} format.
13359 The default is to display all significant digits.
13360
13361 @kindex d e
13362 @pindex calc-eng-notation
13363 @cindex Engineering notation, display of
13364 The @kbd{d e} (@code{calc-eng-notation}) command selects engineering
13365 notation. This is similar to scientific notation except that the
13366 exponent is rounded down to a multiple of three, with from one to three
13367 digits before the decimal point. An optional numeric prefix sets the
13368 number of significant digits to display, as for @kbd{d s}.
13369
13370 It is important to distinguish between the current @emph{precision} and
13371 the current @emph{display format}. After the commands @kbd{C-u 10 p}
13372 and @kbd{C-u 6 d n} the Calculator computes all results to ten
13373 significant figures but displays only six. (In fact, intermediate
13374 calculations are often carried to one or two more significant figures,
13375 but values placed on the stack will be rounded down to ten figures.)
13376 Numbers are never actually rounded to the display precision for storage,
13377 except by commands like @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{M-# y} which operate on the
13378 actual displayed text in the Calculator buffer.
13379
13380 @kindex d .
13381 @pindex calc-point-char
13382 The @kbd{d .} (@code{calc-point-char}) command selects the character used
13383 as a decimal point. Normally this is a period; users in some countries
13384 may wish to change this to a comma. Note that this is only a display
13385 style; on entry, periods must always be used to denote floating-point
13386 numbers, and commas to separate elements in a list.
13387
13388 @node Complex Formats, Fraction Formats, Float Formats, Display Modes
13389 @subsection Complex Formats
13390
13391 @noindent
13392 @kindex d c
13393 @pindex calc-complex-notation
13394 There are three supported notations for complex numbers in rectangular
13395 form. The default is as a pair of real numbers enclosed in parentheses
13396 and separated by a comma: @samp{(a,b)}. The @kbd{d c}
13397 (@code{calc-complex-notation}) command selects this style.
13398
13399 @kindex d i
13400 @pindex calc-i-notation
13401 @kindex d j
13402 @pindex calc-j-notation
13403 The other notations are @kbd{d i} (@code{calc-i-notation}), in which
13404 numbers are displayed in @samp{a+bi} form, and @kbd{d j}
13405 (@code{calc-j-notation}) which displays the form @samp{a+bj} preferred
13406 in some disciplines.
13407
13408 @cindex @code{i} variable
13409 @vindex i
13410 Complex numbers are normally entered in @samp{(a,b)} format.
13411 If you enter @samp{2+3i} as an algebraic formula, it will be stored as
13412 the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i}. However, if you use @kbd{=} to evaluate
13413 this formula and you have not changed the variable @samp{i}, the @samp{i}
13414 will be interpreted as @samp{(0,1)} and the formula will be simplified
13415 to @samp{(2,3)}. Other commands (like @code{calc-sin}) will @emph{not}
13416 interpret the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i} as a complex number.
13417 @xref{Variables}, under ``special constants.''
13418
13419 @node Fraction Formats, HMS Formats, Complex Formats, Display Modes
13420 @subsection Fraction Formats
13421
13422 @noindent
13423 @kindex d o
13424 @pindex calc-over-notation
13425 Display of fractional numbers is controlled by the @kbd{d o}
13426 (@code{calc-over-notation}) command. By default, a number like
13427 eight thirds is displayed in the form @samp{8:3}. The @kbd{d o} command
13428 prompts for a one- or two-character format. If you give one character,
13429 that character is used as the fraction separator. Common separators are
13430 @samp{:} and @samp{/}. (During input of numbers, the @kbd{:} key must be
13431 used regardless of the display format; in particular, the @kbd{/} is used
13432 for RPN-style division, @emph{not} for entering fractions.)
13433
13434 If you give two characters, fractions use ``integer-plus-fractional-part''
13435 notation. For example, the format @samp{+/} would display eight thirds
13436 as @samp{2+2/3}. If two colons are present in a number being entered,
13437 the number is interpreted in this form (so that the entries @kbd{2:2:3}
13438 and @kbd{8:3} are equivalent).
13439
13440 It is also possible to follow the one- or two-character format with
13441 a number. For example: @samp{:10} or @samp{+/3}. In this case,
13442 Calc adjusts all fractions that are displayed to have the specified
13443 denominator, if possible. Otherwise it adjusts the denominator to
13444 be a multiple of the specified value. For example, in @samp{:6} mode
13445 the fraction @expr{1:6} will be unaffected, but @expr{2:3} will be
13446 displayed as @expr{4:6}, @expr{1:2} will be displayed as @expr{3:6},
13447 and @expr{1:8} will be displayed as @expr{3:24}. Integers are also
13448 affected by this mode: 3 is displayed as @expr{18:6}. Note that the
13449 format @samp{:1} writes fractions the same as @samp{:}, but it writes
13450 integers as @expr{n:1}.
13451
13452 The fraction format does not affect the way fractions or integers are
13453 stored, only the way they appear on the screen. The fraction format
13454 never affects floats.
13455
13456 @node HMS Formats, Date Formats, Fraction Formats, Display Modes
13457 @subsection HMS Formats
13458
13459 @noindent
13460 @kindex d h
13461 @pindex calc-hms-notation
13462 The @kbd{d h} (@code{calc-hms-notation}) command controls the display of
13463 HMS (hours-minutes-seconds) forms. It prompts for a string which
13464 consists basically of an ``hours'' marker, optional punctuation, a
13465 ``minutes'' marker, more optional punctuation, and a ``seconds'' marker.
13466 Punctuation is zero or more spaces, commas, or semicolons. The hours
13467 marker is one or more non-punctuation characters. The minutes and
13468 seconds markers must be single non-punctuation characters.
13469
13470 The default HMS format is @samp{@@ ' "}, producing HMS values of the form
13471 @samp{23@@ 30' 15.75"}. The format @samp{deg, ms} would display this same
13472 value as @samp{23deg, 30m15.75s}. During numeric entry, the @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}
13473 keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{@@} regardless of display format.
13474 The @kbd{m} and @kbd{s} keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{'} and
13475 @kbd{"}, respectively, but only if an @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}) has
13476 already been typed; otherwise, they have their usual meanings
13477 (@kbd{m-} prefix and @kbd{s-} prefix). Thus, @kbd{5 "}, @kbd{0 @@ 5 "}, and
13478 @kbd{0 h 5 s} are some of the ways to enter the quantity ``five seconds.''
13479 The @kbd{'} key is recognized as ``minutes'' only if @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or
13480 @kbd{o}) has already been pressed; otherwise it means to switch to algebraic
13481 entry.
13482
13483 @node Date Formats, Truncating the Stack, HMS Formats, Display Modes
13484 @subsection Date Formats
13485
13486 @noindent
13487 @kindex d d
13488 @pindex calc-date-notation
13489 The @kbd{d d} (@code{calc-date-notation}) command controls the display
13490 of date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). It prompts for a string which
13491 contains letters that represent the various parts of a date and time.
13492 To show which parts should be omitted when the form represents a pure
13493 date with no time, parts of the string can be enclosed in @samp{< >}
13494 marks. If you don't include @samp{< >} markers in the format, Calc
13495 guesses at which parts, if any, should be omitted when formatting
13496 pure dates.
13497
13498 The default format is: @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY}.
13499 An example string in this format is @samp{3:32pm Wed Jan 9, 1991}.
13500 If you enter a blank format string, this default format is
13501 reestablished.
13502
13503 Calc uses @samp{< >} notation for nameless functions as well as for
13504 dates. @xref{Specifying Operators}. To avoid confusion with nameless
13505 functions, your date formats should avoid using the @samp{#} character.
13506
13507 @menu
13508 * Date Formatting Codes::
13509 * Free-Form Dates::
13510 * Standard Date Formats::
13511 @end menu
13512
13513 @node Date Formatting Codes, Free-Form Dates, Date Formats, Date Formats
13514 @subsubsection Date Formatting Codes
13515
13516 @noindent
13517 When displaying a date, the current date format is used. All
13518 characters except for letters and @samp{<} and @samp{>} are
13519 copied literally when dates are formatted. The portion between
13520 @samp{< >} markers is omitted for pure dates, or included for
13521 date/time forms. Letters are interpreted according to the table
13522 below.
13523
13524 When dates are read in during algebraic entry, Calc first tries to
13525 match the input string to the current format either with or without
13526 the time part. The punctuation characters (including spaces) must
13527 match exactly; letter fields must correspond to suitable text in
13528 the input. If this doesn't work, Calc checks if the input is a
13529 simple number; if so, the number is interpreted as a number of days
13530 since Jan 1, 1 AD. Otherwise, Calc tries a much more relaxed and
13531 flexible algorithm which is described in the next section.
13532
13533 Weekday names are ignored during reading.
13534
13535 Two-digit year numbers are interpreted as lying in the range
13536 from 1941 to 2039. Years outside that range are always
13537 entered and displayed in full. Year numbers with a leading
13538 @samp{+} sign are always interpreted exactly, allowing the
13539 entry and display of the years 1 through 99 AD.
13540
13541 Here is a complete list of the formatting codes for dates:
13542
13543 @table @asis
13544 @item Y
13545 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13546 @item YY
13547 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``07'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13548 @item BY
13549 Year: ``91'' for 1991, `` 7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13550 @item YYY
13551 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``23'' for 23 AD.
13552 @item YYYY
13553 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13554 @item aa
13555 Year: ``ad'' or blank.
13556 @item AA
13557 Year: ``AD'' or blank.
13558 @item aaa
13559 Year: ``ad '' or blank. (Note trailing space.)
13560 @item AAA
13561 Year: ``AD '' or blank.
13562 @item aaaa
13563 Year: ``a.d.'' or blank.
13564 @item AAAA
13565 Year: ``A.D.'' or blank.
13566 @item bb
13567 Year: ``bc'' or blank.
13568 @item BB
13569 Year: ``BC'' or blank.
13570 @item bbb
13571 Year: `` bc'' or blank. (Note leading space.)
13572 @item BBB
13573 Year: `` BC'' or blank.
13574 @item bbbb
13575 Year: ``b.c.'' or blank.
13576 @item BBBB
13577 Year: ``B.C.'' or blank.
13578 @item M
13579 Month: ``8'' for August.
13580 @item MM
13581 Month: ``08'' for August.
13582 @item BM
13583 Month: `` 8'' for August.
13584 @item MMM
13585 Month: ``AUG'' for August.
13586 @item Mmm
13587 Month: ``Aug'' for August.
13588 @item mmm
13589 Month: ``aug'' for August.
13590 @item MMMM
13591 Month: ``AUGUST'' for August.
13592 @item Mmmm
13593 Month: ``August'' for August.
13594 @item D
13595 Day: ``7'' for 7th day of month.
13596 @item DD
13597 Day: ``07'' for 7th day of month.
13598 @item BD
13599 Day: `` 7'' for 7th day of month.
13600 @item W
13601 Weekday: ``0'' for Sunday, ``6'' for Saturday.
13602 @item WWW
13603 Weekday: ``SUN'' for Sunday.
13604 @item Www
13605 Weekday: ``Sun'' for Sunday.
13606 @item www
13607 Weekday: ``sun'' for Sunday.
13608 @item WWWW
13609 Weekday: ``SUNDAY'' for Sunday.
13610 @item Wwww
13611 Weekday: ``Sunday'' for Sunday.
13612 @item d
13613 Day of year: ``34'' for Feb. 3.
13614 @item ddd
13615 Day of year: ``034'' for Feb. 3.
13616 @item bdd
13617 Day of year: `` 34'' for Feb. 3.
13618 @item h
13619 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13620 @item hh
13621 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13622 @item bh
13623 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13624 @item H
13625 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13626 @item HH
13627 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13628 @item BH
13629 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13630 @item p
13631 AM/PM: ``a'' or ``p''.
13632 @item P
13633 AM/PM: ``A'' or ``P''.
13634 @item pp
13635 AM/PM: ``am'' or ``pm''.
13636 @item PP
13637 AM/PM: ``AM'' or ``PM''.
13638 @item pppp
13639 AM/PM: ``a.m.'' or ``p.m.''.
13640 @item PPPP
13641 AM/PM: ``A.M.'' or ``P.M.''.
13642 @item m
13643 Minutes: ``7'' for 7.
13644 @item mm
13645 Minutes: ``07'' for 7.
13646 @item bm
13647 Minutes: `` 7'' for 7.
13648 @item s
13649 Seconds: ``7'' for 7; ``7.23'' for 7.23.
13650 @item ss
13651 Seconds: ``07'' for 7; ``07.23'' for 7.23.
13652 @item bs
13653 Seconds: `` 7'' for 7; `` 7.23'' for 7.23.
13654 @item SS
13655 Optional seconds: ``07'' for 7; blank for 0.
13656 @item BS
13657 Optional seconds: `` 7'' for 7; blank for 0.
13658 @item N
13659 Numeric date/time: ``726842.25'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13660 @item n
13661 Numeric date: ``726842'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13662 @item J
13663 Julian date/time: ``2448265.75'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13664 @item j
13665 Julian date: ``2448266'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13666 @item U
13667 Unix time: ``663400800'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13668 @item X
13669 Brackets suppression. An ``X'' at the front of the format
13670 causes the surrounding @w{@samp{< >}} delimiters to be omitted
13671 when formatting dates. Note that the brackets are still
13672 required for algebraic entry.
13673 @end table
13674
13675 If ``SS'' or ``BS'' (optional seconds) is preceded by a colon, the
13676 colon is also omitted if the seconds part is zero.
13677
13678 If ``bb,'' ``bbb'' or ``bbbb'' or their upper-case equivalents
13679 appear in the format, then negative year numbers are displayed
13680 without a minus sign. Note that ``aa'' and ``bb'' are mutually
13681 exclusive. Some typical usages would be @samp{YYYY AABB};
13682 @samp{AAAYYYYBBB}; @samp{YYYYBBB}.
13683
13684 The formats ``YY,'' ``YYYY,'' ``MM,'' ``DD,'' ``ddd,'' ``hh,'' ``HH,''
13685 ``mm,'' ``ss,'' and ``SS'' actually match any number of digits during
13686 reading unless several of these codes are strung together with no
13687 punctuation in between, in which case the input must have exactly as
13688 many digits as there are letters in the format.
13689
13690 The ``j,'' ``J,'' and ``U'' formats do not make any time zone
13691 adjustment. They effectively use @samp{julian(x,0)} and
13692 @samp{unixtime(x,0)} to make the conversion; @pxref{Date Arithmetic}.
13693
13694 @node Free-Form Dates, Standard Date Formats, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats
13695 @subsubsection Free-Form Dates
13696
13697 @noindent
13698 When reading a date form during algebraic entry, Calc falls back
13699 on the algorithm described here if the input does not exactly
13700 match the current date format. This algorithm generally
13701 ``does the right thing'' and you don't have to worry about it,
13702 but it is described here in full detail for the curious.
13703
13704 Calc does not distinguish between upper- and lower-case letters
13705 while interpreting dates.
13706
13707 First, the time portion, if present, is located somewhere in the
13708 text and then removed. The remaining text is then interpreted as
13709 the date.
13710
13711 A time is of the form @samp{hh:mm:ss}, possibly with the seconds
13712 part omitted and possibly with an AM/PM indicator added to indicate
13713 12-hour time. If the AM/PM is present, the minutes may also be
13714 omitted. The AM/PM part may be any of the words @samp{am},
13715 @samp{pm}, @samp{noon}, or @samp{midnight}; each of these may be
13716 abbreviated to one letter, and the alternate forms @samp{a.m.},
13717 @samp{p.m.}, and @samp{mid} are also understood. Obviously
13718 @samp{noon} and @samp{midnight} are allowed only on 12:00:00.
13719 The words @samp{noon}, @samp{mid}, and @samp{midnight} are also
13720 recognized with no number attached.
13721
13722 If there is no AM/PM indicator, the time is interpreted in 24-hour
13723 format.
13724
13725 To read the date portion, all words and numbers are isolated
13726 from the string; other characters are ignored. All words must
13727 be either month names or day-of-week names (the latter of which
13728 are ignored). Names can be written in full or as three-letter
13729 abbreviations.
13730
13731 Large numbers, or numbers with @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
13732 are interpreted as years. If one of the other numbers is
13733 greater than 12, then that must be the day and the remaining
13734 number in the input is therefore the month. Otherwise, Calc
13735 assumes the month, day and year are in the same order that they
13736 appear in the current date format. If the year is omitted, the
13737 current year is taken from the system clock.
13738
13739 If there are too many or too few numbers, or any unrecognizable
13740 words, then the input is rejected.
13741
13742 If there are any large numbers (of five digits or more) other than
13743 the year, they are ignored on the assumption that they are something
13744 like Julian dates that were included along with the traditional
13745 date components when the date was formatted.
13746
13747 One of the words @samp{ad}, @samp{a.d.}, @samp{bc}, or @samp{b.c.}
13748 may optionally be used; the latter two are equivalent to a
13749 minus sign on the year value.
13750
13751 If you always enter a four-digit year, and use a name instead
13752 of a number for the month, there is no danger of ambiguity.
13753
13754 @node Standard Date Formats, , Free-Form Dates, Date Formats
13755 @subsubsection Standard Date Formats
13756
13757 @noindent
13758 There are actually ten standard date formats, numbered 0 through 9.
13759 Entering a blank line at the @kbd{d d} command's prompt gives
13760 you format number 1, Calc's usual format. You can enter any digit
13761 to select the other formats.
13762
13763 To create your own standard date formats, give a numeric prefix
13764 argument from 0 to 9 to the @w{@kbd{d d}} command. The format you
13765 enter will be recorded as the new standard format of that
13766 number, as well as becoming the new current date format.
13767 You can save your formats permanently with the @w{@kbd{m m}}
13768 command (@pxref{Mode Settings}).
13769
13770 @table @asis
13771 @item 0
13772 @samp{N} (Numerical format)
13773 @item 1
13774 @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY} (American format)
13775 @item 2
13776 @samp{D Mmm YYYY<, h:mm:SS>} (European format)
13777 @item 3
13778 @samp{Www Mmm BD< hh:mm:ss> YYYY} (Unix written date format)
13779 @item 4
13780 @samp{M/D/Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American slashed format)
13781 @item 5
13782 @samp{D.M.Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dotted format)
13783 @item 6
13784 @samp{M-D-Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American dashed format)
13785 @item 7
13786 @samp{D-M-Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dashed format)
13787 @item 8
13788 @samp{j<, h:mm:ss>} (Julian day plus time)
13789 @item 9
13790 @samp{YYddd< hh:mm:ss>} (Year-day format)
13791 @end table
13792
13793 @node Truncating the Stack, Justification, Date Formats, Display Modes
13794 @subsection Truncating the Stack
13795
13796 @noindent
13797 @kindex d t
13798 @pindex calc-truncate-stack
13799 @cindex Truncating the stack
13800 @cindex Narrowing the stack
13801 The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack}) command moves the @samp{.}@:
13802 line that marks the top-of-stack up or down in the Calculator buffer.
13803 The number right above that line is considered to the be at the top of
13804 the stack. Any numbers below that line are ``hidden'' from all stack
13805 operations. This is similar to the Emacs ``narrowing'' feature, except
13806 that the values below the @samp{.} are @emph{visible}, just temporarily
13807 frozen. This feature allows you to keep several independent calculations
13808 running at once in different parts of the stack, or to apply a certain
13809 command to an element buried deep in the stack.
13810
13811 Pressing @kbd{d t} by itself moves the @samp{.} to the line the cursor
13812 is on. Thus, this line and all those below it become hidden. To un-hide
13813 these lines, move down to the end of the buffer and press @w{@kbd{d t}}.
13814 With a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{n}, @kbd{d t} hides the
13815 bottom @expr{n} values in the buffer. With a negative argument, it hides
13816 all but the top @expr{n} values. With an argument of zero, it hides zero
13817 values, i.e., moves the @samp{.} all the way down to the bottom.
13818
13819 @kindex d [
13820 @pindex calc-truncate-up
13821 @kindex d ]
13822 @pindex calc-truncate-down
13823 The @kbd{d [} (@code{calc-truncate-up}) and @kbd{d ]}
13824 (@code{calc-truncate-down}) commands move the @samp{.} up or down one
13825 line at a time (or several lines with a prefix argument).
13826
13827 @node Justification, Labels, Truncating the Stack, Display Modes
13828 @subsection Justification
13829
13830 @noindent
13831 @kindex d <
13832 @pindex calc-left-justify
13833 @kindex d =
13834 @pindex calc-center-justify
13835 @kindex d >
13836 @pindex calc-right-justify
13837 Values on the stack are normally left-justified in the window. You can
13838 control this arrangement by typing @kbd{d <} (@code{calc-left-justify}),
13839 @kbd{d >} (@code{calc-right-justify}), or @kbd{d =}
13840 (@code{calc-center-justify}). For example, in Right-Justification mode,
13841 stack entries are displayed flush-right against the right edge of the
13842 window.
13843
13844 If you change the width of the Calculator window you may have to type
13845 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}) to re-align right-justified or centered
13846 text.
13847
13848 Right-justification is especially useful together with fixed-point
13849 notation (see @code{d f}; @code{calc-fix-notation}). With these modes
13850 together, the decimal points on numbers will always line up.
13851
13852 With a numeric prefix argument, the justification commands give you
13853 a little extra control over the display. The argument specifies the
13854 horizontal ``origin'' of a display line. It is also possible to
13855 specify a maximum line width using the @kbd{d b} command (@pxref{Normal
13856 Language Modes}). For reference, the precise rules for formatting and
13857 breaking lines are given below. Notice that the interaction between
13858 origin and line width is slightly different in each justification
13859 mode.
13860
13861 In Left-Justified mode, the line is indented by a number of spaces
13862 given by the origin (default zero). If the result is longer than the
13863 maximum line width, if given, or too wide to fit in the Calc window
13864 otherwise, then it is broken into lines which will fit; each broken
13865 line is indented to the origin.
13866
13867 In Right-Justified mode, lines are shifted right so that the rightmost
13868 character is just before the origin, or just before the current
13869 window width if no origin was specified. If the line is too long
13870 for this, then it is broken; the current line width is used, if
13871 specified, or else the origin is used as a width if that is
13872 specified, or else the line is broken to fit in the window.
13873
13874 In Centering mode, the origin is the column number of the center of
13875 each stack entry. If a line width is specified, lines will not be
13876 allowed to go past that width; Calc will either indent less or
13877 break the lines if necessary. If no origin is specified, half the
13878 line width or Calc window width is used.
13879
13880 Note that, in each case, if line numbering is enabled the display
13881 is indented an additional four spaces to make room for the line
13882 number. The width of the line number is taken into account when
13883 positioning according to the current Calc window width, but not
13884 when positioning by explicit origins and widths. In the latter
13885 case, the display is formatted as specified, and then uniformly
13886 shifted over four spaces to fit the line numbers.
13887
13888 @node Labels, , Justification, Display Modes
13889 @subsection Labels
13890
13891 @noindent
13892 @kindex d @{
13893 @pindex calc-left-label
13894 The @kbd{d @{} (@code{calc-left-label}) command prompts for a string,
13895 then displays that string to the left of every stack entry. If the
13896 entries are left-justified (@pxref{Justification}), then they will
13897 appear immediately after the label (unless you specified an origin
13898 greater than the length of the label). If the entries are centered
13899 or right-justified, the label appears on the far left and does not
13900 affect the horizontal position of the stack entry.
13901
13902 Give a blank string (with @kbd{d @{ @key{RET}}) to turn the label off.
13903
13904 @kindex d @}
13905 @pindex calc-right-label
13906 The @kbd{d @}} (@code{calc-right-label}) command similarly adds a
13907 label on the righthand side. It does not affect positioning of
13908 the stack entries unless they are right-justified. Also, if both
13909 a line width and an origin are given in Right-Justified mode, the
13910 stack entry is justified to the origin and the righthand label is
13911 justified to the line width.
13912
13913 One application of labels would be to add equation numbers to
13914 formulas you are manipulating in Calc and then copying into a
13915 document (possibly using Embedded mode). The equations would
13916 typically be centered, and the equation numbers would be on the
13917 left or right as you prefer.
13918
13919 @node Language Modes, Modes Variable, Display Modes, Mode Settings
13920 @section Language Modes
13921
13922 @noindent
13923 The commands in this section change Calc to use a different notation for
13924 entry and display of formulas, corresponding to the conventions of some
13925 other common language such as Pascal or La@TeX{}. Objects displayed on the
13926 stack or yanked from the Calculator to an editing buffer will be formatted
13927 in the current language; objects entered in algebraic entry or yanked from
13928 another buffer will be interpreted according to the current language.
13929
13930 The current language has no effect on things written to or read from the
13931 trail buffer, nor does it affect numeric entry. Only algebraic entry is
13932 affected. You can make even algebraic entry ignore the current language
13933 and use the standard notation by giving a numeric prefix, e.g., @kbd{C-u '}.
13934
13935 For example, suppose the formula @samp{2*a[1] + atan(a[2])} occurs in a C
13936 program; elsewhere in the program you need the derivatives of this formula
13937 with respect to @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}. First, type @kbd{d C}
13938 to switch to C notation. Now use @code{C-u M-# g} to grab the formula
13939 into the Calculator, @kbd{a d a[1] @key{RET}} to differentiate with respect
13940 to the first variable, and @kbd{M-# y} to yank the formula for the derivative
13941 back into your C program. Press @kbd{U} to undo the differentiation and
13942 repeat with @kbd{a d a[2] @key{RET}} for the other derivative.
13943
13944 Without being switched into C mode first, Calc would have misinterpreted
13945 the brackets in @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}, would not have known that
13946 @code{atan} was equivalent to Calc's built-in @code{arctan} function,
13947 and would have written the formula back with notations (like implicit
13948 multiplication) which would not have been legal for a C program.
13949
13950 As another example, suppose you are maintaining a C program and a La@TeX{}
13951 document, each of which needs a copy of the same formula. You can grab the
13952 formula from the program in C mode, switch to La@TeX{} mode, and yank the
13953 formula into the document in La@TeX{} math-mode format.
13954
13955 Language modes are selected by typing the letter @kbd{d} followed by a
13956 shifted letter key.
13957
13958 @menu
13959 * Normal Language Modes::
13960 * C FORTRAN Pascal::
13961 * TeX and LaTeX Language Modes::
13962 * Eqn Language Mode::
13963 * Mathematica Language Mode::
13964 * Maple Language Mode::
13965 * Compositions::
13966 * Syntax Tables::
13967 @end menu
13968
13969 @node Normal Language Modes, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes, Language Modes
13970 @subsection Normal Language Modes
13971
13972 @noindent
13973 @kindex d N
13974 @pindex calc-normal-language
13975 The @kbd{d N} (@code{calc-normal-language}) command selects the usual
13976 notation for Calc formulas, as described in the rest of this manual.
13977 Matrices are displayed in a multi-line tabular format, but all other
13978 objects are written in linear form, as they would be typed from the
13979 keyboard.
13980
13981 @kindex d O
13982 @pindex calc-flat-language
13983 @cindex Matrix display
13984 The @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) command selects a language
13985 identical with the normal one, except that matrices are written in
13986 one-line form along with everything else. In some applications this
13987 form may be more suitable for yanking data into other buffers.
13988
13989 @kindex d b
13990 @pindex calc-line-breaking
13991 @cindex Line breaking
13992 @cindex Breaking up long lines
13993 Even in one-line mode, long formulas or vectors will still be split
13994 across multiple lines if they exceed the width of the Calculator window.
13995 The @kbd{d b} (@code{calc-line-breaking}) command turns this line-breaking
13996 feature on and off. (It works independently of the current language.)
13997 If you give a numeric prefix argument of five or greater to the @kbd{d b}
13998 command, that argument will specify the line width used when breaking
13999 long lines.
14000
14001 @kindex d B
14002 @pindex calc-big-language
14003 The @kbd{d B} (@code{calc-big-language}) command selects a language
14004 which uses textual approximations to various mathematical notations,
14005 such as powers, quotients, and square roots:
14006
14007 @example
14008 ____________
14009 | a + 1 2
14010 | ----- + c
14011 \| b
14012 @end example
14013
14014 @noindent
14015 in place of @samp{sqrt((a+1)/b + c^2)}.
14016
14017 Subscripts like @samp{a_i} are displayed as actual subscripts in Big
14018 mode. Double subscripts, @samp{a_i_j} (@samp{subscr(subscr(a, i), j)})
14019 are displayed as @samp{a} with subscripts separated by commas:
14020 @samp{i, j}. They must still be entered in the usual underscore
14021 notation.
14022
14023 One slight ambiguity of Big notation is that
14024
14025 @example
14026 3
14027 - -
14028 4
14029 @end example
14030
14031 @noindent
14032 can represent either the negative rational number @expr{-3:4}, or the
14033 actual expression @samp{-(3/4)}; but the latter formula would normally
14034 never be displayed because it would immediately be evaluated to
14035 @expr{-3:4} or @expr{-0.75}, so this ambiguity is not a problem in
14036 typical use.
14037
14038 Non-decimal numbers are displayed with subscripts. Thus there is no
14039 way to tell the difference between @samp{16#C2} and @samp{C2_16},
14040 though generally you will know which interpretation is correct.
14041 Logarithms @samp{log(x,b)} and @samp{log10(x)} also use subscripts
14042 in Big mode.
14043
14044 In Big mode, stack entries often take up several lines. To aid
14045 readability, stack entries are separated by a blank line in this mode.
14046 You may find it useful to expand the Calc window's height using
14047 @kbd{C-x ^} (@code{enlarge-window}) or to make the Calc window the only
14048 one on the screen with @kbd{C-x 1} (@code{delete-other-windows}).
14049
14050 Long lines are currently not rearranged to fit the window width in
14051 Big mode, so you may need to use the @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys
14052 to scroll across a wide formula. For really big formulas, you may
14053 even need to use @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} to scroll up and down.
14054
14055 @kindex d U
14056 @pindex calc-unformatted-language
14057 The @kbd{d U} (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) command altogether disables
14058 the use of operator notation in formulas. In this mode, the formula
14059 shown above would be displayed:
14060
14061 @example
14062 sqrt(add(div(add(a, 1), b), pow(c, 2)))
14063 @end example
14064
14065 These four modes differ only in display format, not in the format
14066 expected for algebraic entry. The standard Calc operators work in
14067 all four modes, and unformatted notation works in any language mode
14068 (except that Mathematica mode expects square brackets instead of
14069 parentheses).
14070
14071 @node C FORTRAN Pascal, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Normal Language Modes, Language Modes
14072 @subsection C, FORTRAN, and Pascal Modes
14073
14074 @noindent
14075 @kindex d C
14076 @pindex calc-c-language
14077 @cindex C language
14078 The @kbd{d C} (@code{calc-c-language}) command selects the conventions
14079 of the C language for display and entry of formulas. This differs from
14080 the normal language mode in a variety of (mostly minor) ways. In
14081 particular, C language operators and operator precedences are used in
14082 place of Calc's usual ones. For example, @samp{a^b} means @samp{xor(a,b)}
14083 in C mode; a value raised to a power is written as a function call,
14084 @samp{pow(a,b)}.
14085
14086 In C mode, vectors and matrices use curly braces instead of brackets.
14087 Octal and hexadecimal values are written with leading @samp{0} or @samp{0x}
14088 rather than using the @samp{#} symbol. Array subscripting is
14089 translated into @code{subscr} calls, so that @samp{a[i]} in C
14090 mode is the same as @samp{a_i} in Normal mode. Assignments
14091 turn into the @code{assign} function, which Calc normally displays
14092 using the @samp{:=} symbol.
14093
14094 The variables @code{pi} and @code{e} would be displayed @samp{pi}
14095 and @samp{e} in Normal mode, but in C mode they are displayed as
14096 @samp{M_PI} and @samp{M_E}, corresponding to the names of constants
14097 typically provided in the @file{<math.h>} header. Functions whose
14098 names are different in C are translated automatically for entry and
14099 display purposes. For example, entering @samp{asin(x)} will push the
14100 formula @samp{arcsin(x)} onto the stack; this formula will be displayed
14101 as @samp{asin(x)} as long as C mode is in effect.
14102
14103 @kindex d P
14104 @pindex calc-pascal-language
14105 @cindex Pascal language
14106 The @kbd{d P} (@code{calc-pascal-language}) command selects Pascal
14107 conventions. Like C mode, Pascal mode interprets array brackets and uses
14108 a different table of operators. Hexadecimal numbers are entered and
14109 displayed with a preceding dollar sign. (Thus the regular meaning of
14110 @kbd{$2} during algebraic entry does not work in Pascal mode, though
14111 @kbd{$} (and @kbd{$$}, etc.) not followed by digits works the same as
14112 always.) No special provisions are made for other non-decimal numbers,
14113 vectors, and so on, since there is no universally accepted standard way
14114 of handling these in Pascal.
14115
14116 @kindex d F
14117 @pindex calc-fortran-language
14118 @cindex FORTRAN language
14119 The @kbd{d F} (@code{calc-fortran-language}) command selects FORTRAN
14120 conventions. Various function names are transformed into FORTRAN
14121 equivalents. Vectors are written as @samp{/1, 2, 3/}, and may be
14122 entered this way or using square brackets. Since FORTRAN uses round
14123 parentheses for both function calls and array subscripts, Calc displays
14124 both in the same way; @samp{a(i)} is interpreted as a function call
14125 upon reading, and subscripts must be entered as @samp{subscr(a, i)}.
14126 Also, if the variable @code{a} has been declared to have type
14127 @code{vector} or @code{matrix} then @samp{a(i)} will be parsed as a
14128 subscript. (@xref{Declarations}.) Usually it doesn't matter, though;
14129 if you enter the subscript expression @samp{a(i)} and Calc interprets
14130 it as a function call, you'll never know the difference unless you
14131 switch to another language mode or replace @code{a} with an actual
14132 vector (or unless @code{a} happens to be the name of a built-in
14133 function!).
14134
14135 Underscores are allowed in variable and function names in all of these
14136 language modes. The underscore here is equivalent to the @samp{#} in
14137 Normal mode, or to hyphens in the underlying Emacs Lisp variable names.
14138
14139 FORTRAN and Pascal modes normally do not adjust the case of letters in
14140 formulas. Most built-in Calc names use lower-case letters. If you use a
14141 positive numeric prefix argument with @kbd{d P} or @kbd{d F}, these
14142 modes will use upper-case letters exclusively for display, and will
14143 convert to lower-case on input. With a negative prefix, these modes
14144 convert to lower-case for display and input.
14145
14146 @node TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Eqn Language Mode, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes
14147 @subsection @TeX{} and La@TeX{} Language Modes
14148
14149 @noindent
14150 @kindex d T
14151 @pindex calc-tex-language
14152 @cindex TeX language
14153 @kindex d L
14154 @pindex calc-latex-language
14155 @cindex LaTeX language
14156 The @kbd{d T} (@code{calc-tex-language}) command selects the conventions
14157 of ``math mode'' in Donald Knuth's @TeX{} typesetting language,
14158 and the @kbd{d L} (@code{calc-latex-language}) command selects the
14159 conventions of ``math mode'' in La@TeX{}, a typesetting language that
14160 uses @TeX{} as its formatting engine. Calc's La@TeX{} language mode can
14161 read any formula that the @TeX{} language mode can, although La@TeX{}
14162 mode may display it differently.
14163
14164 Formulas are entered and displayed in the appropriate notation;
14165 @texline @math{\sin(a/b)}
14166 @infoline @expr{sin(a/b)}
14167 will appear as @samp{\sin\left( a \over b \right)} in @TeX{} mode and
14168 @samp{\sin\left(\frac@{a@}@{b@}\right)} in La@TeX{} mode.
14169 Math formulas are often enclosed by @samp{$ $} signs in @TeX{} and
14170 La@TeX{}; these should be omitted when interfacing with Calc. To Calc,
14171 the @samp{$} sign has the same meaning it always does in algebraic
14172 formulas (a reference to an existing entry on the stack).
14173
14174 Complex numbers are displayed as in @samp{3 + 4i}. Fractions and
14175 quotients are written using @code{\over} in @TeX{} mode (as in
14176 @code{@{a \over b@}}) and @code{\frac} in La@TeX{} mode (as in
14177 @code{\frac@{a@}@{b@}}); binomial coefficients are written with
14178 @code{\choose} in @TeX{} mode (as in @code{@{a \choose b@}}) and
14179 @code{\binom} in La@TeX{} mode (as in @code{\binom@{a@}@{b@}}).
14180 Interval forms are written with @code{\ldots}, and error forms are
14181 written with @code{\pm}. Absolute values are written as in
14182 @samp{|x + 1|}, and the floor and ceiling functions are written with
14183 @code{\lfloor}, @code{\rfloor}, etc. The words @code{\left} and
14184 @code{\right} are ignored when reading formulas in @TeX{} and La@TeX{}
14185 modes. Both @code{inf} and @code{uinf} are written as @code{\infty};
14186 when read, @code{\infty} always translates to @code{inf}.
14187
14188 Function calls are written the usual way, with the function name followed
14189 by the arguments in parentheses. However, functions for which @TeX{}
14190 and La@TeX{} have special names (like @code{\sin}) will use curly braces
14191 instead of parentheses for very simple arguments. During input, curly
14192 braces and parentheses work equally well for grouping, but when the
14193 document is formatted the curly braces will be invisible. Thus the
14194 printed result is
14195 @texline @math{\sin{2 x}}
14196 @infoline @expr{sin 2x}
14197 but
14198 @texline @math{\sin(2 + x)}.
14199 @infoline @expr{sin(2 + x)}.
14200
14201 Function and variable names not treated specially by @TeX{} and La@TeX{}
14202 are simply written out as-is, which will cause them to come out in
14203 italic letters in the printed document. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or
14204 @kbd{d L} with a positive numeric prefix argument, names of more than
14205 one character will instead be enclosed in a protective commands that
14206 will prevent them from being typeset in the math italics; they will be
14207 written @samp{\hbox@{@var{name}@}} in @TeX{} mode and
14208 @samp{\text@{@var{name}@}} in La@TeX{} mode. The
14209 @samp{\hbox@{ @}} and @samp{\text@{ @}} notations are ignored during
14210 reading. If you use a negative prefix argument, such function names are
14211 written @samp{\@var{name}}, and function names that begin with @code{\} during
14212 reading have the @code{\} removed. (Note that in this mode, long
14213 variable names are still written with @code{\hbox} or @code{\text}.
14214 However, you can always make an actual variable name like @code{\bar} in
14215 any @TeX{} mode.)
14216
14217 During reading, text of the form @samp{\matrix@{ ...@: @}} is replaced
14218 by @samp{[ ...@: ]}. The same also applies to @code{\pmatrix} and
14219 @code{\bmatrix}. In La@TeX{} mode this also applies to
14220 @samp{\begin@{matrix@} ... \end@{matrix@}},
14221 @samp{\begin@{bmatrix@} ... \end@{bmatrix@}},
14222 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} ... \end@{pmatrix@}}, as well as
14223 @samp{\begin@{smallmatrix@} ... \end@{smallmatrix@}}.
14224 The symbol @samp{&} is interpreted as a comma,
14225 and the symbols @samp{\cr} and @samp{\\} are interpreted as semicolons.
14226 During output, matrices are displayed in @samp{\matrix@{ a & b \\ c & d@}}
14227 format in @TeX{} mode and in
14228 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} a & b \\ c & d \end@{pmatrix@}} format in
14229 La@TeX{} mode; you may need to edit this afterwards to change to your
14230 preferred matrix form. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or @kbd{d L} with an
14231 argument of 2 or -2, then matrices will be displayed in two-dimensional
14232 form, such as
14233
14234 @example
14235 \begin@{pmatrix@}
14236 a & b \\
14237 c & d
14238 \end@{pmatrix@}
14239 @end example
14240
14241 @noindent
14242 This may be convenient for isolated matrices, but could lead to
14243 expressions being displayed like
14244
14245 @example
14246 \begin@{pmatrix@} \times x
14247 a & b \\
14248 c & d
14249 \end@{pmatrix@}
14250 @end example
14251
14252 @noindent
14253 While this wouldn't bother Calc, it is incorrect La@TeX{}.
14254 (Similarly for @TeX{}.)
14255
14256 Accents like @code{\tilde} and @code{\bar} translate into function
14257 calls internally (@samp{tilde(x)}, @samp{bar(x)}). The @code{\underline}
14258 sequence is treated as an accent. The @code{\vec} accent corresponds
14259 to the function name @code{Vec}, because @code{vec} is the name of
14260 a built-in Calc function. The following table shows the accents
14261 in Calc, @TeX{}, La@TeX{} and @dfn{eqn} (described in the next section):
14262
14263 @iftex
14264 @begingroup
14265 @let@calcindexershow=@calcindexernoshow @c Suppress marginal notes
14266 @let@calcindexersh=@calcindexernoshow
14267 @end iftex
14268 @ignore
14269 @starindex
14270 @end ignore
14271 @tindex acute
14272 @ignore
14273 @starindex
14274 @end ignore
14275 @tindex Acute
14276 @ignore
14277 @starindex
14278 @end ignore
14279 @tindex bar
14280 @ignore
14281 @starindex
14282 @end ignore
14283 @tindex Bar
14284 @ignore
14285 @starindex
14286 @end ignore
14287 @tindex breve
14288 @ignore
14289 @starindex
14290 @end ignore
14291 @tindex Breve
14292 @ignore
14293 @starindex
14294 @end ignore
14295 @tindex check
14296 @ignore
14297 @starindex
14298 @end ignore
14299 @tindex Check
14300 @ignore
14301 @starindex
14302 @end ignore
14303 @tindex dddot
14304 @ignore
14305 @starindex
14306 @end ignore
14307 @tindex ddddot
14308 @ignore
14309 @starindex
14310 @end ignore
14311 @tindex dot
14312 @ignore
14313 @starindex
14314 @end ignore
14315 @tindex Dot
14316 @ignore
14317 @starindex
14318 @end ignore
14319 @tindex dotdot
14320 @ignore
14321 @starindex
14322 @end ignore
14323 @tindex DotDot
14324 @ignore
14325 @starindex
14326 @end ignore
14327 @tindex dyad
14328 @ignore
14329 @starindex
14330 @end ignore
14331 @tindex grave
14332 @ignore
14333 @starindex
14334 @end ignore
14335 @tindex Grave
14336 @ignore
14337 @starindex
14338 @end ignore
14339 @tindex hat
14340 @ignore
14341 @starindex
14342 @end ignore
14343 @tindex Hat
14344 @ignore
14345 @starindex
14346 @end ignore
14347 @tindex Prime
14348 @ignore
14349 @starindex
14350 @end ignore
14351 @tindex tilde
14352 @ignore
14353 @starindex
14354 @end ignore
14355 @tindex Tilde
14356 @ignore
14357 @starindex
14358 @end ignore
14359 @tindex under
14360 @ignore
14361 @starindex
14362 @end ignore
14363 @tindex Vec
14364 @ignore
14365 @starindex
14366 @end ignore
14367 @tindex VEC
14368 @iftex
14369 @endgroup
14370 @end iftex
14371 @example
14372 Calc TeX LaTeX eqn
14373 ---- --- ----- ---
14374 acute \acute \acute
14375 Acute \Acute
14376 bar \bar \bar bar
14377 Bar \Bar
14378 breve \breve \breve
14379 Breve \Breve
14380 check \check \check
14381 Check \Check
14382 dddot \dddot
14383 ddddot \ddddot
14384 dot \dot \dot dot
14385 Dot \Dot
14386 dotdot \ddot \ddot dotdot
14387 DotDot \Ddot
14388 dyad dyad
14389 grave \grave \grave
14390 Grave \Grave
14391 hat \hat \hat hat
14392 Hat \Hat
14393 Prime prime
14394 tilde \tilde \tilde tilde
14395 Tilde \Tilde
14396 under \underline \underline under
14397 Vec \vec \vec vec
14398 VEC \Vec
14399 @end example
14400
14401 The @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operator appears as a @code{\to} symbol:
14402 @samp{@{@var{a} \to @var{b}@}}. @TeX{} defines @code{\to} as an
14403 alias for @code{\rightarrow}. However, if the @samp{=>} is the
14404 top-level expression being formatted, a slightly different notation
14405 is used: @samp{\evalto @var{a} \to @var{b}}. The @code{\evalto}
14406 word is ignored by Calc's input routines, and is undefined in @TeX{}.
14407 You will typically want to include one of the following definitions
14408 at the top of a @TeX{} file that uses @code{\evalto}:
14409
14410 @example
14411 \def\evalto@{@}
14412 \def\evalto#1\to@{@}
14413 @end example
14414
14415 The first definition formats evaluates-to operators in the usual
14416 way. The second causes only the @var{b} part to appear in the
14417 printed document; the @var{a} part and the arrow are hidden.
14418 Another definition you may wish to use is @samp{\let\to=\Rightarrow}
14419 which causes @code{\to} to appear more like Calc's @samp{=>} symbol.
14420 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a discussion of @code{evalto}.
14421
14422 The complete set of @TeX{} control sequences that are ignored during
14423 reading is:
14424
14425 @example
14426 \hbox \mbox \text \left \right
14427 \, \> \: \; \! \quad \qquad \hfil \hfill
14428 \displaystyle \textstyle \dsize \tsize
14429 \scriptstyle \scriptscriptstyle \ssize \ssize
14430 \rm \bf \it \sl \roman \bold \italic \slanted
14431 \cal \mit \Cal \Bbb \frak \goth
14432 \evalto
14433 @end example
14434
14435 Note that, because these symbols are ignored, reading a @TeX{} or
14436 La@TeX{} formula into Calc and writing it back out may lose spacing and
14437 font information.
14438
14439 Also, the ``discretionary multiplication sign'' @samp{\*} is read
14440 the same as @samp{*}.
14441
14442 @ifinfo
14443 The @TeX{} version of this manual includes some printed examples at the
14444 end of this section.
14445 @end ifinfo
14446 @iftex
14447 Here are some examples of how various Calc formulas are formatted in @TeX{}:
14448
14449 @example
14450 @group
14451 sin(a^2 / b_i)
14452 \sin\left( {a^2 \over b_i} \right)
14453 @end group
14454 @end example
14455 @tex
14456 $$ \sin\left( a^2 \over b_i \right) $$
14457 @end tex
14458 @sp 1
14459
14460 @example
14461 @group
14462 [(3, 4), 3:4, 3 +/- 4, [3 .. inf)]
14463 [3 + 4i, @{3 \over 4@}, 3 \pm 4, [3 \ldots \infty)]
14464 @end group
14465 @end example
14466 @tex
14467 \turnoffactive
14468 $$ [3 + 4i, {3 \over 4}, 3 \pm 4, [ 3 \ldots \infty)] $$
14469 @end tex
14470 @sp 1
14471
14472 @example
14473 @group
14474 [abs(a), abs(a / b), floor(a), ceil(a / b)]
14475 [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14476 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil]
14477 @end group
14478 @end example
14479 @tex
14480 $$ [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14481 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil] $$
14482 @end tex
14483 @sp 1
14484
14485 @example
14486 @group
14487 [sin(a), sin(2 a), sin(2 + a), sin(a / b)]
14488 [\sin@{a@}, \sin@{2 a@}, \sin(2 + a),
14489 \sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)]
14490 @end group
14491 @end example
14492 @tex
14493 \turnoffactive
14494 $$ [\sin{a}, \sin{2 a}, \sin(2 + a), \sin\left( {a \over b} \right)] $$
14495 @end tex
14496 @sp 2
14497
14498 First with plain @kbd{d T}, then with @kbd{C-u d T}, then finally with
14499 @kbd{C-u - d T} (using the example definition
14500 @samp{\def\foo#1@{\tilde F(#1)@}}:
14501
14502 @example
14503 @group
14504 [f(a), foo(bar), sin(pi)]
14505 [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}]
14506 [f(a), \hbox@{foo@}(\hbox@{bar@}), \sin@{\pi@}]
14507 [f(a), \foo@{\hbox@{bar@}@}, \sin@{\pi@}]
14508 @end group
14509 @end example
14510 @tex
14511 $$ [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}] $$
14512 $$ [f(a), \hbox{foo}(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14513 $$ [f(a), \tilde F(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14514 @end tex
14515 @sp 2
14516
14517 First with @samp{\def\evalto@{@}}, then with @samp{\def\evalto#1\to@{@}}:
14518
14519 @example
14520 @group
14521 2 + 3 => 5
14522 \evalto 2 + 3 \to 5
14523 @end group
14524 @end example
14525 @tex
14526 \turnoffactive
14527 $$ 2 + 3 \to 5 $$
14528 $$ 5 $$
14529 @end tex
14530 @sp 2
14531
14532 First with standard @code{\to}, then with @samp{\let\to\Rightarrow}:
14533
14534 @example
14535 @group
14536 [2 + 3 => 5, a / 2 => (b + c) / 2]
14537 [@{2 + 3 \to 5@}, @{@{a \over 2@} \to @{b + c \over 2@}@}]
14538 @end group
14539 @end example
14540 @tex
14541 \turnoffactive
14542 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$
14543 {\let\to\Rightarrow
14544 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$}
14545 @end tex
14546 @sp 2
14547
14548 Matrices normally, then changing @code{\matrix} to @code{\pmatrix}:
14549
14550 @example
14551 @group
14552 [ [ a / b, 0 ], [ 0, 2^(x + 1) ] ]
14553 \matrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14554 \pmatrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14555 @end group
14556 @end example
14557 @tex
14558 \turnoffactive
14559 $$ \matrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14560 $$ \pmatrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14561 @end tex
14562 @sp 2
14563 @end iftex
14564
14565 @node Eqn Language Mode, Mathematica Language Mode, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Language Modes
14566 @subsection Eqn Language Mode
14567
14568 @noindent
14569 @kindex d E
14570 @pindex calc-eqn-language
14571 @dfn{Eqn} is another popular formatter for math formulas. It is
14572 designed for use with the TROFF text formatter, and comes standard
14573 with many versions of Unix. The @kbd{d E} (@code{calc-eqn-language})
14574 command selects @dfn{eqn} notation.
14575
14576 The @dfn{eqn} language's main idiosyncrasy is that whitespace plays
14577 a significant part in the parsing of the language. For example,
14578 @samp{sqrt x+1 + y} treats @samp{x+1} as the argument of the
14579 @code{sqrt} operator. @dfn{Eqn} also understands more conventional
14580 grouping using curly braces: @samp{sqrt@{x+1@} + y}. Braces are
14581 required only when the argument contains spaces.
14582
14583 In Calc's @dfn{eqn} mode, however, curly braces are required to
14584 delimit arguments of operators like @code{sqrt}. The first of the
14585 above examples would treat only the @samp{x} as the argument of
14586 @code{sqrt}, and in fact @samp{sin x+1} would be interpreted as
14587 @samp{sin * x + 1}, because @code{sin} is not a special operator
14588 in the @dfn{eqn} language. If you always surround the argument
14589 with curly braces, Calc will never misunderstand.
14590
14591 Calc also understands parentheses as grouping characters. Another
14592 peculiarity of @dfn{eqn}'s syntax makes it advisable to separate
14593 words with spaces from any surrounding characters that aren't curly
14594 braces, so Calc writes @samp{sin ( x + y )} in @dfn{eqn} mode.
14595 (The spaces around @code{sin} are important to make @dfn{eqn}
14596 recognize that @code{sin} should be typeset in a roman font, and
14597 the spaces around @code{x} and @code{y} are a good idea just in
14598 case the @dfn{eqn} document has defined special meanings for these
14599 names, too.)
14600
14601 Powers and subscripts are written with the @code{sub} and @code{sup}
14602 operators, respectively. Note that the caret symbol @samp{^} is
14603 treated the same as a space in @dfn{eqn} mode, as is the @samp{~}
14604 symbol (these are used to introduce spaces of various widths into
14605 the typeset output of @dfn{eqn}).
14606
14607 As in La@TeX{} mode, Calc's formatter omits parentheses around the
14608 arguments of functions like @code{ln} and @code{sin} if they are
14609 ``simple-looking''; in this case Calc surrounds the argument with
14610 braces, separated by a @samp{~} from the function name: @samp{sin~@{x@}}.
14611
14612 Font change codes (like @samp{roman @var{x}}) and positioning codes
14613 (like @samp{~} and @samp{down @var{n} @var{x}}) are ignored by the
14614 @dfn{eqn} reader. Also ignored are the words @code{left}, @code{right},
14615 @code{mark}, and @code{lineup}. Quotation marks in @dfn{eqn} mode input
14616 are treated the same as curly braces: @samp{sqrt "1+x"} is equivalent to
14617 @samp{sqrt @{1+x@}}; this is only an approximation to the true meaning
14618 of quotes in @dfn{eqn}, but it is good enough for most uses.
14619
14620 Accent codes (@samp{@var{x} dot}) are handled by treating them as
14621 function calls (@samp{dot(@var{x})}) internally.
14622 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a table of these accent
14623 functions. The @code{prime} accent is treated specially if it occurs on
14624 a variable or function name: @samp{f prime prime @w{( x prime )}} is
14625 stored internally as @samp{f'@w{'}(x')}. For example, taking the
14626 derivative of @samp{f(2 x)} with @kbd{a d x} will produce @samp{2 f'(2
14627 x)}, which @dfn{eqn} mode will display as @samp{2 f prime ( 2 x )}.
14628
14629 Assignments are written with the @samp{<-} (left-arrow) symbol,
14630 and @code{evalto} operators are written with @samp{->} or
14631 @samp{evalto ... ->} (@pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a discussion
14632 of this). The regular Calc symbols @samp{:=} and @samp{=>} are also
14633 recognized for these operators during reading.
14634
14635 Vectors in @dfn{eqn} mode use regular Calc square brackets, but
14636 matrices are formatted as @samp{matrix @{ ccol @{ a above b @} ... @}}.
14637 The words @code{lcol} and @code{rcol} are recognized as synonyms
14638 for @code{ccol} during input, and are generated instead of @code{ccol}
14639 if the matrix justification mode so specifies.
14640
14641 @node Mathematica Language Mode, Maple Language Mode, Eqn Language Mode, Language Modes
14642 @subsection Mathematica Language Mode
14643
14644 @noindent
14645 @kindex d M
14646 @pindex calc-mathematica-language
14647 @cindex Mathematica language
14648 The @kbd{d M} (@code{calc-mathematica-language}) command selects the
14649 conventions of Mathematica, a powerful and popular mathematical tool
14650 from Wolfram Research, Inc. Notable differences in Mathematica mode
14651 are that the names of built-in functions are capitalized, and function
14652 calls use square brackets instead of parentheses. Thus the Calc
14653 formula @samp{sin(2 x)} is entered and displayed @w{@samp{Sin[2 x]}} in
14654 Mathematica mode.
14655
14656 Vectors and matrices use curly braces in Mathematica. Complex numbers
14657 are written @samp{3 + 4 I}. The standard special constants in Calc are
14658 written @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio}, @code{EulerGamma},
14659 @code{Infinity}, @code{ComplexInfinity}, and @code{Indeterminate} in
14660 Mathematica mode.
14661 Non-decimal numbers are written, e.g., @samp{16^^7fff}. Floating-point
14662 numbers in scientific notation are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14663 Subscripts use double square brackets: @samp{a[[i]]}.
14664
14665 @node Maple Language Mode, Compositions, Mathematica Language Mode, Language Modes
14666 @subsection Maple Language Mode
14667
14668 @noindent
14669 @kindex d W
14670 @pindex calc-maple-language
14671 @cindex Maple language
14672 The @kbd{d W} (@code{calc-maple-language}) command selects the
14673 conventions of Maple, another mathematical tool from the University
14674 of Waterloo.
14675
14676 Maple's language is much like C. Underscores are allowed in symbol
14677 names; square brackets are used for subscripts; explicit @samp{*}s for
14678 multiplications are required. Use either @samp{^} or @samp{**} to
14679 denote powers.
14680
14681 Maple uses square brackets for lists and curly braces for sets. Calc
14682 interprets both notations as vectors, and displays vectors with square
14683 brackets. This means Maple sets will be converted to lists when they
14684 pass through Calc. As a special case, matrices are written as calls
14685 to the function @code{matrix}, given a list of lists as the argument,
14686 and can be read in this form or with all-capitals @code{MATRIX}.
14687
14688 The Maple interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} has no surrounding brackets;
14689 Calc reads @samp{2 .. 3} as the closed interval @samp{[2 .. 3]}, and
14690 writes any kind of interval as @samp{2 .. 3}. This means you cannot
14691 see the difference between an open and a closed interval while in
14692 Maple display mode.
14693
14694 Maple writes complex numbers as @samp{3 + 4*I}. Its special constants
14695 are @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, and @code{infinity} (all three of
14696 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} display as @code{infinity}).
14697 Floating-point numbers are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14698
14699 Among things not currently handled by Calc's Maple mode are the
14700 various quote symbols, procedures and functional operators, and
14701 inert (@samp{&}) operators.
14702
14703 @node Compositions, Syntax Tables, Maple Language Mode, Language Modes
14704 @subsection Compositions
14705
14706 @noindent
14707 @cindex Compositions
14708 There are several @dfn{composition functions} which allow you to get
14709 displays in a variety of formats similar to those in Big language
14710 mode. Most of these functions do not evaluate to anything; they are
14711 placeholders which are left in symbolic form by Calc's evaluator but
14712 are recognized by Calc's display formatting routines.
14713
14714 Two of these, @code{string} and @code{bstring}, are described elsewhere.
14715 @xref{Strings}. For example, @samp{string("ABC")} is displayed as
14716 @samp{ABC}. When viewed on the stack it will be indistinguishable from
14717 the variable @code{ABC}, but internally it will be stored as
14718 @samp{string([65, 66, 67])} and can still be manipulated this way; for
14719 example, the selection and vector commands @kbd{j 1 v v j u} would
14720 select the vector portion of this object and reverse the elements, then
14721 deselect to reveal a string whose characters had been reversed.
14722
14723 The composition functions do the same thing in all language modes
14724 (although their components will of course be formatted in the current
14725 language mode). The one exception is Unformatted mode (@kbd{d U}),
14726 which does not give the composition functions any special treatment.
14727 The functions are discussed here because of their relationship to
14728 the language modes.
14729
14730 @menu
14731 * Composition Basics::
14732 * Horizontal Compositions::
14733 * Vertical Compositions::
14734 * Other Compositions::
14735 * Information about Compositions::
14736 * User-Defined Compositions::
14737 @end menu
14738
14739 @node Composition Basics, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions, Compositions
14740 @subsubsection Composition Basics
14741
14742 @noindent
14743 Compositions are generally formed by stacking formulas together
14744 horizontally or vertically in various ways. Those formulas are
14745 themselves compositions. @TeX{} users will find this analogous
14746 to @TeX{}'s ``boxes.'' Each multi-line composition has a
14747 @dfn{baseline}; horizontal compositions use the baselines to
14748 decide how formulas should be positioned relative to one another.
14749 For example, in the Big mode formula
14750
14751 @example
14752 @group
14753 2
14754 a + b
14755 17 + ------
14756 c
14757 @end group
14758 @end example
14759
14760 @noindent
14761 the second term of the sum is four lines tall and has line three as
14762 its baseline. Thus when the term is combined with 17, line three
14763 is placed on the same level as the baseline of 17.
14764
14765 @tex
14766 \bigskip
14767 @end tex
14768
14769 Another important composition concept is @dfn{precedence}. This is
14770 an integer that represents the binding strength of various operators.
14771 For example, @samp{*} has higher precedence (195) than @samp{+} (180),
14772 which means that @samp{(a * b) + c} will be formatted without the
14773 parentheses, but @samp{a * (b + c)} will keep the parentheses.
14774
14775 The operator table used by normal and Big language modes has the
14776 following precedences:
14777
14778 @example
14779 _ 1200 @r{(subscripts)}
14780 % 1100 @r{(as in n}%@r{)}
14781 - 1000 @r{(as in }-@r{n)}
14782 ! 1000 @r{(as in }!@r{n)}
14783 mod 400
14784 +/- 300
14785 !! 210 @r{(as in n}!!@r{)}
14786 ! 210 @r{(as in n}!@r{)}
14787 ^ 200
14788 * 195 @r{(or implicit multiplication)}
14789 / % \ 190
14790 + - 180 @r{(as in a}+@r{b)}
14791 | 170
14792 < = 160 @r{(and other relations)}
14793 && 110
14794 || 100
14795 ? : 90
14796 !!! 85
14797 &&& 80
14798 ||| 75
14799 := 50
14800 :: 45
14801 => 40
14802 @end example
14803
14804 The general rule is that if an operator with precedence @expr{n}
14805 occurs as an argument to an operator with precedence @expr{m}, then
14806 the argument is enclosed in parentheses if @expr{n < m}. Top-level
14807 expressions and expressions which are function arguments, vector
14808 components, etc., are formatted with precedence zero (so that they
14809 normally never get additional parentheses).
14810
14811 For binary left-associative operators like @samp{+}, the righthand
14812 argument is actually formatted with one-higher precedence than shown
14813 in the table. This makes sure @samp{(a + b) + c} omits the parentheses,
14814 but the unnatural form @samp{a + (b + c)} keeps its parentheses.
14815 Right-associative operators like @samp{^} format the lefthand argument
14816 with one-higher precedence.
14817
14818 @ignore
14819 @starindex
14820 @end ignore
14821 @tindex cprec
14822 The @code{cprec} function formats an expression with an arbitrary
14823 precedence. For example, @samp{cprec(abc, 185)} will combine into
14824 sums and products as follows: @samp{7 + abc}, @samp{7 (abc)} (because
14825 this @code{cprec} form has higher precedence than addition, but lower
14826 precedence than multiplication).
14827
14828 @tex
14829 \bigskip
14830 @end tex
14831
14832 A final composition issue is @dfn{line breaking}. Calc uses two
14833 different strategies for ``flat'' and ``non-flat'' compositions.
14834 A non-flat composition is anything that appears on multiple lines
14835 (not counting line breaking). Examples would be matrices and Big
14836 mode powers and quotients. Non-flat compositions are displayed
14837 exactly as specified. If they come out wider than the current
14838 window, you must use horizontal scrolling (@kbd{<} and @kbd{>}) to
14839 view them.
14840
14841 Flat compositions, on the other hand, will be broken across several
14842 lines if they are too wide to fit the window. Certain points in a
14843 composition are noted internally as @dfn{break points}. Calc's
14844 general strategy is to fill each line as much as possible, then to
14845 move down to the next line starting at the first break point that
14846 didn't fit. However, the line breaker understands the hierarchical
14847 structure of formulas. It will not break an ``inner'' formula if
14848 it can use an earlier break point from an ``outer'' formula instead.
14849 For example, a vector of sums might be formatted as:
14850
14851 @example
14852 @group
14853 [ a + b + c, d + e + f,
14854 g + h + i, j + k + l, m ]
14855 @end group
14856 @end example
14857
14858 @noindent
14859 If the @samp{m} can fit, then so, it seems, could the @samp{g}.
14860 But Calc prefers to break at the comma since the comma is part
14861 of a ``more outer'' formula. Calc would break at a plus sign
14862 only if it had to, say, if the very first sum in the vector had
14863 itself been too large to fit.
14864
14865 Of the composition functions described below, only @code{choriz}
14866 generates break points. The @code{bstring} function (@pxref{Strings})
14867 also generates breakable items: A break point is added after every
14868 space (or group of spaces) except for spaces at the very beginning or
14869 end of the string.
14870
14871 Composition functions themselves count as levels in the formula
14872 hierarchy, so a @code{choriz} that is a component of a larger
14873 @code{choriz} will be less likely to be broken. As a special case,
14874 if a @code{bstring} occurs as a component of a @code{choriz} or
14875 @code{choriz}-like object (such as a vector or a list of arguments
14876 in a function call), then the break points in that @code{bstring}
14877 will be on the same level as the break points of the surrounding
14878 object.
14879
14880 @node Horizontal Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Composition Basics, Compositions
14881 @subsubsection Horizontal Compositions
14882
14883 @noindent
14884 @ignore
14885 @starindex
14886 @end ignore
14887 @tindex choriz
14888 The @code{choriz} function takes a vector of objects and composes
14889 them horizontally. For example, @samp{choriz([17, a b/c, d])} formats
14890 as @w{@samp{17a b / cd}} in Normal language mode, or as
14891
14892 @example
14893 @group
14894 a b
14895 17---d
14896 c
14897 @end group
14898 @end example
14899
14900 @noindent
14901 in Big language mode. This is actually one case of the general
14902 function @samp{choriz(@var{vec}, @var{sep}, @var{prec})}, where
14903 either or both of @var{sep} and @var{prec} may be omitted.
14904 @var{Prec} gives the @dfn{precedence} to use when formatting
14905 each of the components of @var{vec}. The default precedence is
14906 the precedence from the surrounding environment.
14907
14908 @var{Sep} is a string (i.e., a vector of character codes as might
14909 be entered with @code{" "} notation) which should separate components
14910 of the composition. Also, if @var{sep} is given, the line breaker
14911 will allow lines to be broken after each occurrence of @var{sep}.
14912 If @var{sep} is omitted, the composition will not be breakable
14913 (unless any of its component compositions are breakable).
14914
14915 For example, @samp{2 choriz([a, b c, d = e], " + ", 180)} is
14916 formatted as @samp{2 a + b c + (d = e)}. To get the @code{choriz}
14917 to have precedence 180 ``outwards'' as well as ``inwards,''
14918 enclose it in a @code{cprec} form: @samp{2 cprec(choriz(...), 180)}
14919 formats as @samp{2 (a + b c + (d = e))}.
14920
14921 The baseline of a horizontal composition is the same as the
14922 baselines of the component compositions, which are all aligned.
14923
14924 @node Vertical Compositions, Other Compositions, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions
14925 @subsubsection Vertical Compositions
14926
14927 @noindent
14928 @ignore
14929 @starindex
14930 @end ignore
14931 @tindex cvert
14932 The @code{cvert} function makes a vertical composition. Each
14933 component of the vector is centered in a column. The baseline of
14934 the result is by default the top line of the resulting composition.
14935 For example, @samp{f(cvert([a, bb, ccc]), cvert([a^2 + 1, b^2]))}
14936 formats in Big mode as
14937
14938 @example
14939 @group
14940 f( a , 2 )
14941 bb a + 1
14942 ccc 2
14943 b
14944 @end group
14945 @end example
14946
14947 @ignore
14948 @starindex
14949 @end ignore
14950 @tindex cbase
14951 There are several special composition functions that work only as
14952 components of a vertical composition. The @code{cbase} function
14953 controls the baseline of the vertical composition; the baseline
14954 will be the same as the baseline of whatever component is enclosed
14955 in @code{cbase}. Thus @samp{f(cvert([a, cbase(bb), ccc]),
14956 cvert([a^2 + 1, cbase(b^2)]))} displays as
14957
14958 @example
14959 @group
14960 2
14961 a + 1
14962 a 2
14963 f(bb , b )
14964 ccc
14965 @end group
14966 @end example
14967
14968 @ignore
14969 @starindex
14970 @end ignore
14971 @tindex ctbase
14972 @ignore
14973 @starindex
14974 @end ignore
14975 @tindex cbbase
14976 There are also @code{ctbase} and @code{cbbase} functions which
14977 make the baseline of the vertical composition equal to the top
14978 or bottom line (rather than the baseline) of that component.
14979 Thus @samp{cvert([cbase(a / b)]) + cvert([ctbase(a / b)]) +
14980 cvert([cbbase(a / b)])} gives
14981
14982 @example
14983 @group
14984 a
14985 a -
14986 - + a + b
14987 b -
14988 b
14989 @end group
14990 @end example
14991
14992 There should be only one @code{cbase}, @code{ctbase}, or @code{cbbase}
14993 function in a given vertical composition. These functions can also
14994 be written with no arguments: @samp{ctbase()} is a zero-height object
14995 which means the baseline is the top line of the following item, and
14996 @samp{cbbase()} means the baseline is the bottom line of the preceding
14997 item.
14998
14999 @ignore
15000 @starindex
15001 @end ignore
15002 @tindex crule
15003 The @code{crule} function builds a ``rule,'' or horizontal line,
15004 across a vertical composition. By itself @samp{crule()} uses @samp{-}
15005 characters to build the rule. You can specify any other character,
15006 e.g., @samp{crule("=")}. The argument must be a character code or
15007 vector of exactly one character code. It is repeated to match the
15008 width of the widest item in the stack. For example, a quotient
15009 with a thick line is @samp{cvert([a + 1, cbase(crule("=")), b^2])}:
15010
15011 @example
15012 @group
15013 a + 1
15014 =====
15015 2
15016 b
15017 @end group
15018 @end example
15019
15020 @ignore
15021 @starindex
15022 @end ignore
15023 @tindex clvert
15024 @ignore
15025 @starindex
15026 @end ignore
15027 @tindex crvert
15028 Finally, the functions @code{clvert} and @code{crvert} act exactly
15029 like @code{cvert} except that the items are left- or right-justified
15030 in the stack. Thus @samp{clvert([a, bb, ccc]) + crvert([a, bb, ccc])}
15031 gives:
15032
15033 @example
15034 @group
15035 a + a
15036 bb bb
15037 ccc ccc
15038 @end group
15039 @end example
15040
15041 Like @code{choriz}, the vertical compositions accept a second argument
15042 which gives the precedence to use when formatting the components.
15043 Vertical compositions do not support separator strings.
15044
15045 @node Other Compositions, Information about Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Compositions
15046 @subsubsection Other Compositions
15047
15048 @noindent
15049 @ignore
15050 @starindex
15051 @end ignore
15052 @tindex csup
15053 The @code{csup} function builds a superscripted expression. For
15054 example, @samp{csup(a, b)} looks the same as @samp{a^b} does in Big
15055 language mode. This is essentially a horizontal composition of
15056 @samp{a} and @samp{b}, where @samp{b} is shifted up so that its
15057 bottom line is one above the baseline.
15058
15059 @ignore
15060 @starindex
15061 @end ignore
15062 @tindex csub
15063 Likewise, the @code{csub} function builds a subscripted expression.
15064 This shifts @samp{b} down so that its top line is one below the
15065 bottom line of @samp{a} (note that this is not quite analogous to
15066 @code{csup}). Other arrangements can be obtained by using
15067 @code{choriz} and @code{cvert} directly.
15068
15069 @ignore
15070 @starindex
15071 @end ignore
15072 @tindex cflat
15073 The @code{cflat} function formats its argument in ``flat'' mode,
15074 as obtained by @samp{d O}, if the current language mode is normal
15075 or Big. It has no effect in other language modes. For example,
15076 @samp{a^(b/c)} is formatted by Big mode like @samp{csup(a, cflat(b/c))}
15077 to improve its readability.
15078
15079 @ignore
15080 @starindex
15081 @end ignore
15082 @tindex cspace
15083 The @code{cspace} function creates horizontal space. For example,
15084 @samp{cspace(4)} is effectively the same as @samp{string(" ")}.
15085 A second string (i.e., vector of characters) argument is repeated
15086 instead of the space character. For example, @samp{cspace(4, "ab")}
15087 looks like @samp{abababab}. If the second argument is not a string,
15088 it is formatted in the normal way and then several copies of that
15089 are composed together: @samp{cspace(4, a^2)} yields
15090
15091 @example
15092 @group
15093 2 2 2 2
15094 a a a a
15095 @end group
15096 @end example
15097
15098 @noindent
15099 If the number argument is zero, this is a zero-width object.
15100
15101 @ignore
15102 @starindex
15103 @end ignore
15104 @tindex cvspace
15105 The @code{cvspace} function creates vertical space, or a vertical
15106 stack of copies of a certain string or formatted object. The
15107 baseline is the center line of the resulting stack. A numerical
15108 argument of zero will produce an object which contributes zero
15109 height if used in a vertical composition.
15110
15111 @ignore
15112 @starindex
15113 @end ignore
15114 @tindex ctspace
15115 @ignore
15116 @starindex
15117 @end ignore
15118 @tindex cbspace
15119 There are also @code{ctspace} and @code{cbspace} functions which
15120 create vertical space with the baseline the same as the baseline
15121 of the top or bottom copy, respectively, of the second argument.
15122 Thus @samp{cvspace(2, a/b) + ctspace(2, a/b) + cbspace(2, a/b)}
15123 displays as:
15124
15125 @example
15126 @group
15127 a
15128 -
15129 a b
15130 - a a
15131 b + - + -
15132 a b b
15133 - a
15134 b -
15135 b
15136 @end group
15137 @end example
15138
15139 @node Information about Compositions, User-Defined Compositions, Other Compositions, Compositions
15140 @subsubsection Information about Compositions
15141
15142 @noindent
15143 The functions in this section are actual functions; they compose their
15144 arguments according to the current language and other display modes,
15145 then return a certain measurement of the composition as an integer.
15146
15147 @ignore
15148 @starindex
15149 @end ignore
15150 @tindex cwidth
15151 The @code{cwidth} function measures the width, in characters, of a
15152 composition. For example, @samp{cwidth(a + b)} is 5, and
15153 @samp{cwidth(a / b)} is 5 in Normal mode, 1 in Big mode, and 11 in
15154 @TeX{} mode (for @samp{@{a \over b@}}). The argument may involve
15155 the composition functions described in this section.
15156
15157 @ignore
15158 @starindex
15159 @end ignore
15160 @tindex cheight
15161 The @code{cheight} function measures the height of a composition.
15162 This is the total number of lines in the argument's printed form.
15163
15164 @ignore
15165 @starindex
15166 @end ignore
15167 @tindex cascent
15168 @ignore
15169 @starindex
15170 @end ignore
15171 @tindex cdescent
15172 The functions @code{cascent} and @code{cdescent} measure the amount
15173 of the height that is above (and including) the baseline, or below
15174 the baseline, respectively. Thus @samp{cascent(@var{x}) + cdescent(@var{x})}
15175 always equals @samp{cheight(@var{x})}. For a one-line formula like
15176 @samp{a + b}, @code{cascent} returns 1 and @code{cdescent} returns 0.
15177 For @samp{a / b} in Big mode, @code{cascent} returns 2 and @code{cdescent}
15178 returns 1. The only formula for which @code{cascent} will return zero
15179 is @samp{cvspace(0)} or equivalents.
15180
15181 @node User-Defined Compositions, , Information about Compositions, Compositions
15182 @subsubsection User-Defined Compositions
15183
15184 @noindent
15185 @kindex Z C
15186 @pindex calc-user-define-composition
15187 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command lets you
15188 define the display format for any algebraic function. You provide a
15189 formula containing a certain number of argument variables on the stack.
15190 Any time Calc formats a call to the specified function in the current
15191 language mode and with that number of arguments, Calc effectively
15192 replaces the function call with that formula with the arguments
15193 replaced.
15194
15195 Calc builds the default argument list by sorting all the variable names
15196 that appear in the formula into alphabetical order. You can edit this
15197 argument list before pressing @key{RET} if you wish. Any variables in
15198 the formula that do not appear in the argument list will be displayed
15199 literally; any arguments that do not appear in the formula will not
15200 affect the display at all.
15201
15202 You can define formats for built-in functions, for functions you have
15203 defined with @kbd{Z F} (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}), or for functions
15204 which have no definitions but are being used as purely syntactic objects.
15205 You can define different formats for each language mode, and for each
15206 number of arguments, using a succession of @kbd{Z C} commands. When
15207 Calc formats a function call, it first searches for a format defined
15208 for the current language mode (and number of arguments); if there is
15209 none, it uses the format defined for the Normal language mode. If
15210 neither format exists, Calc uses its built-in standard format for that
15211 function (usually just @samp{@var{func}(@var{args})}).
15212
15213 If you execute @kbd{Z C} with the number 0 on the stack instead of a
15214 formula, any defined formats for the function in the current language
15215 mode will be removed. The function will revert to its standard format.
15216
15217 For example, the default format for the binomial coefficient function
15218 @samp{choose(n, m)} in the Big language mode is
15219
15220 @example
15221 @group
15222 n
15223 ( )
15224 m
15225 @end group
15226 @end example
15227
15228 @noindent
15229 You might prefer the notation,
15230
15231 @example
15232 @group
15233 C
15234 n m
15235 @end group
15236 @end example
15237
15238 @noindent
15239 To define this notation, first make sure you are in Big mode,
15240 then put the formula
15241
15242 @smallexample
15243 choriz([cvert([cvspace(1), n]), C, cvert([cvspace(1), m])])
15244 @end smallexample
15245
15246 @noindent
15247 on the stack and type @kbd{Z C}. Answer the first prompt with
15248 @code{choose}. The second prompt will be the default argument list
15249 of @samp{(C m n)}. Edit this list to be @samp{(n m)} and press
15250 @key{RET}. Now, try it out: For example, turn simplification
15251 off with @kbd{m O} and enter @samp{choose(a,b) + choose(7,3)}
15252 as an algebraic entry.
15253
15254 @example
15255 @group
15256 C + C
15257 a b 7 3
15258 @end group
15259 @end example
15260
15261 As another example, let's define the usual notation for Stirling
15262 numbers of the first kind, @samp{stir1(n, m)}. This is just like
15263 the regular format for binomial coefficients but with square brackets
15264 instead of parentheses.
15265
15266 @smallexample
15267 choriz([string("["), cvert([n, cbase(cvspace(1)), m]), string("]")])
15268 @end smallexample
15269
15270 Now type @kbd{Z C stir1 @key{RET}}, edit the argument list to
15271 @samp{(n m)}, and type @key{RET}.
15272
15273 The formula provided to @kbd{Z C} usually will involve composition
15274 functions, but it doesn't have to. Putting the formula @samp{a + b + c}
15275 onto the stack and typing @kbd{Z C foo @key{RET} @key{RET}} would define
15276 the function @samp{foo(x,y,z)} to display like @samp{x + y + z}.
15277 This ``sum'' will act exactly like a real sum for all formatting
15278 purposes (it will be parenthesized the same, and so on). However
15279 it will be computationally unrelated to a sum. For example, the
15280 formula @samp{2 * foo(1, 2, 3)} will display as @samp{2 (1 + 2 + 3)}.
15281 Operator precedences have caused the ``sum'' to be written in
15282 parentheses, but the arguments have not actually been summed.
15283 (Generally a display format like this would be undesirable, since
15284 it can easily be confused with a real sum.)
15285
15286 The special function @code{eval} can be used inside a @kbd{Z C}
15287 composition formula to cause all or part of the formula to be
15288 evaluated at display time. For example, if the formula is
15289 @samp{a + eval(b + c)}, then @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} will be displayed
15290 as @samp{1 + 5}. Evaluation will use the default simplifications,
15291 regardless of the current simplification mode. There are also
15292 @code{evalsimp} and @code{evalextsimp} which simplify as if by
15293 @kbd{a s} and @kbd{a e} (respectively). Note that these ``functions''
15294 operate only in the context of composition formulas (and also in
15295 rewrite rules, where they serve a similar purpose; @pxref{Rewrite
15296 Rules}). On the stack, a call to @code{eval} will be left in
15297 symbolic form.
15298
15299 It is not a good idea to use @code{eval} except as a last resort.
15300 It can cause the display of formulas to be extremely slow. For
15301 example, while @samp{eval(a + b)} might seem quite fast and simple,
15302 there are several situations where it could be slow. For example,
15303 @samp{a} and/or @samp{b} could be polar complex numbers, in which
15304 case doing the sum requires trigonometry. Or, @samp{a} could be
15305 the factorial @samp{fact(100)} which is unevaluated because you
15306 have typed @kbd{m O}; @code{eval} will evaluate it anyway to
15307 produce a large, unwieldy integer.
15308
15309 You can save your display formats permanently using the @kbd{Z P}
15310 command (@pxref{Creating User Keys}).
15311
15312 @node Syntax Tables, , Compositions, Language Modes
15313 @subsection Syntax Tables
15314
15315 @noindent
15316 @cindex Syntax tables
15317 @cindex Parsing formulas, customized
15318 Syntax tables do for input what compositions do for output: They
15319 allow you to teach custom notations to Calc's formula parser.
15320 Calc keeps a separate syntax table for each language mode.
15321
15322 (Note that the Calc ``syntax tables'' discussed here are completely
15323 unrelated to the syntax tables described in the Emacs manual.)
15324
15325 @kindex Z S
15326 @pindex calc-edit-user-syntax
15327 The @kbd{Z S} (@code{calc-edit-user-syntax}) command edits the
15328 syntax table for the current language mode. If you want your
15329 syntax to work in any language, define it in the Normal language
15330 mode. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing the syntax table, or
15331 @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @kbd{m m} command saves all
15332 the syntax tables along with the other mode settings;
15333 @pxref{General Mode Commands}.
15334
15335 @menu
15336 * Syntax Table Basics::
15337 * Precedence in Syntax Tables::
15338 * Advanced Syntax Patterns::
15339 * Conditional Syntax Rules::
15340 @end menu
15341
15342 @node Syntax Table Basics, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15343 @subsubsection Syntax Table Basics
15344
15345 @noindent
15346 @dfn{Parsing} is the process of converting a raw string of characters,
15347 such as you would type in during algebraic entry, into a Calc formula.
15348 Calc's parser works in two stages. First, the input is broken down
15349 into @dfn{tokens}, such as words, numbers, and punctuation symbols
15350 like @samp{+}, @samp{:=}, and @samp{+/-}. Space between tokens is
15351 ignored (except when it serves to separate adjacent words). Next,
15352 the parser matches this string of tokens against various built-in
15353 syntactic patterns, such as ``an expression followed by @samp{+}
15354 followed by another expression'' or ``a name followed by @samp{(},
15355 zero or more expressions separated by commas, and @samp{)}.''
15356
15357 A @dfn{syntax table} is a list of user-defined @dfn{syntax rules},
15358 which allow you to specify new patterns to define your own
15359 favorite input notations. Calc's parser always checks the syntax
15360 table for the current language mode, then the table for the Normal
15361 language mode, before it uses its built-in rules to parse an
15362 algebraic formula you have entered. Each syntax rule should go on
15363 its own line; it consists of a @dfn{pattern}, a @samp{:=} symbol,
15364 and a Calc formula with an optional @dfn{condition}. (Syntax rules
15365 resemble algebraic rewrite rules, but the notation for patterns is
15366 completely different.)
15367
15368 A syntax pattern is a list of tokens, separated by spaces.
15369 Except for a few special symbols, tokens in syntax patterns are
15370 matched literally, from left to right. For example, the rule,
15371
15372 @example
15373 foo ( ) := 2+3
15374 @end example
15375
15376 @noindent
15377 would cause Calc to parse the formula @samp{4+foo()*5} as if it
15378 were @samp{4+(2+3)*5}. Notice that the parentheses were written
15379 as two separate tokens in the rule. As a result, the rule works
15380 for both @samp{foo()} and @w{@samp{foo ( )}}. If we had written
15381 the rule as @samp{foo () := 2+3}, then Calc would treat @samp{()}
15382 as a single, indivisible token, so that @w{@samp{foo( )}} would
15383 not be recognized by the rule. (It would be parsed as a regular
15384 zero-argument function call instead.) In fact, this rule would
15385 also make trouble for the rest of Calc's parser: An unrelated
15386 formula like @samp{bar()} would now be tokenized into @samp{bar ()}
15387 instead of @samp{bar ( )}, so that the standard parser for function
15388 calls would no longer recognize it!
15389
15390 While it is possible to make a token with a mixture of letters
15391 and punctuation symbols, this is not recommended. It is better to
15392 break it into several tokens, as we did with @samp{foo()} above.
15393
15394 The symbol @samp{#} in a syntax pattern matches any Calc expression.
15395 On the righthand side, the things that matched the @samp{#}s can
15396 be referred to as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on (where @samp{#1}
15397 matches the leftmost @samp{#} in the pattern). For example, these
15398 rules match a user-defined function, prefix operator, infix operator,
15399 and postfix operator, respectively:
15400
15401 @example
15402 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15403 foo # := myprefix(#1)
15404 # foo # := myinfix(#1,#2)
15405 # foo := mypostfix(#1)
15406 @end example
15407
15408 Thus @samp{foo(3)} will parse as @samp{myfunc(3)}, and @samp{2+3 foo}
15409 will parse as @samp{mypostfix(2+3)}.
15410
15411 It is important to write the first two rules in the order shown,
15412 because Calc tries rules in order from first to last. If the
15413 pattern @samp{foo #} came first, it would match anything that could
15414 match the @samp{foo ( # )} rule, since an expression in parentheses
15415 is itself a valid expression. Thus the @w{@samp{foo ( # )}} rule would
15416 never get to match anything. Likewise, the last two rules must be
15417 written in the order shown or else @samp{3 foo 4} will be parsed as
15418 @samp{mypostfix(3) * 4}. (Of course, the best way to avoid these
15419 ambiguities is not to use the same symbol in more than one way at
15420 the same time! In case you're not convinced, try the following
15421 exercise: How will the above rules parse the input @samp{foo(3,4)},
15422 if at all? Work it out for yourself, then try it in Calc and see.)
15423
15424 Calc is quite flexible about what sorts of patterns are allowed.
15425 The only rule is that every pattern must begin with a literal
15426 token (like @samp{foo} in the first two patterns above), or with
15427 a @samp{#} followed by a literal token (as in the last two
15428 patterns). After that, any mixture is allowed, although putting
15429 two @samp{#}s in a row will not be very useful since two
15430 expressions with nothing between them will be parsed as one
15431 expression that uses implicit multiplication.
15432
15433 As a more practical example, Maple uses the notation
15434 @samp{sum(a(i), i=1..10)} for sums, which Calc's Maple mode doesn't
15435 recognize at present. To handle this syntax, we simply add the
15436 rule,
15437
15438 @example
15439 sum ( # , # = # .. # ) := sum(#1,#2,#3,#4)
15440 @end example
15441
15442 @noindent
15443 to the Maple mode syntax table. As another example, C mode can't
15444 read assignment operators like @samp{++} and @samp{*=}. We can
15445 define these operators quite easily:
15446
15447 @example
15448 # *= # := muleq(#1,#2)
15449 # ++ := postinc(#1)
15450 ++ # := preinc(#1)
15451 @end example
15452
15453 @noindent
15454 To complete the job, we would use corresponding composition functions
15455 and @kbd{Z C} to cause these functions to display in their respective
15456 Maple and C notations. (Note that the C example ignores issues of
15457 operator precedence, which are discussed in the next section.)
15458
15459 You can enclose any token in quotes to prevent its usual
15460 interpretation in syntax patterns:
15461
15462 @example
15463 # ":=" # := becomes(#1,#2)
15464 @end example
15465
15466 Quotes also allow you to include spaces in a token, although once
15467 again it is generally better to use two tokens than one token with
15468 an embedded space. To include an actual quotation mark in a quoted
15469 token, precede it with a backslash. (This also works to include
15470 backslashes in tokens.)
15471
15472 @example
15473 # "bad token" # "/\"\\" # := silly(#1,#2,#3)
15474 @end example
15475
15476 @noindent
15477 This will parse @samp{3 bad token 4 /"\ 5} to @samp{silly(3,4,5)}.
15478
15479 The token @kbd{#} has a predefined meaning in Calc's formula parser;
15480 it is not legal to use @samp{"#"} in a syntax rule. However, longer
15481 tokens that include the @samp{#} character are allowed. Also, while
15482 @samp{"$"} and @samp{"\""} are allowed as tokens, their presence in
15483 the syntax table will prevent those characters from working in their
15484 usual ways (referring to stack entries and quoting strings,
15485 respectively).
15486
15487 Finally, the notation @samp{%%} anywhere in a syntax table causes
15488 the rest of the line to be ignored as a comment.
15489
15490 @node Precedence in Syntax Tables, Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Table Basics, Syntax Tables
15491 @subsubsection Precedence
15492
15493 @noindent
15494 Different operators are generally assigned different @dfn{precedences}.
15495 By default, an operator defined by a rule like
15496
15497 @example
15498 # foo # := foo(#1,#2)
15499 @end example
15500
15501 @noindent
15502 will have an extremely low precedence, so that @samp{2*3+4 foo 5 == 6}
15503 will be parsed as @samp{(2*3+4) foo (5 == 6)}. To change the
15504 precedence of an operator, use the notation @samp{#/@var{p}} in
15505 place of @samp{#}, where @var{p} is an integer precedence level.
15506 For example, 185 lies between the precedences for @samp{+} and
15507 @samp{*}, so if we change this rule to
15508
15509 @example
15510 #/185 foo #/186 := foo(#1,#2)
15511 @end example
15512
15513 @noindent
15514 then @samp{2+3 foo 4*5} will be parsed as @samp{2+(3 foo (4*5))}.
15515 Also, because we've given the righthand expression slightly higher
15516 precedence, our new operator will be left-associative:
15517 @samp{1 foo 2 foo 3} will be parsed as @samp{(1 foo 2) foo 3}.
15518 By raising the precedence of the lefthand expression instead, we
15519 can create a right-associative operator.
15520
15521 @xref{Composition Basics}, for a table of precedences of the
15522 standard Calc operators. For the precedences of operators in other
15523 language modes, look in the Calc source file @file{calc-lang.el}.
15524
15525 @node Advanced Syntax Patterns, Conditional Syntax Rules, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15526 @subsubsection Advanced Syntax Patterns
15527
15528 @noindent
15529 To match a function with a variable number of arguments, you could
15530 write
15531
15532 @example
15533 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15534 foo ( # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2)
15535 foo ( # , # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2,#3)
15536 @end example
15537
15538 @noindent
15539 but this isn't very elegant. To match variable numbers of items,
15540 Calc uses some notations inspired regular expressions and the
15541 ``extended BNF'' style used by some language designers.
15542
15543 @example
15544 foo ( @{ # @}*, ) := apply(myfunc,#1)
15545 @end example
15546
15547 The token @samp{@{} introduces a repeated or optional portion.
15548 One of the three tokens @samp{@}*}, @samp{@}+}, or @samp{@}?}
15549 ends the portion. These will match zero or more, one or more,
15550 or zero or one copies of the enclosed pattern, respectively.
15551 In addition, @samp{@}*} and @samp{@}+} can be followed by a
15552 separator token (with no space in between, as shown above).
15553 Thus @samp{@{ # @}*,} matches nothing, or one expression, or
15554 several expressions separated by commas.
15555
15556 A complete @samp{@{ ... @}} item matches as a vector of the
15557 items that matched inside it. For example, the above rule will
15558 match @samp{foo(1,2,3)} to get @samp{apply(myfunc,[1,2,3])}.
15559 The Calc @code{apply} function takes a function name and a vector
15560 of arguments and builds a call to the function with those
15561 arguments, so the net result is the formula @samp{myfunc(1,2,3)}.
15562
15563 If the body of a @samp{@{ ... @}} contains several @samp{#}s
15564 (or nested @samp{@{ ... @}} constructs), then the items will be
15565 strung together into the resulting vector. If the body
15566 does not contain anything but literal tokens, the result will
15567 always be an empty vector.
15568
15569 @example
15570 foo ( @{ # , # @}+, ) := bar(#1)
15571 foo ( @{ @{ # @}*, @}*; ) := matrix(#1)
15572 @end example
15573
15574 @noindent
15575 will parse @samp{foo(1, 2, 3, 4)} as @samp{bar([1, 2, 3, 4])}, and
15576 @samp{foo(1, 2; 3, 4)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2], [3, 4]])}. Also, after
15577 some thought it's easy to see how this pair of rules will parse
15578 @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2, 3]])}, since the first
15579 rule will only match an even number of arguments. The rule
15580
15581 @example
15582 foo ( # @{ , # , # @}? ) := bar(#1,#2)
15583 @end example
15584
15585 @noindent
15586 will parse @samp{foo(2,3,4)} as @samp{bar(2,[3,4])}, and
15587 @samp{foo(2)} as @samp{bar(2,[])}.
15588
15589 The notation @samp{@{ ... @}?.} (note the trailing period) works
15590 just the same as regular @samp{@{ ... @}?}, except that it does not
15591 count as an argument; the following two rules are equivalent:
15592
15593 @example
15594 foo ( # , @{ also @}? # ) := bar(#1,#3)
15595 foo ( # , @{ also @}?. # ) := bar(#1,#2)
15596 @end example
15597
15598 @noindent
15599 Note that in the first case the optional text counts as @samp{#2},
15600 which will always be an empty vector, but in the second case no
15601 empty vector is produced.
15602
15603 Another variant is @samp{@{ ... @}?$}, which means the body is
15604 optional only at the end of the input formula. All built-in syntax
15605 rules in Calc use this for closing delimiters, so that during
15606 algebraic entry you can type @kbd{[sqrt(2), sqrt(3 @key{RET}}, omitting
15607 the closing parenthesis and bracket. Calc does this automatically
15608 for trailing @samp{)}, @samp{]}, and @samp{>} tokens in syntax
15609 rules, but you can use @samp{@{ ... @}?$} explicitly to get
15610 this effect with any token (such as @samp{"@}"} or @samp{end}).
15611 Like @samp{@{ ... @}?.}, this notation does not count as an
15612 argument. Conversely, you can use quotes, as in @samp{")"}, to
15613 prevent a closing-delimiter token from being automatically treated
15614 as optional.
15615
15616 Calc's parser does not have full backtracking, which means some
15617 patterns will not work as you might expect:
15618
15619 @example
15620 foo ( @{ # , @}? # , # ) := bar(#1,#2,#3)
15621 @end example
15622
15623 @noindent
15624 Here we are trying to make the first argument optional, so that
15625 @samp{foo(2,3)} parses as @samp{bar([],2,3)}. Unfortunately, Calc
15626 first tries to match @samp{2,} against the optional part of the
15627 pattern, finds a match, and so goes ahead to match the rest of the
15628 pattern. Later on it will fail to match the second comma, but it
15629 doesn't know how to go back and try the other alternative at that
15630 point. One way to get around this would be to use two rules:
15631
15632 @example
15633 foo ( # , # , # ) := bar([#1],#2,#3)
15634 foo ( # , # ) := bar([],#1,#2)
15635 @end example
15636
15637 More precisely, when Calc wants to match an optional or repeated
15638 part of a pattern, it scans forward attempting to match that part.
15639 If it reaches the end of the optional part without failing, it
15640 ``finalizes'' its choice and proceeds. If it fails, though, it
15641 backs up and tries the other alternative. Thus Calc has ``partial''
15642 backtracking. A fully backtracking parser would go on to make sure
15643 the rest of the pattern matched before finalizing the choice.
15644
15645 @node Conditional Syntax Rules, , Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Tables
15646 @subsubsection Conditional Syntax Rules
15647
15648 @noindent
15649 It is possible to attach a @dfn{condition} to a syntax rule. For
15650 example, the rules
15651
15652 @example
15653 foo ( # ) := ifoo(#1) :: integer(#1)
15654 foo ( # ) := gfoo(#1)
15655 @end example
15656
15657 @noindent
15658 will parse @samp{foo(3)} as @samp{ifoo(3)}, but will parse
15659 @samp{foo(3.5)} and @samp{foo(x)} as calls to @code{gfoo}. Any
15660 number of conditions may be attached; all must be true for the
15661 rule to succeed. A condition is ``true'' if it evaluates to a
15662 nonzero number. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a list of Calc
15663 functions like @code{integer} that perform logical tests.
15664
15665 The exact sequence of events is as follows: When Calc tries a
15666 rule, it first matches the pattern as usual. It then substitutes
15667 @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, etc., in the conditions, if any. Next, the
15668 conditions are simplified and evaluated in order from left to right,
15669 as if by the @w{@kbd{a s}} algebra command (@pxref{Simplifying Formulas}).
15670 Each result is true if it is a nonzero number, or an expression
15671 that can be proven to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}). If the
15672 results of all conditions are true, the expression (such as
15673 @samp{ifoo(#1)}) has its @samp{#}s substituted, and that is the
15674 result of the parse. If the result of any condition is false, Calc
15675 goes on to try the next rule in the syntax table.
15676
15677 Syntax rules also support @code{let} conditions, which operate in
15678 exactly the same way as they do in algebraic rewrite rules.
15679 @xref{Other Features of Rewrite Rules}, for details. A @code{let}
15680 condition is always true, but as a side effect it defines a
15681 variable which can be used in later conditions, and also in the
15682 expression after the @samp{:=} sign:
15683
15684 @example
15685 foo ( # ) := hifoo(x) :: let(x := #1 + 0.5) :: dnumint(x)
15686 @end example
15687
15688 @noindent
15689 The @code{dnumint} function tests if a value is numerically an
15690 integer, i.e., either a true integer or an integer-valued float.
15691 This rule will parse @code{foo} with a half-integer argument,
15692 like @samp{foo(3.5)}, to a call like @samp{hifoo(4.)}.
15693
15694 The lefthand side of a syntax rule @code{let} must be a simple
15695 variable, not the arbitrary pattern that is allowed in rewrite
15696 rules.
15697
15698 The @code{matches} function is also treated specially in syntax
15699 rule conditions (again, in the same way as in rewrite rules).
15700 @xref{Matching Commands}. If the matching pattern contains
15701 meta-variables, then those meta-variables may be used in later
15702 conditions and in the result expression. The arguments to
15703 @code{matches} are not evaluated in this situation.
15704
15705 @example
15706 sum ( # , # ) := sum(#1,a,b,c) :: matches(#2, a=[b..c])
15707 @end example
15708
15709 @noindent
15710 This is another way to implement the Maple mode @code{sum} notation.
15711 In this approach, we allow @samp{#2} to equal the whole expression
15712 @samp{i=1..10}. Then, we use @code{matches} to break it apart into
15713 its components. If the expression turns out not to match the pattern,
15714 the syntax rule will fail. Note that @kbd{Z S} always uses Calc's
15715 Normal language mode for editing expressions in syntax rules, so we
15716 must use regular Calc notation for the interval @samp{[b..c]} that
15717 will correspond to the Maple mode interval @samp{1..10}.
15718
15719 @node Modes Variable, Calc Mode Line, Language Modes, Mode Settings
15720 @section The @code{Modes} Variable
15721
15722 @noindent
15723 @kindex m g
15724 @pindex calc-get-modes
15725 The @kbd{m g} (@code{calc-get-modes}) command pushes onto the stack
15726 a vector of numbers that describes the various mode settings that
15727 are in effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it pushes only the
15728 @var{n}th mode, i.e., the @var{n}th element of this vector. Keyboard
15729 macros can use the @kbd{m g} command to modify their behavior based
15730 on the current mode settings.
15731
15732 @cindex @code{Modes} variable
15733 @vindex Modes
15734 The modes vector is also available in the special variable
15735 @code{Modes}. In other words, @kbd{m g} is like @kbd{s r Modes @key{RET}}.
15736 It will not work to store into this variable; in fact, if you do,
15737 @code{Modes} will cease to track the current modes. (The @kbd{m g}
15738 command will continue to work, however.)
15739
15740 In general, each number in this vector is suitable as a numeric
15741 prefix argument to the associated mode-setting command. (Recall
15742 that the @kbd{~} key takes a number from the stack and gives it as
15743 a numeric prefix to the next command.)
15744
15745 The elements of the modes vector are as follows:
15746
15747 @enumerate
15748 @item
15749 Current precision. Default is 12; associated command is @kbd{p}.
15750
15751 @item
15752 Binary word size. Default is 32; associated command is @kbd{b w}.
15753
15754 @item
15755 Stack size (not counting the value about to be pushed by @kbd{m g}).
15756 This is zero if @kbd{m g} is executed with an empty stack.
15757
15758 @item
15759 Number radix. Default is 10; command is @kbd{d r}.
15760
15761 @item
15762 Floating-point format. This is the number of digits, plus the
15763 constant 0 for normal notation, 10000 for scientific notation,
15764 20000 for engineering notation, or 30000 for fixed-point notation.
15765 These codes are acceptable as prefix arguments to the @kbd{d n}
15766 command, but note that this may lose information: For example,
15767 @kbd{d s} and @kbd{C-u 12 d s} have similar (but not quite
15768 identical) effects if the current precision is 12, but they both
15769 produce a code of 10012, which will be treated by @kbd{d n} as
15770 @kbd{C-u 12 d s}. If the precision then changes, the float format
15771 will still be frozen at 12 significant figures.
15772
15773 @item
15774 Angular mode. Default is 1 (degrees). Other values are 2 (radians)
15775 and 3 (HMS). The @kbd{m d} command accepts these prefixes.
15776
15777 @item
15778 Symbolic mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m s}.
15779
15780 @item
15781 Fraction mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m f}.
15782
15783 @item
15784 Polar mode. Value is 0 (rectangular) or 1 (polar); default is 0.
15785 Command is @kbd{m p}.
15786
15787 @item
15788 Matrix/Scalar mode. Default value is @mathit{-1}. Value is 0 for Scalar
15789 mode, @mathit{-2} for Matrix mode, or @var{N} for
15790 @texline @math{N\times N}
15791 @infoline @var{N}x@var{N}
15792 Matrix mode. Command is @kbd{m v}.
15793
15794 @item
15795 Simplification mode. Default is 1. Value is @mathit{-1} for off (@kbd{m O}),
15796 0 for @kbd{m N}, 2 for @kbd{m B}, 3 for @kbd{m A}, 4 for @kbd{m E},
15797 or 5 for @w{@kbd{m U}}. The @kbd{m D} command accepts these prefixes.
15798
15799 @item
15800 Infinite mode. Default is @mathit{-1} (off). Value is 1 if the mode is on,
15801 or 0 if the mode is on with positive zeros. Command is @kbd{m i}.
15802 @end enumerate
15803
15804 For example, the sequence @kbd{M-1 m g @key{RET} 2 + ~ p} increases the
15805 precision by two, leaving a copy of the old precision on the stack.
15806 Later, @kbd{~ p} will restore the original precision using that
15807 stack value. (This sequence might be especially useful inside a
15808 keyboard macro.)
15809
15810 As another example, @kbd{M-3 m g 1 - ~ @key{DEL}} deletes all but the
15811 oldest (bottommost) stack entry.
15812
15813 Yet another example: The HP-48 ``round'' command rounds a number
15814 to the current displayed precision. You could roughly emulate this
15815 in Calc with the sequence @kbd{M-5 m g 10000 % ~ c c}. (This
15816 would not work for fixed-point mode, but it wouldn't be hard to
15817 do a full emulation with the help of the @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z ]}
15818 programming commands. @xref{Conditionals in Macros}.)
15819
15820 @node Calc Mode Line, , Modes Variable, Mode Settings
15821 @section The Calc Mode Line
15822
15823 @noindent
15824 @cindex Mode line indicators
15825 This section is a summary of all symbols that can appear on the
15826 Calc mode line, the highlighted bar that appears under the Calc
15827 stack window (or under an editing window in Embedded mode).
15828
15829 The basic mode line format is:
15830
15831 @example
15832 --%%-Calc: 12 Deg @var{other modes} (Calculator)
15833 @end example
15834
15835 The @samp{%%} is the Emacs symbol for ``read-only''; it shows that
15836 regular Emacs commands are not allowed to edit the stack buffer
15837 as if it were text.
15838
15839 The word @samp{Calc:} changes to @samp{CalcEmbed:} if Embedded mode
15840 is enabled. The words after this describe the various Calc modes
15841 that are in effect.
15842
15843 The first mode is always the current precision, an integer.
15844 The second mode is always the angular mode, either @code{Deg},
15845 @code{Rad}, or @code{Hms}.
15846
15847 Here is a complete list of the remaining symbols that can appear
15848 on the mode line:
15849
15850 @table @code
15851 @item Alg
15852 Algebraic mode (@kbd{m a}; @pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
15853
15854 @item Alg[(
15855 Incomplete algebraic mode (@kbd{C-u m a}).
15856
15857 @item Alg*
15858 Total algebraic mode (@kbd{m t}).
15859
15860 @item Symb
15861 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}).
15862
15863 @item Matrix
15864 Matrix mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15865
15866 @item Matrix@var{n}
15867 Dimensioned Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u @var{n} m v}).
15868
15869 @item Scalar
15870 Scalar mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15871
15872 @item Polar
15873 Polar complex mode (@kbd{m p}; @pxref{Polar Mode}).
15874
15875 @item Frac
15876 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}; @pxref{Fraction Mode}).
15877
15878 @item Inf
15879 Infinite mode (@kbd{m i}; @pxref{Infinite Mode}).
15880
15881 @item +Inf
15882 Positive Infinite mode (@kbd{C-u 0 m i}).
15883
15884 @item NoSimp
15885 Default simplifications off (@kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}).
15886
15887 @item NumSimp
15888 Default simplifications for numeric arguments only (@kbd{m N}).
15889
15890 @item BinSimp@var{w}
15891 Binary-integer simplification mode; word size @var{w} (@kbd{m B}, @kbd{b w}).
15892
15893 @item AlgSimp
15894 Algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m A}).
15895
15896 @item ExtSimp
15897 Extended algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m E}).
15898
15899 @item UnitSimp
15900 Units simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
15901
15902 @item Bin
15903 Current radix is 2 (@kbd{d 2}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15904
15905 @item Oct
15906 Current radix is 8 (@kbd{d 8}).
15907
15908 @item Hex
15909 Current radix is 16 (@kbd{d 6}).
15910
15911 @item Radix@var{n}
15912 Current radix is @var{n} (@kbd{d r}).
15913
15914 @item Zero
15915 Leading zeros (@kbd{d z}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15916
15917 @item Big
15918 Big language mode (@kbd{d B}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15919
15920 @item Flat
15921 One-line normal language mode (@kbd{d O}).
15922
15923 @item Unform
15924 Unformatted language mode (@kbd{d U}).
15925
15926 @item C
15927 C language mode (@kbd{d C}; @pxref{C FORTRAN Pascal}).
15928
15929 @item Pascal
15930 Pascal language mode (@kbd{d P}).
15931
15932 @item Fortran
15933 FORTRAN language mode (@kbd{d F}).
15934
15935 @item TeX
15936 @TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d T}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15937
15938 @item LaTeX
15939 La@TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d L}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15940
15941 @item Eqn
15942 @dfn{Eqn} language mode (@kbd{d E}; @pxref{Eqn Language Mode}).
15943
15944 @item Math
15945 Mathematica language mode (@kbd{d M}; @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}).
15946
15947 @item Maple
15948 Maple language mode (@kbd{d W}; @pxref{Maple Language Mode}).
15949
15950 @item Norm@var{n}
15951 Normal float mode with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d n}; @pxref{Float Formats}).
15952
15953 @item Fix@var{n}
15954 Fixed point mode with @var{n} digits after the point (@kbd{d f}).
15955
15956 @item Sci
15957 Scientific notation mode (@kbd{d s}).
15958
15959 @item Sci@var{n}
15960 Scientific notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d s}).
15961
15962 @item Eng
15963 Engineering notation mode (@kbd{d e}).
15964
15965 @item Eng@var{n}
15966 Engineering notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d e}).
15967
15968 @item Left@var{n}
15969 Left-justified display indented by @var{n} (@kbd{d <}; @pxref{Justification}).
15970
15971 @item Right
15972 Right-justified display (@kbd{d >}).
15973
15974 @item Right@var{n}
15975 Right-justified display with width @var{n} (@kbd{d >}).
15976
15977 @item Center
15978 Centered display (@kbd{d =}).
15979
15980 @item Center@var{n}
15981 Centered display with center column @var{n} (@kbd{d =}).
15982
15983 @item Wid@var{n}
15984 Line breaking with width @var{n} (@kbd{d b}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15985
15986 @item Wide
15987 No line breaking (@kbd{d b}).
15988
15989 @item Break
15990 Selections show deep structure (@kbd{j b}; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15991
15992 @item Save
15993 Record modes in @file{~/.calc.el} (@kbd{m R}; @pxref{General Mode Commands}).
15994
15995 @item Local
15996 Record modes in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15997
15998 @item LocEdit
15999 Record modes as editing-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16000
16001 @item LocPerm
16002 Record modes as permanent-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16003
16004 @item Global
16005 Record modes as global in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16006
16007 @item Manual
16008 Automatic recomputation turned off (@kbd{m C}; @pxref{Automatic
16009 Recomputation}).
16010
16011 @item Graph
16012 GNUPLOT process is alive in background (@pxref{Graphics}).
16013
16014 @item Sel
16015 Top-of-stack has a selection (Embedded only; @pxref{Making Selections}).
16016
16017 @item Dirty
16018 The stack display may not be up-to-date (@pxref{Display Modes}).
16019
16020 @item Inv
16021 ``Inverse'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{I}; @pxref{Inverse and Hyperbolic}).
16022
16023 @item Hyp
16024 ``Hyperbolic'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{H}).
16025
16026 @item Keep
16027 ``Keep-arguments'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{K}).
16028
16029 @item Narrow
16030 Stack is truncated (@kbd{d t}; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}).
16031 @end table
16032
16033 In addition, the symbols @code{Active} and @code{~Active} can appear
16034 as minor modes on an Embedded buffer's mode line. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
16035
16036 @node Arithmetic, Scientific Functions, Mode Settings, Top
16037 @chapter Arithmetic Functions
16038
16039 @noindent
16040 This chapter describes the Calc commands for doing simple calculations
16041 on numbers, such as addition, absolute value, and square roots. These
16042 commands work by removing the top one or two values from the stack,
16043 performing the desired operation, and pushing the result back onto the
16044 stack. If the operation cannot be performed, the result pushed is a
16045 formula instead of a number, such as @samp{2/0} (because division by zero
16046 is illegal) or @samp{sqrt(x)} (because the argument @samp{x} is a formula).
16047
16048 Most of the commands described here can be invoked by a single keystroke.
16049 Some of the more obscure ones are two-letter sequences beginning with
16050 the @kbd{f} (``functions'') prefix key.
16051
16052 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
16053 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
16054 interpret a prefix argument.
16055
16056 @menu
16057 * Basic Arithmetic::
16058 * Integer Truncation::
16059 * Complex Number Functions::
16060 * Conversions::
16061 * Date Arithmetic::
16062 * Financial Functions::
16063 * Binary Functions::
16064 @end menu
16065
16066 @node Basic Arithmetic, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16067 @section Basic Arithmetic
16068
16069 @noindent
16070 @kindex +
16071 @pindex calc-plus
16072 @ignore
16073 @mindex @null
16074 @end ignore
16075 @tindex +
16076 The @kbd{+} (@code{calc-plus}) command adds two numbers. The numbers may
16077 be any of the standard Calc data types. The resulting sum is pushed back
16078 onto the stack.
16079
16080 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are vectors or matrices (of matching dimensions),
16081 the result is a vector or matrix sum. If one argument is a vector and the
16082 other a scalar (i.e., a non-vector), the scalar is added to each of the
16083 elements of the vector to form a new vector. If the scalar is not a
16084 number, the operation is left in symbolic form: Suppose you added @samp{x}
16085 to the vector @samp{[1,2]}. You may want the result @samp{[1+x,2+x]}, or
16086 you may plan to substitute a 2-vector for @samp{x} in the future. Since
16087 the Calculator can't tell which interpretation you want, it makes the
16088 safest assumption. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, for a way to add @samp{x}
16089 to every element of a vector.
16090
16091 If either argument of @kbd{+} is a complex number, the result will in general
16092 be complex. If one argument is in rectangular form and the other polar,
16093 the current Polar mode determines the form of the result. If Symbolic
16094 mode is enabled, the sum may be left as a formula if the necessary
16095 conversions for polar addition are non-trivial.
16096
16097 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are HMS forms, the forms are added according to
16098 the usual conventions of hours-minutes-seconds notation. If one argument
16099 is an HMS form and the other is a number, that number is converted from
16100 degrees or radians (depending on the current Angular mode) to HMS format
16101 and then the two HMS forms are added.
16102
16103 If one argument of @kbd{+} is a date form, the other can be either a
16104 real number, which advances the date by a certain number of days, or
16105 an HMS form, which advances the date by a certain amount of time.
16106 Subtracting two date forms yields the number of days between them.
16107 Adding two date forms is meaningless, but Calc interprets it as the
16108 subtraction of one date form and the negative of the other. (The
16109 negative of a date form can be understood by remembering that dates
16110 are stored as the number of days before or after Jan 1, 1 AD.)
16111
16112 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are error forms, the result is an error form
16113 with an appropriately computed standard deviation. If one argument is an
16114 error form and the other is a number, the number is taken to have zero error.
16115 Error forms may have symbolic formulas as their mean and/or error parts;
16116 adding these will produce a symbolic error form result. However, adding an
16117 error form to a plain symbolic formula (as in @samp{(a +/- b) + c}) will not
16118 work, for the same reasons just mentioned for vectors. Instead you must
16119 write @samp{(a +/- b) + (c +/- 0)}.
16120
16121 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are modulo forms with equal values of @expr{M},
16122 or if one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number, the
16123 result is a modulo form which represents the sum, modulo @expr{M}, of
16124 the two values.
16125
16126 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are intervals, the result is an interval
16127 which describes all possible sums of the possible input values. If
16128 one argument is a plain number, it is treated as the interval
16129 @w{@samp{[x ..@: x]}}.
16130
16131 If one argument of @kbd{+} is an infinity and the other is not, the
16132 result is that same infinity. If both arguments are infinite and in
16133 the same direction, the result is the same infinity, but if they are
16134 infinite in different directions the result is @code{nan}.
16135
16136 @kindex -
16137 @pindex calc-minus
16138 @ignore
16139 @mindex @null
16140 @end ignore
16141 @tindex -
16142 The @kbd{-} (@code{calc-minus}) command subtracts two values. The top
16143 number on the stack is subtracted from the one behind it, so that the
16144 computation @kbd{5 @key{RET} 2 -} produces 3, not @mathit{-3}. All options
16145 available for @kbd{+} are available for @kbd{-} as well.
16146
16147 @kindex *
16148 @pindex calc-times
16149 @ignore
16150 @mindex @null
16151 @end ignore
16152 @tindex *
16153 The @kbd{*} (@code{calc-times}) command multiplies two numbers. If one
16154 argument is a vector and the other a scalar, the scalar is multiplied by
16155 the elements of the vector to produce a new vector. If both arguments
16156 are vectors, the interpretation depends on the dimensions of the
16157 vectors: If both arguments are matrices, a matrix multiplication is
16158 done. If one argument is a matrix and the other a plain vector, the
16159 vector is interpreted as a row vector or column vector, whichever is
16160 dimensionally correct. If both arguments are plain vectors, the result
16161 is a single scalar number which is the dot product of the two vectors.
16162
16163 If one argument of @kbd{*} is an HMS form and the other a number, the
16164 HMS form is multiplied by that amount. It is an error to multiply two
16165 HMS forms together, or to attempt any multiplication involving date
16166 forms. Error forms, modulo forms, and intervals can be multiplied;
16167 see the comments for addition of those forms. When two error forms
16168 or intervals are multiplied they are considered to be statistically
16169 independent; thus, @samp{[-2 ..@: 3] * [-2 ..@: 3]} is @samp{[-6 ..@: 9]},
16170 whereas @w{@samp{[-2 ..@: 3] ^ 2}} is @samp{[0 ..@: 9]}.
16171
16172 @kindex /
16173 @pindex calc-divide
16174 @ignore
16175 @mindex @null
16176 @end ignore
16177 @tindex /
16178 The @kbd{/} (@code{calc-divide}) command divides two numbers. When
16179 dividing a scalar @expr{B} by a square matrix @expr{A}, the computation
16180 performed is @expr{B} times the inverse of @expr{A}. This also occurs
16181 if @expr{B} is itself a vector or matrix, in which case the effect is
16182 to solve the set of linear equations represented by @expr{B}. If @expr{B}
16183 is a matrix with the same number of rows as @expr{A}, or a plain vector
16184 (which is interpreted here as a column vector), then the equation
16185 @expr{A X = B} is solved for the vector or matrix @expr{X}. Otherwise,
16186 if @expr{B} is a non-square matrix with the same number of @emph{columns}
16187 as @expr{A}, the equation @expr{X A = B} is solved. If you wish a vector
16188 @expr{B} to be interpreted as a row vector to be solved as @expr{X A = B},
16189 make it into a one-row matrix with @kbd{C-u 1 v p} first. To force a
16190 left-handed solution with a square matrix @expr{B}, transpose @expr{A} and
16191 @expr{B} before dividing, then transpose the result.
16192
16193 HMS forms can be divided by real numbers or by other HMS forms. Error
16194 forms can be divided in any combination of ways. Modulo forms where both
16195 values and the modulo are integers can be divided to get an integer modulo
16196 form result. Intervals can be divided; dividing by an interval that
16197 encompasses zero or has zero as a limit will result in an infinite
16198 interval.
16199
16200 @kindex ^
16201 @pindex calc-power
16202 @ignore
16203 @mindex @null
16204 @end ignore
16205 @tindex ^
16206 The @kbd{^} (@code{calc-power}) command raises a number to a power. If
16207 the power is an integer, an exact result is computed using repeated
16208 multiplications. For non-integer powers, Calc uses Newton's method or
16209 logarithms and exponentials. Square matrices can be raised to integer
16210 powers. If either argument is an error (or interval or modulo) form,
16211 the result is also an error (or interval or modulo) form.
16212
16213 @kindex I ^
16214 @tindex nroot
16215 If you press the @kbd{I} (inverse) key first, the @kbd{I ^} command
16216 computes an Nth root: @kbd{125 @key{RET} 3 I ^} computes the number 5.
16217 (This is entirely equivalent to @kbd{125 @key{RET} 1:3 ^}.)
16218
16219 @kindex \
16220 @pindex calc-idiv
16221 @tindex idiv
16222 @ignore
16223 @mindex @null
16224 @end ignore
16225 @tindex \
16226 The @kbd{\} (@code{calc-idiv}) command divides two numbers on the stack
16227 to produce an integer result. It is equivalent to dividing with
16228 @key{/}, then rounding down with @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}), only a bit
16229 more convenient and efficient. Also, since it is an all-integer
16230 operation when the arguments are integers, it avoids problems that
16231 @kbd{/ F} would have with floating-point roundoff.
16232
16233 @kindex %
16234 @pindex calc-mod
16235 @ignore
16236 @mindex @null
16237 @end ignore
16238 @tindex %
16239 The @kbd{%} (@code{calc-mod}) command performs a ``modulo'' (or ``remainder'')
16240 operation. Mathematically, @samp{a%b = a - (a\b)*b}, and is defined
16241 for all real numbers @expr{a} and @expr{b} (except @expr{b=0}). For
16242 positive @expr{b}, the result will always be between 0 (inclusive) and
16243 @expr{b} (exclusive). Modulo does not work for HMS forms and error forms.
16244 If @expr{a} is a modulo form, its modulo is changed to @expr{b}, which
16245 must be positive real number.
16246
16247 @kindex :
16248 @pindex calc-fdiv
16249 @tindex fdiv
16250 The @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) command [@code{fdiv} function in a formula]
16251 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fractional
16252 result. This is a convenient shorthand for enabling Fraction mode (with
16253 @kbd{m f}) temporarily and using @samp{/}. Note that during numeric entry
16254 the @kbd{:} key is interpreted as a fraction separator, so to divide 8 by 6
16255 you would have to type @kbd{8 @key{RET} 6 @key{RET} :}. (Of course, in
16256 this case, it would be much easier simply to enter the fraction directly
16257 as @kbd{8:6 @key{RET}}!)
16258
16259 @kindex n
16260 @pindex calc-change-sign
16261 The @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the number on the top
16262 of the stack. It works on numbers, vectors and matrices, HMS forms, date
16263 forms, error forms, intervals, and modulo forms.
16264
16265 @kindex A
16266 @pindex calc-abs
16267 @tindex abs
16268 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the absolute
16269 value of a number. The result of @code{abs} is always a nonnegative
16270 real number: With a complex argument, it computes the complex magnitude.
16271 With a vector or matrix argument, it computes the Frobenius norm, i.e.,
16272 the square root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
16273 elements. The absolute value of an error form is defined by replacing
16274 the mean part with its absolute value and leaving the error part the same.
16275 The absolute value of a modulo form is undefined. The absolute value of
16276 an interval is defined in the obvious way.
16277
16278 @kindex f A
16279 @pindex calc-abssqr
16280 @tindex abssqr
16281 The @kbd{f A} (@code{calc-abssqr}) [@code{abssqr}] command computes the
16282 absolute value squared of a number, vector or matrix, or error form.
16283
16284 @kindex f s
16285 @pindex calc-sign
16286 @tindex sign
16287 The @kbd{f s} (@code{calc-sign}) [@code{sign}] command returns 1 if its
16288 argument is positive, @mathit{-1} if its argument is negative, or 0 if its
16289 argument is zero. In algebraic form, you can also write @samp{sign(a,x)}
16290 which evaluates to @samp{x * sign(a)}, i.e., either @samp{x}, @samp{-x}, or
16291 zero depending on the sign of @samp{a}.
16292
16293 @kindex &
16294 @pindex calc-inv
16295 @tindex inv
16296 @cindex Reciprocal
16297 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
16298 reciprocal of a number, i.e., @expr{1 / x}. Operating on a square
16299 matrix, it computes the inverse of that matrix.
16300
16301 @kindex Q
16302 @pindex calc-sqrt
16303 @tindex sqrt
16304 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] command computes the square
16305 root of a number. For a negative real argument, the result will be a
16306 complex number whose form is determined by the current Polar mode.
16307
16308 @kindex f h
16309 @pindex calc-hypot
16310 @tindex hypot
16311 The @kbd{f h} (@code{calc-hypot}) [@code{hypot}] command computes the square
16312 root of the sum of the squares of two numbers. That is, @samp{hypot(a,b)}
16313 is the length of the hypotenuse of a right triangle with sides @expr{a}
16314 and @expr{b}. If the arguments are complex numbers, their squared
16315 magnitudes are used.
16316
16317 @kindex f Q
16318 @pindex calc-isqrt
16319 @tindex isqrt
16320 The @kbd{f Q} (@code{calc-isqrt}) [@code{isqrt}] command computes the
16321 integer square root of an integer. This is the true square root of the
16322 number, rounded down to an integer. For example, @samp{isqrt(10)}
16323 produces 3. Note that, like @kbd{\} [@code{idiv}], this uses exact
16324 integer arithmetic throughout to avoid roundoff problems. If the input
16325 is a floating-point number or other non-integer value, this is exactly
16326 the same as @samp{floor(sqrt(x))}.
16327
16328 @kindex f n
16329 @kindex f x
16330 @pindex calc-min
16331 @tindex min
16332 @pindex calc-max
16333 @tindex max
16334 The @kbd{f n} (@code{calc-min}) [@code{min}] and @kbd{f x} (@code{calc-max})
16335 [@code{max}] commands take the minimum or maximum of two real numbers,
16336 respectively. These commands also work on HMS forms, date forms,
16337 intervals, and infinities. (In algebraic expressions, these functions
16338 take any number of arguments and return the maximum or minimum among
16339 all the arguments.)
16340
16341 @kindex f M
16342 @kindex f X
16343 @pindex calc-mant-part
16344 @tindex mant
16345 @pindex calc-xpon-part
16346 @tindex xpon
16347 The @kbd{f M} (@code{calc-mant-part}) [@code{mant}] function extracts
16348 the ``mantissa'' part @expr{m} of its floating-point argument; @kbd{f X}
16349 (@code{calc-xpon-part}) [@code{xpon}] extracts the ``exponent'' part
16350 @expr{e}. The original number is equal to
16351 @texline @math{m \times 10^e},
16352 @infoline @expr{m * 10^e},
16353 where @expr{m} is in the interval @samp{[1.0 ..@: 10.0)} except that
16354 @expr{m=e=0} if the original number is zero. For integers
16355 and fractions, @code{mant} returns the number unchanged and @code{xpon}
16356 returns zero. The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command can also be
16357 used to ``unpack'' a floating-point number; this produces an integer
16358 mantissa and exponent, with the constraint that the mantissa is not
16359 a multiple of ten (again except for the @expr{m=e=0} case).
16360
16361 @kindex f S
16362 @pindex calc-scale-float
16363 @tindex scf
16364 The @kbd{f S} (@code{calc-scale-float}) [@code{scf}] function scales a number
16365 by a given power of ten. Thus, @samp{scf(mant(x), xpon(x)) = x} for any
16366 real @samp{x}. The second argument must be an integer, but the first
16367 may actually be any numeric value. For example, @samp{scf(5,-2) = 0.05}
16368 or @samp{1:20} depending on the current Fraction mode.
16369
16370 @kindex f [
16371 @kindex f ]
16372 @pindex calc-decrement
16373 @pindex calc-increment
16374 @tindex decr
16375 @tindex incr
16376 The @kbd{f [} (@code{calc-decrement}) [@code{decr}] and @kbd{f ]}
16377 (@code{calc-increment}) [@code{incr}] functions decrease or increase
16378 a number by one unit. For integers, the effect is obvious. For
16379 floating-point numbers, the change is by one unit in the last place.
16380 For example, incrementing @samp{12.3456} when the current precision
16381 is 6 digits yields @samp{12.3457}. If the current precision had been
16382 8 digits, the result would have been @samp{12.345601}. Incrementing
16383 @samp{0.0} produces
16384 @texline @math{10^{-p}},
16385 @infoline @expr{10^-p},
16386 where @expr{p} is the current
16387 precision. These operations are defined only on integers and floats.
16388 With numeric prefix arguments, they change the number by @expr{n} units.
16389
16390 Note that incrementing followed by decrementing, or vice-versa, will
16391 almost but not quite always cancel out. Suppose the precision is
16392 6 digits and the number @samp{9.99999} is on the stack. Incrementing
16393 will produce @samp{10.0000}; decrementing will produce @samp{9.9999}.
16394 One digit has been dropped. This is an unavoidable consequence of the
16395 way floating-point numbers work.
16396
16397 Incrementing a date/time form adjusts it by a certain number of seconds.
16398 Incrementing a pure date form adjusts it by a certain number of days.
16399
16400 @node Integer Truncation, Complex Number Functions, Basic Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16401 @section Integer Truncation
16402
16403 @noindent
16404 There are four commands for truncating a real number to an integer,
16405 differing mainly in their treatment of negative numbers. All of these
16406 commands have the property that if the argument is an integer, the result
16407 is the same integer. An integer-valued floating-point argument is converted
16408 to integer form.
16409
16410 If you press @kbd{H} (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) first, the result will be
16411 expressed as an integer-valued floating-point number.
16412
16413 @cindex Integer part of a number
16414 @kindex F
16415 @pindex calc-floor
16416 @tindex floor
16417 @tindex ffloor
16418 @ignore
16419 @mindex @null
16420 @end ignore
16421 @kindex H F
16422 The @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) [@code{floor} or @code{ffloor}] command
16423 truncates a real number to the next lower integer, i.e., toward minus
16424 infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 F} produces 3, but @kbd{_3.6 F} produces
16425 @mathit{-4}.
16426
16427 @kindex I F
16428 @pindex calc-ceiling
16429 @tindex ceil
16430 @tindex fceil
16431 @ignore
16432 @mindex @null
16433 @end ignore
16434 @kindex H I F
16435 The @kbd{I F} (@code{calc-ceiling}) [@code{ceil} or @code{fceil}]
16436 command truncates toward positive infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 I F} produces
16437 4, and @kbd{_3.6 I F} produces @mathit{-3}.
16438
16439 @kindex R
16440 @pindex calc-round
16441 @tindex round
16442 @tindex fround
16443 @ignore
16444 @mindex @null
16445 @end ignore
16446 @kindex H R
16447 The @kbd{R} (@code{calc-round}) [@code{round} or @code{fround}] command
16448 rounds to the nearest integer. When the fractional part is .5 exactly,
16449 this command rounds away from zero. (All other rounding in the
16450 Calculator uses this convention as well.) Thus @kbd{3.5 R} produces 4
16451 but @kbd{3.4 R} produces 3; @kbd{_3.5 R} produces @mathit{-4}.
16452
16453 @kindex I R
16454 @pindex calc-trunc
16455 @tindex trunc
16456 @tindex ftrunc
16457 @ignore
16458 @mindex @null
16459 @end ignore
16460 @kindex H I R
16461 The @kbd{I R} (@code{calc-trunc}) [@code{trunc} or @code{ftrunc}]
16462 command truncates toward zero. In other words, it ``chops off''
16463 everything after the decimal point. Thus @kbd{3.6 I R} produces 3 and
16464 @kbd{_3.6 I R} produces @mathit{-3}.
16465
16466 These functions may not be applied meaningfully to error forms, but they
16467 do work for intervals. As a convenience, applying @code{floor} to a
16468 modulo form floors the value part of the form. Applied to a vector,
16469 these functions operate on all elements of the vector one by one.
16470 Applied to a date form, they operate on the internal numerical
16471 representation of dates, converting a date/time form into a pure date.
16472
16473 @ignore
16474 @starindex
16475 @end ignore
16476 @tindex rounde
16477 @ignore
16478 @starindex
16479 @end ignore
16480 @tindex roundu
16481 @ignore
16482 @starindex
16483 @end ignore
16484 @tindex frounde
16485 @ignore
16486 @starindex
16487 @end ignore
16488 @tindex froundu
16489 There are two more rounding functions which can only be entered in
16490 algebraic notation. The @code{roundu} function is like @code{round}
16491 except that it rounds up, toward plus infinity, when the fractional
16492 part is .5. This distinction matters only for negative arguments.
16493 Also, @code{rounde} rounds to an even number in the case of a tie,
16494 rounding up or down as necessary. For example, @samp{rounde(3.5)} and
16495 @samp{rounde(4.5)} both return 4, but @samp{rounde(5.5)} returns 6.
16496 The advantage of round-to-even is that the net error due to rounding
16497 after a long calculation tends to cancel out to zero. An important
16498 subtle point here is that the number being fed to @code{rounde} will
16499 already have been rounded to the current precision before @code{rounde}
16500 begins. For example, @samp{rounde(2.500001)} with a current precision
16501 of 6 will incorrectly, or at least surprisingly, yield 2 because the
16502 argument will first have been rounded down to @expr{2.5} (which
16503 @code{rounde} sees as an exact tie between 2 and 3).
16504
16505 Each of these functions, when written in algebraic formulas, allows
16506 a second argument which specifies the number of digits after the
16507 decimal point to keep. For example, @samp{round(123.4567, 2)} will
16508 produce the answer 123.46, and @samp{round(123.4567, -1)} will
16509 produce 120 (i.e., the cutoff is one digit to the @emph{left} of
16510 the decimal point). A second argument of zero is equivalent to
16511 no second argument at all.
16512
16513 @cindex Fractional part of a number
16514 To compute the fractional part of a number (i.e., the amount which, when
16515 added to `@t{floor(}@var{n}@t{)}', will produce @var{n}) just take @var{n}
16516 modulo 1 using the @code{%} command.
16517
16518 Note also the @kbd{\} (integer quotient), @kbd{f I} (integer logarithm),
16519 and @kbd{f Q} (integer square root) commands, which are analogous to
16520 @kbd{/}, @kbd{B}, and @kbd{Q}, respectively, except that they take integer
16521 arguments and return the result rounded down to an integer.
16522
16523 @node Complex Number Functions, Conversions, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic
16524 @section Complex Number Functions
16525
16526 @noindent
16527 @kindex J
16528 @pindex calc-conj
16529 @tindex conj
16530 The @kbd{J} (@code{calc-conj}) [@code{conj}] command computes the
16531 complex conjugate of a number. For complex number @expr{a+bi}, the
16532 complex conjugate is @expr{a-bi}. If the argument is a real number,
16533 this command leaves it the same. If the argument is a vector or matrix,
16534 this command replaces each element by its complex conjugate.
16535
16536 @kindex G
16537 @pindex calc-argument
16538 @tindex arg
16539 The @kbd{G} (@code{calc-argument}) [@code{arg}] command computes the
16540 ``argument'' or polar angle of a complex number. For a number in polar
16541 notation, this is simply the second component of the pair
16542 @texline `@t{(}@var{r}@t{;}@math{\theta}@t{)}'.
16543 @infoline `@t{(}@var{r}@t{;}@var{theta}@t{)}'.
16544 The result is expressed according to the current angular mode and will
16545 be in the range @mathit{-180} degrees (exclusive) to @mathit{+180} degrees
16546 (inclusive), or the equivalent range in radians.
16547
16548 @pindex calc-imaginary
16549 The @code{calc-imaginary} command multiplies the number on the
16550 top of the stack by the imaginary number @expr{i = (0,1)}. This
16551 command is not normally bound to a key in Calc, but it is available
16552 on the @key{IMAG} button in Keypad mode.
16553
16554 @kindex f r
16555 @pindex calc-re
16556 @tindex re
16557 The @kbd{f r} (@code{calc-re}) [@code{re}] command replaces a complex number
16558 by its real part. This command has no effect on real numbers. (As an
16559 added convenience, @code{re} applied to a modulo form extracts
16560 the value part.)
16561
16562 @kindex f i
16563 @pindex calc-im
16564 @tindex im
16565 The @kbd{f i} (@code{calc-im}) [@code{im}] command replaces a complex number
16566 by its imaginary part; real numbers are converted to zero. With a vector
16567 or matrix argument, these functions operate element-wise.
16568
16569 @ignore
16570 @mindex v p
16571 @end ignore
16572 @kindex v p (complex)
16573 @pindex calc-pack
16574 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) command can pack the top two numbers on
16575 the stack into a composite object such as a complex number. With
16576 a prefix argument of @mathit{-1}, it produces a rectangular complex number;
16577 with an argument of @mathit{-2}, it produces a polar complex number.
16578 (Also, @pxref{Building Vectors}.)
16579
16580 @ignore
16581 @mindex v u
16582 @end ignore
16583 @kindex v u (complex)
16584 @pindex calc-unpack
16585 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the complex number
16586 (or other composite object) on the top of the stack and unpacks it
16587 into its separate components.
16588
16589 @node Conversions, Date Arithmetic, Complex Number Functions, Arithmetic
16590 @section Conversions
16591
16592 @noindent
16593 The commands described in this section convert numbers from one form
16594 to another; they are two-key sequences beginning with the letter @kbd{c}.
16595
16596 @kindex c f
16597 @pindex calc-float
16598 @tindex pfloat
16599 The @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) [@code{pfloat}] command converts the
16600 number on the top of the stack to floating-point form. For example,
16601 @expr{23} is converted to @expr{23.0}, @expr{3:2} is converted to
16602 @expr{1.5}, and @expr{2.3} is left the same. If the value is a composite
16603 object such as a complex number or vector, each of the components is
16604 converted to floating-point. If the value is a formula, all numbers
16605 in the formula are converted to floating-point. Note that depending
16606 on the current floating-point precision, conversion to floating-point
16607 format may lose information.
16608
16609 As a special exception, integers which appear as powers or subscripts
16610 are not floated by @kbd{c f}. If you really want to float a power,
16611 you can use a @kbd{j s} command to select the power followed by @kbd{c f}.
16612 Because @kbd{c f} cannot examine the formula outside of the selection,
16613 it does not notice that the thing being floated is a power.
16614 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}.
16615
16616 The normal @kbd{c f} command is ``pervasive'' in the sense that it
16617 applies to all numbers throughout the formula. The @code{pfloat}
16618 algebraic function never stays around in a formula; @samp{pfloat(a + 1)}
16619 changes to @samp{a + 1.0} as soon as it is evaluated.
16620
16621 @kindex H c f
16622 @tindex float
16623 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c f} [@code{float}] operates
16624 only on the number or vector of numbers at the top level of its
16625 argument. Thus, @samp{float(1)} is 1.0, but @samp{float(a + 1)}
16626 is left unevaluated because its argument is not a number.
16627
16628 You should use @kbd{H c f} if you wish to guarantee that the final
16629 value, once all the variables have been assigned, is a float; you
16630 would use @kbd{c f} if you wish to do the conversion on the numbers
16631 that appear right now.
16632
16633 @kindex c F
16634 @pindex calc-fraction
16635 @tindex pfrac
16636 The @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) [@code{pfrac}] command converts a
16637 floating-point number into a fractional approximation. By default, it
16638 produces a fraction whose decimal representation is the same as the
16639 input number, to within the current precision. You can also give a
16640 numeric prefix argument to specify a tolerance, either directly, or,
16641 if the prefix argument is zero, by using the number on top of the stack
16642 as the tolerance. If the tolerance is a positive integer, the fraction
16643 is correct to within that many significant figures. If the tolerance is
16644 a non-positive integer, it specifies how many digits fewer than the current
16645 precision to use. If the tolerance is a floating-point number, the
16646 fraction is correct to within that absolute amount.
16647
16648 @kindex H c F
16649 @tindex frac
16650 The @code{pfrac} function is pervasive, like @code{pfloat}.
16651 There is also a non-pervasive version, @kbd{H c F} [@code{frac}],
16652 which is analogous to @kbd{H c f} discussed above.
16653
16654 @kindex c d
16655 @pindex calc-to-degrees
16656 @tindex deg
16657 The @kbd{c d} (@code{calc-to-degrees}) [@code{deg}] command converts a
16658 number into degrees form. The value on the top of the stack may be an
16659 HMS form (interpreted as degrees-minutes-seconds), or a real number which
16660 will be interpreted in radians regardless of the current angular mode.
16661
16662 @kindex c r
16663 @pindex calc-to-radians
16664 @tindex rad
16665 The @kbd{c r} (@code{calc-to-radians}) [@code{rad}] command converts an
16666 HMS form or angle in degrees into an angle in radians.
16667
16668 @kindex c h
16669 @pindex calc-to-hms
16670 @tindex hms
16671 The @kbd{c h} (@code{calc-to-hms}) [@code{hms}] command converts a real
16672 number, interpreted according to the current angular mode, to an HMS
16673 form describing the same angle. In algebraic notation, the @code{hms}
16674 function also accepts three arguments: @samp{hms(@var{h}, @var{m}, @var{s})}.
16675 (The three-argument version is independent of the current angular mode.)
16676
16677 @pindex calc-from-hms
16678 The @code{calc-from-hms} command converts the HMS form on the top of the
16679 stack into a real number according to the current angular mode.
16680
16681 @kindex c p
16682 @kindex I c p
16683 @pindex calc-polar
16684 @tindex polar
16685 @tindex rect
16686 The @kbd{c p} (@code{calc-polar}) command converts the complex number on
16687 the top of the stack from polar to rectangular form, or from rectangular
16688 to polar form, whichever is appropriate. Real numbers are left the same.
16689 This command is equivalent to the @code{rect} or @code{polar}
16690 functions in algebraic formulas, depending on the direction of
16691 conversion. (It uses @code{polar}, except that if the argument is
16692 already a polar complex number, it uses @code{rect} instead. The
16693 @kbd{I c p} command always uses @code{rect}.)
16694
16695 @kindex c c
16696 @pindex calc-clean
16697 @tindex pclean
16698 The @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) [@code{pclean}] command ``cleans'' the
16699 number on the top of the stack. Floating point numbers are re-rounded
16700 according to the current precision. Polar numbers whose angular
16701 components have strayed from the @mathit{-180} to @mathit{+180} degree range
16702 are normalized. (Note that results will be undesirable if the current
16703 angular mode is different from the one under which the number was
16704 produced!) Integers and fractions are generally unaffected by this
16705 operation. Vectors and formulas are cleaned by cleaning each component
16706 number (i.e., pervasively).
16707
16708 If the simplification mode is set below the default level, it is raised
16709 to the default level for the purposes of this command. Thus, @kbd{c c}
16710 applies the default simplifications even if their automatic application
16711 is disabled. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
16712
16713 @cindex Roundoff errors, correcting
16714 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{c c} sets the floating-point precision
16715 to that value for the duration of the command. A positive prefix (of at
16716 least 3) sets the precision to the specified value; a negative or zero
16717 prefix decreases the precision by the specified amount.
16718
16719 @kindex c 0-9
16720 @pindex calc-clean-num
16721 The keystroke sequences @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} are equivalent
16722 to @kbd{c c} with the corresponding negative prefix argument. If roundoff
16723 errors have changed 2.0 into 1.999999, typing @kbd{c 1} to clip off one
16724 decimal place often conveniently does the trick.
16725
16726 The @kbd{c c} command with a numeric prefix argument, and the @kbd{c 0}
16727 through @kbd{c 9} commands, also ``clip'' very small floating-point
16728 numbers to zero. If the exponent is less than or equal to the negative
16729 of the specified precision, the number is changed to 0.0. For example,
16730 if the current precision is 12, then @kbd{c 2} changes the vector
16731 @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 1e-10, 1e-11]} to @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 0, 0]}.
16732 Numbers this small generally arise from roundoff noise.
16733
16734 If the numbers you are using really are legitimately this small,
16735 you should avoid using the @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} commands.
16736 (The plain @kbd{c c} command rounds to the current precision but
16737 does not clip small numbers.)
16738
16739 One more property of @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}, and of @kbd{c c} with
16740 a prefix argument, is that integer-valued floats are converted to
16741 plain integers, so that @kbd{c 1} on @samp{[1., 1.5, 2., 2.5, 3.]}
16742 produces @samp{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3]}. This is not done for huge
16743 numbers (@samp{1e100} is technically an integer-valued float, but
16744 you wouldn't want it automatically converted to a 100-digit integer).
16745
16746 @kindex H c 0-9
16747 @kindex H c c
16748 @tindex clean
16749 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c c} and @kbd{H c 0} through @kbd{H c 9}
16750 operate non-pervasively [@code{clean}].
16751
16752 @node Date Arithmetic, Financial Functions, Conversions, Arithmetic
16753 @section Date Arithmetic
16754
16755 @noindent
16756 @cindex Date arithmetic, additional functions
16757 The commands described in this section perform various conversions
16758 and calculations involving date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). They
16759 use the @kbd{t} (for time/date) prefix key followed by shifted
16760 letters.
16761
16762 The simplest date arithmetic is done using the regular @kbd{+} and @kbd{-}
16763 commands. In particular, adding a number to a date form advances the
16764 date form by a certain number of days; adding an HMS form to a date
16765 form advances the date by a certain amount of time; and subtracting two
16766 date forms produces a difference measured in days. The commands
16767 described here provide additional, more specialized operations on dates.
16768
16769 Many of these commands accept a numeric prefix argument; if you give
16770 plain @kbd{C-u} as the prefix, these commands will instead take the
16771 additional argument from the top of the stack.
16772
16773 @menu
16774 * Date Conversions::
16775 * Date Functions::
16776 * Time Zones::
16777 * Business Days::
16778 @end menu
16779
16780 @node Date Conversions, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic, Date Arithmetic
16781 @subsection Date Conversions
16782
16783 @noindent
16784 @kindex t D
16785 @pindex calc-date
16786 @tindex date
16787 The @kbd{t D} (@code{calc-date}) [@code{date}] command converts a
16788 date form into a number, measured in days since Jan 1, 1 AD. The
16789 result will be an integer if @var{date} is a pure date form, or a
16790 fraction or float if @var{date} is a date/time form. Or, if its
16791 argument is a number, it converts this number into a date form.
16792
16793 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{t D} takes that many objects
16794 (up to six) from the top of the stack and interprets them in one
16795 of the following ways:
16796
16797 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day})} function
16798 builds a pure date form out of the specified year, month, and
16799 day, which must all be integers. @var{Year} is a year number,
16800 such as 1991 (@emph{not} the same as 91!). @var{Month} must be
16801 an integer in the range 1 to 12; @var{day} must be in the range
16802 1 to 31. If the specified month has fewer than 31 days and
16803 @var{day} is too large, the equivalent day in the following
16804 month will be used.
16805
16806 The @samp{date(@var{month}, @var{day})} function builds a
16807 pure date form using the current year, as determined by the
16808 real-time clock.
16809
16810 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hms})}
16811 function builds a date/time form using an @var{hms} form.
16812
16813 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hour},
16814 @var{minute}, @var{second})} function builds a date/time form.
16815 @var{hour} should be an integer in the range 0 to 23;
16816 @var{minute} should be an integer in the range 0 to 59;
16817 @var{second} should be any real number in the range @samp{[0 .. 60)}.
16818 The last two arguments default to zero if omitted.
16819
16820 @kindex t J
16821 @pindex calc-julian
16822 @tindex julian
16823 @cindex Julian day counts, conversions
16824 The @kbd{t J} (@code{calc-julian}) [@code{julian}] command converts
16825 a date form into a Julian day count, which is the number of days
16826 since noon on Jan 1, 4713 BC. A pure date is converted to an integer
16827 Julian count representing noon of that day. A date/time form is
16828 converted to an exact floating-point Julian count, adjusted to
16829 interpret the date form in the current time zone but the Julian
16830 day count in Greenwich Mean Time. A numeric prefix argument allows
16831 you to specify the time zone; @pxref{Time Zones}. Use a prefix of
16832 zero to suppress the time zone adjustment. Note that pure date forms
16833 are never time-zone adjusted.
16834
16835 This command can also do the opposite conversion, from a Julian day
16836 count (either an integer day, or a floating-point day and time in
16837 the GMT zone), into a pure date form or a date/time form in the
16838 current or specified time zone.
16839
16840 @kindex t U
16841 @pindex calc-unix-time
16842 @tindex unixtime
16843 @cindex Unix time format, conversions
16844 The @kbd{t U} (@code{calc-unix-time}) [@code{unixtime}] command
16845 converts a date form into a Unix time value, which is the number of
16846 seconds since midnight on Jan 1, 1970, or vice-versa. The numeric result
16847 will be an integer if the current precision is 12 or less; for higher
16848 precisions, the result may be a float with (@var{precision}@minus{}12)
16849 digits after the decimal. Just as for @kbd{t J}, the numeric time
16850 is interpreted in the GMT time zone and the date form is interpreted
16851 in the current or specified zone. Some systems use Unix-like
16852 numbering but with the local time zone; give a prefix of zero to
16853 suppress the adjustment if so.
16854
16855 @kindex t C
16856 @pindex calc-convert-time-zones
16857 @tindex tzconv
16858 @cindex Time Zones, converting between
16859 The @kbd{t C} (@code{calc-convert-time-zones}) [@code{tzconv}]
16860 command converts a date form from one time zone to another. You
16861 are prompted for each time zone name in turn; you can answer with
16862 any suitable Calc time zone expression (@pxref{Time Zones}).
16863 If you answer either prompt with a blank line, the local time
16864 zone is used for that prompt. You can also answer the first
16865 prompt with @kbd{$} to take the two time zone names from the
16866 stack (and the date to be converted from the third stack level).
16867
16868 @node Date Functions, Business Days, Date Conversions, Date Arithmetic
16869 @subsection Date Functions
16870
16871 @noindent
16872 @kindex t N
16873 @pindex calc-now
16874 @tindex now
16875 The @kbd{t N} (@code{calc-now}) [@code{now}] command pushes the
16876 current date and time on the stack as a date form. The time is
16877 reported in terms of the specified time zone; with no numeric prefix
16878 argument, @kbd{t N} reports for the current time zone.
16879
16880 @kindex t P
16881 @pindex calc-date-part
16882 The @kbd{t P} (@code{calc-date-part}) command extracts one part
16883 of a date form. The prefix argument specifies the part; with no
16884 argument, this command prompts for a part code from 1 to 9.
16885 The various part codes are described in the following paragraphs.
16886
16887 @tindex year
16888 The @kbd{M-1 t P} [@code{year}] function extracts the year number
16889 from a date form as an integer, e.g., 1991. This and the
16890 following functions will also accept a real number for an
16891 argument, which is interpreted as a standard Calc day number.
16892 Note that this function will never return zero, since the year
16893 1 BC immediately precedes the year 1 AD.
16894
16895 @tindex month
16896 The @kbd{M-2 t P} [@code{month}] function extracts the month number
16897 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 12.
16898
16899 @tindex day
16900 The @kbd{M-3 t P} [@code{day}] function extracts the day number
16901 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 31.
16902
16903 @tindex hour
16904 The @kbd{M-4 t P} [@code{hour}] function extracts the hour from
16905 a date form as an integer in the range 0 (midnight) to 23. Note
16906 that 24-hour time is always used. This returns zero for a pure
16907 date form. This function (and the following two) also accept
16908 HMS forms as input.
16909
16910 @tindex minute
16911 The @kbd{M-5 t P} [@code{minute}] function extracts the minute
16912 from a date form as an integer in the range 0 to 59.
16913
16914 @tindex second
16915 The @kbd{M-6 t P} [@code{second}] function extracts the second
16916 from a date form. If the current precision is 12 or less,
16917 the result is an integer in the range 0 to 59. For higher
16918 precisions, the result may instead be a floating-point number.
16919
16920 @tindex weekday
16921 The @kbd{M-7 t P} [@code{weekday}] function extracts the weekday
16922 number from a date form as an integer in the range 0 (Sunday)
16923 to 6 (Saturday).
16924
16925 @tindex yearday
16926 The @kbd{M-8 t P} [@code{yearday}] function extracts the day-of-year
16927 number from a date form as an integer in the range 1 (January 1)
16928 to 366 (December 31 of a leap year).
16929
16930 @tindex time
16931 The @kbd{M-9 t P} [@code{time}] function extracts the time portion
16932 of a date form as an HMS form. This returns @samp{0@@ 0' 0"}
16933 for a pure date form.
16934
16935 @kindex t M
16936 @pindex calc-new-month
16937 @tindex newmonth
16938 The @kbd{t M} (@code{calc-new-month}) [@code{newmonth}] command
16939 computes a new date form that represents the first day of the month
16940 specified by the input date. The result is always a pure date
16941 form; only the year and month numbers of the input are retained.
16942 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n} in the range from 1 to 31,
16943 @kbd{t M} computes the @var{n}th day of the month. (If @var{n}
16944 is greater than the actual number of days in the month, or if
16945 @var{n} is zero, the last day of the month is used.)
16946
16947 @kindex t Y
16948 @pindex calc-new-year
16949 @tindex newyear
16950 The @kbd{t Y} (@code{calc-new-year}) [@code{newyear}] command
16951 computes a new pure date form that represents the first day of
16952 the year specified by the input. The month, day, and time
16953 of the input date form are lost. With a numeric prefix argument
16954 @var{n} in the range from 1 to 366, @kbd{t Y} computes the
16955 @var{n}th day of the year (366 is treated as 365 in non-leap
16956 years). A prefix argument of 0 computes the last day of the
16957 year (December 31). A negative prefix argument from @mathit{-1} to
16958 @mathit{-12} computes the first day of the @var{n}th month of the year.
16959
16960 @kindex t W
16961 @pindex calc-new-week
16962 @tindex newweek
16963 The @kbd{t W} (@code{calc-new-week}) [@code{newweek}] command
16964 computes a new pure date form that represents the Sunday on or before
16965 the input date. With a numeric prefix argument, it can be made to
16966 use any day of the week as the starting day; the argument must be in
16967 the range from 0 (Sunday) to 6 (Saturday). This function always
16968 subtracts between 0 and 6 days from the input date.
16969
16970 Here's an example use of @code{newweek}: Find the date of the next
16971 Wednesday after a given date. Using @kbd{M-3 t W} or @samp{newweek(d, 3)}
16972 will give you the @emph{preceding} Wednesday, so @samp{newweek(d+7, 3)}
16973 will give you the following Wednesday. A further look at the definition
16974 of @code{newweek} shows that if the input date is itself a Wednesday,
16975 this formula will return the Wednesday one week in the future. An
16976 exercise for the reader is to modify this formula to yield the same day
16977 if the input is already a Wednesday. Another interesting exercise is
16978 to preserve the time-of-day portion of the input (@code{newweek} resets
16979 the time to midnight; hint:@: how can @code{newweek} be defined in terms
16980 of the @code{weekday} function?).
16981
16982 @ignore
16983 @starindex
16984 @end ignore
16985 @tindex pwday
16986 The @samp{pwday(@var{date})} function (not on any key) computes the
16987 day-of-month number of the Sunday on or before @var{date}. With
16988 two arguments, @samp{pwday(@var{date}, @var{day})} computes the day
16989 number of the Sunday on or before day number @var{day} of the month
16990 specified by @var{date}. The @var{day} must be in the range from
16991 7 to 31; if the day number is greater than the actual number of days
16992 in the month, the true number of days is used instead. Thus
16993 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 7)} finds the first Sunday of the month, and
16994 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 31)} finds the last Sunday of the month.
16995 With a third @var{weekday} argument, @code{pwday} can be made to look
16996 for any day of the week instead of Sunday.
16997
16998 @kindex t I
16999 @pindex calc-inc-month
17000 @tindex incmonth
17001 The @kbd{t I} (@code{calc-inc-month}) [@code{incmonth}] command
17002 increases a date form by one month, or by an arbitrary number of
17003 months specified by a numeric prefix argument. The time portion,
17004 if any, of the date form stays the same. The day also stays the
17005 same, except that if the new month has fewer days the day
17006 number may be reduced to lie in the valid range. For example,
17007 @samp{incmonth(<Jan 31, 1991>)} produces @samp{<Feb 28, 1991>}.
17008 Because of this, @kbd{t I t I} and @kbd{M-2 t I} do not always give
17009 the same results (@samp{<Mar 28, 1991>} versus @samp{<Mar 31, 1991>}
17010 in this case).
17011
17012 @ignore
17013 @starindex
17014 @end ignore
17015 @tindex incyear
17016 The @samp{incyear(@var{date}, @var{step})} function increases
17017 a date form by the specified number of years, which may be
17018 any positive or negative integer. Note that @samp{incyear(d, n)}
17019 is equivalent to @w{@samp{incmonth(d, 12*n)}}, but these do not have
17020 simple equivalents in terms of day arithmetic because
17021 months and years have varying lengths. If the @var{step}
17022 argument is omitted, 1 year is assumed. There is no keyboard
17023 command for this function; use @kbd{C-u 12 t I} instead.
17024
17025 There is no @code{newday} function at all because @kbd{F} [@code{floor}]
17026 serves this purpose. Similarly, instead of @code{incday} and
17027 @code{incweek} simply use @expr{d + n} or @expr{d + 7 n}.
17028
17029 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}, for the @kbd{f ]} [@code{incr}] command
17030 which can adjust a date/time form by a certain number of seconds.
17031
17032 @node Business Days, Time Zones, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic
17033 @subsection Business Days
17034
17035 @noindent
17036 Often time is measured in ``business days'' or ``working days,''
17037 where weekends and holidays are skipped. Calc's normal date
17038 arithmetic functions use calendar days, so that subtracting two
17039 consecutive Mondays will yield a difference of 7 days. By contrast,
17040 subtracting two consecutive Mondays would yield 5 business days
17041 (assuming two-day weekends and the absence of holidays).
17042
17043 @kindex t +
17044 @kindex t -
17045 @tindex badd
17046 @tindex bsub
17047 @pindex calc-business-days-plus
17048 @pindex calc-business-days-minus
17049 The @kbd{t +} (@code{calc-business-days-plus}) [@code{badd}]
17050 and @kbd{t -} (@code{calc-business-days-minus}) [@code{bsub}]
17051 commands perform arithmetic using business days. For @kbd{t +},
17052 one argument must be a date form and the other must be a real
17053 number (positive or negative). If the number is not an integer,
17054 then a certain amount of time is added as well as a number of
17055 days; for example, adding 0.5 business days to a time in Friday
17056 evening will produce a time in Monday morning. It is also
17057 possible to add an HMS form; adding @samp{12@@ 0' 0"} also adds
17058 half a business day. For @kbd{t -}, the arguments are either a
17059 date form and a number or HMS form, or two date forms, in which
17060 case the result is the number of business days between the two
17061 dates.
17062
17063 @cindex @code{Holidays} variable
17064 @vindex Holidays
17065 By default, Calc considers any day that is not a Saturday or
17066 Sunday to be a business day. You can define any number of
17067 additional holidays by editing the variable @code{Holidays}.
17068 (There is an @w{@kbd{s H}} convenience command for editing this
17069 variable.) Initially, @code{Holidays} contains the vector
17070 @samp{[sat, sun]}. Entries in the @code{Holidays} vector may
17071 be any of the following kinds of objects:
17072
17073 @itemize @bullet
17074 @item
17075 Date forms (pure dates, not date/time forms). These specify
17076 particular days which are to be treated as holidays.
17077
17078 @item
17079 Intervals of date forms. These specify a range of days, all of
17080 which are holidays (e.g., Christmas week). @xref{Interval Forms}.
17081
17082 @item
17083 Nested vectors of date forms. Each date form in the vector is
17084 considered to be a holiday.
17085
17086 @item
17087 Any Calc formula which evaluates to one of the above three things.
17088 If the formula involves the variable @expr{y}, it stands for a
17089 yearly repeating holiday; @expr{y} will take on various year
17090 numbers like 1992. For example, @samp{date(y, 12, 25)} specifies
17091 Christmas day, and @samp{newweek(date(y, 11, 7), 4) + 21} specifies
17092 Thanksgiving (which is held on the fourth Thursday of November).
17093 If the formula involves the variable @expr{m}, that variable
17094 takes on month numbers from 1 to 12: @samp{date(y, m, 15)} is
17095 a holiday that takes place on the 15th of every month.
17096
17097 @item
17098 A weekday name, such as @code{sat} or @code{sun}. This is really
17099 a variable whose name is a three-letter, lower-case day name.
17100
17101 @item
17102 An interval of year numbers (integers). This specifies the span of
17103 years over which this holiday list is to be considered valid. Any
17104 business-day arithmetic that goes outside this range will result
17105 in an error message. Use this if you are including an explicit
17106 list of holidays, rather than a formula to generate them, and you
17107 want to make sure you don't accidentally go beyond the last point
17108 where the holidays you entered are complete. If there is no
17109 limiting interval in the @code{Holidays} vector, the default
17110 @samp{[1 .. 2737]} is used. (This is the absolute range of years
17111 for which Calc's business-day algorithms will operate.)
17112
17113 @item
17114 An interval of HMS forms. This specifies the span of hours that
17115 are to be considered one business day. For example, if this
17116 range is @samp{[9@@ 0' 0" .. 17@@ 0' 0"]} (i.e., 9am to 5pm), then
17117 the business day is only eight hours long, so that @kbd{1.5 t +}
17118 on @samp{<4:00pm Fri Dec 13, 1991>} will add one business day and
17119 four business hours to produce @samp{<12:00pm Tue Dec 17, 1991>}.
17120 Likewise, @kbd{t -} will now express differences in time as
17121 fractions of an eight-hour day. Times before 9am will be treated
17122 as 9am by business date arithmetic, and times at or after 5pm will
17123 be treated as 4:59:59pm. If there is no HMS interval in @code{Holidays},
17124 the full 24-hour day @samp{[0@ 0' 0" .. 24@ 0' 0"]} is assumed.
17125 (Regardless of the type of bounds you specify, the interval is
17126 treated as inclusive on the low end and exclusive on the high end,
17127 so that the work day goes from 9am up to, but not including, 5pm.)
17128 @end itemize
17129
17130 If the @code{Holidays} vector is empty, then @kbd{t +} and
17131 @kbd{t -} will act just like @kbd{+} and @kbd{-} because there will
17132 then be no difference between business days and calendar days.
17133
17134 Calc expands the intervals and formulas you give into a complete
17135 list of holidays for internal use. This is done mainly to make
17136 sure it can detect multiple holidays. (For example,
17137 @samp{<Jan 1, 1989>} is both New Year's Day and a Sunday, but
17138 Calc's algorithms take care to count it only once when figuring
17139 the number of holidays between two dates.)
17140
17141 Since the complete list of holidays for all the years from 1 to
17142 2737 would be huge, Calc actually computes only the part of the
17143 list between the smallest and largest years that have been involved
17144 in business-day calculations so far. Normally, you won't have to
17145 worry about this. Keep in mind, however, that if you do one
17146 calculation for 1992, and another for 1792, even if both involve
17147 only a small range of years, Calc will still work out all the
17148 holidays that fall in that 200-year span.
17149
17150 If you add a (positive) number of days to a date form that falls on a
17151 weekend or holiday, the date form is treated as if it were the most
17152 recent business day. (Thus adding one business day to a Friday,
17153 Saturday, or Sunday will all yield the following Monday.) If you
17154 subtract a number of days from a weekend or holiday, the date is
17155 effectively on the following business day. (So subtracting one business
17156 day from Saturday, Sunday, or Monday yields the preceding Friday.) The
17157 difference between two dates one or both of which fall on holidays
17158 equals the number of actual business days between them. These
17159 conventions are consistent in the sense that, if you add @var{n}
17160 business days to any date, the difference between the result and the
17161 original date will come out to @var{n} business days. (It can't be
17162 completely consistent though; a subtraction followed by an addition
17163 might come out a bit differently, since @kbd{t +} is incapable of
17164 producing a date that falls on a weekend or holiday.)
17165
17166 @ignore
17167 @starindex
17168 @end ignore
17169 @tindex holiday
17170 There is a @code{holiday} function, not on any keys, that takes
17171 any date form and returns 1 if that date falls on a weekend or
17172 holiday, as defined in @code{Holidays}, or 0 if the date is a
17173 business day.
17174
17175 @node Time Zones, , Business Days, Date Arithmetic
17176 @subsection Time Zones
17177
17178 @noindent
17179 @cindex Time zones
17180 @cindex Daylight savings time
17181 Time zones and daylight savings time are a complicated business.
17182 The conversions to and from Julian and Unix-style dates automatically
17183 compute the correct time zone and daylight savings adjustment to use,
17184 provided they can figure out this information. This section describes
17185 Calc's time zone adjustment algorithm in detail, in case you want to
17186 do conversions in different time zones or in case Calc's algorithms
17187 can't determine the right correction to use.
17188
17189 Adjustments for time zones and daylight savings time are done by
17190 @kbd{t U}, @kbd{t J}, @kbd{t N}, and @kbd{t C}, but not by any other
17191 commands. In particular, @samp{<may 1 1991> - <apr 1 1991>} evaluates
17192 to exactly 30 days even though there is a daylight-savings
17193 transition in between. This is also true for Julian pure dates:
17194 @samp{julian(<may 1 1991>) - julian(<apr 1 1991>)}. But Julian
17195 and Unix date/times will adjust for daylight savings time:
17196 @samp{julian(<12am may 1 1991>) - julian(<12am apr 1 1991>)}
17197 evaluates to @samp{29.95834} (that's 29 days and 23 hours)
17198 because one hour was lost when daylight savings commenced on
17199 April 7, 1991.
17200
17201 In brief, the idiom @samp{julian(@var{date1}) - julian(@var{date2})}
17202 computes the actual number of 24-hour periods between two dates, whereas
17203 @samp{@var{date1} - @var{date2}} computes the number of calendar
17204 days between two dates without taking daylight savings into account.
17205
17206 @pindex calc-time-zone
17207 @ignore
17208 @starindex
17209 @end ignore
17210 @tindex tzone
17211 The @code{calc-time-zone} [@code{tzone}] command converts the time
17212 zone specified by its numeric prefix argument into a number of
17213 seconds difference from Greenwich mean time (GMT). If the argument
17214 is a number, the result is simply that value multiplied by 3600.
17215 Typical arguments for North America are 5 (Eastern) or 8 (Pacific). If
17216 Daylight Savings time is in effect, one hour should be subtracted from
17217 the normal difference.
17218
17219 If you give a prefix of plain @kbd{C-u}, @code{calc-time-zone} (like other
17220 date arithmetic commands that include a time zone argument) takes the
17221 zone argument from the top of the stack. (In the case of @kbd{t J}
17222 and @kbd{t U}, the normal argument is then taken from the second-to-top
17223 stack position.) This allows you to give a non-integer time zone
17224 adjustment. The time-zone argument can also be an HMS form, or
17225 it can be a variable which is a time zone name in upper- or lower-case.
17226 For example @samp{tzone(PST) = tzone(8)} and @samp{tzone(pdt) = tzone(7)}
17227 (for Pacific standard and daylight savings times, respectively).
17228
17229 North American and European time zone names are defined as follows;
17230 note that for each time zone there is one name for standard time,
17231 another for daylight savings time, and a third for ``generalized'' time
17232 in which the daylight savings adjustment is computed from context.
17233
17234 @smallexample
17235 @group
17236 YST PST MST CST EST AST NST GMT WET MET MEZ
17237 9 8 7 6 5 4 3.5 0 -1 -2 -2
17238
17239 YDT PDT MDT CDT EDT ADT NDT BST WETDST METDST MESZ
17240 8 7 6 5 4 3 2.5 -1 -2 -3 -3
17241
17242 YGT PGT MGT CGT EGT AGT NGT BGT WEGT MEGT MEGZ
17243 9/8 8/7 7/6 6/5 5/4 4/3 3.5/2.5 0/-1 -1/-2 -2/-3 -2/-3
17244 @end group
17245 @end smallexample
17246
17247 @vindex math-tzone-names
17248 To define time zone names that do not appear in the above table,
17249 you must modify the Lisp variable @code{math-tzone-names}. This
17250 is a list of lists describing the different time zone names; its
17251 structure is best explained by an example. The three entries for
17252 Pacific Time look like this:
17253
17254 @smallexample
17255 @group
17256 ( ( "PST" 8 0 ) ; Name as an upper-case string, then standard
17257 ( "PDT" 8 -1 ) ; adjustment, then daylight savings adjustment.
17258 ( "PGT" 8 "PST" "PDT" ) ) ; Generalized time zone.
17259 @end group
17260 @end smallexample
17261
17262 @cindex @code{TimeZone} variable
17263 @vindex TimeZone
17264 With no arguments, @code{calc-time-zone} or @samp{tzone()} obtains an
17265 argument from the Calc variable @code{TimeZone} if a value has been
17266 stored for that variable. If not, Calc runs the Unix @samp{date}
17267 command and looks for one of the above time zone names in the output;
17268 if this does not succeed, @samp{tzone()} leaves itself unevaluated.
17269 The time zone name in the @samp{date} output may be followed by a signed
17270 adjustment, e.g., @samp{GMT+5} or @samp{GMT+0500} which specifies a
17271 number of hours and minutes to be added to the base time zone.
17272 Calc stores the time zone it finds into @code{TimeZone} to speed
17273 later calls to @samp{tzone()}.
17274
17275 The special time zone name @code{local} is equivalent to no argument,
17276 i.e., it uses the local time zone as obtained from the @code{date}
17277 command.
17278
17279 If the time zone name found is one of the standard or daylight
17280 savings zone names from the above table, and Calc's internal
17281 daylight savings algorithm says that time and zone are consistent
17282 (e.g., @code{PDT} accompanies a date that Calc's algorithm would also
17283 consider to be daylight savings, or @code{PST} accompanies a date
17284 that Calc would consider to be standard time), then Calc substitutes
17285 the corresponding generalized time zone (like @code{PGT}).
17286
17287 If your system does not have a suitable @samp{date} command, you
17288 may wish to put a @samp{(setq var-TimeZone ...)} in your Emacs
17289 initialization file to set the time zone. (Since you are interacting
17290 with the variable @code{TimeZone} directly from Emacs Lisp, the
17291 @code{var-} prefix needs to be present.) The easiest way to do
17292 this is to edit the @code{TimeZone} variable using Calc's @kbd{s T}
17293 command, then use the @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable})
17294 command to save the value of @code{TimeZone} permanently.
17295
17296 The @kbd{t J} and @code{t U} commands with no numeric prefix
17297 arguments do the same thing as @samp{tzone()}. If the current
17298 time zone is a generalized time zone, e.g., @code{EGT}, Calc
17299 examines the date being converted to tell whether to use standard
17300 or daylight savings time. But if the current time zone is explicit,
17301 e.g., @code{EST} or @code{EDT}, then that adjustment is used exactly
17302 and Calc's daylight savings algorithm is not consulted.
17303
17304 Some places don't follow the usual rules for daylight savings time.
17305 The state of Arizona, for example, does not observe daylight savings
17306 time. If you run Calc during the winter season in Arizona, the
17307 Unix @code{date} command will report @code{MST} time zone, which
17308 Calc will change to @code{MGT}. If you then convert a time that
17309 lies in the summer months, Calc will apply an incorrect daylight
17310 savings time adjustment. To avoid this, set your @code{TimeZone}
17311 variable explicitly to @code{MST} to force the use of standard,
17312 non-daylight-savings time.
17313
17314 @vindex math-daylight-savings-hook
17315 @findex math-std-daylight-savings
17316 By default Calc always considers daylight savings time to begin at
17317 2 a.m.@: on the first Sunday of April, and to end at 2 a.m.@: on the
17318 last Sunday of October. This is the rule that has been in effect
17319 in North America since 1987. If you are in a country that uses
17320 different rules for computing daylight savings time, you have two
17321 choices: Write your own daylight savings hook, or control time
17322 zones explicitly by setting the @code{TimeZone} variable and/or
17323 always giving a time-zone argument for the conversion functions.
17324
17325 The Lisp variable @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} holds the
17326 name of a function that is used to compute the daylight savings
17327 adjustment for a given date. The default is
17328 @code{math-std-daylight-savings}, which computes an adjustment
17329 (either 0 or @mathit{-1}) using the North American rules given above.
17330
17331 The daylight savings hook function is called with four arguments:
17332 The date, as a floating-point number in standard Calc format;
17333 a six-element list of the date decomposed into year, month, day,
17334 hour, minute, and second, respectively; a string which contains
17335 the generalized time zone name in upper-case, e.g., @code{"WEGT"};
17336 and a special adjustment to be applied to the hour value when
17337 converting into a generalized time zone (see below).
17338
17339 @findex math-prev-weekday-in-month
17340 The Lisp function @code{math-prev-weekday-in-month} is useful for
17341 daylight savings computations. This is an internal version of
17342 the user-level @code{pwday} function described in the previous
17343 section. It takes four arguments: The floating-point date value,
17344 the corresponding six-element date list, the day-of-month number,
17345 and the weekday number (0-6).
17346
17347 The default daylight savings hook ignores the time zone name, but a
17348 more sophisticated hook could use different algorithms for different
17349 time zones. It would also be possible to use different algorithms
17350 depending on the year number, but the default hook always uses the
17351 algorithm for 1987 and later. Here is a listing of the default
17352 daylight savings hook:
17353
17354 @smallexample
17355 (defun math-std-daylight-savings (date dt zone bump)
17356 (cond ((< (nth 1 dt) 4) 0)
17357 ((= (nth 1 dt) 4)
17358 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 7 0)))
17359 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) 0)
17360 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17361 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 3 bump)) -1 0))
17362 (t -1))))
17363 ((< (nth 1 dt) 10) -1)
17364 ((= (nth 1 dt) 10)
17365 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 31 0)))
17366 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) -1)
17367 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17368 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 2 bump)) 0 -1))
17369 (t 0))))
17370 (t 0))
17371 )
17372 @end smallexample
17373
17374 @noindent
17375 The @code{bump} parameter is equal to zero when Calc is converting
17376 from a date form in a generalized time zone into a GMT date value.
17377 It is @mathit{-1} when Calc is converting in the other direction. The
17378 adjustments shown above ensure that the conversion behaves correctly
17379 and reasonably around the 2 a.m.@: transition in each direction.
17380
17381 There is a ``missing'' hour between 2 a.m.@: and 3 a.m.@: at the
17382 beginning of daylight savings time; converting a date/time form that
17383 falls in this hour results in a time value for the following hour,
17384 from 3 a.m.@: to 4 a.m. At the end of daylight savings time, the
17385 hour from 1 a.m.@: to 2 a.m.@: repeats itself; converting a date/time
17386 form that falls in in this hour results in a time value for the first
17387 manifestation of that time (@emph{not} the one that occurs one hour later).
17388
17389 If @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} is @code{nil}, then the
17390 daylight savings adjustment is always taken to be zero.
17391
17392 In algebraic formulas, @samp{tzone(@var{zone}, @var{date})}
17393 computes the time zone adjustment for a given zone name at a
17394 given date. The @var{date} is ignored unless @var{zone} is a
17395 generalized time zone. If @var{date} is a date form, the
17396 daylight savings computation is applied to it as it appears.
17397 If @var{date} is a numeric date value, it is adjusted for the
17398 daylight-savings version of @var{zone} before being given to
17399 the daylight savings hook. This odd-sounding rule ensures
17400 that the daylight-savings computation is always done in
17401 local time, not in the GMT time that a numeric @var{date}
17402 is typically represented in.
17403
17404 @ignore
17405 @starindex
17406 @end ignore
17407 @tindex dsadj
17408 The @samp{dsadj(@var{date}, @var{zone})} function computes the
17409 daylight savings adjustment that is appropriate for @var{date} in
17410 time zone @var{zone}. If @var{zone} is explicitly in or not in
17411 daylight savings time (e.g., @code{PDT} or @code{PST}) the
17412 @var{date} is ignored. If @var{zone} is a generalized time zone,
17413 the algorithms described above are used. If @var{zone} is omitted,
17414 the computation is done for the current time zone.
17415
17416 @xref{Reporting Bugs}, for the address of Calc's author, if you
17417 should wish to contribute your improved versions of
17418 @code{math-tzone-names} and @code{math-daylight-savings-hook}
17419 to the Calc distribution.
17420
17421 @node Financial Functions, Binary Functions, Date Arithmetic, Arithmetic
17422 @section Financial Functions
17423
17424 @noindent
17425 Calc's financial or business functions use the @kbd{b} prefix
17426 key followed by a shifted letter. (The @kbd{b} prefix followed by
17427 a lower-case letter is used for operations on binary numbers.)
17428
17429 Note that the rate and the number of intervals given to these
17430 functions must be on the same time scale, e.g., both months or
17431 both years. Mixing an annual interest rate with a time expressed
17432 in months will give you very wrong answers!
17433
17434 It is wise to compute these functions to a higher precision than
17435 you really need, just to make sure your answer is correct to the
17436 last penny; also, you may wish to check the definitions at the end
17437 of this section to make sure the functions have the meaning you expect.
17438
17439 @menu
17440 * Percentages::
17441 * Future Value::
17442 * Present Value::
17443 * Related Financial Functions::
17444 * Depreciation Functions::
17445 * Definitions of Financial Functions::
17446 @end menu
17447
17448 @node Percentages, Future Value, Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17449 @subsection Percentages
17450
17451 @kindex M-%
17452 @pindex calc-percent
17453 @tindex %
17454 @tindex percent
17455 The @kbd{M-%} (@code{calc-percent}) command takes a percentage value,
17456 say 5.4, and converts it to an equivalent actual number. For example,
17457 @kbd{5.4 M-%} enters 0.054 on the stack. (That's the @key{META} or
17458 @key{ESC} key combined with @kbd{%}.)
17459
17460 Actually, @kbd{M-%} creates a formula of the form @samp{5.4%}.
17461 You can enter @samp{5.4%} yourself during algebraic entry. The
17462 @samp{%} operator simply means, ``the preceding value divided by
17463 100.'' The @samp{%} operator has very high precedence, so that
17464 @samp{1+8%} is interpreted as @samp{1+(8%)}, not as @samp{(1+8)%}.
17465 (The @samp{%} operator is just a postfix notation for the
17466 @code{percent} function, just like @samp{20!} is the notation for
17467 @samp{fact(20)}, or twenty-factorial.)
17468
17469 The formula @samp{5.4%} would normally evaluate immediately to
17470 0.054, but the @kbd{M-%} command suppresses evaluation as it puts
17471 the formula onto the stack. However, the next Calc command that
17472 uses the formula @samp{5.4%} will evaluate it as its first step.
17473 The net effect is that you get to look at @samp{5.4%} on the stack,
17474 but Calc commands see it as @samp{0.054}, which is what they expect.
17475
17476 In particular, @samp{5.4%} and @samp{0.054} are suitable values
17477 for the @var{rate} arguments of the various financial functions,
17478 but the number @samp{5.4} is probably @emph{not} suitable---it
17479 represents a rate of 540 percent!
17480
17481 The key sequence @kbd{M-% *} effectively means ``percent-of.''
17482 For example, @kbd{68 @key{RET} 25 M-% *} computes 17, which is 25% of
17483 68 (and also 68% of 25, which comes out to the same thing).
17484
17485 @kindex c %
17486 @pindex calc-convert-percent
17487 The @kbd{c %} (@code{calc-convert-percent}) command converts the
17488 value on the top of the stack from numeric to percentage form.
17489 For example, if 0.08 is on the stack, @kbd{c %} converts it to
17490 @samp{8%}. The quantity is the same, it's just represented
17491 differently. (Contrast this with @kbd{M-%}, which would convert
17492 this number to @samp{0.08%}.) The @kbd{=} key is a convenient way
17493 to convert a formula like @samp{8%} back to numeric form, 0.08.
17494
17495 To compute what percentage one quantity is of another quantity,
17496 use @kbd{/ c %}. For example, @w{@kbd{17 @key{RET} 68 / c %}} displays
17497 @samp{25%}.
17498
17499 @kindex b %
17500 @pindex calc-percent-change
17501 @tindex relch
17502 The @kbd{b %} (@code{calc-percent-change}) [@code{relch}] command
17503 calculates the percentage change from one number to another.
17504 For example, @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} produces the answer @samp{25%},
17505 since 50 is 25% larger than 40. A negative result represents a
17506 decrease: @kbd{50 @key{RET} 40 b %} produces @samp{-20%}, since 40 is
17507 20% smaller than 50. (The answers are different in magnitude
17508 because, in the first case, we're increasing by 25% of 40, but
17509 in the second case, we're decreasing by 20% of 50.) The effect
17510 of @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} is to compute @expr{(50-40)/40}, converting
17511 the answer to percentage form as if by @kbd{c %}.
17512
17513 @node Future Value, Present Value, Percentages, Financial Functions
17514 @subsection Future Value
17515
17516 @noindent
17517 @kindex b F
17518 @pindex calc-fin-fv
17519 @tindex fv
17520 The @kbd{b F} (@code{calc-fin-fv}) [@code{fv}] command computes
17521 the future value of an investment. It takes three arguments
17522 from the stack: @samp{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17523 If you give payments of @var{payment} every year for @var{n}
17524 years, and the money you have paid earns interest at @var{rate} per
17525 year, then this function tells you what your investment would be
17526 worth at the end of the period. (The actual interval doesn't
17527 have to be years, as long as @var{n} and @var{rate} are expressed
17528 in terms of the same intervals.) This function assumes payments
17529 occur at the @emph{end} of each interval.
17530
17531 @kindex I b F
17532 @tindex fvb
17533 The @kbd{I b F} [@code{fvb}] command does the same computation,
17534 but assuming your payments are at the beginning of each interval.
17535 Suppose you plan to deposit $1000 per year in a savings account
17536 earning 5.4% interest, starting right now. How much will be
17537 in the account after five years? @code{fvb(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5870.73}.
17538 Thus you will have earned $870 worth of interest over the years.
17539 Using the stack, this calculation would have been
17540 @kbd{5.4 M-% 5 @key{RET} 1000 I b F}. Note that the rate is expressed
17541 as a number between 0 and 1, @emph{not} as a percentage.
17542
17543 @kindex H b F
17544 @tindex fvl
17545 The @kbd{H b F} [@code{fvl}] command computes the future value
17546 of an initial lump sum investment. Suppose you could deposit
17547 those five thousand dollars in the bank right now; how much would
17548 they be worth in five years? @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 5000) = 6503.89}.
17549
17550 The algebraic functions @code{fv} and @code{fvb} accept an optional
17551 fourth argument, which is used as an initial lump sum in the sense
17552 of @code{fvl}. In other words, @code{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17553 @var{payment}, @var{initial}) = fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})
17554 + fvl(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{initial})}.
17555
17556 To illustrate the relationships between these functions, we could
17557 do the @code{fvb} calculation ``by hand'' using @code{fvl}. The
17558 final balance will be the sum of the contributions of our five
17559 deposits at various times. The first deposit earns interest for
17560 five years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 1300.78}. The second
17561 deposit only earns interest for four years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 4, 1000) =
17562 1234.13}. And so on down to the last deposit, which earns one
17563 year's interest: @code{fvl(5.4%, 1, 1000) = 1054.00}. The sum of
17564 these five values is, sure enough, $5870.73, just as was computed
17565 by @code{fvb} directly.
17566
17567 What does @code{fv(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5569.96} mean? The payments
17568 are now at the ends of the periods. The end of one year is the same
17569 as the beginning of the next, so what this really means is that we've
17570 lost the payment at year zero (which contributed $1300.78), but we're
17571 now counting the payment at year five (which, since it didn't have
17572 a chance to earn interest, counts as $1000). Indeed, @expr{5569.96 =
17573 5870.73 - 1300.78 + 1000} (give or take a bit of roundoff error).
17574
17575 @node Present Value, Related Financial Functions, Future Value, Financial Functions
17576 @subsection Present Value
17577
17578 @noindent
17579 @kindex b P
17580 @pindex calc-fin-pv
17581 @tindex pv
17582 The @kbd{b P} (@code{calc-fin-pv}) [@code{pv}] command computes
17583 the present value of an investment. Like @code{fv}, it takes
17584 three arguments: @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17585 It computes the present value of a series of regular payments.
17586 Suppose you have the chance to make an investment that will
17587 pay $2000 per year over the next four years; as you receive
17588 these payments you can put them in the bank at 9% interest.
17589 You want to know whether it is better to make the investment, or
17590 to keep the money in the bank where it earns 9% interest right
17591 from the start. The calculation @code{pv(9%, 4, 2000)} gives the
17592 result 6479.44. If your initial investment must be less than this,
17593 say, $6000, then the investment is worthwhile. But if you had to
17594 put up $7000, then it would be better just to leave it in the bank.
17595
17596 Here is the interpretation of the result of @code{pv}: You are
17597 trying to compare the return from the investment you are
17598 considering, which is @code{fv(9%, 4, 2000) = 9146.26}, with
17599 the return from leaving the money in the bank, which is
17600 @code{fvl(9%, 4, @var{x})} where @var{x} is the amount of money
17601 you would have to put up in advance. The @code{pv} function
17602 finds the break-even point, @expr{x = 6479.44}, at which
17603 @code{fvl(9%, 4, 6479.44)} is also equal to 9146.26. This is
17604 the largest amount you should be willing to invest.
17605
17606 @kindex I b P
17607 @tindex pvb
17608 The @kbd{I b P} [@code{pvb}] command solves the same problem,
17609 but with payments occurring at the beginning of each interval.
17610 It has the same relationship to @code{fvb} as @code{pv} has
17611 to @code{fv}. For example @code{pvb(9%, 4, 2000) = 7062.59},
17612 a larger number than @code{pv} produced because we get to start
17613 earning interest on the return from our investment sooner.
17614
17615 @kindex H b P
17616 @tindex pvl
17617 The @kbd{H b P} [@code{pvl}] command computes the present value of
17618 an investment that will pay off in one lump sum at the end of the
17619 period. For example, if we get our $8000 all at the end of the
17620 four years, @code{pvl(9%, 4, 8000) = 5667.40}. This is much
17621 less than @code{pv} reported, because we don't earn any interest
17622 on the return from this investment. Note that @code{pvl} and
17623 @code{fvl} are simple inverses: @code{fvl(9%, 4, 5667.40) = 8000}.
17624
17625 You can give an optional fourth lump-sum argument to @code{pv}
17626 and @code{pvb}; this is handled in exactly the same way as the
17627 fourth argument for @code{fv} and @code{fvb}.
17628
17629 @kindex b N
17630 @pindex calc-fin-npv
17631 @tindex npv
17632 The @kbd{b N} (@code{calc-fin-npv}) [@code{npv}] command computes
17633 the net present value of a series of irregular investments.
17634 The first argument is the interest rate. The second argument is
17635 a vector which represents the expected return from the investment
17636 at the end of each interval. For example, if the rate represents
17637 a yearly interest rate, then the vector elements are the return
17638 from the first year, second year, and so on.
17639
17640 Thus, @code{npv(9%, [2000,2000,2000,2000]) = pv(9%, 4, 2000) = 6479.44}.
17641 Obviously this function is more interesting when the payments are
17642 not all the same!
17643
17644 The @code{npv} function can actually have two or more arguments.
17645 Multiple arguments are interpreted in the same way as for the
17646 vector statistical functions like @code{vsum}.
17647 @xref{Single-Variable Statistics}. Basically, if there are several
17648 payment arguments, each either a vector or a plain number, all these
17649 values are collected left-to-right into the complete list of payments.
17650 A numeric prefix argument on the @kbd{b N} command says how many
17651 payment values or vectors to take from the stack.
17652
17653 @kindex I b N
17654 @tindex npvb
17655 The @kbd{I b N} [@code{npvb}] command computes the net present
17656 value where payments occur at the beginning of each interval
17657 rather than at the end.
17658
17659 @node Related Financial Functions, Depreciation Functions, Present Value, Financial Functions
17660 @subsection Related Financial Functions
17661
17662 @noindent
17663 The functions in this section are basically inverses of the
17664 present value functions with respect to the various arguments.
17665
17666 @kindex b M
17667 @pindex calc-fin-pmt
17668 @tindex pmt
17669 The @kbd{b M} (@code{calc-fin-pmt}) [@code{pmt}] command computes
17670 the amount of periodic payment necessary to amortize a loan.
17671 Thus @code{pmt(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{amount})} equals the
17672 value of @var{payment} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17673 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}.
17674
17675 @kindex I b M
17676 @tindex pmtb
17677 The @kbd{I b M} [@code{pmtb}] command does the same computation
17678 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. Like @code{pv} and
17679 @code{pvb}, these functions can also take a fourth argument which
17680 represents an initial lump-sum investment.
17681
17682 @kindex H b M
17683 The @kbd{H b M} key just invokes the @code{fvl} function, which is
17684 the inverse of @code{pvl}. There is no explicit @code{pmtl} function.
17685
17686 @kindex b #
17687 @pindex calc-fin-nper
17688 @tindex nper
17689 The @kbd{b #} (@code{calc-fin-nper}) [@code{nper}] command computes
17690 the number of regular payments necessary to amortize a loan.
17691 Thus @code{nper(@var{rate}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} equals
17692 the value of @var{n} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17693 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}. If @var{payment} is too small
17694 ever to amortize a loan for @var{amount} at interest rate @var{rate},
17695 the @code{nper} function is left in symbolic form.
17696
17697 @kindex I b #
17698 @tindex nperb
17699 The @kbd{I b #} [@code{nperb}] command does the same computation
17700 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. You can give a fourth
17701 lump-sum argument to these functions, but the computation will be
17702 rather slow in the four-argument case.
17703
17704 @kindex H b #
17705 @tindex nperl
17706 The @kbd{H b #} [@code{nperl}] command does the same computation
17707 using @code{pvl}. By exchanging @var{payment} and @var{amount} you
17708 can also get the solution for @code{fvl}. For example,
17709 @code{nperl(8%, 2000, 1000) = 9.006}, so if you place $1000 in a
17710 bank account earning 8%, it will take nine years to grow to $2000.
17711
17712 @kindex b T
17713 @pindex calc-fin-rate
17714 @tindex rate
17715 The @kbd{b T} (@code{calc-fin-rate}) [@code{rate}] command computes
17716 the rate of return on an investment. This is also an inverse of @code{pv}:
17717 @code{rate(@var{n}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} computes the value of
17718 @var{rate} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment}) =
17719 @var{amount}}. The result is expressed as a formula like @samp{6.3%}.
17720
17721 @kindex I b T
17722 @kindex H b T
17723 @tindex rateb
17724 @tindex ratel
17725 The @kbd{I b T} [@code{rateb}] and @kbd{H b T} [@code{ratel}]
17726 commands solve the analogous equations with @code{pvb} or @code{pvl}
17727 in place of @code{pv}. Also, @code{rate} and @code{rateb} can
17728 accept an optional fourth argument just like @code{pv} and @code{pvb}.
17729 To redo the above example from a different perspective,
17730 @code{ratel(9, 2000, 1000) = 8.00597%}, which says you will need an
17731 interest rate of 8% in order to double your account in nine years.
17732
17733 @kindex b I
17734 @pindex calc-fin-irr
17735 @tindex irr
17736 The @kbd{b I} (@code{calc-fin-irr}) [@code{irr}] command is the
17737 analogous function to @code{rate} but for net present value.
17738 Its argument is a vector of payments. Thus @code{irr(@var{payments})}
17739 computes the @var{rate} such that @code{npv(@var{rate}, @var{payments}) = 0};
17740 this rate is known as the @dfn{internal rate of return}.
17741
17742 @kindex I b I
17743 @tindex irrb
17744 The @kbd{I b I} [@code{irrb}] command computes the internal rate of
17745 return assuming payments occur at the beginning of each period.
17746
17747 @node Depreciation Functions, Definitions of Financial Functions, Related Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17748 @subsection Depreciation Functions
17749
17750 @noindent
17751 The functions in this section calculate @dfn{depreciation}, which is
17752 the amount of value that a possession loses over time. These functions
17753 are characterized by three parameters: @var{cost}, the original cost
17754 of the asset; @var{salvage}, the value the asset will have at the end
17755 of its expected ``useful life''; and @var{life}, the number of years
17756 (or other periods) of the expected useful life.
17757
17758 There are several methods for calculating depreciation that differ in
17759 the way they spread the depreciation over the lifetime of the asset.
17760
17761 @kindex b S
17762 @pindex calc-fin-sln
17763 @tindex sln
17764 The @kbd{b S} (@code{calc-fin-sln}) [@code{sln}] command computes the
17765 ``straight-line'' depreciation. In this method, the asset depreciates
17766 by the same amount every year (or period). For example,
17767 @samp{sln(12000, 2000, 5)} returns 2000. The asset costs $12000
17768 initially and will be worth $2000 after five years; it loses $2000
17769 per year.
17770
17771 @kindex b Y
17772 @pindex calc-fin-syd
17773 @tindex syd
17774 The @kbd{b Y} (@code{calc-fin-syd}) [@code{syd}] command computes the
17775 accelerated ``sum-of-years'-digits'' depreciation. Here the depreciation
17776 is higher during the early years of the asset's life. Since the
17777 depreciation is different each year, @kbd{b Y} takes a fourth @var{period}
17778 parameter which specifies which year is requested, from 1 to @var{life}.
17779 If @var{period} is outside this range, the @code{syd} function will
17780 return zero.
17781
17782 @kindex b D
17783 @pindex calc-fin-ddb
17784 @tindex ddb
17785 The @kbd{b D} (@code{calc-fin-ddb}) [@code{ddb}] command computes an
17786 accelerated depreciation using the double-declining balance method.
17787 It also takes a fourth @var{period} parameter.
17788
17789 For symmetry, the @code{sln} function will accept a @var{period}
17790 parameter as well, although it will ignore its value except that the
17791 return value will as usual be zero if @var{period} is out of range.
17792
17793 For example, pushing the vector @expr{[1,2,3,4,5]} (perhaps with @kbd{v x 5})
17794 and then mapping @kbd{V M ' [sln(12000,2000,5,$), syd(12000,2000,5,$),
17795 ddb(12000,2000,5,$)] @key{RET}} produces a matrix that allows us to compare
17796 the three depreciation methods:
17797
17798 @example
17799 @group
17800 [ [ 2000, 3333, 4800 ]
17801 [ 2000, 2667, 2880 ]
17802 [ 2000, 2000, 1728 ]
17803 [ 2000, 1333, 592 ]
17804 [ 2000, 667, 0 ] ]
17805 @end group
17806 @end example
17807
17808 @noindent
17809 (Values have been rounded to nearest integers in this figure.)
17810 We see that @code{sln} depreciates by the same amount each year,
17811 @kbd{syd} depreciates more at the beginning and less at the end,
17812 and @kbd{ddb} weights the depreciation even more toward the beginning.
17813
17814 Summing columns with @kbd{V R : +} yields @expr{[10000, 10000, 10000]};
17815 the total depreciation in any method is (by definition) the
17816 difference between the cost and the salvage value.
17817
17818 @node Definitions of Financial Functions, , Depreciation Functions, Financial Functions
17819 @subsection Definitions
17820
17821 @noindent
17822 For your reference, here are the actual formulas used to compute
17823 Calc's financial functions.
17824
17825 Calc will not evaluate a financial function unless the @var{rate} or
17826 @var{n} argument is known. However, @var{payment} or @var{amount} can
17827 be a variable. Calc expands these functions according to the
17828 formulas below for symbolic arguments only when you use the @kbd{a "}
17829 (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command, or when taking derivatives or
17830 integrals or solving equations involving the functions.
17831
17832 @ifinfo
17833 These formulas are shown using the conventions of Big display
17834 mode (@kbd{d B}); for example, the formula for @code{fv} written
17835 linearly is @samp{pmt * ((1 + rate)^n) - 1) / rate}.
17836
17837 @example
17838 n
17839 (1 + rate) - 1
17840 fv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ---------------
17841 rate
17842
17843 n
17844 ((1 + rate) - 1) (1 + rate)
17845 fvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------------------
17846 rate
17847
17848 n
17849 fvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17850
17851 -n
17852 1 - (1 + rate)
17853 pv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------
17854 rate
17855
17856 -n
17857 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17858 pvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * -----------------------------
17859 rate
17860
17861 -n
17862 pvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17863
17864 -1 -2 -3
17865 npv(rate, [a, b, c]) = a*(1 + rate) + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17866
17867 -1 -2
17868 npvb(rate, [a, b, c]) = a + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17869
17870 -n
17871 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17872 pmt(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17873 -n
17874 1 - (1 + rate)
17875
17876 -n
17877 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17878 pmtb(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17879 -n
17880 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17881
17882 amt * rate
17883 nper(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ------------, 1 + rate)
17884 pmt
17885
17886 amt * rate
17887 nperb(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ---------------, 1 + rate)
17888 pmt * (1 + rate)
17889
17890 amt
17891 nperl(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(---, 1 + rate)
17892 pmt
17893
17894 1/n
17895 pmt
17896 ratel(n, pmt, amt) = ------ - 1
17897 1/n
17898 amt
17899
17900 cost - salv
17901 sln(cost, salv, life) = -----------
17902 life
17903
17904 (cost - salv) * (life - per + 1)
17905 syd(cost, salv, life, per) = --------------------------------
17906 life * (life + 1) / 2
17907
17908 book * 2
17909 ddb(cost, salv, life, per) = --------, book = cost - depreciation so far
17910 life
17911 @end example
17912 @end ifinfo
17913 @tex
17914 \turnoffactive
17915 $$ \code{fv}(r, n, p) = p { (1 + r)^n - 1 \over r } $$
17916 $$ \code{fvb}(r, n, p) = p { ((1 + r)^n - 1) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17917 $$ \code{fvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^n $$
17918 $$ \code{pv}(r, n, p) = p { 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} \over r } $$
17919 $$ \code{pvb}(r, n, p) = p { (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17920 $$ \code{pvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^{-n} $$
17921 $$ \code{npv}(r, [a,b,c]) = a (1 + r)^{-1} + b (1 + r)^{-2} + c (1 + r)^{-3} $$
17922 $$ \code{npvb}(r, [a,b,c]) = a + b (1 + r)^{-1} + c (1 + r)^{-2} $$
17923 $$ \code{pmt}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} }$$
17924 $$ \code{pmtb}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over
17925 (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) } $$
17926 $$ \code{nper}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p }, 1 + r) $$
17927 $$ \code{nperb}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p (1 + r) }, 1 + r) $$
17928 $$ \code{nperl}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}({a \over p}, 1 + r) $$
17929 $$ \code{ratel}(n, p, a) = { p^{1/n} \over a^{1/n} } - 1 $$
17930 $$ \code{sln}(c, s, l) = { c - s \over l } $$
17931 $$ \code{syd}(c, s, l, p) = { (c - s) (l - p + 1) \over l (l+1) / 2 } $$
17932 $$ \code{ddb}(c, s, l, p) = { 2 (c - \hbox{depreciation so far}) \over l } $$
17933 @end tex
17934
17935 @noindent
17936 In @code{pmt} and @code{pmtb}, @expr{x=0} if omitted.
17937
17938 These functions accept any numeric objects, including error forms,
17939 intervals, and even (though not very usefully) complex numbers. The
17940 above formulas specify exactly the behavior of these functions with
17941 all sorts of inputs.
17942
17943 Note that if the first argument to the @code{log} in @code{nper} is
17944 negative, @code{nper} leaves itself in symbolic form rather than
17945 returning a (financially meaningless) complex number.
17946
17947 @samp{rate(num, pmt, amt)} solves the equation
17948 @samp{pv(rate, num, pmt) = amt} for @samp{rate} using @kbd{H a R}
17949 (@code{calc-find-root}), with the interval @samp{[.01% .. 100%]}
17950 for an initial guess. The @code{rateb} function is the same except
17951 that it uses @code{pvb}. Note that @code{ratel} can be solved
17952 directly; its formula is shown in the above list.
17953
17954 Similarly, @samp{irr(pmts)} solves the equation @samp{npv(rate, pmts) = 0}
17955 for @samp{rate}.
17956
17957 If you give a fourth argument to @code{nper} or @code{nperb}, Calc
17958 will also use @kbd{H a R} to solve the equation using an initial
17959 guess interval of @samp{[0 .. 100]}.
17960
17961 A fourth argument to @code{fv} simply sums the two components
17962 calculated from the above formulas for @code{fv} and @code{fvl}.
17963 The same is true of @code{fvb}, @code{pv}, and @code{pvb}.
17964
17965 The @kbd{ddb} function is computed iteratively; the ``book'' value
17966 starts out equal to @var{cost}, and decreases according to the above
17967 formula for the specified number of periods. If the book value
17968 would decrease below @var{salvage}, it only decreases to @var{salvage}
17969 and the depreciation is zero for all subsequent periods. The @code{ddb}
17970 function returns the amount the book value decreased in the specified
17971 period.
17972
17973 The Calc financial function names were borrowed mostly from Microsoft
17974 Excel and Borland's Quattro. The @code{ratel} function corresponds to
17975 @samp{@@CGR} in Borland's Reflex. The @code{nper} and @code{nperl}
17976 functions correspond to @samp{@@TERM} and @samp{@@CTERM} in Quattro,
17977 respectively. Beware that the Calc functions may take their arguments
17978 in a different order than the corresponding functions in your favorite
17979 spreadsheet.
17980
17981 @node Binary Functions, , Financial Functions, Arithmetic
17982 @section Binary Number Functions
17983
17984 @noindent
17985 The commands in this chapter all use two-letter sequences beginning with
17986 the @kbd{b} prefix.
17987
17988 @cindex Binary numbers
17989 The ``binary'' operations actually work regardless of the currently
17990 displayed radix, although their results make the most sense in a radix
17991 like 2, 8, or 16 (as obtained by the @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, or @w{@kbd{d 6}}
17992 commands, respectively). You may also wish to enable display of leading
17993 zeros with @kbd{d z}. @xref{Radix Modes}.
17994
17995 @cindex Word size for binary operations
17996 The Calculator maintains a current @dfn{word size} @expr{w}, an
17997 arbitrary positive or negative integer. For a positive word size, all
17998 of the binary operations described here operate modulo @expr{2^w}. In
17999 particular, negative arguments are converted to positive integers modulo
18000 @expr{2^w} by all binary functions.
18001
18002 If the word size is negative, binary operations produce 2's complement
18003 integers from
18004 @texline @math{-2^{-w-1}}
18005 @infoline @expr{-(2^(-w-1))}
18006 to
18007 @texline @math{2^{-w-1}-1}
18008 @infoline @expr{2^(-w-1)-1}
18009 inclusive. Either mode accepts inputs in any range; the sign of
18010 @expr{w} affects only the results produced.
18011
18012 @kindex b c
18013 @pindex calc-clip
18014 @tindex clip
18015 The @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip})
18016 [@code{clip}] command can be used to clip a number by reducing it modulo
18017 @expr{2^w}. The commands described in this chapter automatically clip
18018 their results to the current word size. Note that other operations like
18019 addition do not use the current word size, since integer addition
18020 generally is not ``binary.'' (However, @pxref{Simplification Modes},
18021 @code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}.) For example, with a word size of 8
18022 bits @kbd{b c} converts a number to the range 0 to 255; with a word
18023 size of @mathit{-8} @kbd{b c} converts to the range @mathit{-128} to 127.
18024
18025 @kindex b w
18026 @pindex calc-word-size
18027 The default word size is 32 bits. All operations except the shifts and
18028 rotates allow you to specify a different word size for that one
18029 operation by giving a numeric prefix argument: @kbd{C-u 8 b c} clips the
18030 top of stack to the range 0 to 255 regardless of the current word size.
18031 To set the word size permanently, use @kbd{b w} (@code{calc-word-size}).
18032 This command displays a prompt with the current word size; press @key{RET}
18033 immediately to keep this word size, or type a new word size at the prompt.
18034
18035 When the binary operations are written in symbolic form, they take an
18036 optional second (or third) word-size parameter. When a formula like
18037 @samp{and(a,b)} is finally evaluated, the word size current at that time
18038 will be used, but when @samp{and(a,b,-8)} is evaluated, a word size of
18039 @mathit{-8} will always be used. A symbolic binary function will be left
18040 in symbolic form unless the all of its argument(s) are integers or
18041 integer-valued floats.
18042
18043 If either or both arguments are modulo forms for which @expr{M} is a
18044 power of two, that power of two is taken as the word size unless a
18045 numeric prefix argument overrides it. The current word size is never
18046 consulted when modulo-power-of-two forms are involved.
18047
18048 @kindex b a
18049 @pindex calc-and
18050 @tindex and
18051 The @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}) [@code{and}] command computes the bitwise
18052 AND of the two numbers on the top of the stack. In other words, for each
18053 of the @expr{w} binary digits of the two numbers (pairwise), the corresponding
18054 bit of the result is 1 if and only if both input bits are 1:
18055 @samp{and(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1000}.
18056
18057 @kindex b o
18058 @pindex calc-or
18059 @tindex or
18060 The @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}) [@code{or}] command computes the bitwise
18061 inclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if either of the input bits, or
18062 both, are 1: @samp{or(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1110}.
18063
18064 @kindex b x
18065 @pindex calc-xor
18066 @tindex xor
18067 The @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}) [@code{xor}] command computes the bitwise
18068 exclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if exactly one of the input bits
18069 is 1: @samp{xor(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0110}.
18070
18071 @kindex b d
18072 @pindex calc-diff
18073 @tindex diff
18074 The @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}) [@code{diff}] command computes the bitwise
18075 difference of two numbers; this is defined by @samp{diff(a,b) = and(a,not(b))},
18076 so that @samp{diff(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0100}.
18077
18078 @kindex b n
18079 @pindex calc-not
18080 @tindex not
18081 The @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}) [@code{not}] command computes the bitwise
18082 NOT of a number. A bit is 1 if the input bit is 0 and vice-versa.
18083
18084 @kindex b l
18085 @pindex calc-lshift-binary
18086 @tindex lsh
18087 The @kbd{b l} (@code{calc-lshift-binary}) [@code{lsh}] command shifts a
18088 number left by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18089 prefix argument. A negative prefix argument performs a logical right shift,
18090 in which zeros are shifted in on the left. In symbolic form, @samp{lsh(a)}
18091 is short for @samp{lsh(a,1)}, which in turn is short for @samp{lsh(a,n,w)}.
18092 Bits shifted ``off the end,'' according to the current word size, are lost.
18093
18094 @kindex H b l
18095 @kindex H b r
18096 @ignore
18097 @mindex @idots
18098 @end ignore
18099 @kindex H b L
18100 @ignore
18101 @mindex @null
18102 @end ignore
18103 @kindex H b R
18104 @ignore
18105 @mindex @null
18106 @end ignore
18107 @kindex H b t
18108 The @kbd{H b l} command also does a left shift, but it takes two arguments
18109 from the stack (the value to shift, and, at top-of-stack, the number of
18110 bits to shift). This version interprets the prefix argument just like
18111 the regular binary operations, i.e., as a word size. The Hyperbolic flag
18112 has a similar effect on the rest of the binary shift and rotate commands.
18113
18114 @kindex b r
18115 @pindex calc-rshift-binary
18116 @tindex rsh
18117 The @kbd{b r} (@code{calc-rshift-binary}) [@code{rsh}] command shifts a
18118 number right by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18119 prefix argument: @samp{rsh(a,n) = lsh(a,-n)}.
18120
18121 @kindex b L
18122 @pindex calc-lshift-arith
18123 @tindex ash
18124 The @kbd{b L} (@code{calc-lshift-arith}) [@code{ash}] command shifts a
18125 number left. It is analogous to @code{lsh}, except that if the shift
18126 is rightward (the prefix argument is negative), an arithmetic shift
18127 is performed as described below.
18128
18129 @kindex b R
18130 @pindex calc-rshift-arith
18131 @tindex rash
18132 The @kbd{b R} (@code{calc-rshift-arith}) [@code{rash}] command performs
18133 an ``arithmetic'' shift to the right, in which the leftmost bit (according
18134 to the current word size) is duplicated rather than shifting in zeros.
18135 This corresponds to dividing by a power of two where the input is interpreted
18136 as a signed, twos-complement number. (The distinction between the @samp{rsh}
18137 and @samp{rash} operations is totally independent from whether the word
18138 size is positive or negative.) With a negative prefix argument, this
18139 performs a standard left shift.
18140
18141 @kindex b t
18142 @pindex calc-rotate-binary
18143 @tindex rot
18144 The @kbd{b t} (@code{calc-rotate-binary}) [@code{rot}] command rotates a
18145 number one bit to the left. The leftmost bit (according to the current
18146 word size) is dropped off the left and shifted in on the right. With a
18147 numeric prefix argument, the number is rotated that many bits to the left
18148 or right.
18149
18150 @xref{Set Operations}, for the @kbd{b p} and @kbd{b u} commands that
18151 pack and unpack binary integers into sets. (For example, @kbd{b u}
18152 unpacks the number @samp{2#11001} to the set of bit-numbers
18153 @samp{[0, 3, 4]}.) Type @kbd{b u V #} to count the number of ``1''
18154 bits in a binary integer.
18155
18156 Another interesting use of the set representation of binary integers
18157 is to reverse the bits in, say, a 32-bit integer. Type @kbd{b u} to
18158 unpack; type @kbd{31 @key{TAB} -} to replace each bit-number in the set
18159 with 31 minus that bit-number; type @kbd{b p} to pack the set back
18160 into a binary integer.
18161
18162 @node Scientific Functions, Matrix Functions, Arithmetic, Top
18163 @chapter Scientific Functions
18164
18165 @noindent
18166 The functions described here perform trigonometric and other transcendental
18167 calculations. They generally produce floating-point answers correct to the
18168 full current precision. The @kbd{H} (Hyperbolic) and @kbd{I} (Inverse)
18169 flag keys must be used to get some of these functions from the keyboard.
18170
18171 @kindex P
18172 @pindex calc-pi
18173 @cindex @code{pi} variable
18174 @vindex pi
18175 @kindex H P
18176 @cindex @code{e} variable
18177 @vindex e
18178 @kindex I P
18179 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
18180 @vindex gamma
18181 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
18182 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
18183 @kindex H I P
18184 @cindex @code{phi} variable
18185 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
18186 @cindex Golden ratio
18187 One miscellaneous command is shift-@kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}), which pushes
18188 the value of @cpi{} (at the current precision) onto the stack. With the
18189 Hyperbolic flag, it pushes the value @expr{e}, the base of natural logarithms.
18190 With the Inverse flag, it pushes Euler's constant
18191 @texline @math{\gamma}
18192 @infoline @expr{gamma}
18193 (about 0.5772). With both Inverse and Hyperbolic, it
18194 pushes the ``golden ratio''
18195 @texline @math{\phi}
18196 @infoline @expr{phi}
18197 (about 1.618). (At present, Euler's constant is not available
18198 to unlimited precision; Calc knows only the first 100 digits.)
18199 In Symbolic mode, these commands push the
18200 actual variables @samp{pi}, @samp{e}, @samp{gamma}, and @samp{phi},
18201 respectively, instead of their values; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}.
18202
18203 @ignore
18204 @mindex Q
18205 @end ignore
18206 @ignore
18207 @mindex I Q
18208 @end ignore
18209 @kindex I Q
18210 @tindex sqr
18211 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] function is described elsewhere;
18212 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}. With the Inverse flag [@code{sqr}], this command
18213 computes the square of the argument.
18214
18215 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
18216 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
18217 interpret a prefix argument.
18218
18219 @menu
18220 * Logarithmic Functions::
18221 * Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions::
18222 * Advanced Math Functions::
18223 * Branch Cuts::
18224 * Random Numbers::
18225 * Combinatorial Functions::
18226 * Probability Distribution Functions::
18227 @end menu
18228
18229 @node Logarithmic Functions, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions, Scientific Functions
18230 @section Logarithmic Functions
18231
18232 @noindent
18233 @kindex L
18234 @pindex calc-ln
18235 @tindex ln
18236 @ignore
18237 @mindex @null
18238 @end ignore
18239 @kindex I E
18240 The shift-@kbd{L} (@code{calc-ln}) [@code{ln}] command computes the natural
18241 logarithm of the real or complex number on the top of the stack. With
18242 the Inverse flag it computes the exponential function instead, although
18243 this is redundant with the @kbd{E} command.
18244
18245 @kindex E
18246 @pindex calc-exp
18247 @tindex exp
18248 @ignore
18249 @mindex @null
18250 @end ignore
18251 @kindex I L
18252 The shift-@kbd{E} (@code{calc-exp}) [@code{exp}] command computes the
18253 exponential, i.e., @expr{e} raised to the power of the number on the stack.
18254 The meanings of the Inverse and Hyperbolic flags follow from those for
18255 the @code{calc-ln} command.
18256
18257 @kindex H L
18258 @kindex H E
18259 @pindex calc-log10
18260 @tindex log10
18261 @tindex exp10
18262 @ignore
18263 @mindex @null
18264 @end ignore
18265 @kindex H I L
18266 @ignore
18267 @mindex @null
18268 @end ignore
18269 @kindex H I E
18270 The @kbd{H L} (@code{calc-log10}) [@code{log10}] command computes the common
18271 (base-10) logarithm of a number. (With the Inverse flag [@code{exp10}],
18272 it raises ten to a given power.) Note that the common logarithm of a
18273 complex number is computed by taking the natural logarithm and dividing
18274 by
18275 @texline @math{\ln10}.
18276 @infoline @expr{ln(10)}.
18277
18278 @kindex B
18279 @kindex I B
18280 @pindex calc-log
18281 @tindex log
18282 @tindex alog
18283 The @kbd{B} (@code{calc-log}) [@code{log}] command computes a logarithm
18284 to any base. For example, @kbd{1024 @key{RET} 2 B} produces 10, since
18285 @texline @math{2^{10} = 1024}.
18286 @infoline @expr{2^10 = 1024}.
18287 In certain cases like @samp{log(3,9)}, the result
18288 will be either @expr{1:2} or @expr{0.5} depending on the current Fraction
18289 mode setting. With the Inverse flag [@code{alog}], this command is
18290 similar to @kbd{^} except that the order of the arguments is reversed.
18291
18292 @kindex f I
18293 @pindex calc-ilog
18294 @tindex ilog
18295 The @kbd{f I} (@code{calc-ilog}) [@code{ilog}] command computes the
18296 integer logarithm of a number to any base. The number and the base must
18297 themselves be positive integers. This is the true logarithm, rounded
18298 down to an integer. Thus @kbd{ilog(x,10)} is 3 for all @expr{x} in the
18299 range from 1000 to 9999. If both arguments are positive integers, exact
18300 integer arithmetic is used; otherwise, this is equivalent to
18301 @samp{floor(log(x,b))}.
18302
18303 @kindex f E
18304 @pindex calc-expm1
18305 @tindex expm1
18306 The @kbd{f E} (@code{calc-expm1}) [@code{expm1}] command computes
18307 @texline @math{e^x - 1},
18308 @infoline @expr{exp(x)-1},
18309 but using an algorithm that produces a more accurate
18310 answer when the result is close to zero, i.e., when
18311 @texline @math{e^x}
18312 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
18313 is close to one.
18314
18315 @kindex f L
18316 @pindex calc-lnp1
18317 @tindex lnp1
18318 The @kbd{f L} (@code{calc-lnp1}) [@code{lnp1}] command computes
18319 @texline @math{\ln(x+1)},
18320 @infoline @expr{ln(x+1)},
18321 producing a more accurate answer when @expr{x} is close to zero.
18322
18323 @node Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Advanced Math Functions, Logarithmic Functions, Scientific Functions
18324 @section Trigonometric/Hyperbolic Functions
18325
18326 @noindent
18327 @kindex S
18328 @pindex calc-sin
18329 @tindex sin
18330 The shift-@kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}) [@code{sin}] command computes the sine
18331 of an angle or complex number. If the input is an HMS form, it is interpreted
18332 as degrees-minutes-seconds; otherwise, the input is interpreted according
18333 to the current angular mode. It is best to use Radians mode when operating
18334 on complex numbers.
18335
18336 Calc's ``units'' mechanism includes angular units like @code{deg},
18337 @code{rad}, and @code{grad}. While @samp{sin(45 deg)} is not evaluated
18338 all the time, the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command will
18339 simplify @samp{sin(45 deg)} by taking the sine of 45 degrees, regardless
18340 of the current angular mode. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
18341
18342 Also, the symbolic variable @code{pi} is not ordinarily recognized in
18343 arguments to trigonometric functions, as in @samp{sin(3 pi / 4)}, but
18344 the @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) command recognizes many such
18345 formulas when the current angular mode is Radians @emph{and} Symbolic
18346 mode is enabled; this example would be replaced by @samp{sqrt(2) / 2}.
18347 @xref{Symbolic Mode}. Beware, this simplification occurs even if you
18348 have stored a different value in the variable @samp{pi}; this is one
18349 reason why changing built-in variables is a bad idea. Arguments of
18350 the form @expr{x} plus a multiple of @cpiover{2} are also simplified.
18351 Calc includes similar formulas for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
18352
18353 The @kbd{a s} command knows all angles which are integer multiples of
18354 @cpiover{12}, @cpiover{10}, or @cpiover{8} radians. In Degrees mode,
18355 analogous simplifications occur for integer multiples of 15 or 18
18356 degrees, and for arguments plus multiples of 90 degrees.
18357
18358 @kindex I S
18359 @pindex calc-arcsin
18360 @tindex arcsin
18361 With the Inverse flag, @code{calc-sin} computes an arcsine. This is also
18362 available as the @code{calc-arcsin} command or @code{arcsin} algebraic
18363 function. The returned argument is converted to degrees, radians, or HMS
18364 notation depending on the current angular mode.
18365
18366 @kindex H S
18367 @pindex calc-sinh
18368 @tindex sinh
18369 @kindex H I S
18370 @pindex calc-arcsinh
18371 @tindex arcsinh
18372 With the Hyperbolic flag, @code{calc-sin} computes the hyperbolic
18373 sine, also available as @code{calc-sinh} [@code{sinh}]. With the
18374 Hyperbolic and Inverse flags, it computes the hyperbolic arcsine
18375 (@code{calc-arcsinh}) [@code{arcsinh}].
18376
18377 @kindex C
18378 @pindex calc-cos
18379 @tindex cos
18380 @ignore
18381 @mindex @idots
18382 @end ignore
18383 @kindex I C
18384 @pindex calc-arccos
18385 @ignore
18386 @mindex @null
18387 @end ignore
18388 @tindex arccos
18389 @ignore
18390 @mindex @null
18391 @end ignore
18392 @kindex H C
18393 @pindex calc-cosh
18394 @ignore
18395 @mindex @null
18396 @end ignore
18397 @tindex cosh
18398 @ignore
18399 @mindex @null
18400 @end ignore
18401 @kindex H I C
18402 @pindex calc-arccosh
18403 @ignore
18404 @mindex @null
18405 @end ignore
18406 @tindex arccosh
18407 @ignore
18408 @mindex @null
18409 @end ignore
18410 @kindex T
18411 @pindex calc-tan
18412 @ignore
18413 @mindex @null
18414 @end ignore
18415 @tindex tan
18416 @ignore
18417 @mindex @null
18418 @end ignore
18419 @kindex I T
18420 @pindex calc-arctan
18421 @ignore
18422 @mindex @null
18423 @end ignore
18424 @tindex arctan
18425 @ignore
18426 @mindex @null
18427 @end ignore
18428 @kindex H T
18429 @pindex calc-tanh
18430 @ignore
18431 @mindex @null
18432 @end ignore
18433 @tindex tanh
18434 @ignore
18435 @mindex @null
18436 @end ignore
18437 @kindex H I T
18438 @pindex calc-arctanh
18439 @ignore
18440 @mindex @null
18441 @end ignore
18442 @tindex arctanh
18443 The shift-@kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}] command computes the cosine
18444 of an angle or complex number, and shift-@kbd{T} (@code{calc-tan}) [@code{tan}]
18445 computes the tangent, along with all the various inverse and hyperbolic
18446 variants of these functions.
18447
18448 @kindex f T
18449 @pindex calc-arctan2
18450 @tindex arctan2
18451 The @kbd{f T} (@code{calc-arctan2}) [@code{arctan2}] command takes two
18452 numbers from the stack and computes the arc tangent of their ratio. The
18453 result is in the full range from @mathit{-180} (exclusive) to @mathit{+180}
18454 (inclusive) degrees, or the analogous range in radians. A similar
18455 result would be obtained with @kbd{/} followed by @kbd{I T}, but the
18456 value would only be in the range from @mathit{-90} to @mathit{+90} degrees
18457 since the division loses information about the signs of the two
18458 components, and an error might result from an explicit division by zero
18459 which @code{arctan2} would avoid. By (arbitrary) definition,
18460 @samp{arctan2(0,0)=0}.
18461
18462 @pindex calc-sincos
18463 @ignore
18464 @starindex
18465 @end ignore
18466 @tindex sincos
18467 @ignore
18468 @starindex
18469 @end ignore
18470 @ignore
18471 @mindex arc@idots
18472 @end ignore
18473 @tindex arcsincos
18474 The @code{calc-sincos} [@code{sincos}] command computes the sine and
18475 cosine of a number, returning them as a vector of the form
18476 @samp{[@var{cos}, @var{sin}]}.
18477 With the Inverse flag [@code{arcsincos}], this command takes a two-element
18478 vector as an argument and computes @code{arctan2} of the elements.
18479 (This command does not accept the Hyperbolic flag.)
18480
18481 @node Advanced Math Functions, Branch Cuts, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions
18482 @section Advanced Mathematical Functions
18483
18484 @noindent
18485 Calc can compute a variety of less common functions that arise in
18486 various branches of mathematics. All of the functions described in
18487 this section allow arbitrary complex arguments and, except as noted,
18488 will work to arbitrarily large precisions. They can not at present
18489 handle error forms or intervals as arguments.
18490
18491 NOTE: These functions are still experimental. In particular, their
18492 accuracy is not guaranteed in all domains. It is advisable to set the
18493 current precision comfortably higher than you actually need when
18494 using these functions. Also, these functions may be impractically
18495 slow for some values of the arguments.
18496
18497 @kindex f g
18498 @pindex calc-gamma
18499 @tindex gamma
18500 The @kbd{f g} (@code{calc-gamma}) [@code{gamma}] command computes the Euler
18501 gamma function. For positive integer arguments, this is related to the
18502 factorial function: @samp{gamma(n+1) = fact(n)}. For general complex
18503 arguments the gamma function can be defined by the following definite
18504 integral:
18505 @texline @math{\Gamma(a) = \int_0^\infty t^{a-1} e^t dt}.
18506 @infoline @expr{gamma(a) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, inf)}.
18507 (The actual implementation uses far more efficient computational methods.)
18508
18509 @kindex f G
18510 @tindex gammaP
18511 @ignore
18512 @mindex @idots
18513 @end ignore
18514 @kindex I f G
18515 @ignore
18516 @mindex @null
18517 @end ignore
18518 @kindex H f G
18519 @ignore
18520 @mindex @null
18521 @end ignore
18522 @kindex H I f G
18523 @pindex calc-inc-gamma
18524 @ignore
18525 @mindex @null
18526 @end ignore
18527 @tindex gammaQ
18528 @ignore
18529 @mindex @null
18530 @end ignore
18531 @tindex gammag
18532 @ignore
18533 @mindex @null
18534 @end ignore
18535 @tindex gammaG
18536 The @kbd{f G} (@code{calc-inc-gamma}) [@code{gammaP}] command computes
18537 the incomplete gamma function, denoted @samp{P(a,x)}. This is defined by
18538 the integral,
18539 @texline @math{P(a,x) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} e^t dt \right) / \Gamma(a)}.
18540 @infoline @expr{gammaP(a,x) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, x) / gamma(a)}.
18541 This implies that @samp{gammaP(a,inf) = 1} for any @expr{a} (see the
18542 definition of the normal gamma function).
18543
18544 Several other varieties of incomplete gamma function are defined.
18545 The complement of @expr{P(a,x)}, called @expr{Q(a,x) = 1-P(a,x)} by
18546 some authors, is computed by the @kbd{I f G} [@code{gammaQ}] command.
18547 You can think of this as taking the other half of the integral, from
18548 @expr{x} to infinity.
18549
18550 @ifinfo
18551 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define @expr{P(a,x)}
18552 and @expr{Q(a,x)} but without the normalizing @expr{1/gamma(a)}
18553 factor are called @expr{g(a,x)} and @expr{G(a,x)}, respectively
18554 (where @expr{g} and @expr{G} represent the lower- and upper-case Greek
18555 letter gamma). You can obtain these using the @kbd{H f G} [@code{gammag}]
18556 and @kbd{H I f G} [@code{gammaG}] commands.
18557 @end ifinfo
18558 @tex
18559 \turnoffactive
18560 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define $P(a,x)$
18561 and $Q(a,x)$ but without the normalizing $1/\Gamma(a)$
18562 factor are called $\gamma(a,x)$ and $\Gamma(a,x)$, respectively.
18563 You can obtain these using the \kbd{H f G} [\code{gammag}] and
18564 \kbd{I H f G} [\code{gammaG}] commands.
18565 @end tex
18566
18567 @kindex f b
18568 @pindex calc-beta
18569 @tindex beta
18570 The @kbd{f b} (@code{calc-beta}) [@code{beta}] command computes the
18571 Euler beta function, which is defined in terms of the gamma function as
18572 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \Gamma(a) \Gamma(b) / \Gamma(a+b)},
18573 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = gamma(a) gamma(b) / gamma(a+b)},
18574 or by
18575 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \int_0^1 t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt}.
18576 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, 1)}.
18577
18578 @kindex f B
18579 @kindex H f B
18580 @pindex calc-inc-beta
18581 @tindex betaI
18582 @tindex betaB
18583 The @kbd{f B} (@code{calc-inc-beta}) [@code{betaI}] command computes
18584 the incomplete beta function @expr{I(x,a,b)}. It is defined by
18585 @texline @math{I(x,a,b) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt \right) / B(a,b)}.
18586 @infoline @expr{betaI(x,a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, x) / beta(a,b)}.
18587 Once again, the @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix gives the corresponding
18588 un-normalized version [@code{betaB}].
18589
18590 @kindex f e
18591 @kindex I f e
18592 @pindex calc-erf
18593 @tindex erf
18594 @tindex erfc
18595 The @kbd{f e} (@code{calc-erf}) [@code{erf}] command computes the
18596 error function
18597 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) = {2 \over \sqrt{\pi}} \int_0^x e^{-t^2} dt}.
18598 @infoline @expr{erf(x) = 2 integ(exp(-(t^2)), t, 0, x) / sqrt(pi)}.
18599 The complementary error function @kbd{I f e} (@code{calc-erfc}) [@code{erfc}]
18600 is the corresponding integral from @samp{x} to infinity; the sum
18601 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) + \hbox{erfc}(x) = 1}.
18602 @infoline @expr{erf(x) + erfc(x) = 1}.
18603
18604 @kindex f j
18605 @kindex f y
18606 @pindex calc-bessel-J
18607 @pindex calc-bessel-Y
18608 @tindex besJ
18609 @tindex besY
18610 The @kbd{f j} (@code{calc-bessel-J}) [@code{besJ}] and @kbd{f y}
18611 (@code{calc-bessel-Y}) [@code{besY}] commands compute the Bessel
18612 functions of the first and second kinds, respectively.
18613 In @samp{besJ(n,x)} and @samp{besY(n,x)} the ``order'' parameter
18614 @expr{n} is often an integer, but is not required to be one.
18615 Calc's implementation of the Bessel functions currently limits the
18616 precision to 8 digits, and may not be exact even to that precision.
18617 Use with care!
18618
18619 @node Branch Cuts, Random Numbers, Advanced Math Functions, Scientific Functions
18620 @section Branch Cuts and Principal Values
18621
18622 @noindent
18623 @cindex Branch cuts
18624 @cindex Principal values
18625 All of the logarithmic, trigonometric, and other scientific functions are
18626 defined for complex numbers as well as for reals.
18627 This section describes the values
18628 returned in cases where the general result is a family of possible values.
18629 Calc follows section 12.5.3 of Steele's @dfn{Common Lisp, the Language},
18630 second edition, in these matters. This section will describe each
18631 function briefly; for a more detailed discussion (including some nifty
18632 diagrams), consult Steele's book.
18633
18634 Note that the branch cuts for @code{arctan} and @code{arctanh} were
18635 changed between the first and second editions of Steele. Versions of
18636 Calc starting with 2.00 follow the second edition.
18637
18638 The new branch cuts exactly match those of the HP-28/48 calculators.
18639 They also match those of Mathematica 1.2, except that Mathematica's
18640 @code{arctan} cut is always in the right half of the complex plane,
18641 and its @code{arctanh} cut is always in the top half of the plane.
18642 Calc's cuts are continuous with quadrants I and III for @code{arctan},
18643 or II and IV for @code{arctanh}.
18644
18645 Note: The current implementations of these functions with complex arguments
18646 are designed with proper behavior around the branch cuts in mind, @emph{not}
18647 efficiency or accuracy. You may need to increase the floating precision
18648 and wait a while to get suitable answers from them.
18649
18650 For @samp{sqrt(a+bi)}: When @expr{a<0} and @expr{b} is small but positive
18651 or zero, the result is close to the @expr{+i} axis. For @expr{b} small and
18652 negative, the result is close to the @expr{-i} axis. The result always lies
18653 in the right half of the complex plane.
18654
18655 For @samp{ln(a+bi)}: The real part is defined as @samp{ln(abs(a+bi))}.
18656 The imaginary part is defined as @samp{arg(a+bi) = arctan2(b,a)}.
18657 Thus the branch cuts for @code{sqrt} and @code{ln} both lie on the
18658 negative real axis.
18659
18660 The following table describes these branch cuts in another way.
18661 If the real and imaginary parts of @expr{z} are as shown, then
18662 the real and imaginary parts of @expr{f(z)} will be as shown.
18663 Here @code{eps} stands for a small positive value; each
18664 occurrence of @code{eps} may stand for a different small value.
18665
18666 @smallexample
18667 z sqrt(z) ln(z)
18668 ----------------------------------------
18669 +, 0 +, 0 any, 0
18670 -, 0 0, + any, pi
18671 -, +eps +eps, + +eps, +
18672 -, -eps +eps, - +eps, -
18673 @end smallexample
18674
18675 For @samp{z1^z2}: This is defined by @samp{exp(ln(z1)*z2)}.
18676 One interesting consequence of this is that @samp{(-8)^1:3} does
18677 not evaluate to @mathit{-2} as you might expect, but to the complex
18678 number @expr{(1., 1.732)}. Both of these are valid cube roots
18679 of @mathit{-8} (as is @expr{(1., -1.732)}); Calc chooses a perhaps
18680 less-obvious root for the sake of mathematical consistency.
18681
18682 For @samp{arcsin(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(i*z + sqrt(1-z^2))}.
18683 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18684
18685 For @samp{arccos(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(z + i*sqrt(1-z^2))},
18686 or equivalently by @samp{pi/2 - arcsin(z)}. The branch cuts are on
18687 the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18688
18689 For @samp{arctan(z)}: This is defined by
18690 @samp{(ln(1+i*z) - ln(1-i*z)) / (2*i)}. The branch cuts are on the
18691 imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and above @expr{i}.
18692
18693 For @samp{arcsinh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{ln(z + sqrt(1+z^2))}.
18694 The branch cuts are on the imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and
18695 above @expr{i}.
18696
18697 For @samp{arccosh(z)}: This is defined by
18698 @samp{ln(z + (z+1)*sqrt((z-1)/(z+1)))}. The branch cut is on the
18699 real axis less than 1.
18700
18701 For @samp{arctanh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{(ln(1+z) - ln(1-z)) / 2}.
18702 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18703
18704 The following tables for @code{arcsin}, @code{arccos}, and
18705 @code{arctan} assume the current angular mode is Radians. The
18706 hyperbolic functions operate independently of the angular mode.
18707
18708 @smallexample
18709 z arcsin(z) arccos(z)
18710 -------------------------------------------------------
18711 (-1..1), 0 (-pi/2..pi/2), 0 (0..pi), 0
18712 (-1..1), +eps (-pi/2..pi/2), +eps (0..pi), -eps
18713 (-1..1), -eps (-pi/2..pi/2), -eps (0..pi), +eps
18714 <-1, 0 -pi/2, + pi, -
18715 <-1, +eps -pi/2 + eps, + pi - eps, -
18716 <-1, -eps -pi/2 + eps, - pi - eps, +
18717 >1, 0 pi/2, - 0, +
18718 >1, +eps pi/2 - eps, + +eps, -
18719 >1, -eps pi/2 - eps, - +eps, +
18720 @end smallexample
18721
18722 @smallexample
18723 z arccosh(z) arctanh(z)
18724 -----------------------------------------------------
18725 (-1..1), 0 0, (0..pi) any, 0
18726 (-1..1), +eps +eps, (0..pi) any, +eps
18727 (-1..1), -eps +eps, (-pi..0) any, -eps
18728 <-1, 0 +, pi -, pi/2
18729 <-1, +eps +, pi - eps -, pi/2 - eps
18730 <-1, -eps +, -pi + eps -, -pi/2 + eps
18731 >1, 0 +, 0 +, -pi/2
18732 >1, +eps +, +eps +, pi/2 - eps
18733 >1, -eps +, -eps +, -pi/2 + eps
18734 @end smallexample
18735
18736 @smallexample
18737 z arcsinh(z) arctan(z)
18738 -----------------------------------------------------
18739 0, (-1..1) 0, (-pi/2..pi/2) 0, any
18740 0, <-1 -, -pi/2 -pi/2, -
18741 +eps, <-1 +, -pi/2 + eps pi/2 - eps, -
18742 -eps, <-1 -, -pi/2 + eps -pi/2 + eps, -
18743 0, >1 +, pi/2 pi/2, +
18744 +eps, >1 +, pi/2 - eps pi/2 - eps, +
18745 -eps, >1 -, pi/2 - eps -pi/2 + eps, +
18746 @end smallexample
18747
18748 Finally, the following identities help to illustrate the relationship
18749 between the complex trigonometric and hyperbolic functions. They
18750 are valid everywhere, including on the branch cuts.
18751
18752 @smallexample
18753 sin(i*z) = i*sinh(z) arcsin(i*z) = i*arcsinh(z)
18754 cos(i*z) = cosh(z) arcsinh(i*z) = i*arcsin(z)
18755 tan(i*z) = i*tanh(z) arctan(i*z) = i*arctanh(z)
18756 sinh(i*z) = i*sin(z) cosh(i*z) = cos(z)
18757 @end smallexample
18758
18759 The ``advanced math'' functions (gamma, Bessel, etc.@:) are also defined
18760 for general complex arguments, but their branch cuts and principal values
18761 are not rigorously specified at present.
18762
18763 @node Random Numbers, Combinatorial Functions, Branch Cuts, Scientific Functions
18764 @section Random Numbers
18765
18766 @noindent
18767 @kindex k r
18768 @pindex calc-random
18769 @tindex random
18770 The @kbd{k r} (@code{calc-random}) [@code{random}] command produces
18771 random numbers of various sorts.
18772
18773 Given a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{M}, it produces a random
18774 integer @expr{N} in the range
18775 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}.
18776 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}.
18777 Each of the @expr{M} values appears with equal probability.
18778
18779 With no numeric prefix argument, the @kbd{k r} command takes its argument
18780 from the stack instead. Once again, if this is a positive integer @expr{M}
18781 the result is a random integer less than @expr{M}. However, note that
18782 while numeric prefix arguments are limited to six digits or so, an @expr{M}
18783 taken from the stack can be arbitrarily large. If @expr{M} is negative,
18784 the result is a random integer in the range
18785 @texline @math{M < N \le 0}.
18786 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0}.
18787
18788 If the value on the stack is a floating-point number @expr{M}, the result
18789 is a random floating-point number @expr{N} in the range
18790 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}
18791 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}
18792 or
18793 @texline @math{M < N \le 0},
18794 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0},
18795 according to the sign of @expr{M}.
18796
18797 If @expr{M} is zero, the result is a Gaussian-distributed random real
18798 number; the distribution has a mean of zero and a standard deviation
18799 of one. The algorithm used generates random numbers in pairs; thus,
18800 every other call to this function will be especially fast.
18801
18802 If @expr{M} is an error form
18803 @texline @math{m} @code{+/-} @math{\sigma}
18804 @infoline @samp{m +/- s}
18805 where @var{m} and
18806 @texline @math{\sigma}
18807 @infoline @var{s}
18808 are both real numbers, the result uses a Gaussian distribution with mean
18809 @var{m} and standard deviation
18810 @texline @math{\sigma}.
18811 @var{s}.
18812
18813 If @expr{M} is an interval form, the lower and upper bounds specify the
18814 acceptable limits of the random numbers. If both bounds are integers,
18815 the result is a random integer in the specified range. If either bound
18816 is floating-point, the result is a random real number in the specified
18817 range. If the interval is open at either end, the result will be sure
18818 not to equal that end value. (This makes a big difference for integer
18819 intervals, but for floating-point intervals it's relatively minor:
18820 with a precision of 6, @samp{random([1.0..2.0))} will return any of one
18821 million numbers from 1.00000 to 1.99999; @samp{random([1.0..2.0])} may
18822 additionally return 2.00000, but the probability of this happening is
18823 extremely small.)
18824
18825 If @expr{M} is a vector, the result is one element taken at random from
18826 the vector. All elements of the vector are given equal probabilities.
18827
18828 @vindex RandSeed
18829 The sequence of numbers produced by @kbd{k r} is completely random by
18830 default, i.e., the sequence is seeded each time you start Calc using
18831 the current time and other information. You can get a reproducible
18832 sequence by storing a particular ``seed value'' in the Calc variable
18833 @code{RandSeed}. Any integer will do for a seed; integers of from 1
18834 to 12 digits are good. If you later store a different integer into
18835 @code{RandSeed}, Calc will switch to a different pseudo-random
18836 sequence. If you ``unstore'' @code{RandSeed}, Calc will re-seed itself
18837 from the current time. If you store the same integer that you used
18838 before back into @code{RandSeed}, you will get the exact same sequence
18839 of random numbers as before.
18840
18841 @pindex calc-rrandom
18842 The @code{calc-rrandom} command (not on any key) produces a random real
18843 number between zero and one. It is equivalent to @samp{random(1.0)}.
18844
18845 @kindex k a
18846 @pindex calc-random-again
18847 The @kbd{k a} (@code{calc-random-again}) command produces another random
18848 number, re-using the most recent value of @expr{M}. With a numeric
18849 prefix argument @var{n}, it produces @var{n} more random numbers using
18850 that value of @expr{M}.
18851
18852 @kindex k h
18853 @pindex calc-shuffle
18854 @tindex shuffle
18855 The @kbd{k h} (@code{calc-shuffle}) command produces a vector of several
18856 random values with no duplicates. The value on the top of the stack
18857 specifies the set from which the random values are drawn, and may be any
18858 of the @expr{M} formats described above. The numeric prefix argument
18859 gives the length of the desired list. (If you do not provide a numeric
18860 prefix argument, the length of the list is taken from the top of the
18861 stack, and @expr{M} from second-to-top.)
18862
18863 If @expr{M} is a floating-point number, zero, or an error form (so
18864 that the random values are being drawn from the set of real numbers)
18865 there is little practical difference between using @kbd{k h} and using
18866 @kbd{k r} several times. But if the set of possible values consists
18867 of just a few integers, or the elements of a vector, then there is
18868 a very real chance that multiple @kbd{k r}'s will produce the same
18869 number more than once. The @kbd{k h} command produces a vector whose
18870 elements are always distinct. (Actually, there is a slight exception:
18871 If @expr{M} is a vector, no given vector element will be drawn more
18872 than once, but if several elements of @expr{M} are equal, they may
18873 each make it into the result vector.)
18874
18875 One use of @kbd{k h} is to rearrange a list at random. This happens
18876 if the prefix argument is equal to the number of values in the list:
18877 @kbd{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3] 5 k h} might produce the permuted list
18878 @samp{[2.5, 1, 1.5, 3, 2]}. As a convenient feature, if the argument
18879 @var{n} is negative it is replaced by the size of the set represented
18880 by @expr{M}. Naturally, this is allowed only when @expr{M} specifies
18881 a small discrete set of possibilities.
18882
18883 To do the equivalent of @kbd{k h} but with duplications allowed,
18884 given @expr{M} on the stack and with @var{n} just entered as a numeric
18885 prefix, use @kbd{v b} to build a vector of copies of @expr{M}, then use
18886 @kbd{V M k r} to ``map'' the normal @kbd{k r} function over the
18887 elements of this vector. @xref{Matrix Functions}.
18888
18889 @menu
18890 * Random Number Generator:: (Complete description of Calc's algorithm)
18891 @end menu
18892
18893 @node Random Number Generator, , Random Numbers, Random Numbers
18894 @subsection Random Number Generator
18895
18896 Calc's random number generator uses several methods to ensure that
18897 the numbers it produces are highly random. Knuth's @emph{Art of
18898 Computer Programming}, Volume II, contains a thorough description
18899 of the theory of random number generators and their measurement and
18900 characterization.
18901
18902 If @code{RandSeed} has no stored value, Calc calls Emacs' built-in
18903 @code{random} function to get a stream of random numbers, which it
18904 then treats in various ways to avoid problems inherent in the simple
18905 random number generators that many systems use to implement @code{random}.
18906
18907 When Calc's random number generator is first invoked, it ``seeds''
18908 the low-level random sequence using the time of day, so that the
18909 random number sequence will be different every time you use Calc.
18910
18911 Since Emacs Lisp doesn't specify the range of values that will be
18912 returned by its @code{random} function, Calc exercises the function
18913 several times to estimate the range. When Calc subsequently uses
18914 the @code{random} function, it takes only 10 bits of the result
18915 near the most-significant end. (It avoids at least the bottom
18916 four bits, preferably more, and also tries to avoid the top two
18917 bits.) This strategy works well with the linear congruential
18918 generators that are typically used to implement @code{random}.
18919
18920 If @code{RandSeed} contains an integer, Calc uses this integer to
18921 seed an ``additive congruential'' method (Knuth's algorithm 3.2.2A,
18922 computing
18923 @texline @math{X_{n-55} - X_{n-24}}.
18924 @infoline @expr{X_n-55 - X_n-24}).
18925 This method expands the seed
18926 value into a large table which is maintained internally; the variable
18927 @code{RandSeed} is changed from, e.g., 42 to the vector @expr{[42]}
18928 to indicate that the seed has been absorbed into this table. When
18929 @code{RandSeed} contains a vector, @kbd{k r} and related commands
18930 continue to use the same internal table as last time. There is no
18931 way to extract the complete state of the random number generator
18932 so that you can restart it from any point; you can only restart it
18933 from the same initial seed value. A simple way to restart from the
18934 same seed is to type @kbd{s r RandSeed} to get the seed vector,
18935 @kbd{v u} to unpack it back into a number, then @kbd{s t RandSeed}
18936 to reseed the generator with that number.
18937
18938 Calc uses a ``shuffling'' method as described in algorithm 3.2.2B
18939 of Knuth. It fills a table with 13 random 10-bit numbers. Then,
18940 to generate a new random number, it uses the previous number to
18941 index into the table, picks the value it finds there as the new
18942 random number, then replaces that table entry with a new value
18943 obtained from a call to the base random number generator (either
18944 the additive congruential generator or the @code{random} function
18945 supplied by the system). If there are any flaws in the base
18946 generator, shuffling will tend to even them out. But if the system
18947 provides an excellent @code{random} function, shuffling will not
18948 damage its randomness.
18949
18950 To create a random integer of a certain number of digits, Calc
18951 builds the integer three decimal digits at a time. For each group
18952 of three digits, Calc calls its 10-bit shuffling random number generator
18953 (which returns a value from 0 to 1023); if the random value is 1000
18954 or more, Calc throws it out and tries again until it gets a suitable
18955 value.
18956
18957 To create a random floating-point number with precision @var{p}, Calc
18958 simply creates a random @var{p}-digit integer and multiplies by
18959 @texline @math{10^{-p}}.
18960 @infoline @expr{10^-p}.
18961 The resulting random numbers should be very clean, but note
18962 that relatively small numbers will have few significant random digits.
18963 In other words, with a precision of 12, you will occasionally get
18964 numbers on the order of
18965 @texline @math{10^{-9}}
18966 @infoline @expr{10^-9}
18967 or
18968 @texline @math{10^{-10}},
18969 @infoline @expr{10^-10},
18970 but those numbers will only have two or three random digits since they
18971 correspond to small integers times
18972 @texline @math{10^{-12}}.
18973 @infoline @expr{10^-12}.
18974
18975 To create a random integer in the interval @samp{[0 .. @var{m})}, Calc
18976 counts the digits in @var{m}, creates a random integer with three
18977 additional digits, then reduces modulo @var{m}. Unless @var{m} is a
18978 power of ten the resulting values will be very slightly biased toward
18979 the lower numbers, but this bias will be less than 0.1%. (For example,
18980 if @var{m} is 42, Calc will reduce a random integer less than 100000
18981 modulo 42 to get a result less than 42. It is easy to show that the
18982 numbers 40 and 41 will be only 2380/2381 as likely to result from this
18983 modulo operation as numbers 39 and below.) If @var{m} is a power of
18984 ten, however, the numbers should be completely unbiased.
18985
18986 The Gaussian random numbers generated by @samp{random(0.0)} use the
18987 ``polar'' method described in Knuth section 3.4.1C. This method
18988 generates a pair of Gaussian random numbers at a time, so only every
18989 other call to @samp{random(0.0)} will require significant calculations.
18990
18991 @node Combinatorial Functions, Probability Distribution Functions, Random Numbers, Scientific Functions
18992 @section Combinatorial Functions
18993
18994 @noindent
18995 Commands relating to combinatorics and number theory begin with the
18996 @kbd{k} key prefix.
18997
18998 @kindex k g
18999 @pindex calc-gcd
19000 @tindex gcd
19001 The @kbd{k g} (@code{calc-gcd}) [@code{gcd}] command computes the
19002 Greatest Common Divisor of two integers. It also accepts fractions;
19003 the GCD of two fractions is defined by taking the GCD of the
19004 numerators, and the LCM of the denominators. This definition is
19005 consistent with the idea that @samp{a / gcd(a,x)} should yield an
19006 integer for any @samp{a} and @samp{x}. For other types of arguments,
19007 the operation is left in symbolic form.
19008
19009 @kindex k l
19010 @pindex calc-lcm
19011 @tindex lcm
19012 The @kbd{k l} (@code{calc-lcm}) [@code{lcm}] command computes the
19013 Least Common Multiple of two integers or fractions. The product of
19014 the LCM and GCD of two numbers is equal to the product of the
19015 numbers.
19016
19017 @kindex k E
19018 @pindex calc-extended-gcd
19019 @tindex egcd
19020 The @kbd{k E} (@code{calc-extended-gcd}) [@code{egcd}] command computes
19021 the GCD of two integers @expr{x} and @expr{y} and returns a vector
19022 @expr{[g, a, b]} where
19023 @texline @math{g = \gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19024 @infoline @expr{g = gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19025
19026 @kindex !
19027 @pindex calc-factorial
19028 @tindex fact
19029 @ignore
19030 @mindex @null
19031 @end ignore
19032 @tindex !
19033 The @kbd{!} (@code{calc-factorial}) [@code{fact}] command computes the
19034 factorial of the number at the top of the stack. If the number is an
19035 integer, the result is an exact integer. If the number is an
19036 integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point approximation. If
19037 the number is a non-integral real number, the generalized factorial is used,
19038 as defined by the Euler Gamma function. Please note that computation of
19039 large factorials can be slow; using floating-point format will help
19040 since fewer digits must be maintained. The same is true of many of
19041 the commands in this section.
19042
19043 @kindex k d
19044 @pindex calc-double-factorial
19045 @tindex dfact
19046 @ignore
19047 @mindex @null
19048 @end ignore
19049 @tindex !!
19050 The @kbd{k d} (@code{calc-double-factorial}) [@code{dfact}] command
19051 computes the ``double factorial'' of an integer. For an even integer,
19052 this is the product of even integers from 2 to @expr{N}. For an odd
19053 integer, this is the product of odd integers from 3 to @expr{N}. If
19054 the argument is an integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point
19055 approximation. This function is undefined for negative even integers.
19056 The notation @expr{N!!} is also recognized for double factorials.
19057
19058 @kindex k c
19059 @pindex calc-choose
19060 @tindex choose
19061 The @kbd{k c} (@code{calc-choose}) [@code{choose}] command computes the
19062 binomial coefficient @expr{N}-choose-@expr{M}, where @expr{M} is the number
19063 on the top of the stack and @expr{N} is second-to-top. If both arguments
19064 are integers, the result is an exact integer. Otherwise, the result is a
19065 floating-point approximation. The binomial coefficient is defined for all
19066 real numbers by
19067 @texline @math{N! \over M! (N-M)!\,}.
19068 @infoline @expr{N! / M! (N-M)!}.
19069
19070 @kindex H k c
19071 @pindex calc-perm
19072 @tindex perm
19073 @ifinfo
19074 The @kbd{H k c} (@code{calc-perm}) [@code{perm}] command computes the
19075 number-of-permutations function @expr{N! / (N-M)!}.
19076 @end ifinfo
19077 @tex
19078 The \kbd{H k c} (\code{calc-perm}) [\code{perm}] command computes the
19079 number-of-perm\-utations function $N! \over (N-M)!\,$.
19080 @end tex
19081
19082 @kindex k b
19083 @kindex H k b
19084 @pindex calc-bernoulli-number
19085 @tindex bern
19086 The @kbd{k b} (@code{calc-bernoulli-number}) [@code{bern}] command
19087 computes a given Bernoulli number. The value at the top of the stack
19088 is a nonnegative integer @expr{n} that specifies which Bernoulli number
19089 is desired. The @kbd{H k b} command computes a Bernoulli polynomial,
19090 taking @expr{n} from the second-to-top position and @expr{x} from the
19091 top of the stack. If @expr{x} is a variable or formula the result is
19092 a polynomial in @expr{x}; if @expr{x} is a number the result is a number.
19093
19094 @kindex k e
19095 @kindex H k e
19096 @pindex calc-euler-number
19097 @tindex euler
19098 The @kbd{k e} (@code{calc-euler-number}) [@code{euler}] command similarly
19099 computes an Euler number, and @w{@kbd{H k e}} computes an Euler polynomial.
19100 Bernoulli and Euler numbers occur in the Taylor expansions of several
19101 functions.
19102
19103 @kindex k s
19104 @kindex H k s
19105 @pindex calc-stirling-number
19106 @tindex stir1
19107 @tindex stir2
19108 The @kbd{k s} (@code{calc-stirling-number}) [@code{stir1}] command
19109 computes a Stirling number of the first
19110 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brack m},
19111 @infoline kind,
19112 given two integers @expr{n} and @expr{m} on the stack. The @kbd{H k s}
19113 [@code{stir2}] command computes a Stirling number of the second
19114 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brace m}.
19115 @infoline kind.
19116 These are the number of @expr{m}-cycle permutations of @expr{n} objects,
19117 and the number of ways to partition @expr{n} objects into @expr{m}
19118 non-empty sets, respectively.
19119
19120 @kindex k p
19121 @pindex calc-prime-test
19122 @cindex Primes
19123 The @kbd{k p} (@code{calc-prime-test}) command checks if the integer on
19124 the top of the stack is prime. For integers less than eight million, the
19125 answer is always exact and reasonably fast. For larger integers, a
19126 probabilistic method is used (see Knuth vol. II, section 4.5.4, algorithm P).
19127 The number is first checked against small prime factors (up to 13). Then,
19128 any number of iterations of the algorithm are performed. Each step either
19129 discovers that the number is non-prime, or substantially increases the
19130 certainty that the number is prime. After a few steps, the chance that
19131 a number was mistakenly described as prime will be less than one percent.
19132 (Indeed, this is a worst-case estimate of the probability; in practice
19133 even a single iteration is quite reliable.) After the @kbd{k p} command,
19134 the number will be reported as definitely prime or non-prime if possible,
19135 or otherwise ``probably'' prime with a certain probability of error.
19136
19137 @ignore
19138 @starindex
19139 @end ignore
19140 @tindex prime
19141 The normal @kbd{k p} command performs one iteration of the primality
19142 test. Pressing @kbd{k p} repeatedly for the same integer will perform
19143 additional iterations. Also, @kbd{k p} with a numeric prefix performs
19144 the specified number of iterations. There is also an algebraic function
19145 @samp{prime(n)} or @samp{prime(n,iters)} which returns 1 if @expr{n}
19146 is (probably) prime and 0 if not.
19147
19148 @kindex k f
19149 @pindex calc-prime-factors
19150 @tindex prfac
19151 The @kbd{k f} (@code{calc-prime-factors}) [@code{prfac}] command
19152 attempts to decompose an integer into its prime factors. For numbers up
19153 to 25 million, the answer is exact although it may take some time. The
19154 result is a vector of the prime factors in increasing order. For larger
19155 inputs, prime factors above 5000 may not be found, in which case the
19156 last number in the vector will be an unfactored integer greater than 25
19157 million (with a warning message). For negative integers, the first
19158 element of the list will be @mathit{-1}. For inputs @mathit{-1}, @mathit{0}, and
19159 @mathit{1}, the result is a list of the same number.
19160
19161 @kindex k n
19162 @pindex calc-next-prime
19163 @ignore
19164 @mindex nextpr@idots
19165 @end ignore
19166 @tindex nextprime
19167 The @kbd{k n} (@code{calc-next-prime}) [@code{nextprime}] command finds
19168 the next prime above a given number. Essentially, it searches by calling
19169 @code{calc-prime-test} on successive integers until it finds one that
19170 passes the test. This is quite fast for integers less than eight million,
19171 but once the probabilistic test comes into play the search may be rather
19172 slow. Ordinarily this command stops for any prime that passes one iteration
19173 of the primality test. With a numeric prefix argument, a number must pass
19174 the specified number of iterations before the search stops. (This only
19175 matters when searching above eight million.) You can always use additional
19176 @kbd{k p} commands to increase your certainty that the number is indeed
19177 prime.
19178
19179 @kindex I k n
19180 @pindex calc-prev-prime
19181 @ignore
19182 @mindex prevpr@idots
19183 @end ignore
19184 @tindex prevprime
19185 The @kbd{I k n} (@code{calc-prev-prime}) [@code{prevprime}] command
19186 analogously finds the next prime less than a given number.
19187
19188 @kindex k t
19189 @pindex calc-totient
19190 @tindex totient
19191 The @kbd{k t} (@code{calc-totient}) [@code{totient}] command computes the
19192 Euler ``totient''
19193 @texline function@tie{}@math{\phi(n)},
19194 @infoline function,
19195 the number of integers less than @expr{n} which
19196 are relatively prime to @expr{n}.
19197
19198 @kindex k m
19199 @pindex calc-moebius
19200 @tindex moebius
19201 The @kbd{k m} (@code{calc-moebius}) [@code{moebius}] command computes the
19202 @texline M@"obius @math{\mu}
19203 @infoline Moebius ``mu''
19204 function. If the input number is a product of @expr{k}
19205 distinct factors, this is @expr{(-1)^k}. If the input number has any
19206 duplicate factors (i.e., can be divided by the same prime more than once),
19207 the result is zero.
19208
19209 @node Probability Distribution Functions, , Combinatorial Functions, Scientific Functions
19210 @section Probability Distribution Functions
19211
19212 @noindent
19213 The functions in this section compute various probability distributions.
19214 For continuous distributions, this is the integral of the probability
19215 density function from @expr{x} to infinity. (These are the ``upper
19216 tail'' distribution functions; there are also corresponding ``lower
19217 tail'' functions which integrate from minus infinity to @expr{x}.)
19218 For discrete distributions, the upper tail function gives the sum
19219 from @expr{x} to infinity; the lower tail function gives the sum
19220 from minus infinity up to, but not including,@w{ }@expr{x}.
19221
19222 To integrate from @expr{x} to @expr{y}, just use the distribution
19223 function twice and subtract. For example, the probability that a
19224 Gaussian random variable with mean 2 and standard deviation 1 will
19225 lie in the range from 2.5 to 2.8 is @samp{utpn(2.5,2,1) - utpn(2.8,2,1)}
19226 (``the probability that it is greater than 2.5, but not greater than 2.8''),
19227 or equivalently @samp{ltpn(2.8,2,1) - ltpn(2.5,2,1)}.
19228
19229 @kindex k B
19230 @kindex I k B
19231 @pindex calc-utpb
19232 @tindex utpb
19233 @tindex ltpb
19234 The @kbd{k B} (@code{calc-utpb}) [@code{utpb}] function uses the
19235 binomial distribution. Push the parameters @var{n}, @var{p}, and
19236 then @var{x} onto the stack; the result (@samp{utpb(x,n,p)}) is the
19237 probability that an event will occur @var{x} or more times out
19238 of @var{n} trials, if its probability of occurring in any given
19239 trial is @var{p}. The @kbd{I k B} [@code{ltpb}] function is
19240 the probability that the event will occur fewer than @var{x} times.
19241
19242 The other probability distribution functions similarly take the
19243 form @kbd{k @var{X}} (@code{calc-utp@var{x}}) [@code{utp@var{x}}]
19244 and @kbd{I k @var{X}} [@code{ltp@var{x}}], for various letters
19245 @var{x}. The arguments to the algebraic functions are the value of
19246 the random variable first, then whatever other parameters define the
19247 distribution. Note these are among the few Calc functions where the
19248 order of the arguments in algebraic form differs from the order of
19249 arguments as found on the stack. (The random variable comes last on
19250 the stack, so that you can type, e.g., @kbd{2 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 2.5
19251 k N M-@key{RET} @key{DEL} 2.8 k N -}, using @kbd{M-@key{RET} @key{DEL}} to
19252 recover the original arguments but substitute a new value for @expr{x}.)
19253
19254 @kindex k C
19255 @pindex calc-utpc
19256 @tindex utpc
19257 @ignore
19258 @mindex @idots
19259 @end ignore
19260 @kindex I k C
19261 @ignore
19262 @mindex @null
19263 @end ignore
19264 @tindex ltpc
19265 The @samp{utpc(x,v)} function uses the chi-square distribution with
19266 @texline @math{\nu}
19267 @infoline @expr{v}
19268 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a model is
19269 correct if its chi-square statistic is @expr{x}.
19270
19271 @kindex k F
19272 @pindex calc-utpf
19273 @tindex utpf
19274 @ignore
19275 @mindex @idots
19276 @end ignore
19277 @kindex I k F
19278 @ignore
19279 @mindex @null
19280 @end ignore
19281 @tindex ltpf
19282 The @samp{utpf(F,v1,v2)} function uses the F distribution, used in
19283 various statistical tests. The parameters
19284 @texline @math{\nu_1}
19285 @infoline @expr{v1}
19286 and
19287 @texline @math{\nu_2}
19288 @infoline @expr{v2}
19289 are the degrees of freedom in the numerator and denominator,
19290 respectively, used in computing the statistic @expr{F}.
19291
19292 @kindex k N
19293 @pindex calc-utpn
19294 @tindex utpn
19295 @ignore
19296 @mindex @idots
19297 @end ignore
19298 @kindex I k N
19299 @ignore
19300 @mindex @null
19301 @end ignore
19302 @tindex ltpn
19303 The @samp{utpn(x,m,s)} function uses a normal (Gaussian) distribution
19304 with mean @expr{m} and standard deviation
19305 @texline @math{\sigma}.
19306 @infoline @expr{s}.
19307 It is the probability that such a normal-distributed random variable
19308 would exceed @expr{x}.
19309
19310 @kindex k P
19311 @pindex calc-utpp
19312 @tindex utpp
19313 @ignore
19314 @mindex @idots
19315 @end ignore
19316 @kindex I k P
19317 @ignore
19318 @mindex @null
19319 @end ignore
19320 @tindex ltpp
19321 The @samp{utpp(n,x)} function uses a Poisson distribution with
19322 mean @expr{x}. It is the probability that @expr{n} or more such
19323 Poisson random events will occur.
19324
19325 @kindex k T
19326 @pindex calc-ltpt
19327 @tindex utpt
19328 @ignore
19329 @mindex @idots
19330 @end ignore
19331 @kindex I k T
19332 @ignore
19333 @mindex @null
19334 @end ignore
19335 @tindex ltpt
19336 The @samp{utpt(t,v)} function uses the Student's ``t'' distribution
19337 with
19338 @texline @math{\nu}
19339 @infoline @expr{v}
19340 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a
19341 t-distributed random variable will be greater than @expr{t}.
19342 (Note: This computes the distribution function
19343 @texline @math{A(t|\nu)}
19344 @infoline @expr{A(t|v)}
19345 where
19346 @texline @math{A(0|\nu) = 1}
19347 @infoline @expr{A(0|v) = 1}
19348 and
19349 @texline @math{A(\infty|\nu) \to 0}.
19350 @infoline @expr{A(inf|v) -> 0}.
19351 The @code{UTPT} operation on the HP-48 uses a different definition which
19352 returns half of Calc's value: @samp{UTPT(t,v) = .5*utpt(t,v)}.)
19353
19354 While Calc does not provide inverses of the probability distribution
19355 functions, the @kbd{a R} command can be used to solve for the inverse.
19356 Since the distribution functions are monotonic, @kbd{a R} is guaranteed
19357 to be able to find a solution given any initial guess.
19358 @xref{Numerical Solutions}.
19359
19360 @node Matrix Functions, Algebra, Scientific Functions, Top
19361 @chapter Vector/Matrix Functions
19362
19363 @noindent
19364 Many of the commands described here begin with the @kbd{v} prefix.
19365 (For convenience, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix is equivalent to @kbd{v}.)
19366 The commands usually apply to both plain vectors and matrices; some
19367 apply only to matrices or only to square matrices. If the argument
19368 has the wrong dimensions the operation is left in symbolic form.
19369
19370 Vectors are entered and displayed using @samp{[a,b,c]} notation.
19371 Matrices are vectors of which all elements are vectors of equal length.
19372 (Though none of the standard Calc commands use this concept, a
19373 three-dimensional matrix or rank-3 tensor could be defined as a
19374 vector of matrices, and so on.)
19375
19376 @menu
19377 * Packing and Unpacking::
19378 * Building Vectors::
19379 * Extracting Elements::
19380 * Manipulating Vectors::
19381 * Vector and Matrix Arithmetic::
19382 * Set Operations::
19383 * Statistical Operations::
19384 * Reducing and Mapping::
19385 * Vector and Matrix Formats::
19386 @end menu
19387
19388 @node Packing and Unpacking, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions, Matrix Functions
19389 @section Packing and Unpacking
19390
19391 @noindent
19392 Calc's ``pack'' and ``unpack'' commands collect stack entries to build
19393 composite objects such as vectors and complex numbers. They are
19394 described in this chapter because they are most often used to build
19395 vectors.
19396
19397 @kindex v p
19398 @pindex calc-pack
19399 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) [@code{pack}] command collects several
19400 elements from the stack into a matrix, complex number, HMS form, error
19401 form, etc. It uses a numeric prefix argument to specify the kind of
19402 object to be built; this argument is referred to as the ``packing mode.''
19403 If the packing mode is a nonnegative integer, a vector of that
19404 length is created. For example, @kbd{C-u 5 v p} will pop the top
19405 five stack elements and push back a single vector of those five
19406 elements. (@kbd{C-u 0 v p} simply creates an empty vector.)
19407
19408 The same effect can be had by pressing @kbd{[} to push an incomplete
19409 vector on the stack, using @key{TAB} (@code{calc-roll-down}) to sneak
19410 the incomplete object up past a certain number of elements, and
19411 then pressing @kbd{]} to complete the vector.
19412
19413 Negative packing modes create other kinds of composite objects:
19414
19415 @table @cite
19416 @item -1
19417 Two values are collected to build a complex number. For example,
19418 @kbd{5 @key{RET} 7 C-u -1 v p} creates the complex number
19419 @expr{(5, 7)}. The result is always a rectangular complex
19420 number. The two input values must both be real numbers,
19421 i.e., integers, fractions, or floats. If they are not, Calc
19422 will instead build a formula like @samp{a + (0, 1) b}. (The
19423 other packing modes also create a symbolic answer if the
19424 components are not suitable.)
19425
19426 @item -2
19427 Two values are collected to build a polar complex number.
19428 The first is the magnitude; the second is the phase expressed
19429 in either degrees or radians according to the current angular
19430 mode.
19431
19432 @item -3
19433 Three values are collected into an HMS form. The first
19434 two values (hours and minutes) must be integers or
19435 integer-valued floats. The third value may be any real
19436 number.
19437
19438 @item -4
19439 Two values are collected into an error form. The inputs
19440 may be real numbers or formulas.
19441
19442 @item -5
19443 Two values are collected into a modulo form. The inputs
19444 must be real numbers.
19445
19446 @item -6
19447 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b]}.
19448 The inputs may be real numbers, HMS or date forms, or formulas.
19449
19450 @item -7
19451 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b)}.
19452
19453 @item -8
19454 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b]}.
19455
19456 @item -9
19457 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b)}.
19458
19459 @item -10
19460 Two integer values are collected into a fraction.
19461
19462 @item -11
19463 Two values are collected into a floating-point number.
19464 The first is the mantissa; the second, which must be an
19465 integer, is the exponent. The result is the mantissa
19466 times ten to the power of the exponent.
19467
19468 @item -12
19469 This is treated the same as @mathit{-11} by the @kbd{v p} command.
19470 When unpacking, @mathit{-12} specifies that a floating-point mantissa
19471 is desired.
19472
19473 @item -13
19474 A real number is converted into a date form.
19475
19476 @item -14
19477 Three numbers (year, month, day) are packed into a pure date form.
19478
19479 @item -15
19480 Six numbers are packed into a date/time form.
19481 @end table
19482
19483 With any of the two-input negative packing modes, either or both
19484 of the inputs may be vectors. If both are vectors of the same
19485 length, the result is another vector made by packing corresponding
19486 elements of the input vectors. If one input is a vector and the
19487 other is a plain number, the number is packed along with each vector
19488 element to produce a new vector. For example, @kbd{C-u -4 v p}
19489 could be used to convert a vector of numbers and a vector of errors
19490 into a single vector of error forms; @kbd{C-u -5 v p} could convert
19491 a vector of numbers and a single number @var{M} into a vector of
19492 numbers modulo @var{M}.
19493
19494 If you don't give a prefix argument to @kbd{v p}, it takes
19495 the packing mode from the top of the stack. The elements to
19496 be packed then begin at stack level 2. Thus
19497 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 4 n v p} is another way to
19498 enter the error form @samp{1 +/- 2}.
19499
19500 If the packing mode taken from the stack is a vector, the result is a
19501 matrix with the dimensions specified by the elements of the vector,
19502 which must each be integers. For example, if the packing mode is
19503 @samp{[2, 3]}, then six numbers will be taken from the stack and
19504 returned in the form @samp{[@w{[a, b, c]}, [d, e, f]]}.
19505
19506 If any elements of the vector are negative, other kinds of
19507 packing are done at that level as described above. For
19508 example, @samp{[2, 3, -4]} takes 12 objects and creates a
19509 @texline @math{2\times3}
19510 @infoline 2x3
19511 matrix of error forms: @samp{[[a +/- b, c +/- d ... ]]}.
19512 Also, @samp{[-4, -10]} will convert four integers into an
19513 error form consisting of two fractions: @samp{a:b +/- c:d}.
19514
19515 @ignore
19516 @starindex
19517 @end ignore
19518 @tindex pack
19519 There is an equivalent algebraic function,
19520 @samp{pack(@var{mode}, @var{items})} where @var{mode} is a
19521 packing mode (an integer or a vector of integers) and @var{items}
19522 is a vector of objects to be packed (re-packed, really) according
19523 to that mode. For example, @samp{pack([3, -4], [a,b,c,d,e,f])}
19524 yields @samp{[a +/- b, @w{c +/- d}, e +/- f]}. The function is
19525 left in symbolic form if the packing mode is illegal, or if the
19526 number of data items does not match the number of items required
19527 by the mode.
19528
19529 @kindex v u
19530 @pindex calc-unpack
19531 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the vector, complex
19532 number, HMS form, or other composite object on the top of the stack and
19533 ``unpacks'' it, pushing each of its elements onto the stack as separate
19534 objects. Thus, it is the ``inverse'' of @kbd{v p}. If the value
19535 at the top of the stack is a formula, @kbd{v u} unpacks it by pushing
19536 each of the arguments of the top-level operator onto the stack.
19537
19538 You can optionally give a numeric prefix argument to @kbd{v u}
19539 to specify an explicit (un)packing mode. If the packing mode is
19540 negative and the input is actually a vector or matrix, the result
19541 will be two or more similar vectors or matrices of the elements.
19542 For example, given the vector @samp{[@w{a +/- b}, c^2, d +/- 7]},
19543 the result of @kbd{C-u -4 v u} will be the two vectors
19544 @samp{[a, c^2, d]} and @w{@samp{[b, 0, 7]}}.
19545
19546 Note that the prefix argument can have an effect even when the input is
19547 not a vector. For example, if the input is the number @mathit{-5}, then
19548 @kbd{c-u -1 v u} yields @mathit{-5} and 0 (the components of @mathit{-5}
19549 when viewed as a rectangular complex number); @kbd{C-u -2 v u} yields 5
19550 and 180 (assuming Degrees mode); and @kbd{C-u -10 v u} yields @mathit{-5}
19551 and 1 (the numerator and denominator of @mathit{-5}, viewed as a rational
19552 number). Plain @kbd{v u} with this input would complain that the input
19553 is not a composite object.
19554
19555 Unpacking mode @mathit{-11} converts a float into an integer mantissa and
19556 an integer exponent, where the mantissa is not divisible by 10
19557 (except that 0.0 is represented by a mantissa and exponent of 0).
19558 Unpacking mode @mathit{-12} converts a float into a floating-point mantissa
19559 and integer exponent, where the mantissa (for non-zero numbers)
19560 is guaranteed to lie in the range [1 .. 10). In both cases,
19561 the mantissa is shifted left or right (and the exponent adjusted
19562 to compensate) in order to satisfy these constraints.
19563
19564 Positive unpacking modes are treated differently than for @kbd{v p}.
19565 A mode of 1 is much like plain @kbd{v u} with no prefix argument,
19566 except that in addition to the components of the input object,
19567 a suitable packing mode to re-pack the object is also pushed.
19568 Thus, @kbd{C-u 1 v u} followed by @kbd{v p} will re-build the
19569 original object.
19570
19571 A mode of 2 unpacks two levels of the object; the resulting
19572 re-packing mode will be a vector of length 2. This might be used
19573 to unpack a matrix, say, or a vector of error forms. Higher
19574 unpacking modes unpack the input even more deeply.
19575
19576 @ignore
19577 @starindex
19578 @end ignore
19579 @tindex unpack
19580 There are two algebraic functions analogous to @kbd{v u}.
19581 The @samp{unpack(@var{mode}, @var{item})} function unpacks the
19582 @var{item} using the given @var{mode}, returning the result as
19583 a vector of components. Here the @var{mode} must be an
19584 integer, not a vector. For example, @samp{unpack(-4, a +/- b)}
19585 returns @samp{[a, b]}, as does @samp{unpack(1, a +/- b)}.
19586
19587 @ignore
19588 @starindex
19589 @end ignore
19590 @tindex unpackt
19591 The @code{unpackt} function is like @code{unpack} but instead
19592 of returning a simple vector of items, it returns a vector of
19593 two things: The mode, and the vector of items. For example,
19594 @samp{unpackt(1, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[-4, [2:3, 1:4]]},
19595 and @samp{unpackt(2, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[[-4, -10], [2, 3, 1, 4]]}.
19596 The identity for re-building the original object is
19597 @samp{apply(pack, unpackt(@var{n}, @var{x})) = @var{x}}. (The
19598 @code{apply} function builds a function call given the function
19599 name and a vector of arguments.)
19600
19601 @cindex Numerator of a fraction, extracting
19602 Subscript notation is a useful way to extract a particular part
19603 of an object. For example, to get the numerator of a rational
19604 number, you can use @samp{unpack(-10, @var{x})_1}.
19605
19606 @node Building Vectors, Extracting Elements, Packing and Unpacking, Matrix Functions
19607 @section Building Vectors
19608
19609 @noindent
19610 Vectors and matrices can be added,
19611 subtracted, multiplied, and divided; @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}.
19612
19613 @kindex |
19614 @pindex calc-concat
19615 @ignore
19616 @mindex @null
19617 @end ignore
19618 @tindex |
19619 The @kbd{|} (@code{calc-concat}) command ``concatenates'' two vectors
19620 into one. For example, after @kbd{@w{[ 1 , 2 ]} [ 3 , 4 ] |}, the stack
19621 will contain the single vector @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]}. If the arguments
19622 are matrices, the rows of the first matrix are concatenated with the
19623 rows of the second. (In other words, two matrices are just two vectors
19624 of row-vectors as far as @kbd{|} is concerned.)
19625
19626 If either argument to @kbd{|} is a scalar (a non-vector), it is treated
19627 like a one-element vector for purposes of concatenation: @kbd{1 [ 2 , 3 ] |}
19628 produces the vector @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Likewise, if one argument is a
19629 matrix and the other is a plain vector, the vector is treated as a
19630 one-row matrix.
19631
19632 @kindex H |
19633 @tindex append
19634 The @kbd{H |} (@code{calc-append}) [@code{append}] command concatenates
19635 two vectors without any special cases. Both inputs must be vectors.
19636 Whether or not they are matrices is not taken into account. If either
19637 argument is a scalar, the @code{append} function is left in symbolic form.
19638 See also @code{cons} and @code{rcons} below.
19639
19640 @kindex I |
19641 @kindex H I |
19642 The @kbd{I |} and @kbd{H I |} commands are similar, but they use their
19643 two stack arguments in the opposite order. Thus @kbd{I |} is equivalent
19644 to @kbd{@key{TAB} |}, but possibly more convenient and also a bit faster.
19645
19646 @kindex v d
19647 @pindex calc-diag
19648 @tindex diag
19649 The @kbd{v d} (@code{calc-diag}) [@code{diag}] function builds a diagonal
19650 square matrix. The optional numeric prefix gives the number of rows
19651 and columns in the matrix. If the value at the top of the stack is a
19652 vector, the elements of the vector are used as the diagonal elements; the
19653 prefix, if specified, must match the size of the vector. If the value on
19654 the stack is a scalar, it is used for each element on the diagonal, and
19655 the prefix argument is required.
19656
19657 To build a constant square matrix, e.g., a
19658 @texline @math{3\times3}
19659 @infoline 3x3
19660 matrix filled with ones, use @kbd{0 M-3 v d 1 +}, i.e., build a zero
19661 matrix first and then add a constant value to that matrix. (Another
19662 alternative would be to use @kbd{v b} and @kbd{v a}; see below.)
19663
19664 @kindex v i
19665 @pindex calc-ident
19666 @tindex idn
19667 The @kbd{v i} (@code{calc-ident}) [@code{idn}] function builds an identity
19668 matrix of the specified size. It is a convenient form of @kbd{v d}
19669 where the diagonal element is always one. If no prefix argument is given,
19670 this command prompts for one.
19671
19672 In algebraic notation, @samp{idn(a,n)} acts much like @samp{diag(a,n)},
19673 except that @expr{a} is required to be a scalar (non-vector) quantity.
19674 If @expr{n} is omitted, @samp{idn(a)} represents @expr{a} times an
19675 identity matrix of unknown size. Calc can operate algebraically on
19676 such generic identity matrices, and if one is combined with a matrix
19677 whose size is known, it is converted automatically to an identity
19678 matrix of a suitable matching size. The @kbd{v i} command with an
19679 argument of zero creates a generic identity matrix, @samp{idn(1)}.
19680 Note that in dimensioned Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), generic
19681 identity matrices are immediately expanded to the current default
19682 dimensions.
19683
19684 @kindex v x
19685 @pindex calc-index
19686 @tindex index
19687 The @kbd{v x} (@code{calc-index}) [@code{index}] function builds a vector
19688 of consecutive integers from 1 to @var{n}, where @var{n} is the numeric
19689 prefix argument. If you do not provide a prefix argument, you will be
19690 prompted to enter a suitable number. If @var{n} is negative, the result
19691 is a vector of negative integers from @var{n} to @mathit{-1}.
19692
19693 With a prefix argument of just @kbd{C-u}, the @kbd{v x} command takes
19694 three values from the stack: @var{n}, @var{start}, and @var{incr} (with
19695 @var{incr} at top-of-stack). Counting starts at @var{start} and increases
19696 by @var{incr} for successive vector elements. If @var{start} or @var{n}
19697 is in floating-point format, the resulting vector elements will also be
19698 floats. Note that @var{start} and @var{incr} may in fact be any kind
19699 of numbers or formulas.
19700
19701 When @var{start} and @var{incr} are specified, a negative @var{n} has a
19702 different interpretation: It causes a geometric instead of arithmetic
19703 sequence to be generated. For example, @samp{index(-3, a, b)} produces
19704 @samp{[a, a b, a b^2]}. If you omit @var{incr} in the algebraic form,
19705 @samp{index(@var{n}, @var{start})}, the default value for @var{incr}
19706 is one for positive @var{n} or two for negative @var{n}.
19707
19708 @kindex v b
19709 @pindex calc-build-vector
19710 @tindex cvec
19711 The @kbd{v b} (@code{calc-build-vector}) [@code{cvec}] function builds a
19712 vector of @var{n} copies of the value on the top of the stack, where @var{n}
19713 is the numeric prefix argument. In algebraic formulas, @samp{cvec(x,n,m)}
19714 can also be used to build an @var{n}-by-@var{m} matrix of copies of @var{x}.
19715 (Interactively, just use @kbd{v b} twice: once to build a row, then again
19716 to build a matrix of copies of that row.)
19717
19718 @kindex v h
19719 @kindex I v h
19720 @pindex calc-head
19721 @pindex calc-tail
19722 @tindex head
19723 @tindex tail
19724 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) [@code{head}] function returns the first
19725 element of a vector. The @kbd{I v h} (@code{calc-tail}) [@code{tail}]
19726 function returns the vector with its first element removed. In both
19727 cases, the argument must be a non-empty vector.
19728
19729 @kindex v k
19730 @pindex calc-cons
19731 @tindex cons
19732 The @kbd{v k} (@code{calc-cons}) [@code{cons}] function takes a value @var{h}
19733 and a vector @var{t} from the stack, and produces the vector whose head is
19734 @var{h} and whose tail is @var{t}. This is similar to @kbd{|}, except
19735 if @var{h} is itself a vector, @kbd{|} will concatenate the two vectors
19736 whereas @code{cons} will insert @var{h} at the front of the vector @var{t}.
19737
19738 @kindex H v h
19739 @tindex rhead
19740 @ignore
19741 @mindex @idots
19742 @end ignore
19743 @kindex H I v h
19744 @ignore
19745 @mindex @null
19746 @end ignore
19747 @kindex H v k
19748 @ignore
19749 @mindex @null
19750 @end ignore
19751 @tindex rtail
19752 @ignore
19753 @mindex @null
19754 @end ignore
19755 @tindex rcons
19756 Each of these three functions also accepts the Hyperbolic flag [@code{rhead},
19757 @code{rtail}, @code{rcons}] in which case @var{t} instead represents
19758 the @emph{last} single element of the vector, with @var{h}
19759 representing the remainder of the vector. Thus the vector
19760 @samp{[a, b, c, d] = cons(a, [b, c, d]) = rcons([a, b, c], d)}.
19761 Also, @samp{head([a, b, c, d]) = a}, @samp{tail([a, b, c, d]) = [b, c, d]},
19762 @samp{rhead([a, b, c, d]) = [a, b, c]}, and @samp{rtail([a, b, c, d]) = d}.
19763
19764 @node Extracting Elements, Manipulating Vectors, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions
19765 @section Extracting Vector Elements
19766
19767 @noindent
19768 @kindex v r
19769 @pindex calc-mrow
19770 @tindex mrow
19771 The @kbd{v r} (@code{calc-mrow}) [@code{mrow}] command extracts one row of
19772 the matrix on the top of the stack, or one element of the plain vector on
19773 the top of the stack. The row or element is specified by the numeric
19774 prefix argument; the default is to prompt for the row or element number.
19775 The matrix or vector is replaced by the specified row or element in the
19776 form of a vector or scalar, respectively.
19777
19778 @cindex Permutations, applying
19779 With a prefix argument of @kbd{C-u} only, @kbd{v r} takes the index of
19780 the element or row from the top of the stack, and the vector or matrix
19781 from the second-to-top position. If the index is itself a vector of
19782 integers, the result is a vector of the corresponding elements of the
19783 input vector, or a matrix of the corresponding rows of the input matrix.
19784 This command can be used to obtain any permutation of a vector.
19785
19786 With @kbd{C-u}, if the index is an interval form with integer components,
19787 it is interpreted as a range of indices and the corresponding subvector or
19788 submatrix is returned.
19789
19790 @cindex Subscript notation
19791 @kindex a _
19792 @pindex calc-subscript
19793 @tindex subscr
19794 @tindex _
19795 Subscript notation in algebraic formulas (@samp{a_b}) stands for the
19796 Calc function @code{subscr}, which is synonymous with @code{mrow}.
19797 Thus, @samp{[x, y, z]_k} produces @expr{x}, @expr{y}, or @expr{z} if
19798 @expr{k} is one, two, or three, respectively. A double subscript
19799 (@samp{M_i_j}, equivalent to @samp{subscr(subscr(M, i), j)}) will
19800 access the element at row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of a matrix.
19801 The @kbd{a _} (@code{calc-subscript}) command creates a subscript
19802 formula @samp{a_b} out of two stack entries. (It is on the @kbd{a}
19803 ``algebra'' prefix because subscripted variables are often used
19804 purely as an algebraic notation.)
19805
19806 @tindex mrrow
19807 Given a negative prefix argument, @kbd{v r} instead deletes one row or
19808 element from the matrix or vector on the top of the stack. Thus
19809 @kbd{C-u 2 v r} replaces a matrix with its second row, but @kbd{C-u -2 v r}
19810 replaces the matrix with the same matrix with its second row removed.
19811 In algebraic form this function is called @code{mrrow}.
19812
19813 @tindex getdiag
19814 Given a prefix argument of zero, @kbd{v r} extracts the diagonal elements
19815 of a square matrix in the form of a vector. In algebraic form this
19816 function is called @code{getdiag}.
19817
19818 @kindex v c
19819 @pindex calc-mcol
19820 @tindex mcol
19821 @tindex mrcol
19822 The @kbd{v c} (@code{calc-mcol}) [@code{mcol} or @code{mrcol}] command is
19823 the analogous operation on columns of a matrix. Given a plain vector
19824 it extracts (or removes) one element, just like @kbd{v r}. If the
19825 index in @kbd{C-u v c} is an interval or vector and the argument is a
19826 matrix, the result is a submatrix with only the specified columns
19827 retained (and possibly permuted in the case of a vector index).
19828
19829 To extract a matrix element at a given row and column, use @kbd{v r} to
19830 extract the row as a vector, then @kbd{v c} to extract the column element
19831 from that vector. In algebraic formulas, it is often more convenient to
19832 use subscript notation: @samp{m_i_j} gives row @expr{i}, column @expr{j}
19833 of matrix @expr{m}.
19834
19835 @kindex v s
19836 @pindex calc-subvector
19837 @tindex subvec
19838 The @kbd{v s} (@code{calc-subvector}) [@code{subvec}] command extracts
19839 a subvector of a vector. The arguments are the vector, the starting
19840 index, and the ending index, with the ending index in the top-of-stack
19841 position. The starting index indicates the first element of the vector
19842 to take. The ending index indicates the first element @emph{past} the
19843 range to be taken. Thus, @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)} produces
19844 the subvector @samp{[b, c]}. You could get the same result using
19845 @samp{mrow([a, b, c, d, e], @w{[2 .. 4)})}.
19846
19847 If either the start or the end index is zero or negative, it is
19848 interpreted as relative to the end of the vector. Thus
19849 @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, -2)} also produces @samp{[b, c]}. In
19850 the algebraic form, the end index can be omitted in which case it
19851 is taken as zero, i.e., elements from the starting element to the
19852 end of the vector are used. The infinity symbol, @code{inf}, also
19853 has this effect when used as the ending index.
19854
19855 @kindex I v s
19856 @tindex rsubvec
19857 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I v s} [@code{rsubvec}] removes a subvector
19858 from a vector. The arguments are interpreted the same as for the
19859 normal @kbd{v s} command. Thus, @samp{rsubvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)}
19860 produces @samp{[a, d, e]}. It is always true that @code{subvec} and
19861 @code{rsubvec} return complementary parts of the input vector.
19862
19863 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for an alternative way to operate on
19864 vectors one element at a time.
19865
19866 @node Manipulating Vectors, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Extracting Elements, Matrix Functions
19867 @section Manipulating Vectors
19868
19869 @noindent
19870 @kindex v l
19871 @pindex calc-vlength
19872 @tindex vlen
19873 The @kbd{v l} (@code{calc-vlength}) [@code{vlen}] command computes the
19874 length of a vector. The length of a non-vector is considered to be zero.
19875 Note that matrices are just vectors of vectors for the purposes of this
19876 command.
19877
19878 @kindex H v l
19879 @tindex mdims
19880 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v l} [@code{mdims}] computes a vector
19881 of the dimensions of a vector, matrix, or higher-order object. For
19882 example, @samp{mdims([[a,b,c],[d,e,f]])} returns @samp{[2, 3]} since
19883 its argument is a
19884 @texline @math{2\times3}
19885 @infoline 2x3
19886 matrix.
19887
19888 @kindex v f
19889 @pindex calc-vector-find
19890 @tindex find
19891 The @kbd{v f} (@code{calc-vector-find}) [@code{find}] command searches
19892 along a vector for the first element equal to a given target. The target
19893 is on the top of the stack; the vector is in the second-to-top position.
19894 If a match is found, the result is the index of the matching element.
19895 Otherwise, the result is zero. The numeric prefix argument, if given,
19896 allows you to select any starting index for the search.
19897
19898 @kindex v a
19899 @pindex calc-arrange-vector
19900 @tindex arrange
19901 @cindex Arranging a matrix
19902 @cindex Reshaping a matrix
19903 @cindex Flattening a matrix
19904 The @kbd{v a} (@code{calc-arrange-vector}) [@code{arrange}] command
19905 rearranges a vector to have a certain number of columns and rows. The
19906 numeric prefix argument specifies the number of columns; if you do not
19907 provide an argument, you will be prompted for the number of columns.
19908 The vector or matrix on the top of the stack is @dfn{flattened} into a
19909 plain vector. If the number of columns is nonzero, this vector is
19910 then formed into a matrix by taking successive groups of @var{n} elements.
19911 If the number of columns does not evenly divide the number of elements
19912 in the vector, the last row will be short and the result will not be
19913 suitable for use as a matrix. For example, with the matrix
19914 @samp{[[1, 2], @w{[3, 4]}]} on the stack, @kbd{v a 4} produces
19915 @samp{[[1, 2, 3, 4]]} (a
19916 @texline @math{1\times4}
19917 @infoline 1x4
19918 matrix), @kbd{v a 1} produces @samp{[[1], [2], [3], [4]]} (a
19919 @texline @math{4\times1}
19920 @infoline 4x1
19921 matrix), @kbd{v a 2} produces @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4]]} (the original
19922 @texline @math{2\times2}
19923 @infoline 2x2
19924 matrix), @w{@kbd{v a 3}} produces @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4]]} (not a
19925 matrix), and @kbd{v a 0} produces the flattened list
19926 @samp{[1, 2, @w{3, 4}]}.
19927
19928 @cindex Sorting data
19929 @kindex V S
19930 @kindex I V S
19931 @pindex calc-sort
19932 @tindex sort
19933 @tindex rsort
19934 The @kbd{V S} (@code{calc-sort}) [@code{sort}] command sorts the elements of
19935 a vector into increasing order. Real numbers, real infinities, and
19936 constant interval forms come first in this ordering; next come other
19937 kinds of numbers, then variables (in alphabetical order), then finally
19938 come formulas and other kinds of objects; these are sorted according
19939 to a kind of lexicographic ordering with the useful property that
19940 one vector is less or greater than another if the first corresponding
19941 unequal elements are less or greater, respectively. Since quoted strings
19942 are stored by Calc internally as vectors of ASCII character codes
19943 (@pxref{Strings}), this means vectors of strings are also sorted into
19944 alphabetical order by this command.
19945
19946 The @kbd{I V S} [@code{rsort}] command sorts a vector into decreasing order.
19947
19948 @cindex Permutation, inverse of
19949 @cindex Inverse of permutation
19950 @cindex Index tables
19951 @cindex Rank tables
19952 @kindex V G
19953 @kindex I V G
19954 @pindex calc-grade
19955 @tindex grade
19956 @tindex rgrade
19957 The @kbd{V G} (@code{calc-grade}) [@code{grade}, @code{rgrade}] command
19958 produces an index table or permutation vector which, if applied to the
19959 input vector (as the index of @kbd{C-u v r}, say), would sort the vector.
19960 A permutation vector is just a vector of integers from 1 to @var{n}, where
19961 each integer occurs exactly once. One application of this is to sort a
19962 matrix of data rows using one column as the sort key; extract that column,
19963 grade it with @kbd{V G}, then use the result to reorder the original matrix
19964 with @kbd{C-u v r}. Another interesting property of the @code{V G} command
19965 is that, if the input is itself a permutation vector, the result will
19966 be the inverse of the permutation. The inverse of an index table is
19967 a rank table, whose @var{k}th element says where the @var{k}th original
19968 vector element will rest when the vector is sorted. To get a rank
19969 table, just use @kbd{V G V G}.
19970
19971 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I V G} produces an index table that would
19972 sort the input into decreasing order. Note that @kbd{V S} and @kbd{V G}
19973 use a ``stable'' sorting algorithm, i.e., any two elements which are equal
19974 will not be moved out of their original order. Generally there is no way
19975 to tell with @kbd{V S}, since two elements which are equal look the same,
19976 but with @kbd{V G} this can be an important issue. In the matrix-of-rows
19977 example, suppose you have names and telephone numbers as two columns and
19978 you wish to sort by phone number primarily, and by name when the numbers
19979 are equal. You can sort the data matrix by names first, and then again
19980 by phone numbers. Because the sort is stable, any two rows with equal
19981 phone numbers will remain sorted by name even after the second sort.
19982
19983 @cindex Histograms
19984 @kindex V H
19985 @pindex calc-histogram
19986 @ignore
19987 @mindex histo@idots
19988 @end ignore
19989 @tindex histogram
19990 The @kbd{V H} (@code{calc-histogram}) [@code{histogram}] command builds a
19991 histogram of a vector of numbers. Vector elements are assumed to be
19992 integers or real numbers in the range [0..@var{n}) for some ``number of
19993 bins'' @var{n}, which is the numeric prefix argument given to the
19994 command. The result is a vector of @var{n} counts of how many times
19995 each value appeared in the original vector. Non-integers in the input
19996 are rounded down to integers. Any vector elements outside the specified
19997 range are ignored. (You can tell if elements have been ignored by noting
19998 that the counts in the result vector don't add up to the length of the
19999 input vector.)
20000
20001 @kindex H V H
20002 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H V H} pulls two vectors from the stack.
20003 The second-to-top vector is the list of numbers as before. The top
20004 vector is an equal-sized list of ``weights'' to attach to the elements
20005 of the data vector. For example, if the first data element is 4.2 and
20006 the first weight is 10, then 10 will be added to bin 4 of the result
20007 vector. Without the hyperbolic flag, every element has a weight of one.
20008
20009 @kindex v t
20010 @pindex calc-transpose
20011 @tindex trn
20012 The @kbd{v t} (@code{calc-transpose}) [@code{trn}] command computes
20013 the transpose of the matrix at the top of the stack. If the argument
20014 is a plain vector, it is treated as a row vector and transposed into
20015 a one-column matrix.
20016
20017 @kindex v v
20018 @pindex calc-reverse-vector
20019 @tindex rev
20020 The @kbd{v v} (@code{calc-reverse-vector}) [@code{vec}] command reverses
20021 a vector end-for-end. Given a matrix, it reverses the order of the rows.
20022 (To reverse the columns instead, just use @kbd{v t v v v t}. The same
20023 principle can be used to apply other vector commands to the columns of
20024 a matrix.)
20025
20026 @kindex v m
20027 @pindex calc-mask-vector
20028 @tindex vmask
20029 The @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector}) [@code{vmask}] command uses
20030 one vector as a mask to extract elements of another vector. The mask
20031 is in the second-to-top position; the target vector is on the top of
20032 the stack. These vectors must have the same length. The result is
20033 the same as the target vector, but with all elements which correspond
20034 to zeros in the mask vector deleted. Thus, for example,
20035 @samp{vmask([1, 0, 1, 0, 1], [a, b, c, d, e])} produces @samp{[a, c, e]}.
20036 @xref{Logical Operations}.
20037
20038 @kindex v e
20039 @pindex calc-expand-vector
20040 @tindex vexp
20041 The @kbd{v e} (@code{calc-expand-vector}) [@code{vexp}] command
20042 expands a vector according to another mask vector. The result is a
20043 vector the same length as the mask, but with nonzero elements replaced
20044 by successive elements from the target vector. The length of the target
20045 vector is normally the number of nonzero elements in the mask. If the
20046 target vector is longer, its last few elements are lost. If the target
20047 vector is shorter, the last few nonzero mask elements are left
20048 unreplaced in the result. Thus @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b])}
20049 produces @samp{[a, 0, b, 0, 7]}.
20050
20051 @kindex H v e
20052 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v e} takes a filler value from the
20053 top of the stack; the mask and target vectors come from the third and
20054 second elements of the stack. This filler is used where the mask is
20055 zero: @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b], z)} produces
20056 @samp{[a, z, c, z, 7]}. If the filler value is itself a vector,
20057 then successive values are taken from it, so that the effect is to
20058 interleave two vectors according to the mask:
20059 @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 7, 0, 0], [a, b], [x, y])} produces
20060 @samp{[a, x, b, 7, y, 0]}.
20061
20062 Another variation on the masking idea is to combine @samp{[a, b, c, d, e]}
20063 with the mask @samp{[1, 0, 1, 0, 1]} to produce @samp{[a, 0, c, 0, e]}.
20064 You can accomplish this with @kbd{V M a &}, mapping the logical ``and''
20065 operation across the two vectors. @xref{Logical Operations}. Note that
20066 the @code{? :} operation also discussed there allows other types of
20067 masking using vectors.
20068
20069 @node Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Set Operations, Manipulating Vectors, Matrix Functions
20070 @section Vector and Matrix Arithmetic
20071
20072 @noindent
20073 Basic arithmetic operations like addition and multiplication are defined
20074 for vectors and matrices as well as for numbers. Division of matrices, in
20075 the sense of multiplying by the inverse, is supported. (Division by a
20076 matrix actually uses LU-decomposition for greater accuracy and speed.)
20077 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
20078
20079 The following functions are applied element-wise if their arguments are
20080 vectors or matrices: @code{change-sign}, @code{conj}, @code{arg},
20081 @code{re}, @code{im}, @code{polar}, @code{rect}, @code{clean},
20082 @code{float}, @code{frac}. @xref{Function Index}.
20083
20084 @kindex V J
20085 @pindex calc-conj-transpose
20086 @tindex ctrn
20087 The @kbd{V J} (@code{calc-conj-transpose}) [@code{ctrn}] command computes
20088 the conjugate transpose of its argument, i.e., @samp{conj(trn(x))}.
20089
20090 @ignore
20091 @mindex A
20092 @end ignore
20093 @kindex A (vectors)
20094 @pindex calc-abs (vectors)
20095 @ignore
20096 @mindex abs
20097 @end ignore
20098 @tindex abs (vectors)
20099 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the
20100 Frobenius norm of a vector or matrix argument. This is the square
20101 root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
20102 elements of the vector or matrix. If the vector is interpreted as
20103 a point in two- or three-dimensional space, this is the distance
20104 from that point to the origin.
20105
20106 @kindex v n
20107 @pindex calc-rnorm
20108 @tindex rnorm
20109 The @kbd{v n} (@code{calc-rnorm}) [@code{rnorm}] command computes
20110 the row norm, or infinity-norm, of a vector or matrix. For a plain
20111 vector, this is the maximum of the absolute values of the elements.
20112 For a matrix, this is the maximum of the row-absolute-value-sums,
20113 i.e., of the sums of the absolute values of the elements along the
20114 various rows.
20115
20116 @kindex V N
20117 @pindex calc-cnorm
20118 @tindex cnorm
20119 The @kbd{V N} (@code{calc-cnorm}) [@code{cnorm}] command computes
20120 the column norm, or one-norm, of a vector or matrix. For a plain
20121 vector, this is the sum of the absolute values of the elements.
20122 For a matrix, this is the maximum of the column-absolute-value-sums.
20123 General @expr{k}-norms for @expr{k} other than one or infinity are
20124 not provided.
20125
20126 @kindex V C
20127 @pindex calc-cross
20128 @tindex cross
20129 The @kbd{V C} (@code{calc-cross}) [@code{cross}] command computes the
20130 right-handed cross product of two vectors, each of which must have
20131 exactly three elements.
20132
20133 @ignore
20134 @mindex &
20135 @end ignore
20136 @kindex & (matrices)
20137 @pindex calc-inv (matrices)
20138 @ignore
20139 @mindex inv
20140 @end ignore
20141 @tindex inv (matrices)
20142 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
20143 inverse of a square matrix. If the matrix is singular, the inverse
20144 operation is left in symbolic form. Matrix inverses are recorded so
20145 that once an inverse (or determinant) of a particular matrix has been
20146 computed, the inverse and determinant of the matrix can be recomputed
20147 quickly in the future.
20148
20149 If the argument to @kbd{&} is a plain number @expr{x}, this
20150 command simply computes @expr{1/x}. This is okay, because the
20151 @samp{/} operator also does a matrix inversion when dividing one
20152 by a matrix.
20153
20154 @kindex V D
20155 @pindex calc-mdet
20156 @tindex det
20157 The @kbd{V D} (@code{calc-mdet}) [@code{det}] command computes the
20158 determinant of a square matrix.
20159
20160 @kindex V L
20161 @pindex calc-mlud
20162 @tindex lud
20163 The @kbd{V L} (@code{calc-mlud}) [@code{lud}] command computes the
20164 LU decomposition of a matrix. The result is a list of three matrices
20165 which, when multiplied together left-to-right, form the original matrix.
20166 The first is a permutation matrix that arises from pivoting in the
20167 algorithm, the second is lower-triangular with ones on the diagonal,
20168 and the third is upper-triangular.
20169
20170 @kindex V T
20171 @pindex calc-mtrace
20172 @tindex tr
20173 The @kbd{V T} (@code{calc-mtrace}) [@code{tr}] command computes the
20174 trace of a square matrix. This is defined as the sum of the diagonal
20175 elements of the matrix.
20176
20177 @node Set Operations, Statistical Operations, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Matrix Functions
20178 @section Set Operations using Vectors
20179
20180 @noindent
20181 @cindex Sets, as vectors
20182 Calc includes several commands which interpret vectors as @dfn{sets} of
20183 objects. A set is a collection of objects; any given object can appear
20184 only once in the set. Calc stores sets as vectors of objects in
20185 sorted order. Objects in a Calc set can be any of the usual things,
20186 such as numbers, variables, or formulas. Two set elements are considered
20187 equal if they are identical, except that numerically equal numbers like
20188 the integer 4 and the float 4.0 are considered equal even though they
20189 are not ``identical.'' Variables are treated like plain symbols without
20190 attached values by the set operations; subtracting the set @samp{[b]}
20191 from @samp{[a, b]} always yields the set @samp{[a]} even though if
20192 the variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} both equaled 17, you might
20193 expect the answer @samp{[]}.
20194
20195 If a set contains interval forms, then it is assumed to be a set of
20196 real numbers. In this case, all set operations require the elements
20197 of the set to be only things that are allowed in intervals: Real
20198 numbers, plus and minus infinity, HMS forms, and date forms. If
20199 there are variables or other non-real objects present in a real set,
20200 all set operations on it will be left in unevaluated form.
20201
20202 If the input to a set operation is a plain number or interval form
20203 @var{a}, it is treated like the one-element vector @samp{[@var{a}]}.
20204 The result is always a vector, except that if the set consists of a
20205 single interval, the interval itself is returned instead.
20206
20207 @xref{Logical Operations}, for the @code{in} function which tests if
20208 a certain value is a member of a given set. To test if the set @expr{A}
20209 is a subset of the set @expr{B}, use @samp{vdiff(A, B) = []}.
20210
20211 @kindex V +
20212 @pindex calc-remove-duplicates
20213 @tindex rdup
20214 The @kbd{V +} (@code{calc-remove-duplicates}) [@code{rdup}] command
20215 converts an arbitrary vector into set notation. It works by sorting
20216 the vector as if by @kbd{V S}, then removing duplicates. (For example,
20217 @kbd{[a, 5, 4, a, 4.0]} is sorted to @samp{[4, 4.0, 5, a, a]} and then
20218 reduced to @samp{[4, 5, a]}). Overlapping intervals are merged as
20219 necessary. You rarely need to use @kbd{V +} explicitly, since all the
20220 other set-based commands apply @kbd{V +} to their inputs before using
20221 them.
20222
20223 @kindex V V
20224 @pindex calc-set-union
20225 @tindex vunion
20226 The @kbd{V V} (@code{calc-set-union}) [@code{vunion}] command computes
20227 the union of two sets. An object is in the union of two sets if and
20228 only if it is in either (or both) of the input sets. (You could
20229 accomplish the same thing by concatenating the sets with @kbd{|},
20230 then using @kbd{V +}.)
20231
20232 @kindex V ^
20233 @pindex calc-set-intersect
20234 @tindex vint
20235 The @kbd{V ^} (@code{calc-set-intersect}) [@code{vint}] command computes
20236 the intersection of two sets. An object is in the intersection if
20237 and only if it is in both of the input sets. Thus if the input
20238 sets are disjoint, i.e., if they share no common elements, the result
20239 will be the empty vector @samp{[]}. Note that the characters @kbd{V}
20240 and @kbd{^} were chosen to be close to the conventional mathematical
20241 notation for set
20242 @texline union@tie{}(@math{A \cup B})
20243 @infoline union
20244 and
20245 @texline intersection@tie{}(@math{A \cap B}).
20246 @infoline intersection.
20247
20248 @kindex V -
20249 @pindex calc-set-difference
20250 @tindex vdiff
20251 The @kbd{V -} (@code{calc-set-difference}) [@code{vdiff}] command computes
20252 the difference between two sets. An object is in the difference
20253 @expr{A - B} if and only if it is in @expr{A} but not in @expr{B}.
20254 Thus subtracting @samp{[y,z]} from a set will remove the elements
20255 @samp{y} and @samp{z} if they are present. You can also think of this
20256 as a general @dfn{set complement} operator; if @expr{A} is the set of
20257 all possible values, then @expr{A - B} is the ``complement'' of @expr{B}.
20258 Obviously this is only practical if the set of all possible values in
20259 your problem is small enough to list in a Calc vector (or simple
20260 enough to express in a few intervals).
20261
20262 @kindex V X
20263 @pindex calc-set-xor
20264 @tindex vxor
20265 The @kbd{V X} (@code{calc-set-xor}) [@code{vxor}] command computes
20266 the ``exclusive-or,'' or ``symmetric difference'' of two sets.
20267 An object is in the symmetric difference of two sets if and only
20268 if it is in one, but @emph{not} both, of the sets. Objects that
20269 occur in both sets ``cancel out.''
20270
20271 @kindex V ~
20272 @pindex calc-set-complement
20273 @tindex vcompl
20274 The @kbd{V ~} (@code{calc-set-complement}) [@code{vcompl}] command
20275 computes the complement of a set with respect to the real numbers.
20276 Thus @samp{vcompl(x)} is equivalent to @samp{vdiff([-inf .. inf], x)}.
20277 For example, @samp{vcompl([2, (3 .. 4]])} evaluates to
20278 @samp{[[-inf .. 2), (2 .. 3], (4 .. inf]]}.
20279
20280 @kindex V F
20281 @pindex calc-set-floor
20282 @tindex vfloor
20283 The @kbd{V F} (@code{calc-set-floor}) [@code{vfloor}] command
20284 reinterprets a set as a set of integers. Any non-integer values,
20285 and intervals that do not enclose any integers, are removed. Open
20286 intervals are converted to equivalent closed intervals. Successive
20287 integers are converted into intervals of integers. For example, the
20288 complement of the set @samp{[2, 6, 7, 8]} is messy, but if you wanted
20289 the complement with respect to the set of integers you could type
20290 @kbd{V ~ V F} to get @samp{[[-inf .. 1], [3 .. 5], [9 .. inf]]}.
20291
20292 @kindex V E
20293 @pindex calc-set-enumerate
20294 @tindex venum
20295 The @kbd{V E} (@code{calc-set-enumerate}) [@code{venum}] command
20296 converts a set of integers into an explicit vector. Intervals in
20297 the set are expanded out to lists of all integers encompassed by
20298 the intervals. This only works for finite sets (i.e., sets which
20299 do not involve @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf}).
20300
20301 @kindex V :
20302 @pindex calc-set-span
20303 @tindex vspan
20304 The @kbd{V :} (@code{calc-set-span}) [@code{vspan}] command converts any
20305 set of reals into an interval form that encompasses all its elements.
20306 The lower limit will be the smallest element in the set; the upper
20307 limit will be the largest element. For an empty set, @samp{vspan([])}
20308 returns the empty interval @w{@samp{[0 .. 0)}}.
20309
20310 @kindex V #
20311 @pindex calc-set-cardinality
20312 @tindex vcard
20313 The @kbd{V #} (@code{calc-set-cardinality}) [@code{vcard}] command counts
20314 the number of integers in a set. The result is the length of the vector
20315 that would be produced by @kbd{V E}, although the computation is much
20316 more efficient than actually producing that vector.
20317
20318 @cindex Sets, as binary numbers
20319 Another representation for sets that may be more appropriate in some
20320 cases is binary numbers. If you are dealing with sets of integers
20321 in the range 0 to 49, you can use a 50-bit binary number where a
20322 particular bit is 1 if the corresponding element is in the set.
20323 @xref{Binary Functions}, for a list of commands that operate on
20324 binary numbers. Note that many of the above set operations have
20325 direct equivalents in binary arithmetic: @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}),
20326 @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}), @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}),
20327 @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}), and @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}),
20328 respectively. You can use whatever representation for sets is most
20329 convenient to you.
20330
20331 @kindex b p
20332 @kindex b u
20333 @pindex calc-pack-bits
20334 @pindex calc-unpack-bits
20335 @tindex vpack
20336 @tindex vunpack
20337 The @kbd{b u} (@code{calc-unpack-bits}) [@code{vunpack}] command
20338 converts an integer that represents a set in binary into a set
20339 in vector/interval notation. For example, @samp{vunpack(67)}
20340 returns @samp{[[0 .. 1], 6]}. If the input is negative, the set
20341 it represents is semi-infinite: @samp{vunpack(-4) = [2 .. inf)}.
20342 Use @kbd{V E} afterwards to expand intervals to individual
20343 values if you wish. Note that this command uses the @kbd{b}
20344 (binary) prefix key.
20345
20346 The @kbd{b p} (@code{calc-pack-bits}) [@code{vpack}] command
20347 converts the other way, from a vector or interval representing
20348 a set of nonnegative integers into a binary integer describing
20349 the same set. The set may include positive infinity, but must
20350 not include any negative numbers. The input is interpreted as a
20351 set of integers in the sense of @kbd{V F} (@code{vfloor}). Beware
20352 that a simple input like @samp{[100]} can result in a huge integer
20353 representation
20354 @texline (@math{2^{100}}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20355 @infoline (@expr{2^100}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20356
20357 @node Statistical Operations, Reducing and Mapping, Set Operations, Matrix Functions
20358 @section Statistical Operations on Vectors
20359
20360 @noindent
20361 @cindex Statistical functions
20362 The commands in this section take vectors as arguments and compute
20363 various statistical measures on the data stored in the vectors. The
20364 references used in the definitions of these functions are Bevington's
20365 @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis for the Physical Sciences},
20366 and @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky and
20367 Vetterling.
20368
20369 The statistical commands use the @kbd{u} prefix key followed by
20370 a shifted letter or other character.
20371
20372 @xref{Manipulating Vectors}, for a description of @kbd{V H}
20373 (@code{calc-histogram}).
20374
20375 @xref{Curve Fitting}, for the @kbd{a F} command for doing
20376 least-squares fits to statistical data.
20377
20378 @xref{Probability Distribution Functions}, for several common
20379 probability distribution functions.
20380
20381 @menu
20382 * Single-Variable Statistics::
20383 * Paired-Sample Statistics::
20384 @end menu
20385
20386 @node Single-Variable Statistics, Paired-Sample Statistics, Statistical Operations, Statistical Operations
20387 @subsection Single-Variable Statistics
20388
20389 @noindent
20390 These functions do various statistical computations on single
20391 vectors. Given a numeric prefix argument, they actually pop
20392 @var{n} objects from the stack and combine them into a data
20393 vector. Each object may be either a number or a vector; if a
20394 vector, any sub-vectors inside it are ``flattened'' as if by
20395 @kbd{v a 0}; @pxref{Manipulating Vectors}. By default one object
20396 is popped, which (in order to be useful) is usually a vector.
20397
20398 If an argument is a variable name, and the value stored in that
20399 variable is a vector, then the stored vector is used. This method
20400 has the advantage that if your data vector is large, you can avoid
20401 the slow process of manipulating it directly on the stack.
20402
20403 These functions are left in symbolic form if any of their arguments
20404 are not numbers or vectors, e.g., if an argument is a formula, or
20405 a non-vector variable. However, formulas embedded within vector
20406 arguments are accepted; the result is a symbolic representation
20407 of the computation, based on the assumption that the formula does
20408 not itself represent a vector. All varieties of numbers such as
20409 error forms and interval forms are acceptable.
20410
20411 Some of the functions in this section also accept a single error form
20412 or interval as an argument. They then describe a property of the
20413 normal or uniform (respectively) statistical distribution described
20414 by the argument. The arguments are interpreted in the same way as
20415 the @var{M} argument of the random number function @kbd{k r}. In
20416 particular, an interval with integer limits is considered an integer
20417 distribution, so that @samp{[2 .. 6)} is the same as @samp{[2 .. 5]}.
20418 An interval with at least one floating-point limit is a continuous
20419 distribution: @samp{[2.0 .. 6.0)} is @emph{not} the same as
20420 @samp{[2.0 .. 5.0]}!
20421
20422 @kindex u #
20423 @pindex calc-vector-count
20424 @tindex vcount
20425 The @kbd{u #} (@code{calc-vector-count}) [@code{vcount}] command
20426 computes the number of data values represented by the inputs.
20427 For example, @samp{vcount(1, [2, 3], [[4, 5], [], x, y])} returns 7.
20428 If the argument is a single vector with no sub-vectors, this
20429 simply computes the length of the vector.
20430
20431 @kindex u +
20432 @kindex u *
20433 @pindex calc-vector-sum
20434 @pindex calc-vector-prod
20435 @tindex vsum
20436 @tindex vprod
20437 @cindex Summations (statistical)
20438 The @kbd{u +} (@code{calc-vector-sum}) [@code{vsum}] command
20439 computes the sum of the data values. The @kbd{u *}
20440 (@code{calc-vector-prod}) [@code{vprod}] command computes the
20441 product of the data values. If the input is a single flat vector,
20442 these are the same as @kbd{V R +} and @kbd{V R *}
20443 (@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}).
20444
20445 @kindex u X
20446 @kindex u N
20447 @pindex calc-vector-max
20448 @pindex calc-vector-min
20449 @tindex vmax
20450 @tindex vmin
20451 The @kbd{u X} (@code{calc-vector-max}) [@code{vmax}] command
20452 computes the maximum of the data values, and the @kbd{u N}
20453 (@code{calc-vector-min}) [@code{vmin}] command computes the minimum.
20454 If the argument is an interval, this finds the minimum or maximum
20455 value in the interval. (Note that @samp{vmax([2..6)) = 5} as
20456 described above.) If the argument is an error form, this returns
20457 plus or minus infinity.
20458
20459 @kindex u M
20460 @pindex calc-vector-mean
20461 @tindex vmean
20462 @cindex Mean of data values
20463 The @kbd{u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean}) [@code{vmean}] command
20464 computes the average (arithmetic mean) of the data values.
20465 If the inputs are error forms
20466 @texline @math{x \pm \sigma},
20467 @infoline @samp{x +/- s},
20468 this is the weighted mean of the @expr{x} values with weights
20469 @texline @math{1 /\sigma^2}.
20470 @infoline @expr{1 / s^2}.
20471 @tex
20472 \turnoffactive
20473 $$ \mu = { \displaystyle \sum { x_i \over \sigma_i^2 } \over
20474 \displaystyle \sum { 1 \over \sigma_i^2 } } $$
20475 @end tex
20476 If the inputs are not error forms, this is simply the sum of the
20477 values divided by the count of the values.
20478
20479 Note that a plain number can be considered an error form with
20480 error
20481 @texline @math{\sigma = 0}.
20482 @infoline @expr{s = 0}.
20483 If the input to @kbd{u M} is a mixture of
20484 plain numbers and error forms, the result is the mean of the
20485 plain numbers, ignoring all values with non-zero errors. (By the
20486 above definitions it's clear that a plain number effectively
20487 has an infinite weight, next to which an error form with a finite
20488 weight is completely negligible.)
20489
20490 This function also works for distributions (error forms or
20491 intervals). The mean of an error form `@var{a} @t{+/-} @var{b}' is simply
20492 @expr{a}. The mean of an interval is the mean of the minimum
20493 and maximum values of the interval.
20494
20495 @kindex I u M
20496 @pindex calc-vector-mean-error
20497 @tindex vmeane
20498 The @kbd{I u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean-error}) [@code{vmeane}]
20499 command computes the mean of the data points expressed as an
20500 error form. This includes the estimated error associated with
20501 the mean. If the inputs are error forms, the error is the square
20502 root of the reciprocal of the sum of the reciprocals of the squares
20503 of the input errors. (I.e., the variance is the reciprocal of the
20504 sum of the reciprocals of the variances.)
20505 @tex
20506 \turnoffactive
20507 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {1 \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}} $$
20508 @end tex
20509 If the inputs are plain
20510 numbers, the error is equal to the standard deviation of the values
20511 divided by the square root of the number of values. (This works
20512 out to be equivalent to calculating the standard deviation and
20513 then assuming each value's error is equal to this standard
20514 deviation.)
20515 @tex
20516 \turnoffactive
20517 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {\sigma^2 \over N} $$
20518 @end tex
20519
20520 @kindex H u M
20521 @pindex calc-vector-median
20522 @tindex vmedian
20523 @cindex Median of data values
20524 The @kbd{H u M} (@code{calc-vector-median}) [@code{vmedian}]
20525 command computes the median of the data values. The values are
20526 first sorted into numerical order; the median is the middle
20527 value after sorting. (If the number of data values is even,
20528 the median is taken to be the average of the two middle values.)
20529 The median function is different from the other functions in
20530 this section in that the arguments must all be real numbers;
20531 variables are not accepted even when nested inside vectors.
20532 (Otherwise it is not possible to sort the data values.) If
20533 any of the input values are error forms, their error parts are
20534 ignored.
20535
20536 The median function also accepts distributions. For both normal
20537 (error form) and uniform (interval) distributions, the median is
20538 the same as the mean.
20539
20540 @kindex H I u M
20541 @pindex calc-vector-harmonic-mean
20542 @tindex vhmean
20543 @cindex Harmonic mean
20544 The @kbd{H I u M} (@code{calc-vector-harmonic-mean}) [@code{vhmean}]
20545 command computes the harmonic mean of the data values. This is
20546 defined as the reciprocal of the arithmetic mean of the reciprocals
20547 of the values.
20548 @tex
20549 \turnoffactive
20550 $$ { N \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over x_i} } $$
20551 @end tex
20552
20553 @kindex u G
20554 @pindex calc-vector-geometric-mean
20555 @tindex vgmean
20556 @cindex Geometric mean
20557 The @kbd{u G} (@code{calc-vector-geometric-mean}) [@code{vgmean}]
20558 command computes the geometric mean of the data values. This
20559 is the @var{n}th root of the product of the values. This is also
20560 equal to the @code{exp} of the arithmetic mean of the logarithms
20561 of the data values.
20562 @tex
20563 \turnoffactive
20564 $$ \exp \left ( \sum { \ln x_i } \right ) =
20565 \left ( \prod { x_i } \right)^{1 / N} $$
20566 @end tex
20567
20568 @kindex H u G
20569 @tindex agmean
20570 The @kbd{H u G} [@code{agmean}] command computes the ``arithmetic-geometric
20571 mean'' of two numbers taken from the stack. This is computed by
20572 replacing the two numbers with their arithmetic mean and geometric
20573 mean, then repeating until the two values converge.
20574 @tex
20575 \turnoffactive
20576 $$ a_{i+1} = { a_i + b_i \over 2 } , \qquad b_{i+1} = \sqrt{a_i b_i} $$
20577 @end tex
20578
20579 @cindex Root-mean-square
20580 Another commonly used mean, the RMS (root-mean-square), can be computed
20581 for a vector of numbers simply by using the @kbd{A} command.
20582
20583 @kindex u S
20584 @pindex calc-vector-sdev
20585 @tindex vsdev
20586 @cindex Standard deviation
20587 @cindex Sample statistics
20588 The @kbd{u S} (@code{calc-vector-sdev}) [@code{vsdev}] command
20589 computes the standard
20590 @texline deviation@tie{}@math{\sigma}
20591 @infoline deviation
20592 of the data values. If the values are error forms, the errors are used
20593 as weights just as for @kbd{u M}. This is the @emph{sample} standard
20594 deviation, whose value is the square root of the sum of the squares of
20595 the differences between the values and the mean of the @expr{N} values,
20596 divided by @expr{N-1}.
20597 @tex
20598 \turnoffactive
20599 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N - 1} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20600 @end tex
20601
20602 This function also applies to distributions. The standard deviation
20603 of a single error form is simply the error part. The standard deviation
20604 of a continuous interval happens to equal the difference between the
20605 limits, divided by
20606 @texline @math{\sqrt{12}}.
20607 @infoline @expr{sqrt(12)}.
20608 The standard deviation of an integer interval is the same as the
20609 standard deviation of a vector of those integers.
20610
20611 @kindex I u S
20612 @pindex calc-vector-pop-sdev
20613 @tindex vpsdev
20614 @cindex Population statistics
20615 The @kbd{I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-sdev}) [@code{vpsdev}]
20616 command computes the @emph{population} standard deviation.
20617 It is defined by the same formula as above but dividing
20618 by @expr{N} instead of by @expr{N-1}. The population standard
20619 deviation is used when the input represents the entire set of
20620 data values in the distribution; the sample standard deviation
20621 is used when the input represents a sample of the set of all
20622 data values, so that the mean computed from the input is itself
20623 only an estimate of the true mean.
20624 @tex
20625 \turnoffactive
20626 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20627 @end tex
20628
20629 For error forms and continuous intervals, @code{vpsdev} works
20630 exactly like @code{vsdev}. For integer intervals, it computes the
20631 population standard deviation of the equivalent vector of integers.
20632
20633 @kindex H u S
20634 @kindex H I u S
20635 @pindex calc-vector-variance
20636 @pindex calc-vector-pop-variance
20637 @tindex vvar
20638 @tindex vpvar
20639 @cindex Variance of data values
20640 The @kbd{H u S} (@code{calc-vector-variance}) [@code{vvar}] and
20641 @kbd{H I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-variance}) [@code{vpvar}]
20642 commands compute the variance of the data values. The variance
20643 is the
20644 @texline square@tie{}@math{\sigma^2}
20645 @infoline square
20646 of the standard deviation, i.e., the sum of the
20647 squares of the deviations of the data values from the mean.
20648 (This definition also applies when the argument is a distribution.)
20649
20650 @ignore
20651 @starindex
20652 @end ignore
20653 @tindex vflat
20654 The @code{vflat} algebraic function returns a vector of its
20655 arguments, interpreted in the same way as the other functions
20656 in this section. For example, @samp{vflat(1, [2, [3, 4]], 5)}
20657 returns @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
20658
20659 @node Paired-Sample Statistics, , Single-Variable Statistics, Statistical Operations
20660 @subsection Paired-Sample Statistics
20661
20662 @noindent
20663 The functions in this section take two arguments, which must be
20664 vectors of equal size. The vectors are each flattened in the same
20665 way as by the single-variable statistical functions. Given a numeric
20666 prefix argument of 1, these functions instead take one object from
20667 the stack, which must be an
20668 @texline @math{N\times2}
20669 @infoline Nx2
20670 matrix of data values. Once again, variable names can be used in place
20671 of actual vectors and matrices.
20672
20673 @kindex u C
20674 @pindex calc-vector-covariance
20675 @tindex vcov
20676 @cindex Covariance
20677 The @kbd{u C} (@code{calc-vector-covariance}) [@code{vcov}] command
20678 computes the sample covariance of two vectors. The covariance
20679 of vectors @var{x} and @var{y} is the sum of the products of the
20680 differences between the elements of @var{x} and the mean of @var{x}
20681 times the differences between the corresponding elements of @var{y}
20682 and the mean of @var{y}, all divided by @expr{N-1}. Note that
20683 the variance of a vector is just the covariance of the vector
20684 with itself. Once again, if the inputs are error forms the
20685 errors are used as weight factors. If both @var{x} and @var{y}
20686 are composed of error forms, the error for a given data point
20687 is taken as the square root of the sum of the squares of the two
20688 input errors.
20689 @tex
20690 \turnoffactive
20691 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 = {1 \over N-1} \sum (x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) $$
20692 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 =
20693 {\displaystyle {1 \over N-1}
20694 \sum {(x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) \over \sigma_i^2}
20695 \over \displaystyle {1 \over N} \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}}
20696 $$
20697 @end tex
20698
20699 @kindex I u C
20700 @pindex calc-vector-pop-covariance
20701 @tindex vpcov
20702 The @kbd{I u C} (@code{calc-vector-pop-covariance}) [@code{vpcov}]
20703 command computes the population covariance, which is the same as the
20704 sample covariance computed by @kbd{u C} except dividing by @expr{N}
20705 instead of @expr{N-1}.
20706
20707 @kindex H u C
20708 @pindex calc-vector-correlation
20709 @tindex vcorr
20710 @cindex Correlation coefficient
20711 @cindex Linear correlation
20712 The @kbd{H u C} (@code{calc-vector-correlation}) [@code{vcorr}]
20713 command computes the linear correlation coefficient of two vectors.
20714 This is defined by the covariance of the vectors divided by the
20715 product of their standard deviations. (There is no difference
20716 between sample or population statistics here.)
20717 @tex
20718 \turnoffactive
20719 $$ r_{x\!y} = { \sigma_{x\!y}^2 \over \sigma_x^2 \sigma_y^2 } $$
20720 @end tex
20721
20722 @node Reducing and Mapping, Vector and Matrix Formats, Statistical Operations, Matrix Functions
20723 @section Reducing and Mapping Vectors
20724
20725 @noindent
20726 The commands in this section allow for more general operations on the
20727 elements of vectors.
20728
20729 @kindex V A
20730 @pindex calc-apply
20731 @tindex apply
20732 The simplest of these operations is @kbd{V A} (@code{calc-apply})
20733 [@code{apply}], which applies a given operator to the elements of a vector.
20734 For example, applying the hypothetical function @code{f} to the vector
20735 @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3]}} would produce the function call @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20736 Applying the @code{+} function to the vector @samp{[a, b]} gives
20737 @samp{a + b}. Applying @code{+} to the vector @samp{[a, b, c]} is an
20738 error, since the @code{+} function expects exactly two arguments.
20739
20740 While @kbd{V A} is useful in some cases, you will usually find that either
20741 @kbd{V R} or @kbd{V M}, described below, is closer to what you want.
20742
20743 @menu
20744 * Specifying Operators::
20745 * Mapping::
20746 * Reducing::
20747 * Nesting and Fixed Points::
20748 * Generalized Products::
20749 @end menu
20750
20751 @node Specifying Operators, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20752 @subsection Specifying Operators
20753
20754 @noindent
20755 Commands in this section (like @kbd{V A}) prompt you to press the key
20756 corresponding to the desired operator. Press @kbd{?} for a partial
20757 list of the available operators. Generally, an operator is any key or
20758 sequence of keys that would normally take one or more arguments from
20759 the stack and replace them with a result. For example, @kbd{V A H C}
20760 uses the hyperbolic cosine operator, @code{cosh}. (Since @code{cosh}
20761 expects one argument, @kbd{V A H C} requires a vector with a single
20762 element as its argument.)
20763
20764 You can press @kbd{x} at the operator prompt to select any algebraic
20765 function by name to use as the operator. This includes functions you
20766 have defined yourself using the @kbd{Z F} command. (@xref{Algebraic
20767 Definitions}.) If you give a name for which no function has been
20768 defined, the result is left in symbolic form, as in @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20769 Calc will prompt for the number of arguments the function takes if it
20770 can't figure it out on its own (say, because you named a function that
20771 is currently undefined). It is also possible to type a digit key before
20772 the function name to specify the number of arguments, e.g.,
20773 @kbd{V M 3 x f @key{RET}} calls @code{f} with three arguments even if it
20774 looks like it ought to have only two. This technique may be necessary
20775 if the function allows a variable number of arguments. For example,
20776 the @kbd{v e} [@code{vexp}] function accepts two or three arguments;
20777 if you want to map with the three-argument version, you will have to
20778 type @kbd{V M 3 v e}.
20779
20780 It is also possible to apply any formula to a vector by treating that
20781 formula as a function. When prompted for the operator to use, press
20782 @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) and type your formula as an algebraic entry.
20783 You will then be prompted for the argument list, which defaults to a
20784 list of all variables that appear in the formula, sorted into alphabetic
20785 order. For example, suppose you enter the formula @w{@samp{x + 2y^x}}.
20786 The default argument list would be @samp{(x y)}, which means that if
20787 this function is applied to the arguments @samp{[3, 10]} the result will
20788 be @samp{3 + 2*10^3}. (If you plan to use a certain formula in this
20789 way often, you might consider defining it as a function with @kbd{Z F}.)
20790
20791 Another way to specify the arguments to the formula you enter is with
20792 @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on. For example, @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$}
20793 has the same effect as the previous example. The argument list is
20794 automatically taken to be @samp{($$ $)}. (The order of the arguments
20795 may seem backwards, but it is analogous to the way normal algebraic
20796 entry interacts with the stack.)
20797
20798 If you press @kbd{$} at the operator prompt, the effect is similar to
20799 the apostrophe except that the relevant formula is taken from top-of-stack
20800 instead. The actual vector arguments of the @kbd{V A $} or related command
20801 then start at the second-to-top stack position. You will still be
20802 prompted for an argument list.
20803
20804 @cindex Nameless functions
20805 @cindex Generic functions
20806 A function can be written without a name using the notation @samp{<#1 - #2>},
20807 which means ``a function of two arguments that computes the first
20808 argument minus the second argument.'' The symbols @samp{#1} and @samp{#2}
20809 are placeholders for the arguments. You can use any names for these
20810 placeholders if you wish, by including an argument list followed by a
20811 colon: @samp{<x, y : x - y>}. When you type @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$ @key{RET}},
20812 Calc builds the nameless function @samp{<#1 + 2 #2^#1>} as the function
20813 to map across the vectors. When you type @kbd{V A ' x + 2y^x @key{RET} @key{RET}},
20814 Calc builds the nameless function @w{@samp{<x, y : x + 2 y^x>}}. In both
20815 cases, Calc also writes the nameless function to the Trail so that you
20816 can get it back later if you wish.
20817
20818 If there is only one argument, you can write @samp{#} in place of @samp{#1}.
20819 (Note that @samp{< >} notation is also used for date forms. Calc tells
20820 that @samp{<@var{stuff}>} is a nameless function by the presence of
20821 @samp{#} signs inside @var{stuff}, or by the fact that @var{stuff}
20822 begins with a list of variables followed by a colon.)
20823
20824 You can type a nameless function directly to @kbd{V A '}, or put one on
20825 the stack and use it with @w{@kbd{V A $}}. Calc will not prompt for an
20826 argument list in this case, since the nameless function specifies the
20827 argument list as well as the function itself. In @kbd{V A '}, you can
20828 omit the @samp{< >} marks if you use @samp{#} notation for the arguments,
20829 so that @kbd{V A ' #1+#2 @key{RET}} is the same as @kbd{V A ' <#1+#2> @key{RET}},
20830 which in turn is the same as @kbd{V A ' $$+$ @key{RET}}.
20831
20832 @cindex Lambda expressions
20833 @ignore
20834 @starindex
20835 @end ignore
20836 @tindex lambda
20837 The internal format for @samp{<x, y : x + y>} is @samp{lambda(x, y, x + y)}.
20838 (The word @code{lambda} derives from Lisp notation and the theory of
20839 functions.) The internal format for @samp{<#1 + #2>} is @samp{lambda(ArgA,
20840 ArgB, ArgA + ArgB)}. Note that there is no actual Calc function called
20841 @code{lambda}; the whole point is that the @code{lambda} expression is
20842 used in its symbolic form, not evaluated for an answer until it is applied
20843 to specific arguments by a command like @kbd{V A} or @kbd{V M}.
20844
20845 (Actually, @code{lambda} does have one special property: Its arguments
20846 are never evaluated; for example, putting @samp{<(2/3) #>} on the stack
20847 will not simplify the @samp{2/3} until the nameless function is actually
20848 called.)
20849
20850 @tindex add
20851 @tindex sub
20852 @ignore
20853 @mindex @idots
20854 @end ignore
20855 @tindex mul
20856 @ignore
20857 @mindex @null
20858 @end ignore
20859 @tindex div
20860 @ignore
20861 @mindex @null
20862 @end ignore
20863 @tindex pow
20864 @ignore
20865 @mindex @null
20866 @end ignore
20867 @tindex neg
20868 @ignore
20869 @mindex @null
20870 @end ignore
20871 @tindex mod
20872 @ignore
20873 @mindex @null
20874 @end ignore
20875 @tindex vconcat
20876 As usual, commands like @kbd{V A} have algebraic function name equivalents.
20877 For example, @kbd{V A k g} with an argument of @samp{v} is equivalent to
20878 @samp{apply(gcd, v)}. The first argument specifies the operator name,
20879 and is either a variable whose name is the same as the function name,
20880 or a nameless function like @samp{<#^3+1>}. Operators that are normally
20881 written as algebraic symbols have the names @code{add}, @code{sub},
20882 @code{mul}, @code{div}, @code{pow}, @code{neg}, @code{mod}, and
20883 @code{vconcat}.
20884
20885 @ignore
20886 @starindex
20887 @end ignore
20888 @tindex call
20889 The @code{call} function builds a function call out of several arguments:
20890 @samp{call(gcd, x, y)} is the same as @samp{apply(gcd, [x, y])}, which
20891 in turn is the same as @samp{gcd(x, y)}. The first argument of @code{call},
20892 like the other functions described here, may be either a variable naming a
20893 function, or a nameless function (@samp{call(<#1+2#2>, x, y)} is the same
20894 as @samp{x + 2y}).
20895
20896 (Experts will notice that it's not quite proper to use a variable to name
20897 a function, since the name @code{gcd} corresponds to the Lisp variable
20898 @code{var-gcd} but to the Lisp function @code{calcFunc-gcd}. Calc
20899 automatically makes this translation, so you don't have to worry
20900 about it.)
20901
20902 @node Mapping, Reducing, Specifying Operators, Reducing and Mapping
20903 @subsection Mapping
20904
20905 @noindent
20906 @kindex V M
20907 @pindex calc-map
20908 @tindex map
20909 The @kbd{V M} (@code{calc-map}) [@code{map}] command applies a given
20910 operator elementwise to one or more vectors. For example, mapping
20911 @code{A} [@code{abs}] produces a vector of the absolute values of the
20912 elements in the input vector. Mapping @code{+} pops two vectors from
20913 the stack, which must be of equal length, and produces a vector of the
20914 pairwise sums of the elements. If either argument is a non-vector, it
20915 is duplicated for each element of the other vector. For example,
20916 @kbd{[1,2,3] 2 V M ^} squares the elements of the specified vector.
20917 With the 2 listed first, it would have computed a vector of powers of
20918 two. Mapping a user-defined function pops as many arguments from the
20919 stack as the function requires. If you give an undefined name, you will
20920 be prompted for the number of arguments to use.
20921
20922 If any argument to @kbd{V M} is a matrix, the operator is normally mapped
20923 across all elements of the matrix. For example, given the matrix
20924 @expr{[[1, -2, 3], [-4, 5, -6]]}, @kbd{V M A} takes six absolute values to
20925 produce another
20926 @texline @math{3\times2}
20927 @infoline 3x2
20928 matrix, @expr{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}.
20929
20930 @tindex mapr
20931 The command @kbd{V M _} [@code{mapr}] (i.e., type an underscore at the
20932 operator prompt) maps by rows instead. For example, @kbd{V M _ A} views
20933 the above matrix as a vector of two 3-element row vectors. It produces
20934 a new vector which contains the absolute values of those row vectors,
20935 namely @expr{[3.74, 8.77]}. (Recall, the absolute value of a vector is
20936 defined as the square root of the sum of the squares of the elements.)
20937 Some operators accept vectors and return new vectors; for example,
20938 @kbd{v v} reverses a vector, so @kbd{V M _ v v} would reverse each row
20939 of the matrix to get a new matrix, @expr{[[3, -2, 1], [-6, 5, -4]]}.
20940
20941 Sometimes a vector of vectors (representing, say, strings, sets, or lists)
20942 happens to look like a matrix. If so, remember to use @kbd{V M _} if you
20943 want to map a function across the whole strings or sets rather than across
20944 their individual elements.
20945
20946 @tindex mapc
20947 The command @kbd{V M :} [@code{mapc}] maps by columns. Basically, it
20948 transposes the input matrix, maps by rows, and then, if the result is a
20949 matrix, transposes again. For example, @kbd{V M : A} takes the absolute
20950 values of the three columns of the matrix, treating each as a 2-vector,
20951 and @kbd{V M : v v} reverses the columns to get the matrix
20952 @expr{[[-4, 5, -6], [1, -2, 3]]}.
20953
20954 (The symbols @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} were chosen because they had row-like
20955 and column-like appearances, and were not already taken by useful
20956 operators. Also, they appear shifted on most keyboards so they are easy
20957 to type after @kbd{V M}.)
20958
20959 The @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} modifiers have no effect on arguments that are
20960 not matrices (so if none of the arguments are matrices, they have no
20961 effect at all). If some of the arguments are matrices and others are
20962 plain numbers, the plain numbers are held constant for all rows of the
20963 matrix (so that @kbd{2 V M _ ^} squares every row of a matrix; squaring
20964 a vector takes a dot product of the vector with itself).
20965
20966 If some of the arguments are vectors with the same lengths as the
20967 rows (for @kbd{V M _}) or columns (for @kbd{V M :}) of the matrix
20968 arguments, those vectors are also held constant for every row or
20969 column.
20970
20971 Sometimes it is useful to specify another mapping command as the operator
20972 to use with @kbd{V M}. For example, @kbd{V M _ V A +} applies @kbd{V A +}
20973 to each row of the input matrix, which in turn adds the two values on that
20974 row. If you give another vector-operator command as the operator for
20975 @kbd{V M}, it automatically uses map-by-rows mode if you don't specify
20976 otherwise; thus @kbd{V M V A +} is equivalent to @kbd{V M _ V A +}. (If
20977 you really want to map-by-elements another mapping command, you can use
20978 a triple-nested mapping command: @kbd{V M V M V A +} means to map
20979 @kbd{V M V A +} over the rows of the matrix; in turn, @kbd{V A +} is
20980 mapped over the elements of each row.)
20981
20982 @tindex mapa
20983 @tindex mapd
20984 Previous versions of Calc had ``map across'' and ``map down'' modes
20985 that are now considered obsolete; the old ``map across'' is now simply
20986 @kbd{V M V A}, and ``map down'' is now @kbd{V M : V A}. The algebraic
20987 functions @code{mapa} and @code{mapd} are still supported, though.
20988 Note also that, while the old mapping modes were persistent (once you
20989 set the mode, it would apply to later mapping commands until you reset
20990 it), the new @kbd{:} and @kbd{_} modifiers apply only to the current
20991 mapping command. The default @kbd{V M} always means map-by-elements.
20992
20993 @xref{Algebraic Manipulation}, for the @kbd{a M} command, which is like
20994 @kbd{V M} but for equations and inequalities instead of vectors.
20995 @xref{Storing Variables}, for the @kbd{s m} command which modifies a
20996 variable's stored value using a @kbd{V M}-like operator.
20997
20998 @node Reducing, Nesting and Fixed Points, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20999 @subsection Reducing
21000
21001 @noindent
21002 @kindex V R
21003 @pindex calc-reduce
21004 @tindex reduce
21005 The @kbd{V R} (@code{calc-reduce}) [@code{reduce}] command applies a given
21006 binary operator across all the elements of a vector. A binary operator is
21007 a function such as @code{+} or @code{max} which takes two arguments. For
21008 example, reducing @code{+} over a vector computes the sum of the elements
21009 of the vector. Reducing @code{-} computes the first element minus each of
21010 the remaining elements. Reducing @code{max} computes the maximum element
21011 and so on. In general, reducing @code{f} over the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]}
21012 produces @samp{f(f(f(a, b), c), d)}.
21013
21014 @kindex I V R
21015 @tindex rreduce
21016 The @kbd{I V R} [@code{rreduce}] command is similar to @kbd{V R} except
21017 that works from right to left through the vector. For example, plain
21018 @kbd{V R -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces @samp{a - b - c - d}
21019 but @kbd{I V R -} on the same vector produces @samp{a - (b - (c - d))},
21020 or @samp{a - b + c - d}. This ``alternating sum'' occurs frequently
21021 in power series expansions.
21022
21023 @kindex V U
21024 @tindex accum
21025 The @kbd{V U} (@code{calc-accumulate}) [@code{accum}] command does an
21026 accumulation operation. Here Calc does the corresponding reduction
21027 operation, but instead of producing only the final result, it produces
21028 a vector of all the intermediate results. Accumulating @code{+} over
21029 the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the vector
21030 @samp{[a, a + b, a + b + c, a + b + c + d]}.
21031
21032 @kindex I V U
21033 @tindex raccum
21034 The @kbd{I V U} [@code{raccum}] command does a right-to-left accumulation.
21035 For example, @kbd{I V U -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the
21036 vector @samp{[a - b + c - d, b - c + d, c - d, d]}.
21037
21038 @tindex reducea
21039 @tindex rreducea
21040 @tindex reduced
21041 @tindex rreduced
21042 As for @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R} normally reduces a matrix elementwise. For
21043 example, given the matrix @expr{[[a, b, c], [d, e, f]]}, @kbd{V R +} will
21044 compute @expr{a + b + c + d + e + f}. You can type @kbd{V R _} or
21045 @kbd{V R :} to modify this behavior. The @kbd{V R _} [@code{reducea}]
21046 command reduces ``across'' the matrix; it reduces each row of the matrix
21047 as a vector, then collects the results. Thus @kbd{V R _ +} of this
21048 matrix would produce @expr{[a + b + c, d + e + f]}. Similarly, @kbd{V R :}
21049 [@code{reduced}] reduces down; @kbd{V R : +} would produce @expr{[a + d,
21050 b + e, c + f]}.
21051
21052 @tindex reducer
21053 @tindex rreducer
21054 There is a third ``by rows'' mode for reduction that is occasionally
21055 useful; @kbd{V R =} [@code{reducer}] simply reduces the operator over
21056 the rows of the matrix themselves. Thus @kbd{V R = +} on the above
21057 matrix would get the same result as @kbd{V R : +}, since adding two
21058 row vectors is equivalent to adding their elements. But @kbd{V R = *}
21059 would multiply the two rows (to get a single number, their dot product),
21060 while @kbd{V R : *} would produce a vector of the products of the columns.
21061
21062 These three matrix reduction modes work with @kbd{V R} and @kbd{I V R},
21063 but they are not currently supported with @kbd{V U} or @kbd{I V U}.
21064
21065 @tindex reducec
21066 @tindex rreducec
21067 The obsolete reduce-by-columns function, @code{reducec}, is still
21068 supported but there is no way to get it through the @kbd{V R} command.
21069
21070 The commands @kbd{M-# :} and @kbd{M-# _} are equivalent to typing
21071 @kbd{M-# r} to grab a rectangle of data into Calc, and then typing
21072 @kbd{V R : +} or @kbd{V R _ +}, respectively, to sum the columns or
21073 rows of the matrix. @xref{Grabbing From Buffers}.
21074
21075 @node Nesting and Fixed Points, Generalized Products, Reducing, Reducing and Mapping
21076 @subsection Nesting and Fixed Points
21077
21078 @noindent
21079 @kindex H V R
21080 @tindex nest
21081 The @kbd{H V R} [@code{nest}] command applies a function to a given
21082 argument repeatedly. It takes two values, @samp{a} and @samp{n}, from
21083 the stack, where @samp{n} must be an integer. It then applies the
21084 function nested @samp{n} times; if the function is @samp{f} and @samp{n}
21085 is 3, the result is @samp{f(f(f(a)))}. The number @samp{n} may be
21086 negative if Calc knows an inverse for the function @samp{f}; for
21087 example, @samp{nest(sin, a, -2)} returns @samp{arcsin(arcsin(a))}.
21088
21089 @kindex H V U
21090 @tindex anest
21091 The @kbd{H V U} [@code{anest}] command is an accumulating version of
21092 @code{nest}: It returns a vector of @samp{n+1} values, e.g.,
21093 @samp{[a, f(a), f(f(a)), f(f(f(a)))]}. If @samp{n} is negative and
21094 @samp{F} is the inverse of @samp{f}, then the result is of the
21095 form @samp{[a, F(a), F(F(a)), F(F(F(a)))]}.
21096
21097 @kindex H I V R
21098 @tindex fixp
21099 @cindex Fixed points
21100 The @kbd{H I V R} [@code{fixp}] command is like @kbd{H V R}, except
21101 that it takes only an @samp{a} value from the stack; the function is
21102 applied until it reaches a ``fixed point,'' i.e., until the result
21103 no longer changes.
21104
21105 @kindex H I V U
21106 @tindex afixp
21107 The @kbd{H I V U} [@code{afixp}] command is an accumulating @code{fixp}.
21108 The first element of the return vector will be the initial value @samp{a};
21109 the last element will be the final result that would have been returned
21110 by @code{fixp}.
21111
21112 For example, 0.739085 is a fixed point of the cosine function (in radians):
21113 @samp{cos(0.739085) = 0.739085}. You can find this value by putting, say,
21114 1.0 on the stack and typing @kbd{H I V U C}. (We use the accumulating
21115 version so we can see the intermediate results: @samp{[1, 0.540302, 0.857553,
21116 0.65329, ...]}. With a precision of six, this command will take 36 steps
21117 to converge to 0.739085.)
21118
21119 Newton's method for finding roots is a classic example of iteration
21120 to a fixed point. To find the square root of five starting with an
21121 initial guess, Newton's method would look for a fixed point of the
21122 function @samp{(x + 5/x) / 2}. Putting a guess of 1 on the stack
21123 and typing @kbd{H I V R ' ($ + 5/$)/2 @key{RET}} quickly yields the result
21124 2.23607. This is equivalent to using the @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root})
21125 command to find a root of the equation @samp{x^2 = 5}.
21126
21127 These examples used numbers for @samp{a} values. Calc keeps applying
21128 the function until two successive results are equal to within the
21129 current precision. For complex numbers, both the real parts and the
21130 imaginary parts must be equal to within the current precision. If
21131 @samp{a} is a formula (say, a variable name), then the function is
21132 applied until two successive results are exactly the same formula.
21133 It is up to you to ensure that the function will eventually converge;
21134 if it doesn't, you may have to press @kbd{C-g} to stop the Calculator.
21135
21136 The algebraic @code{fixp} function takes two optional arguments, @samp{n}
21137 and @samp{tol}. The first is the maximum number of steps to be allowed,
21138 and must be either an integer or the symbol @samp{inf} (infinity, the
21139 default). The second is a convergence tolerance. If a tolerance is
21140 specified, all results during the calculation must be numbers, not
21141 formulas, and the iteration stops when the magnitude of the difference
21142 between two successive results is less than or equal to the tolerance.
21143 (This implies that a tolerance of zero iterates until the results are
21144 exactly equal.)
21145
21146 Putting it all together, @samp{fixp(<(# + A/#)/2>, B, 20, 1e-10)}
21147 computes the square root of @samp{A} given the initial guess @samp{B},
21148 stopping when the result is correct within the specified tolerance, or
21149 when 20 steps have been taken, whichever is sooner.
21150
21151 @node Generalized Products, , Nesting and Fixed Points, Reducing and Mapping
21152 @subsection Generalized Products
21153
21154 @kindex V O
21155 @pindex calc-outer-product
21156 @tindex outer
21157 The @kbd{V O} (@code{calc-outer-product}) [@code{outer}] command applies
21158 a given binary operator to all possible pairs of elements from two
21159 vectors, to produce a matrix. For example, @kbd{V O *} with @samp{[a, b]}
21160 and @samp{[x, y, z]} on the stack produces a multiplication table:
21161 @samp{[[a x, a y, a z], [b x, b y, b z]]}. Element @var{r},@var{c} of
21162 the result matrix is obtained by applying the operator to element @var{r}
21163 of the lefthand vector and element @var{c} of the righthand vector.
21164
21165 @kindex V I
21166 @pindex calc-inner-product
21167 @tindex inner
21168 The @kbd{V I} (@code{calc-inner-product}) [@code{inner}] command computes
21169 the generalized inner product of two vectors or matrices, given a
21170 ``multiplicative'' operator and an ``additive'' operator. These can each
21171 actually be any binary operators; if they are @samp{*} and @samp{+},
21172 respectively, the result is a standard matrix multiplication. Element
21173 @var{r},@var{c} of the result matrix is obtained by mapping the
21174 multiplicative operator across row @var{r} of the lefthand matrix and
21175 column @var{c} of the righthand matrix, and then reducing with the additive
21176 operator. Just as for the standard @kbd{*} command, this can also do a
21177 vector-matrix or matrix-vector inner product, or a vector-vector
21178 generalized dot product.
21179
21180 Since @kbd{V I} requires two operators, it prompts twice. In each case,
21181 you can use any of the usual methods for entering the operator. If you
21182 use @kbd{$} twice to take both operator formulas from the stack, the
21183 first (multiplicative) operator is taken from the top of the stack
21184 and the second (additive) operator is taken from second-to-top.
21185
21186 @node Vector and Matrix Formats, , Reducing and Mapping, Matrix Functions
21187 @section Vector and Matrix Display Formats
21188
21189 @noindent
21190 Commands for controlling vector and matrix display use the @kbd{v} prefix
21191 instead of the usual @kbd{d} prefix. But they are display modes; in
21192 particular, they are influenced by the @kbd{I} and @kbd{H} prefix keys
21193 in the same way (@pxref{Display Modes}). Matrix display is also
21194 influenced by the @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) mode;
21195 @pxref{Normal Language Modes}.
21196
21197 @kindex V <
21198 @pindex calc-matrix-left-justify
21199 @kindex V =
21200 @pindex calc-matrix-center-justify
21201 @kindex V >
21202 @pindex calc-matrix-right-justify
21203 The commands @kbd{v <} (@code{calc-matrix-left-justify}), @kbd{v >}
21204 (@code{calc-matrix-right-justify}), and @w{@kbd{v =}}
21205 (@code{calc-matrix-center-justify}) control whether matrix elements
21206 are justified to the left, right, or center of their columns.
21207
21208 @kindex V [
21209 @pindex calc-vector-brackets
21210 @kindex V @{
21211 @pindex calc-vector-braces
21212 @kindex V (
21213 @pindex calc-vector-parens
21214 The @kbd{v [} (@code{calc-vector-brackets}) command turns the square
21215 brackets that surround vectors and matrices displayed in the stack on
21216 and off. The @kbd{v @{} (@code{calc-vector-braces}) and @kbd{v (}
21217 (@code{calc-vector-parens}) commands use curly braces or parentheses,
21218 respectively, instead of square brackets. For example, @kbd{v @{} might
21219 be used in preparation for yanking a matrix into a buffer running
21220 Mathematica. (In fact, the Mathematica language mode uses this mode;
21221 @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}.) Note that, regardless of the
21222 display mode, either brackets or braces may be used to enter vectors,
21223 and parentheses may never be used for this purpose.
21224
21225 @kindex V ]
21226 @pindex calc-matrix-brackets
21227 The @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) command controls the
21228 ``big'' style display of matrices. It prompts for a string of code
21229 letters; currently implemented letters are @code{R}, which enables
21230 brackets on each row of the matrix; @code{O}, which enables outer
21231 brackets in opposite corners of the matrix; and @code{C}, which
21232 enables commas or semicolons at the ends of all rows but the last.
21233 The default format is @samp{RO}. (Before Calc 2.00, the format
21234 was fixed at @samp{ROC}.) Here are some example matrices:
21235
21236 @example
21237 @group
21238 [ [ 123, 0, 0 ] [ [ 123, 0, 0 ],
21239 [ 0, 123, 0 ] [ 0, 123, 0 ],
21240 [ 0, 0, 123 ] ] [ 0, 0, 123 ] ]
21241
21242 RO ROC
21243
21244 @end group
21245 @end example
21246 @noindent
21247 @example
21248 @group
21249 [ 123, 0, 0 [ 123, 0, 0 ;
21250 0, 123, 0 0, 123, 0 ;
21251 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123 ]
21252
21253 O OC
21254
21255 @end group
21256 @end example
21257 @noindent
21258 @example
21259 @group
21260 [ 123, 0, 0 ] 123, 0, 0
21261 [ 0, 123, 0 ] 0, 123, 0
21262 [ 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123
21263
21264 R @r{blank}
21265 @end group
21266 @end example
21267
21268 @noindent
21269 Note that of the formats shown here, @samp{RO}, @samp{ROC}, and
21270 @samp{OC} are all recognized as matrices during reading, while
21271 the others are useful for display only.
21272
21273 @kindex V ,
21274 @pindex calc-vector-commas
21275 The @kbd{v ,} (@code{calc-vector-commas}) command turns commas on and
21276 off in vector and matrix display.
21277
21278 In vectors of length one, and in all vectors when commas have been
21279 turned off, Calc adds extra parentheses around formulas that might
21280 otherwise be ambiguous. For example, @samp{[a b]} could be a vector
21281 of the one formula @samp{a b}, or it could be a vector of two
21282 variables with commas turned off. Calc will display the former
21283 case as @samp{[(a b)]}. You can disable these extra parentheses
21284 (to make the output less cluttered at the expense of allowing some
21285 ambiguity) by adding the letter @code{P} to the control string you
21286 give to @kbd{v ]} (as described above).
21287
21288 @kindex V .
21289 @pindex calc-full-vectors
21290 The @kbd{v .} (@code{calc-full-vectors}) command turns abbreviated
21291 display of long vectors on and off. In this mode, vectors of six
21292 or more elements, or matrices of six or more rows or columns, will
21293 be displayed in an abbreviated form that displays only the first
21294 three elements and the last element: @samp{[a, b, c, ..., z]}.
21295 When very large vectors are involved this will substantially
21296 improve Calc's display speed.
21297
21298 @kindex t .
21299 @pindex calc-full-trail-vectors
21300 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command controls a
21301 similar mode for recording vectors in the Trail. If you turn on
21302 this mode, vectors of six or more elements and matrices of six or
21303 more rows or columns will be abbreviated when they are put in the
21304 Trail. The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command will be
21305 unable to recover those vectors. If you are working with very
21306 large vectors, this mode will improve the speed of all operations
21307 that involve the trail.
21308
21309 @kindex V /
21310 @pindex calc-break-vectors
21311 The @kbd{v /} (@code{calc-break-vectors}) command turns multi-line
21312 vector display on and off. Normally, matrices are displayed with one
21313 row per line but all other types of vectors are displayed in a single
21314 line. This mode causes all vectors, whether matrices or not, to be
21315 displayed with a single element per line. Sub-vectors within the
21316 vectors will still use the normal linear form.
21317
21318 @node Algebra, Units, Matrix Functions, Top
21319 @chapter Algebra
21320
21321 @noindent
21322 This section covers the Calc features that help you work with
21323 algebraic formulas. First, the general sub-formula selection
21324 mechanism is described; this works in conjunction with any Calc
21325 commands. Then, commands for specific algebraic operations are
21326 described. Finally, the flexible @dfn{rewrite rule} mechanism
21327 is discussed.
21328
21329 The algebraic commands use the @kbd{a} key prefix; selection
21330 commands use the @kbd{j} (for ``just a letter that wasn't used
21331 for anything else'') prefix.
21332
21333 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, to see how to manipulate formulas
21334 using regular Emacs editing commands.
21335
21336 When doing algebraic work, you may find several of the Calculator's
21337 modes to be helpful, including Algebraic Simplification mode (@kbd{m A})
21338 or No-Simplification mode (@kbd{m O}),
21339 Algebraic entry mode (@kbd{m a}), Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}), and
21340 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}). @xref{Mode Settings}, for discussions
21341 of these modes. You may also wish to select Big display mode (@kbd{d B}).
21342 @xref{Normal Language Modes}.
21343
21344 @menu
21345 * Selecting Subformulas::
21346 * Algebraic Manipulation::
21347 * Simplifying Formulas::
21348 * Polynomials::
21349 * Calculus::
21350 * Solving Equations::
21351 * Numerical Solutions::
21352 * Curve Fitting::
21353 * Summations::
21354 * Logical Operations::
21355 * Rewrite Rules::
21356 @end menu
21357
21358 @node Selecting Subformulas, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra, Algebra
21359 @section Selecting Sub-Formulas
21360
21361 @noindent
21362 @cindex Selections
21363 @cindex Sub-formulas
21364 @cindex Parts of formulas
21365 When working with an algebraic formula it is often necessary to
21366 manipulate a portion of the formula rather than the formula as a
21367 whole. Calc allows you to ``select'' a portion of any formula on
21368 the stack. Commands which would normally operate on that stack
21369 entry will now operate only on the sub-formula, leaving the
21370 surrounding part of the stack entry alone.
21371
21372 One common non-algebraic use for selection involves vectors. To work
21373 on one element of a vector in-place, simply select that element as a
21374 ``sub-formula'' of the vector.
21375
21376 @menu
21377 * Making Selections::
21378 * Changing Selections::
21379 * Displaying Selections::
21380 * Operating on Selections::
21381 * Rearranging with Selections::
21382 @end menu
21383
21384 @node Making Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas, Selecting Subformulas
21385 @subsection Making Selections
21386
21387 @noindent
21388 @kindex j s
21389 @pindex calc-select-here
21390 To select a sub-formula, move the Emacs cursor to any character in that
21391 sub-formula, and press @w{@kbd{j s}} (@code{calc-select-here}). Calc will
21392 highlight the smallest portion of the formula that contains that
21393 character. By default the sub-formula is highlighted by blanking out
21394 all of the rest of the formula with dots. Selection works in any
21395 display mode but is perhaps easiest in Big mode (@kbd{d B}).
21396 Suppose you enter the following formula:
21397
21398 @smallexample
21399 @group
21400 3 ___
21401 (a + b) + V c
21402 1: ---------------
21403 2 x + 1
21404 @end group
21405 @end smallexample
21406
21407 @noindent
21408 (by typing @kbd{' ((a+b)^3 + sqrt(c)) / (2x+1)}). If you move the
21409 cursor to the letter @samp{b} and press @w{@kbd{j s}}, the display changes
21410 to
21411
21412 @smallexample
21413 @group
21414 . ...
21415 .. . b. . . .
21416 1* ...............
21417 . . . .
21418 @end group
21419 @end smallexample
21420
21421 @noindent
21422 Every character not part of the sub-formula @samp{b} has been changed
21423 to a dot. The @samp{*} next to the line number is to remind you that
21424 the formula has a portion of it selected. (In this case, it's very
21425 obvious, but it might not always be. If Embedded mode is enabled,
21426 the word @samp{Sel} also appears in the mode line because the stack
21427 may not be visible. @pxref{Embedded Mode}.)
21428
21429 If you had instead placed the cursor on the parenthesis immediately to
21430 the right of the @samp{b}, the selection would have been:
21431
21432 @smallexample
21433 @group
21434 . ...
21435 (a + b) . . .
21436 1* ...............
21437 . . . .
21438 @end group
21439 @end smallexample
21440
21441 @noindent
21442 The portion selected is always large enough to be considered a complete
21443 formula all by itself, so selecting the parenthesis selects the whole
21444 formula that it encloses. Putting the cursor on the @samp{+} sign
21445 would have had the same effect.
21446
21447 (Strictly speaking, the Emacs cursor is really the manifestation of
21448 the Emacs ``point,'' which is a position @emph{between} two characters
21449 in the buffer. So purists would say that Calc selects the smallest
21450 sub-formula which contains the character to the right of ``point.'')
21451
21452 If you supply a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, the selection is
21453 expanded to the @var{n}th enclosing sub-formula. Thus, positioning
21454 the cursor on the @samp{b} and typing @kbd{C-u 1 j s} will select
21455 @samp{a + b}; typing @kbd{C-u 2 j s} will select @samp{(a + b)^3},
21456 and so on.
21457
21458 If the cursor is not on any part of the formula, or if you give a
21459 numeric prefix that is too large, the entire formula is selected.
21460
21461 If the cursor is on the @samp{.} line that marks the top of the stack
21462 (i.e., its normal ``rest position''), this command selects the entire
21463 formula at stack level 1. Most selection commands similarly operate
21464 on the formula at the top of the stack if you haven't positioned the
21465 cursor on any stack entry.
21466
21467 @kindex j a
21468 @pindex calc-select-additional
21469 The @kbd{j a} (@code{calc-select-additional}) command enlarges the
21470 current selection to encompass the cursor. To select the smallest
21471 sub-formula defined by two different points, move to the first and
21472 press @kbd{j s}, then move to the other and press @kbd{j a}. This
21473 is roughly analogous to using @kbd{C-@@} (@code{set-mark-command}) to
21474 select the two ends of a region of text during normal Emacs editing.
21475
21476 @kindex j o
21477 @pindex calc-select-once
21478 The @kbd{j o} (@code{calc-select-once}) command selects a formula in
21479 exactly the same way as @kbd{j s}, except that the selection will
21480 last only as long as the next command that uses it. For example,
21481 @kbd{j o 1 +} is a handy way to add one to the sub-formula indicated
21482 by the cursor.
21483
21484 (A somewhat more precise definition: The @kbd{j o} command sets a flag
21485 such that the next command involving selected stack entries will clear
21486 the selections on those stack entries afterwards. All other selection
21487 commands except @kbd{j a} and @kbd{j O} clear this flag.)
21488
21489 @kindex j S
21490 @kindex j O
21491 @pindex calc-select-here-maybe
21492 @pindex calc-select-once-maybe
21493 The @kbd{j S} (@code{calc-select-here-maybe}) and @kbd{j O}
21494 (@code{calc-select-once-maybe}) commands are equivalent to @kbd{j s}
21495 and @kbd{j o}, respectively, except that if the formula already
21496 has a selection they have no effect. This is analogous to the
21497 behavior of some commands such as @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection};
21498 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}) and is mainly intended to be
21499 used in keyboard macros that implement your own selection-oriented
21500 commands.
21501
21502 Selection of sub-formulas normally treats associative terms like
21503 @samp{a + b - c + d} and @samp{x * y * z} as single levels of the formula.
21504 If you place the cursor anywhere inside @samp{a + b - c + d} except
21505 on one of the variable names and use @kbd{j s}, you will select the
21506 entire four-term sum.
21507
21508 @kindex j b
21509 @pindex calc-break-selections
21510 The @kbd{j b} (@code{calc-break-selections}) command controls a mode
21511 in which the ``deep structure'' of these associative formulas shows
21512 through. Calc actually stores the above formulas as @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}
21513 and @samp{x * (y * z)}. (Note that for certain obscure reasons, Calc
21514 treats multiplication as right-associative.) Once you have enabled
21515 @kbd{j b} mode, selecting with the cursor on the @samp{-} sign would
21516 only select the @samp{a + b - c} portion, which makes sense when the
21517 deep structure of the sum is considered. There is no way to select
21518 the @samp{b - c + d} portion; although this might initially look
21519 like just as legitimate a sub-formula as @samp{a + b - c}, the deep
21520 structure shows that it isn't. The @kbd{d U} command can be used
21521 to view the deep structure of any formula (@pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
21522
21523 When @kbd{j b} mode has not been enabled, the deep structure is
21524 generally hidden by the selection commands---what you see is what
21525 you get.
21526
21527 @kindex j u
21528 @pindex calc-unselect
21529 The @kbd{j u} (@code{calc-unselect}) command unselects the formula
21530 that the cursor is on. If there was no selection in the formula,
21531 this command has no effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it
21532 unselects the @var{n}th stack element rather than using the cursor
21533 position.
21534
21535 @kindex j c
21536 @pindex calc-clear-selections
21537 The @kbd{j c} (@code{calc-clear-selections}) command unselects all
21538 stack elements.
21539
21540 @node Changing Selections, Displaying Selections, Making Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21541 @subsection Changing Selections
21542
21543 @noindent
21544 @kindex j m
21545 @pindex calc-select-more
21546 Once you have selected a sub-formula, you can expand it using the
21547 @w{@kbd{j m}} (@code{calc-select-more}) command. If @samp{a + b} is
21548 selected, pressing @w{@kbd{j m}} repeatedly works as follows:
21549
21550 @smallexample
21551 @group
21552 3 ... 3 ___ 3 ___
21553 (a + b) . . . (a + b) + V c (a + b) + V c
21554 1* ............... 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21555 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21556 @end group
21557 @end smallexample
21558
21559 @noindent
21560 In the last example, the entire formula is selected. This is roughly
21561 the same as having no selection at all, but because there are subtle
21562 differences the @samp{*} character is still there on the line number.
21563
21564 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, @kbd{j m} expands @var{n}
21565 times (or until the entire formula is selected). Note that @kbd{j s}
21566 with argument @var{n} is equivalent to plain @kbd{j s} followed by
21567 @kbd{j m} with argument @var{n}. If @w{@kbd{j m}} is used when there
21568 is no current selection, it is equivalent to @w{@kbd{j s}}.
21569
21570 Even though @kbd{j m} does not explicitly use the location of the
21571 cursor within the formula, it nevertheless uses the cursor to determine
21572 which stack element to operate on. As usual, @kbd{j m} when the cursor
21573 is not on any stack element operates on the top stack element.
21574
21575 @kindex j l
21576 @pindex calc-select-less
21577 The @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) command reduces the current
21578 selection around the cursor position. That is, it selects the
21579 immediate sub-formula of the current selection which contains the
21580 cursor, the opposite of @kbd{j m}. If the cursor is not inside the
21581 current selection, the command de-selects the formula.
21582
21583 @kindex j 1-9
21584 @pindex calc-select-part
21585 The @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} (@code{calc-select-part}) commands
21586 select the @var{n}th sub-formula of the current selection. They are
21587 like @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) except they use counting
21588 rather than the cursor position to decide which sub-formula to select.
21589 For example, if the current selection is @kbd{a + b + c} or
21590 @kbd{f(a, b, c)} or @kbd{[a, b, c]}, then @kbd{j 1} selects @samp{a},
21591 @kbd{j 2} selects @samp{b}, and @kbd{j 3} selects @samp{c}; in each of
21592 these cases, @kbd{j 4} through @kbd{j 9} would be errors.
21593
21594 If there is no current selection, @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} select
21595 the @var{n}th top-level sub-formula. (In other words, they act as if
21596 the entire stack entry were selected first.) To select the @var{n}th
21597 sub-formula where @var{n} is greater than nine, you must instead invoke
21598 @w{@kbd{j 1}} with @var{n} as a numeric prefix argument.
21599
21600 @kindex j n
21601 @kindex j p
21602 @pindex calc-select-next
21603 @pindex calc-select-previous
21604 The @kbd{j n} (@code{calc-select-next}) and @kbd{j p}
21605 (@code{calc-select-previous}) commands change the current selection
21606 to the next or previous sub-formula at the same level. For example,
21607 if @samp{b} is selected in @w{@samp{2 + a*b*c + x}}, then @kbd{j n}
21608 selects @samp{c}. Further @kbd{j n} commands would be in error because,
21609 even though there is something to the right of @samp{c} (namely, @samp{x}),
21610 it is not at the same level; in this case, it is not a term of the
21611 same product as @samp{b} and @samp{c}. However, @kbd{j m} (to select
21612 the whole product @samp{a*b*c} as a term of the sum) followed by
21613 @w{@kbd{j n}} would successfully select the @samp{x}.
21614
21615 Similarly, @kbd{j p} moves the selection from the @samp{b} in this
21616 sample formula to the @samp{a}. Both commands accept numeric prefix
21617 arguments to move several steps at a time.
21618
21619 It is interesting to compare Calc's selection commands with the
21620 Emacs Info system's commands for navigating through hierarchically
21621 organized documentation. Calc's @kbd{j n} command is completely
21622 analogous to Info's @kbd{n} command. Likewise, @kbd{j p} maps to
21623 @kbd{p}, @kbd{j 2} maps to @kbd{2}, and Info's @kbd{u} is like @kbd{j m}.
21624 (Note that @kbd{j u} stands for @code{calc-unselect}, not ``up''.)
21625 The Info @kbd{m} command is somewhat similar to Calc's @kbd{j s} and
21626 @kbd{j l}; in each case, you can jump directly to a sub-component
21627 of the hierarchy simply by pointing to it with the cursor.
21628
21629 @node Displaying Selections, Operating on Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21630 @subsection Displaying Selections
21631
21632 @noindent
21633 @kindex j d
21634 @pindex calc-show-selections
21635 The @kbd{j d} (@code{calc-show-selections}) command controls how
21636 selected sub-formulas are displayed. One of the alternatives is
21637 illustrated in the above examples; if we press @kbd{j d} we switch
21638 to the other style in which the selected portion itself is obscured
21639 by @samp{#} signs:
21640
21641 @smallexample
21642 @group
21643 3 ... # ___
21644 (a + b) . . . ## # ## + V c
21645 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21646 . . . . 2 x + 1
21647 @end group
21648 @end smallexample
21649
21650 @node Operating on Selections, Rearranging with Selections, Displaying Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21651 @subsection Operating on Selections
21652
21653 @noindent
21654 Once a selection is made, all Calc commands that manipulate items
21655 on the stack will operate on the selected portions of the items
21656 instead. (Note that several stack elements may have selections
21657 at once, though there can be only one selection at a time in any
21658 given stack element.)
21659
21660 @kindex j e
21661 @pindex calc-enable-selections
21662 The @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command disables the
21663 effect that selections have on Calc commands. The current selections
21664 still exist, but Calc commands operate on whole stack elements anyway.
21665 This mode can be identified by the fact that the @samp{*} markers on
21666 the line numbers are gone, even though selections are visible. To
21667 reactivate the selections, press @kbd{j e} again.
21668
21669 To extract a sub-formula as a new formula, simply select the
21670 sub-formula and press @key{RET}. This normally duplicates the top
21671 stack element; here it duplicates only the selected portion of that
21672 element.
21673
21674 To replace a sub-formula with something different, you can enter the
21675 new value onto the stack and press @key{TAB}. This normally exchanges
21676 the top two stack elements; here it swaps the value you entered into
21677 the selected portion of the formula, returning the old selected
21678 portion to the top of the stack.
21679
21680 @smallexample
21681 @group
21682 3 ... ... ___
21683 (a + b) . . . 17 x y . . . 17 x y + V c
21684 2* ............... 2* ............. 2: -------------
21685 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21686
21687 3 3
21688 1: 17 x y 1: (a + b) 1: (a + b)
21689 @end group
21690 @end smallexample
21691
21692 In this example we select a sub-formula of our original example,
21693 enter a new formula, @key{TAB} it into place, then deselect to see
21694 the complete, edited formula.
21695
21696 If you want to swap whole formulas around even though they contain
21697 selections, just use @kbd{j e} before and after.
21698
21699 @kindex j '
21700 @pindex calc-enter-selection
21701 The @kbd{j '} (@code{calc-enter-selection}) command is another way
21702 to replace a selected sub-formula. This command does an algebraic
21703 entry just like the regular @kbd{'} key. When you press @key{RET},
21704 the formula you type replaces the original selection. You can use
21705 the @samp{$} symbol in the formula to refer to the original
21706 selection. If there is no selection in the formula under the cursor,
21707 the cursor is used to make a temporary selection for the purposes of
21708 the command. Thus, to change a term of a formula, all you have to
21709 do is move the Emacs cursor to that term and press @kbd{j '}.
21710
21711 @kindex j `
21712 @pindex calc-edit-selection
21713 The @kbd{j `} (@code{calc-edit-selection}) command is a similar
21714 analogue of the @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command. It edits the
21715 selected sub-formula in a separate buffer. If there is no
21716 selection, it edits the sub-formula indicated by the cursor.
21717
21718 To delete a sub-formula, press @key{DEL}. This generally replaces
21719 the sub-formula with the constant zero, but in a few suitable contexts
21720 it uses the constant one instead. The @key{DEL} key automatically
21721 deselects and re-simplifies the entire formula afterwards. Thus:
21722
21723 @smallexample
21724 @group
21725 ###
21726 17 x y + # # 17 x y 17 # y 17 y
21727 1* ------------- 1: ------- 1* ------- 1: -------
21728 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1
21729 @end group
21730 @end smallexample
21731
21732 In this example, we first delete the @samp{sqrt(c)} term; Calc
21733 accomplishes this by replacing @samp{sqrt(c)} with zero and
21734 resimplifying. We then delete the @kbd{x} in the numerator;
21735 since this is part of a product, Calc replaces it with @samp{1}
21736 and resimplifies.
21737
21738 If you select an element of a vector and press @key{DEL}, that
21739 element is deleted from the vector. If you delete one side of
21740 an equation or inequality, only the opposite side remains.
21741
21742 @kindex j @key{DEL}
21743 @pindex calc-del-selection
21744 The @kbd{j @key{DEL}} (@code{calc-del-selection}) command is like
21745 @key{DEL} but with the auto-selecting behavior of @kbd{j '} and
21746 @kbd{j `}. It deletes the selected portion of the formula
21747 indicated by the cursor, or, in the absence of a selection, it
21748 deletes the sub-formula indicated by the cursor position.
21749
21750 @kindex j @key{RET}
21751 @pindex calc-grab-selection
21752 (There is also an auto-selecting @kbd{j @key{RET}} (@code{calc-copy-selection})
21753 command.)
21754
21755 Normal arithmetic operations also apply to sub-formulas. Here we
21756 select the denominator, press @kbd{5 -} to subtract five from the
21757 denominator, press @kbd{n} to negate the denominator, then
21758 press @kbd{Q} to take the square root.
21759
21760 @smallexample
21761 @group
21762 .. . .. . .. . .. .
21763 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ..........
21764 2 x + 1 2 x - 4 4 - 2 x _________
21765 V 4 - 2 x
21766 @end group
21767 @end smallexample
21768
21769 Certain types of operations on selections are not allowed. For
21770 example, for an arithmetic function like @kbd{-} no more than one of
21771 the arguments may be a selected sub-formula. (As the above example
21772 shows, the result of the subtraction is spliced back into the argument
21773 which had the selection; if there were more than one selection involved,
21774 this would not be well-defined.) If you try to subtract two selections,
21775 the command will abort with an error message.
21776
21777 Operations on sub-formulas sometimes leave the formula as a whole
21778 in an ``un-natural'' state. Consider negating the @samp{2 x} term
21779 of our sample formula by selecting it and pressing @kbd{n}
21780 (@code{calc-change-sign}).
21781
21782 @smallexample
21783 @group
21784 .. . .. .
21785 1* .......... 1* ...........
21786 ......... ..........
21787 . . . 2 x . . . -2 x
21788 @end group
21789 @end smallexample
21790
21791 Unselecting the sub-formula reveals that the minus sign, which would
21792 normally have cancelled out with the subtraction automatically, has
21793 not been able to do so because the subtraction was not part of the
21794 selected portion. Pressing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) or doing
21795 any other mathematical operation on the whole formula will cause it
21796 to be simplified.
21797
21798 @smallexample
21799 @group
21800 17 y 17 y
21801 1: ----------- 1: ----------
21802 __________ _________
21803 V 4 - -2 x V 4 + 2 x
21804 @end group
21805 @end smallexample
21806
21807 @node Rearranging with Selections, , Operating on Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21808 @subsection Rearranging Formulas using Selections
21809
21810 @noindent
21811 @kindex j R
21812 @pindex calc-commute-right
21813 The @kbd{j R} (@code{calc-commute-right}) command moves the selected
21814 sub-formula to the right in its surrounding formula. Generally the
21815 selection is one term of a sum or product; the sum or product is
21816 rearranged according to the commutative laws of algebra.
21817
21818 As with @kbd{j '} and @kbd{j @key{DEL}}, the term under the cursor is used
21819 if there is no selection in the current formula. All commands described
21820 in this section share this property. In this example, we place the
21821 cursor on the @samp{a} and type @kbd{j R}, then repeat.
21822
21823 @smallexample
21824 1: a + b - c 1: b + a - c 1: b - c + a
21825 @end smallexample
21826
21827 @noindent
21828 Note that in the final step above, the @samp{a} is switched with
21829 the @samp{c} but the signs are adjusted accordingly. When moving
21830 terms of sums and products, @kbd{j R} will never change the
21831 mathematical meaning of the formula.
21832
21833 The selected term may also be an element of a vector or an argument
21834 of a function. The term is exchanged with the one to its right.
21835 In this case, the ``meaning'' of the vector or function may of
21836 course be drastically changed.
21837
21838 @smallexample
21839 1: [a, b, c] 1: [b, a, c] 1: [b, c, a]
21840
21841 1: f(a, b, c) 1: f(b, a, c) 1: f(b, c, a)
21842 @end smallexample
21843
21844 @kindex j L
21845 @pindex calc-commute-left
21846 The @kbd{j L} (@code{calc-commute-left}) command is like @kbd{j R}
21847 except that it swaps the selected term with the one to its left.
21848
21849 With numeric prefix arguments, these commands move the selected
21850 term several steps at a time. It is an error to try to move a
21851 term left or right past the end of its enclosing formula.
21852 With numeric prefix arguments of zero, these commands move the
21853 selected term as far as possible in the given direction.
21854
21855 @kindex j D
21856 @pindex calc-sel-distribute
21857 The @kbd{j D} (@code{calc-sel-distribute}) command mixes the selected
21858 sum or product into the surrounding formula using the distributive
21859 law. For example, in @samp{a * (b - c)} with the @samp{b - c}
21860 selected, the result is @samp{a b - a c}. This also distributes
21861 products or quotients into surrounding powers, and can also do
21862 transformations like @samp{exp(a + b)} to @samp{exp(a) exp(b)},
21863 where @samp{a + b} is the selected term, and @samp{ln(a ^ b)}
21864 to @samp{ln(a) b}, where @samp{a ^ b} is the selected term.
21865
21866 For multiple-term sums or products, @kbd{j D} takes off one term
21867 at a time: @samp{a * (b + c - d)} goes to @samp{a * (c - d) + a b}
21868 with the @samp{c - d} selected so that you can type @kbd{j D}
21869 repeatedly to expand completely. The @kbd{j D} command allows a
21870 numeric prefix argument which specifies the maximum number of
21871 times to expand at once; the default is one time only.
21872
21873 @vindex DistribRules
21874 The @kbd{j D} command is implemented using rewrite rules.
21875 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}. The rules are stored in
21876 the Calc variable @code{DistribRules}. A convenient way to view
21877 these rules is to use @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) which
21878 displays and edits the stored value of a variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c}
21879 to return from editing mode; be careful not to make any actual changes
21880 or else you will affect the behavior of future @kbd{j D} commands!
21881
21882 To extend @kbd{j D} to handle new cases, just edit @code{DistribRules}
21883 as described above. You can then use the @kbd{s p} command to save
21884 this variable's value permanently for future Calc sessions.
21885 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
21886
21887 @kindex j M
21888 @pindex calc-sel-merge
21889 @vindex MergeRules
21890 The @kbd{j M} (@code{calc-sel-merge}) command is the complement
21891 of @kbd{j D}; given @samp{a b - a c} with either @samp{a b} or
21892 @samp{a c} selected, the result is @samp{a * (b - c)}. Once
21893 again, @kbd{j M} can also merge calls to functions like @code{exp}
21894 and @code{ln}; examine the variable @code{MergeRules} to see all
21895 the relevant rules.
21896
21897 @kindex j C
21898 @pindex calc-sel-commute
21899 @vindex CommuteRules
21900 The @kbd{j C} (@code{calc-sel-commute}) command swaps the arguments
21901 of the selected sum, product, or equation. It always behaves as
21902 if @kbd{j b} mode were in effect, i.e., the sum @samp{a + b + c} is
21903 treated as the nested sums @samp{(a + b) + c} by this command.
21904 If you put the cursor on the first @samp{+}, the result is
21905 @samp{(b + a) + c}; if you put the cursor on the second @samp{+}, the
21906 result is @samp{c + (a + b)} (which the default simplifications
21907 will rearrange to @samp{(c + a) + b}). The relevant rules are stored
21908 in the variable @code{CommuteRules}.
21909
21910 You may need to turn default simplifications off (with the @kbd{m O}
21911 command) in order to get the full benefit of @kbd{j C}. For example,
21912 commuting @samp{a - b} produces @samp{-b + a}, but the default
21913 simplifications will ``simplify'' this right back to @samp{a - b} if
21914 you don't turn them off. The same is true of some of the other
21915 manipulations described in this section.
21916
21917 @kindex j N
21918 @pindex calc-sel-negate
21919 @vindex NegateRules
21920 The @kbd{j N} (@code{calc-sel-negate}) command replaces the selected
21921 term with the negative of that term, then adjusts the surrounding
21922 formula in order to preserve the meaning. For example, given
21923 @samp{exp(a - b)} where @samp{a - b} is selected, the result is
21924 @samp{1 / exp(b - a)}. By contrast, selecting a term and using the
21925 regular @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the
21926 term without adjusting the surroundings, thus changing the meaning
21927 of the formula as a whole. The rules variable is @code{NegateRules}.
21928
21929 @kindex j &
21930 @pindex calc-sel-invert
21931 @vindex InvertRules
21932 The @kbd{j &} (@code{calc-sel-invert}) command is similar to @kbd{j N}
21933 except it takes the reciprocal of the selected term. For example,
21934 given @samp{a - ln(b)} with @samp{b} selected, the result is
21935 @samp{a + ln(1/b)}. The rules variable is @code{InvertRules}.
21936
21937 @kindex j E
21938 @pindex calc-sel-jump-equals
21939 @vindex JumpRules
21940 The @kbd{j E} (@code{calc-sel-jump-equals}) command moves the
21941 selected term from one side of an equation to the other. Given
21942 @samp{a + b = c + d} with @samp{c} selected, the result is
21943 @samp{a + b - c = d}. This command also works if the selected
21944 term is part of a @samp{*}, @samp{/}, or @samp{^} formula. The
21945 relevant rules variable is @code{JumpRules}.
21946
21947 @kindex j I
21948 @kindex H j I
21949 @pindex calc-sel-isolate
21950 The @kbd{j I} (@code{calc-sel-isolate}) command isolates the
21951 selected term on its side of an equation. It uses the @kbd{a S}
21952 (@code{calc-solve-for}) command to solve the equation, and the
21953 Hyperbolic flag affects it in the same way. @xref{Solving Equations}.
21954 When it applies, @kbd{j I} is often easier to use than @kbd{j E}.
21955 It understands more rules of algebra, and works for inequalities
21956 as well as equations.
21957
21958 @kindex j *
21959 @kindex j /
21960 @pindex calc-sel-mult-both-sides
21961 @pindex calc-sel-div-both-sides
21962 The @kbd{j *} (@code{calc-sel-mult-both-sides}) command prompts for a
21963 formula using algebraic entry, then multiplies both sides of the
21964 selected quotient or equation by that formula. It simplifies each
21965 side with @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) before re-forming the
21966 quotient or equation. You can suppress this simplification by
21967 providing any numeric prefix argument. There is also a @kbd{j /}
21968 (@code{calc-sel-div-both-sides}) which is similar to @kbd{j *} but
21969 dividing instead of multiplying by the factor you enter.
21970
21971 As a special feature, if the numerator of the quotient is 1, then
21972 the denominator is expanded at the top level using the distributive
21973 law (i.e., using the @kbd{C-u -1 a x} command). Suppose the
21974 formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (sqrt(a) + 1)}, and you wish
21975 to eliminate the square root in the denominator by multiplying both
21976 sides by @samp{sqrt(a) - 1}. Calc's default simplifications would
21977 change the result @samp{(sqrt(a) - 1) / (sqrt(a) - 1) (sqrt(a) + 1)}
21978 right back to the original form by cancellation; Calc expands the
21979 denominator to @samp{sqrt(a) (sqrt(a) - 1) + sqrt(a) - 1} to prevent
21980 this. (You would now want to use an @kbd{a x} command to expand
21981 the rest of the way, whereupon the denominator would cancel out to
21982 the desired form, @samp{a - 1}.) When the numerator is not 1, this
21983 initial expansion is not necessary because Calc's default
21984 simplifications will not notice the potential cancellation.
21985
21986 If the selection is an inequality, @kbd{j *} and @kbd{j /} will
21987 accept any factor, but will warn unless they can prove the factor
21988 is either positive or negative. (In the latter case the direction
21989 of the inequality will be switched appropriately.) @xref{Declarations},
21990 for ways to inform Calc that a given variable is positive or
21991 negative. If Calc can't tell for sure what the sign of the factor
21992 will be, it will assume it is positive and display a warning
21993 message.
21994
21995 For selections that are not quotients, equations, or inequalities,
21996 these commands pull out a multiplicative factor: They divide (or
21997 multiply) by the entered formula, simplify, then multiply (or divide)
21998 back by the formula.
21999
22000 @kindex j +
22001 @kindex j -
22002 @pindex calc-sel-add-both-sides
22003 @pindex calc-sel-sub-both-sides
22004 The @kbd{j +} (@code{calc-sel-add-both-sides}) and @kbd{j -}
22005 (@code{calc-sel-sub-both-sides}) commands analogously add to or
22006 subtract from both sides of an equation or inequality. For other
22007 types of selections, they extract an additive factor. A numeric
22008 prefix argument suppresses simplification of the intermediate
22009 results.
22010
22011 @kindex j U
22012 @pindex calc-sel-unpack
22013 The @kbd{j U} (@code{calc-sel-unpack}) command replaces the
22014 selected function call with its argument. For example, given
22015 @samp{a + sin(x^2)} with @samp{sin(x^2)} selected, the result
22016 is @samp{a + x^2}. (The @samp{x^2} will remain selected; if you
22017 wanted to change the @code{sin} to @code{cos}, just press @kbd{C}
22018 now to take the cosine of the selected part.)
22019
22020 @kindex j v
22021 @pindex calc-sel-evaluate
22022 The @kbd{j v} (@code{calc-sel-evaluate}) command performs the
22023 normal default simplifications on the selected sub-formula.
22024 These are the simplifications that are normally done automatically
22025 on all results, but which may have been partially inhibited by
22026 previous selection-related operations, or turned off altogether
22027 by the @kbd{m O} command. This command is just an auto-selecting
22028 version of the @w{@kbd{a v}} command (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}).
22029
22030 With a numeric prefix argument of 2, @kbd{C-u 2 j v} applies
22031 the @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) command to the selected
22032 sub-formula. With a prefix argument of 3 or more, e.g., @kbd{C-u j v}
22033 applies the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) command.
22034 @xref{Simplifying Formulas}. With a negative prefix argument
22035 it simplifies at the top level only, just as with @kbd{a v}.
22036 Here the ``top'' level refers to the top level of the selected
22037 sub-formula.
22038
22039 @kindex j "
22040 @pindex calc-sel-expand-formula
22041 The @kbd{j "} (@code{calc-sel-expand-formula}) command is to @kbd{a "}
22042 (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}) what @kbd{j v} is to @kbd{a v}.
22043
22044 You can use the @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command
22045 to define other algebraic operations on sub-formulas. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22046
22047 @node Algebraic Manipulation, Simplifying Formulas, Selecting Subformulas, Algebra
22048 @section Algebraic Manipulation
22049
22050 @noindent
22051 The commands in this section perform general-purpose algebraic
22052 manipulations. They work on the whole formula at the top of the
22053 stack (unless, of course, you have made a selection in that
22054 formula).
22055
22056 Many algebra commands prompt for a variable name or formula. If you
22057 answer the prompt with a blank line, the variable or formula is taken
22058 from top-of-stack, and the normal argument for the command is taken
22059 from the second-to-top stack level.
22060
22061 @kindex a v
22062 @pindex calc-alg-evaluate
22063 The @kbd{a v} (@code{calc-alg-evaluate}) command performs the normal
22064 default simplifications on a formula; for example, @samp{a - -b} is
22065 changed to @samp{a + b}. These simplifications are normally done
22066 automatically on all Calc results, so this command is useful only if
22067 you have turned default simplifications off with an @kbd{m O}
22068 command. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
22069
22070 It is often more convenient to type @kbd{=}, which is like @kbd{a v}
22071 but which also substitutes stored values for variables in the formula.
22072 Use @kbd{a v} if you want the variables to ignore their stored values.
22073
22074 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 2 to @kbd{a v}, it simplifies
22075 as if in Algebraic Simplification mode. This is equivalent to typing
22076 @kbd{a s}; @pxref{Simplifying Formulas}. If you give a numeric prefix
22077 of 3 or more, it uses Extended Simplification mode (@kbd{a e}).
22078
22079 If you give a negative prefix argument @mathit{-1}, @mathit{-2}, or @mathit{-3},
22080 it simplifies in the corresponding mode but only works on the top-level
22081 function call of the formula. For example, @samp{(2 + 3) * (2 + 3)} will
22082 simplify to @samp{(2 + 3)^2}, without simplifying the sub-formulas
22083 @samp{2 + 3}. As another example, typing @kbd{V R +} to sum the vector
22084 @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]} produces the formula @samp{reduce(add, [1, 2, 3, 4])}
22085 in No-Simplify mode. Using @kbd{a v} will evaluate this all the way to
22086 10; using @kbd{C-u - a v} will evaluate it only to @samp{1 + 2 + 3 + 4}.
22087 (@xref{Reducing and Mapping}.)
22088
22089 @tindex evalv
22090 @tindex evalvn
22091 The @kbd{=} command corresponds to the @code{evalv} function, and
22092 the related @kbd{N} command, which is like @kbd{=} but temporarily
22093 disables Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}) during the evaluation, corresponds
22094 to the @code{evalvn} function. (These commands interpret their prefix
22095 arguments differently than @kbd{a v}; @kbd{=} treats the prefix as
22096 the number of stack elements to evaluate at once, and @kbd{N} treats
22097 it as a temporary different working precision.)
22098
22099 The @code{evalvn} function can take an alternate working precision
22100 as an optional second argument. This argument can be either an
22101 integer, to set the precision absolutely, or a vector containing
22102 a single integer, to adjust the precision relative to the current
22103 precision. Note that @code{evalvn} with a larger than current
22104 precision will do the calculation at this higher precision, but the
22105 result will as usual be rounded back down to the current precision
22106 afterward. For example, @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415)} at a precision
22107 of 12 will return @samp{9.265359e-5}; @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, 30)}
22108 will return @samp{9.26535897932e-5} (computing a 25-digit result which
22109 is then rounded down to 12); and @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, [-2])}
22110 will return @samp{9.2654e-5}.
22111
22112 @kindex a "
22113 @pindex calc-expand-formula
22114 The @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command expands functions
22115 into their defining formulas wherever possible. For example,
22116 @samp{deg(x^2)} is changed to @samp{180 x^2 / pi}. Most functions,
22117 like @code{sin} and @code{gcd}, are not defined by simple formulas
22118 and so are unaffected by this command. One important class of
22119 functions which @emph{can} be expanded is the user-defined functions
22120 created by the @kbd{Z F} command. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
22121 Other functions which @kbd{a "} can expand include the probability
22122 distribution functions, most of the financial functions, and the
22123 hyperbolic and inverse hyperbolic functions. A numeric prefix argument
22124 affects @kbd{a "} in the same way as it does @kbd{a v}: A positive
22125 argument expands all functions in the formula and then simplifies in
22126 various ways; a negative argument expands and simplifies only the
22127 top-level function call.
22128
22129 @kindex a M
22130 @pindex calc-map-equation
22131 @tindex mapeq
22132 The @kbd{a M} (@code{calc-map-equation}) [@code{mapeq}] command applies
22133 a given function or operator to one or more equations. It is analogous
22134 to @kbd{V M}, which operates on vectors instead of equations.
22135 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}. For example, @kbd{a M S} changes
22136 @samp{x = y+1} to @samp{sin(x) = sin(y+1)}, and @kbd{a M +} with
22137 @samp{x = y+1} and @expr{6} on the stack produces @samp{x+6 = y+7}.
22138 With two equations on the stack, @kbd{a M +} would add the lefthand
22139 sides together and the righthand sides together to get the two
22140 respective sides of a new equation.
22141
22142 Mapping also works on inequalities. Mapping two similar inequalities
22143 produces another inequality of the same type. Mapping an inequality
22144 with an equation produces an inequality of the same type. Mapping a
22145 @samp{<=} with a @samp{<} or @samp{!=} (not-equal) produces a @samp{<}.
22146 If inequalities with opposite direction (e.g., @samp{<} and @samp{>})
22147 are mapped, the direction of the second inequality is reversed to
22148 match the first: Using @kbd{a M +} on @samp{a < b} and @samp{a > 2}
22149 reverses the latter to get @samp{2 < a}, which then allows the
22150 combination @samp{a + 2 < b + a}, which the @kbd{a s} command can
22151 then simplify to get @samp{2 < b}.
22152
22153 Using @kbd{a M *}, @kbd{a M /}, @kbd{a M n}, or @kbd{a M &} to negate
22154 or invert an inequality will reverse the direction of the inequality.
22155 Other adjustments to inequalities are @emph{not} done automatically;
22156 @kbd{a M S} will change @w{@samp{x < y}} to @samp{sin(x) < sin(y)} even
22157 though this is not true for all values of the variables.
22158
22159 @kindex H a M
22160 @tindex mapeqp
22161 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a M} [@code{mapeqp}] does a plain
22162 mapping operation without reversing the direction of any inequalities.
22163 Thus, @kbd{H a M &} would change @kbd{x > 2} to @kbd{1/x > 0.5}.
22164 (This change is mathematically incorrect, but perhaps you were
22165 fixing an inequality which was already incorrect.)
22166
22167 @kindex I a M
22168 @tindex mapeqr
22169 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a M} [@code{mapeqr}] always reverses
22170 the direction of the inequality. You might use @kbd{I a M C} to
22171 change @samp{x < y} to @samp{cos(x) > cos(y)} if you know you are
22172 working with small positive angles.
22173
22174 @kindex a b
22175 @pindex calc-substitute
22176 @tindex subst
22177 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) [@code{subst}] command substitutes
22178 all occurrences
22179 of some variable or sub-expression of an expression with a new
22180 sub-expression. For example, substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(y)}
22181 in @samp{2 sin(x)^2 + x sin(x) + sin(2 x)} produces
22182 @samp{2 cos(y)^2 + x cos(y) + @w{sin(2 x)}}.
22183 Note that this is a purely structural substitution; the lone @samp{x} and
22184 the @samp{sin(2 x)} stayed the same because they did not look like
22185 @samp{sin(x)}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a more general method for
22186 doing substitutions.
22187
22188 The @kbd{a b} command normally prompts for two formulas, the old
22189 one and the new one. If you enter a blank line for the first
22190 prompt, all three arguments are taken from the stack (new, then old,
22191 then target expression). If you type an old formula but then enter a
22192 blank line for the new one, the new formula is taken from top-of-stack
22193 and the target from second-to-top. If you answer both prompts, the
22194 target is taken from top-of-stack as usual.
22195
22196 Note that @kbd{a b} has no understanding of commutativity or
22197 associativity. The pattern @samp{x+y} will not match the formula
22198 @samp{y+x}. Also, @samp{y+z} will not match inside the formula @samp{x+y+z}
22199 because the @samp{+} operator is left-associative, so the ``deep
22200 structure'' of that formula is @samp{(x+y) + z}. Use @kbd{d U}
22201 (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) mode to see the true structure of
22202 a formula. The rewrite rule mechanism, discussed later, does not have
22203 these limitations.
22204
22205 As an algebraic function, @code{subst} takes three arguments:
22206 Target expression, old, new. Note that @code{subst} is always
22207 evaluated immediately, even if its arguments are variables, so if
22208 you wish to put a call to @code{subst} onto the stack you must
22209 turn the default simplifications off first (with @kbd{m O}).
22210
22211 @node Simplifying Formulas, Polynomials, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra
22212 @section Simplifying Formulas
22213
22214 @noindent
22215 @kindex a s
22216 @pindex calc-simplify
22217 @tindex simplify
22218 The @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) [@code{simplify}] command applies
22219 various algebraic rules to simplify a formula. This includes rules which
22220 are not part of the default simplifications because they may be too slow
22221 to apply all the time, or may not be desirable all of the time. For
22222 example, non-adjacent terms of sums are combined, as in @samp{a + b + 2 a}
22223 to @samp{b + 3 a}, and some formulas like @samp{sin(arcsin(x))} are
22224 simplified to @samp{x}.
22225
22226 The sections below describe all the various kinds of algebraic
22227 simplifications Calc provides in full detail. None of Calc's
22228 simplification commands are designed to pull rabbits out of hats;
22229 they simply apply certain specific rules to put formulas into
22230 less redundant or more pleasing forms. Serious algebra in Calc
22231 must be done manually, usually with a combination of selections
22232 and rewrite rules. @xref{Rearranging with Selections}.
22233 @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22234
22235 @xref{Simplification Modes}, for commands to control what level of
22236 simplification occurs automatically. Normally only the ``default
22237 simplifications'' occur.
22238
22239 @menu
22240 * Default Simplifications::
22241 * Algebraic Simplifications::
22242 * Unsafe Simplifications::
22243 * Simplification of Units::
22244 @end menu
22245
22246 @node Default Simplifications, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas, Simplifying Formulas
22247 @subsection Default Simplifications
22248
22249 @noindent
22250 @cindex Default simplifications
22251 This section describes the ``default simplifications,'' those which are
22252 normally applied to all results. For example, if you enter the variable
22253 @expr{x} on the stack twice and push @kbd{+}, Calc's default
22254 simplifications automatically change @expr{x + x} to @expr{2 x}.
22255
22256 The @kbd{m O} command turns off the default simplifications, so that
22257 @expr{x + x} will remain in this form unless you give an explicit
22258 ``simplify'' command like @kbd{=} or @kbd{a v}. @xref{Algebraic
22259 Manipulation}. The @kbd{m D} command turns the default simplifications
22260 back on.
22261
22262 The most basic default simplification is the evaluation of functions.
22263 For example, @expr{2 + 3} is evaluated to @expr{5}, and @expr{@t{sqrt}(9)}
22264 is evaluated to @expr{3}. Evaluation does not occur if the arguments
22265 to a function are somehow of the wrong type @expr{@t{tan}([2,3,4])}),
22266 range (@expr{@t{tan}(90)}), or number (@expr{@t{tan}(3,5)}),
22267 or if the function name is not recognized (@expr{@t{f}(5)}), or if
22268 Symbolic mode (@pxref{Symbolic Mode}) prevents evaluation
22269 (@expr{@t{sqrt}(2)}).
22270
22271 Calc simplifies (evaluates) the arguments to a function before it
22272 simplifies the function itself. Thus @expr{@t{sqrt}(5+4)} is
22273 simplified to @expr{@t{sqrt}(9)} before the @code{sqrt} function
22274 itself is applied. There are very few exceptions to this rule:
22275 @code{quote}, @code{lambda}, and @code{condition} (the @code{::}
22276 operator) do not evaluate their arguments, @code{if} (the @code{? :}
22277 operator) does not evaluate all of its arguments, and @code{evalto}
22278 does not evaluate its lefthand argument.
22279
22280 Most commands apply the default simplifications to all arguments they
22281 take from the stack, perform a particular operation, then simplify
22282 the result before pushing it back on the stack. In the common special
22283 case of regular arithmetic commands like @kbd{+} and @kbd{Q} [@code{sqrt}],
22284 the arguments are simply popped from the stack and collected into a
22285 suitable function call, which is then simplified (the arguments being
22286 simplified first as part of the process, as described above).
22287
22288 The default simplifications are too numerous to describe completely
22289 here, but this section will describe the ones that apply to the
22290 major arithmetic operators. This list will be rather technical in
22291 nature, and will probably be interesting to you only if you are
22292 a serious user of Calc's algebra facilities.
22293
22294 @tex
22295 \bigskip
22296 @end tex
22297
22298 As well as the simplifications described here, if you have stored
22299 any rewrite rules in the variable @code{EvalRules} then these rules
22300 will also be applied before any built-in default simplifications.
22301 @xref{Automatic Rewrites}, for details.
22302
22303 @tex
22304 \bigskip
22305 @end tex
22306
22307 And now, on with the default simplifications:
22308
22309 Arithmetic operators like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} always take two
22310 arguments in Calc's internal form. Sums and products of three or
22311 more terms are arranged by the associative law of algebra into
22312 a left-associative form for sums, @expr{((a + b) + c) + d}, and
22313 a right-associative form for products, @expr{a * (b * (c * d))}.
22314 Formulas like @expr{(a + b) + (c + d)} are rearranged to
22315 left-associative form, though this rarely matters since Calc's
22316 algebra commands are designed to hide the inner structure of
22317 sums and products as much as possible. Sums and products in
22318 their proper associative form will be written without parentheses
22319 in the examples below.
22320
22321 Sums and products are @emph{not} rearranged according to the
22322 commutative law (@expr{a + b} to @expr{b + a}) except in a few
22323 special cases described below. Some algebra programs always
22324 rearrange terms into a canonical order, which enables them to
22325 see that @expr{a b + b a} can be simplified to @expr{2 a b}.
22326 Calc assumes you have put the terms into the order you want
22327 and generally leaves that order alone, with the consequence
22328 that formulas like the above will only be simplified if you
22329 explicitly give the @kbd{a s} command. @xref{Algebraic
22330 Simplifications}.
22331
22332 Differences @expr{a - b} are treated like sums @expr{a + (-b)}
22333 for purposes of simplification; one of the default simplifications
22334 is to rewrite @expr{a + (-b)} or @expr{(-b) + a}, where @expr{-b}
22335 represents a ``negative-looking'' term, into @expr{a - b} form.
22336 ``Negative-looking'' means negative numbers, negated formulas like
22337 @expr{-x}, and products or quotients in which either term is
22338 negative-looking.
22339
22340 Other simplifications involving negation are @expr{-(-x)} to @expr{x};
22341 @expr{-(a b)} or @expr{-(a/b)} where either @expr{a} or @expr{b} is
22342 negative-looking, simplified by negating that term, or else where
22343 @expr{a} or @expr{b} is any number, by negating that number;
22344 @expr{-(a + b)} to @expr{-a - b}, and @expr{-(b - a)} to @expr{a - b}.
22345 (This, and rewriting @expr{(-b) + a} to @expr{a - b}, are the only
22346 cases where the order of terms in a sum is changed by the default
22347 simplifications.)
22348
22349 The distributive law is used to simplify sums in some cases:
22350 @expr{a x + b x} to @expr{(a + b) x}, where @expr{a} represents
22351 a number or an implicit 1 or @mathit{-1} (as in @expr{x} or @expr{-x})
22352 and similarly for @expr{b}. Use the @kbd{a c}, @w{@kbd{a f}}, or
22353 @kbd{j M} commands to merge sums with non-numeric coefficients
22354 using the distributive law.
22355
22356 The distributive law is only used for sums of two terms, or
22357 for adjacent terms in a larger sum. Thus @expr{a + b + b + c}
22358 is simplified to @expr{a + 2 b + c}, but @expr{a + b + c + b}
22359 is not simplified. The reason is that comparing all terms of a
22360 sum with one another would require time proportional to the
22361 square of the number of terms; Calc relegates potentially slow
22362 operations like this to commands that have to be invoked
22363 explicitly, like @kbd{a s}.
22364
22365 Finally, @expr{a + 0} and @expr{0 + a} are simplified to @expr{a}.
22366 A consequence of the above rules is that @expr{0 - a} is simplified
22367 to @expr{-a}.
22368
22369 @tex
22370 \bigskip
22371 @end tex
22372
22373 The products @expr{1 a} and @expr{a 1} are simplified to @expr{a};
22374 @expr{(-1) a} and @expr{a (-1)} are simplified to @expr{-a};
22375 @expr{0 a} and @expr{a 0} are simplified to @expr{0}, except that
22376 in Matrix mode where @expr{a} is not provably scalar the result
22377 is the generic zero matrix @samp{idn(0)}, and that if @expr{a} is
22378 infinite the result is @samp{nan}.
22379
22380 Also, @expr{(-a) b} and @expr{a (-b)} are simplified to @expr{-(a b)},
22381 where this occurs for negated formulas but not for regular negative
22382 numbers.
22383
22384 Products are commuted only to move numbers to the front:
22385 @expr{a b 2} is commuted to @expr{2 a b}.
22386
22387 The product @expr{a (b + c)} is distributed over the sum only if
22388 @expr{a} and at least one of @expr{b} and @expr{c} are numbers:
22389 @expr{2 (x + 3)} goes to @expr{2 x + 6}. The formula
22390 @expr{(-a) (b - c)}, where @expr{-a} is a negative number, is
22391 rewritten to @expr{a (c - b)}.
22392
22393 The distributive law of products and powers is used for adjacent
22394 terms of the product: @expr{x^a x^b} goes to
22395 @texline @math{x^{a+b}}
22396 @infoline @expr{x^(a+b)}
22397 where @expr{a} is a number, or an implicit 1 (as in @expr{x}),
22398 or the implicit one-half of @expr{@t{sqrt}(x)}, and similarly for
22399 @expr{b}. The result is written using @samp{sqrt} or @samp{1/sqrt}
22400 if the sum of the powers is @expr{1/2} or @expr{-1/2}, respectively.
22401 If the sum of the powers is zero, the product is simplified to
22402 @expr{1} or to @samp{idn(1)} if Matrix mode is enabled.
22403
22404 The product of a negative power times anything but another negative
22405 power is changed to use division:
22406 @texline @math{x^{-2} y}
22407 @infoline @expr{x^(-2) y}
22408 goes to @expr{y / x^2} unless Matrix mode is
22409 in effect and neither @expr{x} nor @expr{y} are scalar (in which
22410 case it is considered unsafe to rearrange the order of the terms).
22411
22412 Finally, @expr{a (b/c)} is rewritten to @expr{(a b)/c}, and also
22413 @expr{(a/b) c} is changed to @expr{(a c)/b} unless in Matrix mode.
22414
22415 @tex
22416 \bigskip
22417 @end tex
22418
22419 Simplifications for quotients are analogous to those for products.
22420 The quotient @expr{0 / x} is simplified to @expr{0}, with the same
22421 exceptions that were noted for @expr{0 x}. Likewise, @expr{x / 1}
22422 and @expr{x / (-1)} are simplified to @expr{x} and @expr{-x},
22423 respectively.
22424
22425 The quotient @expr{x / 0} is left unsimplified or changed to an
22426 infinite quantity, as directed by the current infinite mode.
22427 @xref{Infinite Mode}.
22428
22429 The expression
22430 @texline @math{a / b^{-c}}
22431 @infoline @expr{a / b^(-c)}
22432 is changed to @expr{a b^c}, where @expr{-c} is any negative-looking
22433 power. Also, @expr{1 / b^c} is changed to
22434 @texline @math{b^{-c}}
22435 @infoline @expr{b^(-c)}
22436 for any power @expr{c}.
22437
22438 Also, @expr{(-a) / b} and @expr{a / (-b)} go to @expr{-(a/b)};
22439 @expr{(a/b) / c} goes to @expr{a / (b c)}; and @expr{a / (b/c)}
22440 goes to @expr{(a c) / b} unless Matrix mode prevents this
22441 rearrangement. Similarly, @expr{a / (b:c)} is simplified to
22442 @expr{(c:b) a} for any fraction @expr{b:c}.
22443
22444 The distributive law is applied to @expr{(a + b) / c} only if
22445 @expr{c} and at least one of @expr{a} and @expr{b} are numbers.
22446 Quotients of powers and square roots are distributed just as
22447 described for multiplication.
22448
22449 Quotients of products cancel only in the leading terms of the
22450 numerator and denominator. In other words, @expr{a x b / a y b}
22451 is cancelled to @expr{x b / y b} but not to @expr{x / y}. Once
22452 again this is because full cancellation can be slow; use @kbd{a s}
22453 to cancel all terms of the quotient.
22454
22455 Quotients of negative-looking values are simplified according
22456 to @expr{(-a) / (-b)} to @expr{a / b}, @expr{(-a) / (b - c)}
22457 to @expr{a / (c - b)}, and @expr{(a - b) / (-c)} to @expr{(b - a) / c}.
22458
22459 @tex
22460 \bigskip
22461 @end tex
22462
22463 The formula @expr{x^0} is simplified to @expr{1}, or to @samp{idn(1)}
22464 in Matrix mode. The formula @expr{0^x} is simplified to @expr{0}
22465 unless @expr{x} is a negative number or complex number, in which
22466 case the result is an infinity or an unsimplified formula according
22467 to the current infinite mode. Note that @expr{0^0} is an
22468 indeterminate form, as evidenced by the fact that the simplifications
22469 for @expr{x^0} and @expr{0^x} conflict when @expr{x=0}.
22470
22471 Powers of products or quotients @expr{(a b)^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c}
22472 are distributed to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{a^c / b^c} only if @expr{c}
22473 is an integer, or if either @expr{a} or @expr{b} are nonnegative
22474 real numbers. Powers of powers @expr{(a^b)^c} are simplified to
22475 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
22476 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22477 only when @expr{c} is an integer and @expr{b c} also
22478 evaluates to an integer. Without these restrictions these simplifications
22479 would not be safe because of problems with principal values.
22480 (In other words,
22481 @texline @math{((-3)^{1/2})^2}
22482 @infoline @expr{((-3)^1:2)^2}
22483 is safe to simplify, but
22484 @texline @math{((-3)^2)^{1/2}}
22485 @infoline @expr{((-3)^2)^1:2}
22486 is not.) @xref{Declarations}, for ways to inform Calc that your
22487 variables satisfy these requirements.
22488
22489 As a special case of this rule, @expr{@t{sqrt}(x)^n} is simplified to
22490 @texline @math{x^{n/2}}
22491 @infoline @expr{x^(n/2)}
22492 only for even integers @expr{n}.
22493
22494 If @expr{a} is known to be real, @expr{b} is an even integer, and
22495 @expr{c} is a half- or quarter-integer, then @expr{(a^b)^c} is
22496 simplified to @expr{@t{abs}(a^(b c))}.
22497
22498 Also, @expr{(-a)^b} is simplified to @expr{a^b} if @expr{b} is an
22499 even integer, or to @expr{-(a^b)} if @expr{b} is an odd integer,
22500 for any negative-looking expression @expr{-a}.
22501
22502 Square roots @expr{@t{sqrt}(x)} generally act like one-half powers
22503 @texline @math{x^{1:2}}
22504 @infoline @expr{x^1:2}
22505 for the purposes of the above-listed simplifications.
22506
22507 Also, note that
22508 @texline @math{1 / x^{1:2}}
22509 @infoline @expr{1 / x^1:2}
22510 is changed to
22511 @texline @math{x^{-1:2}},
22512 @infoline @expr{x^(-1:2)},
22513 but @expr{1 / @t{sqrt}(x)} is left alone.
22514
22515 @tex
22516 \bigskip
22517 @end tex
22518
22519 Generic identity matrices (@pxref{Matrix Mode}) are simplified by the
22520 following rules: @expr{@t{idn}(a) + b} to @expr{a + b} if @expr{b}
22521 is provably scalar, or expanded out if @expr{b} is a matrix;
22522 @expr{@t{idn}(a) + @t{idn}(b)} to @expr{@t{idn}(a + b)};
22523 @expr{-@t{idn}(a)} to @expr{@t{idn}(-a)}; @expr{a @t{idn}(b)} to
22524 @expr{@t{idn}(a b)} if @expr{a} is provably scalar, or to @expr{a b}
22525 if @expr{a} is provably non-scalar; @expr{@t{idn}(a) @t{idn}(b)} to
22526 @expr{@t{idn}(a b)}; analogous simplifications for quotients involving
22527 @code{idn}; and @expr{@t{idn}(a)^n} to @expr{@t{idn}(a^n)} where
22528 @expr{n} is an integer.
22529
22530 @tex
22531 \bigskip
22532 @end tex
22533
22534 The @code{floor} function and other integer truncation functions
22535 vanish if the argument is provably integer-valued, so that
22536 @expr{@t{floor}(@t{round}(x))} simplifies to @expr{@t{round}(x)}.
22537 Also, combinations of @code{float}, @code{floor} and its friends,
22538 and @code{ffloor} and its friends, are simplified in appropriate
22539 ways. @xref{Integer Truncation}.
22540
22541 The expression @expr{@t{abs}(-x)} changes to @expr{@t{abs}(x)}.
22542 The expression @expr{@t{abs}(@t{abs}(x))} changes to
22543 @expr{@t{abs}(x)}; in fact, @expr{@t{abs}(x)} changes to @expr{x} or
22544 @expr{-x} if @expr{x} is provably nonnegative or nonpositive
22545 (@pxref{Declarations}).
22546
22547 While most functions do not recognize the variable @code{i} as an
22548 imaginary number, the @code{arg} function does handle the two cases
22549 @expr{@t{arg}(@t{i})} and @expr{@t{arg}(-@t{i})} just for convenience.
22550
22551 The expression @expr{@t{conj}(@t{conj}(x))} simplifies to @expr{x}.
22552 Various other expressions involving @code{conj}, @code{re}, and
22553 @code{im} are simplified, especially if some of the arguments are
22554 provably real or involve the constant @code{i}. For example,
22555 @expr{@t{conj}(a + b i)} is changed to
22556 @expr{@t{conj}(a) - @t{conj}(b) i}, or to @expr{a - b i} if @expr{a}
22557 and @expr{b} are known to be real.
22558
22559 Functions like @code{sin} and @code{arctan} generally don't have
22560 any default simplifications beyond simply evaluating the functions
22561 for suitable numeric arguments and infinity. The @kbd{a s} command
22562 described in the next section does provide some simplifications for
22563 these functions, though.
22564
22565 One important simplification that does occur is that
22566 @expr{@t{ln}(@t{e})} is simplified to 1, and @expr{@t{ln}(@t{e}^x)} is
22567 simplified to @expr{x} for any @expr{x}. This occurs even if you have
22568 stored a different value in the Calc variable @samp{e}; but this would
22569 be a bad idea in any case if you were also using natural logarithms!
22570
22571 Among the logical functions, @t{(@var{a} <= @var{b})} changes to
22572 @t{@var{a} > @var{b}} and so on. Equations and inequalities where both sides
22573 are either negative-looking or zero are simplified by negating both sides
22574 and reversing the inequality. While it might seem reasonable to simplify
22575 @expr{!!x} to @expr{x}, this would not be valid in general because
22576 @expr{!!2} is 1, not 2.
22577
22578 Most other Calc functions have few if any default simplifications
22579 defined, aside of course from evaluation when the arguments are
22580 suitable numbers.
22581
22582 @node Algebraic Simplifications, Unsafe Simplifications, Default Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22583 @subsection Algebraic Simplifications
22584
22585 @noindent
22586 @cindex Algebraic simplifications
22587 The @kbd{a s} command makes simplifications that may be too slow to
22588 do all the time, or that may not be desirable all of the time.
22589 If you find these simplifications are worthwhile, you can type
22590 @kbd{m A} to have Calc apply them automatically.
22591
22592 This section describes all simplifications that are performed by
22593 the @kbd{a s} command. Note that these occur in addition to the
22594 default simplifications; even if the default simplifications have
22595 been turned off by an @kbd{m O} command, @kbd{a s} will turn them
22596 back on temporarily while it simplifies the formula.
22597
22598 There is a variable, @code{AlgSimpRules}, in which you can put rewrites
22599 to be applied by @kbd{a s}. Its use is analogous to @code{EvalRules},
22600 but without the special restrictions. Basically, the simplifier does
22601 @samp{@w{a r} AlgSimpRules} with an infinite repeat count on the whole
22602 expression being simplified, then it traverses the expression applying
22603 the built-in rules described below. If the result is different from
22604 the original expression, the process repeats with the default
22605 simplifications (including @code{EvalRules}), then @code{AlgSimpRules},
22606 then the built-in simplifications, and so on.
22607
22608 @tex
22609 \bigskip
22610 @end tex
22611
22612 Sums are simplified in two ways. Constant terms are commuted to the
22613 end of the sum, so that @expr{a + 2 + b} changes to @expr{a + b + 2}.
22614 The only exception is that a constant will not be commuted away
22615 from the first position of a difference, i.e., @expr{2 - x} is not
22616 commuted to @expr{-x + 2}.
22617
22618 Also, terms of sums are combined by the distributive law, as in
22619 @expr{x + y + 2 x} to @expr{y + 3 x}. This always occurs for
22620 adjacent terms, but @kbd{a s} compares all pairs of terms including
22621 non-adjacent ones.
22622
22623 @tex
22624 \bigskip
22625 @end tex
22626
22627 Products are sorted into a canonical order using the commutative
22628 law. For example, @expr{b c a} is commuted to @expr{a b c}.
22629 This allows easier comparison of products; for example, the default
22630 simplifications will not change @expr{x y + y x} to @expr{2 x y},
22631 but @kbd{a s} will; it first rewrites the sum to @expr{x y + x y},
22632 and then the default simplifications are able to recognize a sum
22633 of identical terms.
22634
22635 The canonical ordering used to sort terms of products has the
22636 property that real-valued numbers, interval forms and infinities
22637 come first, and are sorted into increasing order. The @kbd{V S}
22638 command uses the same ordering when sorting a vector.
22639
22640 Sorting of terms of products is inhibited when Matrix mode is
22641 turned on; in this case, Calc will never exchange the order of
22642 two terms unless it knows at least one of the terms is a scalar.
22643
22644 Products of powers are distributed by comparing all pairs of
22645 terms, using the same method that the default simplifications
22646 use for adjacent terms of products.
22647
22648 Even though sums are not sorted, the commutative law is still
22649 taken into account when terms of a product are being compared.
22650 Thus @expr{(x + y) (y + x)} will be simplified to @expr{(x + y)^2}.
22651 A subtle point is that @expr{(x - y) (y - x)} will @emph{not}
22652 be simplified to @expr{-(x - y)^2}; Calc does not notice that
22653 one term can be written as a constant times the other, even if
22654 that constant is @mathit{-1}.
22655
22656 A fraction times any expression, @expr{(a:b) x}, is changed to
22657 a quotient involving integers: @expr{a x / b}. This is not
22658 done for floating-point numbers like @expr{0.5}, however. This
22659 is one reason why you may find it convenient to turn Fraction mode
22660 on while doing algebra; @pxref{Fraction Mode}.
22661
22662 @tex
22663 \bigskip
22664 @end tex
22665
22666 Quotients are simplified by comparing all terms in the numerator
22667 with all terms in the denominator for possible cancellation using
22668 the distributive law. For example, @expr{a x^2 b / c x^3 d} will
22669 cancel @expr{x^2} from both sides to get @expr{a b / c x d}.
22670 (The terms in the denominator will then be rearranged to @expr{c d x}
22671 as described above.) If there is any common integer or fractional
22672 factor in the numerator and denominator, it is cancelled out;
22673 for example, @expr{(4 x + 6) / 8 x} simplifies to @expr{(2 x + 3) / 4 x}.
22674
22675 Non-constant common factors are not found even by @kbd{a s}. To
22676 cancel the factor @expr{a} in @expr{(a x + a) / a^2} you could first
22677 use @kbd{j M} on the product @expr{a x} to Merge the numerator to
22678 @expr{a (1+x)}, which can then be simplified successfully.
22679
22680 @tex
22681 \bigskip
22682 @end tex
22683
22684 Integer powers of the variable @code{i} are simplified according
22685 to the identity @expr{i^2 = -1}. If you store a new value other
22686 than the complex number @expr{(0,1)} in @code{i}, this simplification
22687 will no longer occur. This is done by @kbd{a s} instead of by default
22688 in case someone (unwisely) uses the name @code{i} for a variable
22689 unrelated to complex numbers; it would be unfortunate if Calc
22690 quietly and automatically changed this formula for reasons the
22691 user might not have been thinking of.
22692
22693 Square roots of integer or rational arguments are simplified in
22694 several ways. (Note that these will be left unevaluated only in
22695 Symbolic mode.) First, square integer or rational factors are
22696 pulled out so that @expr{@t{sqrt}(8)} is rewritten as
22697 @texline @math{2\,\t{sqrt}(2)}.
22698 @infoline @expr{2 sqrt(2)}.
22699 Conceptually speaking this implies factoring the argument into primes
22700 and moving pairs of primes out of the square root, but for reasons of
22701 efficiency Calc only looks for primes up to 29.
22702
22703 Square roots in the denominator of a quotient are moved to the
22704 numerator: @expr{1 / @t{sqrt}(3)} changes to @expr{@t{sqrt}(3) / 3}.
22705 The same effect occurs for the square root of a fraction:
22706 @expr{@t{sqrt}(2:3)} changes to @expr{@t{sqrt}(6) / 3}.
22707
22708 @tex
22709 \bigskip
22710 @end tex
22711
22712 The @code{%} (modulo) operator is simplified in several ways
22713 when the modulus @expr{M} is a positive real number. First, if
22714 the argument is of the form @expr{x + n} for some real number
22715 @expr{n}, then @expr{n} is itself reduced modulo @expr{M}. For
22716 example, @samp{(x - 23) % 10} is simplified to @samp{(x + 7) % 10}.
22717
22718 If the argument is multiplied by a constant, and this constant
22719 has a common integer divisor with the modulus, then this factor is
22720 cancelled out. For example, @samp{12 x % 15} is changed to
22721 @samp{3 (4 x % 5)} by factoring out 3. Also, @samp{(12 x + 1) % 15}
22722 is changed to @samp{3 ((4 x + 1:3) % 5)}. While these forms may
22723 not seem ``simpler,'' they allow Calc to discover useful information
22724 about modulo forms in the presence of declarations.
22725
22726 If the modulus is 1, then Calc can use @code{int} declarations to
22727 evaluate the expression. For example, the idiom @samp{x % 2} is
22728 often used to check whether a number is odd or even. As described
22729 above, @w{@samp{2 n % 2}} and @samp{(2 n + 1) % 2} are simplified to
22730 @samp{2 (n % 1)} and @samp{2 ((n + 1:2) % 1)}, respectively; Calc
22731 can simplify these to 0 and 1 (respectively) if @code{n} has been
22732 declared to be an integer.
22733
22734 @tex
22735 \bigskip
22736 @end tex
22737
22738 Trigonometric functions are simplified in several ways. First,
22739 @expr{@t{sin}(@t{arcsin}(x))} is simplified to @expr{x}, and
22740 similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}. If the argument to
22741 @code{sin} is negative-looking, it is simplified to
22742 @expr{-@t{sin}(x),}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22743 Finally, certain special values of the argument are recognized;
22744 @pxref{Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions}.
22745
22746 Trigonometric functions of inverses of different trigonometric
22747 functions can also be simplified, as in @expr{@t{sin}(@t{arccos}(x))}
22748 to @expr{@t{sqrt}(1 - x^2)}.
22749
22750 Hyperbolic functions of their inverses and of negative-looking
22751 arguments are also handled, as are exponentials of inverse
22752 hyperbolic functions.
22753
22754 No simplifications for inverse trigonometric and hyperbolic
22755 functions are known, except for negative arguments of @code{arcsin},
22756 @code{arctan}, @code{arcsinh}, and @code{arctanh}. Note that
22757 @expr{@t{arcsin}(@t{sin}(x))} can @emph{not} safely change to
22758 @expr{x}, since this only correct within an integer multiple of
22759 @texline @math{2 \pi}
22760 @infoline @expr{2 pi}
22761 radians or 360 degrees. However, @expr{@t{arcsinh}(@t{sinh}(x))} is
22762 simplified to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22763
22764 Several simplifications that apply to logarithms and exponentials
22765 are that @expr{@t{exp}(@t{ln}(x))},
22766 @texline @t{e}@math{^{\ln(x)}},
22767 @infoline @expr{e^@t{ln}(x)},
22768 and
22769 @texline @math{10^{{\rm log10}(x)}}
22770 @infoline @expr{10^@t{log10}(x)}
22771 all reduce to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@t{ln}(@t{exp}(x))}, etc., can
22772 reduce to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is provably real. The form
22773 @expr{@t{exp}(x)^y} is simplified to @expr{@t{exp}(x y)}. If @expr{x}
22774 is a suitable multiple of
22775 @texline @math{\pi i}
22776 @infoline @expr{pi i}
22777 (as described above for the trigonometric functions), then
22778 @expr{@t{exp}(x)} or @expr{e^x} will be expanded. Finally,
22779 @expr{@t{ln}(x)} is simplified to a form involving @code{pi} and
22780 @code{i} where @expr{x} is provably negative, positive imaginary, or
22781 negative imaginary.
22782
22783 The error functions @code{erf} and @code{erfc} are simplified when
22784 their arguments are negative-looking or are calls to the @code{conj}
22785 function.
22786
22787 @tex
22788 \bigskip
22789 @end tex
22790
22791 Equations and inequalities are simplified by cancelling factors
22792 of products, quotients, or sums on both sides. Inequalities
22793 change sign if a negative multiplicative factor is cancelled.
22794 Non-constant multiplicative factors as in @expr{a b = a c} are
22795 cancelled from equations only if they are provably nonzero (generally
22796 because they were declared so; @pxref{Declarations}). Factors
22797 are cancelled from inequalities only if they are nonzero and their
22798 sign is known.
22799
22800 Simplification also replaces an equation or inequality with
22801 1 or 0 (``true'' or ``false'') if it can through the use of
22802 declarations. If @expr{x} is declared to be an integer greater
22803 than 5, then @expr{x < 3}, @expr{x = 3}, and @expr{x = 7.5} are
22804 all simplified to 0, but @expr{x > 3} is simplified to 1.
22805 By a similar analysis, @expr{abs(x) >= 0} is simplified to 1,
22806 as is @expr{x^2 >= 0} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22807
22808 @node Unsafe Simplifications, Simplification of Units, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22809 @subsection ``Unsafe'' Simplifications
22810
22811 @noindent
22812 @cindex Unsafe simplifications
22813 @cindex Extended simplification
22814 @kindex a e
22815 @pindex calc-simplify-extended
22816 @ignore
22817 @mindex esimpl@idots
22818 @end ignore
22819 @tindex esimplify
22820 The @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) [@code{esimplify}] command
22821 is like @kbd{a s}
22822 except that it applies some additional simplifications which are not
22823 ``safe'' in all cases. Use this only if you know the values in your
22824 formula lie in the restricted ranges for which these simplifications
22825 are valid. The symbolic integrator uses @kbd{a e};
22826 one effect of this is that the integrator's results must be used with
22827 caution. Where an integral table will often attach conditions like
22828 ``for positive @expr{a} only,'' Calc (like most other symbolic
22829 integration programs) will simply produce an unqualified result.
22830
22831 Because @kbd{a e}'s simplifications are unsafe, it is sometimes better
22832 to type @kbd{C-u -3 a v}, which does extended simplification only
22833 on the top level of the formula without affecting the sub-formulas.
22834 In fact, @kbd{C-u -3 j v} allows you to target extended simplification
22835 to any specific part of a formula.
22836
22837 The variable @code{ExtSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
22838 the @kbd{a e} command. These are applied in addition to
22839 @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. (The @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
22840 step described above is simply followed by an @kbd{a r ExtSimpRules} step.)
22841
22842 Following is a complete list of ``unsafe'' simplifications performed
22843 by @kbd{a e}.
22844
22845 @tex
22846 \bigskip
22847 @end tex
22848
22849 Inverse trigonometric or hyperbolic functions, called with their
22850 corresponding non-inverse functions as arguments, are simplified
22851 by @kbd{a e}. For example, @expr{@t{arcsin}(@t{sin}(x))} changes
22852 to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@t{arcsin}(@t{cos}(x))} and
22853 @expr{@t{arccos}(@t{sin}(x))} both change to @expr{@t{pi}/2 - x}.
22854 These simplifications are unsafe because they are valid only for
22855 values of @expr{x} in a certain range; outside that range, values
22856 are folded down to the 360-degree range that the inverse trigonometric
22857 functions always produce.
22858
22859 Powers of powers @expr{(x^a)^b} are simplified to
22860 @texline @math{x^{a b}}
22861 @infoline @expr{x^(a b)}
22862 for all @expr{a} and @expr{b}. These results will be valid only
22863 in a restricted range of @expr{x}; for example, in
22864 @texline @math{(x^2)^{1:2}}
22865 @infoline @expr{(x^2)^1:2}
22866 the powers cancel to get @expr{x}, which is valid for positive values
22867 of @expr{x} but not for negative or complex values.
22868
22869 Similarly, @expr{@t{sqrt}(x^a)} and @expr{@t{sqrt}(x)^a} are both
22870 simplified (possibly unsafely) to
22871 @texline @math{x^{a/2}}.
22872 @infoline @expr{x^(a/2)}.
22873
22874 Forms like @expr{@t{sqrt}(1 - sin(x)^2)} are simplified to, e.g.,
22875 @expr{@t{cos}(x)}. Calc has identities of this sort for @code{sin},
22876 @code{cos}, @code{tan}, @code{sinh}, and @code{cosh}.
22877
22878 Arguments of square roots are partially factored to look for
22879 squared terms that can be extracted. For example,
22880 @expr{@t{sqrt}(a^2 b^3 + a^3 b^2)} simplifies to
22881 @expr{a b @t{sqrt}(a+b)}.
22882
22883 The simplifications of @expr{@t{ln}(@t{exp}(x))},
22884 @expr{@t{ln}(@t{e}^x)}, and @expr{@t{log10}(10^x)} to @expr{x} are also
22885 unsafe because of problems with principal values (although these
22886 simplifications are safe if @expr{x} is known to be real).
22887
22888 Common factors are cancelled from products on both sides of an
22889 equation, even if those factors may be zero: @expr{a x / b x}
22890 to @expr{a / b}. Such factors are never cancelled from
22891 inequalities: Even @kbd{a e} is not bold enough to reduce
22892 @expr{a x < b x} to @expr{a < b} (or @expr{a > b}, depending
22893 on whether you believe @expr{x} is positive or negative).
22894 The @kbd{a M /} command can be used to divide a factor out of
22895 both sides of an inequality.
22896
22897 @node Simplification of Units, , Unsafe Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22898 @subsection Simplification of Units
22899
22900 @noindent
22901 The simplifications described in this section are applied by the
22902 @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command. These are in addition
22903 to the regular @kbd{a s} (but not @kbd{a e}) simplifications described
22904 earlier. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
22905
22906 The variable @code{UnitSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
22907 the @kbd{u s} command. These are applied in addition to @code{EvalRules}
22908 and @code{AlgSimpRules}.
22909
22910 Scalar mode is automatically put into effect when simplifying units.
22911 @xref{Matrix Mode}.
22912
22913 Sums @expr{a + b} involving units are simplified by extracting the
22914 units of @expr{a} as if by the @kbd{u x} command (call the result
22915 @expr{u_a}), then simplifying the expression @expr{b / u_a}
22916 using @kbd{u b} and @kbd{u s}. If the result has units then the sum
22917 is inconsistent and is left alone. Otherwise, it is rewritten
22918 in terms of the units @expr{u_a}.
22919
22920 If units auto-ranging mode is enabled, products or quotients in
22921 which the first argument is a number which is out of range for the
22922 leading unit are modified accordingly.
22923
22924 When cancelling and combining units in products and quotients,
22925 Calc accounts for unit names that differ only in the prefix letter.
22926 For example, @samp{2 km m} is simplified to @samp{2000 m^2}.
22927 However, compatible but different units like @code{ft} and @code{in}
22928 are not combined in this way.
22929
22930 Quotients @expr{a / b} are simplified in three additional ways. First,
22931 if @expr{b} is a number or a product beginning with a number, Calc
22932 computes the reciprocal of this number and moves it to the numerator.
22933
22934 Second, for each pair of unit names from the numerator and denominator
22935 of a quotient, if the units are compatible (e.g., they are both
22936 units of area) then they are replaced by the ratio between those
22937 units. For example, in @samp{3 s in N / kg cm} the units
22938 @samp{in / cm} will be replaced by @expr{2.54}.
22939
22940 Third, if the units in the quotient exactly cancel out, so that
22941 a @kbd{u b} command on the quotient would produce a dimensionless
22942 number for an answer, then the quotient simplifies to that number.
22943
22944 For powers and square roots, the ``unsafe'' simplifications
22945 @expr{(a b)^c} to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c} to @expr{a^c / b^c},
22946 and @expr{(a^b)^c} to
22947 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
22948 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22949 are done if the powers are real numbers. (These are safe in the context
22950 of units because all numbers involved can reasonably be assumed to be
22951 real.)
22952
22953 Also, if a unit name is raised to a fractional power, and the
22954 base units in that unit name all occur to powers which are a
22955 multiple of the denominator of the power, then the unit name
22956 is expanded out into its base units, which can then be simplified
22957 according to the previous paragraph. For example, @samp{acre^1.5}
22958 is simplified by noting that @expr{1.5 = 3:2}, that @samp{acre}
22959 is defined in terms of @samp{m^2}, and that the 2 in the power of
22960 @code{m} is a multiple of 2 in @expr{3:2}. Thus, @code{acre^1.5} is
22961 replaced by approximately
22962 @texline @math{(4046 m^2)^{1.5}}
22963 @infoline @expr{(4046 m^2)^1.5},
22964 which is then changed to
22965 @texline @math{4046^{1.5} \, (m^2)^{1.5}},
22966 @infoline @expr{4046^1.5 (m^2)^1.5},
22967 then to @expr{257440 m^3}.
22968
22969 The functions @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{clean}, @code{abs},
22970 as well as @code{floor} and the other integer truncation functions,
22971 applied to unit names or products or quotients involving units, are
22972 simplified. For example, @samp{round(1.6 in)} is changed to
22973 @samp{round(1.6) round(in)}; the lefthand term evaluates to 2,
22974 and the righthand term simplifies to @code{in}.
22975
22976 The functions @code{sin}, @code{cos}, and @code{tan} with arguments
22977 that have angular units like @code{rad} or @code{arcmin} are
22978 simplified by converting to base units (radians), then evaluating
22979 with the angular mode temporarily set to radians.
22980
22981 @node Polynomials, Calculus, Simplifying Formulas, Algebra
22982 @section Polynomials
22983
22984 A @dfn{polynomial} is a sum of terms which are coefficients times
22985 various powers of a ``base'' variable. For example, @expr{2 x^2 + 3 x - 4}
22986 is a polynomial in @expr{x}. Some formulas can be considered
22987 polynomials in several different variables: @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2}
22988 is a polynomial in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}. Polynomial coefficients
22989 are often numbers, but they may in general be any formulas not
22990 involving the base variable.
22991
22992 @kindex a f
22993 @pindex calc-factor
22994 @tindex factor
22995 The @kbd{a f} (@code{calc-factor}) [@code{factor}] command factors a
22996 polynomial into a product of terms. For example, the polynomial
22997 @expr{x^3 + 2 x^2 + x} is factored into @samp{x*(x+1)^2}. As another
22998 example, @expr{a c + b d + b c + a d} is factored into the product
22999 @expr{(a + b) (c + d)}.
23000
23001 Calc currently has three algorithms for factoring. Formulas which are
23002 linear in several variables, such as the second example above, are
23003 merged according to the distributive law. Formulas which are
23004 polynomials in a single variable, with constant integer or fractional
23005 coefficients, are factored into irreducible linear and/or quadratic
23006 terms. The first example above factors into three linear terms
23007 (@expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, and @expr{x+1} again). Finally, formulas
23008 which do not fit the above criteria are handled by the algebraic
23009 rewrite mechanism.
23010
23011 Calc's polynomial factorization algorithm works by using the general
23012 root-finding command (@w{@kbd{a P}}) to solve for the roots of the
23013 polynomial. It then looks for roots which are rational numbers
23014 or complex-conjugate pairs, and converts these into linear and
23015 quadratic terms, respectively. Because it uses floating-point
23016 arithmetic, it may be unable to find terms that involve large
23017 integers (whose number of digits approaches the current precision).
23018 Also, irreducible factors of degree higher than quadratic are not
23019 found, and polynomials in more than one variable are not treated.
23020 (A more robust factorization algorithm may be included in a future
23021 version of Calc.)
23022
23023 @vindex FactorRules
23024 @ignore
23025 @starindex
23026 @end ignore
23027 @tindex thecoefs
23028 @ignore
23029 @starindex
23030 @end ignore
23031 @ignore
23032 @mindex @idots
23033 @end ignore
23034 @tindex thefactors
23035 The rewrite-based factorization method uses rules stored in the variable
23036 @code{FactorRules}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of the
23037 operation of rewrite rules. The default @code{FactorRules} are able
23038 to factor quadratic forms symbolically into two linear terms,
23039 @expr{(a x + b) (c x + d)}. You can edit these rules to include other
23040 cases if you wish. To use the rules, Calc builds the formula
23041 @samp{thecoefs(x, [a, b, c, ...])} where @code{x} is the polynomial
23042 base variable and @code{a}, @code{b}, etc., are polynomial coefficients
23043 (which may be numbers or formulas). The constant term is written first,
23044 i.e., in the @code{a} position. When the rules complete, they should have
23045 changed the formula into the form @samp{thefactors(x, [f1, f2, f3, ...])}
23046 where each @code{fi} should be a factored term, e.g., @samp{x - ai}.
23047 Calc then multiplies these terms together to get the complete
23048 factored form of the polynomial. If the rules do not change the
23049 @code{thecoefs} call to a @code{thefactors} call, @kbd{a f} leaves the
23050 polynomial alone on the assumption that it is unfactorable. (Note that
23051 the function names @code{thecoefs} and @code{thefactors} are used only
23052 as placeholders; there are no actual Calc functions by those names.)
23053
23054 @kindex H a f
23055 @tindex factors
23056 The @kbd{H a f} [@code{factors}] command also factors a polynomial,
23057 but it returns a list of factors instead of an expression which is the
23058 product of the factors. Each factor is represented by a sub-vector
23059 of the factor, and the power with which it appears. For example,
23060 @expr{x^5 + x^4 - 33 x^3 + 63 x^2} factors to @expr{(x + 7) x^2 (x - 3)^2}
23061 in @kbd{a f}, or to @expr{[ [x, 2], [x+7, 1], [x-3, 2] ]} in @kbd{H a f}.
23062 If there is an overall numeric factor, it always comes first in the list.
23063 The functions @code{factor} and @code{factors} allow a second argument
23064 when written in algebraic form; @samp{factor(x,v)} factors @expr{x} with
23065 respect to the specific variable @expr{v}. The default is to factor with
23066 respect to all the variables that appear in @expr{x}.
23067
23068 @kindex a c
23069 @pindex calc-collect
23070 @tindex collect
23071 The @kbd{a c} (@code{calc-collect}) [@code{collect}] command rearranges a
23072 formula as a
23073 polynomial in a given variable, ordered in decreasing powers of that
23074 variable. For example, given @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2} on
23075 the stack, @kbd{a c x} would produce @expr{(2 + 4 y^2) x + (1 + 3 y)},
23076 and @kbd{a c y} would produce @expr{(4 x) y^2 + 3 y + (1 + 2 x)}.
23077 The polynomial will be expanded out using the distributive law as
23078 necessary: Collecting @expr{x} in @expr{(x - 1)^3} produces
23079 @expr{x^3 - 3 x^2 + 3 x - 1}. Terms not involving @expr{x} will
23080 not be expanded.
23081
23082 The ``variable'' you specify at the prompt can actually be any
23083 expression: @kbd{a c ln(x+1)} will collect together all terms multiplied
23084 by @samp{ln(x+1)} or integer powers thereof. If @samp{x} also appears
23085 in the formula in a context other than @samp{ln(x+1)}, @kbd{a c} will
23086 treat those occurrences as unrelated to @samp{ln(x+1)}, i.e., as constants.
23087
23088 @kindex a x
23089 @pindex calc-expand
23090 @tindex expand
23091 The @kbd{a x} (@code{calc-expand}) [@code{expand}] command expands an
23092 expression by applying the distributive law everywhere. It applies to
23093 products, quotients, and powers involving sums. By default, it fully
23094 distributes all parts of the expression. With a numeric prefix argument,
23095 the distributive law is applied only the specified number of times, then
23096 the partially expanded expression is left on the stack.
23097
23098 The @kbd{a x} and @kbd{j D} commands are somewhat redundant. Use
23099 @kbd{a x} if you want to expand all products of sums in your formula.
23100 Use @kbd{j D} if you want to expand a particular specified term of
23101 the formula. There is an exactly analogous correspondence between
23102 @kbd{a f} and @kbd{j M}. (The @kbd{j D} and @kbd{j M} commands
23103 also know many other kinds of expansions, such as
23104 @samp{exp(a + b) = exp(a) exp(b)}, which @kbd{a x} and @kbd{a f}
23105 do not do.)
23106
23107 Calc's automatic simplifications will sometimes reverse a partial
23108 expansion. For example, the first step in expanding @expr{(x+1)^3} is
23109 to write @expr{(x+1) (x+1)^2}. If @kbd{a x} stops there and tries
23110 to put this formula onto the stack, though, Calc will automatically
23111 simplify it back to @expr{(x+1)^3} form. The solution is to turn
23112 simplification off first (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), or to run
23113 @kbd{a x} without a numeric prefix argument so that it expands all
23114 the way in one step.
23115
23116 @kindex a a
23117 @pindex calc-apart
23118 @tindex apart
23119 The @kbd{a a} (@code{calc-apart}) [@code{apart}] command expands a
23120 rational function by partial fractions. A rational function is the
23121 quotient of two polynomials; @code{apart} pulls this apart into a
23122 sum of rational functions with simple denominators. In algebraic
23123 notation, the @code{apart} function allows a second argument that
23124 specifies which variable to use as the ``base''; by default, Calc
23125 chooses the base variable automatically.
23126
23127 @kindex a n
23128 @pindex calc-normalize-rat
23129 @tindex nrat
23130 The @kbd{a n} (@code{calc-normalize-rat}) [@code{nrat}] command
23131 attempts to arrange a formula into a quotient of two polynomials.
23132 For example, given @expr{1 + (a + b/c) / d}, the result would be
23133 @expr{(b + a c + c d) / c d}. The quotient is reduced, so that
23134 @kbd{a n} will simplify @expr{(x^2 + 2x + 1) / (x^2 - 1)} by dividing
23135 out the common factor @expr{x + 1}, yielding @expr{(x + 1) / (x - 1)}.
23136
23137 @kindex a \
23138 @pindex calc-poly-div
23139 @tindex pdiv
23140 The @kbd{a \} (@code{calc-poly-div}) [@code{pdiv}] command divides
23141 two polynomials @expr{u} and @expr{v}, yielding a new polynomial
23142 @expr{q}. If several variables occur in the inputs, the inputs are
23143 considered multivariate polynomials. (Calc divides by the variable
23144 with the largest power in @expr{u} first, or, in the case of equal
23145 powers, chooses the variables in alphabetical order.) For example,
23146 dividing @expr{x^2 + 3 x + 2} by @expr{x + 2} yields @expr{x + 1}.
23147 The remainder from the division, if any, is reported at the bottom
23148 of the screen and is also placed in the Trail along with the quotient.
23149
23150 Using @code{pdiv} in algebraic notation, you can specify the particular
23151 variable to be used as the base: @code{pdiv(@var{a},@var{b},@var{x})}.
23152 If @code{pdiv} is given only two arguments (as is always the case with
23153 the @kbd{a \} command), then it does a multivariate division as outlined
23154 above.
23155
23156 @kindex a %
23157 @pindex calc-poly-rem
23158 @tindex prem
23159 The @kbd{a %} (@code{calc-poly-rem}) [@code{prem}] command divides
23160 two polynomials and keeps the remainder @expr{r}. The quotient
23161 @expr{q} is discarded. For any formulas @expr{a} and @expr{b}, the
23162 results of @kbd{a \} and @kbd{a %} satisfy @expr{a = q b + r}.
23163 (This is analogous to plain @kbd{\} and @kbd{%}, which compute the
23164 integer quotient and remainder from dividing two numbers.)
23165
23166 @kindex a /
23167 @kindex H a /
23168 @pindex calc-poly-div-rem
23169 @tindex pdivrem
23170 @tindex pdivide
23171 The @kbd{a /} (@code{calc-poly-div-rem}) [@code{pdivrem}] command
23172 divides two polynomials and reports both the quotient and the
23173 remainder as a vector @expr{[q, r]}. The @kbd{H a /} [@code{pdivide}]
23174 command divides two polynomials and constructs the formula
23175 @expr{q + r/b} on the stack. (Naturally if the remainder is zero,
23176 this will immediately simplify to @expr{q}.)
23177
23178 @kindex a g
23179 @pindex calc-poly-gcd
23180 @tindex pgcd
23181 The @kbd{a g} (@code{calc-poly-gcd}) [@code{pgcd}] command computes
23182 the greatest common divisor of two polynomials. (The GCD actually
23183 is unique only to within a constant multiplier; Calc attempts to
23184 choose a GCD which will be unsurprising.) For example, the @kbd{a n}
23185 command uses @kbd{a g} to take the GCD of the numerator and denominator
23186 of a quotient, then divides each by the result using @kbd{a \}. (The
23187 definition of GCD ensures that this division can take place without
23188 leaving a remainder.)
23189
23190 While the polynomials used in operations like @kbd{a /} and @kbd{a g}
23191 often have integer coefficients, this is not required. Calc can also
23192 deal with polynomials over the rationals or floating-point reals.
23193 Polynomials with modulo-form coefficients are also useful in many
23194 applications; if you enter @samp{(x^2 + 3 x - 1) mod 5}, Calc
23195 automatically transforms this into a polynomial over the field of
23196 integers mod 5: @samp{(1 mod 5) x^2 + (3 mod 5) x + (4 mod 5)}.
23197
23198 Congratulations and thanks go to Ove Ewerlid
23199 (@code{ewerlid@@mizar.DoCS.UU.SE}), who contributed many of the
23200 polynomial routines used in the above commands.
23201
23202 @xref{Decomposing Polynomials}, for several useful functions for
23203 extracting the individual coefficients of a polynomial.
23204
23205 @node Calculus, Solving Equations, Polynomials, Algebra
23206 @section Calculus
23207
23208 @noindent
23209 The following calculus commands do not automatically simplify their
23210 inputs or outputs using @code{calc-simplify}. You may find it helps
23211 to do this by hand by typing @kbd{a s} or @kbd{a e}. It may also help
23212 to use @kbd{a x} and/or @kbd{a c} to arrange a result in the most
23213 readable way.
23214
23215 @menu
23216 * Differentiation::
23217 * Integration::
23218 * Customizing the Integrator::
23219 * Numerical Integration::
23220 * Taylor Series::
23221 @end menu
23222
23223 @node Differentiation, Integration, Calculus, Calculus
23224 @subsection Differentiation
23225
23226 @noindent
23227 @kindex a d
23228 @kindex H a d
23229 @pindex calc-derivative
23230 @tindex deriv
23231 @tindex tderiv
23232 The @kbd{a d} (@code{calc-derivative}) [@code{deriv}] command computes
23233 the derivative of the expression on the top of the stack with respect to
23234 some variable, which it will prompt you to enter. Normally, variables
23235 in the formula other than the specified differentiation variable are
23236 considered constant, i.e., @samp{deriv(y,x)} is reduced to zero. With
23237 the Hyperbolic flag, the @code{tderiv} (total derivative) operation is used
23238 instead, in which derivatives of variables are not reduced to zero
23239 unless those variables are known to be ``constant,'' i.e., independent
23240 of any other variables. (The built-in special variables like @code{pi}
23241 are considered constant, as are variables that have been declared
23242 @code{const}; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23243
23244 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, this command computes the
23245 @var{n}th derivative.
23246
23247 When working with trigonometric functions, it is best to switch to
23248 Radians mode first (with @w{@kbd{m r}}). The derivative of @samp{sin(x)}
23249 in degrees is @samp{(pi/180) cos(x)}, probably not the expected
23250 answer!
23251
23252 If you use the @code{deriv} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23253 you can write @samp{deriv(f,x,x0)} which represents the derivative
23254 of @expr{f} with respect to @expr{x}, evaluated at the point
23255 @texline @math{x=x_0}.
23256 @infoline @expr{x=x0}.
23257
23258 If the formula being differentiated contains functions which Calc does
23259 not know, the derivatives of those functions are produced by adding
23260 primes (apostrophe characters). For example, @samp{deriv(f(2x), x)}
23261 produces @samp{2 f'(2 x)}, where the function @code{f'} represents the
23262 derivative of @code{f}.
23263
23264 For functions you have defined with the @kbd{Z F} command, Calc expands
23265 the functions according to their defining formulas unless you have
23266 also defined @code{f'} suitably. For example, suppose we define
23267 @samp{sinc(x) = sin(x)/x} using @kbd{Z F}. If we then differentiate
23268 the formula @samp{sinc(2 x)}, the formula will be expanded to
23269 @samp{sin(2 x) / (2 x)} and differentiated. However, if we also
23270 define @samp{sinc'(x) = dsinc(x)}, say, then Calc will write the
23271 result as @samp{2 dsinc(2 x)}. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
23272
23273 For multi-argument functions @samp{f(x,y,z)}, the derivative with respect
23274 to the first argument is written @samp{f'(x,y,z)}; derivatives with
23275 respect to the other arguments are @samp{f'2(x,y,z)} and @samp{f'3(x,y,z)}.
23276 Various higher-order derivatives can be formed in the obvious way, e.g.,
23277 @samp{f'@var{}'(x)} (the second derivative of @code{f}) or
23278 @samp{f'@var{}'2'3(x,y,z)} (@code{f} differentiated with respect to each
23279 argument once).
23280
23281 @node Integration, Customizing the Integrator, Differentiation, Calculus
23282 @subsection Integration
23283
23284 @noindent
23285 @kindex a i
23286 @pindex calc-integral
23287 @tindex integ
23288 The @kbd{a i} (@code{calc-integral}) [@code{integ}] command computes the
23289 indefinite integral of the expression on the top of the stack with
23290 respect to a variable. The integrator is not guaranteed to work for
23291 all integrable functions, but it is able to integrate several large
23292 classes of formulas. In particular, any polynomial or rational function
23293 (a polynomial divided by a polynomial) is acceptable. (Rational functions
23294 don't have to be in explicit quotient form, however;
23295 @texline @math{x/(1+x^{-2})}
23296 @infoline @expr{x/(1+x^-2)}
23297 is not strictly a quotient of polynomials, but it is equivalent to
23298 @expr{x^3/(x^2+1)}, which is.) Also, square roots of terms involving
23299 @expr{x} and @expr{x^2} may appear in rational functions being
23300 integrated. Finally, rational functions involving trigonometric or
23301 hyperbolic functions can be integrated.
23302
23303 @ifinfo
23304 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23305 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23306 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23307 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23308 integral from @code{a} to @code{b}.
23309 @end ifinfo
23310 @tex
23311 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23312 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23313 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23314 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23315 integral $\int_a^b f(x) \, dx$.
23316 @end tex
23317
23318 Please note that the current implementation of Calc's integrator sometimes
23319 produces results that are significantly more complex than they need to
23320 be. For example, the integral Calc finds for
23321 @texline @math{1/(x+\sqrt{x^2+1})}
23322 @infoline @expr{1/(x+sqrt(x^2+1))}
23323 is several times more complicated than the answer Mathematica
23324 returns for the same input, although the two forms are numerically
23325 equivalent. Also, any indefinite integral should be considered to have
23326 an arbitrary constant of integration added to it, although Calc does not
23327 write an explicit constant of integration in its result. For example,
23328 Calc's solution for
23329 @texline @math{1/(1+\tan x)}
23330 @infoline @expr{1/(1+tan(x))}
23331 differs from the solution given in the @emph{CRC Math Tables} by a
23332 constant factor of
23333 @texline @math{\pi i / 2}
23334 @infoline @expr{pi i / 2},
23335 due to a different choice of constant of integration.
23336
23337 The Calculator remembers all the integrals it has done. If conditions
23338 change in a way that would invalidate the old integrals, say, a switch
23339 from Degrees to Radians mode, then they will be thrown out. If you
23340 suspect this is not happening when it should, use the
23341 @code{calc-flush-caches} command; @pxref{Caches}.
23342
23343 @vindex IntegLimit
23344 Calc normally will pursue integration by substitution or integration by
23345 parts up to 3 nested times before abandoning an approach as fruitless.
23346 If the integrator is taking too long, you can lower this limit by storing
23347 a number (like 2) in the variable @code{IntegLimit}. (The @kbd{s I}
23348 command is a convenient way to edit @code{IntegLimit}.) If this variable
23349 has no stored value or does not contain a nonnegative integer, a limit
23350 of 3 is used. The lower this limit is, the greater the chance that Calc
23351 will be unable to integrate a function it could otherwise handle. Raising
23352 this limit allows the Calculator to solve more integrals, though the time
23353 it takes may grow exponentially. You can monitor the integrator's actions
23354 by creating an Emacs buffer called @code{*Trace*}. If such a buffer
23355 exists, the @kbd{a i} command will write a log of its actions there.
23356
23357 If you want to manipulate integrals in a purely symbolic way, you can
23358 set the integration nesting limit to 0 to prevent all but fast
23359 table-lookup solutions of integrals. You might then wish to define
23360 rewrite rules for integration by parts, various kinds of substitutions,
23361 and so on. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
23362
23363 @node Customizing the Integrator, Numerical Integration, Integration, Calculus
23364 @subsection Customizing the Integrator
23365
23366 @noindent
23367 @vindex IntegRules
23368 Calc has two built-in rewrite rules called @code{IntegRules} and
23369 @code{IntegAfterRules} which you can edit to define new integration
23370 methods. @xref{Rewrite Rules}. At each step of the integration process,
23371 Calc wraps the current integrand in a call to the fictitious function
23372 @samp{integtry(@var{expr},@var{var})}, where @var{expr} is the
23373 integrand and @var{var} is the integration variable. If your rules
23374 rewrite this to be a plain formula (not a call to @code{integtry}), then
23375 Calc will use this formula as the integral of @var{expr}. For example,
23376 the rule @samp{integtry(mysin(x),x) := -mycos(x)} would define a rule to
23377 integrate a function @code{mysin} that acts like the sine function.
23378 Then, putting @samp{4 mysin(2y+1)} on the stack and typing @kbd{a i y}
23379 will produce the integral @samp{-2 mycos(2y+1)}. Note that Calc has
23380 automatically made various transformations on the integral to allow it
23381 to use your rule; integral tables generally give rules for
23382 @samp{mysin(a x + b)}, but you don't need to use this much generality
23383 in your @code{IntegRules}.
23384
23385 @cindex Exponential integral Ei(x)
23386 @ignore
23387 @starindex
23388 @end ignore
23389 @tindex Ei
23390 As a more serious example, the expression @samp{exp(x)/x} cannot be
23391 integrated in terms of the standard functions, so the ``exponential
23392 integral'' function
23393 @texline @math{{\rm Ei}(x)}
23394 @infoline @expr{Ei(x)}
23395 was invented to describe it.
23396 We can get Calc to do this integral in terms of a made-up @code{Ei}
23397 function by adding the rule @samp{[integtry(exp(x)/x, x) := Ei(x)]}
23398 to @code{IntegRules}. Now entering @samp{exp(2x)/x} on the stack
23399 and typing @kbd{a i x} yields @samp{Ei(2 x)}. This new rule will
23400 work with Calc's various built-in integration methods (such as
23401 integration by substitution) to solve a variety of other problems
23402 involving @code{Ei}: For example, now Calc will also be able to
23403 integrate @samp{exp(exp(x))} and @samp{ln(ln(x))} (to get @samp{Ei(exp(x))}
23404 and @samp{x ln(ln(x)) - Ei(ln(x))}, respectively).
23405
23406 Your rule may do further integration by calling @code{integ}. For
23407 example, @samp{integtry(twice(u),x) := twice(integ(u))} allows Calc
23408 to integrate @samp{twice(sin(x))} to get @samp{twice(-cos(x))}.
23409 Note that @code{integ} was called with only one argument. This notation
23410 is allowed only within @code{IntegRules}; it means ``integrate this
23411 with respect to the same integration variable.'' If Calc is unable
23412 to integrate @code{u}, the integration that invoked @code{IntegRules}
23413 also fails. Thus integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} fails, returning the
23414 unevaluated integral @samp{integ(twice(f(x)), x)}. It is still legal
23415 to call @code{integ} with two or more arguments, however; in this case,
23416 if @code{u} is not integrable, @code{twice} itself will still be
23417 integrated: If the above rule is changed to @samp{... := twice(integ(u,x))},
23418 then integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} will yield @samp{twice(integ(f(x),x))}.
23419
23420 If a rule instead produces the formula @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr},
23421 @var{svar})}, either replacing the top-level @code{integtry} call or
23422 nested anywhere inside the expression, then Calc will apply the
23423 substitution @samp{@var{u} = @var{sexpr}(@var{svar})} to try to
23424 integrate the original @var{expr}. For example, the rule
23425 @samp{sqrt(a) := integsubst(sqrt(x),x)} says that if Calc ever finds
23426 a square root in the integrand, it should attempt the substitution
23427 @samp{u = sqrt(x)}. (This particular rule is unnecessary because
23428 Calc always tries ``obvious'' substitutions where @var{sexpr} actually
23429 appears in the integrand.) The variable @var{svar} may be the same
23430 as the @var{var} that appeared in the call to @code{integtry}, but
23431 it need not be.
23432
23433 When integrating according to an @code{integsubst}, Calc uses the
23434 equation solver to find the inverse of @var{sexpr} (if the integrand
23435 refers to @var{var} anywhere except in subexpressions that exactly
23436 match @var{sexpr}). It uses the differentiator to find the derivative
23437 of @var{sexpr} and/or its inverse (it has two methods that use one
23438 derivative or the other). You can also specify these items by adding
23439 extra arguments to the @code{integsubst} your rules construct; the
23440 general form is @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr}, @var{svar}, @var{sinv},
23441 @var{sprime})}, where @var{sinv} is the inverse of @var{sexpr} (still
23442 written as a function of @var{svar}), and @var{sprime} is the
23443 derivative of @var{sexpr} with respect to @var{svar}. If you don't
23444 specify these things, and Calc is not able to work them out on its
23445 own with the information it knows, then your substitution rule will
23446 work only in very specific, simple cases.
23447
23448 Calc applies @code{IntegRules} as if by @kbd{C-u 1 a r IntegRules};
23449 in other words, Calc stops rewriting as soon as any rule in your rule
23450 set succeeds. (If it weren't for this, the @samp{integsubst(sqrt(x),x)}
23451 example above would keep on adding layers of @code{integsubst} calls
23452 forever!)
23453
23454 @vindex IntegSimpRules
23455 Another set of rules, stored in @code{IntegSimpRules}, are applied
23456 every time the integrator uses @kbd{a s} to simplify an intermediate
23457 result. For example, putting the rule @samp{twice(x) := 2 x} into
23458 @code{IntegSimpRules} would tell Calc to convert the @code{twice}
23459 function into a form it knows whenever integration is attempted.
23460
23461 One more way to influence the integrator is to define a function with
23462 the @kbd{Z F} command (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}). Calc's
23463 integrator automatically expands such functions according to their
23464 defining formulas, even if you originally asked for the function to
23465 be left unevaluated for symbolic arguments. (Certain other Calc
23466 systems, such as the differentiator and the equation solver, also
23467 do this.)
23468
23469 @vindex IntegAfterRules
23470 Sometimes Calc is able to find a solution to your integral, but it
23471 expresses the result in a way that is unnecessarily complicated. If
23472 this happens, you can either use @code{integsubst} as described
23473 above to try to hint at a more direct path to the desired result, or
23474 you can use @code{IntegAfterRules}. This is an extra rule set that
23475 runs after the main integrator returns its result; basically, Calc does
23476 an @kbd{a r IntegAfterRules} on the result before showing it to you.
23477 (It also does an @kbd{a s}, without @code{IntegSimpRules}, after that
23478 to further simplify the result.) For example, Calc's integrator
23479 sometimes produces expressions of the form @samp{ln(1+x) - ln(1-x)};
23480 the default @code{IntegAfterRules} rewrite this into the more readable
23481 form @samp{2 arctanh(x)}. Note that, unlike @code{IntegRules},
23482 @code{IntegSimpRules} and @code{IntegAfterRules} are applied any number
23483 of times until no further changes are possible. Rewriting by
23484 @code{IntegAfterRules} occurs only after the main integrator has
23485 finished, not at every step as for @code{IntegRules} and
23486 @code{IntegSimpRules}.
23487
23488 @node Numerical Integration, Taylor Series, Customizing the Integrator, Calculus
23489 @subsection Numerical Integration
23490
23491 @noindent
23492 @kindex a I
23493 @pindex calc-num-integral
23494 @tindex ninteg
23495 If you want a purely numerical answer to an integration problem, you can
23496 use the @kbd{a I} (@code{calc-num-integral}) [@code{ninteg}] command. This
23497 command prompts for an integration variable, a lower limit, and an
23498 upper limit. Except for the integration variable, all other variables
23499 that appear in the integrand formula must have stored values. (A stored
23500 value, if any, for the integration variable itself is ignored.)
23501
23502 Numerical integration works by evaluating your formula at many points in
23503 the specified interval. Calc uses an ``open Romberg'' method; this means
23504 that it does not evaluate the formula actually at the endpoints (so that
23505 it is safe to integrate @samp{sin(x)/x} from zero, for example). Also,
23506 the Romberg method works especially well when the function being
23507 integrated is fairly smooth. If the function is not smooth, Calc will
23508 have to evaluate it at quite a few points before it can accurately
23509 determine the value of the integral.
23510
23511 Integration is much faster when the current precision is small. It is
23512 best to set the precision to the smallest acceptable number of digits
23513 before you use @kbd{a I}. If Calc appears to be taking too long, press
23514 @kbd{C-g} to halt it and try a lower precision. If Calc still appears
23515 to need hundreds of evaluations, check to make sure your function is
23516 well-behaved in the specified interval.
23517
23518 It is possible for the lower integration limit to be @samp{-inf} (minus
23519 infinity). Likewise, the upper limit may be plus infinity. Calc
23520 internally transforms the integral into an equivalent one with finite
23521 limits. However, integration to or across singularities is not supported:
23522 The integral of @samp{1/sqrt(x)} from 0 to 1 exists (it can be found
23523 by Calc's symbolic integrator, for example), but @kbd{a I} will fail
23524 because the integrand goes to infinity at one of the endpoints.
23525
23526 @node Taylor Series, , Numerical Integration, Calculus
23527 @subsection Taylor Series
23528
23529 @noindent
23530 @kindex a t
23531 @pindex calc-taylor
23532 @tindex taylor
23533 The @kbd{a t} (@code{calc-taylor}) [@code{taylor}] command computes a
23534 power series expansion or Taylor series of a function. You specify the
23535 variable and the desired number of terms. You may give an expression of
23536 the form @samp{@var{var} = @var{a}} or @samp{@var{var} - @var{a}} instead
23537 of just a variable to produce a Taylor expansion about the point @var{a}.
23538 You may specify the number of terms with a numeric prefix argument;
23539 otherwise the command will prompt you for the number of terms. Note that
23540 many series expansions have coefficients of zero for some terms, so you
23541 may appear to get fewer terms than you asked for.
23542
23543 If the @kbd{a i} command is unable to find a symbolic integral for a
23544 function, you can get an approximation by integrating the function's
23545 Taylor series.
23546
23547 @node Solving Equations, Numerical Solutions, Calculus, Algebra
23548 @section Solving Equations
23549
23550 @noindent
23551 @kindex a S
23552 @pindex calc-solve-for
23553 @tindex solve
23554 @cindex Equations, solving
23555 @cindex Solving equations
23556 The @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) [@code{solve}] command rearranges
23557 an equation to solve for a specific variable. An equation is an
23558 expression of the form @expr{L = R}. For example, the command @kbd{a S x}
23559 will rearrange @expr{y = 3x + 6} to the form, @expr{x = y/3 - 2}. If the
23560 input is not an equation, it is treated like an equation of the
23561 form @expr{X = 0}.
23562
23563 This command also works for inequalities, as in @expr{y < 3x + 6}.
23564 Some inequalities cannot be solved where the analogous equation could
23565 be; for example, solving
23566 @texline @math{a < b \, c}
23567 @infoline @expr{a < b c}
23568 for @expr{b} is impossible
23569 without knowing the sign of @expr{c}. In this case, @kbd{a S} will
23570 produce the result
23571 @texline @math{b \mathbin{\hbox{\code{!=}}} a/c}
23572 @infoline @expr{b != a/c}
23573 (using the not-equal-to operator) to signify that the direction of the
23574 inequality is now unknown. The inequality
23575 @texline @math{a \le b \, c}
23576 @infoline @expr{a <= b c}
23577 is not even partially solved. @xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell
23578 Calc that the signs of the variables in a formula are in fact known.
23579
23580 Two useful commands for working with the result of @kbd{a S} are
23581 @kbd{a .} (@pxref{Logical Operations}), which converts @expr{x = y/3 - 2}
23582 to @expr{y/3 - 2}, and @kbd{s l} (@pxref{Let Command}) which evaluates
23583 another formula with @expr{x} set equal to @expr{y/3 - 2}.
23584
23585 @menu
23586 * Multiple Solutions::
23587 * Solving Systems of Equations::
23588 * Decomposing Polynomials::
23589 @end menu
23590
23591 @node Multiple Solutions, Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations, Solving Equations
23592 @subsection Multiple Solutions
23593
23594 @noindent
23595 @kindex H a S
23596 @tindex fsolve
23597 Some equations have more than one solution. The Hyperbolic flag
23598 (@code{H a S}) [@code{fsolve}] tells the solver to report the fully
23599 general family of solutions. It will invent variables @code{n1},
23600 @code{n2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary integers, and
23601 @code{s1}, @code{s2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary
23602 signs (either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}). If you don't use the Hyperbolic
23603 flag, Calc will use zero in place of all arbitrary integers, and plus
23604 one in place of all arbitrary signs. Note that variables like @code{n1}
23605 and @code{s1} are not given any special interpretation in Calc except by
23606 the equation solver itself. As usual, you can use the @w{@kbd{s l}}
23607 (@code{calc-let}) command to obtain solutions for various actual values
23608 of these variables.
23609
23610 For example, @kbd{' x^2 = y @key{RET} H a S x @key{RET}} solves to
23611 get @samp{x = s1 sqrt(y)}, indicating that the two solutions to the
23612 equation are @samp{sqrt(y)} and @samp{-sqrt(y)}. Another way to
23613 think about it is that the square-root operation is really a
23614 two-valued function; since every Calc function must return a
23615 single result, @code{sqrt} chooses to return the positive result.
23616 Then @kbd{H a S} doctors this result using @code{s1} to indicate
23617 the full set of possible values of the mathematical square-root.
23618
23619 There is a similar phenomenon going the other direction: Suppose
23620 we solve @samp{sqrt(y) = x} for @code{y}. Calc squares both sides
23621 to get @samp{y = x^2}. This is correct, except that it introduces
23622 some dubious solutions. Consider solving @samp{sqrt(y) = -3}:
23623 Calc will report @expr{y = 9} as a valid solution, which is true
23624 in the mathematical sense of square-root, but false (there is no
23625 solution) for the actual Calc positive-valued @code{sqrt}. This
23626 happens for both @kbd{a S} and @kbd{H a S}.
23627
23628 @cindex @code{GenCount} variable
23629 @vindex GenCount
23630 @ignore
23631 @starindex
23632 @end ignore
23633 @tindex an
23634 @ignore
23635 @starindex
23636 @end ignore
23637 @tindex as
23638 If you store a positive integer in the Calc variable @code{GenCount},
23639 then Calc will generate formulas of the form @samp{as(@var{n})} for
23640 arbitrary signs, and @samp{an(@var{n})} for arbitrary integers,
23641 where @var{n} represents successive values taken by incrementing
23642 @code{GenCount} by one. While the normal arbitrary sign and
23643 integer symbols start over at @code{s1} and @code{n1} with each
23644 new Calc command, the @code{GenCount} approach will give each
23645 arbitrary value a name that is unique throughout the entire Calc
23646 session. Also, the arbitrary values are function calls instead
23647 of variables, which is advantageous in some cases. For example,
23648 you can make a rewrite rule that recognizes all arbitrary signs
23649 using a pattern like @samp{as(n)}. The @kbd{s l} command only works
23650 on variables, but you can use the @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
23651 command to substitute actual values for function calls like @samp{as(3)}.
23652
23653 The @kbd{s G} (@code{calc-edit-GenCount}) command is a convenient
23654 way to create or edit this variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish.
23655
23656 If you have not stored a value in @code{GenCount}, or if the value
23657 in that variable is not a positive integer, the regular
23658 @code{s1}/@code{n1} notation is used.
23659
23660 @kindex I a S
23661 @kindex H I a S
23662 @tindex finv
23663 @tindex ffinv
23664 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a S} [@code{finv}] treats the expression
23665 on top of the stack as a function of the specified variable and solves
23666 to find the inverse function, written in terms of the same variable.
23667 For example, @kbd{I a S x} inverts @expr{2x + 6} to @expr{x/2 - 3}.
23668 You can use both Inverse and Hyperbolic [@code{ffinv}] to obtain a
23669 fully general inverse, as described above.
23670
23671 @kindex a P
23672 @pindex calc-poly-roots
23673 @tindex roots
23674 Some equations, specifically polynomials, have a known, finite number
23675 of solutions. The @kbd{a P} (@code{calc-poly-roots}) [@code{roots}]
23676 command uses @kbd{H a S} to solve an equation in general form, then, for
23677 all arbitrary-sign variables like @code{s1}, and all arbitrary-integer
23678 variables like @code{n1} for which @code{n1} only usefully varies over
23679 a finite range, it expands these variables out to all their possible
23680 values. The results are collected into a vector, which is returned.
23681 For example, @samp{roots(x^4 = 1, x)} returns the four solutions
23682 @samp{[1, -1, (0, 1), (0, -1)]}. Generally an @var{n}th degree
23683 polynomial will always have @var{n} roots on the complex plane.
23684 (If you have given a @code{real} declaration for the solution
23685 variable, then only the real-valued solutions, if any, will be
23686 reported; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23687
23688 Note that because @kbd{a P} uses @kbd{H a S}, it is able to deliver
23689 symbolic solutions if the polynomial has symbolic coefficients. Also
23690 note that Calc's solver is not able to get exact symbolic solutions
23691 to all polynomials. Polynomials containing powers up to @expr{x^4}
23692 can always be solved exactly; polynomials of higher degree sometimes
23693 can be: @expr{x^6 + x^3 + 1} is converted to @expr{(x^3)^2 + (x^3) + 1},
23694 which can be solved for @expr{x^3} using the quadratic equation, and then
23695 for @expr{x} by taking cube roots. But in many cases, like
23696 @expr{x^6 + x + 1}, Calc does not know how to rewrite the polynomial
23697 into a form it can solve. The @kbd{a P} command can still deliver a
23698 list of numerical roots, however, provided that Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s})
23699 is not turned on. (If you work with Symbolic mode on, recall that the
23700 @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) key is a handy way to reevaluate the
23701 formula on the stack with Symbolic mode temporarily off.) Naturally,
23702 @kbd{a P} can only provide numerical roots if the polynomial coefficients
23703 are all numbers (real or complex).
23704
23705 @node Solving Systems of Equations, Decomposing Polynomials, Multiple Solutions, Solving Equations
23706 @subsection Solving Systems of Equations
23707
23708 @noindent
23709 @cindex Systems of equations, symbolic
23710 You can also use the commands described above to solve systems of
23711 simultaneous equations. Just create a vector of equations, then
23712 specify a vector of variables for which to solve. (You can omit
23713 the surrounding brackets when entering the vector of variables
23714 at the prompt.)
23715
23716 For example, putting @samp{[x + y = a, x - y = b]} on the stack
23717 and typing @kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}} produces the vector of solutions
23718 @samp{[x = a - (a-b)/2, y = (a-b)/2]}. The result vector will
23719 have the same length as the variables vector, and the variables
23720 will be listed in the same order there. Note that the solutions
23721 are not always simplified as far as possible; the solution for
23722 @expr{x} here could be improved by an application of the @kbd{a n}
23723 command.
23724
23725 Calc's algorithm works by trying to eliminate one variable at a
23726 time by solving one of the equations for that variable and then
23727 substituting into the other equations. Calc will try all the
23728 possibilities, but you can speed things up by noting that Calc
23729 first tries to eliminate the first variable with the first
23730 equation, then the second variable with the second equation,
23731 and so on. It also helps to put the simpler (e.g., more linear)
23732 equations toward the front of the list. Calc's algorithm will
23733 solve any system of linear equations, and also many kinds of
23734 nonlinear systems.
23735
23736 @ignore
23737 @starindex
23738 @end ignore
23739 @tindex elim
23740 Normally there will be as many variables as equations. If you
23741 give fewer variables than equations (an ``over-determined'' system
23742 of equations), Calc will find a partial solution. For example,
23743 typing @kbd{a S y @key{RET}} with the above system of equations
23744 would produce @samp{[y = a - x]}. There are now several ways to
23745 express this solution in terms of the original variables; Calc uses
23746 the first one that it finds. You can control the choice by adding
23747 variable specifiers of the form @samp{elim(@var{v})} to the
23748 variables list. This says that @var{v} should be eliminated from
23749 the equations; the variable will not appear at all in the solution.
23750 For example, typing @kbd{a S y,elim(x)} would yield
23751 @samp{[y = a - (b+a)/2]}.
23752
23753 If the variables list contains only @code{elim} specifiers,
23754 Calc simply eliminates those variables from the equations
23755 and then returns the resulting set of equations. For example,
23756 @kbd{a S elim(x)} produces @samp{[a - 2 y = b]}. Every variable
23757 eliminated will reduce the number of equations in the system
23758 by one.
23759
23760 Again, @kbd{a S} gives you one solution to the system of
23761 equations. If there are several solutions, you can use @kbd{H a S}
23762 to get a general family of solutions, or, if there is a finite
23763 number of solutions, you can use @kbd{a P} to get a list. (In
23764 the latter case, the result will take the form of a matrix where
23765 the rows are different solutions and the columns correspond to the
23766 variables you requested.)
23767
23768 Another way to deal with certain kinds of overdetermined systems of
23769 equations is the @kbd{a F} command, which does least-squares fitting
23770 to satisfy the equations. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
23771
23772 @node Decomposing Polynomials, , Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations
23773 @subsection Decomposing Polynomials
23774
23775 @noindent
23776 @ignore
23777 @starindex
23778 @end ignore
23779 @tindex poly
23780 The @code{poly} function takes a polynomial and a variable as
23781 arguments, and returns a vector of polynomial coefficients (constant
23782 coefficient first). For example, @samp{poly(x^3 + 2 x, x)} returns
23783 @expr{[0, 2, 0, 1]}. If the input is not a polynomial in @expr{x},
23784 the call to @code{poly} is left in symbolic form. If the input does
23785 not involve the variable @expr{x}, the input is returned in a list
23786 of length one, representing a polynomial with only a constant
23787 coefficient. The call @samp{poly(x, x)} returns the vector @expr{[0, 1]}.
23788 The last element of the returned vector is guaranteed to be nonzero;
23789 note that @samp{poly(0, x)} returns the empty vector @expr{[]}.
23790 Note also that @expr{x} may actually be any formula; for example,
23791 @samp{poly(sin(x)^2 - sin(x) + 3, sin(x))} returns @expr{[3, -1, 1]}.
23792
23793 @cindex Coefficients of polynomial
23794 @cindex Degree of polynomial
23795 To get the @expr{x^k} coefficient of polynomial @expr{p}, use
23796 @samp{poly(p, x)_(k+1)}. To get the degree of polynomial @expr{p},
23797 use @samp{vlen(poly(p, x)) - 1}. For example, @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)}
23798 returns @samp{[1, 4, 6, 4, 1]}, so @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)_(2+1)}
23799 gives the @expr{x^2} coefficient of this polynomial, 6.
23800
23801 @ignore
23802 @starindex
23803 @end ignore
23804 @tindex gpoly
23805 One important feature of the solver is its ability to recognize
23806 formulas which are ``essentially'' polynomials. This ability is
23807 made available to the user through the @code{gpoly} function, which
23808 is used just like @code{poly}: @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var})}.
23809 If @var{expr} is a polynomial in some term which includes @var{var}, then
23810 this function will return a vector @samp{[@var{x}, @var{c}, @var{a}]}
23811 where @var{x} is the term that depends on @var{var}, @var{c} is a
23812 vector of polynomial coefficients (like the one returned by @code{poly}),
23813 and @var{a} is a multiplier which is usually 1. Basically,
23814 @samp{@var{expr} = @var{a}*(@var{c}_1 + @var{c}_2 @var{x} +
23815 @var{c}_3 @var{x}^2 + ...)}. The last element of @var{c} is
23816 guaranteed to be non-zero, and @var{c} will not equal @samp{[1]}
23817 (i.e., the trivial decomposition @var{expr} = @var{x} is not
23818 considered a polynomial). One side effect is that @samp{gpoly(x, x)}
23819 and @samp{gpoly(6, x)}, both of which might be expected to recognize
23820 their arguments as polynomials, will not because the decomposition
23821 is considered trivial.
23822
23823 For example, @samp{gpoly((x-2)^2, x)} returns @samp{[x, [4, -4, 1], 1]},
23824 since the expanded form of this polynomial is @expr{4 - 4 x + x^2}.
23825
23826 The term @var{x} may itself be a polynomial in @var{var}. This is
23827 done to reduce the size of the @var{c} vector. For example,
23828 @samp{gpoly(x^4 + x^2 - 1, x)} returns @samp{[x^2, [-1, 1, 1], 1]},
23829 since a quadratic polynomial in @expr{x^2} is easier to solve than
23830 a quartic polynomial in @expr{x}.
23831
23832 A few more examples of the kinds of polynomials @code{gpoly} can
23833 discover:
23834
23835 @smallexample
23836 sin(x) - 1 [sin(x), [-1, 1], 1]
23837 x + 1/x - 1 [x, [1, -1, 1], 1/x]
23838 x + 1/x [x^2, [1, 1], 1/x]
23839 x^3 + 2 x [x^2, [2, 1], x]
23840 x + x^2:3 + sqrt(x) [x^1:6, [1, 1, 0, 1], x^1:2]
23841 x^(2a) + 2 x^a + 5 [x^a, [5, 2, 1], 1]
23842 (exp(-x) + exp(x)) / 2 [e^(2 x), [0.5, 0.5], e^-x]
23843 @end smallexample
23844
23845 The @code{poly} and @code{gpoly} functions accept a third integer argument
23846 which specifies the largest degree of polynomial that is acceptable.
23847 If this is @expr{n}, then only @var{c} vectors of length @expr{n+1}
23848 or less will be returned. Otherwise, the @code{poly} or @code{gpoly}
23849 call will remain in symbolic form. For example, the equation solver
23850 can handle quartics and smaller polynomials, so it calls
23851 @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var}, 4)} to discover whether @var{expr}
23852 can be treated by its linear, quadratic, cubic, or quartic formulas.
23853
23854 @ignore
23855 @starindex
23856 @end ignore
23857 @tindex pdeg
23858 The @code{pdeg} function computes the degree of a polynomial;
23859 @samp{pdeg(p,x)} is the highest power of @code{x} that appears in
23860 @code{p}. This is the same as @samp{vlen(poly(p,x))-1}, but is
23861 much more efficient. If @code{p} is constant with respect to @code{x},
23862 then @samp{pdeg(p,x) = 0}. If @code{p} is not a polynomial in @code{x}
23863 (e.g., @samp{pdeg(2 cos(x), x)}, the function remains unevaluated.
23864 It is possible to omit the second argument @code{x}, in which case
23865 @samp{pdeg(p)} returns the highest total degree of any term of the
23866 polynomial, counting all variables that appear in @code{p}. Note
23867 that @code{pdeg(c) = pdeg(c,x) = 0} for any nonzero constant @code{c};
23868 the degree of the constant zero is considered to be @code{-inf}
23869 (minus infinity).
23870
23871 @ignore
23872 @starindex
23873 @end ignore
23874 @tindex plead
23875 The @code{plead} function finds the leading term of a polynomial.
23876 Thus @samp{plead(p,x)} is equivalent to @samp{poly(p,x)_vlen(poly(p,x))},
23877 though again more efficient. In particular, @samp{plead((2x+1)^10, x)}
23878 returns 1024 without expanding out the list of coefficients. The
23879 value of @code{plead(p,x)} will be zero only if @expr{p = 0}.
23880
23881 @ignore
23882 @starindex
23883 @end ignore
23884 @tindex pcont
23885 The @code{pcont} function finds the @dfn{content} of a polynomial. This
23886 is the greatest common divisor of all the coefficients of the polynomial.
23887 With two arguments, @code{pcont(p,x)} effectively uses @samp{poly(p,x)}
23888 to get a list of coefficients, then uses @code{pgcd} (the polynomial
23889 GCD function) to combine these into an answer. For example,
23890 @samp{pcont(4 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y, x)} is @samp{2 y}. The content is
23891 basically the ``biggest'' polynomial that can be divided into @code{p}
23892 exactly. The sign of the content is the same as the sign of the leading
23893 coefficient.
23894
23895 With only one argument, @samp{pcont(p)} computes the numerical
23896 content of the polynomial, i.e., the @code{gcd} of the numerical
23897 coefficients of all the terms in the formula. Note that @code{gcd}
23898 is defined on rational numbers as well as integers; it computes
23899 the @code{gcd} of the numerators and the @code{lcm} of the
23900 denominators. Thus @samp{pcont(4:3 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y)} returns 2:3.
23901 Dividing the polynomial by this number will clear all the
23902 denominators, as well as dividing by any common content in the
23903 numerators. The numerical content of a polynomial is negative only
23904 if all the coefficients in the polynomial are negative.
23905
23906 @ignore
23907 @starindex
23908 @end ignore
23909 @tindex pprim
23910 The @code{pprim} function finds the @dfn{primitive part} of a
23911 polynomial, which is simply the polynomial divided (using @code{pdiv}
23912 if necessary) by its content. If the input polynomial has rational
23913 coefficients, the result will have integer coefficients in simplest
23914 terms.
23915
23916 @node Numerical Solutions, Curve Fitting, Solving Equations, Algebra
23917 @section Numerical Solutions
23918
23919 @noindent
23920 Not all equations can be solved symbolically. The commands in this
23921 section use numerical algorithms that can find a solution to a specific
23922 instance of an equation to any desired accuracy. Note that the
23923 numerical commands are slower than their algebraic cousins; it is a
23924 good idea to try @kbd{a S} before resorting to these commands.
23925
23926 (@xref{Curve Fitting}, for some other, more specialized, operations
23927 on numerical data.)
23928
23929 @menu
23930 * Root Finding::
23931 * Minimization::
23932 * Numerical Systems of Equations::
23933 @end menu
23934
23935 @node Root Finding, Minimization, Numerical Solutions, Numerical Solutions
23936 @subsection Root Finding
23937
23938 @noindent
23939 @kindex a R
23940 @pindex calc-find-root
23941 @tindex root
23942 @cindex Newton's method
23943 @cindex Roots of equations
23944 @cindex Numerical root-finding
23945 The @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}) [@code{root}] command finds a
23946 numerical solution (or @dfn{root}) of an equation. (This command treats
23947 inequalities the same as equations. If the input is any other kind
23948 of formula, it is interpreted as an equation of the form @expr{X = 0}.)
23949
23950 The @kbd{a R} command requires an initial guess on the top of the
23951 stack, and a formula in the second-to-top position. It prompts for a
23952 solution variable, which must appear in the formula. All other variables
23953 that appear in the formula must have assigned values, i.e., when
23954 a value is assigned to the solution variable and the formula is
23955 evaluated with @kbd{=}, it should evaluate to a number. Any assigned
23956 value for the solution variable itself is ignored and unaffected by
23957 this command.
23958
23959 When the command completes, the initial guess is replaced on the stack
23960 by a vector of two numbers: The value of the solution variable that
23961 solves the equation, and the difference between the lefthand and
23962 righthand sides of the equation at that value. Ordinarily, the second
23963 number will be zero or very nearly zero. (Note that Calc uses a
23964 slightly higher precision while finding the root, and thus the second
23965 number may be slightly different from the value you would compute from
23966 the equation yourself.)
23967
23968 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) command is a handy way to extract
23969 the first element of the result vector, discarding the error term.
23970
23971 The initial guess can be a real number, in which case Calc searches
23972 for a real solution near that number, or a complex number, in which
23973 case Calc searches the whole complex plane near that number for a
23974 solution, or it can be an interval form which restricts the search
23975 to real numbers inside that interval.
23976
23977 Calc tries to use @kbd{a d} to take the derivative of the equation.
23978 If this succeeds, it uses Newton's method. If the equation is not
23979 differentiable Calc uses a bisection method. (If Newton's method
23980 appears to be going astray, Calc switches over to bisection if it
23981 can, or otherwise gives up. In this case it may help to try again
23982 with a slightly different initial guess.) If the initial guess is a
23983 complex number, the function must be differentiable.
23984
23985 If the formula (or the difference between the sides of an equation)
23986 is negative at one end of the interval you specify and positive at
23987 the other end, the root finder is guaranteed to find a root.
23988 Otherwise, Calc subdivides the interval into small parts looking for
23989 positive and negative values to bracket the root. When your guess is
23990 an interval, Calc will not look outside that interval for a root.
23991
23992 @kindex H a R
23993 @tindex wroot
23994 The @kbd{H a R} [@code{wroot}] command is similar to @kbd{a R}, except
23995 that if the initial guess is an interval for which the function has
23996 the same sign at both ends, then rather than subdividing the interval
23997 Calc attempts to widen it to enclose a root. Use this mode if
23998 you are not sure if the function has a root in your interval.
23999
24000 If the function is not differentiable, and you give a simple number
24001 instead of an interval as your initial guess, Calc uses this widening
24002 process even if you did not type the Hyperbolic flag. (If the function
24003 @emph{is} differentiable, Calc uses Newton's method which does not
24004 require a bounding interval in order to work.)
24005
24006 If Calc leaves the @code{root} or @code{wroot} function in symbolic
24007 form on the stack, it will normally display an explanation for why
24008 no root was found. If you miss this explanation, press @kbd{w}
24009 (@code{calc-why}) to get it back.
24010
24011 @node Minimization, Numerical Systems of Equations, Root Finding, Numerical Solutions
24012 @subsection Minimization
24013
24014 @noindent
24015 @kindex a N
24016 @kindex H a N
24017 @kindex a X
24018 @kindex H a X
24019 @pindex calc-find-minimum
24020 @pindex calc-find-maximum
24021 @tindex minimize
24022 @tindex maximize
24023 @cindex Minimization, numerical
24024 The @kbd{a N} (@code{calc-find-minimum}) [@code{minimize}] command
24025 finds a minimum value for a formula. It is very similar in operation
24026 to @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}): You give the formula and an initial
24027 guess on the stack, and are prompted for the name of a variable. The guess
24028 may be either a number near the desired minimum, or an interval enclosing
24029 the desired minimum. The function returns a vector containing the
24030 value of the variable which minimizes the formula's value, along
24031 with the minimum value itself.
24032
24033 Note that this command looks for a @emph{local} minimum. Many functions
24034 have more than one minimum; some, like
24035 @texline @math{x \sin x},
24036 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)},
24037 have infinitely many. In fact, there is no easy way to define the
24038 ``global'' minimum of
24039 @texline @math{x \sin x}
24040 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)}
24041 but Calc can still locate any particular local minimum
24042 for you. Calc basically goes downhill from the initial guess until it
24043 finds a point at which the function's value is greater both to the left
24044 and to the right. Calc does not use derivatives when minimizing a function.
24045
24046 If your initial guess is an interval and it looks like the minimum
24047 occurs at one or the other endpoint of the interval, Calc will return
24048 that endpoint only if that endpoint is closed; thus, minimizing @expr{17 x}
24049 over @expr{[2..3]} will return @expr{[2, 38]}, but minimizing over
24050 @expr{(2..3]} would report no minimum found. In general, you should
24051 use closed intervals to find literally the minimum value in that
24052 range of @expr{x}, or open intervals to find the local minimum, if
24053 any, that happens to lie in that range.
24054
24055 Most functions are smooth and flat near their minimum values. Because
24056 of this flatness, if the current precision is, say, 12 digits, the
24057 variable can only be determined meaningfully to about six digits. Thus
24058 you should set the precision to twice as many digits as you need in your
24059 answer.
24060
24061 @ignore
24062 @mindex wmin@idots
24063 @end ignore
24064 @tindex wminimize
24065 @ignore
24066 @mindex wmax@idots
24067 @end ignore
24068 @tindex wmaximize
24069 The @kbd{H a N} [@code{wminimize}] command, analogously to @kbd{H a R},
24070 expands the guess interval to enclose a minimum rather than requiring
24071 that the minimum lie inside the interval you supply.
24072
24073 The @kbd{a X} (@code{calc-find-maximum}) [@code{maximize}] and
24074 @kbd{H a X} [@code{wmaximize}] commands effectively minimize the
24075 negative of the formula you supply.
24076
24077 The formula must evaluate to a real number at all points inside the
24078 interval (or near the initial guess if the guess is a number). If
24079 the initial guess is a complex number the variable will be minimized
24080 over the complex numbers; if it is real or an interval it will
24081 be minimized over the reals.
24082
24083 @node Numerical Systems of Equations, , Minimization, Numerical Solutions
24084 @subsection Systems of Equations
24085
24086 @noindent
24087 @cindex Systems of equations, numerical
24088 The @kbd{a R} command can also solve systems of equations. In this
24089 case, the equation should instead be a vector of equations, the
24090 guess should instead be a vector of numbers (intervals are not
24091 supported), and the variable should be a vector of variables. You
24092 can omit the brackets while entering the list of variables. Each
24093 equation must be differentiable by each variable for this mode to
24094 work. The result will be a vector of two vectors: The variable
24095 values that solved the system of equations, and the differences
24096 between the sides of the equations with those variable values.
24097 There must be the same number of equations as variables. Since
24098 only plain numbers are allowed as guesses, the Hyperbolic flag has
24099 no effect when solving a system of equations.
24100
24101 It is also possible to minimize over many variables with @kbd{a N}
24102 (or maximize with @kbd{a X}). Once again the variable name should
24103 be replaced by a vector of variables, and the initial guess should
24104 be an equal-sized vector of initial guesses. But, unlike the case of
24105 multidimensional @kbd{a R}, the formula being minimized should
24106 still be a single formula, @emph{not} a vector. Beware that
24107 multidimensional minimization is currently @emph{very} slow.
24108
24109 @node Curve Fitting, Summations, Numerical Solutions, Algebra
24110 @section Curve Fitting
24111
24112 @noindent
24113 The @kbd{a F} command fits a set of data to a @dfn{model formula},
24114 such as @expr{y = m x + b} where @expr{m} and @expr{b} are parameters
24115 to be determined. For a typical set of measured data there will be
24116 no single @expr{m} and @expr{b} that exactly fit the data; in this
24117 case, Calc chooses values of the parameters that provide the closest
24118 possible fit.
24119
24120 @menu
24121 * Linear Fits::
24122 * Polynomial and Multilinear Fits::
24123 * Error Estimates for Fits::
24124 * Standard Nonlinear Models::
24125 * Curve Fitting Details::
24126 * Interpolation::
24127 @end menu
24128
24129 @node Linear Fits, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting, Curve Fitting
24130 @subsection Linear Fits
24131
24132 @noindent
24133 @kindex a F
24134 @pindex calc-curve-fit
24135 @tindex fit
24136 @cindex Linear regression
24137 @cindex Least-squares fits
24138 The @kbd{a F} (@code{calc-curve-fit}) [@code{fit}] command attempts
24139 to fit a set of data (@expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers) to a
24140 straight line, polynomial, or other function of @expr{x}. For the
24141 moment we will consider only the case of fitting to a line, and we
24142 will ignore the issue of whether or not the model was in fact a good
24143 fit for the data.
24144
24145 In a standard linear least-squares fit, we have a set of @expr{(x,y)}
24146 data points that we wish to fit to the model @expr{y = m x + b}
24147 by adjusting the parameters @expr{m} and @expr{b} to make the @expr{y}
24148 values calculated from the formula be as close as possible to the actual
24149 @expr{y} values in the data set. (In a polynomial fit, the model is
24150 instead, say, @expr{y = a x^3 + b x^2 + c x + d}. In a multilinear fit,
24151 we have data points of the form @expr{(x_1,x_2,x_3,y)} and our model is
24152 @expr{y = a x_1 + b x_2 + c x_3 + d}. These will be discussed later.)
24153
24154 In the model formula, variables like @expr{x} and @expr{x_2} are called
24155 the @dfn{independent variables}, and @expr{y} is the @dfn{dependent
24156 variable}. Variables like @expr{m}, @expr{a}, and @expr{b} are called
24157 the @dfn{parameters} of the model.
24158
24159 The @kbd{a F} command takes the data set to be fitted from the stack.
24160 By default, it expects the data in the form of a matrix. For example,
24161 for a linear or polynomial fit, this would be a
24162 @texline @math{2\times N}
24163 @infoline 2xN
24164 matrix where the first row is a list of @expr{x} values and the second
24165 row has the corresponding @expr{y} values. For the multilinear fit
24166 shown above, the matrix would have four rows (@expr{x_1}, @expr{x_2},
24167 @expr{x_3}, and @expr{y}, respectively).
24168
24169 If you happen to have an
24170 @texline @math{N\times2}
24171 @infoline Nx2
24172 matrix instead of a
24173 @texline @math{2\times N}
24174 @infoline 2xN
24175 matrix, just press @kbd{v t} first to transpose the matrix.
24176
24177 After you type @kbd{a F}, Calc prompts you to select a model. For a
24178 linear fit, press the digit @kbd{1}.
24179
24180 Calc then prompts for you to name the variables. By default it chooses
24181 high letters like @expr{x} and @expr{y} for independent variables and
24182 low letters like @expr{a} and @expr{b} for parameters. (The dependent
24183 variable doesn't need a name.) The two kinds of variables are separated
24184 by a semicolon. Since you generally care more about the names of the
24185 independent variables than of the parameters, Calc also allows you to
24186 name only those and let the parameters use default names.
24187
24188 For example, suppose the data matrix
24189
24190 @ifinfo
24191 @example
24192 @group
24193 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24194 [ 5, 7, 9, 11, 13 ] ]
24195 @end group
24196 @end example
24197 @end ifinfo
24198 @tex
24199 \turnoffactive
24200 \turnoffactive
24201 \beforedisplay
24202 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 \cr
24203 5 & 7 & 9 & 11 & 13 }
24204 $$
24205 \afterdisplay
24206 @end tex
24207
24208 @noindent
24209 is on the stack and we wish to do a simple linear fit. Type
24210 @kbd{a F}, then @kbd{1} for the model, then @key{RET} to use
24211 the default names. The result will be the formula @expr{3 + 2 x}
24212 on the stack. Calc has created the model expression @kbd{a + b x},
24213 then found the optimal values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} to fit the
24214 data. (In this case, it was able to find an exact fit.) Calc then
24215 substituted those values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} in the model
24216 formula.
24217
24218 The @kbd{a F} command puts two entries in the trail. One is, as
24219 always, a copy of the result that went to the stack; the other is
24220 a vector of the actual parameter values, written as equations:
24221 @expr{[a = 3, b = 2]}, in case you'd rather read them in a list
24222 than pick them out of the formula. (You can type @kbd{t y}
24223 to move this vector to the stack; see @ref{Trail Commands}.
24224
24225 Specifying a different independent variable name will affect the
24226 resulting formula: @kbd{a F 1 k @key{RET}} produces @kbd{3 + 2 k}.
24227 Changing the parameter names (say, @kbd{a F 1 k;b,m @key{RET}}) will affect
24228 the equations that go into the trail.
24229
24230 @tex
24231 \bigskip
24232 @end tex
24233
24234 To see what happens when the fit is not exact, we could change
24235 the number 13 in the data matrix to 14 and try the fit again.
24236 The result is:
24237
24238 @example
24239 2.6 + 2.2 x
24240 @end example
24241
24242 Evaluating this formula, say with @kbd{v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}}, shows
24243 a reasonably close match to the y-values in the data.
24244
24245 @example
24246 [4.8, 7., 9.2, 11.4, 13.6]
24247 @end example
24248
24249 Since there is no line which passes through all the @var{n} data points,
24250 Calc has chosen a line that best approximates the data points using
24251 the method of least squares. The idea is to define the @dfn{chi-square}
24252 error measure
24253
24254 @ifinfo
24255 @example
24256 chi^2 = sum((y_i - (a + b x_i))^2, i, 1, N)
24257 @end example
24258 @end ifinfo
24259 @tex
24260 \turnoffactive
24261 \beforedisplay
24262 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N (y_i - (a + b x_i))^2 $$
24263 \afterdisplay
24264 @end tex
24265
24266 @noindent
24267 which is clearly zero if @expr{a + b x} exactly fits all data points,
24268 and increases as various @expr{a + b x_i} values fail to match the
24269 corresponding @expr{y_i} values. There are several reasons why the
24270 summand is squared, one of them being to ensure that
24271 @texline @math{\chi^2 \ge 0}.
24272 @infoline @expr{chi^2 >= 0}.
24273 Least-squares fitting simply chooses the values of @expr{a} and @expr{b}
24274 for which the error
24275 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24276 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24277 is as small as possible.
24278
24279 Other kinds of models do the same thing but with a different model
24280 formula in place of @expr{a + b x_i}.
24281
24282 @tex
24283 \bigskip
24284 @end tex
24285
24286 A numeric prefix argument causes the @kbd{a F} command to take the
24287 data in some other form than one big matrix. A positive argument @var{n}
24288 will take @var{N} items from the stack, corresponding to the @var{n} rows
24289 of a data matrix. In the linear case, @var{n} must be 2 since there
24290 is always one independent variable and one dependent variable.
24291
24292 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} is a compromise; Calc takes two
24293 items from the stack, an @var{n}-row matrix of @expr{x} values, and a
24294 vector of @expr{y} values. If there is only one independent variable,
24295 the @expr{x} values can be either a one-row matrix or a plain vector,
24296 in which case the @kbd{C-u} prefix is the same as a @w{@kbd{C-u 2}} prefix.
24297
24298 @node Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Error Estimates for Fits, Linear Fits, Curve Fitting
24299 @subsection Polynomial and Multilinear Fits
24300
24301 @noindent
24302 To fit the data to higher-order polynomials, just type one of the
24303 digits @kbd{2} through @kbd{9} when prompted for a model. For example,
24304 we could fit the original data matrix from the previous section
24305 (with 13, not 14) to a parabola instead of a line by typing
24306 @kbd{a F 2 @key{RET}}.
24307
24308 @example
24309 2.00000000001 x - 1.5e-12 x^2 + 2.99999999999
24310 @end example
24311
24312 Note that since the constant and linear terms are enough to fit the
24313 data exactly, it's no surprise that Calc chose a tiny contribution
24314 for @expr{x^2}. (The fact that it's not exactly zero is due only
24315 to roundoff error. Since our data are exact integers, we could get
24316 an exact answer by typing @kbd{m f} first to get Fraction mode.
24317 Then the @expr{x^2} term would vanish altogether. Usually, though,
24318 the data being fitted will be approximate floats so Fraction mode
24319 won't help.)
24320
24321 Doing the @kbd{a F 2} fit on the data set with 14 instead of 13
24322 gives a much larger @expr{x^2} contribution, as Calc bends the
24323 line slightly to improve the fit.
24324
24325 @example
24326 0.142857142855 x^2 + 1.34285714287 x + 3.59999999998
24327 @end example
24328
24329 An important result from the theory of polynomial fitting is that it
24330 is always possible to fit @var{n} data points exactly using a polynomial
24331 of degree @mathit{@var{n}-1}, sometimes called an @dfn{interpolating polynomial}.
24332 Using the modified (14) data matrix, a model number of 4 gives
24333 a polynomial that exactly matches all five data points:
24334
24335 @example
24336 0.04167 x^4 - 0.4167 x^3 + 1.458 x^2 - 0.08333 x + 4.
24337 @end example
24338
24339 The actual coefficients we get with a precision of 12, like
24340 @expr{0.0416666663588}, clearly suffer from loss of precision.
24341 It is a good idea to increase the working precision to several
24342 digits beyond what you need when you do a fitting operation.
24343 Or, if your data are exact, use Fraction mode to get exact
24344 results.
24345
24346 You can type @kbd{i} instead of a digit at the model prompt to fit
24347 the data exactly to a polynomial. This just counts the number of
24348 columns of the data matrix to choose the degree of the polynomial
24349 automatically.
24350
24351 Fitting data ``exactly'' to high-degree polynomials is not always
24352 a good idea, though. High-degree polynomials have a tendency to
24353 wiggle uncontrollably in between the fitting data points. Also,
24354 if the exact-fit polynomial is going to be used to interpolate or
24355 extrapolate the data, it is numerically better to use the @kbd{a p}
24356 command described below. @xref{Interpolation}.
24357
24358 @tex
24359 \bigskip
24360 @end tex
24361
24362 Another generalization of the linear model is to assume the
24363 @expr{y} values are a sum of linear contributions from several
24364 @expr{x} values. This is a @dfn{multilinear} fit, and it is also
24365 selected by the @kbd{1} digit key. (Calc decides whether the fit
24366 is linear or multilinear by counting the rows in the data matrix.)
24367
24368 Given the data matrix,
24369
24370 @example
24371 @group
24372 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24373 [ 7, 2, 3, 5, 2 ]
24374 [ 14.5, 15, 18.5, 22.5, 24 ] ]
24375 @end group
24376 @end example
24377
24378 @noindent
24379 the command @kbd{a F 1 @key{RET}} will call the first row @expr{x} and the
24380 second row @expr{y}, and will fit the values in the third row to the
24381 model @expr{a + b x + c y}.
24382
24383 @example
24384 8. + 3. x + 0.5 y
24385 @end example
24386
24387 Calc can do multilinear fits with any number of independent variables
24388 (i.e., with any number of data rows).
24389
24390 @tex
24391 \bigskip
24392 @end tex
24393
24394 Yet another variation is @dfn{homogeneous} linear models, in which
24395 the constant term is known to be zero. In the linear case, this
24396 means the model formula is simply @expr{a x}; in the multilinear
24397 case, the model might be @expr{a x + b y + c z}; and in the polynomial
24398 case, the model could be @expr{a x + b x^2 + c x^3}. You can get
24399 a homogeneous linear or multilinear model by pressing the letter
24400 @kbd{h} followed by a regular model key, like @kbd{1} or @kbd{2}.
24401
24402 It is certainly possible to have other constrained linear models,
24403 like @expr{2.3 + a x} or @expr{a - 4 x}. While there is no single
24404 key to select models like these, a later section shows how to enter
24405 any desired model by hand. In the first case, for example, you
24406 would enter @kbd{a F ' 2.3 + a x}.
24407
24408 Another class of models that will work but must be entered by hand
24409 are multinomial fits, e.g., @expr{a + b x + c y + d x^2 + e y^2 + f x y}.
24410
24411 @node Error Estimates for Fits, Standard Nonlinear Models, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting
24412 @subsection Error Estimates for Fits
24413
24414 @noindent
24415 @kindex H a F
24416 @tindex efit
24417 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a F} [@code{efit}] performs the same
24418 fitting operation as @kbd{a F}, but reports the coefficients as error
24419 forms instead of plain numbers. Fitting our two data matrices (first
24420 with 13, then with 14) to a line with @kbd{H a F} gives the results,
24421
24422 @example
24423 3. + 2. x
24424 2.6 +/- 0.382970843103 + 2.2 +/- 0.115470053838 x
24425 @end example
24426
24427 In the first case the estimated errors are zero because the linear
24428 fit is perfect. In the second case, the errors are nonzero but
24429 moderately small, because the data are still very close to linear.
24430
24431 It is also possible for the @emph{input} to a fitting operation to
24432 contain error forms. The data values must either all include errors
24433 or all be plain numbers. Error forms can go anywhere but generally
24434 go on the numbers in the last row of the data matrix. If the last
24435 row contains error forms
24436 @texline `@var{y_i}@w{ @t{+/-} }@math{\sigma_i}',
24437 @infoline `@var{y_i}@w{ @t{+/-} }@var{sigma_i}',
24438 then the
24439 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24440 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24441 statistic is now,
24442
24443 @ifinfo
24444 @example
24445 chi^2 = sum(((y_i - (a + b x_i)) / sigma_i)^2, i, 1, N)
24446 @end example
24447 @end ifinfo
24448 @tex
24449 \turnoffactive
24450 \beforedisplay
24451 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N \left(y_i - (a + b x_i) \over \sigma_i\right)^2 $$
24452 \afterdisplay
24453 @end tex
24454
24455 @noindent
24456 so that data points with larger error estimates contribute less to
24457 the fitting operation.
24458
24459 If there are error forms on other rows of the data matrix, all the
24460 errors for a given data point are combined; the square root of the
24461 sum of the squares of the errors forms the
24462 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24463 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24464 used for the data point.
24465
24466 Both @kbd{a F} and @kbd{H a F} can accept error forms in the input
24467 matrix, although if you are concerned about error analysis you will
24468 probably use @kbd{H a F} so that the output also contains error
24469 estimates.
24470
24471 If the input contains error forms but all the
24472 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24473 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24474 values are the same, it is easy to see that the resulting fitted model
24475 will be the same as if the input did not have error forms at all
24476 @texline (@math{\chi^2}
24477 @infoline (@expr{chi^2}
24478 is simply scaled uniformly by
24479 @texline @math{1 / \sigma^2},
24480 @infoline @expr{1 / sigma^2},
24481 which doesn't affect where it has a minimum). But there @emph{will} be
24482 a difference in the estimated errors of the coefficients reported by
24483 @kbd{H a F}.
24484
24485 Consult any text on statistical modeling of data for a discussion
24486 of where these error estimates come from and how they should be
24487 interpreted.
24488
24489 @tex
24490 \bigskip
24491 @end tex
24492
24493 @kindex I a F
24494 @tindex xfit
24495 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] produces even more
24496 information. The result is a vector of six items:
24497
24498 @enumerate
24499 @item
24500 The model formula with error forms for its coefficients or
24501 parameters. This is the result that @kbd{H a F} would have
24502 produced.
24503
24504 @item
24505 A vector of ``raw'' parameter values for the model. These are the
24506 polynomial coefficients or other parameters as plain numbers, in the
24507 same order as the parameters appeared in the final prompt of the
24508 @kbd{I a F} command. For polynomials of degree @expr{d}, this vector
24509 will have length @expr{M = d+1} with the constant term first.
24510
24511 @item
24512 The covariance matrix @expr{C} computed from the fit. This is
24513 an @var{m}x@var{m} symmetric matrix; the diagonal elements
24514 @texline @math{C_{jj}}
24515 @infoline @expr{C_j_j}
24516 are the variances
24517 @texline @math{\sigma_j^2}
24518 @infoline @expr{sigma_j^2}
24519 of the parameters. The other elements are covariances
24520 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2}
24521 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2}
24522 that describe the correlation between pairs of parameters. (A related
24523 set of numbers, the @dfn{linear correlation coefficients}
24524 @texline @math{r_{ij}},
24525 @infoline @expr{r_i_j},
24526 are defined as
24527 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2 / \sigma_i \, \sigma_j}.)
24528 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2 / sigma_i sigma_j}.)
24529
24530 @item
24531 A vector of @expr{M} ``parameter filter'' functions whose
24532 meanings are described below. If no filters are necessary this
24533 will instead be an empty vector; this is always the case for the
24534 polynomial and multilinear fits described so far.
24535
24536 @item
24537 The value of
24538 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24539 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24540 for the fit, calculated by the formulas shown above. This gives a
24541 measure of the quality of the fit; statisticians consider
24542 @texline @math{\chi^2 \approx N - M}
24543 @infoline @expr{chi^2 = N - M}
24544 to indicate a moderately good fit (where again @expr{N} is the number of
24545 data points and @expr{M} is the number of parameters).
24546
24547 @item
24548 A measure of goodness of fit expressed as a probability @expr{Q}.
24549 This is computed from the @code{utpc} probability distribution
24550 function using
24551 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24552 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24553 with @expr{N - M} degrees of freedom. A
24554 value of 0.5 implies a good fit; some texts recommend that often
24555 @expr{Q = 0.1} or even 0.001 can signify an acceptable fit. In
24556 particular,
24557 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24558 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24559 statistics assume the errors in your inputs
24560 follow a normal (Gaussian) distribution; if they don't, you may
24561 have to accept smaller values of @expr{Q}.
24562
24563 The @expr{Q} value is computed only if the input included error
24564 estimates. Otherwise, Calc will report the symbol @code{nan}
24565 for @expr{Q}. The reason is that in this case the
24566 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24567 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24568 value has effectively been used to estimate the original errors
24569 in the input, and thus there is no redundant information left
24570 over to use for a confidence test.
24571 @end enumerate
24572
24573 @node Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting Details, Error Estimates for Fits, Curve Fitting
24574 @subsection Standard Nonlinear Models
24575
24576 @noindent
24577 The @kbd{a F} command also accepts other kinds of models besides
24578 lines and polynomials. Some common models have quick single-key
24579 abbreviations; others must be entered by hand as algebraic formulas.
24580
24581 Here is a complete list of the standard models recognized by @kbd{a F}:
24582
24583 @table @kbd
24584 @item 1
24585 Linear or multilinear. @mathit{a + b x + c y + d z}.
24586 @item 2-9
24587 Polynomials. @mathit{a + b x + c x^2 + d x^3}.
24588 @item e
24589 Exponential. @mathit{a} @t{exp}@mathit{(b x)} @t{exp}@mathit{(c y)}.
24590 @item E
24591 Base-10 exponential. @mathit{a} @t{10^}@mathit{(b x)} @t{10^}@mathit{(c y)}.
24592 @item x
24593 Exponential (alternate notation). @t{exp}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24594 @item X
24595 Base-10 exponential (alternate). @t{10^}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24596 @item l
24597 Logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @t{ln}@mathit{(x) + c} @t{ln}@mathit{(y)}.
24598 @item L
24599 Base-10 logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @t{log10}@mathit{(x) + c} @t{log10}@mathit{(y)}.
24600 @item ^
24601 General exponential. @mathit{a b^x c^y}.
24602 @item p
24603 Power law. @mathit{a x^b y^c}.
24604 @item q
24605 Quadratic. @mathit{a + b (x-c)^2 + d (x-e)^2}.
24606 @item g
24607 Gaussian.
24608 @texline @math{{a \over b \sqrt{2 \pi}} \exp\left( -{1 \over 2} \left( x - c \over b \right)^2 \right)}.
24609 @infoline @mathit{(a / b sqrt(2 pi)) exp(-0.5*((x-c)/b)^2)}.
24610 @end table
24611
24612 All of these models are used in the usual way; just press the appropriate
24613 letter at the model prompt, and choose variable names if you wish. The
24614 result will be a formula as shown in the above table, with the best-fit
24615 values of the parameters substituted. (You may find it easier to read
24616 the parameter values from the vector that is placed in the trail.)
24617
24618 All models except Gaussian and polynomials can generalize as shown to any
24619 number of independent variables. Also, all the built-in models have an
24620 additive or multiplicative parameter shown as @expr{a} in the above table
24621 which can be replaced by zero or one, as appropriate, by typing @kbd{h}
24622 before the model key.
24623
24624 Note that many of these models are essentially equivalent, but express
24625 the parameters slightly differently. For example, @expr{a b^x} and
24626 the other two exponential models are all algebraic rearrangements of
24627 each other. Also, the ``quadratic'' model is just a degree-2 polynomial
24628 with the parameters expressed differently. Use whichever form best
24629 matches the problem.
24630
24631 The HP-28/48 calculators support four different models for curve
24632 fitting, called @code{LIN}, @code{LOG}, @code{EXP}, and @code{PWR}.
24633 These correspond to Calc models @samp{a + b x}, @samp{a + b ln(x)},
24634 @samp{a exp(b x)}, and @samp{a x^b}, respectively. In each case,
24635 @expr{a} is what the HP-48 identifies as the ``intercept,'' and
24636 @expr{b} is what it calls the ``slope.''
24637
24638 @tex
24639 \bigskip
24640 @end tex
24641
24642 If the model you want doesn't appear on this list, press @kbd{'}
24643 (the apostrophe key) at the model prompt to enter any algebraic
24644 formula, such as @kbd{m x - b}, as the model. (Not all models
24645 will work, though---see the next section for details.)
24646
24647 The model can also be an equation like @expr{y = m x + b}.
24648 In this case, Calc thinks of all the rows of the data matrix on
24649 equal terms; this model effectively has two parameters
24650 (@expr{m} and @expr{b}) and two independent variables (@expr{x}
24651 and @expr{y}), with no ``dependent'' variables. Model equations
24652 do not need to take this @expr{y =} form. For example, the
24653 implicit line equation @expr{a x + b y = 1} works fine as a
24654 model.
24655
24656 When you enter a model, Calc makes an alphabetical list of all
24657 the variables that appear in the model. These are used for the
24658 default parameters, independent variables, and dependent variable
24659 (in that order). If you enter a plain formula (not an equation),
24660 Calc assumes the dependent variable does not appear in the formula
24661 and thus does not need a name.
24662
24663 For example, if the model formula has the variables @expr{a,mu,sigma,t,x},
24664 and the data matrix has three rows (meaning two independent variables),
24665 Calc will use @expr{a,mu,sigma} as the default parameters, and the
24666 data rows will be named @expr{t} and @expr{x}, respectively. If you
24667 enter an equation instead of a plain formula, Calc will use @expr{a,mu}
24668 as the parameters, and @expr{sigma,t,x} as the three independent
24669 variables.
24670
24671 You can, of course, override these choices by entering something
24672 different at the prompt. If you leave some variables out of the list,
24673 those variables must have stored values and those stored values will
24674 be used as constants in the model. (Stored values for the parameters
24675 and independent variables are ignored by the @kbd{a F} command.)
24676 If you list only independent variables, all the remaining variables
24677 in the model formula will become parameters.
24678
24679 If there are @kbd{$} signs in the model you type, they will stand
24680 for parameters and all other variables (in alphabetical order)
24681 will be independent. Use @kbd{$} for one parameter, @kbd{$$} for
24682 another, and so on. Thus @kbd{$ x + $$} is another way to describe
24683 a linear model.
24684
24685 If you type a @kbd{$} instead of @kbd{'} at the model prompt itself,
24686 Calc will take the model formula from the stack. (The data must then
24687 appear at the second stack level.) The same conventions are used to
24688 choose which variables in the formula are independent by default and
24689 which are parameters.
24690
24691 Models taken from the stack can also be expressed as vectors of
24692 two or three elements, @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}]} or
24693 @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}]}. Each of @var{vars}
24694 and @var{params} may be either a variable or a vector of variables.
24695 (If @var{params} is omitted, all variables in @var{model} except
24696 those listed as @var{vars} are parameters.)
24697
24698 When you enter a model manually with @kbd{'}, Calc puts a 3-vector
24699 describing the model in the trail so you can get it back if you wish.
24700
24701 @tex
24702 \bigskip
24703 @end tex
24704
24705 @vindex Model1
24706 @vindex Model2
24707 Finally, you can store a model in one of the Calc variables
24708 @code{Model1} or @code{Model2}, then use this model by typing
24709 @kbd{a F u} or @kbd{a F U} (respectively). The value stored in
24710 the variable can be any of the formats that @kbd{a F $} would
24711 accept for a model on the stack.
24712
24713 @tex
24714 \bigskip
24715 @end tex
24716
24717 Calc uses the principal values of inverse functions like @code{ln}
24718 and @code{arcsin} when doing fits. For example, when you enter
24719 the model @samp{y = sin(a t + b)} Calc actually uses the easier
24720 form @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b}. The @code{arcsin} function always
24721 returns results in the range from @mathit{-90} to 90 degrees (or the
24722 equivalent range in radians). Suppose you had data that you
24723 believed to represent roughly three oscillations of a sine wave,
24724 so that the argument of the sine might go from zero to
24725 @texline @math{3\times360}
24726 @infoline @mathit{3*360}
24727 degrees.
24728 The above model would appear to be a good way to determine the
24729 true frequency and phase of the sine wave, but in practice it
24730 would fail utterly. The righthand side of the actual model
24731 @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b} will grow smoothly with @expr{t}, but
24732 the lefthand side will bounce back and forth between @mathit{-90} and 90.
24733 No values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} can make the two sides match,
24734 even approximately.
24735
24736 There is no good solution to this problem at present. You could
24737 restrict your data to small enough ranges so that the above problem
24738 doesn't occur (i.e., not straddling any peaks in the sine wave).
24739 Or, in this case, you could use a totally different method such as
24740 Fourier analysis, which is beyond the scope of the @kbd{a F} command.
24741 (Unfortunately, Calc does not currently have any facilities for
24742 taking Fourier and related transforms.)
24743
24744 @node Curve Fitting Details, Interpolation, Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting
24745 @subsection Curve Fitting Details
24746
24747 @noindent
24748 Calc's internal least-squares fitter can only handle multilinear
24749 models. More precisely, it can handle any model of the form
24750 @expr{a f(x,y,z) + b g(x,y,z) + c h(x,y,z)}, where @expr{a,b,c}
24751 are the parameters and @expr{x,y,z} are the independent variables
24752 (of course there can be any number of each, not just three).
24753
24754 In a simple multilinear or polynomial fit, it is easy to see how
24755 to convert the model into this form. For example, if the model
24756 is @expr{a + b x + c x^2}, then @expr{f(x) = 1}, @expr{g(x) = x},
24757 and @expr{h(x) = x^2} are suitable functions.
24758
24759 For other models, Calc uses a variety of algebraic manipulations
24760 to try to put the problem into the form
24761
24762 @smallexample
24763 Y(x,y,z) = A(a,b,c) F(x,y,z) + B(a,b,c) G(x,y,z) + C(a,b,c) H(x,y,z)
24764 @end smallexample
24765
24766 @noindent
24767 where @expr{Y,A,B,C,F,G,H} are arbitrary functions. It computes
24768 @expr{Y}, @expr{F}, @expr{G}, and @expr{H} for all the data points,
24769 does a standard linear fit to find the values of @expr{A}, @expr{B},
24770 and @expr{C}, then uses the equation solver to solve for @expr{a,b,c}
24771 in terms of @expr{A,B,C}.
24772
24773 A remarkable number of models can be cast into this general form.
24774 We'll look at two examples here to see how it works. The power-law
24775 model @expr{y = a x^b} with two independent variables and two parameters
24776 can be rewritten as follows:
24777
24778 @example
24779 y = a x^b
24780 y = a exp(b ln(x))
24781 y = exp(ln(a) + b ln(x))
24782 ln(y) = ln(a) + b ln(x)
24783 @end example
24784
24785 @noindent
24786 which matches the desired form with
24787 @texline @math{Y = \ln(y)},
24788 @infoline @expr{Y = ln(y)},
24789 @texline @math{A = \ln(a)},
24790 @infoline @expr{A = ln(a)},
24791 @expr{F = 1}, @expr{B = b}, and
24792 @texline @math{G = \ln(x)}.
24793 @infoline @expr{G = ln(x)}.
24794 Calc thus computes the logarithms of your @expr{y} and @expr{x} values,
24795 does a linear fit for @expr{A} and @expr{B}, then solves to get
24796 @texline @math{a = \exp(A)}
24797 @infoline @expr{a = exp(A)}
24798 and @expr{b = B}.
24799
24800 Another interesting example is the ``quadratic'' model, which can
24801 be handled by expanding according to the distributive law.
24802
24803 @example
24804 y = a + b*(x - c)^2
24805 y = a + b c^2 - 2 b c x + b x^2
24806 @end example
24807
24808 @noindent
24809 which matches with @expr{Y = y}, @expr{A = a + b c^2}, @expr{F = 1},
24810 @expr{B = -2 b c}, @expr{G = x} (the @mathit{-2} factor could just as easily
24811 have been put into @expr{G} instead of @expr{B}), @expr{C = b}, and
24812 @expr{H = x^2}.
24813
24814 The Gaussian model looks quite complicated, but a closer examination
24815 shows that it's actually similar to the quadratic model but with an
24816 exponential that can be brought to the top and moved into @expr{Y}.
24817
24818 An example of a model that cannot be put into general linear
24819 form is a Gaussian with a constant background added on, i.e.,
24820 @expr{d} + the regular Gaussian formula. If you have a model like
24821 this, your best bet is to replace enough of your parameters with
24822 constants to make the model linearizable, then adjust the constants
24823 manually by doing a series of fits. You can compare the fits by
24824 graphing them, by examining the goodness-of-fit measures returned by
24825 @kbd{I a F}, or by some other method suitable to your application.
24826 Note that some models can be linearized in several ways. The
24827 Gaussian-plus-@var{d} model can be linearized by setting @expr{d}
24828 (the background) to a constant, or by setting @expr{b} (the standard
24829 deviation) and @expr{c} (the mean) to constants.
24830
24831 To fit a model with constants substituted for some parameters, just
24832 store suitable values in those parameter variables, then omit them
24833 from the list of parameters when you answer the variables prompt.
24834
24835 @tex
24836 \bigskip
24837 @end tex
24838
24839 A last desperate step would be to use the general-purpose
24840 @code{minimize} function rather than @code{fit}. After all, both
24841 functions solve the problem of minimizing an expression (the
24842 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24843 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24844 sum) by adjusting certain parameters in the expression. The @kbd{a F}
24845 command is able to use a vastly more efficient algorithm due to its
24846 special knowledge about linear chi-square sums, but the @kbd{a N}
24847 command can do the same thing by brute force.
24848
24849 A compromise would be to pick out a few parameters without which the
24850 fit is linearizable, and use @code{minimize} on a call to @code{fit}
24851 which efficiently takes care of the rest of the parameters. The thing
24852 to be minimized would be the value of
24853 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24854 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24855 returned as the fifth result of the @code{xfit} function:
24856
24857 @smallexample
24858 minimize(xfit(gaus(a,b,c,d,x), x, [a,b,c], data)_5, d, guess)
24859 @end smallexample
24860
24861 @noindent
24862 where @code{gaus} represents the Gaussian model with background,
24863 @code{data} represents the data matrix, and @code{guess} represents
24864 the initial guess for @expr{d} that @code{minimize} requires.
24865 This operation will only be, shall we say, extraordinarily slow
24866 rather than astronomically slow (as would be the case if @code{minimize}
24867 were used by itself to solve the problem).
24868
24869 @tex
24870 \bigskip
24871 @end tex
24872
24873 The @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] command is somewhat trickier when
24874 nonlinear models are used. The second item in the result is the
24875 vector of ``raw'' parameters @expr{A}, @expr{B}, @expr{C}. The
24876 covariance matrix is written in terms of those raw parameters.
24877 The fifth item is a vector of @dfn{filter} expressions. This
24878 is the empty vector @samp{[]} if the raw parameters were the same
24879 as the requested parameters, i.e., if @expr{A = a}, @expr{B = b},
24880 and so on (which is always true if the model is already linear
24881 in the parameters as written, e.g., for polynomial fits). If the
24882 parameters had to be rearranged, the fifth item is instead a vector
24883 of one formula per parameter in the original model. The raw
24884 parameters are expressed in these ``filter'' formulas as
24885 @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)} for @expr{B},
24886 and so on.
24887
24888 When Calc needs to modify the model to return the result, it replaces
24889 @samp{fitdummy(1)} in all the filters with the first item in the raw
24890 parameters list, and so on for the other raw parameters, then
24891 evaluates the resulting filter formulas to get the actual parameter
24892 values to be substituted into the original model. In the case of
24893 @kbd{H a F} and @kbd{I a F} where the parameters must be error forms,
24894 Calc uses the square roots of the diagonal entries of the covariance
24895 matrix as error values for the raw parameters, then lets Calc's
24896 standard error-form arithmetic take it from there.
24897
24898 If you use @kbd{I a F} with a nonlinear model, be sure to remember
24899 that the covariance matrix is in terms of the raw parameters,
24900 @emph{not} the actual requested parameters. It's up to you to
24901 figure out how to interpret the covariances in the presence of
24902 nontrivial filter functions.
24903
24904 Things are also complicated when the input contains error forms.
24905 Suppose there are three independent and dependent variables, @expr{x},
24906 @expr{y}, and @expr{z}, one or more of which are error forms in the
24907 data. Calc combines all the error values by taking the square root
24908 of the sum of the squares of the errors. It then changes @expr{x}
24909 and @expr{y} to be plain numbers, and makes @expr{z} into an error
24910 form with this combined error. The @expr{Y(x,y,z)} part of the
24911 linearized model is evaluated, and the result should be an error
24912 form. The error part of that result is used for
24913 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24914 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24915 for the data point. If for some reason @expr{Y(x,y,z)} does not return
24916 an error form, the combined error from @expr{z} is used directly for
24917 @texline @math{\sigma_i}.
24918 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}.
24919 Finally, @expr{z} is also stripped of its error
24920 for use in computing @expr{F(x,y,z)}, @expr{G(x,y,z)} and so on;
24921 the righthand side of the linearized model is computed in regular
24922 arithmetic with no error forms.
24923
24924 (While these rules may seem complicated, they are designed to do
24925 the most reasonable thing in the typical case that @expr{Y(x,y,z)}
24926 depends only on the dependent variable @expr{z}, and in fact is
24927 often simply equal to @expr{z}. For common cases like polynomials
24928 and multilinear models, the combined error is simply used as the
24929 @texline @math{\sigma}
24930 @infoline @expr{sigma}
24931 for the data point with no further ado.)
24932
24933 @tex
24934 \bigskip
24935 @end tex
24936
24937 @vindex FitRules
24938 It may be the case that the model you wish to use is linearizable,
24939 but Calc's built-in rules are unable to figure it out. Calc uses
24940 its algebraic rewrite mechanism to linearize a model. The rewrite
24941 rules are kept in the variable @code{FitRules}. You can edit this
24942 variable using the @kbd{s e FitRules} command; in fact, there is
24943 a special @kbd{s F} command just for editing @code{FitRules}.
24944 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
24945
24946 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of rewrite rules.
24947
24948 @ignore
24949 @starindex
24950 @end ignore
24951 @tindex fitvar
24952 @ignore
24953 @starindex
24954 @end ignore
24955 @ignore
24956 @mindex @idots
24957 @end ignore
24958 @tindex fitparam
24959 @ignore
24960 @starindex
24961 @end ignore
24962 @ignore
24963 @mindex @null
24964 @end ignore
24965 @tindex fitmodel
24966 @ignore
24967 @starindex
24968 @end ignore
24969 @ignore
24970 @mindex @null
24971 @end ignore
24972 @tindex fitsystem
24973 @ignore
24974 @starindex
24975 @end ignore
24976 @ignore
24977 @mindex @null
24978 @end ignore
24979 @tindex fitdummy
24980 Calc uses @code{FitRules} as follows. First, it converts the model
24981 to an equation if necessary and encloses the model equation in a
24982 call to the function @code{fitmodel} (which is not actually a defined
24983 function in Calc; it is only used as a placeholder by the rewrite rules).
24984 Parameter variables are renamed to function calls @samp{fitparam(1)},
24985 @samp{fitparam(2)}, and so on, and independent variables are renamed
24986 to @samp{fitvar(1)}, @samp{fitvar(2)}, etc. The dependent variable
24987 is the highest-numbered @code{fitvar}. For example, the power law
24988 model @expr{a x^b} is converted to @expr{y = a x^b}, then to
24989
24990 @smallexample
24991 @group
24992 fitmodel(fitvar(2) = fitparam(1) fitvar(1)^fitparam(2))
24993 @end group
24994 @end smallexample
24995
24996 Calc then applies the rewrites as if by @samp{C-u 0 a r FitRules}.
24997 (The zero prefix means that rewriting should continue until no further
24998 changes are possible.)
24999
25000 When rewriting is complete, the @code{fitmodel} call should have
25001 been replaced by a @code{fitsystem} call that looks like this:
25002
25003 @example
25004 fitsystem(@var{Y}, @var{FGH}, @var{abc})
25005 @end example
25006
25007 @noindent
25008 where @var{Y} is a formula that describes the function @expr{Y(x,y,z)},
25009 @var{FGH} is the vector of formulas @expr{[F(x,y,z), G(x,y,z), H(x,y,z)]},
25010 and @var{abc} is the vector of parameter filters which refer to the
25011 raw parameters as @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)}
25012 for @expr{B}, etc. While the number of raw parameters (the length of
25013 the @var{FGH} vector) is usually the same as the number of original
25014 parameters (the length of the @var{abc} vector), this is not required.
25015
25016 The power law model eventually boils down to
25017
25018 @smallexample
25019 @group
25020 fitsystem(ln(fitvar(2)),
25021 [1, ln(fitvar(1))],
25022 [exp(fitdummy(1)), fitdummy(2)])
25023 @end group
25024 @end smallexample
25025
25026 The actual implementation of @code{FitRules} is complicated; it
25027 proceeds in four phases. First, common rearrangements are done
25028 to try to bring linear terms together and to isolate functions like
25029 @code{exp} and @code{ln} either all the way ``out'' (so that they
25030 can be put into @var{Y}) or all the way ``in'' (so that they can
25031 be put into @var{abc} or @var{FGH}). In particular, all
25032 non-constant powers are converted to logs-and-exponentials form,
25033 and the distributive law is used to expand products of sums.
25034 Quotients are rewritten to use the @samp{fitinv} function, where
25035 @samp{fitinv(x)} represents @expr{1/x} while the @code{FitRules}
25036 are operating. (The use of @code{fitinv} makes recognition of
25037 linear-looking forms easier.) If you modify @code{FitRules}, you
25038 will probably only need to modify the rules for this phase.
25039
25040 Phase two, whose rules can actually also apply during phases one
25041 and three, first rewrites @code{fitmodel} to a two-argument
25042 form @samp{fitmodel(@var{Y}, @var{model})}, where @var{Y} is
25043 initially zero and @var{model} has been changed from @expr{a=b}
25044 to @expr{a-b} form. It then tries to peel off invertible functions
25045 from the outside of @var{model} and put them into @var{Y} instead,
25046 calling the equation solver to invert the functions. Finally, when
25047 this is no longer possible, the @code{fitmodel} is changed to a
25048 four-argument @code{fitsystem}, where the fourth argument is
25049 @var{model} and the @var{FGH} and @var{abc} vectors are initially
25050 empty. (The last vector is really @var{ABC}, corresponding to
25051 raw parameters, for now.)
25052
25053 Phase three converts a sum of items in the @var{model} to a sum
25054 of @samp{fitpart(@var{a}, @var{b}, @var{c})} terms which represent
25055 terms @samp{@var{a}*@var{b}*@var{c}} of the sum, where @var{a}
25056 is all factors that do not involve any variables, @var{b} is all
25057 factors that involve only parameters, and @var{c} is the factors
25058 that involve only independent variables. (If this decomposition
25059 is not possible, the rule set will not complete and Calc will
25060 complain that the model is too complex.) Then @code{fitpart}s
25061 with equal @var{b} or @var{c} components are merged back together
25062 using the distributive law in order to minimize the number of
25063 raw parameters needed.
25064
25065 Phase four moves the @code{fitpart} terms into the @var{FGH} and
25066 @var{ABC} vectors. Also, some of the algebraic expansions that
25067 were done in phase 1 are undone now to make the formulas more
25068 computationally efficient. Finally, it calls the solver one more
25069 time to convert the @var{ABC} vector to an @var{abc} vector, and
25070 removes the fourth @var{model} argument (which by now will be zero)
25071 to obtain the three-argument @code{fitsystem} that the linear
25072 least-squares solver wants to see.
25073
25074 @ignore
25075 @starindex
25076 @end ignore
25077 @ignore
25078 @mindex hasfit@idots
25079 @end ignore
25080 @tindex hasfitparams
25081 @ignore
25082 @starindex
25083 @end ignore
25084 @ignore
25085 @mindex @null
25086 @end ignore
25087 @tindex hasfitvars
25088 Two functions which are useful in connection with @code{FitRules}
25089 are @samp{hasfitparams(x)} and @samp{hasfitvars(x)}, which check
25090 whether @expr{x} refers to any parameters or independent variables,
25091 respectively. Specifically, these functions return ``true'' if the
25092 argument contains any @code{fitparam} (or @code{fitvar}) function
25093 calls, and ``false'' otherwise. (Recall that ``true'' means a
25094 nonzero number, and ``false'' means zero. The actual nonzero number
25095 returned is the largest @var{n} from all the @samp{fitparam(@var{n})}s
25096 or @samp{fitvar(@var{n})}s, respectively, that appear in the formula.)
25097
25098 @tex
25099 \bigskip
25100 @end tex
25101
25102 The @code{fit} function in algebraic notation normally takes four
25103 arguments, @samp{fit(@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}, @var{data})},
25104 where @var{model} is the model formula as it would be typed after
25105 @kbd{a F '}, @var{vars} is the independent variable or a vector of
25106 independent variables, @var{params} likewise gives the parameter(s),
25107 and @var{data} is the data matrix. Note that the length of @var{vars}
25108 must be equal to the number of rows in @var{data} if @var{model} is
25109 an equation, or one less than the number of rows if @var{model} is
25110 a plain formula. (Actually, a name for the dependent variable is
25111 allowed but will be ignored in the plain-formula case.)
25112
25113 If @var{params} is omitted, the parameters are all variables in
25114 @var{model} except those that appear in @var{vars}. If @var{vars}
25115 is also omitted, Calc sorts all the variables that appear in
25116 @var{model} alphabetically and uses the higher ones for @var{vars}
25117 and the lower ones for @var{params}.
25118
25119 Alternatively, @samp{fit(@var{modelvec}, @var{data})} is allowed
25120 where @var{modelvec} is a 2- or 3-vector describing the model
25121 and variables, as discussed previously.
25122
25123 If Calc is unable to do the fit, the @code{fit} function is left
25124 in symbolic form, ordinarily with an explanatory message. The
25125 message will be ``Model expression is too complex'' if the
25126 linearizer was unable to put the model into the required form.
25127
25128 The @code{efit} (corresponding to @kbd{H a F}) and @code{xfit}
25129 (for @kbd{I a F}) functions are completely analogous.
25130
25131 @node Interpolation, , Curve Fitting Details, Curve Fitting
25132 @subsection Polynomial Interpolation
25133
25134 @kindex a p
25135 @pindex calc-poly-interp
25136 @tindex polint
25137 The @kbd{a p} (@code{calc-poly-interp}) [@code{polint}] command does
25138 a polynomial interpolation at a particular @expr{x} value. It takes
25139 two arguments from the stack: A data matrix of the sort used by
25140 @kbd{a F}, and a single number which represents the desired @expr{x}
25141 value. Calc effectively does an exact polynomial fit as if by @kbd{a F i},
25142 then substitutes the @expr{x} value into the result in order to get an
25143 approximate @expr{y} value based on the fit. (Calc does not actually
25144 use @kbd{a F i}, however; it uses a direct method which is both more
25145 efficient and more numerically stable.)
25146
25147 The result of @kbd{a p} is actually a vector of two values: The @expr{y}
25148 value approximation, and an error measure @expr{dy} that reflects Calc's
25149 estimation of the probable error of the approximation at that value of
25150 @expr{x}. If the input @expr{x} is equal to any of the @expr{x} values
25151 in the data matrix, the output @expr{y} will be the corresponding @expr{y}
25152 value from the matrix, and the output @expr{dy} will be exactly zero.
25153
25154 A prefix argument of 2 causes @kbd{a p} to take separate x- and
25155 y-vectors from the stack instead of one data matrix.
25156
25157 If @expr{x} is a vector of numbers, @kbd{a p} will return a matrix of
25158 interpolated results for each of those @expr{x} values. (The matrix will
25159 have two columns, the @expr{y} values and the @expr{dy} values.)
25160 If @expr{x} is a formula instead of a number, the @code{polint} function
25161 remains in symbolic form; use the @kbd{a "} command to expand it out to
25162 a formula that describes the fit in symbolic terms.
25163
25164 In all cases, the @kbd{a p} command leaves the data vectors or matrix
25165 on the stack. Only the @expr{x} value is replaced by the result.
25166
25167 @kindex H a p
25168 @tindex ratint
25169 The @kbd{H a p} [@code{ratint}] command does a rational function
25170 interpolation. It is used exactly like @kbd{a p}, except that it
25171 uses as its model the quotient of two polynomials. If there are
25172 @expr{N} data points, the numerator and denominator polynomials will
25173 each have degree @expr{N/2} (if @expr{N} is odd, the denominator will
25174 have degree one higher than the numerator).
25175
25176 Rational approximations have the advantage that they can accurately
25177 describe functions that have poles (points at which the function's value
25178 goes to infinity, so that the denominator polynomial of the approximation
25179 goes to zero). If @expr{x} corresponds to a pole of the fitted rational
25180 function, then the result will be a division by zero. If Infinite mode
25181 is enabled, the result will be @samp{[uinf, uinf]}.
25182
25183 There is no way to get the actual coefficients of the rational function
25184 used by @kbd{H a p}. (The algorithm never generates these coefficients
25185 explicitly, and quotients of polynomials are beyond @w{@kbd{a F}}'s
25186 capabilities to fit.)
25187
25188 @node Summations, Logical Operations, Curve Fitting, Algebra
25189 @section Summations
25190
25191 @noindent
25192 @cindex Summation of a series
25193 @kindex a +
25194 @pindex calc-summation
25195 @tindex sum
25196 The @kbd{a +} (@code{calc-summation}) [@code{sum}] command computes
25197 the sum of a formula over a certain range of index values. The formula
25198 is taken from the top of the stack; the command prompts for the
25199 name of the summation index variable, the lower limit of the
25200 sum (any formula), and the upper limit of the sum. If you
25201 enter a blank line at any of these prompts, that prompt and
25202 any later ones are answered by reading additional elements from
25203 the stack. Thus, @kbd{' k^2 @key{RET} ' k @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 5 @key{RET} a + @key{RET}}
25204 produces the result 55.
25205 @tex
25206 \turnoffactive
25207 $$ \sum_{k=1}^5 k^2 = 55 $$
25208 @end tex
25209
25210 The choice of index variable is arbitrary, but it's best not to
25211 use a variable with a stored value. In particular, while
25212 @code{i} is often a favorite index variable, it should be avoided
25213 in Calc because @code{i} has the imaginary constant @expr{(0, 1)}
25214 as a value. If you pressed @kbd{=} on a sum over @code{i}, it would
25215 be changed to a nonsensical sum over the ``variable'' @expr{(0, 1)}!
25216 If you really want to use @code{i} as an index variable, use
25217 @w{@kbd{s u i @key{RET}}} first to ``unstore'' this variable.
25218 (@xref{Storing Variables}.)
25219
25220 A numeric prefix argument steps the index by that amount rather
25221 than by one. Thus @kbd{' a_k @key{RET} C-u -2 a + k @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 0 @key{RET}}
25222 yields @samp{a_10 + a_8 + a_6 + a_4 + a_2 + a_0}. A prefix
25223 argument of plain @kbd{C-u} causes @kbd{a +} to prompt for the
25224 step value, in which case you can enter any formula or enter
25225 a blank line to take the step value from the stack. With the
25226 @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{a +} can take up to five arguments from
25227 the stack: The formula, the variable, the lower limit, the
25228 upper limit, and (at the top of the stack), the step value.
25229
25230 Calc knows how to do certain sums in closed form. For example,
25231 @samp{sum(6 k^2, k, 1, n) = @w{2 n^3} + 3 n^2 + n}. In particular,
25232 this is possible if the formula being summed is polynomial or
25233 exponential in the index variable. Sums of logarithms are
25234 transformed into logarithms of products. Sums of trigonometric
25235 and hyperbolic functions are transformed to sums of exponentials
25236 and then done in closed form. Also, of course, sums in which the
25237 lower and upper limits are both numbers can always be evaluated
25238 just by grinding them out, although Calc will use closed forms
25239 whenever it can for the sake of efficiency.
25240
25241 The notation for sums in algebraic formulas is
25242 @samp{sum(@var{expr}, @var{var}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{step})}.
25243 If @var{step} is omitted, it defaults to one. If @var{high} is
25244 omitted, @var{low} is actually the upper limit and the lower limit
25245 is one. If @var{low} is also omitted, the limits are @samp{-inf}
25246 and @samp{inf}, respectively.
25247
25248 Infinite sums can sometimes be evaluated: @samp{sum(.5^k, k, 1, inf)}
25249 returns @expr{1}. This is done by evaluating the sum in closed
25250 form (to @samp{1. - 0.5^n} in this case), then evaluating this
25251 formula with @code{n} set to @code{inf}. Calc's usual rules
25252 for ``infinite'' arithmetic can find the answer from there. If
25253 infinite arithmetic yields a @samp{nan}, or if the sum cannot be
25254 solved in closed form, Calc leaves the @code{sum} function in
25255 symbolic form. @xref{Infinities}.
25256
25257 As a special feature, if the limits are infinite (or omitted, as
25258 described above) but the formula includes vectors subscripted by
25259 expressions that involve the iteration variable, Calc narrows
25260 the limits to include only the range of integers which result in
25261 legal subscripts for the vector. For example, the sum
25262 @samp{sum(k [a,b,c,d,e,f,g]_(2k),k)} evaluates to @samp{b + 2 d + 3 f}.
25263
25264 The limits of a sum do not need to be integers. For example,
25265 @samp{sum(a_k, k, 0, 2 n, n)} produces @samp{a_0 + a_n + a_(2 n)}.
25266 Calc computes the number of iterations using the formula
25267 @samp{1 + (@var{high} - @var{low}) / @var{step}}, which must,
25268 after simplification as if by @kbd{a s}, evaluate to an integer.
25269
25270 If the number of iterations according to the above formula does
25271 not come out to an integer, the sum is illegal and will be left
25272 in symbolic form. However, closed forms are still supplied, and
25273 you are on your honor not to misuse the resulting formulas by
25274 substituting mismatched bounds into them. For example,
25275 @samp{sum(k, k, 1, 10, 2)} is invalid, but Calc will go ahead and
25276 evaluate the closed form solution for the limits 1 and 10 to get
25277 the rather dubious answer, 29.25.
25278
25279 If the lower limit is greater than the upper limit (assuming a
25280 positive step size), the result is generally zero. However,
25281 Calc only guarantees a zero result when the upper limit is
25282 exactly one step less than the lower limit, i.e., if the number
25283 of iterations is @mathit{-1}. Thus @samp{sum(f(k), k, n, n-1)} is zero
25284 but the sum from @samp{n} to @samp{n-2} may report a nonzero value
25285 if Calc used a closed form solution.
25286
25287 Calc's logical predicates like @expr{a < b} return 1 for ``true''
25288 and 0 for ``false.'' @xref{Logical Operations}. This can be
25289 used to advantage for building conditional sums. For example,
25290 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k, 1, 20)} is the sum of the squares of all
25291 prime numbers from 1 to 20; the @code{prime} predicate returns 1 if
25292 its argument is prime and 0 otherwise. You can read this expression
25293 as ``the sum of @expr{k^2}, where @expr{k} is prime.'' Indeed,
25294 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k)} would represent the sum of @emph{all} primes
25295 squared, since the limits default to plus and minus infinity, but
25296 there are no such sums that Calc's built-in rules can do in
25297 closed form.
25298
25299 As another example, @samp{sum((k != k_0) * f(k), k, 1, n)} is the
25300 sum of @expr{f(k)} for all @expr{k} from 1 to @expr{n}, excluding
25301 one value @expr{k_0}. Slightly more tricky is the summand
25302 @samp{(k != k_0) / (k - k_0)}, which is an attempt to describe
25303 the sum of all @expr{1/(k-k_0)} except at @expr{k = k_0}, where
25304 this would be a division by zero. But at @expr{k = k_0}, this
25305 formula works out to the indeterminate form @expr{0 / 0}, which
25306 Calc will not assume is zero. Better would be to use
25307 @samp{(k != k_0) ? 1/(k-k_0) : 0}; the @samp{? :} operator does
25308 an ``if-then-else'' test: This expression says, ``if
25309 @texline @math{k \ne k_0},
25310 @infoline @expr{k != k_0},
25311 then @expr{1/(k-k_0)}, else zero.'' Now the formula @expr{1/(k-k_0)}
25312 will not even be evaluated by Calc when @expr{k = k_0}.
25313
25314 @cindex Alternating sums
25315 @kindex a -
25316 @pindex calc-alt-summation
25317 @tindex asum
25318 The @kbd{a -} (@code{calc-alt-summation}) [@code{asum}] command
25319 computes an alternating sum. Successive terms of the sequence
25320 are given alternating signs, with the first term (corresponding
25321 to the lower index value) being positive. Alternating sums
25322 are converted to normal sums with an extra term of the form
25323 @samp{(-1)^(k-@var{low})}. This formula is adjusted appropriately
25324 if the step value is other than one. For example, the Taylor
25325 series for the sine function is @samp{asum(x^k / k!, k, 1, inf, 2)}.
25326 (Calc cannot evaluate this infinite series, but it can approximate
25327 it if you replace @code{inf} with any particular odd number.)
25328 Calc converts this series to a regular sum with a step of one,
25329 namely @samp{sum((-1)^k x^(2k+1) / (2k+1)!, k, 0, inf)}.
25330
25331 @cindex Product of a sequence
25332 @kindex a *
25333 @pindex calc-product
25334 @tindex prod
25335 The @kbd{a *} (@code{calc-product}) [@code{prod}] command is
25336 the analogous way to take a product of many terms. Calc also knows
25337 some closed forms for products, such as @samp{prod(k, k, 1, n) = n!}.
25338 Conditional products can be written @samp{prod(k^prime(k), k, 1, n)}
25339 or @samp{prod(prime(k) ? k : 1, k, 1, n)}.
25340
25341 @kindex a T
25342 @pindex calc-tabulate
25343 @tindex table
25344 The @kbd{a T} (@code{calc-tabulate}) [@code{table}] command
25345 evaluates a formula at a series of iterated index values, just
25346 like @code{sum} and @code{prod}, but its result is simply a
25347 vector of the results. For example, @samp{table(a_i, i, 1, 7, 2)}
25348 produces @samp{[a_1, a_3, a_5, a_7]}.
25349
25350 @node Logical Operations, Rewrite Rules, Summations, Algebra
25351 @section Logical Operations
25352
25353 @noindent
25354 The following commands and algebraic functions return true/false values,
25355 where 1 represents ``true'' and 0 represents ``false.'' In cases where
25356 a truth value is required (such as for the condition part of a rewrite
25357 rule, or as the condition for a @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} control structure), any
25358 nonzero value is accepted to mean ``true.'' (Specifically, anything
25359 for which @code{dnonzero} returns 1 is ``true,'' and anything for
25360 which @code{dnonzero} returns 0 or cannot decide is assumed ``false.''
25361 Note that this means that @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} will execute the ``then''
25362 portion if its condition is provably true, but it will execute the
25363 ``else'' portion for any condition like @expr{a = b} that is not
25364 provably true, even if it might be true. Algebraic functions that
25365 have conditions as arguments, like @code{? :} and @code{&&}, remain
25366 unevaluated if the condition is neither provably true nor provably
25367 false. @xref{Declarations}.)
25368
25369 @kindex a =
25370 @pindex calc-equal-to
25371 @tindex eq
25372 @tindex =
25373 @tindex ==
25374 The @kbd{a =} (@code{calc-equal-to}) command, or @samp{eq(a,b)} function
25375 (which can also be written @samp{a = b} or @samp{a == b} in an algebraic
25376 formula) is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are equal, either because they
25377 are identical expressions, or because they are numbers which are
25378 numerically equal. (Thus the integer 1 is considered equal to the float
25379 1.0.) If the equality of @expr{a} and @expr{b} cannot be determined,
25380 the comparison is left in symbolic form. Note that as a command, this
25381 operation pops two values from the stack and pushes back either a 1 or
25382 a 0, or a formula @samp{a = b} if the values' equality cannot be determined.
25383
25384 Many Calc commands use @samp{=} formulas to represent @dfn{equations}.
25385 For example, the @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) command rearranges
25386 an equation to solve for a given variable. The @kbd{a M}
25387 (@code{calc-map-equation}) command can be used to apply any
25388 function to both sides of an equation; for example, @kbd{2 a M *}
25389 multiplies both sides of the equation by two. Note that just
25390 @kbd{2 *} would not do the same thing; it would produce the formula
25391 @samp{2 (a = b)} which represents 2 if the equality is true or
25392 zero if not.
25393
25394 The @code{eq} function with more than two arguments (e.g., @kbd{C-u 3 a =}
25395 or @samp{a = b = c}) tests if all of its arguments are equal. In
25396 algebraic notation, the @samp{=} operator is unusual in that it is
25397 neither left- nor right-associative: @samp{a = b = c} is not the
25398 same as @samp{(a = b) = c} or @samp{a = (b = c)} (which each compare
25399 one variable with the 1 or 0 that results from comparing two other
25400 variables).
25401
25402 @kindex a #
25403 @pindex calc-not-equal-to
25404 @tindex neq
25405 @tindex !=
25406 The @kbd{a #} (@code{calc-not-equal-to}) command, or @samp{neq(a,b)} or
25407 @samp{a != b} function, is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are not equal.
25408 This also works with more than two arguments; @samp{a != b != c != d}
25409 tests that all four of @expr{a}, @expr{b}, @expr{c}, and @expr{d} are
25410 distinct numbers.
25411
25412 @kindex a <
25413 @tindex lt
25414 @ignore
25415 @mindex @idots
25416 @end ignore
25417 @kindex a >
25418 @ignore
25419 @mindex @null
25420 @end ignore
25421 @kindex a [
25422 @ignore
25423 @mindex @null
25424 @end ignore
25425 @kindex a ]
25426 @pindex calc-less-than
25427 @pindex calc-greater-than
25428 @pindex calc-less-equal
25429 @pindex calc-greater-equal
25430 @ignore
25431 @mindex @null
25432 @end ignore
25433 @tindex gt
25434 @ignore
25435 @mindex @null
25436 @end ignore
25437 @tindex leq
25438 @ignore
25439 @mindex @null
25440 @end ignore
25441 @tindex geq
25442 @ignore
25443 @mindex @null
25444 @end ignore
25445 @tindex <
25446 @ignore
25447 @mindex @null
25448 @end ignore
25449 @tindex >
25450 @ignore
25451 @mindex @null
25452 @end ignore
25453 @tindex <=
25454 @ignore
25455 @mindex @null
25456 @end ignore
25457 @tindex >=
25458 The @kbd{a <} (@code{calc-less-than}) [@samp{lt(a,b)} or @samp{a < b}]
25459 operation is true if @expr{a} is less than @expr{b}. Similar functions
25460 are @kbd{a >} (@code{calc-greater-than}) [@samp{gt(a,b)} or @samp{a > b}],
25461 @kbd{a [} (@code{calc-less-equal}) [@samp{leq(a,b)} or @samp{a <= b}], and
25462 @kbd{a ]} (@code{calc-greater-equal}) [@samp{geq(a,b)} or @samp{a >= b}].
25463
25464 While the inequality functions like @code{lt} do not accept more
25465 than two arguments, the syntax @w{@samp{a <= b < c}} is translated to an
25466 equivalent expression involving intervals: @samp{b in [a .. c)}.
25467 (See the description of @code{in} below.) All four combinations
25468 of @samp{<} and @samp{<=} are allowed, or any of the four combinations
25469 of @samp{>} and @samp{>=}. Four-argument constructions like
25470 @samp{a < b < c < d}, and mixtures like @w{@samp{a < b = c}} that
25471 involve both equalities and inequalities, are not allowed.
25472
25473 @kindex a .
25474 @pindex calc-remove-equal
25475 @tindex rmeq
25476 The @kbd{a .} (@code{calc-remove-equal}) [@code{rmeq}] command extracts
25477 the righthand side of the equation or inequality on the top of the
25478 stack. It also works elementwise on vectors. For example, if
25479 @samp{[x = 2.34, y = z / 2]} is on the stack, then @kbd{a .} produces
25480 @samp{[2.34, z / 2]}. As a special case, if the righthand side is a
25481 variable and the lefthand side is a number (as in @samp{2.34 = x}), then
25482 Calc keeps the lefthand side instead. Finally, this command works with
25483 assignments @samp{x := 2.34} as well as equations, always taking the
25484 the righthand side, and for @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operators, always
25485 taking the lefthand side.
25486
25487 @kindex a &
25488 @pindex calc-logical-and
25489 @tindex land
25490 @tindex &&
25491 The @kbd{a &} (@code{calc-logical-and}) [@samp{land(a,b)} or @samp{a && b}]
25492 function is true if both of its arguments are true, i.e., are
25493 non-zero numbers. In this case, the result will be either @expr{a} or
25494 @expr{b}, chosen arbitrarily. If either argument is zero, the result is
25495 zero. Otherwise, the formula is left in symbolic form.
25496
25497 @kindex a |
25498 @pindex calc-logical-or
25499 @tindex lor
25500 @tindex ||
25501 The @kbd{a |} (@code{calc-logical-or}) [@samp{lor(a,b)} or @samp{a || b}]
25502 function is true if either or both of its arguments are true (nonzero).
25503 The result is whichever argument was nonzero, choosing arbitrarily if both
25504 are nonzero. If both @expr{a} and @expr{b} are zero, the result is
25505 zero.
25506
25507 @kindex a !
25508 @pindex calc-logical-not
25509 @tindex lnot
25510 @tindex !
25511 The @kbd{a !} (@code{calc-logical-not}) [@samp{lnot(a)} or @samp{!@: a}]
25512 function is true if @expr{a} is false (zero), or false if @expr{a} is
25513 true (nonzero). It is left in symbolic form if @expr{a} is not a
25514 number.
25515
25516 @kindex a :
25517 @pindex calc-logical-if
25518 @tindex if
25519 @ignore
25520 @mindex ? :
25521 @end ignore
25522 @tindex ?
25523 @ignore
25524 @mindex @null
25525 @end ignore
25526 @tindex :
25527 @cindex Arguments, not evaluated
25528 The @kbd{a :} (@code{calc-logical-if}) [@samp{if(a,b,c)} or @samp{a ? b :@: c}]
25529 function is equal to either @expr{b} or @expr{c} if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25530 number or zero, respectively. If @expr{a} is not a number, the test is
25531 left in symbolic form and neither @expr{b} nor @expr{c} is evaluated in
25532 any way. In algebraic formulas, this is one of the few Calc functions
25533 whose arguments are not automatically evaluated when the function itself
25534 is evaluated. The others are @code{lambda}, @code{quote}, and
25535 @code{condition}.
25536
25537 One minor surprise to watch out for is that the formula @samp{a?3:4}
25538 will not work because the @samp{3:4} is parsed as a fraction instead of
25539 as three separate symbols. Type something like @samp{a ? 3 : 4} or
25540 @samp{a?(3):4} instead.
25541
25542 As a special case, if @expr{a} evaluates to a vector, then both @expr{b}
25543 and @expr{c} are evaluated; the result is a vector of the same length
25544 as @expr{a} whose elements are chosen from corresponding elements of
25545 @expr{b} and @expr{c} according to whether each element of @expr{a}
25546 is zero or nonzero. Each of @expr{b} and @expr{c} must be either a
25547 vector of the same length as @expr{a}, or a non-vector which is matched
25548 with all elements of @expr{a}.
25549
25550 @kindex a @{
25551 @pindex calc-in-set
25552 @tindex in
25553 The @kbd{a @{} (@code{calc-in-set}) [@samp{in(a,b)}] function is true if
25554 the number @expr{a} is in the set of numbers represented by @expr{b}.
25555 If @expr{b} is an interval form, @expr{a} must be one of the values
25556 encompassed by the interval. If @expr{b} is a vector, @expr{a} must be
25557 equal to one of the elements of the vector. (If any vector elements are
25558 intervals, @expr{a} must be in any of the intervals.) If @expr{b} is a
25559 plain number, @expr{a} must be numerically equal to @expr{b}.
25560 @xref{Set Operations}, for a group of commands that manipulate sets
25561 of this sort.
25562
25563 @ignore
25564 @starindex
25565 @end ignore
25566 @tindex typeof
25567 The @samp{typeof(a)} function produces an integer or variable which
25568 characterizes @expr{a}. If @expr{a} is a number, vector, or variable,
25569 the result will be one of the following numbers:
25570
25571 @example
25572 1 Integer
25573 2 Fraction
25574 3 Floating-point number
25575 4 HMS form
25576 5 Rectangular complex number
25577 6 Polar complex number
25578 7 Error form
25579 8 Interval form
25580 9 Modulo form
25581 10 Date-only form
25582 11 Date/time form
25583 12 Infinity (inf, uinf, or nan)
25584 100 Variable
25585 101 Vector (but not a matrix)
25586 102 Matrix
25587 @end example
25588
25589 Otherwise, @expr{a} is a formula, and the result is a variable which
25590 represents the name of the top-level function call.
25591
25592 @ignore
25593 @starindex
25594 @end ignore
25595 @tindex integer
25596 @ignore
25597 @starindex
25598 @end ignore
25599 @tindex real
25600 @ignore
25601 @starindex
25602 @end ignore
25603 @tindex constant
25604 The @samp{integer(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is an integer.
25605 The @samp{real(a)} function
25606 is true if @expr{a} is a real number, either integer, fraction, or
25607 float. The @samp{constant(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is
25608 any of the objects for which @code{typeof} would produce an integer
25609 code result except for variables, and provided that the components of
25610 an object like a vector or error form are themselves constant.
25611 Note that infinities do not satisfy any of these tests, nor do
25612 special constants like @code{pi} and @code{e}.
25613
25614 @xref{Declarations}, for a set of similar functions that recognize
25615 formulas as well as actual numbers. For example, @samp{dint(floor(x))}
25616 is true because @samp{floor(x)} is provably integer-valued, but
25617 @samp{integer(floor(x))} does not because @samp{floor(x)} is not
25618 literally an integer constant.
25619
25620 @ignore
25621 @starindex
25622 @end ignore
25623 @tindex refers
25624 The @samp{refers(a,b)} function is true if the variable (or sub-expression)
25625 @expr{b} appears in @expr{a}, or false otherwise. Unlike the other
25626 tests described here, this function returns a definite ``no'' answer
25627 even if its arguments are still in symbolic form. The only case where
25628 @code{refers} will be left unevaluated is if @expr{a} is a plain
25629 variable (different from @expr{b}).
25630
25631 @ignore
25632 @starindex
25633 @end ignore
25634 @tindex negative
25635 The @samp{negative(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} ``looks'' negative,
25636 because it is a negative number, because it is of the form @expr{-x},
25637 or because it is a product or quotient with a term that looks negative.
25638 This is most useful in rewrite rules. Beware that @samp{negative(a)}
25639 evaluates to 1 or 0 for @emph{any} argument @expr{a}, so it can only
25640 be stored in a formula if the default simplifications are turned off
25641 first with @kbd{m O} (or if it appears in an unevaluated context such
25642 as a rewrite rule condition).
25643
25644 @ignore
25645 @starindex
25646 @end ignore
25647 @tindex variable
25648 The @samp{variable(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a variable,
25649 or false if not. If @expr{a} is a function call, this test is left
25650 in symbolic form. Built-in variables like @code{pi} and @code{inf}
25651 are considered variables like any others by this test.
25652
25653 @ignore
25654 @starindex
25655 @end ignore
25656 @tindex nonvar
25657 The @samp{nonvar(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a non-variable.
25658 If its argument is a variable it is left unsimplified; it never
25659 actually returns zero. However, since Calc's condition-testing
25660 commands consider ``false'' anything not provably true, this is
25661 often good enough.
25662
25663 @ignore
25664 @starindex
25665 @end ignore
25666 @tindex lin
25667 @ignore
25668 @starindex
25669 @end ignore
25670 @tindex linnt
25671 @ignore
25672 @starindex
25673 @end ignore
25674 @tindex islin
25675 @ignore
25676 @starindex
25677 @end ignore
25678 @tindex islinnt
25679 @cindex Linearity testing
25680 The functions @code{lin}, @code{linnt}, @code{islin}, and @code{islinnt}
25681 check if an expression is ``linear,'' i.e., can be written in the form
25682 @expr{a + b x} for some constants @expr{a} and @expr{b}, and some
25683 variable or subformula @expr{x}. The function @samp{islin(f,x)} checks
25684 if formula @expr{f} is linear in @expr{x}, returning 1 if so. For
25685 example, @samp{islin(x,x)}, @samp{islin(-x,x)}, @samp{islin(3,x)}, and
25686 @samp{islin(x y / 3 - 2, x)} all return 1. The @samp{lin(f,x)} function
25687 is similar, except that instead of returning 1 it returns the vector
25688 @expr{[a, b, x]}. For the above examples, this vector would be
25689 @expr{[0, 1, x]}, @expr{[0, -1, x]}, @expr{[3, 0, x]}, and
25690 @expr{[-2, y/3, x]}, respectively. Both @code{lin} and @code{islin}
25691 generally remain unevaluated for expressions which are not linear,
25692 e.g., @samp{lin(2 x^2, x)} and @samp{lin(sin(x), x)}. The second
25693 argument can also be a formula; @samp{islin(2 + 3 sin(x), sin(x))}
25694 returns true.
25695
25696 The @code{linnt} and @code{islinnt} functions perform a similar check,
25697 but require a ``non-trivial'' linear form, which means that the
25698 @expr{b} coefficient must be non-zero. For example, @samp{lin(2,x)}
25699 returns @expr{[2, 0, x]} and @samp{lin(y,x)} returns @expr{[y, 0, x]},
25700 but @samp{linnt(2,x)} and @samp{linnt(y,x)} are left unevaluated
25701 (in other words, these formulas are considered to be only ``trivially''
25702 linear in @expr{x}).
25703
25704 All four linearity-testing functions allow you to omit the second
25705 argument, in which case the input may be linear in any non-constant
25706 formula. Here, the @expr{a=0}, @expr{b=1} case is also considered
25707 trivial, and only constant values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} are
25708 recognized. Thus, @samp{lin(2 x y)} returns @expr{[0, 2, x y]},
25709 @samp{lin(2 - x y)} returns @expr{[2, -1, x y]}, and @samp{lin(x y)}
25710 returns @expr{[0, 1, x y]}. The @code{linnt} function would allow the
25711 first two cases but not the third. Also, neither @code{lin} nor
25712 @code{linnt} accept plain constants as linear in the one-argument
25713 case: @samp{islin(2,x)} is true, but @samp{islin(2)} is false.
25714
25715 @ignore
25716 @starindex
25717 @end ignore
25718 @tindex istrue
25719 The @samp{istrue(a)} function returns 1 if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25720 number or provably nonzero formula, or 0 if @expr{a} is anything else.
25721 Calls to @code{istrue} can only be manipulated if @kbd{m O} mode is
25722 used to make sure they are not evaluated prematurely. (Note that
25723 declarations are used when deciding whether a formula is true;
25724 @code{istrue} returns 1 when @code{dnonzero} would return 1, and
25725 it returns 0 when @code{dnonzero} would return 0 or leave itself
25726 in symbolic form.)
25727
25728 @node Rewrite Rules, , Logical Operations, Algebra
25729 @section Rewrite Rules
25730
25731 @noindent
25732 @cindex Rewrite rules
25733 @cindex Transformations
25734 @cindex Pattern matching
25735 @kindex a r
25736 @pindex calc-rewrite
25737 @tindex rewrite
25738 The @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) [@code{rewrite}] command makes
25739 substitutions in a formula according to a specified pattern or patterns
25740 known as @dfn{rewrite rules}. Whereas @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
25741 matches literally, so that substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(x)}
25742 matches only the @code{sin} function applied to the variable @code{x},
25743 rewrite rules match general kinds of formulas; rewriting using the rule
25744 @samp{sin(x) := cos(x)} matches @code{sin} of any argument and replaces
25745 it with @code{cos} of that same argument. The only significance of the
25746 name @code{x} is that the same name is used on both sides of the rule.
25747
25748 Rewrite rules rearrange formulas already in Calc's memory.
25749 @xref{Syntax Tables}, to read about @dfn{syntax rules}, which are
25750 similar to algebraic rewrite rules but operate when new algebraic
25751 entries are being parsed, converting strings of characters into
25752 Calc formulas.
25753
25754 @menu
25755 * Entering Rewrite Rules::
25756 * Basic Rewrite Rules::
25757 * Conditional Rewrite Rules::
25758 * Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules::
25759 * Other Features of Rewrite Rules::
25760 * Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules::
25761 * Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules::
25762 * Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules::
25763 * Selections with Rewrite Rules::
25764 * Matching Commands::
25765 * Automatic Rewrites::
25766 * Debugging Rewrites::
25767 * Examples of Rewrite Rules::
25768 @end menu
25769
25770 @node Entering Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25771 @subsection Entering Rewrite Rules
25772
25773 @noindent
25774 Rewrite rules normally use the ``assignment'' operator
25775 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}.
25776 This operator is equivalent to the function call @samp{assign(old, new)}.
25777 The @code{assign} function is undefined by itself in Calc, so an
25778 assignment formula such as a rewrite rule will be left alone by ordinary
25779 Calc commands. But certain commands, like the rewrite system, interpret
25780 assignments in special ways.
25781
25782 For example, the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1-cos(x)^2} says to replace
25783 every occurrence of the sine of something, squared, with one minus the
25784 square of the cosine of that same thing. All by itself as a formula
25785 on the stack it does nothing, but when given to the @kbd{a r} command
25786 it turns that command into a sine-squared-to-cosine-squared converter.
25787
25788 To specify a set of rules to be applied all at once, make a vector of
25789 rules.
25790
25791 When @kbd{a r} prompts you to enter the rewrite rules, you can answer
25792 in several ways:
25793
25794 @enumerate
25795 @item
25796 With a rule: @kbd{f(x) := g(x) @key{RET}}.
25797 @item
25798 With a vector of rules: @kbd{[f1(x) := g1(x), f2(x) := g2(x)] @key{RET}}.
25799 (You can omit the enclosing square brackets if you wish.)
25800 @item
25801 With the name of a variable that contains the rule or rules vector:
25802 @kbd{myrules @key{RET}}.
25803 @item
25804 With any formula except a rule, a vector, or a variable name; this
25805 will be interpreted as the @var{old} half of a rewrite rule,
25806 and you will be prompted a second time for the @var{new} half:
25807 @kbd{f(x) @key{RET} g(x) @key{RET}}.
25808 @item
25809 With a blank line, in which case the rule, rules vector, or variable
25810 will be taken from the top of the stack (and the formula to be
25811 rewritten will come from the second-to-top position).
25812 @end enumerate
25813
25814 If you enter the rules directly (as opposed to using rules stored
25815 in a variable), those rules will be put into the Trail so that you
25816 can retrieve them later. @xref{Trail Commands}.
25817
25818 It is most convenient to store rules you use often in a variable and
25819 invoke them by giving the variable name. The @kbd{s e}
25820 (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command is an easy way to create or edit a
25821 rule set stored in a variable. You may also wish to use @kbd{s p}
25822 (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) to save your rules permanently;
25823 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
25824
25825 Rewrite rules are compiled into a special internal form for faster
25826 matching. If you enter a rule set directly it must be recompiled
25827 every time. If you store the rules in a variable and refer to them
25828 through that variable, they will be compiled once and saved away
25829 along with the variable for later reference. This is another good
25830 reason to store your rules in a variable.
25831
25832 Calc also accepts an obsolete notation for rules, as vectors
25833 @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}]}. But because it is easily confused with a
25834 vector of two rules, the use of this notation is no longer recommended.
25835
25836 @node Basic Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Entering Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25837 @subsection Basic Rewrite Rules
25838
25839 @noindent
25840 To match a particular formula @expr{x} with a particular rewrite rule
25841 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}, Calc compares the structure of @expr{x} with
25842 the structure of @var{old}. Variables that appear in @var{old} are
25843 treated as @dfn{meta-variables}; the corresponding positions in @expr{x}
25844 may contain any sub-formulas. For example, the pattern @samp{f(x,y)}
25845 would match the expression @samp{f(12, a+1)} with the meta-variable
25846 @samp{x} corresponding to 12 and with @samp{y} corresponding to
25847 @samp{a+1}. However, this pattern would not match @samp{f(12)} or
25848 @samp{g(12, a+1)}, since there is no assignment of the meta-variables
25849 that will make the pattern match these expressions. Notice that if
25850 the pattern is a single meta-variable, it will match any expression.
25851
25852 If a given meta-variable appears more than once in @var{old}, the
25853 corresponding sub-formulas of @expr{x} must be identical. Thus
25854 the pattern @samp{f(x,x)} would match @samp{f(12, 12)} and
25855 @samp{f(a+1, a+1)} but not @samp{f(12, a+1)} or @samp{f(a+b, b+a)}.
25856 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for a way to match the latter.)
25857
25858 Things other than variables must match exactly between the pattern
25859 and the target formula. To match a particular variable exactly, use
25860 the pseudo-function @samp{quote(v)} in the pattern. For example, the
25861 pattern @samp{x+quote(y)} matches @samp{x+y}, @samp{2+y}, or
25862 @samp{sin(a)+y}.
25863
25864 The special variable names @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi},
25865 @samp{gamma}, @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} always match
25866 literally. Thus the pattern @samp{sin(d + e + f)} acts exactly like
25867 @samp{sin(d + quote(e) + f)}.
25868
25869 If the @var{old} pattern is found to match a given formula, that
25870 formula is replaced by @var{new}, where any occurrences in @var{new}
25871 of meta-variables from the pattern are replaced with the sub-formulas
25872 that they matched. Thus, applying the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x)}
25873 to @samp{f(12, a+1)} would produce @samp{g(a+13, 12)}.
25874
25875 The normal @kbd{a r} command applies rewrite rules over and over
25876 throughout the target formula until no further changes are possible
25877 (up to a limit of 100 times). Use @kbd{C-u 1 a r} to make only one
25878 change at a time.
25879
25880 @node Conditional Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25881 @subsection Conditional Rewrite Rules
25882
25883 @noindent
25884 A rewrite rule can also be @dfn{conditional}, written in the form
25885 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}}. (There is also the obsolete
25886 form @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}, @var{cond}]}.) If a @var{cond} part
25887 is present in the
25888 rule, this is an additional condition that must be satisfied before
25889 the rule is accepted. Once @var{old} has been successfully matched
25890 to the target expression, @var{cond} is evaluated (with all the
25891 meta-variables substituted for the values they matched) and simplified
25892 with @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}). If the result is a nonzero
25893 number or any other object known to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}),
25894 the rule is accepted. If the result is zero or if it is a symbolic
25895 formula that is not known to be nonzero, the rule is rejected.
25896 @xref{Logical Operations}, for a number of functions that return
25897 1 or 0 according to the results of various tests.
25898
25899 For example, the formula @samp{n > 0} simplifies to 1 or 0 if @expr{n}
25900 is replaced by a positive or nonpositive number, respectively (or if
25901 @expr{n} has been declared to be positive or nonpositive). Thus,
25902 the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x) :: x+y > 0} would apply to
25903 @samp{f(0, 4)} but not to @samp{f(-3, 2)} or @samp{f(12, a+1)}
25904 (assuming no outstanding declarations for @expr{a}). In the case of
25905 @samp{f(-3, 2)}, the condition can be shown not to be satisfied; in
25906 the case of @samp{f(12, a+1)}, the condition merely cannot be shown
25907 to be satisfied, but that is enough to reject the rule.
25908
25909 While Calc will use declarations to reason about variables in the
25910 formula being rewritten, declarations do not apply to meta-variables.
25911 For example, the rule @samp{f(a) := g(a+1)} will match for any values
25912 of @samp{a}, such as complex numbers, vectors, or formulas, even if
25913 @samp{a} has been declared to be real or scalar. If you want the
25914 meta-variable @samp{a} to match only literal real numbers, use
25915 @samp{f(a) := g(a+1) :: real(a)}. If you want @samp{a} to match only
25916 reals and formulas which are provably real, use @samp{dreal(a)} as
25917 the condition.
25918
25919 The @samp{::} operator is a shorthand for the @code{condition}
25920 function; @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}} is equivalent to
25921 the formula @samp{condition(assign(@var{old}, @var{new}), @var{cond})}.
25922
25923 If you have several conditions, you can use @samp{... :: c1 :: c2 :: c3}
25924 or @samp{... :: c1 && c2 && c3}. The two are entirely equivalent.
25925
25926 It is also possible to embed conditions inside the pattern:
25927 @samp{f(x :: x>0, y) := g(y+x, x)}. This is purely a notational
25928 convenience, though; where a condition appears in a rule has no
25929 effect on when it is tested. The rewrite-rule compiler automatically
25930 decides when it is best to test each condition while a rule is being
25931 matched.
25932
25933 Certain conditions are handled as special cases by the rewrite rule
25934 system and are tested very efficiently: Where @expr{x} is any
25935 meta-variable, these conditions are @samp{integer(x)}, @samp{real(x)},
25936 @samp{constant(x)}, @samp{negative(x)}, @samp{x >= y} where @expr{y}
25937 is either a constant or another meta-variable and @samp{>=} may be
25938 replaced by any of the six relational operators, and @samp{x % a = b}
25939 where @expr{a} and @expr{b} are constants. Other conditions, like
25940 @samp{x >= y+1} or @samp{dreal(x)}, will be less efficient to check
25941 since Calc must bring the whole evaluator and simplifier into play.
25942
25943 An interesting property of @samp{::} is that neither of its arguments
25944 will be touched by Calc's default simplifications. This is important
25945 because conditions often are expressions that cannot safely be
25946 evaluated early. For example, the @code{typeof} function never
25947 remains in symbolic form; entering @samp{typeof(a)} will put the
25948 number 100 (the type code for variables like @samp{a}) on the stack.
25949 But putting the condition @samp{... :: typeof(a) = 6} on the stack
25950 is safe since @samp{::} prevents the @code{typeof} from being
25951 evaluated until the condition is actually used by the rewrite system.
25952
25953 Since @samp{::} protects its lefthand side, too, you can use a dummy
25954 condition to protect a rule that must itself not evaluate early.
25955 For example, it's not safe to put @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x])} on
25956 the stack because it will immediately evaluate to @samp{a(f,x) := f(x)},
25957 where the meta-variable-ness of @code{f} on the righthand side has been
25958 lost. But @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x]) :: 1} is safe, and of course
25959 the condition @samp{1} is always true (nonzero) so it has no effect on
25960 the functioning of the rule. (The rewrite compiler will ensure that
25961 it doesn't even impact the speed of matching the rule.)
25962
25963 @node Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25964 @subsection Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules
25965
25966 @noindent
25967 The rewrite mechanism understands the algebraic properties of functions
25968 like @samp{+} and @samp{*}. In particular, pattern matching takes
25969 the associativity and commutativity of the following functions into
25970 account:
25971
25972 @smallexample
25973 + - * = != && || and or xor vint vunion vxor gcd lcm max min beta
25974 @end smallexample
25975
25976 For example, the rewrite rule:
25977
25978 @example
25979 a x + b x := (a + b) x
25980 @end example
25981
25982 @noindent
25983 will match formulas of the form,
25984
25985 @example
25986 a x + b x, x a + x b, a x + x b, x a + b x
25987 @end example
25988
25989 Rewrites also understand the relationship between the @samp{+} and @samp{-}
25990 operators. The above rewrite rule will also match the formulas,
25991
25992 @example
25993 a x - b x, x a - x b, a x - x b, x a - b x
25994 @end example
25995
25996 @noindent
25997 by matching @samp{b} in the pattern to @samp{-b} from the formula.
25998
25999 Applied to a sum of many terms like @samp{r + a x + s + b x + t}, this
26000 pattern will check all pairs of terms for possible matches. The rewrite
26001 will take whichever suitable pair it discovers first.
26002
26003 In general, a pattern using an associative operator like @samp{a + b}
26004 will try @var{2 n} different ways to match a sum of @var{n} terms
26005 like @samp{x + y + z - w}. First, @samp{a} is matched against each
26006 of @samp{x}, @samp{y}, @samp{z}, and @samp{-w} in turn, with @samp{b}
26007 being matched to the remainders @samp{y + z - w}, @samp{x + z - w}, etc.
26008 If none of these succeed, then @samp{b} is matched against each of the
26009 four terms with @samp{a} matching the remainder. Half-and-half matches,
26010 like @samp{(x + y) + (z - w)}, are not tried.
26011
26012 Note that @samp{*} is not commutative when applied to matrices, but
26013 rewrite rules pretend that it is. If you type @kbd{m v} to enable
26014 Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), rewrite rules will match @samp{*}
26015 literally, ignoring its usual commutativity property. (In the
26016 current implementation, the associativity also vanishes---it is as
26017 if the pattern had been enclosed in a @code{plain} marker; see below.)
26018 If you are applying rewrites to formulas with matrices, it's best to
26019 enable Matrix mode first to prevent algebraically incorrect rewrites
26020 from occurring.
26021
26022 The pattern @samp{-x} will actually match any expression. For example,
26023 the rule
26024
26025 @example
26026 f(-x) := -f(x)
26027 @end example
26028
26029 @noindent
26030 will rewrite @samp{f(a)} to @samp{-f(-a)}. To avoid this, either use
26031 a @code{plain} marker as described below, or add a @samp{negative(x)}
26032 condition. The @code{negative} function is true if its argument
26033 ``looks'' negative, for example, because it is a negative number or
26034 because it is a formula like @samp{-x}. The new rule using this
26035 condition is:
26036
26037 @example
26038 f(x) := -f(-x) :: negative(x) @r{or, equivalently,}
26039 f(-x) := -f(x) :: negative(-x)
26040 @end example
26041
26042 In the same way, the pattern @samp{x - y} will match the sum @samp{a + b}
26043 by matching @samp{y} to @samp{-b}.
26044
26045 The pattern @samp{a b} will also match the formula @samp{x/y} if
26046 @samp{y} is a number. Thus the rule @samp{a x + @w{b x} := (a+b) x}
26047 will also convert @samp{a x + x / 2} to @samp{(a + 0.5) x} (or
26048 @samp{(a + 1:2) x}, depending on the current fraction mode).
26049
26050 Calc will @emph{not} take other liberties with @samp{*}, @samp{/}, and
26051 @samp{^}. For example, the pattern @samp{f(a b)} will not match
26052 @samp{f(x^2)}, and @samp{f(a + b)} will not match @samp{f(2 x)}, even
26053 though conceivably these patterns could match with @samp{a = b = x}.
26054 Nor will @samp{f(a b)} match @samp{f(x / y)} if @samp{y} is not a
26055 constant, even though it could be considered to match with @samp{a = x}
26056 and @samp{b = 1/y}. The reasons are partly for efficiency, and partly
26057 because while few mathematical operations are substantively different
26058 for addition and subtraction, often it is preferable to treat the cases
26059 of multiplication, division, and integer powers separately.
26060
26061 Even more subtle is the rule set
26062
26063 @example
26064 [ f(a) + f(b) := f(a + b), -f(a) := f(-a) ]
26065 @end example
26066
26067 @noindent
26068 attempting to match @samp{f(x) - f(y)}. You might think that Calc
26069 will view this subtraction as @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))} and then apply
26070 the above two rules in turn, but actually this will not work because
26071 Calc only does this when considering rules for @samp{+} (like the
26072 first rule in this set). So it will see first that @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))}
26073 does not match @samp{f(a) + f(b)} for any assignments of the
26074 meta-variables, and then it will see that @samp{f(x) - f(y)} does
26075 not match @samp{-f(a)} for any assignment of @samp{a}. Because Calc
26076 tries only one rule at a time, it will not be able to rewrite
26077 @samp{f(x) - f(y)} with this rule set. An explicit @samp{f(a) - f(b)}
26078 rule will have to be added.
26079
26080 Another thing patterns will @emph{not} do is break up complex numbers.
26081 The pattern @samp{myconj(a + @w{b i)} := a - b i} will work for formulas
26082 involving the special constant @samp{i} (such as @samp{3 - 4 i}), but
26083 it will not match actual complex numbers like @samp{(3, -4)}. A version
26084 of the above rule for complex numbers would be
26085
26086 @example
26087 myconj(a) := re(a) - im(a) (0,1) :: im(a) != 0
26088 @end example
26089
26090 @noindent
26091 (Because the @code{re} and @code{im} functions understand the properties
26092 of the special constant @samp{i}, this rule will also work for
26093 @samp{3 - 4 i}. In fact, this particular rule would probably be better
26094 without the @samp{im(a) != 0} condition, since if @samp{im(a) = 0} the
26095 righthand side of the rule will still give the correct answer for the
26096 conjugate of a real number.)
26097
26098 It is also possible to specify optional arguments in patterns. The rule
26099
26100 @example
26101 opt(a) x + opt(b) (x^opt(c) + opt(d)) := f(a, b, c, d)
26102 @end example
26103
26104 @noindent
26105 will match the formula
26106
26107 @example
26108 5 (x^2 - 4) + 3 x
26109 @end example
26110
26111 @noindent
26112 in a fairly straightforward manner, but it will also match reduced
26113 formulas like
26114
26115 @example
26116 x + x^2, 2(x + 1) - x, x + x
26117 @end example
26118
26119 @noindent
26120 producing, respectively,
26121
26122 @example
26123 f(1, 1, 2, 0), f(-1, 2, 1, 1), f(1, 1, 1, 0)
26124 @end example
26125
26126 (The latter two formulas can be entered only if default simplifications
26127 have been turned off with @kbd{m O}.)
26128
26129 The default value for a term of a sum is zero. The default value
26130 for a part of a product, for a power, or for the denominator of a
26131 quotient, is one. Also, @samp{-x} matches the pattern @samp{opt(a) b}
26132 with @samp{a = -1}.
26133
26134 In particular, the distributive-law rule can be refined to
26135
26136 @example
26137 opt(a) x + opt(b) x := (a + b) x
26138 @end example
26139
26140 @noindent
26141 so that it will convert, e.g., @samp{a x - x}, to @samp{(a - 1) x}.
26142
26143 The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x} matches almost any formulas which
26144 are linear in @samp{x}. You can also use the @code{lin} and @code{islin}
26145 functions with rewrite conditions to test for this; @pxref{Logical
26146 Operations}. These functions are not as convenient to use in rewrite
26147 rules, but they recognize more kinds of formulas as linear:
26148 @samp{x/z} is considered linear with @expr{b = 1/z} by @code{lin},
26149 but it will not match the above pattern because that pattern calls
26150 for a multiplication, not a division.
26151
26152 As another example, the obvious rule to replace @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2}
26153 by 1,
26154
26155 @example
26156 sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 := 1
26157 @end example
26158
26159 @noindent
26160 misses many cases because the sine and cosine may both be multiplied by
26161 an equal factor. Here's a more successful rule:
26162
26163 @example
26164 opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a
26165 @end example
26166
26167 Note that this rule will @emph{not} match @samp{sin(x)^2 + 6 cos(x)^2}
26168 because one @expr{a} would have ``matched'' 1 while the other matched 6.
26169
26170 Calc automatically converts a rule like
26171
26172 @example
26173 f(x-1, x) := g(x)
26174 @end example
26175
26176 @noindent
26177 into the form
26178
26179 @example
26180 f(temp, x) := g(x) :: temp = x-1
26181 @end example
26182
26183 @noindent
26184 (where @code{temp} stands for a new, invented meta-variable that
26185 doesn't actually have a name). This modified rule will successfully
26186 match @samp{f(6, 7)}, binding @samp{temp} and @samp{x} to 6 and 7,
26187 respectively, then verifying that they differ by one even though
26188 @samp{6} does not superficially look like @samp{x-1}.
26189
26190 However, Calc does not solve equations to interpret a rule. The
26191 following rule,
26192
26193 @example
26194 f(x-1, x+1) := g(x)
26195 @end example
26196
26197 @noindent
26198 will not work. That is, it will match @samp{f(a - 1 + b, a + 1 + b)}
26199 but not @samp{f(6, 8)}. Calc always interprets at least one occurrence
26200 of a variable by literal matching. If the variable appears ``isolated''
26201 then Calc is smart enough to use it for literal matching. But in this
26202 last example, Calc is forced to rewrite the rule to @samp{f(x-1, temp)
26203 := g(x) :: temp = x+1} where the @samp{x-1} term must correspond to an
26204 actual ``something-minus-one'' in the target formula.
26205
26206 A successful way to write this would be @samp{f(x, x+2) := g(x+1)}.
26207 You could make this resemble the original form more closely by using
26208 @code{let} notation, which is described in the next section:
26209
26210 @example
26211 f(xm1, x+1) := g(x) :: let(x := xm1+1)
26212 @end example
26213
26214 Calc does this rewriting or ``conditionalizing'' for any sub-pattern
26215 which involves only the functions in the following list, operating
26216 only on constants and meta-variables which have already been matched
26217 elsewhere in the pattern. When matching a function call, Calc is
26218 careful to match arguments which are plain variables before arguments
26219 which are calls to any of the functions below, so that a pattern like
26220 @samp{f(x-1, x)} can be conditionalized even though the isolated
26221 @samp{x} comes after the @samp{x-1}.
26222
26223 @smallexample
26224 + - * / \ % ^ abs sign round rounde roundu trunc floor ceil
26225 max min re im conj arg
26226 @end smallexample
26227
26228 You can suppress all of the special treatments described in this
26229 section by surrounding a function call with a @code{plain} marker.
26230 This marker causes the function call which is its argument to be
26231 matched literally, without regard to commutativity, associativity,
26232 negation, or conditionalization. When you use @code{plain}, the
26233 ``deep structure'' of the formula being matched can show through.
26234 For example,
26235
26236 @example
26237 plain(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26238 @end example
26239
26240 @noindent
26241 will match only literal subtractions. However, the @code{plain}
26242 marker does not affect its arguments' arguments. In this case,
26243 commutativity and associativity is still considered while matching
26244 the @w{@samp{a b}} sub-pattern, so the whole pattern will match
26245 @samp{x - y x} as well as @samp{x - x y}. We could go still
26246 further and use
26247
26248 @example
26249 plain(a - plain(a b)) := f(a, b)
26250 @end example
26251
26252 @noindent
26253 which would do a completely strict match for the pattern.
26254
26255 By contrast, the @code{quote} marker means that not only the
26256 function name but also the arguments must be literally the same.
26257 The above pattern will match @samp{x - x y} but
26258
26259 @example
26260 quote(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26261 @end example
26262
26263 @noindent
26264 will match only the single formula @samp{a - a b}. Also,
26265
26266 @example
26267 quote(a - quote(a b)) := f(a, b)
26268 @end example
26269
26270 @noindent
26271 will match only @samp{a - quote(a b)}---probably not the desired
26272 effect!
26273
26274 A certain amount of algebra is also done when substituting the
26275 meta-variables on the righthand side of a rule. For example,
26276 in the rule
26277
26278 @example
26279 a + f(b) := f(a + b)
26280 @end example
26281
26282 @noindent
26283 matching @samp{f(x) - y} would produce @samp{f((-y) + x)} if
26284 taken literally, but the rewrite mechanism will simplify the
26285 righthand side to @samp{f(x - y)} automatically. (Of course,
26286 the default simplifications would do this anyway, so this
26287 special simplification is only noticeable if you have turned the
26288 default simplifications off.) This rewriting is done only when
26289 a meta-variable expands to a ``negative-looking'' expression.
26290 If this simplification is not desirable, you can use a @code{plain}
26291 marker on the righthand side:
26292
26293 @example
26294 a + f(b) := f(plain(a + b))
26295 @end example
26296
26297 @noindent
26298 In this example, we are still allowing the pattern-matcher to
26299 use all the algebra it can muster, but the righthand side will
26300 always simplify to a literal addition like @samp{f((-y) + x)}.
26301
26302 @node Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26303 @subsection Other Features of Rewrite Rules
26304
26305 @noindent
26306 Certain ``function names'' serve as markers in rewrite rules.
26307 Here is a complete list of these markers. First are listed the
26308 markers that work inside a pattern; then come the markers that
26309 work in the righthand side of a rule.
26310
26311 @ignore
26312 @starindex
26313 @end ignore
26314 @tindex import
26315 One kind of marker, @samp{import(x)}, takes the place of a whole
26316 rule. Here @expr{x} is the name of a variable containing another
26317 rule set; those rules are ``spliced into'' the rule set that
26318 imports them. For example, if @samp{[f(a+b) := f(a) + f(b),
26319 f(a b) := a f(b) :: real(a)]} is stored in variable @samp{linearF},
26320 then the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 0, import(linearF)]} will apply
26321 all three rules. It is possible to modify the imported rules
26322 slightly: @samp{import(x, v1, x1, v2, x2, @dots{})} imports
26323 the rule set @expr{x} with all occurrences of
26324 @texline @math{v_1},
26325 @infoline @expr{v1},
26326 as either a variable name or a function name, replaced with
26327 @texline @math{x_1}
26328 @infoline @expr{x1}
26329 and so on. (If
26330 @texline @math{v_1}
26331 @infoline @expr{v1}
26332 is used as a function name, then
26333 @texline @math{x_1}
26334 @infoline @expr{x1}
26335 must be either a function name itself or a @w{@samp{< >}} nameless
26336 function; @pxref{Specifying Operators}.) For example, @samp{[g(0) := 0,
26337 import(linearF, f, g)]} applies the linearity rules to the function
26338 @samp{g} instead of @samp{f}. Imports can be nested, but the
26339 import-with-renaming feature may fail to rename sub-imports properly.
26340
26341 The special functions allowed in patterns are:
26342
26343 @table @samp
26344 @item quote(x)
26345 @ignore
26346 @starindex
26347 @end ignore
26348 @tindex quote
26349 This pattern matches exactly @expr{x}; variable names in @expr{x} are
26350 not interpreted as meta-variables. The only flexibility is that
26351 numbers are compared for numeric equality, so that the pattern
26352 @samp{f(quote(12))} will match both @samp{f(12)} and @samp{f(12.0)}.
26353 (Numbers are always treated this way by the rewrite mechanism:
26354 The rule @samp{f(x,x) := g(x)} will match @samp{f(12, 12.0)}.
26355 The rewrite may produce either @samp{g(12)} or @samp{g(12.0)}
26356 as a result in this case.)
26357
26358 @item plain(x)
26359 @ignore
26360 @starindex
26361 @end ignore
26362 @tindex plain
26363 Here @expr{x} must be a function call @samp{f(x1,x2,@dots{})}. This
26364 pattern matches a call to function @expr{f} with the specified
26365 argument patterns. No special knowledge of the properties of the
26366 function @expr{f} is used in this case; @samp{+} is not commutative or
26367 associative. Unlike @code{quote}, the arguments @samp{x1,x2,@dots{}}
26368 are treated as patterns. If you wish them to be treated ``plainly''
26369 as well, you must enclose them with more @code{plain} markers:
26370 @samp{plain(plain(@w{-a}) + plain(b c))}.
26371
26372 @item opt(x,def)
26373 @ignore
26374 @starindex
26375 @end ignore
26376 @tindex opt
26377 Here @expr{x} must be a variable name. This must appear as an
26378 argument to a function or an element of a vector; it specifies that
26379 the argument or element is optional.
26380 As an argument to @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*}, @samp{&&}, or @samp{||},
26381 or as the second argument to @samp{/} or @samp{^}, the value @var{def}
26382 may be omitted. The pattern @samp{x + opt(y)} matches a sum by
26383 binding one summand to @expr{x} and the other to @expr{y}, and it
26384 matches anything else by binding the whole expression to @expr{x} and
26385 zero to @expr{y}. The other operators above work similarly.
26386
26387 For general miscellaneous functions, the default value @code{def}
26388 must be specified. Optional arguments are dropped starting with
26389 the rightmost one during matching. For example, the pattern
26390 @samp{f(opt(a,0), b, opt(c,b))} will match @samp{f(b)}, @samp{f(a,b)},
26391 or @samp{f(a,b,c)}. Default values of zero and @expr{b} are
26392 supplied in this example for the omitted arguments. Note that
26393 the literal variable @expr{b} will be the default in the latter
26394 case, @emph{not} the value that matched the meta-variable @expr{b}.
26395 In other words, the default @var{def} is effectively quoted.
26396
26397 @item condition(x,c)
26398 @ignore
26399 @starindex
26400 @end ignore
26401 @tindex condition
26402 @tindex ::
26403 This matches the pattern @expr{x}, with the attached condition
26404 @expr{c}. It is the same as @samp{x :: c}.
26405
26406 @item pand(x,y)
26407 @ignore
26408 @starindex
26409 @end ignore
26410 @tindex pand
26411 @tindex &&&
26412 This matches anything that matches both pattern @expr{x} and
26413 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @samp{x &&& y}.
26414 @pxref{Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules}.
26415
26416 @item por(x,y)
26417 @ignore
26418 @starindex
26419 @end ignore
26420 @tindex por
26421 @tindex |||
26422 This matches anything that matches either pattern @expr{x} or
26423 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @w{@samp{x ||| y}}.
26424
26425 @item pnot(x)
26426 @ignore
26427 @starindex
26428 @end ignore
26429 @tindex pnot
26430 @tindex !!!
26431 This matches anything that does not match pattern @expr{x}.
26432 It is the same as @samp{!!! x}.
26433
26434 @item cons(h,t)
26435 @ignore
26436 @mindex cons
26437 @end ignore
26438 @tindex cons (rewrites)
26439 This matches any vector of one or more elements. The first
26440 element is matched to @expr{h}; a vector of the remaining
26441 elements is matched to @expr{t}. Note that vectors of fixed
26442 length can also be matched as actual vectors: The rule
26443 @samp{cons(a,cons(b,[])) := cons(a+b,[])} is equivalent
26444 to the rule @samp{[a,b] := [a+b]}.
26445
26446 @item rcons(t,h)
26447 @ignore
26448 @mindex rcons
26449 @end ignore
26450 @tindex rcons (rewrites)
26451 This is like @code{cons}, except that the @emph{last} element
26452 is matched to @expr{h}, with the remaining elements matched
26453 to @expr{t}.
26454
26455 @item apply(f,args)
26456 @ignore
26457 @mindex apply
26458 @end ignore
26459 @tindex apply (rewrites)
26460 This matches any function call. The name of the function, in
26461 the form of a variable, is matched to @expr{f}. The arguments
26462 of the function, as a vector of zero or more objects, are
26463 matched to @samp{args}. Constants, variables, and vectors
26464 do @emph{not} match an @code{apply} pattern. For example,
26465 @samp{apply(f,x)} matches any function call, @samp{apply(quote(f),x)}
26466 matches any call to the function @samp{f}, @samp{apply(f,[a,b])}
26467 matches any function call with exactly two arguments, and
26468 @samp{apply(quote(f), cons(a,cons(b,x)))} matches any call
26469 to the function @samp{f} with two or more arguments. Another
26470 way to implement the latter, if the rest of the rule does not
26471 need to refer to the first two arguments of @samp{f} by name,
26472 would be @samp{apply(quote(f), x :: vlen(x) >= 2)}.
26473 Here's a more interesting sample use of @code{apply}:
26474
26475 @example
26476 apply(f,[x+n]) := n + apply(f,[x])
26477 :: in(f, [floor,ceil,round,trunc]) :: integer(n)
26478 @end example
26479
26480 Note, however, that this will be slower to match than a rule
26481 set with four separate rules. The reason is that Calc sorts
26482 the rules of a rule set according to top-level function name;
26483 if the top-level function is @code{apply}, Calc must try the
26484 rule for every single formula and sub-formula. If the top-level
26485 function in the pattern is, say, @code{floor}, then Calc invokes
26486 the rule only for sub-formulas which are calls to @code{floor}.
26487
26488 Formulas normally written with operators like @code{+} are still
26489 considered function calls: @code{apply(f,x)} matches @samp{a+b}
26490 with @samp{f = add}, @samp{x = [a,b]}.
26491
26492 You must use @code{apply} for meta-variables with function names
26493 on both sides of a rewrite rule: @samp{apply(f, [x]) := f(x+1)}
26494 is @emph{not} correct, because it rewrites @samp{spam(6)} into
26495 @samp{f(7)}. The righthand side should be @samp{apply(f, [x+1])}.
26496 Also note that you will have to use No-Simplify mode (@kbd{m O})
26497 when entering this rule so that the @code{apply} isn't
26498 evaluated immediately to get the new rule @samp{f(x) := f(x+1)}.
26499 Or, use @kbd{s e} to enter the rule without going through the stack,
26500 or enter the rule as @samp{apply(f, [x]) := apply(f, [x+1]) @w{:: 1}}.
26501 @xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}.
26502
26503 @item select(x)
26504 @ignore
26505 @starindex
26506 @end ignore
26507 @tindex select
26508 This is used for applying rules to formulas with selections;
26509 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26510 @end table
26511
26512 Special functions for the righthand sides of rules are:
26513
26514 @table @samp
26515 @item quote(x)
26516 The notation @samp{quote(x)} is changed to @samp{x} when the
26517 righthand side is used. As far as the rewrite rule is concerned,
26518 @code{quote} is invisible. However, @code{quote} has the special
26519 property in Calc that its argument is not evaluated. Thus,
26520 while it will not work to put the rule @samp{t(a) := typeof(a)}
26521 on the stack because @samp{typeof(a)} is evaluated immediately
26522 to produce @samp{t(a) := 100}, you can use @code{quote} to
26523 protect the righthand side: @samp{t(a) := quote(typeof(a))}.
26524 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for another trick for
26525 protecting rules from evaluation.)
26526
26527 @item plain(x)
26528 Special properties of and simplifications for the function call
26529 @expr{x} are not used. One interesting case where @code{plain}
26530 is useful is the rule, @samp{q(x) := quote(x)}, trying to expand a
26531 shorthand notation for the @code{quote} function. This rule will
26532 not work as shown; instead of replacing @samp{q(foo)} with
26533 @samp{quote(foo)}, it will replace it with @samp{foo}! The correct
26534 rule would be @samp{q(x) := plain(quote(x))}.
26535
26536 @item cons(h,t)
26537 Where @expr{t} is a vector, this is converted into an expanded
26538 vector during rewrite processing. Note that @code{cons} is a regular
26539 Calc function which normally does this anyway; the only way @code{cons}
26540 is treated specially by rewrites is that @code{cons} on the righthand
26541 side of a rule will be evaluated even if default simplifications
26542 have been turned off.
26543
26544 @item rcons(t,h)
26545 Analogous to @code{cons} except putting @expr{h} at the @emph{end} of
26546 the vector @expr{t}.
26547
26548 @item apply(f,args)
26549 Where @expr{f} is a variable and @var{args} is a vector, this
26550 is converted to a function call. Once again, note that @code{apply}
26551 is also a regular Calc function.
26552
26553 @item eval(x)
26554 @ignore
26555 @starindex
26556 @end ignore
26557 @tindex eval
26558 The formula @expr{x} is handled in the usual way, then the
26559 default simplifications are applied to it even if they have
26560 been turned off normally. This allows you to treat any function
26561 similarly to the way @code{cons} and @code{apply} are always
26562 treated. However, there is a slight difference: @samp{cons(2+3, [])}
26563 with default simplifications off will be converted to @samp{[2+3]},
26564 whereas @samp{eval(cons(2+3, []))} will be converted to @samp{[5]}.
26565
26566 @item evalsimp(x)
26567 @ignore
26568 @starindex
26569 @end ignore
26570 @tindex evalsimp
26571 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the usual
26572 way, then algebraically simplified as if by the @kbd{a s} command.
26573
26574 @item evalextsimp(x)
26575 @ignore
26576 @starindex
26577 @end ignore
26578 @tindex evalextsimp
26579 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the normal
26580 way, then ``extendedly'' simplified as if by the @kbd{a e} command.
26581
26582 @item select(x)
26583 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26584 @end table
26585
26586 There are also some special functions you can use in conditions.
26587
26588 @table @samp
26589 @item let(v := x)
26590 @ignore
26591 @starindex
26592 @end ignore
26593 @tindex let
26594 The expression @expr{x} is evaluated with meta-variables substituted.
26595 The @kbd{a s} command's simplifications are @emph{not} applied by
26596 default, but @expr{x} can include calls to @code{evalsimp} or
26597 @code{evalextsimp} as described above to invoke higher levels
26598 of simplification. The
26599 result of @expr{x} is then bound to the meta-variable @expr{v}. As
26600 usual, if this meta-variable has already been matched to something
26601 else the two values must be equal; if the meta-variable is new then
26602 it is bound to the result of the expression. This variable can then
26603 appear in later conditions, and on the righthand side of the rule.
26604 In fact, @expr{v} may be any pattern in which case the result of
26605 evaluating @expr{x} is matched to that pattern, binding any
26606 meta-variables that appear in that pattern. Note that @code{let}
26607 can only appear by itself as a condition, or as one term of an
26608 @samp{&&} which is a whole condition: It cannot be inside
26609 an @samp{||} term or otherwise buried.
26610
26611 The alternate, equivalent form @samp{let(v, x)} is also recognized.
26612 Note that the use of @samp{:=} by @code{let}, while still being
26613 assignment-like in character, is unrelated to the use of @samp{:=}
26614 in the main part of a rewrite rule.
26615
26616 As an example, @samp{f(a) := g(ia) :: let(ia := 1/a) :: constant(ia)}
26617 replaces @samp{f(a)} with @samp{g} of the inverse of @samp{a}, if
26618 that inverse exists and is constant. For example, if @samp{a} is a
26619 singular matrix the operation @samp{1/a} is left unsimplified and
26620 @samp{constant(ia)} fails, but if @samp{a} is an invertible matrix
26621 then the rule succeeds. Without @code{let} there would be no way
26622 to express this rule that didn't have to invert the matrix twice.
26623 Note that, because the meta-variable @samp{ia} is otherwise unbound
26624 in this rule, the @code{let} condition itself always ``succeeds''
26625 because no matter what @samp{1/a} evaluates to, it can successfully
26626 be bound to @code{ia}.
26627
26628 Here's another example, for integrating cosines of linear
26629 terms: @samp{myint(cos(y),x) := sin(y)/b :: let([a,b,x] := lin(y,x))}.
26630 The @code{lin} function returns a 3-vector if its argument is linear,
26631 or leaves itself unevaluated if not. But an unevaluated @code{lin}
26632 call will not match the 3-vector on the lefthand side of the @code{let},
26633 so this @code{let} both verifies that @code{y} is linear, and binds
26634 the coefficients @code{a} and @code{b} for use elsewhere in the rule.
26635 (It would have been possible to use @samp{sin(a x + b)/b} for the
26636 righthand side instead, but using @samp{sin(y)/b} avoids gratuitous
26637 rearrangement of the argument of the sine.)
26638
26639 @ignore
26640 @starindex
26641 @end ignore
26642 @tindex ierf
26643 Similarly, here is a rule that implements an inverse-@code{erf}
26644 function. It uses @code{root} to search for a solution. If
26645 @code{root} succeeds, it will return a vector of two numbers
26646 where the first number is the desired solution. If no solution
26647 is found, @code{root} remains in symbolic form. So we use
26648 @code{let} to check that the result was indeed a vector.
26649
26650 @example
26651 ierf(x) := y :: let([y,z] := root(erf(a) = x, a, .5))
26652 @end example
26653
26654 @item matches(v,p)
26655 The meta-variable @var{v}, which must already have been matched
26656 to something elsewhere in the rule, is compared against pattern
26657 @var{p}. Since @code{matches} is a standard Calc function, it
26658 can appear anywhere in a condition. But if it appears alone or
26659 as a term of a top-level @samp{&&}, then you get the special
26660 extra feature that meta-variables which are bound to things
26661 inside @var{p} can be used elsewhere in the surrounding rewrite
26662 rule.
26663
26664 The only real difference between @samp{let(p := v)} and
26665 @samp{matches(v, p)} is that the former evaluates @samp{v} using
26666 the default simplifications, while the latter does not.
26667
26668 @item remember
26669 @vindex remember
26670 This is actually a variable, not a function. If @code{remember}
26671 appears as a condition in a rule, then when that rule succeeds
26672 the original expression and rewritten expression are added to the
26673 front of the rule set that contained the rule. If the rule set
26674 was not stored in a variable, @code{remember} is ignored. The
26675 lefthand side is enclosed in @code{quote} in the added rule if it
26676 contains any variables.
26677
26678 For example, the rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: remember} applied
26679 to @samp{f(7)} will add the rule @samp{f(7) := 7 f(6)} to the front
26680 of the rule set. The rule set @code{EvalRules} works slightly
26681 differently: There, the evaluation of @samp{f(6)} will complete before
26682 the result is added to the rule set, in this case as @samp{f(7) := 5040}.
26683 Thus @code{remember} is most useful inside @code{EvalRules}.
26684
26685 It is up to you to ensure that the optimization performed by
26686 @code{remember} is safe. For example, the rule @samp{foo(n) := n
26687 :: evalv(eatfoo) > 0 :: remember} is a bad idea (@code{evalv} is
26688 the function equivalent of the @kbd{=} command); if the variable
26689 @code{eatfoo} ever contains 1, rules like @samp{foo(7) := 7} will
26690 be added to the rule set and will continue to operate even if
26691 @code{eatfoo} is later changed to 0.
26692
26693 @item remember(c)
26694 @ignore
26695 @starindex
26696 @end ignore
26697 @tindex remember
26698 Remember the match as described above, but only if condition @expr{c}
26699 is true. For example, @samp{remember(n % 4 = 0)} in the above factorial
26700 rule remembers only every fourth result. Note that @samp{remember(1)}
26701 is equivalent to @samp{remember}, and @samp{remember(0)} has no effect.
26702 @end table
26703
26704 @node Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26705 @subsection Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules
26706
26707 @noindent
26708 There are three operators, @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!},
26709 that combine rewrite patterns to make larger patterns. The
26710 combinations are ``and,'' ``or,'' and ``not,'' respectively, and
26711 these operators are the pattern equivalents of @samp{&&}, @samp{||}
26712 and @samp{!} (which operate on zero-or-nonzero logical values).
26713
26714 Note that @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!} are left in symbolic
26715 form by all regular Calc features; they have special meaning only in
26716 the context of rewrite rule patterns.
26717
26718 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} &&& @var{p2}} matches anything that
26719 matches both @var{p1} and @var{p2}. One especially useful case is
26720 when one of @var{p1} or @var{p2} is a meta-variable. For example,
26721 here is a rule that operates on error forms:
26722
26723 @example
26724 f(x &&& a +/- b, x) := g(x)
26725 @end example
26726
26727 This does the same thing, but is arguably simpler than, the rule
26728
26729 @example
26730 f(a +/- b, a +/- b) := g(a +/- b)
26731 @end example
26732
26733 @ignore
26734 @starindex
26735 @end ignore
26736 @tindex ends
26737 Here's another interesting example:
26738
26739 @example
26740 ends(cons(a, x) &&& rcons(y, b)) := [a, b]
26741 @end example
26742
26743 @noindent
26744 which effectively clips out the middle of a vector leaving just
26745 the first and last elements. This rule will change a one-element
26746 vector @samp{[a]} to @samp{[a, a]}. The similar rule
26747
26748 @example
26749 ends(cons(a, rcons(y, b))) := [a, b]
26750 @end example
26751
26752 @noindent
26753 would do the same thing except that it would fail to match a
26754 one-element vector.
26755
26756 @tex
26757 \bigskip
26758 @end tex
26759
26760 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} ||| @var{p2}} matches anything that
26761 matches either @var{p1} or @var{p2}. Calc first tries matching
26762 against @var{p1}; if that fails, it goes on to try @var{p2}.
26763
26764 @ignore
26765 @starindex
26766 @end ignore
26767 @tindex curve
26768 A simple example of @samp{|||} is
26769
26770 @example
26771 curve(inf ||| -inf) := 0
26772 @end example
26773
26774 @noindent
26775 which converts both @samp{curve(inf)} and @samp{curve(-inf)} to zero.
26776
26777 Here is a larger example:
26778
26779 @example
26780 log(a, b) ||| (ln(a) :: let(b := e)) := mylog(a, b)
26781 @end example
26782
26783 This matches both generalized and natural logarithms in a single rule.
26784 Note that the @samp{::} term must be enclosed in parentheses because
26785 that operator has lower precedence than @samp{|||} or @samp{:=}.
26786
26787 (In practice this rule would probably include a third alternative,
26788 omitted here for brevity, to take care of @code{log10}.)
26789
26790 While Calc generally treats interior conditions exactly the same as
26791 conditions on the outside of a rule, it does guarantee that if all the
26792 variables in the condition are special names like @code{e}, or already
26793 bound in the pattern to which the condition is attached (say, if
26794 @samp{a} had appeared in this condition), then Calc will process this
26795 condition right after matching the pattern to the left of the @samp{::}.
26796 Thus, we know that @samp{b} will be bound to @samp{e} only if the
26797 @code{ln} branch of the @samp{|||} was taken.
26798
26799 Note that this rule was careful to bind the same set of meta-variables
26800 on both sides of the @samp{|||}. Calc does not check this, but if
26801 you bind a certain meta-variable only in one branch and then use that
26802 meta-variable elsewhere in the rule, results are unpredictable:
26803
26804 @example
26805 f(a,b) ||| g(b) := h(a,b)
26806 @end example
26807
26808 Here if the pattern matches @samp{g(17)}, Calc makes no promises about
26809 the value that will be substituted for @samp{a} on the righthand side.
26810
26811 @tex
26812 \bigskip
26813 @end tex
26814
26815 The pattern @samp{!!! @var{pat}} matches anything that does not
26816 match @var{pat}. Any meta-variables that are bound while matching
26817 @var{pat} remain unbound outside of @var{pat}.
26818
26819 For example,
26820
26821 @example
26822 f(x &&& !!! a +/- b, !!![]) := g(x)
26823 @end example
26824
26825 @noindent
26826 converts @code{f} whose first argument is anything @emph{except} an
26827 error form, and whose second argument is not the empty vector, into
26828 a similar call to @code{g} (but without the second argument).
26829
26830 If we know that the second argument will be a vector (empty or not),
26831 then an equivalent rule would be:
26832
26833 @example
26834 f(x, y) := g(x) :: typeof(x) != 7 :: vlen(y) > 0
26835 @end example
26836
26837 @noindent
26838 where of course 7 is the @code{typeof} code for error forms.
26839 Another final condition, that works for any kind of @samp{y},
26840 would be @samp{!istrue(y == [])}. (The @code{istrue} function
26841 returns an explicit 0 if its argument was left in symbolic form;
26842 plain @samp{!(y == [])} or @samp{y != []} would not work to replace
26843 @samp{!!![]} since these would be left unsimplified, and thus cause
26844 the rule to fail, if @samp{y} was something like a variable name.)
26845
26846 It is possible for a @samp{!!!} to refer to meta-variables bound
26847 elsewhere in the pattern. For example,
26848
26849 @example
26850 f(a, !!!a) := g(a)
26851 @end example
26852
26853 @noindent
26854 matches any call to @code{f} with different arguments, changing
26855 this to @code{g} with only the first argument.
26856
26857 If a function call is to be matched and one of the argument patterns
26858 contains a @samp{!!!} somewhere inside it, that argument will be
26859 matched last. Thus
26860
26861 @example
26862 f(!!!a, a) := g(a)
26863 @end example
26864
26865 @noindent
26866 will be careful to bind @samp{a} to the second argument of @code{f}
26867 before testing the first argument. If Calc had tried to match the
26868 first argument of @code{f} first, the results would have been
26869 disastrous: since @code{a} was unbound so far, the pattern @samp{a}
26870 would have matched anything at all, and the pattern @samp{!!!a}
26871 therefore would @emph{not} have matched anything at all!
26872
26873 @node Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26874 @subsection Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules
26875
26876 @noindent
26877 When @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) is used, it takes an expression from
26878 the top of the stack and attempts to match any of the specified rules
26879 to any part of the expression, starting with the whole expression
26880 and then, if that fails, trying deeper and deeper sub-expressions.
26881 For each part of the expression, the rules are tried in the order
26882 they appear in the rules vector. The first rule to match the first
26883 sub-expression wins; it replaces the matched sub-expression according
26884 to the @var{new} part of the rule.
26885
26886 Often, the rule set will match and change the formula several times.
26887 The top-level formula is first matched and substituted repeatedly until
26888 it no longer matches the pattern; then, sub-formulas are tried, and
26889 so on. Once every part of the formula has gotten its chance, the
26890 rewrite mechanism starts over again with the top-level formula
26891 (in case a substitution of one of its arguments has caused it again
26892 to match). This continues until no further matches can be made
26893 anywhere in the formula.
26894
26895 It is possible for a rule set to get into an infinite loop. The
26896 most obvious case, replacing a formula with itself, is not a problem
26897 because a rule is not considered to ``succeed'' unless the righthand
26898 side actually comes out to something different than the original
26899 formula or sub-formula that was matched. But if you accidentally
26900 had both @samp{ln(a b) := ln(a) + ln(b)} and the reverse
26901 @samp{ln(a) + ln(b) := ln(a b)} in your rule set, Calc would
26902 run forever switching a formula back and forth between the two
26903 forms.
26904
26905 To avoid disaster, Calc normally stops after 100 changes have been
26906 made to the formula. This will be enough for most multiple rewrites,
26907 but it will keep an endless loop of rewrites from locking up the
26908 computer forever. (On most systems, you can also type @kbd{C-g} to
26909 halt any Emacs command prematurely.)
26910
26911 To change this limit, give a positive numeric prefix argument.
26912 In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} applies only one rewrite at a time,
26913 useful when you are first testing your rule (or just if repeated
26914 rewriting is not what is called for by your application).
26915
26916 @ignore
26917 @starindex
26918 @end ignore
26919 @ignore
26920 @mindex iter@idots
26921 @end ignore
26922 @tindex iterations
26923 You can also put a ``function call'' @samp{iterations(@var{n})}
26924 in place of a rule anywhere in your rules vector (but usually at
26925 the top). Then, @var{n} will be used instead of 100 as the default
26926 number of iterations for this rule set. You can use
26927 @samp{iterations(inf)} if you want no iteration limit by default.
26928 A prefix argument will override the @code{iterations} limit in the
26929 rule set.
26930
26931 @example
26932 [ iterations(1),
26933 f(x) := f(x+1) ]
26934 @end example
26935
26936 More precisely, the limit controls the number of ``iterations,''
26937 where each iteration is a successful matching of a rule pattern whose
26938 righthand side, after substituting meta-variables and applying the
26939 default simplifications, is different from the original sub-formula
26940 that was matched.
26941
26942 A prefix argument of zero sets the limit to infinity. Use with caution!
26943
26944 Given a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{a r} will match and
26945 substitute the top-level expression up to that many times, but
26946 will not attempt to match the rules to any sub-expressions.
26947
26948 In a formula, @code{rewrite(@var{expr}, @var{rules}, @var{n})}
26949 does a rewriting operation. Here @var{expr} is the expression
26950 being rewritten, @var{rules} is the rule, vector of rules, or
26951 variable containing the rules, and @var{n} is the optional
26952 iteration limit, which may be a positive integer, a negative
26953 integer, or @samp{inf} or @samp{-inf}. If @var{n} is omitted
26954 the @code{iterations} value from the rule set is used; if both
26955 are omitted, 100 is used.
26956
26957 @node Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26958 @subsection Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules
26959
26960 @noindent
26961 It is possible to separate a rewrite rule set into several @dfn{phases}.
26962 During each phase, certain rules will be enabled while certain others
26963 will be disabled. A @dfn{phase schedule} controls the order in which
26964 phases occur during the rewriting process.
26965
26966 @ignore
26967 @starindex
26968 @end ignore
26969 @tindex phase
26970 @vindex all
26971 If a call to the marker function @code{phase} appears in the rules
26972 vector in place of a rule, all rules following that point will be
26973 members of the phase(s) identified in the arguments to @code{phase}.
26974 Phases are given integer numbers. The markers @samp{phase()} and
26975 @samp{phase(all)} both mean the following rules belong to all phases;
26976 this is the default at the start of the rule set.
26977
26978 If you do not explicitly schedule the phases, Calc sorts all phase
26979 numbers that appear in the rule set and executes the phases in
26980 ascending order. For example, the rule set
26981
26982 @example
26983 @group
26984 [ f0(x) := g0(x),
26985 phase(1),
26986 f1(x) := g1(x),
26987 phase(2),
26988 f2(x) := g2(x),
26989 phase(3),
26990 f3(x) := g3(x),
26991 phase(1,2),
26992 f4(x) := g4(x) ]
26993 @end group
26994 @end example
26995
26996 @noindent
26997 has three phases, 1 through 3. Phase 1 consists of the @code{f0},
26998 @code{f1}, and @code{f4} rules (in that order). Phase 2 consists of
26999 @code{f0}, @code{f2}, and @code{f4}. Phase 3 consists of @code{f0}
27000 and @code{f3}.
27001
27002 When Calc rewrites a formula using this rule set, it first rewrites
27003 the formula using only the phase 1 rules until no further changes are
27004 possible. Then it switches to the phase 2 rule set and continues
27005 until no further changes occur, then finally rewrites with phase 3.
27006 When no more phase 3 rules apply, rewriting finishes. (This is
27007 assuming @kbd{a r} with a large enough prefix argument to allow the
27008 rewriting to run to completion; the sequence just described stops
27009 early if the number of iterations specified in the prefix argument,
27010 100 by default, is reached.)
27011
27012 During each phase, Calc descends through the nested levels of the
27013 formula as described previously. (@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite
27014 Rules}.) Rewriting starts at the top of the formula, then works its
27015 way down to the parts, then goes back to the top and works down again.
27016 The phase 2 rules do not begin until no phase 1 rules apply anywhere
27017 in the formula.
27018
27019 @ignore
27020 @starindex
27021 @end ignore
27022 @tindex schedule
27023 A @code{schedule} marker appearing in the rule set (anywhere, but
27024 conventionally at the top) changes the default schedule of phases.
27025 In the simplest case, @code{schedule} has a sequence of phase numbers
27026 for arguments; each phase number is invoked in turn until the
27027 arguments to @code{schedule} are exhausted. Thus adding
27028 @samp{schedule(3,2,1)} at the top of the above rule set would
27029 reverse the order of the phases; @samp{schedule(1,2,3)} would have
27030 no effect since this is the default schedule; and @samp{schedule(1,2,1,3)}
27031 would give phase 1 a second chance after phase 2 has completed, before
27032 moving on to phase 3.
27033
27034 Any argument to @code{schedule} can instead be a vector of phase
27035 numbers (or even of sub-vectors). Then the sub-sequence of phases
27036 described by the vector are tried repeatedly until no change occurs
27037 in any phase in the sequence. For example, @samp{schedule([1, 2], 3)}
27038 tries phase 1, then phase 2, then, if either phase made any changes
27039 to the formula, repeats these two phases until they can make no
27040 further progress. Finally, it goes on to phase 3 for finishing
27041 touches.
27042
27043 Also, items in @code{schedule} can be variable names as well as
27044 numbers. A variable name is interpreted as the name of a function
27045 to call on the whole formula. For example, @samp{schedule(1, simplify)}
27046 says to apply the phase-1 rules (presumably, all of them), then to
27047 call @code{simplify} which is the function name equivalent of @kbd{a s}.
27048 Likewise, @samp{schedule([1, simplify])} says to alternate between
27049 phase 1 and @kbd{a s} until no further changes occur.
27050
27051 Phases can be used purely to improve efficiency; if it is known that
27052 a certain group of rules will apply only at the beginning of rewriting,
27053 and a certain other group will apply only at the end, then rewriting
27054 will be faster if these groups are identified as separate phases.
27055 Once the phase 1 rules are done, Calc can put them aside and no longer
27056 spend any time on them while it works on phase 2.
27057
27058 There are also some problems that can only be solved with several
27059 rewrite phases. For a real-world example of a multi-phase rule set,
27060 examine the set @code{FitRules}, which is used by the curve-fitting
27061 command to convert a model expression to linear form.
27062 @xref{Curve Fitting Details}. This set is divided into four phases.
27063 The first phase rewrites certain kinds of expressions to be more
27064 easily linearizable, but less computationally efficient. After the
27065 linear components have been picked out, the final phase includes the
27066 opposite rewrites to put each component back into an efficient form.
27067 If both sets of rules were included in one big phase, Calc could get
27068 into an infinite loop going back and forth between the two forms.
27069
27070 Elsewhere in @code{FitRules}, the components are first isolated,
27071 then recombined where possible to reduce the complexity of the linear
27072 fit, then finally packaged one component at a time into vectors.
27073 If the packaging rules were allowed to begin before the recombining
27074 rules were finished, some components might be put away into vectors
27075 before they had a chance to recombine. By putting these rules in
27076 two separate phases, this problem is neatly avoided.
27077
27078 @node Selections with Rewrite Rules, Matching Commands, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27079 @subsection Selections with Rewrite Rules
27080
27081 @noindent
27082 If a sub-formula of the current formula is selected (as by @kbd{j s};
27083 @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}), the @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite})
27084 command applies only to that sub-formula. Together with a negative
27085 prefix argument, you can use this fact to apply a rewrite to one
27086 specific part of a formula without affecting any other parts.
27087
27088 @kindex j r
27089 @pindex calc-rewrite-selection
27090 The @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command allows more
27091 sophisticated operations on selections. This command prompts for
27092 the rules in the same way as @kbd{a r}, but it then applies those
27093 rules to the whole formula in question even though a sub-formula
27094 of it has been selected. However, the selected sub-formula will
27095 first have been surrounded by a @samp{select( )} function call.
27096 (Calc's evaluator does not understand the function name @code{select};
27097 this is only a tag used by the @kbd{j r} command.)
27098
27099 For example, suppose the formula on the stack is @samp{2 (a + b)^2}
27100 and the sub-formula @samp{a + b} is selected. This formula will
27101 be rewritten to @samp{2 select(a + b)^2} and then the rewrite
27102 rules will be applied in the usual way. The rewrite rules can
27103 include references to @code{select} to tell where in the pattern
27104 the selected sub-formula should appear.
27105
27106 If there is still exactly one @samp{select( )} function call in
27107 the formula after rewriting is done, it indicates which part of
27108 the formula should be selected afterwards. Otherwise, the
27109 formula will be unselected.
27110
27111 You can make @kbd{j r} act much like @kbd{a r} by enclosing both parts
27112 of the rewrite rule with @samp{select()}. However, @kbd{j r}
27113 allows you to use the current selection in more flexible ways.
27114 Suppose you wished to make a rule which removed the exponent from
27115 the selected term; the rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} would
27116 work. In the above example, it would rewrite @samp{2 select(a + b)^2}
27117 to @samp{2 select(a + b)}. This would then be returned to the
27118 stack as @samp{2 (a + b)} with the @samp{a + b} selected.
27119
27120 The @kbd{j r} command uses one iteration by default, unlike
27121 @kbd{a r} which defaults to 100 iterations. A numeric prefix
27122 argument affects @kbd{j r} in the same way as @kbd{a r}.
27123 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.
27124
27125 As with other selection commands, @kbd{j r} operates on the stack
27126 entry that contains the cursor. (If the cursor is on the top-of-stack
27127 @samp{.} marker, it works as if the cursor were on the formula
27128 at stack level 1.)
27129
27130 If you don't specify a set of rules, the rules are taken from the
27131 top of the stack, just as with @kbd{a r}. In this case, the
27132 cursor must indicate stack entry 2 or above as the formula to be
27133 rewritten (otherwise the same formula would be used as both the
27134 target and the rewrite rules).
27135
27136 If the indicated formula has no selection, the cursor position within
27137 the formula temporarily selects a sub-formula for the purposes of this
27138 command. If the cursor is not on any sub-formula (e.g., it is in
27139 the line-number area to the left of the formula), the @samp{select( )}
27140 markers are ignored by the rewrite mechanism and the rules are allowed
27141 to apply anywhere in the formula.
27142
27143 As a special feature, the normal @kbd{a r} command also ignores
27144 @samp{select( )} calls in rewrite rules. For example, if you used the
27145 above rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} with @kbd{a r}, it would apply
27146 the rule as if it were @samp{a^x := a}. Thus, you can write general
27147 purpose rules with @samp{select( )} hints inside them so that they
27148 will ``do the right thing'' in both @kbd{a r} and @kbd{j r},
27149 both with and without selections.
27150
27151 @node Matching Commands, Automatic Rewrites, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27152 @subsection Matching Commands
27153
27154 @noindent
27155 @kindex a m
27156 @pindex calc-match
27157 @tindex match
27158 The @kbd{a m} (@code{calc-match}) [@code{match}] function takes a
27159 vector of formulas and a rewrite-rule-style pattern, and produces
27160 a vector of all formulas which match the pattern. The command
27161 prompts you to enter the pattern; as for @kbd{a r}, you can enter
27162 a single pattern (i.e., a formula with meta-variables), or a
27163 vector of patterns, or a variable which contains patterns, or
27164 you can give a blank response in which case the patterns are taken
27165 from the top of the stack. The pattern set will be compiled once
27166 and saved if it is stored in a variable. If there are several
27167 patterns in the set, vector elements are kept if they match any
27168 of the patterns.
27169
27170 For example, @samp{match(a+b, [x, x+y, x-y, 7, x+y+z])}
27171 will return @samp{[x+y, x-y, x+y+z]}.
27172
27173 The @code{import} mechanism is not available for pattern sets.
27174
27175 The @kbd{a m} command can also be used to extract all vector elements
27176 which satisfy any condition: The pattern @samp{x :: x>0} will select
27177 all the positive vector elements.
27178
27179 @kindex I a m
27180 @tindex matchnot
27181 With the Inverse flag [@code{matchnot}], this command extracts all
27182 vector elements which do @emph{not} match the given pattern.
27183
27184 @ignore
27185 @starindex
27186 @end ignore
27187 @tindex matches
27188 There is also a function @samp{matches(@var{x}, @var{p})} which
27189 evaluates to 1 if expression @var{x} matches pattern @var{p}, or
27190 to 0 otherwise. This is sometimes useful for including into the
27191 conditional clauses of other rewrite rules.
27192
27193 @ignore
27194 @starindex
27195 @end ignore
27196 @tindex vmatches
27197 The function @code{vmatches} is just like @code{matches}, except
27198 that if the match succeeds it returns a vector of assignments to
27199 the meta-variables instead of the number 1. For example,
27200 @samp{vmatches(f(1,2), f(a,b))} returns @samp{[a := 1, b := 2]}.
27201 If the match fails, the function returns the number 0.
27202
27203 @node Automatic Rewrites, Debugging Rewrites, Matching Commands, Rewrite Rules
27204 @subsection Automatic Rewrites
27205
27206 @noindent
27207 @cindex @code{EvalRules} variable
27208 @vindex EvalRules
27209 It is possible to get Calc to apply a set of rewrite rules on all
27210 results, effectively adding to the built-in set of default
27211 simplifications. To do this, simply store your rule set in the
27212 variable @code{EvalRules}. There is a convenient @kbd{s E} command
27213 for editing @code{EvalRules}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27214
27215 For example, suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out
27216 to @samp{sin(b) cos(a) + cos(b) sin(a)} wherever it appears, and
27217 similarly for @samp{cos(a + b)}. The corresponding rewrite rule
27218 set would be,
27219
27220 @smallexample
27221 @group
27222 [ sin(a + b) := cos(a) sin(b) + sin(a) cos(b),
27223 cos(a + b) := cos(a) cos(b) - sin(a) sin(b) ]
27224 @end group
27225 @end smallexample
27226
27227 To apply these manually, you could put them in a variable called
27228 @code{trigexp} and then use @kbd{a r trigexp} every time you wanted
27229 to expand trig functions. But if instead you store them in the
27230 variable @code{EvalRules}, they will automatically be applied to all
27231 sines and cosines of sums. Then, with @samp{2 x} and @samp{45} on
27232 the stack, typing @kbd{+ S} will (assuming Degrees mode) result in
27233 @samp{0.7071 sin(2 x) + 0.7071 cos(2 x)} automatically.
27234
27235 As each level of a formula is evaluated, the rules from
27236 @code{EvalRules} are applied before the default simplifications.
27237 Rewriting continues until no further @code{EvalRules} apply.
27238 Note that this is different from the usual order of application of
27239 rewrite rules: @code{EvalRules} works from the bottom up, simplifying
27240 the arguments to a function before the function itself, while @kbd{a r}
27241 applies rules from the top down.
27242
27243 Because the @code{EvalRules} are tried first, you can use them to
27244 override the normal behavior of any built-in Calc function.
27245
27246 It is important not to write a rule that will get into an infinite
27247 loop. For example, the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 1, f(n) := n f(n-1)]}
27248 appears to be a good definition of a factorial function, but it is
27249 unsafe. Imagine what happens if @samp{f(2.5)} is simplified. Calc
27250 will continue to subtract 1 from this argument forever without reaching
27251 zero. A safer second rule would be @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0}.
27252 Another dangerous rule is @samp{g(x, y) := g(y, x)}. Rewriting
27253 @samp{g(2, 4)}, this would bounce back and forth between that and
27254 @samp{g(4, 2)} forever. If an infinite loop in @code{EvalRules}
27255 occurs, Emacs will eventually stop with a ``Computation got stuck
27256 or ran too long'' message.
27257
27258 Another subtle difference between @code{EvalRules} and regular rewrites
27259 concerns rules that rewrite a formula into an identical formula. For
27260 example, @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} ``fails to match'' when @expr{n} is
27261 already an integer. But in @code{EvalRules} this case is detected only
27262 if the righthand side literally becomes the original formula before any
27263 further simplification. This means that @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} will
27264 get into an infinite loop if it occurs in @code{EvalRules}. Calc will
27265 replace @samp{f(6)} with @samp{f(floor(6))}, which is different from
27266 @samp{f(6)}, so it will consider the rule to have matched and will
27267 continue simplifying that formula; first the argument is simplified
27268 to get @samp{f(6)}, then the rule matches again to get @samp{f(floor(6))}
27269 again, ad infinitum. A much safer rule would check its argument first,
27270 say, with @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n)) :: !dint(n)}.
27271
27272 (What really happens is that the rewrite mechanism substitutes the
27273 meta-variables in the righthand side of a rule, compares to see if the
27274 result is the same as the original formula and fails if so, then uses
27275 the default simplifications to simplify the result and compares again
27276 (and again fails if the formula has simplified back to its original
27277 form). The only special wrinkle for the @code{EvalRules} is that the
27278 same rules will come back into play when the default simplifications
27279 are used. What Calc wants to do is build @samp{f(floor(6))}, see that
27280 this is different from the original formula, simplify to @samp{f(6)},
27281 see that this is the same as the original formula, and thus halt the
27282 rewriting. But while simplifying, @samp{f(6)} will again trigger
27283 the same @code{EvalRules} rule and Calc will get into a loop inside
27284 the rewrite mechanism itself.)
27285
27286 The @code{phase}, @code{schedule}, and @code{iterations} markers do
27287 not work in @code{EvalRules}. If the rule set is divided into phases,
27288 only the phase 1 rules are applied, and the schedule is ignored.
27289 The rules are always repeated as many times as possible.
27290
27291 The @code{EvalRules} are applied to all function calls in a formula,
27292 but not to numbers (and other number-like objects like error forms),
27293 nor to vectors or individual variable names. (Though they will apply
27294 to @emph{components} of vectors and error forms when appropriate.) You
27295 might try to make a variable @code{phihat} which automatically expands
27296 to its definition without the need to press @kbd{=} by writing the
27297 rule @samp{quote(phihat) := (1-sqrt(5))/2}, but unfortunately this rule
27298 will not work as part of @code{EvalRules}.
27299
27300 Finally, another limitation is that Calc sometimes calls its built-in
27301 functions directly rather than going through the default simplifications.
27302 When it does this, @code{EvalRules} will not be able to override those
27303 functions. For example, when you take the absolute value of the complex
27304 number @expr{(2, 3)}, Calc computes @samp{sqrt(2*2 + 3*3)} by calling
27305 the multiplication, addition, and square root functions directly rather
27306 than applying the default simplifications to this formula. So an
27307 @code{EvalRules} rule that (perversely) rewrites @samp{sqrt(13) := 6}
27308 would not apply. (However, if you put Calc into Symbolic mode so that
27309 @samp{sqrt(13)} will be left in symbolic form by the built-in square
27310 root function, your rule will be able to apply. But if the complex
27311 number were @expr{(3,4)}, so that @samp{sqrt(25)} must be calculated,
27312 then Symbolic mode will not help because @samp{sqrt(25)} can be
27313 evaluated exactly to 5.)
27314
27315 One subtle restriction that normally only manifests itself with
27316 @code{EvalRules} is that while a given rewrite rule is in the process
27317 of being checked, that same rule cannot be recursively applied. Calc
27318 effectively removes the rule from its rule set while checking the rule,
27319 then puts it back once the match succeeds or fails. (The technical
27320 reason for this is that compiled pattern programs are not reentrant.)
27321 For example, consider the rule @samp{foo(x) := x :: foo(x/2) > 0}
27322 attempting to match @samp{foo(8)}. This rule will be inactive while
27323 the condition @samp{foo(4) > 0} is checked, even though it might be
27324 an integral part of evaluating that condition. Note that this is not
27325 a problem for the more usual recursive type of rule, such as
27326 @samp{foo(x) := foo(x/2)}, because there the rule has succeeded and
27327 been reactivated by the time the righthand side is evaluated.
27328
27329 If @code{EvalRules} has no stored value (its default state), or if
27330 anything but a vector is stored in it, then it is ignored.
27331
27332 Even though Calc's rewrite mechanism is designed to compare rewrite
27333 rules to formulas as quickly as possible, storing rules in
27334 @code{EvalRules} may make Calc run substantially slower. This is
27335 particularly true of rules where the top-level call is a commonly used
27336 function, or is not fixed. The rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0} will
27337 only activate the rewrite mechanism for calls to the function @code{f},
27338 but @samp{lg(n) + lg(m) := lg(n m)} will check every @samp{+} operator.
27339
27340 @smallexample
27341 apply(f, [a*b]) := apply(f, [a]) + apply(f, [b]) :: in(f, [ln, log10])
27342 @end smallexample
27343
27344 @noindent
27345 may seem more ``efficient'' than two separate rules for @code{ln} and
27346 @code{log10}, but actually it is vastly less efficient because rules
27347 with @code{apply} as the top-level pattern must be tested against
27348 @emph{every} function call that is simplified.
27349
27350 @cindex @code{AlgSimpRules} variable
27351 @vindex AlgSimpRules
27352 Suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out not all the time,
27353 but only when @kbd{a s} is used to simplify the formula. The variable
27354 @code{AlgSimpRules} holds rules for this purpose. The @kbd{a s} command
27355 will apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules} to the formula, as
27356 well as all of its built-in simplifications.
27357
27358 Most of the special limitations for @code{EvalRules} don't apply to
27359 @code{AlgSimpRules}. Calc simply does an @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
27360 command with an infinite repeat count as the first step of @kbd{a s}.
27361 It then applies its own built-in simplifications throughout the
27362 formula, and then repeats these two steps (along with applying the
27363 default simplifications) until no further changes are possible.
27364
27365 @cindex @code{ExtSimpRules} variable
27366 @cindex @code{UnitSimpRules} variable
27367 @vindex ExtSimpRules
27368 @vindex UnitSimpRules
27369 There are also @code{ExtSimpRules} and @code{UnitSimpRules} variables
27370 that are used by @kbd{a e} and @kbd{u s}, respectively; these commands
27371 also apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. The variable
27372 @code{IntegSimpRules} contains simplification rules that are used
27373 only during integration by @kbd{a i}.
27374
27375 @node Debugging Rewrites, Examples of Rewrite Rules, Automatic Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27376 @subsection Debugging Rewrites
27377
27378 @noindent
27379 If a buffer named @samp{*Trace*} exists, the rewrite mechanism will
27380 record some useful information there as it operates. The original
27381 formula is written there, as is the result of each successful rewrite,
27382 and the final result of the rewriting. All phase changes are also
27383 noted.
27384
27385 Calc always appends to @samp{*Trace*}. You must empty this buffer
27386 yourself periodically if it is in danger of growing unwieldy.
27387
27388 Note that the rewriting mechanism is substantially slower when the
27389 @samp{*Trace*} buffer exists, even if the buffer is not visible on
27390 the screen. Once you are done, you will probably want to kill this
27391 buffer (with @kbd{C-x k *Trace* @key{RET}}). If you leave it in
27392 existence and forget about it, all your future rewrite commands will
27393 be needlessly slow.
27394
27395 @node Examples of Rewrite Rules, , Debugging Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27396 @subsection Examples of Rewrite Rules
27397
27398 @noindent
27399 Returning to the example of substituting the pattern
27400 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2} with 1, we saw that the rule
27401 @samp{opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a} does a good job of
27402 finding suitable cases. Another solution would be to use the rule
27403 @samp{cos(x)^2 := 1 - sin(x)^2}, followed by algebraic simplification
27404 if necessary. This rule will be the most effective way to do the job,
27405 but at the expense of making some changes that you might not desire.
27406
27407 Another algebraic rewrite rule is @samp{exp(x+y) := exp(x) exp(y)}.
27408 To make this work with the @w{@kbd{j r}} command so that it can be
27409 easily targeted to a particular exponential in a large formula,
27410 you might wish to write the rule as @samp{select(exp(x+y)) :=
27411 select(exp(x) exp(y))}. The @samp{select} markers will be
27412 ignored by the regular @kbd{a r} command
27413 (@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}).
27414
27415 A surprisingly useful rewrite rule is @samp{a/(b-c) := a*(b+c)/(b^2-c^2)}.
27416 This will simplify the formula whenever @expr{b} and/or @expr{c} can
27417 be made simpler by squaring. For example, applying this rule to
27418 @samp{2 / (sqrt(2) + 3)} yields @samp{6:7 - 2:7 sqrt(2)} (assuming
27419 Symbolic mode has been enabled to keep the square root from being
27420 evaluated to a floating-point approximation). This rule is also
27421 useful when working with symbolic complex numbers, e.g.,
27422 @samp{(a + b i) / (c + d i)}.
27423
27424 As another example, we could define our own ``triangular numbers'' function
27425 with the rules @samp{[tri(0) := 0, tri(n) := n + tri(n-1) :: n>0]}. Enter
27426 this vector and store it in a variable: @kbd{@w{s t} trirules}. Now, given
27427 a suitable formula like @samp{tri(5)} on the stack, type @samp{a r trirules}
27428 to apply these rules repeatedly. After six applications, @kbd{a r} will
27429 stop with 15 on the stack. Once these rules are debugged, it would probably
27430 be most useful to add them to @code{EvalRules} so that Calc will evaluate
27431 the new @code{tri} function automatically. We could then use @kbd{Z K} on
27432 the keyboard macro @kbd{' tri($) @key{RET}} to make a command that applies
27433 @code{tri} to the value on the top of the stack. @xref{Programming}.
27434
27435 @cindex Quaternions
27436 The following rule set, contributed by
27437 @texline Fran\c cois
27438 @infoline Francois
27439 Pinard, implements @dfn{quaternions}, a generalization of the concept of
27440 complex numbers. Quaternions have four components, and are here
27441 represented by function calls @samp{quat(@var{w}, [@var{x}, @var{y},
27442 @var{z}])} with ``real part'' @var{w} and the three ``imaginary'' parts
27443 collected into a vector. Various arithmetical operations on quaternions
27444 are supported. To use these rules, either add them to @code{EvalRules},
27445 or create a command based on @kbd{a r} for simplifying quaternion
27446 formulas. A convenient way to enter quaternions would be a command
27447 defined by a keyboard macro containing: @kbd{' quat($$$$, [$$$, $$, $])
27448 @key{RET}}.
27449
27450 @smallexample
27451 [ quat(w, x, y, z) := quat(w, [x, y, z]),
27452 quat(w, [0, 0, 0]) := w,
27453 abs(quat(w, v)) := hypot(w, v),
27454 -quat(w, v) := quat(-w, -v),
27455 r + quat(w, v) := quat(r + w, v) :: real(r),
27456 r - quat(w, v) := quat(r - w, -v) :: real(r),
27457 quat(w1, v1) + quat(w2, v2) := quat(w1 + w2, v1 + v2),
27458 r * quat(w, v) := quat(r * w, r * v) :: real(r),
27459 plain(quat(w1, v1) * quat(w2, v2))
27460 := quat(w1 * w2 - v1 * v2, w1 * v2 + w2 * v1 + cross(v1, v2)),
27461 quat(w1, v1) / r := quat(w1 / r, v1 / r) :: real(r),
27462 z / quat(w, v) := z * quatinv(quat(w, v)),
27463 quatinv(quat(w, v)) := quat(w, -v) / (w^2 + v^2),
27464 quatsqr(quat(w, v)) := quat(w^2 - v^2, 2 * w * v),
27465 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^(k / 2))
27466 :: integer(k) :: k > 0 :: k % 2 = 0,
27467 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^((k - 1) / 2)) * quat(w, v)
27468 :: integer(k) :: k > 2,
27469 quat(w, v)^-k := quatinv(quat(w, v)^k) :: integer(k) :: k > 0 ]
27470 @end smallexample
27471
27472 Quaternions, like matrices, have non-commutative multiplication.
27473 In other words, @expr{q1 * q2 = q2 * q1} is not necessarily true if
27474 @expr{q1} and @expr{q2} are @code{quat} forms. The @samp{quat*quat}
27475 rule above uses @code{plain} to prevent Calc from rearranging the
27476 product. It may also be wise to add the line @samp{[quat(), matrix]}
27477 to the @code{Decls} matrix, to ensure that Calc's other algebraic
27478 operations will not rearrange a quaternion product. @xref{Declarations}.
27479
27480 These rules also accept a four-argument @code{quat} form, converting
27481 it to the preferred form in the first rule. If you would rather see
27482 results in the four-argument form, just append the two items
27483 @samp{phase(2), quat(w, [x, y, z]) := quat(w, x, y, z)} to the end
27484 of the rule set. (But remember that multi-phase rule sets don't work
27485 in @code{EvalRules}.)
27486
27487 @node Units, Store and Recall, Algebra, Top
27488 @chapter Operating on Units
27489
27490 @noindent
27491 One special interpretation of algebraic formulas is as numbers with units.
27492 For example, the formula @samp{5 m / s^2} can be read ``five meters
27493 per second squared.'' The commands in this chapter help you
27494 manipulate units expressions in this form. Units-related commands
27495 begin with the @kbd{u} prefix key.
27496
27497 @menu
27498 * Basic Operations on Units::
27499 * The Units Table::
27500 * Predefined Units::
27501 * User-Defined Units::
27502 @end menu
27503
27504 @node Basic Operations on Units, The Units Table, Units, Units
27505 @section Basic Operations on Units
27506
27507 @noindent
27508 A @dfn{units expression} is a formula which is basically a number
27509 multiplied and/or divided by one or more @dfn{unit names}, which may
27510 optionally be raised to integer powers. Actually, the value part need not
27511 be a number; any product or quotient involving unit names is a units
27512 expression. Many of the units commands will also accept any formula,
27513 where the command applies to all units expressions which appear in the
27514 formula.
27515
27516 A unit name is a variable whose name appears in the @dfn{unit table},
27517 or a variable whose name is a prefix character like @samp{k} (for ``kilo'')
27518 or @samp{u} (for ``micro'') followed by a name in the unit table.
27519 A substantial table of built-in units is provided with Calc;
27520 @pxref{Predefined Units}. You can also define your own unit names;
27521 @pxref{User-Defined Units}.
27522
27523 Note that if the value part of a units expression is exactly @samp{1},
27524 it will be removed by the Calculator's automatic algebra routines: The
27525 formula @samp{1 mm} is ``simplified'' to @samp{mm}. This is only a
27526 display anomaly, however; @samp{mm} will work just fine as a
27527 representation of one millimeter.
27528
27529 You may find that Algebraic mode (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}) makes working
27530 with units expressions easier. Otherwise, you will have to remember
27531 to hit the apostrophe key every time you wish to enter units.
27532
27533 @kindex u s
27534 @pindex calc-simplify-units
27535 @ignore
27536 @mindex usimpl@idots
27537 @end ignore
27538 @tindex usimplify
27539 The @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) [@code{usimplify}] command
27540 simplifies a units
27541 expression. It uses @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) to simplify the
27542 expression first as a regular algebraic formula; it then looks for
27543 features that can be further simplified by converting one object's units
27544 to be compatible with another's. For example, @samp{5 m + 23 mm} will
27545 simplify to @samp{5.023 m}. When different but compatible units are
27546 added, the righthand term's units are converted to match those of the
27547 lefthand term. @xref{Simplification Modes}, for a way to have this done
27548 automatically at all times.
27549
27550 Units simplification also handles quotients of two units with the same
27551 dimensionality, as in @w{@samp{2 in s/L cm}} to @samp{5.08 s/L}; fractional
27552 powers of unit expressions, as in @samp{sqrt(9 mm^2)} to @samp{3 mm} and
27553 @samp{sqrt(9 acre)} to a quantity in meters; and @code{floor},
27554 @code{ceil}, @code{round}, @code{rounde}, @code{roundu}, @code{trunc},
27555 @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{abs}, and @code{clean}
27556 applied to units expressions, in which case
27557 the operation in question is applied only to the numeric part of the
27558 expression. Finally, trigonometric functions of quantities with units
27559 of angle are evaluated, regardless of the current angular mode.
27560
27561 @kindex u c
27562 @pindex calc-convert-units
27563 The @kbd{u c} (@code{calc-convert-units}) command converts a units
27564 expression to new, compatible units. For example, given the units
27565 expression @samp{55 mph}, typing @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces
27566 @samp{24.5872 m/s}. If the units you request are inconsistent with
27567 the original units, the number will be converted into your units
27568 times whatever ``remainder'' units are left over. For example,
27569 converting @samp{55 mph} into acres produces @samp{6.08e-3 acre / m s}.
27570 (Recall that multiplication binds more strongly than division in Calc
27571 formulas, so the units here are acres per meter-second.) Remainder
27572 units are expressed in terms of ``fundamental'' units like @samp{m} and
27573 @samp{s}, regardless of the input units.
27574
27575 One special exception is that if you specify a single unit name, and
27576 a compatible unit appears somewhere in the units expression, then
27577 that compatible unit will be converted to the new unit and the
27578 remaining units in the expression will be left alone. For example,
27579 given the input @samp{980 cm/s^2}, the command @kbd{u c ms} will
27580 change the @samp{s} to @samp{ms} to get @samp{9.8e-4 cm/ms^2}.
27581 The ``remainder unit'' @samp{cm} is left alone rather than being
27582 changed to the base unit @samp{m}.
27583
27584 You can use explicit unit conversion instead of the @kbd{u s} command
27585 to gain more control over the units of the result of an expression.
27586 For example, given @samp{5 m + 23 mm}, you can type @kbd{u c m} or
27587 @kbd{u c mm} to express the result in either meters or millimeters.
27588 (For that matter, you could type @kbd{u c fath} to express the result
27589 in fathoms, if you preferred!)
27590
27591 In place of a specific set of units, you can also enter one of the
27592 units system names @code{si}, @code{mks} (equivalent), or @code{cgs}.
27593 For example, @kbd{u c si @key{RET}} converts the expression into
27594 International System of Units (SI) base units. Also, @kbd{u c base}
27595 converts to Calc's base units, which are the same as @code{si} units
27596 except that @code{base} uses @samp{g} as the fundamental unit of mass
27597 whereas @code{si} uses @samp{kg}.
27598
27599 @cindex Composite units
27600 The @kbd{u c} command also accepts @dfn{composite units}, which
27601 are expressed as the sum of several compatible unit names. For
27602 example, converting @samp{30.5 in} to units @samp{mi+ft+in} (miles,
27603 feet, and inches) produces @samp{2 ft + 6.5 in}. Calc first
27604 sorts the unit names into order of decreasing relative size.
27605 It then accounts for as much of the input quantity as it can
27606 using an integer number times the largest unit, then moves on
27607 to the next smaller unit, and so on. Only the smallest unit
27608 may have a non-integer amount attached in the result. A few
27609 standard unit names exist for common combinations, such as
27610 @code{mfi} for @samp{mi+ft+in}, and @code{tpo} for @samp{ton+lb+oz}.
27611 Composite units are expanded as if by @kbd{a x}, so that
27612 @samp{(ft+in)/hr} is first converted to @samp{ft/hr+in/hr}.
27613
27614 If the value on the stack does not contain any units, @kbd{u c} will
27615 prompt first for the old units which this value should be considered
27616 to have, then for the new units. Assuming the old and new units you
27617 give are consistent with each other, the result also will not contain
27618 any units. For example, @kbd{@w{u c} cm @key{RET} in @key{RET}} converts the number
27619 2 on the stack to 5.08.
27620
27621 @kindex u b
27622 @pindex calc-base-units
27623 The @kbd{u b} (@code{calc-base-units}) command is shorthand for
27624 @kbd{u c base}; it converts the units expression on the top of the
27625 stack into @code{base} units. If @kbd{u s} does not simplify a
27626 units expression as far as you would like, try @kbd{u b}.
27627
27628 The @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u b} commands treat temperature units (like
27629 @samp{degC} and @samp{K}) as relative temperatures. For example,
27630 @kbd{u c} converts @samp{10 degC} to @samp{18 degF}: A change of 10
27631 degrees Celsius corresponds to a change of 18 degrees Fahrenheit.
27632
27633 @kindex u t
27634 @pindex calc-convert-temperature
27635 @cindex Temperature conversion
27636 The @kbd{u t} (@code{calc-convert-temperature}) command converts
27637 absolute temperatures. The value on the stack must be a simple units
27638 expression with units of temperature only. This command would convert
27639 @samp{10 degC} to @samp{50 degF}, the equivalent temperature on the
27640 Fahrenheit scale.
27641
27642 @kindex u r
27643 @pindex calc-remove-units
27644 @kindex u x
27645 @pindex calc-extract-units
27646 The @kbd{u r} (@code{calc-remove-units}) command removes units from the
27647 formula at the top of the stack. The @kbd{u x}
27648 (@code{calc-extract-units}) command extracts only the units portion of a
27649 formula. These commands essentially replace every term of the formula
27650 that does or doesn't (respectively) look like a unit name by the
27651 constant 1, then resimplify the formula.
27652
27653 @kindex u a
27654 @pindex calc-autorange-units
27655 The @kbd{u a} (@code{calc-autorange-units}) command turns on and off a
27656 mode in which unit prefixes like @code{k} (``kilo'') are automatically
27657 applied to keep the numeric part of a units expression in a reasonable
27658 range. This mode affects @kbd{u s} and all units conversion commands
27659 except @kbd{u b}. For example, with autoranging on, @samp{12345 Hz}
27660 will be simplified to @samp{12.345 kHz}. Autoranging is useful for
27661 some kinds of units (like @code{Hz} and @code{m}), but is probably
27662 undesirable for non-metric units like @code{ft} and @code{tbsp}.
27663 (Composite units are more appropriate for those; see above.)
27664
27665 Autoranging always applies the prefix to the leftmost unit name.
27666 Calc chooses the largest prefix that causes the number to be greater
27667 than or equal to 1.0. Thus an increasing sequence of adjusted times
27668 would be @samp{1 ms, 10 ms, 100 ms, 1 s, 10 s, 100 s, 1 ks}.
27669 Generally the rule of thumb is that the number will be adjusted
27670 to be in the interval @samp{[1 .. 1000)}, although there are several
27671 exceptions to this rule. First, if the unit has a power then this
27672 is not possible; @samp{0.1 s^2} simplifies to @samp{100000 ms^2}.
27673 Second, the ``centi-'' prefix is allowed to form @code{cm} (centimeters),
27674 but will not apply to other units. The ``deci-,'' ``deka-,'' and
27675 ``hecto-'' prefixes are never used. Thus the allowable interval is
27676 @samp{[1 .. 10)} for millimeters and @samp{[1 .. 100)} for centimeters.
27677 Finally, a prefix will not be added to a unit if the resulting name
27678 is also the actual name of another unit; @samp{1e-15 t} would normally
27679 be considered a ``femto-ton,'' but it is written as @samp{1000 at}
27680 (1000 atto-tons) instead because @code{ft} would be confused with feet.
27681
27682 @node The Units Table, Predefined Units, Basic Operations on Units, Units
27683 @section The Units Table
27684
27685 @noindent
27686 @kindex u v
27687 @pindex calc-enter-units-table
27688 The @kbd{u v} (@code{calc-enter-units-table}) command displays the units table
27689 in another buffer called @code{*Units Table*}. Each entry in this table
27690 gives the unit name as it would appear in an expression, the definition
27691 of the unit in terms of simpler units, and a full name or description of
27692 the unit. Fundamental units are defined as themselves; these are the
27693 units produced by the @kbd{u b} command. The fundamental units are
27694 meters, seconds, grams, kelvins, amperes, candelas, moles, radians,
27695 and steradians.
27696
27697 The Units Table buffer also displays the Unit Prefix Table. Note that
27698 two prefixes, ``kilo'' and ``hecto,'' accept either upper- or lower-case
27699 prefix letters. @samp{Meg} is also accepted as a synonym for the @samp{M}
27700 prefix. Whenever a unit name can be interpreted as either a built-in name
27701 or a prefix followed by another built-in name, the former interpretation
27702 wins. For example, @samp{2 pt} means two pints, not two pico-tons.
27703
27704 The Units Table buffer, once created, is not rebuilt unless you define
27705 new units. To force the buffer to be rebuilt, give any numeric prefix
27706 argument to @kbd{u v}.
27707
27708 @kindex u V
27709 @pindex calc-view-units-table
27710 The @kbd{u V} (@code{calc-view-units-table}) command is like @kbd{u v} except
27711 that the cursor is not moved into the Units Table buffer. You can
27712 type @kbd{u V} again to remove the Units Table from the display. To
27713 return from the Units Table buffer after a @kbd{u v}, type @kbd{M-# c}
27714 again or use the regular Emacs @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window})
27715 command. You can also kill the buffer with @kbd{C-x k} if you wish;
27716 the actual units table is safely stored inside the Calculator.
27717
27718 @kindex u g
27719 @pindex calc-get-unit-definition
27720 The @kbd{u g} (@code{calc-get-unit-definition}) command retrieves a unit's
27721 defining expression and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. For example,
27722 @kbd{u g in} will produce the expression @samp{2.54 cm}. This is the
27723 same definition for the unit that would appear in the Units Table buffer.
27724 Note that this command works only for actual unit names; @kbd{u g km}
27725 will report that no such unit exists, for example, because @code{km} is
27726 really the unit @code{m} with a @code{k} (``kilo'') prefix. To see a
27727 definition of a unit in terms of base units, it is easier to push the
27728 unit name on the stack and then reduce it to base units with @kbd{u b}.
27729
27730 @kindex u e
27731 @pindex calc-explain-units
27732 The @kbd{u e} (@code{calc-explain-units}) command displays an English
27733 description of the units of the expression on the stack. For example,
27734 for the expression @samp{62 km^2 g / s^2 mol K}, the description is
27735 ``Square-Kilometer Gram per (Second-squared Mole Degree-Kelvin).'' This
27736 command uses the English descriptions that appear in the righthand
27737 column of the Units Table.
27738
27739 @node Predefined Units, User-Defined Units, The Units Table, Units
27740 @section Predefined Units
27741
27742 @noindent
27743 Since the exact definitions of many kinds of units have evolved over the
27744 years, and since certain countries sometimes have local differences in
27745 their definitions, it is a good idea to examine Calc's definition of a
27746 unit before depending on its exact value. For example, there are three
27747 different units for gallons, corresponding to the US (@code{gal}),
27748 Canadian (@code{galC}), and British (@code{galUK}) definitions. Also,
27749 note that @code{oz} is a standard ounce of mass, @code{ozt} is a Troy
27750 ounce, and @code{ozfl} is a fluid ounce.
27751
27752 The temperature units corresponding to degrees Kelvin and Centigrade
27753 (Celsius) are the same in this table, since most units commands treat
27754 temperatures as being relative. The @code{calc-convert-temperature}
27755 command has special rules for handling the different absolute magnitudes
27756 of the various temperature scales.
27757
27758 The unit of volume ``liters'' can be referred to by either the lower-case
27759 @code{l} or the upper-case @code{L}.
27760
27761 The unit @code{A} stands for Amperes; the name @code{Ang} is used
27762 @tex
27763 for \AA ngstroms.
27764 @end tex
27765 @ifinfo
27766 for Angstroms.
27767 @end ifinfo
27768
27769 The unit @code{pt} stands for pints; the name @code{point} stands for
27770 a typographical point, defined by @samp{72 point = 1 in}. There is
27771 also @code{tpt}, which stands for a printer's point as defined by the
27772 @TeX{} typesetting system: @samp{72.27 tpt = 1 in}.
27773
27774 The unit @code{e} stands for the elementary (electron) unit of charge;
27775 because algebra command could mistake this for the special constant
27776 @expr{e}, Calc provides the alternate unit name @code{ech} which is
27777 preferable to @code{e}.
27778
27779 The name @code{g} stands for one gram of mass; there is also @code{gf},
27780 one gram of force. (Likewise for @kbd{lb}, pounds, and @kbd{lbf}.)
27781 Meanwhile, one ``@expr{g}'' of acceleration is denoted @code{ga}.
27782
27783 The unit @code{ton} is a U.S. ton of @samp{2000 lb}, and @code{t} is
27784 a metric ton of @samp{1000 kg}.
27785
27786 The names @code{s} (or @code{sec}) and @code{min} refer to units of
27787 time; @code{arcsec} and @code{arcmin} are units of angle.
27788
27789 Some ``units'' are really physical constants; for example, @code{c}
27790 represents the speed of light, and @code{h} represents Planck's
27791 constant. You can use these just like other units: converting
27792 @samp{.5 c} to @samp{m/s} expresses one-half the speed of light in
27793 meters per second. You can also use this merely as a handy reference;
27794 the @kbd{u g} command gets the definition of one of these constants
27795 in its normal terms, and @kbd{u b} expresses the definition in base
27796 units.
27797
27798 Two units, @code{pi} and @code{fsc} (the fine structure constant,
27799 approximately @mathit{1/137}) are dimensionless. The units simplification
27800 commands simply treat these names as equivalent to their corresponding
27801 values. However you can, for example, use @kbd{u c} to convert a pure
27802 number into multiples of the fine structure constant, or @kbd{u b} to
27803 convert this back into a pure number. (When @kbd{u c} prompts for the
27804 ``old units,'' just enter a blank line to signify that the value
27805 really is unitless.)
27806
27807 @c Describe angular units, luminosity vs. steradians problem.
27808
27809 @node User-Defined Units, , Predefined Units, Units
27810 @section User-Defined Units
27811
27812 @noindent
27813 Calc provides ways to get quick access to your selected ``favorite''
27814 units, as well as ways to define your own new units.
27815
27816 @kindex u 0-9
27817 @pindex calc-quick-units
27818 @vindex Units
27819 @cindex @code{Units} variable
27820 @cindex Quick units
27821 To select your favorite units, store a vector of unit names or
27822 expressions in the Calc variable @code{Units}. The @kbd{u 1}
27823 through @kbd{u 9} commands (@code{calc-quick-units}) provide access
27824 to these units. If the value on the top of the stack is a plain
27825 number (with no units attached), then @kbd{u 1} gives it the
27826 specified units. (Basically, it multiplies the number by the
27827 first item in the @code{Units} vector.) If the number on the
27828 stack @emph{does} have units, then @kbd{u 1} converts that number
27829 to the new units. For example, suppose the vector @samp{[in, ft]}
27830 is stored in @code{Units}. Then @kbd{30 u 1} will create the
27831 expression @samp{30 in}, and @kbd{u 2} will convert that expression
27832 to @samp{2.5 ft}.
27833
27834 The @kbd{u 0} command accesses the tenth element of @code{Units}.
27835 Only ten quick units may be defined at a time. If the @code{Units}
27836 variable has no stored value (the default), or if its value is not
27837 a vector, then the quick-units commands will not function. The
27838 @kbd{s U} command is a convenient way to edit the @code{Units}
27839 variable; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27840
27841 @kindex u d
27842 @pindex calc-define-unit
27843 @cindex User-defined units
27844 The @kbd{u d} (@code{calc-define-unit}) command records the units
27845 expression on the top of the stack as the definition for a new,
27846 user-defined unit. For example, putting @samp{16.5 ft} on the stack and
27847 typing @kbd{u d rod} defines the new unit @samp{rod} to be equivalent to
27848 16.5 feet. The unit conversion and simplification commands will now
27849 treat @code{rod} just like any other unit of length. You will also be
27850 prompted for an optional English description of the unit, which will
27851 appear in the Units Table.
27852
27853 @kindex u u
27854 @pindex calc-undefine-unit
27855 The @kbd{u u} (@code{calc-undefine-unit}) command removes a user-defined
27856 unit. It is not possible to remove one of the predefined units,
27857 however.
27858
27859 If you define a unit with an existing unit name, your new definition
27860 will replace the original definition of that unit. If the unit was a
27861 predefined unit, the old definition will not be replaced, only
27862 ``shadowed.'' The built-in definition will reappear if you later use
27863 @kbd{u u} to remove the shadowing definition.
27864
27865 To create a new fundamental unit, use either 1 or the unit name itself
27866 as the defining expression. Otherwise the expression can involve any
27867 other units that you like (except for composite units like @samp{mfi}).
27868 You can create a new composite unit with a sum of other units as the
27869 defining expression. The next unit operation like @kbd{u c} or @kbd{u v}
27870 will rebuild the internal unit table incorporating your modifications.
27871 Note that erroneous definitions (such as two units defined in terms of
27872 each other) will not be detected until the unit table is next rebuilt;
27873 @kbd{u v} is a convenient way to force this to happen.
27874
27875 Temperature units are treated specially inside the Calculator; it is not
27876 possible to create user-defined temperature units.
27877
27878 @kindex u p
27879 @pindex calc-permanent-units
27880 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined units
27881 The @kbd{u p} (@code{calc-permanent-units}) command stores the user-defined
27882 units in your Calc init file (the file given by the variable
27883 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}), so that the
27884 units will still be available in subsequent Emacs sessions. If there
27885 was already a set of user-defined units in your Calc init file, it
27886 is replaced by the new set. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to
27887 tell Calc to use a different file for the Calc init file.)
27888
27889 @node Store and Recall, Graphics, Units, Top
27890 @chapter Storing and Recalling
27891
27892 @noindent
27893 Calculator variables are really just Lisp variables that contain numbers
27894 or formulas in a form that Calc can understand. The commands in this
27895 section allow you to manipulate variables conveniently. Commands related
27896 to variables use the @kbd{s} prefix key.
27897
27898 @menu
27899 * Storing Variables::
27900 * Recalling Variables::
27901 * Operations on Variables::
27902 * Let Command::
27903 * Evaluates-To Operator::
27904 @end menu
27905
27906 @node Storing Variables, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall, Store and Recall
27907 @section Storing Variables
27908
27909 @noindent
27910 @kindex s s
27911 @pindex calc-store
27912 @cindex Storing variables
27913 @cindex Quick variables
27914 @vindex q0
27915 @vindex q9
27916 The @kbd{s s} (@code{calc-store}) command stores the value at the top of
27917 the stack into a specified variable. It prompts you to enter the
27918 name of the variable. If you press a single digit, the value is stored
27919 immediately in one of the ``quick'' variables @code{q0} through
27920 @code{q9}. Or you can enter any variable name.
27921
27922 @kindex s t
27923 @pindex calc-store-into
27924 The @kbd{s s} command leaves the stored value on the stack. There is
27925 also an @kbd{s t} (@code{calc-store-into}) command, which removes a
27926 value from the stack and stores it in a variable.
27927
27928 If the top of stack value is an equation @samp{a = 7} or assignment
27929 @samp{a := 7} with a variable on the lefthand side, then Calc will
27930 assign that variable with that value by default, i.e., if you type
27931 @kbd{s s @key{RET}} or @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. In this example, the
27932 value 7 would be stored in the variable @samp{a}. (If you do type
27933 a variable name at the prompt, the top-of-stack value is stored in
27934 its entirety, even if it is an equation: @samp{s s b @key{RET}}
27935 with @samp{a := 7} on the stack stores @samp{a := 7} in @code{b}.)
27936
27937 In fact, the top of stack value can be a vector of equations or
27938 assignments with different variables on their lefthand sides; the
27939 default will be to store all the variables with their corresponding
27940 righthand sides simultaneously.
27941
27942 It is also possible to type an equation or assignment directly at
27943 the prompt for the @kbd{s s} or @kbd{s t} command: @kbd{s s foo = 7}.
27944 In this case the expression to the right of the @kbd{=} or @kbd{:=}
27945 symbol is evaluated as if by the @kbd{=} command, and that value is
27946 stored in the variable. No value is taken from the stack; @kbd{s s}
27947 and @kbd{s t} are equivalent when used in this way.
27948
27949 @kindex s 0-9
27950 @kindex t 0-9
27951 The prefix keys @kbd{s} and @kbd{t} may be followed immediately by a
27952 digit; @kbd{s 9} is equivalent to @kbd{s s 9}, and @kbd{t 9} is
27953 equivalent to @kbd{s t 9}. (The @kbd{t} prefix is otherwise used
27954 for trail and time/date commands.)
27955
27956 @kindex s +
27957 @kindex s -
27958 @ignore
27959 @mindex @idots
27960 @end ignore
27961 @kindex s *
27962 @ignore
27963 @mindex @null
27964 @end ignore
27965 @kindex s /
27966 @ignore
27967 @mindex @null
27968 @end ignore
27969 @kindex s ^
27970 @ignore
27971 @mindex @null
27972 @end ignore
27973 @kindex s |
27974 @ignore
27975 @mindex @null
27976 @end ignore
27977 @kindex s n
27978 @ignore
27979 @mindex @null
27980 @end ignore
27981 @kindex s &
27982 @ignore
27983 @mindex @null
27984 @end ignore
27985 @kindex s [
27986 @ignore
27987 @mindex @null
27988 @end ignore
27989 @kindex s ]
27990 @pindex calc-store-plus
27991 @pindex calc-store-minus
27992 @pindex calc-store-times
27993 @pindex calc-store-div
27994 @pindex calc-store-power
27995 @pindex calc-store-concat
27996 @pindex calc-store-neg
27997 @pindex calc-store-inv
27998 @pindex calc-store-decr
27999 @pindex calc-store-incr
28000 There are also several ``arithmetic store'' commands. For example,
28001 @kbd{s +} removes a value from the stack and adds it to the specified
28002 variable. The other arithmetic stores are @kbd{s -}, @kbd{s *}, @kbd{s /},
28003 @kbd{s ^}, and @w{@kbd{s |}} (vector concatenation), plus @kbd{s n} and
28004 @kbd{s &} which negate or invert the value in a variable, and @w{@kbd{s [}}
28005 and @kbd{s ]} which decrease or increase a variable by one.
28006
28007 All the arithmetic stores accept the Inverse prefix to reverse the
28008 order of the operands. If @expr{v} represents the contents of the
28009 variable, and @expr{a} is the value drawn from the stack, then regular
28010 @w{@kbd{s -}} assigns
28011 @texline @math{v \coloneq v - a},
28012 @infoline @expr{v := v - a},
28013 but @kbd{I s -} assigns
28014 @texline @math{v \coloneq a - v}.
28015 @infoline @expr{v := a - v}.
28016 While @kbd{I s *} might seem pointless, it is
28017 useful if matrix multiplication is involved. Actually, all the
28018 arithmetic stores use formulas designed to behave usefully both
28019 forwards and backwards:
28020
28021 @example
28022 @group
28023 s + v := v + a v := a + v
28024 s - v := v - a v := a - v
28025 s * v := v * a v := a * v
28026 s / v := v / a v := a / v
28027 s ^ v := v ^ a v := a ^ v
28028 s | v := v | a v := a | v
28029 s n v := v / (-1) v := (-1) / v
28030 s & v := v ^ (-1) v := (-1) ^ v
28031 s [ v := v - 1 v := 1 - v
28032 s ] v := v - (-1) v := (-1) - v
28033 @end group
28034 @end example
28035
28036 In the last four cases, a numeric prefix argument will be used in
28037 place of the number one. (For example, @kbd{M-2 s ]} increases
28038 a variable by 2, and @kbd{M-2 I s ]} replaces a variable by
28039 minus-two minus the variable.
28040
28041 The first six arithmetic stores can also be typed @kbd{s t +}, @kbd{s t -},
28042 etc. The commands @kbd{s s +}, @kbd{s s -}, and so on are analogous
28043 arithmetic stores that don't remove the value @expr{a} from the stack.
28044
28045 All arithmetic stores report the new value of the variable in the
28046 Trail for your information. They signal an error if the variable
28047 previously had no stored value. If default simplifications have been
28048 turned off, the arithmetic stores temporarily turn them on for numeric
28049 arguments only (i.e., they temporarily do an @kbd{m N} command).
28050 @xref{Simplification Modes}. Large vectors put in the trail by
28051 these commands always use abbreviated (@kbd{t .}) mode.
28052
28053 @kindex s m
28054 @pindex calc-store-map
28055 The @kbd{s m} command is a general way to adjust a variable's value
28056 using any Calc function. It is a ``mapping'' command analogous to
28057 @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R}, etc. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, to see
28058 how to specify a function for a mapping command. Basically,
28059 all you do is type the Calc command key that would invoke that
28060 function normally. For example, @kbd{s m n} applies the @kbd{n}
28061 key to negate the contents of the variable, so @kbd{s m n} is
28062 equivalent to @kbd{s n}. Also, @kbd{s m Q} takes the square root
28063 of the value stored in a variable, @kbd{s m v v} uses @kbd{v v} to
28064 reverse the vector stored in the variable, and @kbd{s m H I S}
28065 takes the hyperbolic arcsine of the variable contents.
28066
28067 If the mapping function takes two or more arguments, the additional
28068 arguments are taken from the stack; the old value of the variable
28069 is provided as the first argument. Thus @kbd{s m -} with @expr{a}
28070 on the stack computes @expr{v - a}, just like @kbd{s -}. With the
28071 Inverse prefix, the variable's original value becomes the @emph{last}
28072 argument instead of the first. Thus @kbd{I s m -} is also
28073 equivalent to @kbd{I s -}.
28074
28075 @kindex s x
28076 @pindex calc-store-exchange
28077 The @kbd{s x} (@code{calc-store-exchange}) command exchanges the value
28078 of a variable with the value on the top of the stack. Naturally, the
28079 variable must already have a stored value for this to work.
28080
28081 You can type an equation or assignment at the @kbd{s x} prompt. The
28082 command @kbd{s x a=6} takes no values from the stack; instead, it
28083 pushes the old value of @samp{a} on the stack and stores @samp{a = 6}.
28084
28085 @kindex s u
28086 @pindex calc-unstore
28087 @cindex Void variables
28088 @cindex Un-storing variables
28089 Until you store something in them, variables are ``void,'' that is, they
28090 contain no value at all. If they appear in an algebraic formula they
28091 will be left alone even if you press @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
28092 The @kbd{s u} (@code{calc-unstore}) command returns a variable to the
28093 void state.
28094
28095 The only variables with predefined values are the ``special constants''
28096 @code{pi}, @code{e}, @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}. You are free
28097 to unstore these variables or to store new values into them if you like,
28098 although some of the algebraic-manipulation functions may assume these
28099 variables represent their standard values. Calc displays a warning if
28100 you change the value of one of these variables, or of one of the other
28101 special variables @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} (which are
28102 normally void).
28103
28104 Note that @code{pi} doesn't actually have 3.14159265359 stored
28105 in it, but rather a special magic value that evaluates to @cpi{}
28106 at the current precision. Likewise @code{e}, @code{i}, and
28107 @code{phi} evaluate according to the current precision or polar mode.
28108 If you recall a value from @code{pi} and store it back, this magic
28109 property will be lost.
28110
28111 @kindex s c
28112 @pindex calc-copy-variable
28113 The @kbd{s c} (@code{calc-copy-variable}) command copies the stored
28114 value of one variable to another. It differs from a simple @kbd{s r}
28115 followed by an @kbd{s t} in two important ways. First, the value never
28116 goes on the stack and thus is never rounded, evaluated, or simplified
28117 in any way; it is not even rounded down to the current precision.
28118 Second, the ``magic'' contents of a variable like @code{e} can
28119 be copied into another variable with this command, perhaps because
28120 you need to unstore @code{e} right now but you wish to put it
28121 back when you're done. The @kbd{s c} command is the only way to
28122 manipulate these magic values intact.
28123
28124 @node Recalling Variables, Operations on Variables, Storing Variables, Store and Recall
28125 @section Recalling Variables
28126
28127 @noindent
28128 @kindex s r
28129 @pindex calc-recall
28130 @cindex Recalling variables
28131 The most straightforward way to extract the stored value from a variable
28132 is to use the @kbd{s r} (@code{calc-recall}) command. This command prompts
28133 for a variable name (similarly to @code{calc-store}), looks up the value
28134 of the specified variable, and pushes that value onto the stack. It is
28135 an error to try to recall a void variable.
28136
28137 It is also possible to recall the value from a variable by evaluating a
28138 formula containing that variable. For example, @kbd{' a @key{RET} =} is
28139 the same as @kbd{s r a @key{RET}} except that if the variable is void, the
28140 former will simply leave the formula @samp{a} on the stack whereas the
28141 latter will produce an error message.
28142
28143 @kindex r 0-9
28144 The @kbd{r} prefix may be followed by a digit, so that @kbd{r 9} is
28145 equivalent to @kbd{s r 9}. (The @kbd{r} prefix is otherwise unused
28146 in the current version of Calc.)
28147
28148 @node Operations on Variables, Let Command, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall
28149 @section Other Operations on Variables
28150
28151 @noindent
28152 @kindex s e
28153 @pindex calc-edit-variable
28154 The @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command edits the stored
28155 value of a variable without ever putting that value on the stack
28156 or simplifying or evaluating the value. It prompts for the name of
28157 the variable to edit. If the variable has no stored value, the
28158 editing buffer will start out empty. If the editing buffer is
28159 empty when you press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish, the variable will
28160 be made void. @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, for a general
28161 description of editing.
28162
28163 The @kbd{s e} command is especially useful for creating and editing
28164 rewrite rules which are stored in variables. Sometimes these rules
28165 contain formulas which must not be evaluated until the rules are
28166 actually used. (For example, they may refer to @samp{deriv(x,y)},
28167 where @code{x} will someday become some expression involving @code{y};
28168 if you let Calc evaluate the rule while you are defining it, Calc will
28169 replace @samp{deriv(x,y)} with 0 because the formula @code{x} does
28170 not itself refer to @code{y}.) By contrast, recalling the variable,
28171 editing with @kbd{`}, and storing will evaluate the variable's value
28172 as a side effect of putting the value on the stack.
28173
28174 @kindex s A
28175 @kindex s D
28176 @ignore
28177 @mindex @idots
28178 @end ignore
28179 @kindex s E
28180 @ignore
28181 @mindex @null
28182 @end ignore
28183 @kindex s F
28184 @ignore
28185 @mindex @null
28186 @end ignore
28187 @kindex s G
28188 @ignore
28189 @mindex @null
28190 @end ignore
28191 @kindex s H
28192 @ignore
28193 @mindex @null
28194 @end ignore
28195 @kindex s I
28196 @ignore
28197 @mindex @null
28198 @end ignore
28199 @kindex s L
28200 @ignore
28201 @mindex @null
28202 @end ignore
28203 @kindex s P
28204 @ignore
28205 @mindex @null
28206 @end ignore
28207 @kindex s R
28208 @ignore
28209 @mindex @null
28210 @end ignore
28211 @kindex s T
28212 @ignore
28213 @mindex @null
28214 @end ignore
28215 @kindex s U
28216 @ignore
28217 @mindex @null
28218 @end ignore
28219 @kindex s X
28220 @pindex calc-store-AlgSimpRules
28221 @pindex calc-store-Decls
28222 @pindex calc-store-EvalRules
28223 @pindex calc-store-FitRules
28224 @pindex calc-store-GenCount
28225 @pindex calc-store-Holidays
28226 @pindex calc-store-IntegLimit
28227 @pindex calc-store-LineStyles
28228 @pindex calc-store-PointStyles
28229 @pindex calc-store-PlotRejects
28230 @pindex calc-store-TimeZone
28231 @pindex calc-store-Units
28232 @pindex calc-store-ExtSimpRules
28233 There are several special-purpose variable-editing commands that
28234 use the @kbd{s} prefix followed by a shifted letter:
28235
28236 @table @kbd
28237 @item s A
28238 Edit @code{AlgSimpRules}. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
28239 @item s D
28240 Edit @code{Decls}. @xref{Declarations}.
28241 @item s E
28242 Edit @code{EvalRules}. @xref{Default Simplifications}.
28243 @item s F
28244 Edit @code{FitRules}. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
28245 @item s G
28246 Edit @code{GenCount}. @xref{Solving Equations}.
28247 @item s H
28248 Edit @code{Holidays}. @xref{Business Days}.
28249 @item s I
28250 Edit @code{IntegLimit}. @xref{Calculus}.
28251 @item s L
28252 Edit @code{LineStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28253 @item s P
28254 Edit @code{PointStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28255 @item s R
28256 Edit @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Graphics}.
28257 @item s T
28258 Edit @code{TimeZone}. @xref{Time Zones}.
28259 @item s U
28260 Edit @code{Units}. @xref{User-Defined Units}.
28261 @item s X
28262 Edit @code{ExtSimpRules}. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
28263 @end table
28264
28265 These commands are just versions of @kbd{s e} that use fixed variable
28266 names rather than prompting for the variable name.
28267
28268 @kindex s p
28269 @pindex calc-permanent-variable
28270 @cindex Storing variables
28271 @cindex Permanent variables
28272 @cindex Calc init file, variables
28273 The @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command saves a
28274 variable's value permanently in your Calc init file (the file given by
28275 the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}), so
28276 that its value will still be available in future Emacs sessions. You
28277 can re-execute @w{@kbd{s p}} later on to update the saved value, but the
28278 only way to remove a saved variable is to edit your calc init file
28279 by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
28280 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28281
28282 If you do not specify the name of a variable to save (i.e.,
28283 @kbd{s p @key{RET}}), all Calc variables with defined values
28284 are saved except for the special constants @code{pi}, @code{e},
28285 @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}; the variables @code{TimeZone}
28286 and @code{PlotRejects};
28287 @code{FitRules}, @code{DistribRules}, and other built-in rewrite
28288 rules; and @code{PlotData@var{n}} variables generated
28289 by the graphics commands. (You can still save these variables by
28290 explicitly naming them in an @kbd{s p} command.)
28291
28292 @kindex s i
28293 @pindex calc-insert-variables
28294 The @kbd{s i} (@code{calc-insert-variables}) command writes
28295 the values of all Calc variables into a specified buffer.
28296 The variables are written with the prefix @code{var-} in the form of
28297 Lisp @code{setq} commands
28298 which store the values in string form. You can place these commands
28299 in your Calc init file (or @file{.emacs}) if you wish, though in this case it
28300 would be easier to use @kbd{s p @key{RET}}. (Note that @kbd{s i}
28301 omits the same set of variables as @w{@kbd{s p @key{RET}}}; the difference
28302 is that @kbd{s i} will store the variables in any buffer, and it also
28303 stores in a more human-readable format.)
28304
28305 @node Let Command, Evaluates-To Operator, Operations on Variables, Store and Recall
28306 @section The Let Command
28307
28308 @noindent
28309 @kindex s l
28310 @pindex calc-let
28311 @cindex Variables, temporary assignment
28312 @cindex Temporary assignment to variables
28313 If you have an expression like @samp{a+b^2} on the stack and you wish to
28314 compute its value where @expr{b=3}, you can simply store 3 in @expr{b} and
28315 then press @kbd{=} to reevaluate the formula. This has the side-effect
28316 of leaving the stored value of 3 in @expr{b} for future operations.
28317
28318 The @kbd{s l} (@code{calc-let}) command evaluates a formula under a
28319 @emph{temporary} assignment of a variable. It stores the value on the
28320 top of the stack into the specified variable, then evaluates the
28321 second-to-top stack entry, then restores the original value (or lack of one)
28322 in the variable. Thus after @kbd{'@w{ }a+b^2 @key{RET} 3 s l b @key{RET}},
28323 the stack will contain the formula @samp{a + 9}. The subsequent command
28324 @kbd{@w{5 s l a} @key{RET}} will replace this formula with the number 14.
28325 The variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} are not permanently affected in any way
28326 by these commands.
28327
28328 The value on the top of the stack may be an equation or assignment, or
28329 a vector of equations or assignments, in which case the default will be
28330 analogous to the case of @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
28331
28332 Also, you can answer the variable-name prompt with an equation or
28333 assignment: @kbd{s l b=3 @key{RET}} is the same as storing 3 on the stack
28334 and typing @kbd{s l b @key{RET}}.
28335
28336 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) command is another way to substitute
28337 a variable with a value in a formula. It does an actual substitution
28338 rather than temporarily assigning the variable and evaluating. For
28339 example, letting @expr{n=2} in @samp{f(n pi)} with @kbd{a b} will
28340 produce @samp{f(2 pi)}, whereas @kbd{s l} would give @samp{f(6.28)}
28341 since the evaluation step will also evaluate @code{pi}.
28342
28343 @node Evaluates-To Operator, , Let Command, Store and Recall
28344 @section The Evaluates-To Operator
28345
28346 @noindent
28347 @tindex evalto
28348 @tindex =>
28349 @cindex Evaluates-to operator
28350 @cindex @samp{=>} operator
28351 The special algebraic symbol @samp{=>} is known as the @dfn{evaluates-to
28352 operator}. (It will show up as an @code{evalto} function call in
28353 other language modes like Pascal and La@TeX{}.) This is a binary
28354 operator, that is, it has a lefthand and a righthand argument,
28355 although it can be entered with the righthand argument omitted.
28356
28357 A formula like @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}} is evaluated by Calc as
28358 follows: First, @var{a} is not simplified or modified in any
28359 way. The previous value of argument @var{b} is thrown away; the
28360 formula @var{a} is then copied and evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
28361 command according to all current modes and stored variable values,
28362 and the result is installed as the new value of @var{b}.
28363
28364 For example, suppose you enter the algebraic formula @samp{2 + 3 => 17}.
28365 The number 17 is ignored, and the lefthand argument is left in its
28366 unevaluated form; the result is the formula @samp{2 + 3 => 5}.
28367
28368 @kindex s =
28369 @pindex calc-evalto
28370 You can enter an @samp{=>} formula either directly using algebraic
28371 entry (in which case the righthand side may be omitted since it is
28372 going to be replaced right away anyhow), or by using the @kbd{s =}
28373 (@code{calc-evalto}) command, which takes @var{a} from the stack
28374 and replaces it with @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}}.
28375
28376 Calc keeps track of all @samp{=>} operators on the stack, and
28377 recomputes them whenever anything changes that might affect their
28378 values, i.e., a mode setting or variable value. This occurs only
28379 if the @samp{=>} operator is at the top level of the formula, or
28380 if it is part of a top-level vector. In other words, pushing
28381 @samp{2 + (a => 17)} will change the 17 to the actual value of
28382 @samp{a} when you enter the formula, but the result will not be
28383 dynamically updated when @samp{a} is changed later because the
28384 @samp{=>} operator is buried inside a sum. However, a vector
28385 of @samp{=>} operators will be recomputed, since it is convenient
28386 to push a vector like @samp{[a =>, b =>, c =>]} on the stack to
28387 make a concise display of all the variables in your problem.
28388 (Another way to do this would be to use @samp{[a, b, c] =>},
28389 which provides a slightly different format of display. You
28390 can use whichever you find easiest to read.)
28391
28392 @kindex m C
28393 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
28394 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command allows you to
28395 turn this automatic recomputation on or off. If you turn
28396 recomputation off, you must explicitly recompute an @samp{=>}
28397 operator on the stack in one of the usual ways, such as by
28398 pressing @kbd{=}. Turning recomputation off temporarily can save
28399 a lot of time if you will be changing several modes or variables
28400 before you look at the @samp{=>} entries again.
28401
28402 Most commands are not especially useful with @samp{=>} operators
28403 as arguments. For example, given @samp{x + 2 => 17}, it won't
28404 work to type @kbd{1 +} to get @samp{x + 3 => 18}. If you want
28405 to operate on the lefthand side of the @samp{=>} operator on
28406 the top of the stack, type @kbd{j 1} (that's the digit ``one'')
28407 to select the lefthand side, execute your commands, then type
28408 @kbd{j u} to unselect.
28409
28410 All current modes apply when an @samp{=>} operator is computed,
28411 including the current simplification mode. Recall that the
28412 formula @samp{x + y + x} is not handled by Calc's default
28413 simplifications, but the @kbd{a s} command will reduce it to
28414 the simpler form @samp{y + 2 x}. You can also type @kbd{m A}
28415 to enable an Algebraic Simplification mode in which the
28416 equivalent of @kbd{a s} is used on all of Calc's results.
28417 If you enter @samp{x + y + x =>} normally, the result will
28418 be @samp{x + y + x => x + y + x}. If you change to
28419 Algebraic Simplification mode, the result will be
28420 @samp{x + y + x => y + 2 x}. However, just pressing @kbd{a s}
28421 once will have no effect on @samp{x + y + x => x + y + x},
28422 because the righthand side depends only on the lefthand side
28423 and the current mode settings, and the lefthand side is not
28424 affected by commands like @kbd{a s}.
28425
28426 The ``let'' command (@kbd{s l}) has an interesting interaction
28427 with the @samp{=>} operator. The @kbd{s l} command evaluates the
28428 second-to-top stack entry with the top stack entry supplying
28429 a temporary value for a given variable. As you might expect,
28430 if that stack entry is an @samp{=>} operator its righthand
28431 side will temporarily show this value for the variable. In
28432 fact, all @samp{=>}s on the stack will be updated if they refer
28433 to that variable. But this change is temporary in the sense
28434 that the next command that causes Calc to look at those stack
28435 entries will make them revert to the old variable value.
28436
28437 @smallexample
28438 @group
28439 2: a => a 2: a => 17 2: a => a
28440 1: a + 1 => a + 1 1: a + 1 => 18 1: a + 1 => a + 1
28441 . . .
28442
28443 17 s l a @key{RET} p 8 @key{RET}
28444 @end group
28445 @end smallexample
28446
28447 Here the @kbd{p 8} command changes the current precision,
28448 thus causing the @samp{=>} forms to be recomputed after the
28449 influence of the ``let'' is gone. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command
28450 (@code{calc-refresh}) is a handy way to force the @samp{=>}
28451 operators on the stack to be recomputed without any other
28452 side effects.
28453
28454 @kindex s :
28455 @pindex calc-assign
28456 @tindex assign
28457 @tindex :=
28458 Embedded mode also uses @samp{=>} operators. In Embedded mode,
28459 the lefthand side of an @samp{=>} operator can refer to variables
28460 assigned elsewhere in the file by @samp{:=} operators. The
28461 assignment operator @samp{a := 17} does not actually do anything
28462 by itself. But Embedded mode recognizes it and marks it as a sort
28463 of file-local definition of the variable. You can enter @samp{:=}
28464 operators in Algebraic mode, or by using the @kbd{s :}
28465 (@code{calc-assign}) [@code{assign}] command which takes a variable
28466 and value from the stack and replaces them with an assignment.
28467
28468 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for the way @samp{=>} appears in
28469 @TeX{} language output. The @dfn{eqn} mode gives similar
28470 treatment to @samp{=>}.
28471
28472 @node Graphics, Kill and Yank, Store and Recall, Top
28473 @chapter Graphics
28474
28475 @noindent
28476 The commands for graphing data begin with the @kbd{g} prefix key. Calc
28477 uses GNUPLOT 2.0 or 3.0 to do graphics. These commands will only work
28478 if GNUPLOT is available on your system. (While GNUPLOT sounds like
28479 a relative of GNU Emacs, it is actually completely unrelated.
28480 However, it is free software and can be obtained from the Free
28481 Software Foundation's machine @samp{prep.ai.mit.edu}.)
28482
28483 @vindex calc-gnuplot-name
28484 If you have GNUPLOT installed on your system but Calc is unable to
28485 find it, you may need to set the @code{calc-gnuplot-name} variable
28486 in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs}. You may also need to set some Lisp
28487 variables to show Calc how to run GNUPLOT on your system; these
28488 are described under @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} below. If you are
28489 using the X window system, Calc will configure GNUPLOT for you
28490 automatically. If you have GNUPLOT 3.0 and you are not using X,
28491 Calc will configure GNUPLOT to display graphs using simple character
28492 graphics that will work on any terminal.
28493
28494 @menu
28495 * Basic Graphics::
28496 * Three Dimensional Graphics::
28497 * Managing Curves::
28498 * Graphics Options::
28499 * Devices::
28500 @end menu
28501
28502 @node Basic Graphics, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics, Graphics
28503 @section Basic Graphics
28504
28505 @noindent
28506 @kindex g f
28507 @pindex calc-graph-fast
28508 The easiest graphics command is @kbd{g f} (@code{calc-graph-fast}).
28509 This command takes two vectors of equal length from the stack.
28510 The vector at the top of the stack represents the ``y'' values of
28511 the various data points. The vector in the second-to-top position
28512 represents the corresponding ``x'' values. This command runs
28513 GNUPLOT (if it has not already been started by previous graphing
28514 commands) and displays the set of data points. The points will
28515 be connected by lines, and there will also be some kind of symbol
28516 to indicate the points themselves.
28517
28518 The ``x'' entry may instead be an interval form, in which case suitable
28519 ``x'' values are interpolated between the minimum and maximum values of
28520 the interval (whether the interval is open or closed is ignored).
28521
28522 The ``x'' entry may also be a number, in which case Calc uses the
28523 sequence of ``x'' values @expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, @expr{x+2}, etc.
28524 (Generally the number 0 or 1 would be used for @expr{x} in this case.)
28525
28526 The ``y'' entry may be any formula instead of a vector. Calc effectively
28527 uses @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) to evaluate variables in the formula;
28528 the result of this must be a formula in a single (unassigned) variable.
28529 The formula is plotted with this variable taking on the various ``x''
28530 values. Graphs of formulas by default use lines without symbols at the
28531 computed data points. Note that if neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is a vector,
28532 Calc guesses at a reasonable number of data points to use. See the
28533 @kbd{g N} command below. (The ``x'' values must be either a vector
28534 or an interval if ``y'' is a formula.)
28535
28536 @ignore
28537 @starindex
28538 @end ignore
28539 @tindex xy
28540 If ``y'' is (or evaluates to) a formula of the form
28541 @samp{xy(@var{x}, @var{y})} then the result is a
28542 parametric plot. The two arguments of the fictitious @code{xy} function
28543 are used as the ``x'' and ``y'' coordinates of the curve, respectively.
28544 In this case the ``x'' vector or interval you specified is not directly
28545 visible in the graph. For example, if ``x'' is the interval @samp{[0..360]}
28546 and ``y'' is the formula @samp{xy(sin(t), cos(t))}, the resulting graph
28547 will be a circle.
28548
28549 Also, ``x'' and ``y'' may each be variable names, in which case Calc
28550 looks for suitable vectors, intervals, or formulas stored in those
28551 variables.
28552
28553 The ``x'' and ``y'' values for the data points (as pulled from the vectors,
28554 calculated from the formulas, or interpolated from the intervals) should
28555 be real numbers (integers, fractions, or floats). If either the ``x''
28556 value or the ``y'' value of a given data point is not a real number, that
28557 data point will be omitted from the graph. The points on either side
28558 of the invalid point will @emph{not} be connected by a line.
28559
28560 See the documentation for @kbd{g a} below for a description of the way
28561 numeric prefix arguments affect @kbd{g f}.
28562
28563 @cindex @code{PlotRejects} variable
28564 @vindex PlotRejects
28565 If you store an empty vector in the variable @code{PlotRejects}
28566 (i.e., @kbd{[ ] s t PlotRejects}), Calc will append information to
28567 this vector for every data point which was rejected because its
28568 ``x'' or ``y'' values were not real numbers. The result will be
28569 a matrix where each row holds the curve number, data point number,
28570 ``x'' value, and ``y'' value for a rejected data point.
28571 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a handy way to keep tabs on the
28572 current value of @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Operations on Variables},
28573 for the @kbd{s R} command which is another easy way to examine
28574 @code{PlotRejects}.
28575
28576 @kindex g c
28577 @pindex calc-graph-clear
28578 To clear the graphics display, type @kbd{g c} (@code{calc-graph-clear}).
28579 If the GNUPLOT output device is an X window, the window will go away.
28580 Effects on other kinds of output devices will vary. You don't need
28581 to use @kbd{g c} if you don't want to---if you give another @kbd{g f}
28582 or @kbd{g p} command later on, it will reuse the existing graphics
28583 window if there is one.
28584
28585 @node Three Dimensional Graphics, Managing Curves, Basic Graphics, Graphics
28586 @section Three-Dimensional Graphics
28587
28588 @kindex g F
28589 @pindex calc-graph-fast-3d
28590 The @kbd{g F} (@code{calc-graph-fast-3d}) command makes a three-dimensional
28591 graph. It works only if you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later; with GNUPLOT 2.0,
28592 you will see a GNUPLOT error message if you try this command.
28593
28594 The @kbd{g F} command takes three values from the stack, called ``x'',
28595 ``y'', and ``z'', respectively. As was the case for 2D graphs, there
28596 are several options for these values.
28597
28598 In the first case, ``x'' and ``y'' are each vectors (not necessarily of
28599 the same length); either or both may instead be interval forms. The
28600 ``z'' value must be a matrix with the same number of rows as elements
28601 in ``x'', and the same number of columns as elements in ``y''. The
28602 result is a surface plot where
28603 @texline @math{z_{ij}}
28604 @infoline @expr{z_ij}
28605 is the height of the point
28606 at coordinate @expr{(x_i, y_j)} on the surface. The 3D graph will
28607 be displayed from a certain default viewpoint; you can change this
28608 viewpoint by adding a @samp{set view} to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
28609 buffer as described later. See the GNUPLOT 3.0 documentation for a
28610 description of the @samp{set view} command.
28611
28612 Each point in the matrix will be displayed as a dot in the graph,
28613 and these points will be connected by a grid of lines (@dfn{isolines}).
28614
28615 In the second case, ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' are all vectors of equal
28616 length. The resulting graph displays a 3D line instead of a surface,
28617 where the coordinates of points along the line are successive triplets
28618 of values from the input vectors.
28619
28620 In the third case, ``x'' and ``y'' are vectors or interval forms, and
28621 ``z'' is any formula involving two variables (not counting variables
28622 with assigned values). These variables are sorted into alphabetical
28623 order; the first takes on values from ``x'' and the second takes on
28624 values from ``y'' to form a matrix of results that are graphed as a
28625 3D surface.
28626
28627 @ignore
28628 @starindex
28629 @end ignore
28630 @tindex xyz
28631 If the ``z'' formula evaluates to a call to the fictitious function
28632 @samp{xyz(@var{x}, @var{y}, @var{z})}, then the result is a
28633 ``parametric surface.'' In this case, the axes of the graph are
28634 taken from the @var{x} and @var{y} values in these calls, and the
28635 ``x'' and ``y'' values from the input vectors or intervals are used only
28636 to specify the range of inputs to the formula. For example, plotting
28637 @samp{[0..360], [0..180], xyz(sin(x)*sin(y), cos(x)*sin(y), cos(y))}
28638 will draw a sphere. (Since the default resolution for 3D plots is
28639 5 steps in each of ``x'' and ``y'', this will draw a very crude
28640 sphere. You could use the @kbd{g N} command, described below, to
28641 increase this resolution, or specify the ``x'' and ``y'' values as
28642 vectors with more than 5 elements.
28643
28644 It is also possible to have a function in a regular @kbd{g f} plot
28645 evaluate to an @code{xyz} call. Since @kbd{g f} plots a line, not
28646 a surface, the result will be a 3D parametric line. For example,
28647 @samp{[[0..720], xyz(sin(x), cos(x), x)]} will plot two turns of a
28648 helix (a three-dimensional spiral).
28649
28650 As for @kbd{g f}, each of ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' may instead be
28651 variables containing the relevant data.
28652
28653 @node Managing Curves, Graphics Options, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics
28654 @section Managing Curves
28655
28656 @noindent
28657 The @kbd{g f} command is really shorthand for the following commands:
28658 @kbd{C-u g d g a g p}. Likewise, @w{@kbd{g F}} is shorthand for
28659 @kbd{C-u g d g A g p}. You can gain more control over your graph
28660 by using these commands directly.
28661
28662 @kindex g a
28663 @pindex calc-graph-add
28664 The @kbd{g a} (@code{calc-graph-add}) command adds the ``curve''
28665 represented by the two values on the top of the stack to the current
28666 graph. You can have any number of curves in the same graph. When
28667 you give the @kbd{g p} command, all the curves will be drawn superimposed
28668 on the same axes.
28669
28670 The @kbd{g a} command (and many others that affect the current graph)
28671 will cause a special buffer, @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}, to be displayed
28672 in another window. This buffer is a template of the commands that will
28673 be sent to GNUPLOT when it is time to draw the graph. The first
28674 @kbd{g a} command adds a @code{plot} command to this buffer. Succeeding
28675 @kbd{g a} commands add extra curves onto that @code{plot} command.
28676 Other graph-related commands put other GNUPLOT commands into this
28677 buffer. In normal usage you never need to work with this buffer
28678 directly, but you can if you wish. The only constraint is that there
28679 must be only one @code{plot} command, and it must be the last command
28680 in the buffer. If you want to save and later restore a complete graph
28681 configuration, you can use regular Emacs commands to save and restore
28682 the contents of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
28683
28684 @vindex PlotData1
28685 @vindex PlotData2
28686 If the values on the stack are not variable names, @kbd{g a} will invent
28687 variable names for them (of the form @samp{PlotData@var{n}}) and store
28688 the values in those variables. The ``x'' and ``y'' variables are what
28689 go into the @code{plot} command in the template. If you add a curve
28690 that uses a certain variable and then later change that variable, you
28691 can replot the graph without having to delete and re-add the curve.
28692 That's because the variable name, not the vector, interval or formula
28693 itself, is what was added by @kbd{g a}.
28694
28695 A numeric prefix argument on @kbd{g a} or @kbd{g f} changes the way
28696 stack entries are interpreted as curves. With a positive prefix
28697 argument @expr{n}, the top @expr{n} stack entries are ``y'' values
28698 for @expr{n} different curves which share a common ``x'' value in
28699 the @expr{n+1}st stack entry. (Thus @kbd{g a} with no prefix
28700 argument is equivalent to @kbd{C-u 1 g a}.)
28701
28702 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} means to take two stack entries,
28703 ``x'' and ``y'' as usual, but to interpret ``y'' as a vector of
28704 ``y'' values for several curves that share a common ``x''.
28705
28706 A negative prefix argument tells Calc to read @expr{n} vectors from
28707 the stack; each vector @expr{[x, y]} describes an independent curve.
28708 This is the only form of @kbd{g a} that creates several curves at once
28709 that don't have common ``x'' values. (Of course, the range of ``x''
28710 values covered by all the curves ought to be roughly the same if
28711 they are to look nice on the same graph.)
28712
28713 For example, to plot
28714 @texline @math{\sin n x}
28715 @infoline @expr{sin(n x)}
28716 for integers @expr{n}
28717 from 1 to 5, you could use @kbd{v x} to create a vector of integers
28718 (@expr{n}), then @kbd{V M '} or @kbd{V M $} to map @samp{sin(n x)}
28719 across this vector. The resulting vector of formulas is suitable
28720 for use as the ``y'' argument to a @kbd{C-u g a} or @kbd{C-u g f}
28721 command.
28722
28723 @kindex g A
28724 @pindex calc-graph-add-3d
28725 The @kbd{g A} (@code{calc-graph-add-3d}) command adds a 3D curve
28726 to the graph. It is not legal to intermix 2D and 3D curves in a
28727 single graph. This command takes three arguments, ``x'', ``y'',
28728 and ``z'', from the stack. With a positive prefix @expr{n}, it
28729 takes @expr{n+2} arguments (common ``x'' and ``y'', plus @expr{n}
28730 separate ``z''s). With a zero prefix, it takes three stack entries
28731 but the ``z'' entry is a vector of curve values. With a negative
28732 prefix @expr{-n}, it takes @expr{n} vectors of the form @expr{[x, y, z]}.
28733 The @kbd{g A} command works by adding a @code{splot} (surface-plot)
28734 command to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
28735
28736 (Although @kbd{g a} adds a 2D @code{plot} command to the
28737 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer, Calc changes this to @code{splot}
28738 before sending it to GNUPLOT if it notices that the data points are
28739 evaluating to @code{xyz} calls. It will not work to mix 2D and 3D
28740 @kbd{g a} curves in a single graph, although Calc does not currently
28741 check for this.)
28742
28743 @kindex g d
28744 @pindex calc-graph-delete
28745 The @kbd{g d} (@code{calc-graph-delete}) command deletes the most
28746 recently added curve from the graph. It has no effect if there are
28747 no curves in the graph. With a numeric prefix argument of any kind,
28748 it deletes all of the curves from the graph.
28749
28750 @kindex g H
28751 @pindex calc-graph-hide
28752 The @kbd{g H} (@code{calc-graph-hide}) command ``hides'' or ``unhides''
28753 the most recently added curve. A hidden curve will not appear in
28754 the actual plot, but information about it such as its name and line and
28755 point styles will be retained.
28756
28757 @kindex g j
28758 @pindex calc-graph-juggle
28759 The @kbd{g j} (@code{calc-graph-juggle}) command moves the curve
28760 at the end of the list (the ``most recently added curve'') to the
28761 front of the list. The next-most-recent curve is thus exposed for
28762 @w{@kbd{g d}} or similar commands to use. With @kbd{g j} you can work
28763 with any curve in the graph even though curve-related commands only
28764 affect the last curve in the list.
28765
28766 @kindex g p
28767 @pindex calc-graph-plot
28768 The @kbd{g p} (@code{calc-graph-plot}) command uses GNUPLOT to draw
28769 the graph described in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Any
28770 GNUPLOT parameters which are not defined by commands in this buffer
28771 are reset to their default values. The variables named in the @code{plot}
28772 command are written to a temporary data file and the variable names
28773 are then replaced by the file name in the template. The resulting
28774 plotting commands are fed to the GNUPLOT program. See the documentation
28775 for the GNUPLOT program for more specific information. All temporary
28776 files are removed when Emacs or GNUPLOT exits.
28777
28778 If you give a formula for ``y'', Calc will remember all the values that
28779 it calculates for the formula so that later plots can reuse these values.
28780 Calc throws out these saved values when you change any circumstances
28781 that may affect the data, such as switching from Degrees to Radians
28782 mode, or changing the value of a parameter in the formula. You can
28783 force Calc to recompute the data from scratch by giving a negative
28784 numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}.
28785
28786 Calc uses a fairly rough step size when graphing formulas over intervals.
28787 This is to ensure quick response. You can ``refine'' a plot by giving
28788 a positive numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}. Calc goes through
28789 the data points it has computed and saved from previous plots of the
28790 function, and computes and inserts a new data point midway between
28791 each of the existing points. You can refine a plot any number of times,
28792 but beware that the amount of calculation involved doubles each time.
28793
28794 Calc does not remember computed values for 3D graphs. This means the
28795 numerix prefix argument, if any, to @kbd{g p} is effectively ignored if
28796 the current graph is three-dimensional.
28797
28798 @kindex g P
28799 @pindex calc-graph-print
28800 The @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}) command is like @kbd{g p},
28801 except that it sends the output to a printer instead of to the
28802 screen. More precisely, @kbd{g p} looks for @samp{set terminal}
28803 or @samp{set output} commands in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer;
28804 lacking these it uses the default settings. However, @kbd{g P}
28805 ignores @samp{set terminal} and @samp{set output} commands and
28806 uses a different set of default values. All of these values are
28807 controlled by the @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} commands discussed below.
28808 Provided everything is set up properly, @kbd{g p} will plot to
28809 the screen unless you have specified otherwise and @kbd{g P} will
28810 always plot to the printer.
28811
28812 @node Graphics Options, Devices, Managing Curves, Graphics
28813 @section Graphics Options
28814
28815 @noindent
28816 @kindex g g
28817 @pindex calc-graph-grid
28818 The @kbd{g g} (@code{calc-graph-grid}) command turns the ``grid''
28819 on and off. It is off by default; tick marks appear only at the
28820 edges of the graph. With the grid turned on, dotted lines appear
28821 across the graph at each tick mark. Note that this command only
28822 changes the setting in @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}; to see the effects
28823 of the change you must give another @kbd{g p} command.
28824
28825 @kindex g b
28826 @pindex calc-graph-border
28827 The @kbd{g b} (@code{calc-graph-border}) command turns the border
28828 (the box that surrounds the graph) on and off. It is on by default.
28829 This command will only work with GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
28830
28831 @kindex g k
28832 @pindex calc-graph-key
28833 The @kbd{g k} (@code{calc-graph-key}) command turns the ``key''
28834 on and off. The key is a chart in the corner of the graph that
28835 shows the correspondence between curves and line styles. It is
28836 off by default, and is only really useful if you have several
28837 curves on the same graph.
28838
28839 @kindex g N
28840 @pindex calc-graph-num-points
28841 The @kbd{g N} (@code{calc-graph-num-points}) command allows you
28842 to select the number of data points in the graph. This only affects
28843 curves where neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is specified as a vector.
28844 Enter a blank line to revert to the default value (initially 15).
28845 With no prefix argument, this command affects only the current graph.
28846 With a positive prefix argument this command changes or, if you enter
28847 a blank line, displays the default number of points used for all
28848 graphs created by @kbd{g a} that don't specify the resolution explicitly.
28849 With a negative prefix argument, this command changes or displays
28850 the default value (initially 5) used for 3D graphs created by @kbd{g A}.
28851 Note that a 3D setting of 5 means that a total of @expr{5^2 = 25} points
28852 will be computed for the surface.
28853
28854 Data values in the graph of a function are normally computed to a
28855 precision of five digits, regardless of the current precision at the
28856 time. This is usually more than adequate, but there are cases where
28857 it will not be. For example, plotting @expr{1 + x} with @expr{x} in the
28858 interval @samp{[0 ..@: 1e-6]} will round all the data points down
28859 to 1.0! Putting the command @samp{set precision @var{n}} in the
28860 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer will cause the data to be computed
28861 at precision @var{n} instead of 5. Since this is such a rare case,
28862 there is no keystroke-based command to set the precision.
28863
28864 @kindex g h
28865 @pindex calc-graph-header
28866 The @kbd{g h} (@code{calc-graph-header}) command sets the title
28867 for the graph. This will show up centered above the graph.
28868 The default title is blank (no title).
28869
28870 @kindex g n
28871 @pindex calc-graph-name
28872 The @kbd{g n} (@code{calc-graph-name}) command sets the title of an
28873 individual curve. Like the other curve-manipulating commands, it
28874 affects the most recently added curve, i.e., the last curve on the
28875 list in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. To set the title of
28876 the other curves you must first juggle them to the end of the list
28877 with @kbd{g j}, or edit the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer by hand.
28878 Curve titles appear in the key; if the key is turned off they are
28879 not used.
28880
28881 @kindex g t
28882 @kindex g T
28883 @pindex calc-graph-title-x
28884 @pindex calc-graph-title-y
28885 The @kbd{g t} (@code{calc-graph-title-x}) and @kbd{g T}
28886 (@code{calc-graph-title-y}) commands set the titles on the ``x''
28887 and ``y'' axes, respectively. These titles appear next to the
28888 tick marks on the left and bottom edges of the graph, respectively.
28889 Calc does not have commands to control the tick marks themselves,
28890 but you can edit them into the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer if
28891 you wish. See the GNUPLOT documentation for details.
28892
28893 @kindex g r
28894 @kindex g R
28895 @pindex calc-graph-range-x
28896 @pindex calc-graph-range-y
28897 The @kbd{g r} (@code{calc-graph-range-x}) and @kbd{g R}
28898 (@code{calc-graph-range-y}) commands set the range of values on the
28899 ``x'' and ``y'' axes, respectively. You are prompted to enter a
28900 suitable range. This should be either a pair of numbers of the
28901 form, @samp{@var{min}:@var{max}}, or a blank line to revert to the
28902 default behavior of setting the range based on the range of values
28903 in the data, or @samp{$} to take the range from the top of the stack.
28904 Ranges on the stack can be represented as either interval forms or
28905 vectors: @samp{[@var{min} ..@: @var{max}]} or @samp{[@var{min}, @var{max}]}.
28906
28907 @kindex g l
28908 @kindex g L
28909 @pindex calc-graph-log-x
28910 @pindex calc-graph-log-y
28911 The @kbd{g l} (@code{calc-graph-log-x}) and @kbd{g L} (@code{calc-graph-log-y})
28912 commands allow you to set either or both of the axes of the graph to
28913 be logarithmic instead of linear.
28914
28915 @kindex g C-l
28916 @kindex g C-r
28917 @kindex g C-t
28918 @pindex calc-graph-log-z
28919 @pindex calc-graph-range-z
28920 @pindex calc-graph-title-z
28921 For 3D plots, @kbd{g C-t}, @kbd{g C-r}, and @kbd{g C-l} (those are
28922 letters with the Control key held down) are the corresponding commands
28923 for the ``z'' axis.
28924
28925 @kindex g z
28926 @kindex g Z
28927 @pindex calc-graph-zero-x
28928 @pindex calc-graph-zero-y
28929 The @kbd{g z} (@code{calc-graph-zero-x}) and @kbd{g Z}
28930 (@code{calc-graph-zero-y}) commands control whether a dotted line is
28931 drawn to indicate the ``x'' and/or ``y'' zero axes. (These are the same
28932 dotted lines that would be drawn there anyway if you used @kbd{g g} to
28933 turn the ``grid'' feature on.) Zero-axis lines are on by default, and
28934 may be turned off only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions. They are
28935 not available for 3D plots.
28936
28937 @kindex g s
28938 @pindex calc-graph-line-style
28939 The @kbd{g s} (@code{calc-graph-line-style}) command turns the connecting
28940 lines on or off for the most recently added curve, and optionally selects
28941 the style of lines to be used for that curve. Plain @kbd{g s} simply
28942 toggles the lines on and off. With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g s}
28943 turns lines on and sets a particular line style. Line style numbers
28944 start at one and their meanings vary depending on the output device.
28945 GNUPLOT guarantees that there will be at least six different line styles
28946 available for any device.
28947
28948 @kindex g S
28949 @pindex calc-graph-point-style
28950 The @kbd{g S} (@code{calc-graph-point-style}) command similarly turns
28951 the symbols at the data points on or off, or sets the point style.
28952 If you turn both lines and points off, the data points will show as
28953 tiny dots.
28954
28955 @cindex @code{LineStyles} variable
28956 @cindex @code{PointStyles} variable
28957 @vindex LineStyles
28958 @vindex PointStyles
28959 Another way to specify curve styles is with the @code{LineStyles} and
28960 @code{PointStyles} variables. These variables initially have no stored
28961 values, but if you store a vector of integers in one of these variables,
28962 the @kbd{g a} and @kbd{g f} commands will use those style numbers
28963 instead of the defaults for new curves that are added to the graph.
28964 An entry should be a positive integer for a specific style, or 0 to let
28965 the style be chosen automatically, or @mathit{-1} to turn off lines or points
28966 altogether. If there are more curves than elements in the vector, the
28967 last few curves will continue to have the default styles. Of course,
28968 you can later use @kbd{g s} and @kbd{g S} to change any of these styles.
28969
28970 For example, @kbd{'[2 -1 3] @key{RET} s t LineStyles} causes the first curve
28971 to have lines in style number 2, the second curve to have no connecting
28972 lines, and the third curve to have lines in style 3. Point styles will
28973 still be assigned automatically, but you could store another vector in
28974 @code{PointStyles} to define them, too.
28975
28976 @node Devices, , Graphics Options, Graphics
28977 @section Graphical Devices
28978
28979 @noindent
28980 @kindex g D
28981 @pindex calc-graph-device
28982 The @kbd{g D} (@code{calc-graph-device}) command sets the device name
28983 (or ``terminal name'' in GNUPLOT lingo) to be used by @kbd{g p} commands
28984 on this graph. It does not affect the permanent default device name.
28985 If you enter a blank name, the device name reverts to the default.
28986 Enter @samp{?} to see a list of supported devices.
28987
28988 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} instead sets
28989 the default device name, used by all plots in the future which do
28990 not override it with a plain @kbd{g D} command. If you enter a
28991 blank line this command shows you the current default. The special
28992 name @code{default} signifies that Calc should choose @code{x11} if
28993 the X window system is in use (as indicated by the presence of a
28994 @code{DISPLAY} environment variable), or otherwise @code{dumb} under
28995 GNUPLOT 3.0 and later, or @code{postscript} under GNUPLOT 2.0.
28996 This is the initial default value.
28997
28998 The @code{dumb} device is an interface to ``dumb terminals,'' i.e.,
28999 terminals with no special graphics facilities. It writes a crude
29000 picture of the graph composed of characters like @code{-} and @code{|}
29001 to a buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}, which Calc then displays.
29002 The graph is made the same size as the Emacs screen, which on most
29003 dumb terminals will be
29004 @texline @math{80\times24}
29005 @infoline 80x24
29006 characters. The graph is displayed in
29007 an Emacs ``recursive edit''; type @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-c C-c} to exit
29008 the recursive edit and return to Calc. Note that the @code{dumb}
29009 device is present only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29010
29011 The word @code{dumb} may be followed by two numbers separated by
29012 spaces. These are the desired width and height of the graph in
29013 characters. Also, the device name @code{big} is like @code{dumb}
29014 but creates a graph four times the width and height of the Emacs
29015 screen. You will then have to scroll around to view the entire
29016 graph. In the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer, @key{SPC}, @key{DEL},
29017 @kbd{<}, and @kbd{>} are defined to scroll by one screenful in each
29018 of the four directions.
29019
29020 With a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} sets or displays
29021 the device name used by @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}). This
29022 is initially @code{postscript}. If you don't have a PostScript
29023 printer, you may decide once again to use @code{dumb} to create a
29024 plot on any text-only printer.
29025
29026 @kindex g O
29027 @pindex calc-graph-output
29028 The @kbd{g O} (@code{calc-graph-output}) command sets the name of
29029 the output file used by GNUPLOT. For some devices, notably @code{x11},
29030 there is no output file and this information is not used. Many other
29031 ``devices'' are really file formats like @code{postscript}; in these
29032 cases the output in the desired format goes into the file you name
29033 with @kbd{g O}. Type @kbd{g O stdout @key{RET}} to set GNUPLOT to write
29034 to its standard output stream, i.e., to @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}.
29035 This is the default setting.
29036
29037 Another special output name is @code{tty}, which means that GNUPLOT
29038 is going to write graphics commands directly to its standard output,
29039 which you wish Emacs to pass through to your terminal. Tektronix
29040 graphics terminals, among other devices, operate this way. Calc does
29041 this by telling GNUPLOT to write to a temporary file, then running a
29042 sub-shell executing the command @samp{cat tempfile >/dev/tty}. On
29043 typical Unix systems, this will copy the temporary file directly to
29044 the terminal, bypassing Emacs entirely. You will have to type @kbd{C-l}
29045 to Emacs afterwards to refresh the screen.
29046
29047 Once again, @kbd{g O} with a positive or negative prefix argument
29048 sets the default or printer output file names, respectively. In each
29049 case you can specify @code{auto}, which causes Calc to invent a temporary
29050 file name for each @kbd{g p} (or @kbd{g P}) command. This temporary file
29051 will be deleted once it has been displayed or printed. If the output file
29052 name is not @code{auto}, the file is not automatically deleted.
29053
29054 The default and printer devices and output files can be saved
29055 permanently by the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command. The
29056 default number of data points (see @kbd{g N}) and the X geometry
29057 (see @kbd{g X}) are also saved. Other graph information is @emph{not}
29058 saved; you can save a graph's configuration simply by saving the contents
29059 of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29060
29061 @vindex calc-gnuplot-plot-command
29062 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-device
29063 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-output
29064 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-command
29065 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-device
29066 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-output
29067 If you are installing Calc you may wish to configure the default and
29068 printer devices and output files for the whole system. The relevant
29069 Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-default-device} and @code{-output},
29070 and @code{calc-gnuplot-print-device} and @code{-output}. The output
29071 file names must be either strings as described above, or Lisp
29072 expressions which are evaluated on the fly to get the output file names.
29073
29074 Other important Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
29075 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command}, which give the system commands to
29076 display or print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
29077 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
29078 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
29079 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
29080 to display or print the output.
29081
29082 @kindex g x
29083 @pindex calc-graph-display
29084 The @kbd{g x} (@code{calc-graph-display}) command lets you specify
29085 on which X window system display your graphs should be drawn. Enter
29086 a blank line to see the current display name. This command has no
29087 effect unless the current device is @code{x11}.
29088
29089 @kindex g X
29090 @pindex calc-graph-geometry
29091 The @kbd{g X} (@code{calc-graph-geometry}) command is a similar
29092 command for specifying the position and size of the X window.
29093 The normal value is @code{default}, which generally means your
29094 window manager will let you place the window interactively.
29095 Entering @samp{800x500+0+0} would create an 800-by-500 pixel
29096 window in the upper-left corner of the screen.
29097
29098 The buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} holds a transcript of the
29099 session with GNUPLOT. This shows the commands Calc has ``typed'' to
29100 GNUPLOT and the responses it has received. Calc tries to notice when an
29101 error message has appeared here and display the buffer for you when
29102 this happens. You can check this buffer yourself if you suspect
29103 something has gone wrong.
29104
29105 @kindex g C
29106 @pindex calc-graph-command
29107 The @kbd{g C} (@code{calc-graph-command}) command prompts you to
29108 enter any line of text, then simply sends that line to the current
29109 GNUPLOT process. The @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer looks deceptively
29110 like a Shell buffer but you can't type commands in it yourself.
29111 Instead, you must use @kbd{g C} for this purpose.
29112
29113 @kindex g v
29114 @kindex g V
29115 @pindex calc-graph-view-commands
29116 @pindex calc-graph-view-trail
29117 The @kbd{g v} (@code{calc-graph-view-commands}) and @kbd{g V}
29118 (@code{calc-graph-view-trail}) commands display the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29119 and @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffers, respectively, in another window.
29120 This happens automatically when Calc thinks there is something you
29121 will want to see in either of these buffers. If you type @kbd{g v}
29122 or @kbd{g V} when the relevant buffer is already displayed, the
29123 buffer is hidden again.
29124
29125 One reason to use @kbd{g v} is to add your own commands to the
29126 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Press @kbd{g v}, then use
29127 @kbd{C-x o} to switch into that window. For example, GNUPLOT has
29128 @samp{set label} and @samp{set arrow} commands that allow you to
29129 annotate your plots. Since Calc doesn't understand these commands,
29130 you have to add them to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer
29131 yourself, then use @w{@kbd{g p}} to replot using these new commands. Note
29132 that your commands must appear @emph{before} the @code{plot} command.
29133 To get help on any GNUPLOT feature, type, e.g., @kbd{g C help set label}.
29134 You may have to type @kbd{g C @key{RET}} a few times to clear the
29135 ``press return for more'' or ``subtopic of @dots{}'' requests.
29136 Note that Calc always sends commands (like @samp{set nolabel}) to
29137 reset all plotting parameters to the defaults before each plot, so
29138 to delete a label all you need to do is delete the @samp{set label}
29139 line you added (or comment it out with @samp{#}) and then replot
29140 with @kbd{g p}.
29141
29142 @kindex g q
29143 @pindex calc-graph-quit
29144 You can use @kbd{g q} (@code{calc-graph-quit}) to kill the GNUPLOT
29145 process that is running. The next graphing command you give will
29146 start a fresh GNUPLOT process. The word @samp{Graph} appears in
29147 the Calc window's mode line whenever a GNUPLOT process is currently
29148 running. The GNUPLOT process is automatically killed when you
29149 exit Emacs if you haven't killed it manually by then.
29150
29151 @kindex g K
29152 @pindex calc-graph-kill
29153 The @kbd{g K} (@code{calc-graph-kill}) command is like @kbd{g q}
29154 except that it also views the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer so that
29155 you can see the process being killed. This is better if you are
29156 killing GNUPLOT because you think it has gotten stuck.
29157
29158 @node Kill and Yank, Keypad Mode, Graphics, Top
29159 @chapter Kill and Yank Functions
29160
29161 @noindent
29162 The commands in this chapter move information between the Calculator and
29163 other Emacs editing buffers.
29164
29165 In many cases Embedded mode is an easier and more natural way to
29166 work with Calc from a regular editing buffer. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
29167
29168 @menu
29169 * Killing From Stack::
29170 * Yanking Into Stack::
29171 * Grabbing From Buffers::
29172 * Yanking Into Buffers::
29173 * X Cut and Paste::
29174 @end menu
29175
29176 @node Killing From Stack, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank, Kill and Yank
29177 @section Killing from the Stack
29178
29179 @noindent
29180 @kindex C-k
29181 @pindex calc-kill
29182 @kindex M-k
29183 @pindex calc-copy-as-kill
29184 @kindex C-w
29185 @pindex calc-kill-region
29186 @kindex M-w
29187 @pindex calc-copy-region-as-kill
29188 @cindex Kill ring
29189 @dfn{Kill} commands are Emacs commands that insert text into the
29190 ``kill ring,'' from which it can later be ``yanked'' by a @kbd{C-y}
29191 command. Three common kill commands in normal Emacs are @kbd{C-k}, which
29192 kills one line, @kbd{C-w}, which kills the region between mark and point,
29193 and @kbd{M-w}, which puts the region into the kill ring without actually
29194 deleting it. All of these commands work in the Calculator, too. Also,
29195 @kbd{M-k} has been provided to complete the set; it puts the current line
29196 into the kill ring without deleting anything.
29197
29198 The kill commands are unusual in that they pay attention to the location
29199 of the cursor in the Calculator buffer. If the cursor is on or below the
29200 bottom line, the kill commands operate on the top of the stack. Otherwise,
29201 they operate on whatever stack element the cursor is on. Calc's kill
29202 commands always operate on whole stack entries. (They act the same as their
29203 standard Emacs cousins except they ``round up'' the specified region to
29204 encompass full lines.) The text is copied into the kill ring exactly as
29205 it appears on the screen, including line numbers if they are enabled.
29206
29207 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{C-k} or @kbd{M-k} affects the number
29208 of lines killed. A positive argument kills the current line and @expr{n-1}
29209 lines below it. A negative argument kills the @expr{-n} lines above the
29210 current line. Again this mirrors the behavior of the standard Emacs
29211 @kbd{C-k} command. Although a whole line is always deleted, @kbd{C-k}
29212 with no argument copies only the number itself into the kill ring, whereas
29213 @kbd{C-k} with a prefix argument of 1 copies the number with its trailing
29214 newline.
29215
29216 @node Yanking Into Stack, Grabbing From Buffers, Killing From Stack, Kill and Yank
29217 @section Yanking into the Stack
29218
29219 @noindent
29220 @kindex C-y
29221 @pindex calc-yank
29222 The @kbd{C-y} command yanks the most recently killed text back into the
29223 Calculator. It pushes this value onto the top of the stack regardless of
29224 the cursor position. In general it re-parses the killed text as a number
29225 or formula (or a list of these separated by commas or newlines). However if
29226 the thing being yanked is something that was just killed from the Calculator
29227 itself, its full internal structure is yanked. For example, if you have
29228 set the floating-point display mode to show only four significant digits,
29229 then killing and re-yanking 3.14159 (which displays as 3.142) will yank the
29230 full 3.14159, even though yanking it into any other buffer would yank the
29231 number in its displayed form, 3.142. (Since the default display modes
29232 show all objects to their full precision, this feature normally makes no
29233 difference.)
29234
29235 @node Grabbing From Buffers, Yanking Into Buffers, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank
29236 @section Grabbing from Other Buffers
29237
29238 @noindent
29239 @kindex M-# g
29240 @pindex calc-grab-region
29241 The @kbd{M-# g} (@code{calc-grab-region}) command takes the text between
29242 point and mark in the current buffer and attempts to parse it as a
29243 vector of values. Basically, it wraps the text in vector brackets
29244 @samp{[ ]} unless the text already is enclosed in vector brackets,
29245 then reads the text as if it were an algebraic entry. The contents
29246 of the vector may be numbers, formulas, or any other Calc objects.
29247 If the @kbd{M-# g} command works successfully, it does an automatic
29248 @kbd{M-# c} to enter the Calculator buffer.
29249
29250 A numeric prefix argument grabs the specified number of lines around
29251 point, ignoring the mark. A positive prefix grabs from point to the
29252 @expr{n}th following newline (so that @kbd{M-1 M-# g} grabs from point
29253 to the end of the current line); a negative prefix grabs from point
29254 back to the @expr{n+1}st preceding newline. In these cases the text
29255 that is grabbed is exactly the same as the text that @kbd{C-k} would
29256 delete given that prefix argument.
29257
29258 A prefix of zero grabs the current line; point may be anywhere on the
29259 line.
29260
29261 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix interprets the region between point and mark
29262 as a single number or formula rather than a vector. For example,
29263 @kbd{M-# g} on the text @samp{2 a b} produces the vector of three
29264 values @samp{[2, a, b]}, but @kbd{C-u M-# g} on the same region
29265 reads a formula which is a product of three things: @samp{2 a b}.
29266 (The text @samp{a + b}, on the other hand, will be grabbed as a
29267 vector of one element by plain @kbd{M-# g} because the interpretation
29268 @samp{[a, +, b]} would be a syntax error.)
29269
29270 If a different language has been specified (@pxref{Language Modes}),
29271 the grabbed text will be interpreted according to that language.
29272
29273 @kindex M-# r
29274 @pindex calc-grab-rectangle
29275 The @kbd{M-# r} (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) command takes the text between
29276 point and mark and attempts to parse it as a matrix. If point and mark
29277 are both in the leftmost column, the lines in between are parsed in their
29278 entirety. Otherwise, point and mark define the corners of a rectangle
29279 whose contents are parsed.
29280
29281 Each line of the grabbed area becomes a row of the matrix. The result
29282 will actually be a vector of vectors, which Calc will treat as a matrix
29283 only if every row contains the same number of values.
29284
29285 If a line contains a portion surrounded by square brackets (or curly
29286 braces), that portion is interpreted as a vector which becomes a row
29287 of the matrix. Any text surrounding the bracketed portion on the line
29288 is ignored.
29289
29290 Otherwise, the entire line is interpreted as a row vector as if it
29291 were surrounded by square brackets. Leading line numbers (in the
29292 format used in the Calc stack buffer) are ignored. If you wish to
29293 force this interpretation (even if the line contains bracketed
29294 portions), give a negative numeric prefix argument to the
29295 @kbd{M-# r} command.
29296
29297 If you give a numeric prefix argument of zero or plain @kbd{C-u}, each
29298 line is instead interpreted as a single formula which is converted into
29299 a one-element vector. Thus the result of @kbd{C-u M-# r} will be a
29300 one-column matrix. For example, suppose one line of the data is the
29301 expression @samp{2 a}. A plain @w{@kbd{M-# r}} will interpret this as
29302 @samp{[2 a]}, which in turn is read as a two-element vector that forms
29303 one row of the matrix. But a @kbd{C-u M-# r} will interpret this row
29304 as @samp{[2*a]}.
29305
29306 If you give a positive numeric prefix argument @var{n}, then each line
29307 will be split up into columns of width @var{n}; each column is parsed
29308 separately as a matrix element. If a line contained
29309 @w{@samp{2 +/- 3 4 +/- 5}}, then grabbing with a prefix argument of 8
29310 would correctly split the line into two error forms.
29311
29312 @xref{Matrix Functions}, to see how to pull the matrix apart into its
29313 constituent rows and columns. (If it is a
29314 @texline @math{1\times1}
29315 @infoline 1x1
29316 matrix, just hit @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) twice.)
29317
29318 @kindex M-# :
29319 @kindex M-# _
29320 @pindex calc-grab-sum-across
29321 @pindex calc-grab-sum-down
29322 @cindex Summing rows and columns of data
29323 The @kbd{M-# :} (@code{calc-grab-sum-down}) command is a handy way to
29324 grab a rectangle of data and sum its columns. It is equivalent to
29325 typing @kbd{M-# r}, followed by @kbd{V R : +} (the vector reduction
29326 command that sums the columns of a matrix; @pxref{Reducing}). The
29327 result of the command will be a vector of numbers, one for each column
29328 in the input data. The @kbd{M-# _} (@code{calc-grab-sum-across}) command
29329 similarly grabs a rectangle and sums its rows by executing @w{@kbd{V R _ +}}.
29330
29331 As well as being more convenient, @kbd{M-# :} and @kbd{M-# _} are also
29332 much faster because they don't actually place the grabbed vector on
29333 the stack. In a @kbd{M-# r V R : +} sequence, formatting the vector
29334 for display on the stack takes a large fraction of the total time
29335 (unless you have planned ahead and used @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} modes).
29336
29337 For example, suppose we have a column of numbers in a file which we
29338 wish to sum. Go to one corner of the column and press @kbd{C-@@} to
29339 set the mark; go to the other corner and type @kbd{M-# :}. Since there
29340 is only one column, the result will be a vector of one number, the sum.
29341 (You can type @kbd{v u} to unpack this vector into a plain number if
29342 you want to do further arithmetic with it.)
29343
29344 To compute the product of the column of numbers, we would have to do
29345 it ``by hand'' since there's no special grab-and-multiply command.
29346 Use @kbd{M-# r} to grab the column of numbers into the calculator in
29347 the form of a column matrix. The statistics command @kbd{u *} is a
29348 handy way to find the product of a vector or matrix of numbers.
29349 @xref{Statistical Operations}. Another approach would be to use
29350 an explicit column reduction command, @kbd{V R : *}.
29351
29352 @node Yanking Into Buffers, X Cut and Paste, Grabbing From Buffers, Kill and Yank
29353 @section Yanking into Other Buffers
29354
29355 @noindent
29356 @kindex y
29357 @pindex calc-copy-to-buffer
29358 The plain @kbd{y} (@code{calc-copy-to-buffer}) command inserts the number
29359 at the top of the stack into the most recently used normal editing buffer.
29360 (More specifically, this is the most recently used buffer which is displayed
29361 in a window and whose name does not begin with @samp{*}. If there is no
29362 such buffer, this is the most recently used buffer except for Calculator
29363 and Calc Trail buffers.) The number is inserted exactly as it appears and
29364 without a newline. (If line-numbering is enabled, the line number is
29365 normally not included.) The number is @emph{not} removed from the stack.
29366
29367 With a prefix argument, @kbd{y} inserts several numbers, one per line.
29368 A positive argument inserts the specified number of values from the top
29369 of the stack. A negative argument inserts the @expr{n}th value from the
29370 top of the stack. An argument of zero inserts the entire stack. Note
29371 that @kbd{y} with an argument of 1 is slightly different from @kbd{y}
29372 with no argument; the former always copies full lines, whereas the
29373 latter strips off the trailing newline.
29374
29375 With a lone @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, @kbd{y} @emph{replaces} the
29376 region in the other buffer with the yanked text, then quits the
29377 Calculator, leaving you in that buffer. A typical use would be to use
29378 @kbd{M-# g} to read a region of data into the Calculator, operate on the
29379 data to produce a new matrix, then type @kbd{C-u y} to replace the
29380 original data with the new data. One might wish to alter the matrix
29381 display style (@pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}) or change the current
29382 display language (@pxref{Language Modes}) before doing this. Also, note
29383 that this command replaces a linear region of text (as grabbed by
29384 @kbd{M-# g}), not a rectangle (as grabbed by @kbd{M-# r}).
29385
29386 If the editing buffer is in overwrite (as opposed to insert) mode,
29387 and the @kbd{C-u} prefix was not used, then the yanked number will
29388 overwrite the characters following point rather than being inserted
29389 before those characters. The usual conventions of overwrite mode
29390 are observed; for example, characters will be inserted at the end of
29391 a line rather than overflowing onto the next line. Yanking a multi-line
29392 object such as a matrix in overwrite mode overwrites the next @var{n}
29393 lines in the buffer, lengthening or shortening each line as necessary.
29394 Finally, if the thing being yanked is a simple integer or floating-point
29395 number (like @samp{-1.2345e-3}) and the characters following point also
29396 make up such a number, then Calc will replace that number with the new
29397 number, lengthening or shortening as necessary. The concept of
29398 ``overwrite mode'' has thus been generalized from overwriting characters
29399 to overwriting one complete number with another.
29400
29401 @kindex M-# y
29402 The @kbd{M-# y} key sequence is equivalent to @kbd{y} except that
29403 it can be typed anywhere, not just in Calc. This provides an easy
29404 way to guarantee that Calc knows which editing buffer you want to use!
29405
29406 @node X Cut and Paste, , Yanking Into Buffers, Kill and Yank
29407 @section X Cut and Paste
29408
29409 @noindent
29410 If you are using Emacs with the X window system, there is an easier
29411 way to move small amounts of data into and out of the calculator:
29412 Use the mouse-oriented cut and paste facilities of X.
29413
29414 The default bindings for a three-button mouse cause the left button
29415 to move the Emacs cursor to the given place, the right button to
29416 select the text between the cursor and the clicked location, and
29417 the middle button to yank the selection into the buffer at the
29418 clicked location. So, if you have a Calc window and an editing
29419 window on your Emacs screen, you can use left-click/right-click
29420 to select a number, vector, or formula from one window, then
29421 middle-click to paste that value into the other window. When you
29422 paste text into the Calc window, Calc interprets it as an algebraic
29423 entry. It doesn't matter where you click in the Calc window; the
29424 new value is always pushed onto the top of the stack.
29425
29426 The @code{xterm} program that is typically used for general-purpose
29427 shell windows in X interprets the mouse buttons in the same way.
29428 So you can use the mouse to move data between Calc and any other
29429 Unix program. One nice feature of @code{xterm} is that a double
29430 left-click selects one word, and a triple left-click selects a
29431 whole line. So you can usually transfer a single number into Calc
29432 just by double-clicking on it in the shell, then middle-clicking
29433 in the Calc window.
29434
29435 @node Keypad Mode, Embedded Mode, Kill and Yank, Introduction
29436 @chapter Keypad Mode
29437
29438 @noindent
29439 @kindex M-# k
29440 @pindex calc-keypad
29441 The @kbd{M-# k} (@code{calc-keypad}) command starts the Calculator
29442 and displays a picture of a calculator-style keypad. If you are using
29443 the X window system, you can click on any of the ``keys'' in the
29444 keypad using the left mouse button to operate the calculator.
29445 The original window remains the selected window; in Keypad mode
29446 you can type in your file while simultaneously performing
29447 calculations with the mouse.
29448
29449 @pindex full-calc-keypad
29450 If you have used @kbd{M-# b} first, @kbd{M-# k} instead invokes
29451 the @code{full-calc-keypad} command, which takes over the whole
29452 Emacs screen and displays the keypad, the Calc stack, and the Calc
29453 trail all at once. This mode would normally be used when running
29454 Calc standalone (@pxref{Standalone Operation}).
29455
29456 If you aren't using the X window system, you must switch into
29457 the @samp{*Calc Keypad*} window, place the cursor on the desired
29458 ``key,'' and type @key{SPC} or @key{RET}. If you think this
29459 is easier than using Calc normally, go right ahead.
29460
29461 Calc commands are more or less the same in Keypad mode. Certain
29462 keypad keys differ slightly from the corresponding normal Calc
29463 keystrokes; all such deviations are described below.
29464
29465 Keypad mode includes many more commands than will fit on the keypad
29466 at once. Click the right mouse button [@code{calc-keypad-menu}]
29467 to switch to the next menu. The bottom five rows of the keypad
29468 stay the same; the top three rows change to a new set of commands.
29469 To return to earlier menus, click the middle mouse button
29470 [@code{calc-keypad-menu-back}] or simply advance through the menus
29471 until you wrap around. Typing @key{TAB} inside the keypad window
29472 is equivalent to clicking the right mouse button there.
29473
29474 You can always click the @key{EXEC} button and type any normal
29475 Calc key sequence. This is equivalent to switching into the
29476 Calc buffer, typing the keys, then switching back to your
29477 original buffer.
29478
29479 @menu
29480 * Keypad Main Menu::
29481 * Keypad Functions Menu::
29482 * Keypad Binary Menu::
29483 * Keypad Vectors Menu::
29484 * Keypad Modes Menu::
29485 @end menu
29486
29487 @node Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode, Keypad Mode
29488 @section Main Menu
29489
29490 @smallexample
29491 @group
29492 |----+-----Calc 2.00-----+----1
29493 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
29494 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29495 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
29496 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29497 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
29498 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29499 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
29500 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
29501 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
29502 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29503 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
29504 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29505 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
29506 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29507 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
29508 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
29509 @end group
29510 @end smallexample
29511
29512 @noindent
29513 This is the menu that appears the first time you start Keypad mode.
29514 It will show up in a vertical window on the right side of your screen.
29515 Above this menu is the traditional Calc stack display. On a 24-line
29516 screen you will be able to see the top three stack entries.
29517
29518 The ten digit keys, decimal point, and @key{EEX} key are used for
29519 entering numbers in the obvious way. @key{EEX} begins entry of an
29520 exponent in scientific notation. Just as with regular Calc, the
29521 number is pushed onto the stack as soon as you press @key{ENTER}
29522 or any other function key.
29523
29524 The @key{+/-} key corresponds to normal Calc's @kbd{n} key. During
29525 numeric entry it changes the sign of the number or of the exponent.
29526 At other times it changes the sign of the number on the top of the
29527 stack.
29528
29529 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys modify other keys. As well as
29530 having the effects described elsewhere in this manual, Keypad mode
29531 defines several other ``inverse'' operations. These are described
29532 below and in the following sections.
29533
29534 The @key{ENTER} key finishes the current numeric entry, or otherwise
29535 duplicates the top entry on the stack.
29536
29537 The @key{UNDO} key undoes the most recent Calc operation.
29538 @kbd{INV UNDO} is the ``redo'' command, and @kbd{HYP UNDO} is
29539 ``last arguments'' (@kbd{M-@key{RET}}).
29540
29541 The @key{<-} key acts as a ``backspace'' during numeric entry.
29542 At other times it removes the top stack entry. @kbd{INV <-}
29543 clears the entire stack. @kbd{HYP <-} takes an integer from
29544 the stack, then removes that many additional stack elements.
29545
29546 The @key{EXEC} key prompts you to enter any keystroke sequence
29547 that would normally work in Calc mode. This can include a
29548 numeric prefix if you wish. It is also possible simply to
29549 switch into the Calc window and type commands in it; there is
29550 nothing ``magic'' about this window when Keypad mode is active.
29551
29552 The other keys in this display perform their obvious calculator
29553 functions. @key{CLN2} rounds the top-of-stack by temporarily
29554 reducing the precision by 2 digits. @key{FLT} converts an
29555 integer or fraction on the top of the stack to floating-point.
29556
29557 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys combined with several of these keys
29558 give you access to some common functions even if the appropriate menu
29559 is not displayed. Obviously you don't need to learn these keys
29560 unless you find yourself wasting time switching among the menus.
29561
29562 @table @kbd
29563 @item INV +/-
29564 is the same as @key{1/x}.
29565 @item INV +
29566 is the same as @key{SQRT}.
29567 @item INV -
29568 is the same as @key{CONJ}.
29569 @item INV *
29570 is the same as @key{y^x}.
29571 @item INV /
29572 is the same as @key{INV y^x} (the @expr{x}th root of @expr{y}).
29573 @item HYP/INV 1
29574 are the same as @key{SIN} / @kbd{INV SIN}.
29575 @item HYP/INV 2
29576 are the same as @key{COS} / @kbd{INV COS}.
29577 @item HYP/INV 3
29578 are the same as @key{TAN} / @kbd{INV TAN}.
29579 @item INV/HYP 4
29580 are the same as @key{LN} / @kbd{HYP LN}.
29581 @item INV/HYP 5
29582 are the same as @key{EXP} / @kbd{HYP EXP}.
29583 @item INV 6
29584 is the same as @key{ABS}.
29585 @item INV 7
29586 is the same as @key{RND} (@code{calc-round}).
29587 @item INV 8
29588 is the same as @key{CLN2}.
29589 @item INV 9
29590 is the same as @key{FLT} (@code{calc-float}).
29591 @item INV 0
29592 is the same as @key{IMAG}.
29593 @item INV .
29594 is the same as @key{PREC}.
29595 @item INV ENTER
29596 is the same as @key{SWAP}.
29597 @item HYP ENTER
29598 is the same as @key{RLL3}.
29599 @item INV HYP ENTER
29600 is the same as @key{OVER}.
29601 @item HYP +/-
29602 packs the top two stack entries as an error form.
29603 @item HYP EEX
29604 packs the top two stack entries as a modulo form.
29605 @item INV EEX
29606 creates an interval form; this removes an integer which is one
29607 of 0 @samp{[]}, 1 @samp{[)}, 2 @samp{(]} or 3 @samp{()}, followed
29608 by the two limits of the interval.
29609 @end table
29610
29611 The @kbd{OFF} key turns Calc off; typing @kbd{M-# k} or @kbd{M-# M-#}
29612 again has the same effect. This is analogous to typing @kbd{q} or
29613 hitting @kbd{M-# c} again in the normal calculator. If Calc is
29614 running standalone (the @code{full-calc-keypad} command appeared in the
29615 command line that started Emacs), then @kbd{OFF} is replaced with
29616 @kbd{EXIT}; clicking on this actually exits Emacs itself.
29617
29618 @node Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Mode
29619 @section Functions Menu
29620
29621 @smallexample
29622 @group
29623 |----+----+----+----+----+----2
29624 |IGAM|BETA|IBET|ERF |BESJ|BESY|
29625 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29626 |IMAG|CONJ| RE |ATN2|RAND|RAGN|
29627 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29628 |GCD |FACT|DFCT|BNOM|PERM|NXTP|
29629 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29630 @end group
29631 @end smallexample
29632
29633 @noindent
29634 This menu provides various operations from the @kbd{f} and @kbd{k}
29635 prefix keys.
29636
29637 @key{IMAG} multiplies the number on the stack by the imaginary
29638 number @expr{i = (0, 1)}.
29639
29640 @key{RE} extracts the real part a complex number. @kbd{INV RE}
29641 extracts the imaginary part.
29642
29643 @key{RAND} takes a number from the top of the stack and computes
29644 a random number greater than or equal to zero but less than that
29645 number. (@xref{Random Numbers}.) @key{RAGN} is the ``random
29646 again'' command; it computes another random number using the
29647 same limit as last time.
29648
29649 @key{INV GCD} computes the LCM (least common multiple) function.
29650
29651 @key{INV FACT} is the gamma function.
29652 @texline @math{\Gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
29653 @infoline @expr{gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
29654
29655 @key{PERM} is the number-of-permutations function, which is on the
29656 @kbd{H k c} key in normal Calc.
29657
29658 @key{NXTP} finds the next prime after a number. @kbd{INV NXTP}
29659 finds the previous prime.
29660
29661 @node Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode
29662 @section Binary Menu
29663
29664 @smallexample
29665 @group
29666 |----+----+----+----+----+----3
29667 |AND | OR |XOR |NOT |LSH |RSH |
29668 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29669 |DEC |HEX |OCT |BIN |WSIZ|ARSH|
29670 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29671 | A | B | C | D | E | F |
29672 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29673 @end group
29674 @end smallexample
29675
29676 @noindent
29677 The keys in this menu perform operations on binary integers.
29678 Note that both logical and arithmetic right-shifts are provided.
29679 @key{INV LSH} rotates one bit to the left.
29680
29681 The ``difference'' function (normally on @kbd{b d}) is on @key{INV AND}.
29682 The ``clip'' function (normally on @w{@kbd{b c}}) is on @key{INV NOT}.
29683
29684 The @key{DEC}, @key{HEX}, @key{OCT}, and @key{BIN} keys select the
29685 current radix for display and entry of numbers: Decimal, hexadecimal,
29686 octal, or binary. The six letter keys @key{A} through @key{F} are used
29687 for entering hexadecimal numbers.
29688
29689 The @key{WSIZ} key displays the current word size for binary operations
29690 and allows you to enter a new word size. You can respond to the prompt
29691 using either the keyboard or the digits and @key{ENTER} from the keypad.
29692 The initial word size is 32 bits.
29693
29694 @node Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Modes Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Mode
29695 @section Vectors Menu
29696
29697 @smallexample
29698 @group
29699 |----+----+----+----+----+----4
29700 |SUM |PROD|MAX |MAP*|MAP^|MAP$|
29701 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29702 |MINV|MDET|MTRN|IDNT|CRSS|"x" |
29703 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29704 |PACK|UNPK|INDX|BLD |LEN |... |
29705 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29706 @end group
29707 @end smallexample
29708
29709 @noindent
29710 The keys in this menu operate on vectors and matrices.
29711
29712 @key{PACK} removes an integer @var{n} from the top of the stack;
29713 the next @var{n} stack elements are removed and packed into a vector,
29714 which is replaced onto the stack. Thus the sequence
29715 @kbd{1 ENTER 3 ENTER 5 ENTER 3 PACK} enters the vector
29716 @samp{[1, 3, 5]} onto the stack. To enter a matrix, build each row
29717 on the stack as a vector, then use a final @key{PACK} to collect the
29718 rows into a matrix.
29719
29720 @key{UNPK} unpacks the vector on the stack, pushing each of its
29721 components separately.
29722
29723 @key{INDX} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds a vector of
29724 integers from 1 to @var{n}. @kbd{INV INDX} takes three numbers
29725 from the stack: The vector size @var{n}, the starting number,
29726 and the increment. @kbd{BLD} takes an integer @var{n} and any
29727 value @var{x} and builds a vector of @var{n} copies of @var{x}.
29728
29729 @key{IDNT} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds an @var{n}-by-@var{n}
29730 identity matrix.
29731
29732 @key{LEN} replaces a vector by its length, an integer.
29733
29734 @key{...} turns on or off ``abbreviated'' display mode for large vectors.
29735
29736 @key{MINV}, @key{MDET}, @key{MTRN}, and @key{CROSS} are the matrix
29737 inverse, determinant, and transpose, and vector cross product.
29738
29739 @key{SUM} replaces a vector by the sum of its elements. It is
29740 equivalent to @kbd{u +} in normal Calc (@pxref{Statistical Operations}).
29741 @key{PROD} computes the product of the elements of a vector, and
29742 @key{MAX} computes the maximum of all the elements of a vector.
29743
29744 @key{INV SUM} computes the alternating sum of the first element
29745 minus the second, plus the third, minus the fourth, and so on.
29746 @key{INV MAX} computes the minimum of the vector elements.
29747
29748 @key{HYP SUM} computes the mean of the vector elements.
29749 @key{HYP PROD} computes the sample standard deviation.
29750 @key{HYP MAX} computes the median.
29751
29752 @key{MAP*} multiplies two vectors elementwise. It is equivalent
29753 to the @kbd{V M *} command. @key{MAP^} computes powers elementwise.
29754 The arguments must be vectors of equal length, or one must be a vector
29755 and the other must be a plain number. For example, @kbd{2 MAP^} squares
29756 all the elements of a vector.
29757
29758 @key{MAP$} maps the formula on the top of the stack across the
29759 vector in the second-to-top position. If the formula contains
29760 several variables, Calc takes that many vectors starting at the
29761 second-to-top position and matches them to the variables in
29762 alphabetical order. The result is a vector of the same size as
29763 the input vectors, whose elements are the formula evaluated with
29764 the variables set to the various sets of numbers in those vectors.
29765 For example, you could simulate @key{MAP^} using @key{MAP$} with
29766 the formula @samp{x^y}.
29767
29768 The @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable name @expr{x} onto the
29769 stack. To build the formula @expr{x^2 + 6}, you would use the
29770 key sequence @kbd{"x" 2 y^x 6 +}. This formula would then be
29771 suitable for use with the @key{MAP$} key described above.
29772 With @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, or @key{INV} and @key{HYP}, the
29773 @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable names @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and
29774 @expr{t}, respectively.
29775
29776 @node Keypad Modes Menu, , Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Mode
29777 @section Modes Menu
29778
29779 @smallexample
29780 @group
29781 |----+----+----+----+----+----5
29782 |FLT |FIX |SCI |ENG |GRP | |
29783 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29784 |RAD |DEG |FRAC|POLR|SYMB|PREC|
29785 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29786 |SWAP|RLL3|RLL4|OVER|STO |RCL |
29787 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29788 @end group
29789 @end smallexample
29790
29791 @noindent
29792 The keys in this menu manipulate modes, variables, and the stack.
29793
29794 The @key{FLT}, @key{FIX}, @key{SCI}, and @key{ENG} keys select
29795 floating-point, fixed-point, scientific, or engineering notation.
29796 @key{FIX} displays two digits after the decimal by default; the
29797 others display full precision. With the @key{INV} prefix, these
29798 keys pop a number-of-digits argument from the stack.
29799
29800 The @key{GRP} key turns grouping of digits with commas on or off.
29801 @kbd{INV GRP} enables grouping to the right of the decimal point as
29802 well as to the left.
29803
29804 The @key{RAD} and @key{DEG} keys switch between radians and degrees
29805 for trigonometric functions.
29806
29807 The @key{FRAC} key turns Fraction mode on or off. This affects
29808 whether commands like @kbd{/} with integer arguments produce
29809 fractional or floating-point results.
29810
29811 The @key{POLR} key turns Polar mode on or off, determining whether
29812 polar or rectangular complex numbers are used by default.
29813
29814 The @key{SYMB} key turns Symbolic mode on or off, in which
29815 operations that would produce inexact floating-point results
29816 are left unevaluated as algebraic formulas.
29817
29818 The @key{PREC} key selects the current precision. Answer with
29819 the keyboard or with the keypad digit and @key{ENTER} keys.
29820
29821 The @key{SWAP} key exchanges the top two stack elements.
29822 The @key{RLL3} key rotates the top three stack elements upwards.
29823 The @key{RLL4} key rotates the top four stack elements upwards.
29824 The @key{OVER} key duplicates the second-to-top stack element.
29825
29826 The @key{STO} and @key{RCL} keys are analogous to @kbd{s t} and
29827 @kbd{s r} in regular Calc. @xref{Store and Recall}. Click the
29828 @key{STO} or @key{RCL} key, then one of the ten digits. (Named
29829 variables are not available in Keypad mode.) You can also use,
29830 for example, @kbd{STO + 3} to add to register 3.
29831
29832 @node Embedded Mode, Programming, Keypad Mode, Top
29833 @chapter Embedded Mode
29834
29835 @noindent
29836 Embedded mode in Calc provides an alternative to copying numbers
29837 and formulas back and forth between editing buffers and the Calc
29838 stack. In Embedded mode, your editing buffer becomes temporarily
29839 linked to the stack and this copying is taken care of automatically.
29840
29841 @menu
29842 * Basic Embedded Mode::
29843 * More About Embedded Mode::
29844 * Assignments in Embedded Mode::
29845 * Mode Settings in Embedded Mode::
29846 * Customizing Embedded Mode::
29847 @end menu
29848
29849 @node Basic Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
29850 @section Basic Embedded Mode
29851
29852 @noindent
29853 @kindex M-# e
29854 @pindex calc-embedded
29855 To enter Embedded mode, position the Emacs point (cursor) on a
29856 formula in any buffer and press @kbd{M-# e} (@code{calc-embedded}).
29857 Note that @kbd{M-# e} is not to be used in the Calc stack buffer
29858 like most Calc commands, but rather in regular editing buffers that
29859 are visiting your own files.
29860
29861 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
29862 nearest opening and closing @dfn{formula delimiters}. The simplest
29863 delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that Embedded mode
29864 understands are:
29865
29866 @enumerate
29867 @item
29868 The @TeX{} and La@TeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
29869 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
29870 @item
29871 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
29872 @item
29873 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
29874 @item
29875 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
29876 @item
29877 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
29878 @end enumerate
29879
29880 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to make Calc recognize
29881 your own favorite delimiters. Delimiters like @samp{$ $} can appear
29882 on their own separate lines or in-line with the formula.
29883
29884 If you give a positive or negative numeric prefix argument, Calc
29885 instead uses the current point as one end of the formula, and moves
29886 forward or backward (respectively) by that many lines to find the
29887 other end. Explicit delimiters are not necessary in this case.
29888
29889 With a prefix argument of zero, Calc uses the current region
29890 (delimited by point and mark) instead of formula delimiters.
29891
29892 @kindex M-# w
29893 @pindex calc-embedded-word
29894 With a prefix argument of @kbd{C-u} only, Calc scans for the first
29895 non-numeric character (i.e., the first character that is not a
29896 digit, sign, decimal point, or upper- or lower-case @samp{e})
29897 forward and backward to delimit the formula. @kbd{M-# w}
29898 (@code{calc-embedded-word}) is equivalent to @kbd{C-u M-# e}.
29899
29900 When you enable Embedded mode for a formula, Calc reads the text
29901 between the delimiters and tries to interpret it as a Calc formula.
29902 It's best if the current Calc language mode is correct for the
29903 formula, but Calc can generally identify @TeX{} formulas and
29904 Big-style formulas even if the language mode is wrong. If Calc
29905 can't make sense of the formula, it beeps and refuses to enter
29906 Embedded mode. But if the current language is wrong, Calc can
29907 sometimes parse the formula successfully (but incorrectly);
29908 for example, the C expression @samp{atan(a[1])} can be parsed
29909 in Normal language mode, but the @code{atan} won't correspond to
29910 the built-in @code{arctan} function, and the @samp{a[1]} will be
29911 interpreted as @samp{a} times the vector @samp{[1]}!
29912
29913 If you press @kbd{M-# e} or @kbd{M-# w} to activate an embedded
29914 formula which is blank, say with the cursor on the space between
29915 the two delimiters @samp{$ $}, Calc will immediately prompt for
29916 an algebraic entry.
29917
29918 Only one formula in one buffer can be enabled at a time. If you
29919 move to another area of the current buffer and give Calc commands,
29920 Calc turns Embedded mode off for the old formula and then tries
29921 to restart Embedded mode at the new position. Other buffers are
29922 not affected by Embedded mode.
29923
29924 When Embedded mode begins, Calc pushes the current formula onto
29925 the stack. No Calc stack window is created; however, Calc copies
29926 the top-of-stack position into the original buffer at all times.
29927 You can create a Calc window by hand with @kbd{M-# o} if you
29928 find you need to see the entire stack.
29929
29930 For example, typing @kbd{M-# e} while somewhere in the formula
29931 @samp{n>2} in the following line enables Embedded mode on that
29932 inequality:
29933
29934 @example
29935 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n>2$.
29936 @end example
29937
29938 @noindent
29939 The formula @expr{n>2} will be pushed onto the Calc stack, and
29940 the top of stack will be copied back into the editing buffer.
29941 This means that spaces will appear around the @samp{>} symbol
29942 to match Calc's usual display style:
29943
29944 @example
29945 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n > 2$.
29946 @end example
29947
29948 @noindent
29949 No spaces have appeared around the @samp{+} sign because it's
29950 in a different formula, one which we have not yet touched with
29951 Embedded mode.
29952
29953 Now that Embedded mode is enabled, keys you type in this buffer
29954 are interpreted as Calc commands. At this point we might use
29955 the ``commute'' command @kbd{j C} to reverse the inequality.
29956 This is a selection-based command for which we first need to
29957 move the cursor onto the operator (@samp{>} in this case) that
29958 needs to be commuted.
29959
29960 @example
29961 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $2 < n$.
29962 @end example
29963
29964 The @kbd{M-# o} command is a useful way to open a Calc window
29965 without actually selecting that window. Giving this command
29966 verifies that @samp{2 < n} is also on the Calc stack. Typing
29967 @kbd{17 @key{RET}} would produce:
29968
29969 @example
29970 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $17$.
29971 @end example
29972
29973 @noindent
29974 with @samp{2 < n} and @samp{17} on the stack; typing @key{TAB}
29975 at this point will exchange the two stack values and restore
29976 @samp{2 < n} to the embedded formula. Even though you can't
29977 normally see the stack in Embedded mode, it is still there and
29978 it still operates in the same way. But, as with old-fashioned
29979 RPN calculators, you can only see the value at the top of the
29980 stack at any given time (unless you use @kbd{M-# o}).
29981
29982 Typing @kbd{M-# e} again turns Embedded mode off. The Calc
29983 window reveals that the formula @w{@samp{2 < n}} is automatically
29984 removed from the stack, but the @samp{17} is not. Entering
29985 Embedded mode always pushes one thing onto the stack, and
29986 leaving Embedded mode always removes one thing. Anything else
29987 that happens on the stack is entirely your business as far as
29988 Embedded mode is concerned.
29989
29990 If you press @kbd{M-# e} in the wrong place by accident, it is
29991 possible that Calc will be able to parse the nearby text as a
29992 formula and will mangle that text in an attempt to redisplay it
29993 ``properly'' in the current language mode. If this happens,
29994 press @kbd{M-# e} again to exit Embedded mode, then give the
29995 regular Emacs ``undo'' command (@kbd{C-_} or @kbd{C-x u}) to put
29996 the text back the way it was before Calc edited it. Note that Calc's
29997 own Undo command (typed before you turn Embedded mode back off)
29998 will not do you any good, because as far as Calc is concerned
29999 you haven't done anything with this formula yet.
30000
30001 @node More About Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Basic Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30002 @section More About Embedded Mode
30003
30004 @noindent
30005 When Embedded mode ``activates'' a formula, i.e., when it examines
30006 the formula for the first time since the buffer was created or
30007 loaded, Calc tries to sense the language in which the formula was
30008 written. If the formula contains any La@TeX{}-like @samp{\} sequences,
30009 it is parsed (i.e., read) in La@TeX{} mode. If the formula appears to
30010 be written in multi-line Big mode, it is parsed in Big mode. Otherwise,
30011 it is parsed according to the current language mode.
30012
30013 Note that Calc does not change the current language mode according
30014 to what it finds. Even though it can read a La@TeX{} formula when
30015 not in La@TeX{} mode, it will immediately rewrite this formula using
30016 whatever language mode is in effect. You must then type @kbd{d L}
30017 to switch Calc permanently into La@TeX{} mode if that is what you
30018 desire.
30019
30020 @tex
30021 \bigskip
30022 @end tex
30023
30024 @kindex d p
30025 @pindex calc-show-plain
30026 Calc's parser is unable to read certain kinds of formulas. For
30027 example, with @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) you can
30028 specify matrix display styles which the parser is unable to
30029 recognize as matrices. The @kbd{d p} (@code{calc-show-plain})
30030 command turns on a mode in which a ``plain'' version of a
30031 formula is placed in front of the fully-formatted version.
30032 When Calc reads a formula that has such a plain version in
30033 front, it reads the plain version and ignores the formatted
30034 version.
30035
30036 Plain formulas are preceded and followed by @samp{%%%} signs
30037 by default. This notation has the advantage that the @samp{%}
30038 character begins a comment in @TeX{} and La@TeX{}, so if your formula is
30039 embedded in a @TeX{} or La@TeX{} document its plain version will be
30040 invisible in the final printed copy. @xref{Customizing
30041 Embedded Mode}, to see how to change the ``plain'' formula
30042 delimiters, say to something that @dfn{eqn} or some other
30043 formatter will treat as a comment.
30044
30045 There are several notations which Calc's parser for ``big''
30046 formatted formulas can't yet recognize. In particular, it can't
30047 read the large symbols for @code{sum}, @code{prod}, and @code{integ},
30048 and it can't handle @samp{=>} with the righthand argument omitted.
30049 Also, Calc won't recognize special formats you have defined with
30050 the @kbd{Z C} command (@pxref{User-Defined Compositions}). In
30051 these cases it is important to use ``plain'' mode to make sure
30052 Calc will be able to read your formula later.
30053
30054 Another example where ``plain'' mode is important is if you have
30055 specified a float mode with few digits of precision. Normally
30056 any digits that are computed but not displayed will simply be
30057 lost when you save and re-load your embedded buffer, but ``plain''
30058 mode allows you to make sure that the complete number is present
30059 in the file as well as the rounded-down number.
30060
30061 @tex
30062 \bigskip
30063 @end tex
30064
30065 Embedded buffers remember active formulas for as long as they
30066 exist in Emacs memory. Suppose you have an embedded formula
30067 which is @cpi{} to the normal 12 decimal places, and then
30068 type @w{@kbd{C-u 5 d n}} to display only five decimal places.
30069 If you then type @kbd{d n}, all 12 places reappear because the
30070 full number is still there on the Calc stack. More surprisingly,
30071 even if you exit Embedded mode and later re-enter it for that
30072 formula, typing @kbd{d n} will restore all 12 places because
30073 each buffer remembers all its active formulas. However, if you
30074 save the buffer in a file and reload it in a new Emacs session,
30075 all non-displayed digits will have been lost unless you used
30076 ``plain'' mode.
30077
30078 @tex
30079 \bigskip
30080 @end tex
30081
30082 In some applications of Embedded mode, you will want to have a
30083 sequence of copies of a formula that show its evolution as you
30084 work on it. For example, you might want to have a sequence
30085 like this in your file (elaborating here on the example from
30086 the ``Getting Started'' chapter):
30087
30088 @smallexample
30089 The derivative of
30090
30091 ln(ln(x))
30092
30093 is
30094
30095 @r{(the derivative of }ln(ln(x))@r{)}
30096
30097 whose value at x = 2 is
30098
30099 @r{(the value)}
30100
30101 and at x = 3 is
30102
30103 @r{(the value)}
30104 @end smallexample
30105
30106 @kindex M-# d
30107 @pindex calc-embedded-duplicate
30108 The @kbd{M-# d} (@code{calc-embedded-duplicate}) command is a
30109 handy way to make sequences like this. If you type @kbd{M-# d},
30110 the formula under the cursor (which may or may not have Embedded
30111 mode enabled for it at the time) is copied immediately below and
30112 Embedded mode is then enabled for that copy.
30113
30114 For this example, you would start with just
30115
30116 @smallexample
30117 The derivative of
30118
30119 ln(ln(x))
30120 @end smallexample
30121
30122 @noindent
30123 and press @kbd{M-# d} with the cursor on this formula. The result
30124 is
30125
30126 @smallexample
30127 The derivative of
30128
30129 ln(ln(x))
30130
30131
30132 ln(ln(x))
30133 @end smallexample
30134
30135 @noindent
30136 with the second copy of the formula enabled in Embedded mode.
30137 You can now press @kbd{a d x @key{RET}} to take the derivative, and
30138 @kbd{M-# d M-# d} to make two more copies of the derivative.
30139 To complete the computations, type @kbd{3 s l x @key{RET}} to evaluate
30140 the last formula, then move up to the second-to-last formula
30141 and type @kbd{2 s l x @key{RET}}.
30142
30143 Finally, you would want to press @kbd{M-# e} to exit Embedded
30144 mode, then go up and insert the necessary text in between the
30145 various formulas and numbers.
30146
30147 @tex
30148 \bigskip
30149 @end tex
30150
30151 @kindex M-# f
30152 @kindex M-# '
30153 @pindex calc-embedded-new-formula
30154 The @kbd{M-# f} (@code{calc-embedded-new-formula}) command
30155 creates a new embedded formula at the current point. It inserts
30156 some default delimiters, which are usually just blank lines,
30157 and then does an algebraic entry to get the formula (which is
30158 then enabled for Embedded mode). This is just shorthand for
30159 typing the delimiters yourself, positioning the cursor between
30160 the new delimiters, and pressing @kbd{M-# e}. The key sequence
30161 @kbd{M-# '} is equivalent to @kbd{M-# f}.
30162
30163 @kindex M-# n
30164 @kindex M-# p
30165 @pindex calc-embedded-next
30166 @pindex calc-embedded-previous
30167 The @kbd{M-# n} (@code{calc-embedded-next}) and @kbd{M-# p}
30168 (@code{calc-embedded-previous}) commands move the cursor to the
30169 next or previous active embedded formula in the buffer. They
30170 can take positive or negative prefix arguments to move by several
30171 formulas. Note that these commands do not actually examine the
30172 text of the buffer looking for formulas; they only see formulas
30173 which have previously been activated in Embedded mode. In fact,
30174 @kbd{M-# n} and @kbd{M-# p} are a useful way to tell which
30175 embedded formulas are currently active. Also, note that these
30176 commands do not enable Embedded mode on the next or previous
30177 formula, they just move the cursor. (By the way, @kbd{M-# n} is
30178 not as awkward to type as it may seem, because @kbd{M-#} ignores
30179 Shift and Meta on the second keystroke: @kbd{M-# M-N} can be typed
30180 by holding down Shift and Meta and alternately typing two keys.)
30181
30182 @kindex M-# `
30183 @pindex calc-embedded-edit
30184 The @kbd{M-# `} (@code{calc-embedded-edit}) command edits the
30185 embedded formula at the current point as if by @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}).
30186 Embedded mode does not have to be enabled for this to work. Press
30187 @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish the edit, or @kbd{C-x k} to cancel.
30188
30189 @node Assignments in Embedded Mode, Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30190 @section Assignments in Embedded Mode
30191
30192 @noindent
30193 The @samp{:=} (assignment) and @samp{=>} (``evaluates-to'') operators
30194 are especially useful in Embedded mode. They allow you to make
30195 a definition in one formula, then refer to that definition in
30196 other formulas embedded in the same buffer.
30197
30198 An embedded formula which is an assignment to a variable, as in
30199
30200 @example
30201 foo := 5
30202 @end example
30203
30204 @noindent
30205 records @expr{5} as the stored value of @code{foo} for the
30206 purposes of Embedded mode operations in the current buffer. It
30207 does @emph{not} actually store @expr{5} as the ``global'' value
30208 of @code{foo}, however. Regular Calc operations, and Embedded
30209 formulas in other buffers, will not see this assignment.
30210
30211 One way to use this assigned value is simply to create an
30212 Embedded formula elsewhere that refers to @code{foo}, and to press
30213 @kbd{=} in that formula. However, this permanently replaces the
30214 @code{foo} in the formula with its current value. More interesting
30215 is to use @samp{=>} elsewhere:
30216
30217 @example
30218 foo + 7 => 12
30219 @end example
30220
30221 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a general discussion of @samp{=>}.
30222
30223 If you move back and change the assignment to @code{foo}, any
30224 @samp{=>} formulas which refer to it are automatically updated.
30225
30226 @example
30227 foo := 17
30228
30229 foo + 7 => 24
30230 @end example
30231
30232 The obvious question then is, @emph{how} can one easily change the
30233 assignment to @code{foo}? If you simply select the formula in
30234 Embedded mode and type 17, the assignment itself will be replaced
30235 by the 17. The effect on the other formula will be that the
30236 variable @code{foo} becomes unassigned:
30237
30238 @example
30239 17
30240
30241 foo + 7 => foo + 7
30242 @end example
30243
30244 The right thing to do is first to use a selection command (@kbd{j 2}
30245 will do the trick) to select the righthand side of the assignment.
30246 Then, @kbd{17 @key{TAB} @key{DEL}} will swap the 17 into place (@pxref{Selecting
30247 Subformulas}, to see how this works).
30248
30249 @kindex M-# j
30250 @pindex calc-embedded-select
30251 The @kbd{M-# j} (@code{calc-embedded-select}) command provides an
30252 easy way to operate on assignments. It is just like @kbd{M-# e},
30253 except that if the enabled formula is an assignment, it uses
30254 @kbd{j 2} to select the righthand side. If the enabled formula
30255 is an evaluates-to, it uses @kbd{j 1} to select the lefthand side.
30256 A formula can also be a combination of both:
30257
30258 @example
30259 bar := foo + 3 => 20
30260 @end example
30261
30262 @noindent
30263 in which case @kbd{M-# j} will select the middle part (@samp{foo + 3}).
30264
30265 The formula is automatically deselected when you leave Embedded
30266 mode.
30267
30268 @kindex M-# u
30269 @kindex M-# =
30270 @pindex calc-embedded-update
30271 Another way to change the assignment to @code{foo} would simply be
30272 to edit the number using regular Emacs editing rather than Embedded
30273 mode. Then, we have to find a way to get Embedded mode to notice
30274 the change. The @kbd{M-# u} or @kbd{M-# =}
30275 (@code{calc-embedded-update-formula}) command is a convenient way
30276 to do this.
30277
30278 @example
30279 foo := 6
30280
30281 foo + 7 => 13
30282 @end example
30283
30284 Pressing @kbd{M-# u} is much like pressing @kbd{M-# e = M-# e}, that
30285 is, temporarily enabling Embedded mode for the formula under the
30286 cursor and then evaluating it with @kbd{=}. But @kbd{M-# u} does
30287 not actually use @kbd{M-# e}, and in fact another formula somewhere
30288 else can be enabled in Embedded mode while you use @kbd{M-# u} and
30289 that formula will not be disturbed.
30290
30291 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{M-# u} updates all active
30292 @samp{=>} formulas in the buffer. Formulas which have not yet
30293 been activated in Embedded mode, and formulas which do not have
30294 @samp{=>} as their top-level operator, are not affected by this.
30295 (This is useful only if you have used @kbd{m C}; see below.)
30296
30297 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{C-u M-# u} updates only in the
30298 region between mark and point rather than in the whole buffer.
30299
30300 @kbd{M-# u} is also a handy way to activate a formula, such as an
30301 @samp{=>} formula that has freshly been typed in or loaded from a
30302 file.
30303
30304 @kindex M-# a
30305 @pindex calc-embedded-activate
30306 The @kbd{M-# a} (@code{calc-embedded-activate}) command scans
30307 through the current buffer and activates all embedded formulas
30308 that contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols. This does not mean
30309 that Embedded mode is actually turned on, but only that the
30310 formulas' positions are registered with Embedded mode so that
30311 the @samp{=>} values can be properly updated as assignments are
30312 changed.
30313
30314 It is a good idea to type @kbd{M-# a} right after loading a file
30315 that uses embedded @samp{=>} operators. Emacs includes a nifty
30316 ``buffer-local variables'' feature that you can use to do this
30317 automatically. The idea is to place near the end of your file
30318 a few lines that look like this:
30319
30320 @example
30321 --- Local Variables: ---
30322 --- eval:(calc-embedded-activate) ---
30323 --- End: ---
30324 @end example
30325
30326 @noindent
30327 where the leading and trailing @samp{---} can be replaced by
30328 any suitable strings (which must be the same on all three lines)
30329 or omitted altogether; in a @TeX{} or La@TeX{} file, @samp{%} would be a good
30330 leading string and no trailing string would be necessary. In a
30331 C program, @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} would be good leading and
30332 trailing strings.
30333
30334 When Emacs loads a file into memory, it checks for a Local Variables
30335 section like this one at the end of the file. If it finds this
30336 section, it does the specified things (in this case, running
30337 @kbd{M-# a} automatically) before editing of the file begins.
30338 The Local Variables section must be within 3000 characters of the
30339 end of the file for Emacs to find it, and it must be in the last
30340 page of the file if the file has any page separators.
30341 @xref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the
30342 Emacs manual}.
30343
30344 Note that @kbd{M-# a} does not update the formulas it finds.
30345 To do this, type, say, @kbd{M-1 M-# u} after @w{@kbd{M-# a}}.
30346 Generally this should not be a problem, though, because the
30347 formulas will have been up-to-date already when the file was
30348 saved.
30349
30350 Normally, @kbd{M-# a} activates all the formulas it finds, but
30351 any previous active formulas remain active as well. With a
30352 positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{M-# a} first deactivates
30353 all current active formulas, then actives the ones it finds in
30354 its scan of the buffer. With a negative prefix argument,
30355 @kbd{M-# a} simply deactivates all formulas.
30356
30357 Embedded mode has two symbols, @samp{Active} and @samp{~Active},
30358 which it puts next to the major mode name in a buffer's mode line.
30359 It puts @samp{Active} if it has reason to believe that all
30360 formulas in the buffer are active, because you have typed @kbd{M-# a}
30361 and Calc has not since had to deactivate any formulas (which can
30362 happen if Calc goes to update an @samp{=>} formula somewhere because
30363 a variable changed, and finds that the formula is no longer there
30364 due to some kind of editing outside of Embedded mode). Calc puts
30365 @samp{~Active} in the mode line if some, but probably not all,
30366 formulas in the buffer are active. This happens if you activate
30367 a few formulas one at a time but never use @kbd{M-# a}, or if you
30368 used @kbd{M-# a} but then Calc had to deactivate a formula
30369 because it lost track of it. If neither of these symbols appears
30370 in the mode line, no embedded formulas are active in the buffer
30371 (e.g., before Embedded mode has been used, or after a @kbd{M-- M-# a}).
30372
30373 Embedded formulas can refer to assignments both before and after them
30374 in the buffer. If there are several assignments to a variable, the
30375 nearest preceding assignment is used if there is one, otherwise the
30376 following assignment is used.
30377
30378 @example
30379 x => 1
30380
30381 x := 1
30382
30383 x => 1
30384
30385 x := 2
30386
30387 x => 2
30388 @end example
30389
30390 As well as simple variables, you can also assign to subscript
30391 expressions of the form @samp{@var{var}_@var{number}} (as in
30392 @code{x_0}), or @samp{@var{var}_@var{var}} (as in @code{x_max}).
30393 Assignments to other kinds of objects can be represented by Calc,
30394 but the automatic linkage between assignments and references works
30395 only for plain variables and these two kinds of subscript expressions.
30396
30397 If there are no assignments to a given variable, the global
30398 stored value for the variable is used (@pxref{Storing Variables}),
30399 or, if no value is stored, the variable is left in symbolic form.
30400 Note that global stored values will be lost when the file is saved
30401 and loaded in a later Emacs session, unless you have used the
30402 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save them;
30403 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
30404
30405 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns automatic
30406 recomputation of @samp{=>} forms on and off. If you turn automatic
30407 recomputation off, you will have to use @kbd{M-# u} to update these
30408 formulas manually after an assignment has been changed. If you
30409 plan to change several assignments at once, it may be more efficient
30410 to type @kbd{m C}, change all the assignments, then use @kbd{M-1 M-# u}
30411 to update the entire buffer afterwards. The @kbd{m C} command also
30412 controls @samp{=>} formulas on the stack; @pxref{Evaluates-To
30413 Operator}. When you turn automatic recomputation back on, the
30414 stack will be updated but the Embedded buffer will not; you must
30415 use @kbd{M-# u} to update the buffer by hand.
30416
30417 @node Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Customizing Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30418 @section Mode Settings in Embedded Mode
30419
30420 @noindent
30421 Embedded mode has a rather complicated mechanism for handling mode
30422 settings in Embedded formulas. It is possible to put annotations
30423 in the file that specify mode settings either global to the entire
30424 file or local to a particular formula or formulas. In the latter
30425 case, different modes can be specified for use when a formula
30426 is the enabled Embedded mode formula.
30427
30428 When you give any mode-setting command, like @kbd{m f} (for Fraction
30429 mode) or @kbd{d s} (for scientific notation), Embedded mode adds
30430 a line like the following one to the file just before the opening
30431 delimiter of the formula.
30432
30433 @example
30434 % [calc-mode: fractions: t]
30435 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30436 @end example
30437
30438 When Calc interprets an embedded formula, it scans the text before
30439 the formula for mode-setting annotations like these and sets the
30440 Calc buffer to match these modes. Modes not explicitly described
30441 in the file are not changed. Calc scans all the way to the top of
30442 the file, or up to a line of the form
30443
30444 @example
30445 % [calc-defaults]
30446 @end example
30447
30448 @noindent
30449 which you can insert at strategic places in the file if this backward
30450 scan is getting too slow, or just to provide a barrier between one
30451 ``zone'' of mode settings and another.
30452
30453 If the file contains several annotations for the same mode, the
30454 closest one before the formula is used. Annotations after the
30455 formula are never used (except for global annotations, described
30456 below).
30457
30458 The scan does not look for the leading @samp{% }, only for the
30459 square brackets and the text they enclose. You can edit the mode
30460 annotations to a style that works better in context if you wish.
30461 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to change the style
30462 that Calc uses when it generates the annotations. You can write
30463 mode annotations into the file yourself if you know the syntax;
30464 the easiest way to find the syntax for a given mode is to let
30465 Calc write the annotation for it once and see what it does.
30466
30467 If you give a mode-changing command for a mode that already has
30468 a suitable annotation just above the current formula, Calc will
30469 modify that annotation rather than generating a new, conflicting
30470 one.
30471
30472 Mode annotations have three parts, separated by colons. (Spaces
30473 after the colons are optional.) The first identifies the kind
30474 of mode setting, the second is a name for the mode itself, and
30475 the third is the value in the form of a Lisp symbol, number,
30476 or list. Annotations with unrecognizable text in the first or
30477 second parts are ignored. The third part is not checked to make
30478 sure the value is of a legal type or range; if you write an
30479 annotation by hand, be sure to give a proper value or results
30480 will be unpredictable. Mode-setting annotations are case-sensitive.
30481
30482 While Embedded mode is enabled, the word @code{Local} appears in
30483 the mode line. This is to show that mode setting commands generate
30484 annotations that are ``local'' to the current formula or set of
30485 formulas. The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command
30486 causes Calc to generate different kinds of annotations. Pressing
30487 @kbd{m R} repeatedly cycles through the possible modes.
30488
30489 @code{LocEdit} and @code{LocPerm} modes generate annotations
30490 that look like this, respectively:
30491
30492 @example
30493 % [calc-edit-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30494 % [calc-perm-mode: float-format: (sci 5)]
30495 @end example
30496
30497 The first kind of annotation will be used only while a formula
30498 is enabled in Embedded mode. The second kind will be used only
30499 when the formula is @emph{not} enabled. (Whether the formula
30500 is ``active'' or not, i.e., whether Calc has seen this formula
30501 yet, is not relevant here.)
30502
30503 @code{Global} mode generates an annotation like this at the end
30504 of the file:
30505
30506 @example
30507 % [calc-global-mode: fractions t]
30508 @end example
30509
30510 Global mode annotations affect all formulas throughout the file,
30511 and may appear anywhere in the file. This allows you to tuck your
30512 mode annotations somewhere out of the way, say, on a new page of
30513 the file, as long as those mode settings are suitable for all
30514 formulas in the file.
30515
30516 Enabling a formula with @kbd{M-# e} causes a fresh scan for local
30517 mode annotations; you will have to use this after adding annotations
30518 above a formula by hand to get the formula to notice them. Updating
30519 a formula with @kbd{M-# u} will also re-scan the local modes, but
30520 global modes are only re-scanned by @kbd{M-# a}.
30521
30522 Another way that modes can get out of date is if you add a local
30523 mode annotation to a formula that has another formula after it.
30524 In this example, we have used the @kbd{d s} command while the
30525 first of the two embedded formulas is active. But the second
30526 formula has not changed its style to match, even though by the
30527 rules of reading annotations the @samp{(sci 0)} applies to it, too.
30528
30529 @example
30530 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30531 1.23e2
30532
30533 456.
30534 @end example
30535
30536 We would have to go down to the other formula and press @kbd{M-# u}
30537 on it in order to get it to notice the new annotation.
30538
30539 Two more mode-recording modes selectable by @kbd{m R} are @code{Save}
30540 (which works even outside of Embedded mode), in which mode settings
30541 are recorded permanently in your Calc init file (the file given by the
30542 variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el})
30543 rather than by annotating the current document, and no-recording
30544 mode (where there is no symbol like @code{Save} or @code{Local} in
30545 the mode line), in which mode-changing commands do not leave any
30546 annotations at all.
30547
30548 When Embedded mode is not enabled, mode-recording modes except
30549 for @code{Save} have no effect.
30550
30551 @node Customizing Embedded Mode, , Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30552 @section Customizing Embedded Mode
30553
30554 @noindent
30555 You can modify Embedded mode's behavior by setting various Lisp
30556 variables described here. Use @kbd{M-x set-variable} or
30557 @kbd{M-x edit-options} to adjust a variable on the fly, or
30558 put a suitable @code{setq} statement in your Calc init file (or
30559 @file{~/.emacs}) to set a variable permanently. (Another possibility would
30560 be to use a file-local variable annotation at the end of the
30561 file; @pxref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the
30562 Emacs manual}.)
30563
30564 While none of these variables will be buffer-local by default, you
30565 can make any of them local to any Embedded mode buffer. (Their
30566 values in the @samp{*Calculator*} buffer are never used.)
30567
30568 @vindex calc-embedded-open-formula
30569 The @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} variable holds a regular
30570 expression for the opening delimiter of a formula. @xref{Regexp Search,
30571 , Regular Expression Search, emacs, the Emacs manual}, to see
30572 how regular expressions work. Basically, a regular expression is a
30573 pattern that Calc can search for. A regular expression that considers
30574 blank lines, @samp{$}, and @samp{$$} to be opening delimiters is
30575 @code{"\\`\\|^\n\\|\\$\\$?"}. Just in case the meaning of this
30576 regular expression is not completely plain, let's go through it
30577 in detail.
30578
30579 The surrounding @samp{" "} marks quote the text between them as a
30580 Lisp string. If you left them off, @code{set-variable} or
30581 @code{edit-options} would try to read the regular expression as a
30582 Lisp program.
30583
30584 The most obvious property of this regular expression is that it
30585 contains indecently many backslashes. There are actually two levels
30586 of backslash usage going on here. First, when Lisp reads a quoted
30587 string, all pairs of characters beginning with a backslash are
30588 interpreted as special characters. Here, @code{\n} changes to a
30589 new-line character, and @code{\\} changes to a single backslash.
30590 So the actual regular expression seen by Calc is
30591 @samp{\`\|^ @r{(newline)} \|\$\$?}.
30592
30593 Regular expressions also consider pairs beginning with backslash
30594 to have special meanings. Sometimes the backslash is used to quote
30595 a character that otherwise would have a special meaning in a regular
30596 expression, like @samp{$}, which normally means ``end-of-line,''
30597 or @samp{?}, which means that the preceding item is optional. So
30598 @samp{\$\$?} matches either one or two dollar signs.
30599
30600 The other codes in this regular expression are @samp{^}, which matches
30601 ``beginning-of-line,'' @samp{\|}, which means ``or,'' and @samp{\`},
30602 which matches ``beginning-of-buffer.'' So the whole pattern means
30603 that a formula begins at the beginning of the buffer, or on a newline
30604 that occurs at the beginning of a line (i.e., a blank line), or at
30605 one or two dollar signs.
30606
30607 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} looks just
30608 like this example, with several more alternatives added on to
30609 recognize various other common kinds of delimiters.
30610
30611 By the way, the reason to use @samp{^\n} rather than @samp{^$}
30612 or @samp{\n\n}, which also would appear to match blank lines,
30613 is that the former expression actually ``consumes'' only one
30614 newline character as @emph{part of} the delimiter, whereas the
30615 latter expressions consume zero or two newlines, respectively.
30616 The former choice gives the most natural behavior when Calc
30617 must operate on a whole formula including its delimiters.
30618
30619 See the Emacs manual for complete details on regular expressions.
30620 But just for your convenience, here is a list of all characters
30621 which must be quoted with backslash (like @samp{\$}) to avoid
30622 some special interpretation: @samp{. * + ? [ ] ^ $ \}. (Note
30623 the backslash in this list; for example, to match @samp{\[} you
30624 must use @code{"\\\\\\["}. An exercise for the reader is to
30625 account for each of these six backslashes!)
30626
30627 @vindex calc-embedded-close-formula
30628 The @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} variable holds a regular
30629 expression for the closing delimiter of a formula. A closing
30630 regular expression to match the above example would be
30631 @code{"\\'\\|\n$\\|\\$\\$?"}. This is almost the same as the
30632 other one, except it now uses @samp{\'} (``end-of-buffer'') and
30633 @samp{\n$} (newline occurring at end of line, yet another way
30634 of describing a blank line that is more appropriate for this
30635 case).
30636
30637 @vindex calc-embedded-open-word
30638 @vindex calc-embedded-close-word
30639 The @code{calc-embedded-open-word} and @code{calc-embedded-close-word}
30640 variables are similar expressions used when you type @kbd{M-# w}
30641 instead of @kbd{M-# e} to enable Embedded mode.
30642
30643 @vindex calc-embedded-open-plain
30644 The @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} variable is a string which
30645 begins a ``plain'' formula written in front of the formatted
30646 formula when @kbd{d p} mode is turned on. Note that this is an
30647 actual string, not a regular expression, because Calc must be able
30648 to write this string into a buffer as well as to recognize it.
30649 The default string is @code{"%%% "} (note the trailing space).
30650
30651 @vindex calc-embedded-close-plain
30652 The @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} variable is a string which
30653 ends a ``plain'' formula. The default is @code{" %%%\n"}. Without
30654 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
30655 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
30656
30657 @vindex calc-embedded-open-new-formula
30658 The @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} variable is a string
30659 which is inserted at the front of a new formula when you type
30660 @kbd{M-# f}. Its default value is @code{"\n\n"}. If this
30661 string begins with a newline character and the @kbd{M-# f} is
30662 typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{M-# f} will skip this
30663 first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in
30664 the file.
30665
30666 @vindex calc-embedded-close-new-formula
30667 The @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} variable is the corresponding
30668 string which is inserted at the end of a new formula. Its default
30669 value is also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by
30670 @w{@kbd{M-# f}} if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if
30671 @kbd{M-# f} is typed on a blank line, both a leading opening
30672 newline and a trailing closing newline are omitted.)
30673
30674 @vindex calc-embedded-announce-formula
30675 The @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} variable is a regular
30676 expression which is sure to be followed by an embedded formula.
30677 The @kbd{M-# a} command searches for this pattern as well as for
30678 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=} operators. Note that @kbd{M-# a} will
30679 not activate just anything surrounded by formula delimiters; after
30680 all, blank lines are considered formula delimiters by default!
30681 But if your language includes a delimiter which can only occur
30682 actually in front of a formula, you can take advantage of it here.
30683 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, which
30684 checks for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of lines beginning
30685 with @samp{%} and a space. This last is important to make Calc
30686 consider mode annotations part of the pattern, so that the formula's
30687 opening delimiter really is sure to follow the pattern.
30688
30689 @vindex calc-embedded-open-mode
30690 The @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} variable is a string (not a
30691 regular expression) which should precede a mode annotation.
30692 Calc never scans for this string; Calc always looks for the
30693 annotation itself. But this is the string that is inserted before
30694 the opening bracket when Calc adds an annotation on its own.
30695 The default is @code{"% "}.
30696
30697 @vindex calc-embedded-close-mode
30698 The @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} variable is a string which
30699 follows a mode annotation written by Calc. Its default value
30700 is simply a newline, @code{"\n"}. If you change this, it is a
30701 good idea still to end with a newline so that mode annotations
30702 will appear on lines by themselves.
30703
30704 @node Programming, Installation, Embedded Mode, Top
30705 @chapter Programming
30706
30707 @noindent
30708 There are several ways to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator, depending
30709 on the nature of the problem you need to solve.
30710
30711 @enumerate
30712 @item
30713 @dfn{Keyboard macros} allow you to record a sequence of keystrokes
30714 and play them back at a later time. This is just the standard Emacs
30715 keyboard macro mechanism, dressed up with a few more features such
30716 as loops and conditionals.
30717
30718 @item
30719 @dfn{Algebraic definitions} allow you to use any formula to define a
30720 new function. This function can then be used in algebraic formulas or
30721 as an interactive command.
30722
30723 @item
30724 @dfn{Rewrite rules} are discussed in the section on algebra commands.
30725 @xref{Rewrite Rules}. If you put your rewrite rules in the variable
30726 @code{EvalRules}, they will be applied automatically to all Calc
30727 results in just the same way as an internal ``rule'' is applied to
30728 evaluate @samp{sqrt(9)} to 3 and so on. @xref{Automatic Rewrites}.
30729
30730 @item
30731 @dfn{Lisp} is the programming language that Calc (and most of Emacs)
30732 is written in. If the above techniques aren't powerful enough, you
30733 can write Lisp functions to do anything that built-in Calc commands
30734 can do. Lisp code is also somewhat faster than keyboard macros or
30735 rewrite rules.
30736 @end enumerate
30737
30738 @kindex z
30739 Programming features are available through the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z}
30740 prefix keys. New commands that you define are two-key sequences
30741 beginning with @kbd{z}. Commands for managing these definitions
30742 use the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix. (The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing})
30743 command is described elsewhere; @pxref{Troubleshooting Commands}.
30744 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command is also
30745 described elsewhere; @pxref{User-Defined Compositions}.)
30746
30747 @menu
30748 * Creating User Keys::
30749 * Keyboard Macros::
30750 * Invocation Macros::
30751 * Algebraic Definitions::
30752 * Lisp Definitions::
30753 @end menu
30754
30755 @node Creating User Keys, Keyboard Macros, Programming, Programming
30756 @section Creating User Keys
30757
30758 @noindent
30759 @kindex Z D
30760 @pindex calc-user-define
30761 Any Calculator command may be bound to a key using the @kbd{Z D}
30762 (@code{calc-user-define}) command. Actually, it is bound to a two-key
30763 sequence beginning with the lower-case @kbd{z} prefix.
30764
30765 The @kbd{Z D} command first prompts for the key to define. For example,
30766 press @kbd{Z D a} to define the new key sequence @kbd{z a}. You are then
30767 prompted for the name of the Calculator command that this key should
30768 run. For example, the @code{calc-sincos} command is not normally
30769 available on a key. Typing @kbd{Z D s sincos @key{RET}} programs the
30770 @kbd{z s} key sequence to run @code{calc-sincos}. This definition will remain
30771 in effect for the rest of this Emacs session, or until you redefine
30772 @kbd{z s} to be something else.
30773
30774 You can actually bind any Emacs command to a @kbd{z} key sequence by
30775 backspacing over the @samp{calc-} when you are prompted for the command name.
30776
30777 As with any other prefix key, you can type @kbd{z ?} to see a list of
30778 all the two-key sequences you have defined that start with @kbd{z}.
30779 Initially, no @kbd{z} sequences (except @kbd{z ?} itself) are defined.
30780
30781 User keys are typically letters, but may in fact be any key.
30782 (@key{META}-keys are not permitted, nor are a terminal's special
30783 function keys which generate multi-character sequences when pressed.)
30784 You can define different commands on the shifted and unshifted versions
30785 of a letter if you wish.
30786
30787 @kindex Z U
30788 @pindex calc-user-undefine
30789 The @kbd{Z U} (@code{calc-user-undefine}) command unbinds a user key.
30790 For example, the key sequence @kbd{Z U s} will undefine the @code{sincos}
30791 key we defined above.
30792
30793 @kindex Z P
30794 @pindex calc-user-define-permanent
30795 @cindex Storing user definitions
30796 @cindex Permanent user definitions
30797 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined commands
30798 The @kbd{Z P} (@code{calc-user-define-permanent}) command makes a key
30799 binding permanent so that it will remain in effect even in future Emacs
30800 sessions. (It does this by adding a suitable bit of Lisp code into
30801 your Calc init file; that is, the file given by the variable
30802 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}.) For example,
30803 @kbd{Z P s} would register our @code{sincos} command permanently. If
30804 you later wish to unregister this command you must edit your Calc init
30805 file by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
30806 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
30807
30808 The @kbd{Z P} command also saves the user definition, if any, for the
30809 command bound to the key. After @kbd{Z F} and @kbd{Z C}, a given user
30810 key could invoke a command, which in turn calls an algebraic function,
30811 which might have one or more special display formats. A single @kbd{Z P}
30812 command will save all of these definitions.
30813 To save an algebraic function, type @kbd{'} (the apostrophe)
30814 when prompted for a key, and type the function name. To save a command
30815 without its key binding, type @kbd{M-x} and enter a function name. (The
30816 @samp{calc-} prefix will automatically be inserted for you.)
30817 (If the command you give implies a function, the function will be saved,
30818 and if the function has any display formats, those will be saved, but
30819 not the other way around: Saving a function will not save any commands
30820 or key bindings associated with the function.)
30821
30822 @kindex Z E
30823 @pindex calc-user-define-edit
30824 @cindex Editing user definitions
30825 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command edits the definition
30826 of a user key. This works for keys that have been defined by either
30827 keyboard macros or formulas; further details are contained in the relevant
30828 following sections.
30829
30830 @node Keyboard Macros, Invocation Macros, Creating User Keys, Programming
30831 @section Programming with Keyboard Macros
30832
30833 @noindent
30834 @kindex X
30835 @cindex Programming with keyboard macros
30836 @cindex Keyboard macros
30837 The easiest way to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator is to use standard
30838 keyboard macros. Press @w{@kbd{C-x (}} to begin recording a macro. From
30839 this point on, keystrokes you type will be saved away as well as
30840 performing their usual functions. Press @kbd{C-x )} to end recording.
30841 Press shift-@kbd{X} (or the standard Emacs key sequence @kbd{C-x e}) to
30842 execute your keyboard macro by replaying the recorded keystrokes.
30843 @xref{Keyboard Macros, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for further
30844 information.
30845
30846 When you use @kbd{X} to invoke a keyboard macro, the entire macro is
30847 treated as a single command by the undo and trail features. The stack
30848 display buffer is not updated during macro execution, but is instead
30849 fixed up once the macro completes. Thus, commands defined with keyboard
30850 macros are convenient and efficient. The @kbd{C-x e} command, on the
30851 other hand, invokes the keyboard macro with no special treatment: Each
30852 command in the macro will record its own undo information and trail entry,
30853 and update the stack buffer accordingly. If your macro uses features
30854 outside of Calc's control to operate on the contents of the Calc stack
30855 buffer, or if it includes Undo, Redo, or last-arguments commands, you
30856 must use @kbd{C-x e} to make sure the buffer and undo list are up-to-date
30857 at all times. You could also consider using @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args})
30858 instead of @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
30859
30860 Calc extends the standard Emacs keyboard macros in several ways.
30861 Keyboard macros can be used to create user-defined commands. Keyboard
30862 macros can include conditional and iteration structures, somewhat
30863 analogous to those provided by a traditional programmable calculator.
30864
30865 @menu
30866 * Naming Keyboard Macros::
30867 * Conditionals in Macros::
30868 * Loops in Macros::
30869 * Local Values in Macros::
30870 * Queries in Macros::
30871 @end menu
30872
30873 @node Naming Keyboard Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
30874 @subsection Naming Keyboard Macros
30875
30876 @noindent
30877 @kindex Z K
30878 @pindex calc-user-define-kbd-macro
30879 Once you have defined a keyboard macro, you can bind it to a @kbd{z}
30880 key sequence with the @kbd{Z K} (@code{calc-user-define-kbd-macro}) command.
30881 This command prompts first for a key, then for a command name. For
30882 example, if you type @kbd{C-x ( n @key{TAB} n @key{TAB} C-x )} you will
30883 define a keyboard macro which negates the top two numbers on the stack
30884 (@key{TAB} swaps the top two stack elements). Now you can type
30885 @kbd{Z K n @key{RET}} to define this keyboard macro onto the @kbd{z n} key
30886 sequence. The default command name (if you answer the second prompt with
30887 just the @key{RET} key as in this example) will be something like
30888 @samp{calc-User-n}. The keyboard macro will now be available as both
30889 @kbd{z n} and @kbd{M-x calc-User-n}. You can backspace and enter a more
30890 descriptive command name if you wish.
30891
30892 Macros defined by @kbd{Z K} act like single commands; they are executed
30893 in the same way as by the @kbd{X} key. If you wish to define the macro
30894 as a standard no-frills Emacs macro (to be executed as if by @kbd{C-x e}),
30895 give a negative prefix argument to @kbd{Z K}.
30896
30897 Once you have bound your keyboard macro to a key, you can use
30898 @kbd{Z P} to register it permanently with Emacs. @xref{Creating User Keys}.
30899
30900 @cindex Keyboard macros, editing
30901 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
30902 been defined by a keyboard macro tries to use the @code{edmacro} package
30903 edit the macro. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and update
30904 the definition stored on the key, or, to cancel the edit, kill the
30905 buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
30906 The special characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC},
30907 @code{DEL}, and @code{NUL} must be entered as these three character
30908 sequences, written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes @code{C-} and
30909 @code{M-}. Spaces and line breaks are ignored. Other characters are
30910 copied verbatim into the keyboard macro. Basically, the notation is the
30911 same as is used in all of this manual's examples, except that the manual
30912 takes some liberties with spaces: When we say @kbd{' [1 2 3] @key{RET}},
30913 we take it for granted that it is clear we really mean
30914 @kbd{' [1 @key{SPC} 2 @key{SPC} 3] @key{RET}}.
30915
30916 @kindex M-# m
30917 @pindex read-kbd-macro
30918 The @kbd{M-# m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) command reads an Emacs ``region''
30919 of spelled-out keystrokes and defines it as the current keyboard macro.
30920 It is a convenient way to define a keyboard macro that has been stored
30921 in a file, or to define a macro without executing it at the same time.
30922
30923 @node Conditionals in Macros, Loops in Macros, Naming Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
30924 @subsection Conditionals in Keyboard Macros
30925
30926 @noindent
30927 @kindex Z [
30928 @kindex Z ]
30929 @pindex calc-kbd-if
30930 @pindex calc-kbd-else
30931 @pindex calc-kbd-else-if
30932 @pindex calc-kbd-end-if
30933 @cindex Conditional structures
30934 The @kbd{Z [} (@code{calc-kbd-if}) and @kbd{Z ]} (@code{calc-kbd-end-if})
30935 commands allow you to put simple tests in a keyboard macro. When Calc
30936 sees the @kbd{Z [}, it pops an object from the stack and, if the object is
30937 a non-zero value, continues executing keystrokes. But if the object is
30938 zero, or if it is not provably nonzero, Calc skips ahead to the matching
30939 @kbd{Z ]} keystroke. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a set of commands for
30940 performing tests which conveniently produce 1 for true and 0 for false.
30941
30942 For example, @kbd{@key{RET} 0 a < Z [ n Z ]} implements an absolute-value
30943 function in the form of a keyboard macro. This macro duplicates the
30944 number on the top of the stack, pushes zero and compares using @kbd{a <}
30945 (@code{calc-less-than}), then, if the number was less than zero,
30946 executes @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}). Otherwise, the change-sign
30947 command is skipped.
30948
30949 To program this macro, type @kbd{C-x (}, type the above sequence of
30950 keystrokes, then type @kbd{C-x )}. Note that the keystrokes will be
30951 executed while you are making the definition as well as when you later
30952 re-execute the macro by typing @kbd{X}. Thus you should make sure a
30953 suitable number is on the stack before defining the macro so that you
30954 don't get a stack-underflow error during the definition process.
30955
30956 Conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. However, there should be exactly
30957 one @kbd{Z ]} for each @kbd{Z [} in a keyboard macro.
30958
30959 @kindex Z :
30960 The @kbd{Z :} (@code{calc-kbd-else}) command allows you to choose between
30961 two keystroke sequences. The general format is @kbd{@var{cond} Z [
30962 @var{then-part} Z : @var{else-part} Z ]}. If @var{cond} is true
30963 (i.e., if the top of stack contains a non-zero number after @var{cond}
30964 has been executed), the @var{then-part} will be executed and the
30965 @var{else-part} will be skipped. Otherwise, the @var{then-part} will
30966 be skipped and the @var{else-part} will be executed.
30967
30968 @kindex Z |
30969 The @kbd{Z |} (@code{calc-kbd-else-if}) command allows you to choose
30970 between any number of alternatives. For example,
30971 @kbd{@var{cond1} Z [ @var{part1} Z : @var{cond2} Z | @var{part2} Z :
30972 @var{part3} Z ]} will execute @var{part1} if @var{cond1} is true,
30973 otherwise it will execute @var{part2} if @var{cond2} is true, otherwise
30974 it will execute @var{part3}.
30975
30976 More precisely, @kbd{Z [} pops a number and conditionally skips to the
30977 next matching @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]} key. @w{@kbd{Z ]}} has no effect when
30978 actually executed. @kbd{Z :} skips to the next matching @kbd{Z ]}.
30979 @kbd{Z |} pops a number and conditionally skips to the next matching
30980 @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]}; thus, @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z |} are functionally
30981 equivalent except that @kbd{Z [} participates in nesting but @kbd{Z |}
30982 does not.
30983
30984 Calc's conditional and looping constructs work by scanning the
30985 keyboard macro for occurrences of character sequences like @samp{Z:}
30986 and @samp{Z]}. One side-effect of this is that if you use these
30987 constructs you must be careful that these character pairs do not
30988 occur by accident in other parts of the macros. Since Calc rarely
30989 uses shift-@kbd{Z} for any purpose except as a prefix character, this
30990 is not likely to be a problem. Another side-effect is that it will
30991 not work to define your own custom key bindings for these commands.
30992 Only the standard shift-@kbd{Z} bindings will work correctly.
30993
30994 @kindex Z C-g
30995 If Calc gets stuck while skipping characters during the definition of a
30996 macro, type @kbd{Z C-g} to cancel the definition. (Typing plain @kbd{C-g}
30997 actually adds a @kbd{C-g} keystroke to the macro.)
30998
30999 @node Loops in Macros, Local Values in Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31000 @subsection Loops in Keyboard Macros
31001
31002 @noindent
31003 @kindex Z <
31004 @kindex Z >
31005 @pindex calc-kbd-repeat
31006 @pindex calc-kbd-end-repeat
31007 @cindex Looping structures
31008 @cindex Iterative structures
31009 The @kbd{Z <} (@code{calc-kbd-repeat}) and @kbd{Z >}
31010 (@code{calc-kbd-end-repeat}) commands pop a number from the stack,
31011 which must be an integer, then repeat the keystrokes between the brackets
31012 the specified number of times. If the integer is zero or negative, the
31013 body is skipped altogether. For example, @kbd{1 @key{TAB} Z < 2 * Z >}
31014 computes two to a nonnegative integer power. First, we push 1 on the
31015 stack and then swap the integer argument back to the top. The @kbd{Z <}
31016 pops that argument leaving the 1 back on top of the stack. Then, we
31017 repeat a multiply-by-two step however many times.
31018
31019 Once again, the keyboard macro is executed as it is being entered.
31020 In this case it is especially important to set up reasonable initial
31021 conditions before making the definition: Suppose the integer 1000 just
31022 happened to be sitting on the stack before we typed the above definition!
31023 Another approach is to enter a harmless dummy definition for the macro,
31024 then go back and edit in the real one with a @kbd{Z E} command. Yet
31025 another approach is to type the macro as written-out keystroke names
31026 in a buffer, then use @kbd{M-# m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the
31027 macro.
31028
31029 @kindex Z /
31030 @pindex calc-break
31031 The @kbd{Z /} (@code{calc-kbd-break}) command allows you to break out
31032 of a keyboard macro loop prematurely. It pops an object from the stack;
31033 if that object is true (a non-zero number), control jumps out of the
31034 innermost enclosing @kbd{Z <} @dots{} @kbd{Z >} loop and continues
31035 after the @kbd{Z >}. If the object is false, the @kbd{Z /} has no
31036 effect. Thus @kbd{@var{cond} Z /} is similar to @samp{if (@var{cond}) break;}
31037 in the C language.
31038
31039 @kindex Z (
31040 @kindex Z )
31041 @pindex calc-kbd-for
31042 @pindex calc-kbd-end-for
31043 The @kbd{Z (} (@code{calc-kbd-for}) and @kbd{Z )} (@code{calc-kbd-end-for})
31044 commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and @kbd{Z >}, except that they make the
31045 value of the counter available inside the loop. The general layout is
31046 @kbd{@var{init} @var{final} Z ( @var{body} @var{step} Z )}. The @kbd{Z (}
31047 command pops initial and final values from the stack. It then creates
31048 a temporary internal counter and initializes it with the value @var{init}.
31049 The @kbd{Z (} command then repeatedly pushes the counter value onto the
31050 stack and executes @var{body} and @var{step}, adding @var{step} to the
31051 counter each time until the loop finishes.
31052
31053 @cindex Summations (by keyboard macros)
31054 By default, the loop finishes when the counter becomes greater than (or
31055 less than) @var{final}, assuming @var{initial} is less than (greater
31056 than) @var{final}. If @var{initial} is equal to @var{final}, the body
31057 executes exactly once. The body of the loop always executes at least
31058 once. For example, @kbd{0 1 10 Z ( 2 ^ + 1 Z )} computes the sum of the
31059 squares of the integers from 1 to 10, in steps of 1.
31060
31061 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{Z (}, the loop is
31062 forced to use upward-counting conventions. In this case, if @var{initial}
31063 is greater than @var{final} the body will not be executed at all.
31064 Note that @var{step} may still be negative in this loop; the prefix
31065 argument merely constrains the loop-finished test. Likewise, a prefix
31066 argument of @mathit{-1} forces downward-counting conventions.
31067
31068 @kindex Z @{
31069 @kindex Z @}
31070 @pindex calc-kbd-loop
31071 @pindex calc-kbd-end-loop
31072 The @kbd{Z @{} (@code{calc-kbd-loop}) and @kbd{Z @}}
31073 (@code{calc-kbd-end-loop}) commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and
31074 @kbd{Z >}, except that they do not pop a count from the stack---they
31075 effectively create an infinite loop. Every @kbd{Z @{} @dots{} @kbd{Z @}}
31076 loop ought to include at least one @kbd{Z /} to make sure the loop
31077 doesn't run forever. (If any error message occurs which causes Emacs
31078 to beep, the keyboard macro will also be halted; this is a standard
31079 feature of Emacs. You can also generally press @kbd{C-g} to halt a
31080 running keyboard macro, although not all versions of Unix support
31081 this feature.)
31082
31083 The conditional and looping constructs are not actually tied to
31084 keyboard macros, but they are most often used in that context.
31085 For example, the keystrokes @kbd{10 Z < 23 @key{RET} Z >} push
31086 ten copies of 23 onto the stack. This can be typed ``live'' just
31087 as easily as in a macro definition.
31088
31089 @xref{Conditionals in Macros}, for some additional notes about
31090 conditional and looping commands.
31091
31092 @node Local Values in Macros, Queries in Macros, Loops in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31093 @subsection Local Values in Macros
31094
31095 @noindent
31096 @cindex Local variables
31097 @cindex Restoring saved modes
31098 Keyboard macros sometimes want to operate under known conditions
31099 without affecting surrounding conditions. For example, a keyboard
31100 macro may wish to turn on Fraction mode, or set a particular
31101 precision, independent of the user's normal setting for those
31102 modes.
31103
31104 @kindex Z `
31105 @kindex Z '
31106 @pindex calc-kbd-push
31107 @pindex calc-kbd-pop
31108 Macros also sometimes need to use local variables. Assignments to
31109 local variables inside the macro should not affect any variables
31110 outside the macro. The @kbd{Z `} (@code{calc-kbd-push}) and @kbd{Z '}
31111 (@code{calc-kbd-pop}) commands give you both of these capabilities.
31112
31113 When you type @kbd{Z `} (with a backquote or accent grave character),
31114 the values of various mode settings are saved away. The ten ``quick''
31115 variables @code{q0} through @code{q9} are also saved. When
31116 you type @w{@kbd{Z '}} (with an apostrophe), these values are restored.
31117 Pairs of @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} commands may be nested.
31118
31119 If a keyboard macro halts due to an error in between a @kbd{Z `} and
31120 a @kbd{Z '}, the saved values will be restored correctly even though
31121 the macro never reaches the @kbd{Z '} command. Thus you can use
31122 @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} without having to worry about what happens
31123 in exceptional conditions.
31124
31125 If you type @kbd{Z `} ``live'' (not in a keyboard macro), Calc puts
31126 you into a ``recursive edit.'' You can tell you are in a recursive
31127 edit because there will be extra square brackets in the mode line,
31128 as in @samp{[(Calculator)]}. These brackets will go away when you
31129 type the matching @kbd{Z '} command. The modes and quick variables
31130 will be saved and restored in just the same way as if actual keyboard
31131 macros were involved.
31132
31133 The modes saved by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} are the current precision
31134 and binary word size, the angular mode (Deg, Rad, or HMS), the
31135 simplification mode, Algebraic mode, Symbolic mode, Infinite mode,
31136 Matrix or Scalar mode, Fraction mode, and the current complex mode
31137 (Polar or Rectangular). The ten ``quick'' variables' values (or lack
31138 thereof) are also saved.
31139
31140 Most mode-setting commands act as toggles, but with a numeric prefix
31141 they force the mode either on (positive prefix) or off (negative
31142 or zero prefix). Since you don't know what the environment might
31143 be when you invoke your macro, it's best to use prefix arguments
31144 for all mode-setting commands inside the macro.
31145
31146 In fact, @kbd{C-u Z `} is like @kbd{Z `} except that it sets the modes
31147 listed above to their default values. As usual, the matching @kbd{Z '}
31148 will restore the modes to their settings from before the @kbd{C-u Z `}.
31149 Also, @w{@kbd{Z `}} with a negative prefix argument resets the algebraic mode
31150 to its default (off) but leaves the other modes the same as they were
31151 outside the construct.
31152
31153 The contents of the stack and trail, values of non-quick variables, and
31154 other settings such as the language mode and the various display modes,
31155 are @emph{not} affected by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '}.
31156
31157 @node Queries in Macros, , Local Values in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31158 @subsection Queries in Keyboard Macros
31159
31160 @noindent
31161 @kindex Z =
31162 @pindex calc-kbd-report
31163 The @kbd{Z =} (@code{calc-kbd-report}) command displays an informative
31164 message including the value on the top of the stack. You are prompted
31165 to enter a string. That string, along with the top-of-stack value,
31166 is displayed unless @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) has been used
31167 to turn such messages off.
31168
31169 @kindex Z #
31170 @pindex calc-kbd-query
31171 The @kbd{Z #} (@code{calc-kbd-query}) command displays a prompt message
31172 (which you enter during macro definition), then does an algebraic entry
31173 which takes its input from the keyboard, even during macro execution.
31174 This command allows your keyboard macros to accept numbers or formulas
31175 as interactive input. All the normal conventions of algebraic input,
31176 including the use of @kbd{$} characters, are supported.
31177
31178 @xref{Keyboard Macro Query, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for a description of
31179 @kbd{C-x q} (@code{kbd-macro-query}), the standard Emacs way to accept
31180 keyboard input during a keyboard macro. In particular, you can use
31181 @kbd{C-x q} to enter a recursive edit, which allows the user to perform
31182 any Calculator operations interactively before pressing @kbd{C-M-c} to
31183 return control to the keyboard macro.
31184
31185 @node Invocation Macros, Algebraic Definitions, Keyboard Macros, Programming
31186 @section Invocation Macros
31187
31188 @kindex M-# z
31189 @kindex Z I
31190 @pindex calc-user-invocation
31191 @pindex calc-user-define-invocation
31192 Calc provides one special keyboard macro, called up by @kbd{M-# z}
31193 (@code{calc-user-invocation}), that is intended to allow you to define
31194 your own special way of starting Calc. To define this ``invocation
31195 macro,'' create the macro in the usual way with @kbd{C-x (} and
31196 @kbd{C-x )}, then type @kbd{Z I} (@code{calc-user-define-invocation}).
31197 There is only one invocation macro, so you don't need to type any
31198 additional letters after @kbd{Z I}. From now on, you can type
31199 @kbd{M-# z} at any time to execute your invocation macro.
31200
31201 For example, suppose you find yourself often grabbing rectangles of
31202 numbers into Calc and multiplying their columns. You can do this
31203 by typing @kbd{M-# r} to grab, and @kbd{V R : *} to multiply columns.
31204 To make this into an invocation macro, just type @kbd{C-x ( M-# r
31205 V R : * C-x )}, then @kbd{Z I}. Then, to multiply a rectangle of data,
31206 just mark the data in its buffer in the usual way and type @kbd{M-# z}.
31207
31208 Invocation macros are treated like regular Emacs keyboard macros;
31209 all the special features described above for @kbd{Z K}-style macros
31210 do not apply. @kbd{M-# z} is just like @kbd{C-x e}, except that it
31211 uses the macro that was last stored by @kbd{Z I}. (In fact, the
31212 macro does not even have to have anything to do with Calc!)
31213
31214 The @kbd{m m} command saves the last invocation macro defined by
31215 @kbd{Z I} along with all the other Calc mode settings.
31216 @xref{General Mode Commands}.
31217
31218 @node Algebraic Definitions, Lisp Definitions, Invocation Macros, Programming
31219 @section Programming with Formulas
31220
31221 @noindent
31222 @kindex Z F
31223 @pindex calc-user-define-formula
31224 @cindex Programming with algebraic formulas
31225 Another way to create a new Calculator command uses algebraic formulas.
31226 The @kbd{Z F} (@code{calc-user-define-formula}) command stores the
31227 formula at the top of the stack as the definition for a key. This
31228 command prompts for five things: The key, the command name, the function
31229 name, the argument list, and the behavior of the command when given
31230 non-numeric arguments.
31231
31232 For example, suppose we type @kbd{' a+2b @key{RET}} to push the formula
31233 @samp{a + 2*b} onto the stack. We now type @kbd{Z F m} to define this
31234 formula on the @kbd{z m} key sequence. The next prompt is for a command
31235 name, beginning with @samp{calc-}, which should be the long (@kbd{M-x}) form
31236 for the new command. If you simply press @key{RET}, a default name like
31237 @code{calc-User-m} will be constructed. In our example, suppose we enter
31238 @kbd{spam @key{RET}} to define the new command as @code{calc-spam}.
31239
31240 If you want to give the formula a long-style name only, you can press
31241 @key{SPC} or @key{RET} when asked which single key to use. For example
31242 @kbd{Z F @key{RET} spam @key{RET}} defines the new command as
31243 @kbd{M-x calc-spam}, with no keyboard equivalent.
31244
31245 The third prompt is for an algebraic function name. The default is to
31246 use the same name as the command name but without the @samp{calc-}
31247 prefix. (If this is of the form @samp{User-m}, the hyphen is removed so
31248 it won't be taken for a minus sign in algebraic formulas.)
31249 This is the name you will use if you want to enter your
31250 new function in an algebraic formula. Suppose we enter @kbd{yow @key{RET}}.
31251 Then the new function can be invoked by pushing two numbers on the
31252 stack and typing @kbd{z m} or @kbd{x spam}, or by entering the algebraic
31253 formula @samp{yow(x,y)}.
31254
31255 The fourth prompt is for the function's argument list. This is used to
31256 associate values on the stack with the variables that appear in the formula.
31257 The default is a list of all variables which appear in the formula, sorted
31258 into alphabetical order. In our case, the default would be @samp{(a b)}.
31259 This means that, when the user types @kbd{z m}, the Calculator will remove
31260 two numbers from the stack, substitute these numbers for @samp{a} and
31261 @samp{b} (respectively) in the formula, then simplify the formula and
31262 push the result on the stack. In other words, @kbd{10 @key{RET} 100 z m}
31263 would replace the 10 and 100 on the stack with the number 210, which is
31264 @expr{a + 2 b} with @expr{a=10} and @expr{b=100}. Likewise, the formula
31265 @samp{yow(10, 100)} will be evaluated by substituting @expr{a=10} and
31266 @expr{b=100} in the definition.
31267
31268 You can rearrange the order of the names before pressing @key{RET} to
31269 control which stack positions go to which variables in the formula. If
31270 you remove a variable from the argument list, that variable will be left
31271 in symbolic form by the command. Thus using an argument list of @samp{(b)}
31272 for our function would cause @kbd{10 z m} to replace the 10 on the stack
31273 with the formula @samp{a + 20}. If we had used an argument list of
31274 @samp{(b a)}, the result with inputs 10 and 100 would have been 120.
31275
31276 You can also put a nameless function on the stack instead of just a
31277 formula, as in @samp{<a, b : a + 2 b>}. @xref{Specifying Operators}.
31278 In this example, the command will be defined by the formula @samp{a + 2 b}
31279 using the argument list @samp{(a b)}.
31280
31281 The final prompt is a y-or-n question concerning what to do if symbolic
31282 arguments are given to your function. If you answer @kbd{y}, then
31283 executing @kbd{z m} (using the original argument list @samp{(a b)}) with
31284 arguments @expr{10} and @expr{x} will leave the function in symbolic
31285 form, i.e., @samp{yow(10,x)}. On the other hand, if you answer @kbd{n},
31286 then the formula will always be expanded, even for non-constant
31287 arguments: @samp{10 + 2 x}. If you never plan to feed algebraic
31288 formulas to your new function, it doesn't matter how you answer this
31289 question.
31290
31291 If you answered @kbd{y} to this question you can still cause a function
31292 call to be expanded by typing @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}).
31293 Also, Calc will expand the function if necessary when you take a
31294 derivative or integral or solve an equation involving the function.
31295
31296 @kindex Z G
31297 @pindex calc-get-user-defn
31298 Once you have defined a formula on a key, you can retrieve this formula
31299 with the @kbd{Z G} (@code{calc-user-define-get-defn}) command. Press a
31300 key, and this command pushes the formula that was used to define that
31301 key onto the stack. Actually, it pushes a nameless function that
31302 specifies both the argument list and the defining formula. You will get
31303 an error message if the key is undefined, or if the key was not defined
31304 by a @kbd{Z F} command.
31305
31306 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31307 been defined by a formula uses a variant of the @code{calc-edit} command
31308 to edit the defining formula. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and
31309 store the new formula back in the definition, or kill the buffer with
31310 @kbd{C-x k} to
31311 cancel the edit. (The argument list and other properties of the
31312 definition are unchanged; to adjust the argument list, you can use
31313 @kbd{Z G} to grab the function onto the stack, edit with @kbd{`}, and
31314 then re-execute the @kbd{Z F} command.)
31315
31316 As usual, the @kbd{Z P} command records your definition permanently.
31317 In this case it will permanently record all three of the relevant
31318 definitions: the key, the command, and the function.
31319
31320 You may find it useful to turn off the default simplifications with
31321 @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) when entering a formula to be
31322 used as a function definition. For example, the formula @samp{deriv(a^2,v)}
31323 which might be used to define a new function @samp{dsqr(a,v)} will be
31324 ``simplified'' to 0 immediately upon entry since @code{deriv} considers
31325 @expr{a} to be constant with respect to @expr{v}. Turning off
31326 default simplifications cures this problem: The definition will be stored
31327 in symbolic form without ever activating the @code{deriv} function. Press
31328 @kbd{m D} to turn the default simplifications back on afterwards.
31329
31330 @node Lisp Definitions, , Algebraic Definitions, Programming
31331 @section Programming with Lisp
31332
31333 @noindent
31334 The Calculator can be programmed quite extensively in Lisp. All you
31335 do is write a normal Lisp function definition, but with @code{defmath}
31336 in place of @code{defun}. This has the same form as @code{defun}, but it
31337 automagically replaces calls to standard Lisp functions like @code{+} and
31338 @code{zerop} with calls to the corresponding functions in Calc's own library.
31339 Thus you can write natural-looking Lisp code which operates on all of the
31340 standard Calculator data types. You can then use @kbd{Z D} if you wish to
31341 bind your new command to a @kbd{z}-prefix key sequence. The @kbd{Z E} command
31342 will not edit a Lisp-based definition.
31343
31344 Emacs Lisp is described in the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. This section
31345 assumes a familiarity with Lisp programming concepts; if you do not know
31346 Lisp, you may find keyboard macros or rewrite rules to be an easier way
31347 to program the Calculator.
31348
31349 This section first discusses ways to write commands, functions, or
31350 small programs to be executed inside of Calc. Then it discusses how
31351 your own separate programs are able to call Calc from the outside.
31352 Finally, there is a list of internal Calc functions and data structures
31353 for the true Lisp enthusiast.
31354
31355 @menu
31356 * Defining Functions::
31357 * Defining Simple Commands::
31358 * Defining Stack Commands::
31359 * Argument Qualifiers::
31360 * Example Definitions::
31361
31362 * Calling Calc from Your Programs::
31363 * Internals::
31364 @end menu
31365
31366 @node Defining Functions, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions, Lisp Definitions
31367 @subsection Defining New Functions
31368
31369 @noindent
31370 @findex defmath
31371 The @code{defmath} function (actually a Lisp macro) is like @code{defun}
31372 except that code in the body of the definition can make use of the full
31373 range of Calculator data types. The prefix @samp{calcFunc-} is added
31374 to the specified name to get the actual Lisp function name. As a simple
31375 example,
31376
31377 @example
31378 (defmath myfact (n)
31379 (if (> n 0)
31380 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31381 1))
31382 @end example
31383
31384 @noindent
31385 This actually expands to the code,
31386
31387 @example
31388 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
31389 (if (math-posp n)
31390 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
31391 1))
31392 @end example
31393
31394 @noindent
31395 This function can be used in algebraic expressions, e.g., @samp{myfact(5)}.
31396
31397 The @samp{myfact} function as it is defined above has the bug that an
31398 expression @samp{myfact(a+b)} will be simplified to 1 because the
31399 formula @samp{a+b} is not considered to be @code{posp}. A robust
31400 factorial function would be written along the following lines:
31401
31402 @smallexample
31403 (defmath myfact (n)
31404 (if (> n 0)
31405 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31406 (if (= n 0)
31407 1
31408 nil))) ; this could be simplified as: (and (= n 0) 1)
31409 @end smallexample
31410
31411 If a function returns @code{nil}, it is left unsimplified by the Calculator
31412 (except that its arguments will be simplified). Thus, @samp{myfact(a+1+2)}
31413 will be simplified to @samp{myfact(a+3)} but no further. Beware that every
31414 time the Calculator reexamines this formula it will attempt to resimplify
31415 it, so your function ought to detect the returning-@code{nil} case as
31416 efficiently as possible.
31417
31418 The following standard Lisp functions are treated by @code{defmath}:
31419 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^} or
31420 @code{expt}, @code{=}, @code{<}, @code{>}, @code{<=}, @code{>=},
31421 @code{/=}, @code{1+}, @code{1-}, @code{logand}, @code{logior}, @code{logxor},
31422 @code{logandc2}, @code{lognot}. Also, @code{~=} is an abbreviation for
31423 @code{math-nearly-equal}, which is useful in implementing Taylor series.
31424
31425 For other functions @var{func}, if a function by the name
31426 @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if a function by the
31427 name @samp{math-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if @var{func} itself
31428 is defined as a function it is used, otherwise @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} is
31429 used on the assumption that this is a to-be-defined math function. Also, if
31430 the function name is quoted as in @samp{('integerp a)} the function name is
31431 always used exactly as written (but not quoted).
31432
31433 Variable names have @samp{var-} prepended to them unless they appear in
31434 the function's argument list or in an enclosing @code{let}, @code{let*},
31435 @code{for}, or @code{foreach} form,
31436 or their names already contain a @samp{-} character. Thus a reference to
31437 @samp{foo} is the same as a reference to @samp{var-foo}.
31438
31439 A few other Lisp extensions are available in @code{defmath} definitions:
31440
31441 @itemize @bullet
31442 @item
31443 The @code{elt} function accepts any number of index variables.
31444 Note that Calc vectors are stored as Lisp lists whose first
31445 element is the symbol @code{vec}; thus, @samp{(elt v 2)} yields
31446 the second element of vector @code{v}, and @samp{(elt m i j)}
31447 yields one element of a Calc matrix.
31448
31449 @item
31450 The @code{setq} function has been extended to act like the Common
31451 Lisp @code{setf} function. (The name @code{setf} is recognized as
31452 a synonym of @code{setq}.) Specifically, the first argument of
31453 @code{setq} can be an @code{nth}, @code{elt}, @code{car}, or @code{cdr} form,
31454 in which case the effect is to store into the specified
31455 element of a list. Thus, @samp{(setq (elt m i j) x)} stores @expr{x}
31456 into one element of a matrix.
31457
31458 @item
31459 A @code{for} looping construct is available. For example,
31460 @samp{(for ((i 0 10)) body)} executes @code{body} once for each
31461 binding of @expr{i} from zero to 10. This is like a @code{let}
31462 form in that @expr{i} is temporarily bound to the loop count
31463 without disturbing its value outside the @code{for} construct.
31464 Nested loops, as in @samp{(for ((i 0 10) (j 0 (1- i) 2)) body)},
31465 are also available. For each value of @expr{i} from zero to 10,
31466 @expr{j} counts from 0 to @expr{i-1} in steps of two. Note that
31467 @code{for} has the same general outline as @code{let*}, except
31468 that each element of the header is a list of three or four
31469 things, not just two.
31470
31471 @item
31472 The @code{foreach} construct loops over elements of a list.
31473 For example, @samp{(foreach ((x (cdr v))) body)} executes
31474 @code{body} with @expr{x} bound to each element of Calc vector
31475 @expr{v} in turn. The purpose of @code{cdr} here is to skip over
31476 the initial @code{vec} symbol in the vector.
31477
31478 @item
31479 The @code{break} function breaks out of the innermost enclosing
31480 @code{while}, @code{for}, or @code{foreach} loop. If given a
31481 value, as in @samp{(break x)}, this value is returned by the
31482 loop. (Lisp loops otherwise always return @code{nil}.)
31483
31484 @item
31485 The @code{return} function prematurely returns from the enclosing
31486 function. For example, @samp{(return (+ x y))} returns @expr{x+y}
31487 as the value of a function. You can use @code{return} anywhere
31488 inside the body of the function.
31489 @end itemize
31490
31491 Non-integer numbers (and extremely large integers) cannot be included
31492 directly into a @code{defmath} definition. This is because the Lisp
31493 reader will fail to parse them long before @code{defmath} ever gets control.
31494 Instead, use the notation, @samp{:"3.1415"}. In fact, any algebraic
31495 formula can go between the quotes. For example,
31496
31497 @smallexample
31498 (defmath sqexp (x) ; sqexp(x) == sqrt(exp(x)) == exp(x*0.5)
31499 (and (numberp x)
31500 (exp :"x * 0.5")))
31501 @end smallexample
31502
31503 expands to
31504
31505 @smallexample
31506 (defun calcFunc-sqexp (x)
31507 (and (math-numberp x)
31508 (calcFunc-exp (math-mul x '(float 5 -1)))))
31509 @end smallexample
31510
31511 Note the use of @code{numberp} as a guard to ensure that the argument is
31512 a number first, returning @code{nil} if not. The exponential function
31513 could itself have been included in the expression, if we had preferred:
31514 @samp{:"exp(x * 0.5)"}. As another example, the multiplication-and-recursion
31515 step of @code{myfact} could have been written
31516
31517 @example
31518 :"n * myfact(n-1)"
31519 @end example
31520
31521 A good place to put your @code{defmath} commands is your Calc init file
31522 (the file given by @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
31523 @file{~/.calc.el}), which will not be loaded until Calc starts.
31524 If a file named @file{.emacs} exists in your home directory, Emacs reads
31525 and executes the Lisp forms in this file as it starts up. While it may
31526 seem reasonable to put your favorite @code{defmath} commands there,
31527 this has the unfortunate side-effect that parts of the Calculator must be
31528 loaded in to process the @code{defmath} commands whether or not you will
31529 actually use the Calculator! If you want to put the @code{defmath}
31530 commands there (for example, if you redefine @code{calc-settings-file}
31531 to be @file{.emacs}), a better effect can be had by writing
31532
31533 @example
31534 (put 'calc-define 'thing '(progn
31535 (defmath ... )
31536 (defmath ... )
31537 ))
31538 @end example
31539
31540 @noindent
31541 @vindex calc-define
31542 The @code{put} function adds a @dfn{property} to a symbol. Each Lisp
31543 symbol has a list of properties associated with it. Here we add a
31544 property with a name of @code{thing} and a @samp{(progn ...)} form as
31545 its value. When Calc starts up, and at the start of every Calc command,
31546 the property list for the symbol @code{calc-define} is checked and the
31547 values of any properties found are evaluated as Lisp forms. The
31548 properties are removed as they are evaluated. The property names
31549 (like @code{thing}) are not used; you should choose something like the
31550 name of your project so as not to conflict with other properties.
31551
31552 The net effect is that you can put the above code in your @file{.emacs}
31553 file and it will not be executed until Calc is loaded. Or, you can put
31554 that same code in another file which you load by hand either before or
31555 after Calc itself is loaded.
31556
31557 The properties of @code{calc-define} are evaluated in the same order
31558 that they were added. They can assume that the Calc modules @file{calc.el},
31559 @file{calc-ext.el}, and @file{calc-macs.el} have been fully loaded, and
31560 that the @samp{*Calculator*} buffer will be the current buffer.
31561
31562 If your @code{calc-define} property only defines algebraic functions,
31563 you can be sure that it will have been evaluated before Calc tries to
31564 call your function, even if the file defining the property is loaded
31565 after Calc is loaded. But if the property defines commands or key
31566 sequences, it may not be evaluated soon enough. (Suppose it defines the
31567 new command @code{tweak-calc}; the user can load your file, then type
31568 @kbd{M-x tweak-calc} before Calc has had chance to do anything.) To
31569 protect against this situation, you can put
31570
31571 @example
31572 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
31573 @end example
31574
31575 @findex calc-check-defines
31576 @noindent
31577 at the end of your file. The @code{calc-check-defines} function is what
31578 looks for and evaluates properties on @code{calc-define}; @code{run-hooks}
31579 has the advantage that it is quietly ignored if @code{calc-check-defines}
31580 is not yet defined because Calc has not yet been loaded.
31581
31582 Examples of things that ought to be enclosed in a @code{calc-define}
31583 property are @code{defmath} calls, @code{define-key} calls that modify
31584 the Calc key map, and any calls that redefine things defined inside Calc.
31585 Ordinary @code{defun}s need not be enclosed with @code{calc-define}.
31586
31587 @node Defining Simple Commands, Defining Stack Commands, Defining Functions, Lisp Definitions
31588 @subsection Defining New Simple Commands
31589
31590 @noindent
31591 @findex interactive
31592 If a @code{defmath} form contains an @code{interactive} clause, it defines
31593 a Calculator command. Actually such a @code{defmath} results in @emph{two}
31594 function definitions: One, a @samp{calcFunc-} function as was just described,
31595 with the @code{interactive} clause removed. Two, a @samp{calc-} function
31596 with a suitable @code{interactive} clause and some sort of wrapper to make
31597 the command work in the Calc environment.
31598
31599 In the simple case, the @code{interactive} clause has the same form as
31600 for normal Emacs Lisp commands:
31601
31602 @smallexample
31603 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
31604 "Increase precision by DELTA." ; This is the "documentation string"
31605 (interactive "p") ; Register this as a M-x-able command
31606 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
31607 @end smallexample
31608
31609 This expands to the pair of definitions,
31610
31611 @smallexample
31612 (defun calc-increase-precision (delta)
31613 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31614 (interactive "p")
31615 (calc-wrapper
31616 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta))))
31617
31618 (defun calcFunc-increase-precision (delta)
31619 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31620 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta)))
31621 @end smallexample
31622
31623 @noindent
31624 where in this case the latter function would never really be used! Note
31625 that since the Calculator stores small integers as plain Lisp integers,
31626 the @code{math-add} function will work just as well as the native
31627 @code{+} even when the intent is to operate on native Lisp integers.
31628
31629 @findex calc-wrapper
31630 The @samp{calc-wrapper} call invokes a macro which surrounds the body of
31631 the function with code that looks roughly like this:
31632
31633 @smallexample
31634 (let ((calc-command-flags nil))
31635 (unwind-protect
31636 (save-excursion
31637 (calc-select-buffer)
31638 @emph{body of function}
31639 @emph{renumber stack}
31640 @emph{clear} Working @emph{message})
31641 @emph{realign cursor and window}
31642 @emph{clear Inverse, Hyperbolic, and Keep Args flags}
31643 @emph{update Emacs mode line}))
31644 @end smallexample
31645
31646 @findex calc-select-buffer
31647 The @code{calc-select-buffer} function selects the @samp{*Calculator*}
31648 buffer if necessary, say, because the command was invoked from inside
31649 the @samp{*Calc Trail*} window.
31650
31651 @findex calc-set-command-flag
31652 You can call, for example, @code{(calc-set-command-flag 'no-align)} to
31653 set the above-mentioned command flags. Calc routines recognize the
31654 following command flags:
31655
31656 @table @code
31657 @item renum-stack
31658 Stack line numbers @samp{1:}, @samp{2:}, and so on must be renumbered
31659 after this command completes. This is set by routines like
31660 @code{calc-push}.
31661
31662 @item clear-message
31663 Calc should call @samp{(message "")} if this command completes normally
31664 (to clear a ``Working@dots{}'' message out of the echo area).
31665
31666 @item no-align
31667 Do not move the cursor back to the @samp{.} top-of-stack marker.
31668
31669 @item position-point
31670 Use the variables @code{calc-position-point-line} and
31671 @code{calc-position-point-column} to position the cursor after
31672 this command finishes.
31673
31674 @item keep-flags
31675 Do not clear @code{calc-inverse-flag}, @code{calc-hyperbolic-flag},
31676 and @code{calc-keep-args-flag} at the end of this command.
31677
31678 @item do-edit
31679 Switch to buffer @samp{*Calc Edit*} after this command.
31680
31681 @item hold-trail
31682 Do not move trail pointer to end of trail when something is recorded
31683 there.
31684 @end table
31685
31686 @kindex Y
31687 @kindex Y ?
31688 @vindex calc-Y-help-msgs
31689 Calc reserves a special prefix key, shift-@kbd{Y}, for user-written
31690 extensions to Calc. There are no built-in commands that work with
31691 this prefix key; you must call @code{define-key} from Lisp (probably
31692 from inside a @code{calc-define} property) to add to it. Initially only
31693 @kbd{Y ?} is defined; it takes help messages from a list of strings
31694 (initially @code{nil}) in the variable @code{calc-Y-help-msgs}. All
31695 other undefined keys except for @kbd{Y} are reserved for use by
31696 future versions of Calc.
31697
31698 If you are writing a Calc enhancement which you expect to give to
31699 others, it is best to minimize the number of @kbd{Y}-key sequences
31700 you use. In fact, if you have more than one key sequence you should
31701 consider defining three-key sequences with a @kbd{Y}, then a key that
31702 stands for your package, then a third key for the particular command
31703 within your package.
31704
31705 Users may wish to install several Calc enhancements, and it is possible
31706 that several enhancements will choose to use the same key. In the
31707 example below, a variable @code{inc-prec-base-key} has been defined
31708 to contain the key that identifies the @code{inc-prec} package. Its
31709 value is initially @code{"P"}, but a user can change this variable
31710 if necessary without having to modify the file.
31711
31712 Here is a complete file, @file{inc-prec.el}, which makes a @kbd{Y P I}
31713 command that increases the precision, and a @kbd{Y P D} command that
31714 decreases the precision.
31715
31716 @smallexample
31717 ;;; Increase and decrease Calc precision. Dave Gillespie, 5/31/91.
31718 ;;; (Include copyright or copyleft stuff here.)
31719
31720 (defvar inc-prec-base-key "P"
31721 "Base key for inc-prec.el commands.")
31722
31723 (put 'calc-define 'inc-prec '(progn
31724
31725 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sI" inc-prec-base-key)
31726 'increase-precision)
31727 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sD" inc-prec-base-key)
31728 'decrease-precision)
31729
31730 (setq calc-Y-help-msgs
31731 (cons (format "%s + Inc-prec, Dec-prec" inc-prec-base-key)
31732 calc-Y-help-msgs))
31733
31734 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
31735 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31736 (interactive "p")
31737 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
31738
31739 (defmath decrease-precision (delta)
31740 "Decrease precision by DELTA."
31741 (interactive "p")
31742 (setq calc-internal-prec (- calc-internal-prec delta)))
31743
31744 )) ; end of calc-define property
31745
31746 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
31747 @end smallexample
31748
31749 @node Defining Stack Commands, Argument Qualifiers, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions
31750 @subsection Defining New Stack-Based Commands
31751
31752 @noindent
31753 To define a new computational command which takes and/or leaves arguments
31754 on the stack, a special form of @code{interactive} clause is used.
31755
31756 @example
31757 (interactive @var{num} @var{tag})
31758 @end example
31759
31760 @noindent
31761 where @var{num} is an integer, and @var{tag} is a string. The effect is
31762 to pop @var{num} values off the stack, resimplify them by calling
31763 @code{calc-normalize}, and hand them to your function according to the
31764 function's argument list. Your function may include @code{&optional} and
31765 @code{&rest} parameters, so long as calling the function with @var{num}
31766 parameters is legal.
31767
31768 Your function must return either a number or a formula in a form
31769 acceptable to Calc, or a list of such numbers or formulas. These value(s)
31770 are pushed onto the stack when the function completes. They are also
31771 recorded in the Calc Trail buffer on a line beginning with @var{tag},
31772 a string of (normally) four characters or less. If you omit @var{tag}
31773 or use @code{nil} as a tag, the result is not recorded in the trail.
31774
31775 As an example, the definition
31776
31777 @smallexample
31778 (defmath myfact (n)
31779 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31780 (interactive 1 "fact")
31781 (if (> n 0)
31782 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31783 (and (= n 0) 1)))
31784 @end smallexample
31785
31786 @noindent
31787 is a version of the factorial function shown previously which can be used
31788 as a command as well as an algebraic function. It expands to
31789
31790 @smallexample
31791 (defun calc-myfact ()
31792 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31793 (interactive)
31794 (calc-slow-wrapper
31795 (calc-enter-result 1 "fact"
31796 (cons 'calcFunc-myfact (calc-top-list-n 1)))))
31797
31798 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
31799 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31800 (if (math-posp n)
31801 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
31802 (and (math-zerop n) 1)))
31803 @end smallexample
31804
31805 @findex calc-slow-wrapper
31806 The @code{calc-slow-wrapper} function is a version of @code{calc-wrapper}
31807 that automatically puts up a @samp{Working...} message before the
31808 computation begins. (This message can be turned off by the user
31809 with an @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) command.)
31810
31811 @findex calc-top-list-n
31812 The @code{calc-top-list-n} function returns a list of the specified number
31813 of values from the top of the stack. It resimplifies each value by
31814 calling @code{calc-normalize}. If its argument is zero it returns an
31815 empty list. It does not actually remove these values from the stack.
31816
31817 @findex calc-enter-result
31818 The @code{calc-enter-result} function takes an integer @var{num} and string
31819 @var{tag} as described above, plus a third argument which is either a
31820 Calculator data object or a list of such objects. These objects are
31821 resimplified and pushed onto the stack after popping the specified number
31822 of values from the stack. If @var{tag} is non-@code{nil}, the values
31823 being pushed are also recorded in the trail.
31824
31825 Note that if @code{calcFunc-myfact} returns @code{nil} this represents
31826 ``leave the function in symbolic form.'' To return an actual empty list,
31827 in the sense that @code{calc-enter-result} will push zero elements back
31828 onto the stack, you should return the special value @samp{'(nil)}, a list
31829 containing the single symbol @code{nil}.
31830
31831 The @code{interactive} declaration can actually contain a limited
31832 Emacs-style code string as well which comes just before @var{num} and
31833 @var{tag}. Currently the only Emacs code supported is @samp{"p"}, as in
31834
31835 @example
31836 (defmath foo (a b &optional c)
31837 (interactive "p" 2 "foo")
31838 @var{body})
31839 @end example
31840
31841 In this example, the command @code{calc-foo} will evaluate the expression
31842 @samp{foo(a,b)} if executed with no argument, or @samp{foo(a,b,n)} if
31843 executed with a numeric prefix argument of @expr{n}.
31844
31845 The other code string allowed is @samp{"m"} (unrelated to the usual @samp{"m"}
31846 code as used with @code{defun}). It uses the numeric prefix argument as the
31847 number of objects to remove from the stack and pass to the function.
31848 In this case, the integer @var{num} serves as a default number of
31849 arguments to be used when no prefix is supplied.
31850
31851 @node Argument Qualifiers, Example Definitions, Defining Stack Commands, Lisp Definitions
31852 @subsection Argument Qualifiers
31853
31854 @noindent
31855 Anywhere a parameter name can appear in the parameter list you can also use
31856 an @dfn{argument qualifier}. Thus the general form of a definition is:
31857
31858 @example
31859 (defmath @var{name} (@var{param} @var{param...}
31860 &optional @var{param} @var{param...}
31861 &rest @var{param})
31862 @var{body})
31863 @end example
31864
31865 @noindent
31866 where each @var{param} is either a symbol or a list of the form
31867
31868 @example
31869 (@var{qual} @var{param})
31870 @end example
31871
31872 The following qualifiers are recognized:
31873
31874 @table @samp
31875 @item complete
31876 @findex complete
31877 The argument must not be an incomplete vector, interval, or complex number.
31878 (This is rarely needed since the Calculator itself will never call your
31879 function with an incomplete argument. But there is nothing stopping your
31880 own Lisp code from calling your function with an incomplete argument.)
31881
31882 @item integer
31883 @findex integer
31884 The argument must be an integer. If it is an integer-valued float
31885 it will be accepted but converted to integer form. Non-integers and
31886 formulas are rejected.
31887
31888 @item natnum
31889 @findex natnum
31890 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must be non-negative.
31891
31892 @item fixnum
31893 @findex fixnum
31894 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must fit into a native Lisp integer,
31895 which on most systems means less than 2^23 in absolute value. The
31896 argument is converted into Lisp-integer form if necessary.
31897
31898 @item float
31899 @findex float
31900 The argument is converted to floating-point format if it is a number or
31901 vector. If it is a formula it is left alone. (The argument is never
31902 actually rejected by this qualifier.)
31903
31904 @item @var{pred}
31905 The argument must satisfy predicate @var{pred}, which is one of the
31906 standard Calculator predicates. @xref{Predicates}.
31907
31908 @item not-@var{pred}
31909 The argument must @emph{not} satisfy predicate @var{pred}.
31910 @end table
31911
31912 For example,
31913
31914 @example
31915 (defmath foo (a (constp (not-matrixp b)) &optional (float c)
31916 &rest (integer d))
31917 @var{body})
31918 @end example
31919
31920 @noindent
31921 expands to
31922
31923 @example
31924 (defun calcFunc-foo (a b &optional c &rest d)
31925 (and (math-matrixp b)
31926 (math-reject-arg b 'not-matrixp))
31927 (or (math-constp b)
31928 (math-reject-arg b 'constp))
31929 (and c (setq c (math-check-float c)))
31930 (setq d (mapcar 'math-check-integer d))
31931 @var{body})
31932 @end example
31933
31934 @noindent
31935 which performs the necessary checks and conversions before executing the
31936 body of the function.
31937
31938 @node Example Definitions, Calling Calc from Your Programs, Argument Qualifiers, Lisp Definitions
31939 @subsection Example Definitions
31940
31941 @noindent
31942 This section includes some Lisp programming examples on a larger scale.
31943 These programs make use of some of the Calculator's internal functions;
31944 @pxref{Internals}.
31945
31946 @menu
31947 * Bit Counting Example::
31948 * Sine Example::
31949 @end menu
31950
31951 @node Bit Counting Example, Sine Example, Example Definitions, Example Definitions
31952 @subsubsection Bit-Counting
31953
31954 @noindent
31955 @ignore
31956 @starindex
31957 @end ignore
31958 @tindex bcount
31959 Calc does not include a built-in function for counting the number of
31960 ``one'' bits in a binary integer. It's easy to invent one using @kbd{b u}
31961 to convert the integer to a set, and @kbd{V #} to count the elements of
31962 that set; let's write a function that counts the bits without having to
31963 create an intermediate set.
31964
31965 @smallexample
31966 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
31967 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
31968 (let ((count 0))
31969 (while (> n 0)
31970 (if (oddp n)
31971 (setq count (1+ count)))
31972 (setq n (lsh n -1)))
31973 count))
31974 @end smallexample
31975
31976 @noindent
31977 When this is expanded by @code{defmath}, it will become the following
31978 Emacs Lisp function:
31979
31980 @smallexample
31981 (defun calcFunc-bcount (n)
31982 (setq n (math-check-natnum n))
31983 (let ((count 0))
31984 (while (math-posp n)
31985 (if (math-oddp n)
31986 (setq count (math-add count 1)))
31987 (setq n (calcFunc-lsh n -1)))
31988 count))
31989 @end smallexample
31990
31991 If the input numbers are large, this function involves a fair amount
31992 of arithmetic. A binary right shift is essentially a division by two;
31993 recall that Calc stores integers in decimal form so bit shifts must
31994 involve actual division.
31995
31996 To gain a bit more efficiency, we could divide the integer into
31997 @var{n}-bit chunks, each of which can be handled quickly because
31998 they fit into Lisp integers. It turns out that Calc's arithmetic
31999 routines are especially fast when dividing by an integer less than
32000 1000, so we can set @var{n = 9} bits and use repeated division by 512:
32001
32002 @smallexample
32003 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32004 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32005 (let ((count 0))
32006 (while (not (fixnump n))
32007 (let ((qr (idivmod n 512)))
32008 (setq count (+ count (bcount-fixnum (cdr qr)))
32009 n (car qr))))
32010 (+ count (bcount-fixnum n))))
32011
32012 (defun bcount-fixnum (n)
32013 (let ((count 0))
32014 (while (> n 0)
32015 (setq count (+ count (logand n 1))
32016 n (lsh n -1)))
32017 count))
32018 @end smallexample
32019
32020 @noindent
32021 Note that the second function uses @code{defun}, not @code{defmath}.
32022 Because this function deals only with native Lisp integers (``fixnums''),
32023 it can use the actual Emacs @code{+} and related functions rather
32024 than the slower but more general Calc equivalents which @code{defmath}
32025 uses.
32026
32027 The @code{idivmod} function does an integer division, returning both
32028 the quotient and the remainder at once. Again, note that while it
32029 might seem that @samp{(logand n 511)} and @samp{(lsh n -9)} are
32030 more efficient ways to split off the bottom nine bits of @code{n},
32031 actually they are less efficient because each operation is really
32032 a division by 512 in disguise; @code{idivmod} allows us to do the
32033 same thing with a single division by 512.
32034
32035 @node Sine Example, , Bit Counting Example, Example Definitions
32036 @subsubsection The Sine Function
32037
32038 @noindent
32039 @ignore
32040 @starindex
32041 @end ignore
32042 @tindex mysin
32043 A somewhat limited sine function could be defined as follows, using the
32044 well-known Taylor series expansion for
32045 @texline @math{\sin x}:
32046 @infoline @samp{sin(x)}:
32047
32048 @smallexample
32049 (defmath mysin ((float (anglep x)))
32050 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32051 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32052 (let ((sum x) ; Initial term of Taylor expansion of sin.
32053 newsum
32054 (nfact 1) ; "nfact" equals "n" factorial at all times.
32055 (xnegsqr :"-(x^2)")) ; "xnegsqr" equals -x^2.
32056 (for ((n 3 100 2)) ; Upper limit of 100 is a good precaution.
32057 (working "mysin" sum) ; Display "Working" message, if enabled.
32058 (setq nfact (* nfact (1- n) n)
32059 x (* x xnegsqr)
32060 newsum (+ sum (/ x nfact)))
32061 (if (~= newsum sum) ; If newsum is "nearly equal to" sum,
32062 (break)) ; then we are done.
32063 (setq sum newsum))
32064 sum))
32065 @end smallexample
32066
32067 The actual @code{sin} function in Calc works by first reducing the problem
32068 to a sine or cosine of a nonnegative number less than @cpiover{4}. This
32069 ensures that the Taylor series will converge quickly. Also, the calculation
32070 is carried out with two extra digits of precision to guard against cumulative
32071 round-off in @samp{sum}. Finally, complex arguments are allowed and handled
32072 by a separate algorithm.
32073
32074 @smallexample
32075 (defmath mysin ((float (scalarp x)))
32076 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32077 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32078 (with-extra-prec 2 ; Evaluate with extra precision.
32079 (cond ((complexp x)
32080 (mysin-complex x))
32081 ((< x 0)
32082 (- (mysin-raw (- x))) ; Always call mysin-raw with x >= 0.
32083 (t (mysin-raw x))))))
32084
32085 (defmath mysin-raw (x)
32086 (cond ((>= x 7)
32087 (mysin-raw (% x (two-pi)))) ; Now x < 7.
32088 ((> x (pi-over-2))
32089 (- (mysin-raw (- x (pi))))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/2.
32090 ((> x (pi-over-4))
32091 (mycos-raw (- x (pi-over-2)))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/4.
32092 ((< x (- (pi-over-4)))
32093 (- (mycos-raw (+ x (pi-over-2))))) ; Now -pi/4 <= x <= pi/4,
32094 (t (mysin-series x)))) ; so the series will be efficient.
32095 @end smallexample
32096
32097 @noindent
32098 where @code{mysin-complex} is an appropriate function to handle complex
32099 numbers, @code{mysin-series} is the routine to compute the sine Taylor
32100 series as before, and @code{mycos-raw} is a function analogous to
32101 @code{mysin-raw} for cosines.
32102
32103 The strategy is to ensure that @expr{x} is nonnegative before calling
32104 @code{mysin-raw}. This function then recursively reduces its argument
32105 to a suitable range, namely, plus-or-minus @cpiover{4}. Note that each
32106 test, and particularly the first comparison against 7, is designed so
32107 that small roundoff errors cannot produce an infinite loop. (Suppose
32108 we compared with @samp{(two-pi)} instead; if due to roundoff problems
32109 the modulo operator ever returned @samp{(two-pi)} exactly, an infinite
32110 recursion could result!) We use modulo only for arguments that will
32111 clearly get reduced, knowing that the next rule will catch any reductions
32112 that this rule misses.
32113
32114 If a program is being written for general use, it is important to code
32115 it carefully as shown in this second example. For quick-and-dirty programs,
32116 when you know that your own use of the sine function will never encounter
32117 a large argument, a simpler program like the first one shown is fine.
32118
32119 @node Calling Calc from Your Programs, Internals, Example Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32120 @subsection Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs
32121
32122 @noindent
32123 A later section (@pxref{Internals}) gives a full description of
32124 Calc's internal Lisp functions. It's not hard to call Calc from
32125 inside your programs, but the number of these functions can be daunting.
32126 So Calc provides one special ``programmer-friendly'' function called
32127 @code{calc-eval} that can be made to do just about everything you
32128 need. It's not as fast as the low-level Calc functions, but it's
32129 much simpler to use!
32130
32131 It may seem that @code{calc-eval} itself has a daunting number of
32132 options, but they all stem from one simple operation.
32133
32134 In its simplest manifestation, @samp{(calc-eval "1+2")} parses the
32135 string @code{"1+2"} as if it were a Calc algebraic entry and returns
32136 the result formatted as a string: @code{"3"}.
32137
32138 Since @code{calc-eval} is on the list of recommended @code{autoload}
32139 functions, you don't need to make any special preparations to load
32140 Calc before calling @code{calc-eval} the first time. Calc will be
32141 loaded and initialized for you.
32142
32143 All the Calc modes that are currently in effect will be used when
32144 evaluating the expression and formatting the result.
32145
32146 @ifinfo
32147 @example
32148
32149 @end example
32150 @end ifinfo
32151 @subsubsection Additional Arguments to @code{calc-eval}
32152
32153 @noindent
32154 If the input string parses to a list of expressions, Calc returns
32155 the results separated by @code{", "}. You can specify a different
32156 separator by giving a second string argument to @code{calc-eval}:
32157 @samp{(calc-eval "1+2,3+4" ";")} returns @code{"3;7"}.
32158
32159 The ``separator'' can also be any of several Lisp symbols which
32160 request other behaviors from @code{calc-eval}. These are discussed
32161 one by one below.
32162
32163 You can give additional arguments to be substituted for
32164 @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, and so on in the main expression. For
32165 example, @samp{(calc-eval "$/$$" nil "7" "1+1")} evaluates the
32166 expression @code{"7/(1+1)"} to yield the result @code{"3.5"}
32167 (assuming Fraction mode is not in effect). Note the @code{nil}
32168 used as a placeholder for the item-separator argument.
32169
32170 @ifinfo
32171 @example
32172
32173 @end example
32174 @end ifinfo
32175 @subsubsection Error Handling
32176
32177 @noindent
32178 If @code{calc-eval} encounters an error, it returns a list containing
32179 the character position of the error, plus a suitable message as a
32180 string. Note that @samp{1 / 0} is @emph{not} an error by Calc's
32181 standards; it simply returns the string @code{"1 / 0"} which is the
32182 division left in symbolic form. But @samp{(calc-eval "1/")} will
32183 return the list @samp{(2 "Expected a number")}.
32184
32185 If you bind the variable @code{calc-eval-error} to @code{t}
32186 using a @code{let} form surrounding the call to @code{calc-eval},
32187 errors instead call the Emacs @code{error} function which aborts
32188 to the Emacs command loop with a beep and an error message.
32189
32190 If you bind this variable to the symbol @code{string}, error messages
32191 are returned as strings instead of lists. The character position is
32192 ignored.
32193
32194 As a courtesy to other Lisp code which may be using Calc, be sure
32195 to bind @code{calc-eval-error} using @code{let} rather than changing
32196 it permanently with @code{setq}.
32197
32198 @ifinfo
32199 @example
32200
32201 @end example
32202 @end ifinfo
32203 @subsubsection Numbers Only
32204
32205 @noindent
32206 Sometimes it is preferable to treat @samp{1 / 0} as an error
32207 rather than returning a symbolic result. If you pass the symbol
32208 @code{num} as the second argument to @code{calc-eval}, results
32209 that are not constants are treated as errors. The error message
32210 reported is the first @code{calc-why} message if there is one,
32211 or otherwise ``Number expected.''
32212
32213 A result is ``constant'' if it is a number, vector, or other
32214 object that does not include variables or function calls. If it
32215 is a vector, the components must themselves be constants.
32216
32217 @ifinfo
32218 @example
32219
32220 @end example
32221 @end ifinfo
32222 @subsubsection Default Modes
32223
32224 @noindent
32225 If the first argument to @code{calc-eval} is a list whose first
32226 element is a formula string, then @code{calc-eval} sets all the
32227 various Calc modes to their default values while the formula is
32228 evaluated and formatted. For example, the precision is set to 12
32229 digits, digit grouping is turned off, and the Normal language
32230 mode is used.
32231
32232 This same principle applies to the other options discussed below.
32233 If the first argument would normally be @var{x}, then it can also
32234 be the list @samp{(@var{x})} to use the default mode settings.
32235
32236 If there are other elements in the list, they are taken as
32237 variable-name/value pairs which override the default mode
32238 settings. Look at the documentation at the front of the
32239 @file{calc.el} file to find the names of the Lisp variables for
32240 the various modes. The mode settings are restored to their
32241 original values when @code{calc-eval} is done.
32242
32243 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '("$+$$" calc-internal-prec 8) 'num a b)}
32244 computes the sum of two numbers, requiring a numeric result, and
32245 using default mode settings except that the precision is 8 instead
32246 of the default of 12.
32247
32248 It's usually best to use this form of @code{calc-eval} unless your
32249 program actually considers the interaction with Calc's mode settings
32250 to be a feature. This will avoid all sorts of potential ``gotchas'';
32251 consider what happens with @samp{(calc-eval "sqrt(2)" 'num)}
32252 when the user has left Calc in Symbolic mode or No-Simplify mode.
32253
32254 As another example, @samp{(equal (calc-eval '("$<$$") nil a b) "1")}
32255 checks if the number in string @expr{a} is less than the one in
32256 string @expr{b}. Without using a list, the integer 1 might
32257 come out in a variety of formats which would be hard to test for
32258 conveniently: @code{"1"}, @code{"8#1"}, @code{"00001"}. (But
32259 see ``Predicates'' mode, below.)
32260
32261 @ifinfo
32262 @example
32263
32264 @end example
32265 @end ifinfo
32266 @subsubsection Raw Numbers
32267
32268 @noindent
32269 Normally all input and output for @code{calc-eval} is done with strings.
32270 You can do arithmetic with, say, @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" nil a b)}
32271 in place of @samp{(+ a b)}, but this is very inefficient since the
32272 numbers must be converted to and from string format as they are passed
32273 from one @code{calc-eval} to the next.
32274
32275 If the separator is the symbol @code{raw}, the result will be returned
32276 as a raw Calc data structure rather than a string. You can read about
32277 how these objects look in the following sections, but usually you can
32278 treat them as ``black box'' objects with no important internal
32279 structure.
32280
32281 There is also a @code{rawnum} symbol, which is a combination of
32282 @code{raw} (returning a raw Calc object) and @code{num} (signaling
32283 an error if that object is not a constant).
32284
32285 You can pass a raw Calc object to @code{calc-eval} in place of a
32286 string, either as the formula itself or as one of the @samp{$}
32287 arguments. Thus @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" 'raw a b)} is an
32288 addition function that operates on raw Calc objects. Of course
32289 in this case it would be easier to call the low-level @code{math-add}
32290 function in Calc, if you can remember its name.
32291
32292 In particular, note that a plain Lisp integer is acceptable to Calc
32293 as a raw object. (All Lisp integers are accepted on input, but
32294 integers of more than six decimal digits are converted to ``big-integer''
32295 form for output. @xref{Data Type Formats}.)
32296
32297 When it comes time to display the object, just use @samp{(calc-eval a)}
32298 to format it as a string.
32299
32300 It is an error if the input expression evaluates to a list of
32301 values. The separator symbol @code{list} is like @code{raw}
32302 except that it returns a list of one or more raw Calc objects.
32303
32304 Note that a Lisp string is not a valid Calc object, nor is a list
32305 containing a string. Thus you can still safely distinguish all the
32306 various kinds of error returns discussed above.
32307
32308 @ifinfo
32309 @example
32310
32311 @end example
32312 @end ifinfo
32313 @subsubsection Predicates
32314
32315 @noindent
32316 If the separator symbol is @code{pred}, the result of the formula is
32317 treated as a true/false value; @code{calc-eval} returns @code{t} or
32318 @code{nil}, respectively. A value is considered ``true'' if it is a
32319 non-zero number, or false if it is zero or if it is not a number.
32320
32321 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "$<$$" 'pred a b)} tests whether
32322 one value is less than another.
32323
32324 As usual, it is also possible for @code{calc-eval} to return one of
32325 the error indicators described above. Lisp will interpret such an
32326 indicator as ``true'' if you don't check for it explicitly. If you
32327 wish to have an error register as ``false'', use something like
32328 @samp{(eq (calc-eval ...) t)}.
32329
32330 @ifinfo
32331 @example
32332
32333 @end example
32334 @end ifinfo
32335 @subsubsection Variable Values
32336
32337 @noindent
32338 Variables in the formula passed to @code{calc-eval} are not normally
32339 replaced by their values. If you wish this, you can use the
32340 @code{evalv} function (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}). For example,
32341 if 4 is stored in Calc variable @code{a} (i.e., in Lisp variable
32342 @code{var-a}), then @samp{(calc-eval "a+pi")} will return the
32343 formula @code{"a + pi"}, but @samp{(calc-eval "evalv(a+pi)")}
32344 will return @code{"7.14159265359"}.
32345
32346 To store in a Calc variable, just use @code{setq} to store in the
32347 corresponding Lisp variable. (This is obtained by prepending
32348 @samp{var-} to the Calc variable name.) Calc routines will
32349 understand either string or raw form values stored in variables,
32350 although raw data objects are much more efficient. For example,
32351 to increment the Calc variable @code{a}:
32352
32353 @example
32354 (setq var-a (calc-eval "evalv(a+1)" 'raw))
32355 @end example
32356
32357 @ifinfo
32358 @example
32359
32360 @end example
32361 @end ifinfo
32362 @subsubsection Stack Access
32363
32364 @noindent
32365 If the separator symbol is @code{push}, the formula argument is
32366 evaluated (with possible @samp{$} expansions, as usual). The
32367 result is pushed onto the Calc stack. The return value is @code{nil}
32368 (unless there is an error from evaluating the formula, in which
32369 case the return value depends on @code{calc-eval-error} in the
32370 usual way).
32371
32372 If the separator symbol is @code{pop}, the first argument to
32373 @code{calc-eval} must be an integer instead of a string. That
32374 many values are popped from the stack and thrown away. A negative
32375 argument deletes the entry at that stack level. The return value
32376 is the number of elements remaining in the stack after popping;
32377 @samp{(calc-eval 0 'pop)} is a good way to measure the size of
32378 the stack.
32379
32380 If the separator symbol is @code{top}, the first argument to
32381 @code{calc-eval} must again be an integer. The value at that
32382 stack level is formatted as a string and returned. Thus
32383 @samp{(calc-eval 1 'top)} returns the top-of-stack value. If the
32384 integer is out of range, @code{nil} is returned.
32385
32386 The separator symbol @code{rawtop} is just like @code{top} except
32387 that the stack entry is returned as a raw Calc object instead of
32388 as a string.
32389
32390 In all of these cases the first argument can be made a list in
32391 order to force the default mode settings, as described above.
32392 Thus @samp{(calc-eval '(2 calc-number-radix 16) 'top)} returns the
32393 second-to-top stack entry, formatted as a string using the default
32394 instead of current display modes, except that the radix is
32395 hexadecimal instead of decimal.
32396
32397 It is, of course, polite to put the Calc stack back the way you
32398 found it when you are done, unless the user of your program is
32399 actually expecting it to affect the stack.
32400
32401 Note that you do not actually have to switch into the @samp{*Calculator*}
32402 buffer in order to use @code{calc-eval}; it temporarily switches into
32403 the stack buffer if necessary.
32404
32405 @ifinfo
32406 @example
32407
32408 @end example
32409 @end ifinfo
32410 @subsubsection Keyboard Macros
32411
32412 @noindent
32413 If the separator symbol is @code{macro}, the first argument must be a
32414 string of characters which Calc can execute as a sequence of keystrokes.
32415 This switches into the Calc buffer for the duration of the macro.
32416 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "vx5\rVR+" 'macro)} pushes the
32417 vector @samp{[1,2,3,4,5]} on the stack and then replaces it
32418 with the sum of those numbers. Note that @samp{\r} is the Lisp
32419 notation for the carriage-return, @key{RET}, character.
32420
32421 If your keyboard macro wishes to pop the stack, @samp{\C-d} is
32422 safer than @samp{\177} (the @key{DEL} character) because some
32423 installations may have switched the meanings of @key{DEL} and
32424 @kbd{C-h}. Calc always interprets @kbd{C-d} as a synonym for
32425 ``pop-stack'' regardless of key mapping.
32426
32427 If you provide a third argument to @code{calc-eval}, evaluation
32428 of the keyboard macro will leave a record in the Trail using
32429 that argument as a tag string. Normally the Trail is unaffected.
32430
32431 The return value in this case is always @code{nil}.
32432
32433 @ifinfo
32434 @example
32435
32436 @end example
32437 @end ifinfo
32438 @subsubsection Lisp Evaluation
32439
32440 @noindent
32441 Finally, if the separator symbol is @code{eval}, then the Lisp
32442 @code{eval} function is called on the first argument, which must
32443 be a Lisp expression rather than a Calc formula. Remember to
32444 quote the expression so that it is not evaluated until inside
32445 @code{calc-eval}.
32446
32447 The difference from plain @code{eval} is that @code{calc-eval}
32448 switches to the Calc buffer before evaluating the expression.
32449 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '(setq calc-internal-prec 17) 'eval)}
32450 will correctly affect the buffer-local Calc precision variable.
32451
32452 An alternative would be @samp{(calc-eval '(calc-precision 17) 'eval)}.
32453 This is evaluating a call to the function that is normally invoked
32454 by the @kbd{p} key, giving it 17 as its ``numeric prefix argument.''
32455 Note that this function will leave a message in the echo area as
32456 a side effect. Also, all Calc functions switch to the Calc buffer
32457 automatically if not invoked from there, so the above call is
32458 also equivalent to @samp{(calc-precision 17)} by itself.
32459 In all cases, Calc uses @code{save-excursion} to switch back to
32460 your original buffer when it is done.
32461
32462 As usual the first argument can be a list that begins with a Lisp
32463 expression to use default instead of current mode settings.
32464
32465 The result of @code{calc-eval} in this usage is just the result
32466 returned by the evaluated Lisp expression.
32467
32468 @ifinfo
32469 @example
32470
32471 @end example
32472 @end ifinfo
32473 @subsubsection Example
32474
32475 @noindent
32476 @findex convert-temp
32477 Here is a sample Emacs command that uses @code{calc-eval}. Suppose
32478 you have a document with lots of references to temperatures on the
32479 Fahrenheit scale, say ``98.6 F'', and you wish to convert these
32480 references to Centigrade. The following command does this conversion.
32481 Place the Emacs cursor right after the letter ``F'' and invoke the
32482 command to change ``98.6 F'' to ``37 C''. Or, if the temperature is
32483 already in Centigrade form, the command changes it back to Fahrenheit.
32484
32485 @example
32486 (defun convert-temp ()
32487 (interactive)
32488 (save-excursion
32489 (re-search-backward "[^-.0-9]\\([-.0-9]+\\) *\\([FC]\\)")
32490 (let* ((top1 (match-beginning 1))
32491 (bot1 (match-end 1))
32492 (number (buffer-substring top1 bot1))
32493 (top2 (match-beginning 2))
32494 (bot2 (match-end 2))
32495 (type (buffer-substring top2 bot2)))
32496 (if (equal type "F")
32497 (setq type "C"
32498 number (calc-eval "($ - 32)*5/9" nil number))
32499 (setq type "F"
32500 number (calc-eval "$*9/5 + 32" nil number)))
32501 (goto-char top2)
32502 (delete-region top2 bot2)
32503 (insert-before-markers type)
32504 (goto-char top1)
32505 (delete-region top1 bot1)
32506 (if (string-match "\\.$" number) ; change "37." to "37"
32507 (setq number (substring number 0 -1)))
32508 (insert number))))
32509 @end example
32510
32511 Note the use of @code{insert-before-markers} when changing between
32512 ``F'' and ``C'', so that the character winds up before the cursor
32513 instead of after it.
32514
32515 @node Internals, , Calling Calc from Your Programs, Lisp Definitions
32516 @subsection Calculator Internals
32517
32518 @noindent
32519 This section describes the Lisp functions defined by the Calculator that
32520 may be of use to user-written Calculator programs (as described in the
32521 rest of this chapter). These functions are shown by their names as they
32522 conventionally appear in @code{defmath}. Their full Lisp names are
32523 generally gotten by prepending @samp{calcFunc-} or @samp{math-} to their
32524 apparent names. (Names that begin with @samp{calc-} are already in
32525 their full Lisp form.) You can use the actual full names instead if you
32526 prefer them, or if you are calling these functions from regular Lisp.
32527
32528 The functions described here are scattered throughout the various
32529 Calc component files. Note that @file{calc.el} includes @code{autoload}s
32530 for only a few component files; when Calc wants to call an advanced
32531 function it calls @samp{(calc-extensions)} first; this function
32532 autoloads @file{calc-ext.el}, which in turn autoloads all the functions
32533 in the remaining component files.
32534
32535 Because @code{defmath} itself uses the extensions, user-written code
32536 generally always executes with the extensions already loaded, so
32537 normally you can use any Calc function and be confident that it will
32538 be autoloaded for you when necessary. If you are doing something
32539 special, check carefully to make sure each function you are using is
32540 from @file{calc.el} or its components, and call @samp{(calc-extensions)}
32541 before using any function based in @file{calc-ext.el} if you can't
32542 prove this file will already be loaded.
32543
32544 @menu
32545 * Data Type Formats::
32546 * Interactive Lisp Functions::
32547 * Stack Lisp Functions::
32548 * Predicates::
32549 * Computational Lisp Functions::
32550 * Vector Lisp Functions::
32551 * Symbolic Lisp Functions::
32552 * Formatting Lisp Functions::
32553 * Hooks::
32554 @end menu
32555
32556 @node Data Type Formats, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals, Internals
32557 @subsubsection Data Type Formats
32558
32559 @noindent
32560 Integers are stored in either of two ways, depending on their magnitude.
32561 Integers less than one million in absolute value are stored as standard
32562 Lisp integers. This is the only storage format for Calc data objects
32563 which is not a Lisp list.
32564
32565 Large integers are stored as lists of the form @samp{(bigpos @var{d0}
32566 @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for positive integers 1000000 or more, or
32567 @samp{(bigneg @var{d0} @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for negative integers
32568 @mathit{-1000000} or less. Each @var{d} is a base-1000 ``digit,'' a Lisp integer
32569 from 0 to 999. The least significant digit is @var{d0}; the last digit,
32570 @var{dn}, which is always nonzero, is the most significant digit. For
32571 example, the integer @mathit{-12345678} is stored as @samp{(bigneg 678 345 12)}.
32572
32573 The distinction between small and large integers is entirely hidden from
32574 the user. In @code{defmath} definitions, the Lisp predicate @code{integerp}
32575 returns true for either kind of integer, and in general both big and small
32576 integers are accepted anywhere the word ``integer'' is used in this manual.
32577 If the distinction must be made, native Lisp integers are called @dfn{fixnums}
32578 and large integers are called @dfn{bignums}.
32579
32580 Fractions are stored as a list of the form, @samp{(frac @var{n} @var{d})}
32581 where @var{n} is an integer (big or small) numerator, @var{d} is an
32582 integer denominator greater than one, and @var{n} and @var{d} are relatively
32583 prime. Note that fractions where @var{d} is one are automatically converted
32584 to plain integers by all math routines; fractions where @var{d} is negative
32585 are normalized by negating the numerator and denominator.
32586
32587 Floating-point numbers are stored in the form, @samp{(float @var{mant}
32588 @var{exp})}, where @var{mant} (the ``mantissa'') is an integer less than
32589 @samp{10^@var{p}} in absolute value (@var{p} represents the current
32590 precision), and @var{exp} (the ``exponent'') is a fixnum. The value of
32591 the float is @samp{@var{mant} * 10^@var{exp}}. For example, the number
32592 @mathit{-3.14} is stored as @samp{(float -314 -2) = -314*10^-2}. Other constraints
32593 are that the number 0.0 is always stored as @samp{(float 0 0)}, and,
32594 except for the 0.0 case, the rightmost base-10 digit of @var{mant} is
32595 always nonzero. (If the rightmost digit is zero, the number is
32596 rearranged by dividing @var{mant} by ten and incrementing @var{exp}.)
32597
32598 Rectangular complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(cplx @var{re}
32599 @var{im})}, where @var{re} and @var{im} are each real numbers, either
32600 integers, fractions, or floats. The value is @samp{@var{re} + @var{im}i}.
32601 The @var{im} part is nonzero; complex numbers with zero imaginary
32602 components are converted to real numbers automatically.
32603
32604 Polar complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(polar @var{r}
32605 @var{theta})}, where @var{r} is a positive real value and @var{theta}
32606 is a real value or HMS form representing an angle. This angle is
32607 usually normalized to lie in the interval @samp{(-180 ..@: 180)} degrees,
32608 or @samp{(-pi ..@: pi)} radians, according to the current angular mode.
32609 If the angle is 0 the value is converted to a real number automatically.
32610 (If the angle is 180 degrees, the value is usually also converted to a
32611 negative real number.)
32612
32613 Hours-minutes-seconds forms are stored as @samp{(hms @var{h} @var{m}
32614 @var{s})}, where @var{h} is an integer or an integer-valued float (i.e.,
32615 a float with @samp{@var{exp} >= 0}), @var{m} is an integer or integer-valued
32616 float in the range @w{@samp{[0 ..@: 60)}}, and @var{s} is any real number
32617 in the range @samp{[0 ..@: 60)}.
32618
32619 Date forms are stored as @samp{(date @var{n})}, where @var{n} is
32620 a real number that counts days since midnight on the morning of
32621 January 1, 1 AD. If @var{n} is an integer, this is a pure date
32622 form. If @var{n} is a fraction or float, this is a date/time form.
32623
32624 Modulo forms are stored as @samp{(mod @var{n} @var{m})}, where @var{m} is a
32625 positive real number or HMS form, and @var{n} is a real number or HMS
32626 form in the range @samp{[0 ..@: @var{m})}.
32627
32628 Error forms are stored as @samp{(sdev @var{x} @var{sigma})}, where @var{x}
32629 is the mean value and @var{sigma} is the standard deviation. Each
32630 component is either a number, an HMS form, or a symbolic object
32631 (a variable or function call). If @var{sigma} is zero, the value is
32632 converted to a plain real number. If @var{sigma} is negative or
32633 complex, it is automatically normalized to be a positive real.
32634
32635 Interval forms are stored as @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{lo} @var{hi})},
32636 where @var{mask} is one of the integers 0, 1, 2, or 3, and @var{lo} and
32637 @var{hi} are real numbers, HMS forms, or symbolic objects. The @var{mask}
32638 is a binary integer where 1 represents the fact that the interval is
32639 closed on the high end, and 2 represents the fact that it is closed on
32640 the low end. (Thus 3 represents a fully closed interval.) The interval
32641 @w{@samp{(intv 3 @var{x} @var{x})}} is converted to the plain number @var{x};
32642 intervals @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{x} @var{x})} for any other @var{mask}
32643 represent empty intervals. If @var{hi} is less than @var{lo}, the interval
32644 is converted to a standard empty interval by replacing @var{hi} with @var{lo}.
32645
32646 Vectors are stored as @samp{(vec @var{v1} @var{v2} @dots{})}, where @var{v1}
32647 is the first element of the vector, @var{v2} is the second, and so on.
32648 An empty vector is stored as @samp{(vec)}. A matrix is simply a vector
32649 where all @var{v}'s are themselves vectors of equal lengths. Note that
32650 Calc vectors are unrelated to the Emacs Lisp ``vector'' type, which is
32651 generally unused by Calc data structures.
32652
32653 Variables are stored as @samp{(var @var{name} @var{sym})}, where
32654 @var{name} is a Lisp symbol whose print name is used as the visible name
32655 of the variable, and @var{sym} is a Lisp symbol in which the variable's
32656 value is actually stored. Thus, @samp{(var pi var-pi)} represents the
32657 special constant @samp{pi}. Almost always, the form is @samp{(var
32658 @var{v} var-@var{v})}. If the variable name was entered with @code{#}
32659 signs (which are converted to hyphens internally), the form is
32660 @samp{(var @var{u} @var{v})}, where @var{u} is a symbol whose name
32661 contains @code{#} characters, and @var{v} is a symbol that contains
32662 @code{-} characters instead. The value of a variable is the Calc
32663 object stored in its @var{sym} symbol's value cell. If the symbol's
32664 value cell is void or if it contains @code{nil}, the variable has no
32665 value. Special constants have the form @samp{(special-const
32666 @var{value})} stored in their value cell, where @var{value} is a formula
32667 which is evaluated when the constant's value is requested. Variables
32668 which represent units are not stored in any special way; they are units
32669 only because their names appear in the units table. If the value
32670 cell contains a string, it is parsed to get the variable's value when
32671 the variable is used.
32672
32673 A Lisp list with any other symbol as the first element is a function call.
32674 The symbols @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^},
32675 and @code{|} represent special binary operators; these lists are always
32676 of the form @samp{(@var{op} @var{lhs} @var{rhs})} where @var{lhs} is the
32677 sub-formula on the lefthand side and @var{rhs} is the sub-formula on the
32678 right. The symbol @code{neg} represents unary negation; this list is always
32679 of the form @samp{(neg @var{arg})}. Any other symbol @var{func} represents a
32680 function that would be displayed in function-call notation; the symbol
32681 @var{func} is in general always of the form @samp{calcFunc-@var{name}}.
32682 The function cell of the symbol @var{func} should contain a Lisp function
32683 for evaluating a call to @var{func}. This function is passed the remaining
32684 elements of the list (themselves already evaluated) as arguments; such
32685 functions should return @code{nil} or call @code{reject-arg} to signify
32686 that they should be left in symbolic form, or they should return a Calc
32687 object which represents their value, or a list of such objects if they
32688 wish to return multiple values. (The latter case is allowed only for
32689 functions which are the outer-level call in an expression whose value is
32690 about to be pushed on the stack; this feature is considered obsolete
32691 and is not used by any built-in Calc functions.)
32692
32693 @node Interactive Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Data Type Formats, Internals
32694 @subsubsection Interactive Functions
32695
32696 @noindent
32697 The functions described here are used in implementing interactive Calc
32698 commands. Note that this list is not exhaustive! If there is an
32699 existing command that behaves similarly to the one you want to define,
32700 you may find helpful tricks by checking the source code for that command.
32701
32702 @defun calc-set-command-flag flag
32703 Set the command flag @var{flag}. This is generally a Lisp symbol, but
32704 may in fact be anything. The effect is to add @var{flag} to the list
32705 stored in the variable @code{calc-command-flags}, unless it is already
32706 there. @xref{Defining Simple Commands}.
32707 @end defun
32708
32709 @defun calc-clear-command-flag flag
32710 If @var{flag} appears among the list of currently-set command flags,
32711 remove it from that list.
32712 @end defun
32713
32714 @defun calc-record-undo rec
32715 Add the ``undo record'' @var{rec} to the list of steps to take if the
32716 current operation should need to be undone. Stack push and pop functions
32717 automatically call @code{calc-record-undo}, so the kinds of undo records
32718 you might need to create take the form @samp{(set @var{sym} @var{value})},
32719 which says that the Lisp variable @var{sym} was changed and had previously
32720 contained @var{value}; @samp{(store @var{var} @var{value})} which says that
32721 the Calc variable @var{var} (a string which is the name of the symbol that
32722 contains the variable's value) was stored and its previous value was
32723 @var{value} (either a Calc data object, or @code{nil} if the variable was
32724 previously void); or @samp{(eval @var{undo} @var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})},
32725 which means that to undo requires calling the function @samp{(@var{undo}
32726 @var{args} @dots{})} and, if the undo is later redone, calling
32727 @samp{(@var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})}.
32728 @end defun
32729
32730 @defun calc-record-why msg args
32731 Record the error or warning message @var{msg}, which is normally a string.
32732 This message will be replayed if the user types @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why});
32733 if the message string begins with a @samp{*}, it is considered important
32734 enough to display even if the user doesn't type @kbd{w}. If one or more
32735 @var{args} are present, the displayed message will be of the form,
32736 @samp{@var{msg}: @var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}}, where the arguments are
32737 formatted on the assumption that they are either strings or Calc objects of
32738 some sort. If @var{msg} is a symbol, it is the name of a Calc predicate
32739 (such as @code{integerp} or @code{numvecp}) which the arguments did not
32740 satisfy; it is expanded to a suitable string such as ``Expected an
32741 integer.'' The @code{reject-arg} function calls @code{calc-record-why}
32742 automatically; @pxref{Predicates}.
32743 @end defun
32744
32745 @defun calc-is-inverse
32746 This predicate returns true if the current command is inverse,
32747 i.e., if the Inverse (@kbd{I} key) flag was set.
32748 @end defun
32749
32750 @defun calc-is-hyperbolic
32751 This predicate is the analogous function for the @kbd{H} key.
32752 @end defun
32753
32754 @node Stack Lisp Functions, Predicates, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals
32755 @subsubsection Stack-Oriented Functions
32756
32757 @noindent
32758 The functions described here perform various operations on the Calc
32759 stack and trail. They are to be used in interactive Calc commands.
32760
32761 @defun calc-push-list vals n
32762 Push the Calc objects in list @var{vals} onto the stack at stack level
32763 @var{n}. If @var{n} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements
32764 are pushed at the top of the stack. If @var{n} is greater than 1, the
32765 elements will be inserted into the stack so that the last element will
32766 end up at level @var{n}, the next-to-last at level @var{n}+1, etc.
32767 The elements of @var{vals} are assumed to be valid Calc objects, and
32768 are not evaluated, rounded, or renormalized in any way. If @var{vals}
32769 is an empty list, nothing happens.
32770
32771 The stack elements are pushed without any sub-formula selections.
32772 You can give an optional third argument to this function, which must
32773 be a list the same size as @var{vals} of selections. Each selection
32774 must be @code{eq} to some sub-formula of the corresponding formula
32775 in @var{vals}, or @code{nil} if that formula should have no selection.
32776 @end defun
32777
32778 @defun calc-top-list n m
32779 Return a list of the @var{n} objects starting at level @var{m} of the
32780 stack. If @var{m} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements are
32781 taken from the top of the stack. If @var{n} is omitted, it also
32782 defaults to 1, so that the top stack element (in the form of a
32783 one-element list) is returned. If @var{m} is greater than 1, the
32784 @var{m}th stack element will be at the end of the list, the @var{m}+1st
32785 element will be next-to-last, etc. If @var{n} or @var{m} are out of
32786 range, the command is aborted with a suitable error message. If @var{n}
32787 is zero, the function returns an empty list. The stack elements are not
32788 evaluated, rounded, or renormalized.
32789
32790 If any stack elements contain selections, and selections have not
32791 been disabled by the @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command,
32792 this function returns the selected portions rather than the entire
32793 stack elements. It can be given a third ``selection-mode'' argument
32794 which selects other behaviors. If it is the symbol @code{t}, then
32795 a selection in any of the requested stack elements produces an
32796 ``illegal operation on selections'' error. If it is the symbol @code{full},
32797 the whole stack entry is always returned regardless of selections.
32798 If it is the symbol @code{sel}, the selected portion is always returned,
32799 or @code{nil} if there is no selection. (This mode ignores the @kbd{j e}
32800 command.) If the symbol is @code{entry}, the complete stack entry in
32801 list form is returned; the first element of this list will be the whole
32802 formula, and the third element will be the selection (or @code{nil}).
32803 @end defun
32804
32805 @defun calc-pop-stack n m
32806 Remove the specified elements from the stack. The parameters @var{n}
32807 and @var{m} are defined the same as for @code{calc-top-list}. The return
32808 value of @code{calc-pop-stack} is uninteresting.
32809
32810 If there are any selected sub-formulas among the popped elements, and
32811 @kbd{j e} has not been used to disable selections, this produces an
32812 error without changing the stack. If you supply an optional third
32813 argument of @code{t}, the stack elements are popped even if they
32814 contain selections.
32815 @end defun
32816
32817 @defun calc-record-list vals tag
32818 This function records one or more results in the trail. The @var{vals}
32819 are a list of strings or Calc objects. The @var{tag} is the four-character
32820 tag string to identify the values. If @var{tag} is omitted, a blank tag
32821 will be used.
32822 @end defun
32823
32824 @defun calc-normalize n
32825 This function takes a Calc object and ``normalizes'' it. At the very
32826 least this involves re-rounding floating-point values according to the
32827 current precision and other similar jobs. Also, unless the user has
32828 selected No-Simplify mode (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), this involves
32829 actually evaluating a formula object by executing the function calls
32830 it contains, and possibly also doing algebraic simplification, etc.
32831 @end defun
32832
32833 @defun calc-top-list-n n m
32834 This function is identical to @code{calc-top-list}, except that it calls
32835 @code{calc-normalize} on the values that it takes from the stack. They
32836 are also passed through @code{check-complete}, so that incomplete
32837 objects will be rejected with an error message. All computational
32838 commands should use this in preference to @code{calc-top-list}; the only
32839 standard Calc commands that operate on the stack without normalizing
32840 are stack management commands like @code{calc-enter} and @code{calc-roll-up}.
32841 This function accepts the same optional selection-mode argument as
32842 @code{calc-top-list}.
32843 @end defun
32844
32845 @defun calc-top-n m
32846 This function is a convenient form of @code{calc-top-list-n} in which only
32847 a single element of the stack is taken and returned, rather than a list
32848 of elements. This also accepts an optional selection-mode argument.
32849 @end defun
32850
32851 @defun calc-enter-result n tag vals
32852 This function is a convenient interface to most of the above functions.
32853 The @var{vals} argument should be either a single Calc object, or a list
32854 of Calc objects; the object or objects are normalized, and the top @var{n}
32855 stack entries are replaced by the normalized objects. If @var{tag} is
32856 non-@code{nil}, the normalized objects are also recorded in the trail.
32857 A typical stack-based computational command would take the form,
32858
32859 @smallexample
32860 (calc-enter-result @var{n} @var{tag} (cons 'calcFunc-@var{func}
32861 (calc-top-list-n @var{n})))
32862 @end smallexample
32863
32864 If any of the @var{n} stack elements replaced contain sub-formula
32865 selections, and selections have not been disabled by @kbd{j e},
32866 this function takes one of two courses of action. If @var{n} is
32867 equal to the number of elements in @var{vals}, then each element of
32868 @var{vals} is spliced into the corresponding selection; this is what
32869 happens when you use the @key{TAB} key, or when you use a unary
32870 arithmetic operation like @code{sqrt}. If @var{vals} has only one
32871 element but @var{n} is greater than one, there must be only one
32872 selection among the top @var{n} stack elements; the element from
32873 @var{vals} is spliced into that selection. This is what happens when
32874 you use a binary arithmetic operation like @kbd{+}. Any other
32875 combination of @var{n} and @var{vals} is an error when selections
32876 are present.
32877 @end defun
32878
32879 @defun calc-unary-op tag func arg
32880 This function implements a unary operator that allows a numeric prefix
32881 argument to apply the operator over many stack entries. If the prefix
32882 argument @var{arg} is @code{nil}, this uses @code{calc-enter-result}
32883 as outlined above. Otherwise, it maps the function over several stack
32884 elements; @pxref{Prefix Arguments}. For example,
32885
32886 @smallexample
32887 (defun calc-zeta (arg)
32888 (interactive "P")
32889 (calc-unary-op "zeta" 'calcFunc-zeta arg))
32890 @end smallexample
32891 @end defun
32892
32893 @defun calc-binary-op tag func arg ident unary
32894 This function implements a binary operator, analogously to
32895 @code{calc-unary-op}. The optional @var{ident} and @var{unary}
32896 arguments specify the behavior when the prefix argument is zero or
32897 one, respectively. If the prefix is zero, the value @var{ident}
32898 is pushed onto the stack, if specified, otherwise an error message
32899 is displayed. If the prefix is one, the unary function @var{unary}
32900 is applied to the top stack element, or, if @var{unary} is not
32901 specified, nothing happens. When the argument is two or more,
32902 the binary function @var{func} is reduced across the top @var{arg}
32903 stack elements; when the argument is negative, the function is
32904 mapped between the next-to-top @mathit{-@var{arg}} stack elements and the
32905 top element.
32906 @end defun
32907
32908 @defun calc-stack-size
32909 Return the number of elements on the stack as an integer. This count
32910 does not include elements that have been temporarily hidden by stack
32911 truncation; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
32912 @end defun
32913
32914 @defun calc-cursor-stack-index n
32915 Move the point to the @var{n}th stack entry. If @var{n} is zero, this
32916 will be the @samp{.} line. If @var{n} is from 1 to the current stack size,
32917 this will be the beginning of the first line of that stack entry's display.
32918 If line numbers are enabled, this will move to the first character of the
32919 line number, not the stack entry itself.
32920 @end defun
32921
32922 @defun calc-substack-height n
32923 Return the number of lines between the beginning of the @var{n}th stack
32924 entry and the bottom of the buffer. If @var{n} is zero, this
32925 will be one (assuming no stack truncation). If all stack entries are
32926 one line long (i.e., no matrices are displayed), the return value will
32927 be equal @var{n}+1 as long as @var{n} is in range. (Note that in Big
32928 mode, the return value includes the blank lines that separate stack
32929 entries.)
32930 @end defun
32931
32932 @defun calc-refresh
32933 Erase the @code{*Calculator*} buffer and reformat its contents from memory.
32934 This must be called after changing any parameter, such as the current
32935 display radix, which might change the appearance of existing stack
32936 entries. (During a keyboard macro invoked by the @kbd{X} key, refreshing
32937 is suppressed, but a flag is set so that the entire stack will be refreshed
32938 rather than just the top few elements when the macro finishes.)
32939 @end defun
32940
32941 @node Predicates, Computational Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Internals
32942 @subsubsection Predicates
32943
32944 @noindent
32945 The functions described here are predicates, that is, they return a
32946 true/false value where @code{nil} means false and anything else means
32947 true. These predicates are expanded by @code{defmath}, for example,
32948 from @code{zerop} to @code{math-zerop}. In many cases they correspond
32949 to native Lisp functions by the same name, but are extended to cover
32950 the full range of Calc data types.
32951
32952 @defun zerop x
32953 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically zero, in any of the Calc data
32954 types. (Note that for some types, such as error forms and intervals,
32955 it never makes sense to return true.) In @code{defmath}, the expression
32956 @samp{(= x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-zerop x)},
32957 and @samp{(/= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-zerop x))}.
32958 @end defun
32959
32960 @defun negp x
32961 Returns true if @var{x} is negative. This accepts negative real numbers
32962 of various types, negative HMS and date forms, and intervals in which
32963 all included values are negative. In @code{defmath}, the expression
32964 @samp{(< x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-negp x)},
32965 and @samp{(>= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-negp x))}.
32966 @end defun
32967
32968 @defun posp x
32969 Returns true if @var{x} is positive (and non-zero). For complex
32970 numbers, none of these three predicates will return true.
32971 @end defun
32972
32973 @defun looks-negp x
32974 Returns true if @var{x} is ``negative-looking.'' This returns true if
32975 @var{x} is a negative number, or a formula with a leading minus sign
32976 such as @samp{-a/b}. In other words, this is an object which can be
32977 made simpler by calling @code{(- @var{x})}.
32978 @end defun
32979
32980 @defun integerp x
32981 Returns true if @var{x} is an integer of any size.
32982 @end defun
32983
32984 @defun fixnump x
32985 Returns true if @var{x} is a native Lisp integer.
32986 @end defun
32987
32988 @defun natnump x
32989 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative integer of any size.
32990 @end defun
32991
32992 @defun fixnatnump x
32993 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative Lisp integer.
32994 @end defun
32995
32996 @defun num-integerp x
32997 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically an integer, i.e., either a
32998 true integer or a float with no significant digits to the right of
32999 the decimal point.
33000 @end defun
33001
33002 @defun messy-integerp x
33003 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically, but not literally, an integer.
33004 A value is @code{num-integerp} if it is @code{integerp} or
33005 @code{messy-integerp} (but it is never both at once).
33006 @end defun
33007
33008 @defun num-natnump x
33009 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically a nonnegative integer.
33010 @end defun
33011
33012 @defun evenp x
33013 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer.
33014 @end defun
33015
33016 @defun looks-evenp x
33017 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer, or a formula with a leading
33018 multiplicative coefficient which is an even integer.
33019 @end defun
33020
33021 @defun oddp x
33022 Returns true if @var{x} is an odd integer.
33023 @end defun
33024
33025 @defun ratp x
33026 Returns true if @var{x} is a rational number, i.e., an integer or a
33027 fraction.
33028 @end defun
33029
33030 @defun realp x
33031 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number, i.e., an integer, fraction,
33032 or floating-point number.
33033 @end defun
33034
33035 @defun anglep x
33036 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or HMS form.
33037 @end defun
33038
33039 @defun floatp x
33040 Returns true if @var{x} is a float, or a complex number, error form,
33041 interval, date form, or modulo form in which at least one component
33042 is a float.
33043 @end defun
33044
33045 @defun complexp x
33046 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular or polar complex number
33047 (but not a real number).
33048 @end defun
33049
33050 @defun rect-complexp x
33051 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular complex number.
33052 @end defun
33053
33054 @defun polar-complexp x
33055 Returns true if @var{x} is a polar complex number.
33056 @end defun
33057
33058 @defun numberp x
33059 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or a complex number.
33060 @end defun
33061
33062 @defun scalarp x
33063 Returns true if @var{x} is a real or complex number or an HMS form.
33064 @end defun
33065
33066 @defun vectorp x
33067 Returns true if @var{x} is a vector (this simply checks if its argument
33068 is a list whose first element is the symbol @code{vec}).
33069 @end defun
33070
33071 @defun numvecp x
33072 Returns true if @var{x} is a number or vector.
33073 @end defun
33074
33075 @defun matrixp x
33076 Returns true if @var{x} is a matrix, i.e., a vector of one or more vectors,
33077 all of the same size.
33078 @end defun
33079
33080 @defun square-matrixp x
33081 Returns true if @var{x} is a square matrix.
33082 @end defun
33083
33084 @defun objectp x
33085 Returns true if @var{x} is any numeric Calc object, including real and
33086 complex numbers, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33087 modulo forms. (Note that error forms and intervals may include formulas
33088 as their components; see @code{constp} below.)
33089 @end defun
33090
33091 @defun objvecp x
33092 Returns true if @var{x} is an object or a vector. This also accepts
33093 incomplete objects, but it rejects variables and formulas (except as
33094 mentioned above for @code{objectp}).
33095 @end defun
33096
33097 @defun primp x
33098 Returns true if @var{x} is a ``primitive'' or ``atomic'' Calc object,
33099 i.e., one whose components cannot be regarded as sub-formulas. This
33100 includes variables, and all @code{objectp} types except error forms
33101 and intervals.
33102 @end defun
33103
33104 @defun constp x
33105 Returns true if @var{x} is constant, i.e., a real or complex number,
33106 HMS form, date form, or error form, interval, or vector all of whose
33107 components are @code{constp}.
33108 @end defun
33109
33110 @defun lessp x y
33111 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically less than @var{y}. Returns false
33112 if @var{x} is greater than or equal to @var{y}, or if the order is
33113 undefined or cannot be determined. Generally speaking, this works
33114 by checking whether @samp{@var{x} - @var{y}} is @code{negp}. In
33115 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(< x y)} will automatically be
33116 converted to @samp{(lessp x y)}; expressions involving @code{>}, @code{<=},
33117 and @code{>=} are similarly converted in terms of @code{lessp}.
33118 @end defun
33119
33120 @defun beforep x y
33121 Returns true if @var{x} comes before @var{y} in a canonical ordering
33122 of Calc objects. If @var{x} and @var{y} are both real numbers, this
33123 will be the same as @code{lessp}. But whereas @code{lessp} considers
33124 other types of objects to be unordered, @code{beforep} puts any two
33125 objects into a definite, consistent order. The @code{beforep}
33126 function is used by the @kbd{V S} vector-sorting command, and also
33127 by @kbd{a s} to put the terms of a product into canonical order:
33128 This allows @samp{x y + y x} to be simplified easily to @samp{2 x y}.
33129 @end defun
33130
33131 @defun equal x y
33132 This is the standard Lisp @code{equal} predicate; it returns true if
33133 @var{x} and @var{y} are structurally identical. This is the usual way
33134 to compare numbers for equality, but note that @code{equal} will treat
33135 0 and 0.0 as different.
33136 @end defun
33137
33138 @defun math-equal x y
33139 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y} are numerically equal, either because
33140 they are @code{equal}, or because their difference is @code{zerop}. In
33141 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(= x y)} will automatically be
33142 converted to @samp{(math-equal x y)}.
33143 @end defun
33144
33145 @defun equal-int x n
33146 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{n} are numerically equal, where @var{n}
33147 is a fixnum which is not a multiple of 10. This will automatically be
33148 used by @code{defmath} in place of the more general @code{math-equal}
33149 whenever possible.
33150 @end defun
33151
33152 @defun nearly-equal x y
33153 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y}, as floating-point numbers, are
33154 equal except possibly in the last decimal place. For example,
33155 314.159 and 314.166 are considered nearly equal if the current
33156 precision is 6 (since they differ by 7 units), but not if the current
33157 precision is 7 (since they differ by 70 units). Most functions which
33158 use series expansions use @code{with-extra-prec} to evaluate the
33159 series with 2 extra digits of precision, then use @code{nearly-equal}
33160 to decide when the series has converged; this guards against cumulative
33161 error in the series evaluation without doing extra work which would be
33162 lost when the result is rounded back down to the current precision.
33163 In @code{defmath}, this can be written @samp{(~= @var{x} @var{y})}.
33164 The @var{x} and @var{y} can be numbers of any kind, including complex.
33165 @end defun
33166
33167 @defun nearly-zerop x y
33168 Returns true if @var{x} is nearly zero, compared to @var{y}. This
33169 checks whether @var{x} plus @var{y} would by be @code{nearly-equal}
33170 to @var{y} itself, to within the current precision, in other words,
33171 if adding @var{x} to @var{y} would have a negligible effect on @var{y}
33172 due to roundoff error. @var{X} may be a real or complex number, but
33173 @var{y} must be real.
33174 @end defun
33175
33176 @defun is-true x
33177 Return true if the formula @var{x} represents a true value in
33178 Calc, not Lisp, terms. It tests if @var{x} is a non-zero number
33179 or a provably non-zero formula.
33180 @end defun
33181
33182 @defun reject-arg val pred
33183 Abort the current function evaluation due to unacceptable argument values.
33184 This calls @samp{(calc-record-why @var{pred} @var{val})}, then signals a
33185 Lisp error which @code{normalize} will trap. The net effect is that the
33186 function call which led here will be left in symbolic form.
33187 @end defun
33188
33189 @defun inexact-value
33190 If Symbolic mode is enabled, this will signal an error that causes
33191 @code{normalize} to leave the formula in symbolic form, with the message
33192 ``Inexact result.'' (This function has no effect when not in Symbolic mode.)
33193 Note that if your function calls @samp{(sin 5)} in Symbolic mode, the
33194 @code{sin} function will call @code{inexact-value}, which will cause your
33195 function to be left unsimplified. You may instead wish to call
33196 @samp{(normalize (list 'calcFunc-sin 5))}, which in Symbolic mode will
33197 return the formula @samp{sin(5)} to your function.
33198 @end defun
33199
33200 @defun overflow
33201 This signals an error that will be reported as a floating-point overflow.
33202 @end defun
33203
33204 @defun underflow
33205 This signals a floating-point underflow.
33206 @end defun
33207
33208 @node Computational Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Predicates, Internals
33209 @subsubsection Computational Functions
33210
33211 @noindent
33212 The functions described here do the actual computational work of the
33213 Calculator. In addition to these, note that any function described in
33214 the main body of this manual may be called from Lisp; for example, if
33215 the documentation refers to the @code{calc-sqrt} [@code{sqrt}] command,
33216 this means @code{calc-sqrt} is an interactive stack-based square-root
33217 command and @code{sqrt} (which @code{defmath} expands to @code{calcFunc-sqrt})
33218 is the actual Lisp function for taking square roots.
33219
33220 The functions @code{math-add}, @code{math-sub}, @code{math-mul},
33221 @code{math-div}, @code{math-mod}, and @code{math-neg} are not included
33222 in this list, since @code{defmath} allows you to write native Lisp
33223 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, and unary @code{-},
33224 respectively, instead.
33225
33226 @defun normalize val
33227 (Full form: @code{math-normalize}.)
33228 Reduce the value @var{val} to standard form. For example, if @var{val}
33229 is a fixnum, it will be converted to a bignum if it is too large, and
33230 if @var{val} is a bignum it will be normalized by clipping off trailing
33231 (i.e., most-significant) zero digits and converting to a fixnum if it is
33232 small. All the various data types are similarly converted to their standard
33233 forms. Variables are left alone, but function calls are actually evaluated
33234 in formulas. For example, normalizing @samp{(+ 2 (calcFunc-abs -4))} will
33235 return 6.
33236
33237 If a function call fails, because the function is void or has the wrong
33238 number of parameters, or because it returns @code{nil} or calls
33239 @code{reject-arg} or @code{inexact-result}, @code{normalize} returns
33240 the formula still in symbolic form.
33241
33242 If the current simplification mode is ``none'' or ``numeric arguments
33243 only,'' @code{normalize} will act appropriately. However, the more
33244 powerful simplification modes (like Algebraic Simplification) are
33245 not handled by @code{normalize}. They are handled by @code{calc-normalize},
33246 which calls @code{normalize} and possibly some other routines, such
33247 as @code{simplify} or @code{simplify-units}. Programs generally will
33248 never call @code{calc-normalize} except when popping or pushing values
33249 on the stack.
33250 @end defun
33251
33252 @defun evaluate-expr expr
33253 Replace all variables in @var{expr} that have values with their values,
33254 then use @code{normalize} to simplify the result. This is what happens
33255 when you press the @kbd{=} key interactively.
33256 @end defun
33257
33258 @defmac with-extra-prec n body
33259 Evaluate the Lisp forms in @var{body} with precision increased by @var{n}
33260 digits. This is a macro which expands to
33261
33262 @smallexample
33263 (math-normalize
33264 (let ((calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec @var{n})))
33265 @var{body}))
33266 @end smallexample
33267
33268 The surrounding call to @code{math-normalize} causes a floating-point
33269 result to be rounded down to the original precision afterwards. This
33270 is important because some arithmetic operations assume a number's
33271 mantissa contains no more digits than the current precision allows.
33272 @end defmac
33273
33274 @defun make-frac n d
33275 Build a fraction @samp{@var{n}:@var{d}}. This is equivalent to calling
33276 @samp{(normalize (list 'frac @var{n} @var{d}))}, but more efficient.
33277 @end defun
33278
33279 @defun make-float mant exp
33280 Build a floating-point value out of @var{mant} and @var{exp}, both
33281 of which are arbitrary integers. This function will return a
33282 properly normalized float value, or signal an overflow or underflow
33283 if @var{exp} is out of range.
33284 @end defun
33285
33286 @defun make-sdev x sigma
33287 Build an error form out of @var{x} and the absolute value of @var{sigma}.
33288 If @var{sigma} is zero, the result is the number @var{x} directly.
33289 If @var{sigma} is negative or complex, its absolute value is used.
33290 If @var{x} or @var{sigma} is not a valid type of object for use in
33291 error forms, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33292 @end defun
33293
33294 @defun make-intv mask lo hi
33295 Build an interval form out of @var{mask} (which is assumed to be an
33296 integer from 0 to 3), and the limits @var{lo} and @var{hi}. If
33297 @var{lo} is greater than @var{hi}, an empty interval form is returned.
33298 This calls @code{reject-arg} if @var{lo} or @var{hi} is unsuitable.
33299 @end defun
33300
33301 @defun sort-intv mask lo hi
33302 Build an interval form, similar to @code{make-intv}, except that if
33303 @var{lo} is less than @var{hi} they are simply exchanged, and the
33304 bits of @var{mask} are swapped accordingly.
33305 @end defun
33306
33307 @defun make-mod n m
33308 Build a modulo form out of @var{n} and the modulus @var{m}. Since modulo
33309 forms do not allow formulas as their components, if @var{n} or @var{m}
33310 is not a real number or HMS form the result will be a formula which
33311 is a call to @code{makemod}, the algebraic version of this function.
33312 @end defun
33313
33314 @defun float x
33315 Convert @var{x} to floating-point form. Integers and fractions are
33316 converted to numerically equivalent floats; components of complex
33317 numbers, vectors, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33318 modulo forms are recursively floated. If the argument is a variable
33319 or formula, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33320 @end defun
33321
33322 @defun compare x y
33323 Compare the numbers @var{x} and @var{y}, and return @mathit{-1} if
33324 @samp{(lessp @var{x} @var{y})}, 1 if @samp{(lessp @var{y} @var{x})},
33325 0 if @samp{(math-equal @var{x} @var{y})}, or 2 if the order is
33326 undefined or cannot be determined.
33327 @end defun
33328
33329 @defun numdigs n
33330 Return the number of digits of integer @var{n}, effectively
33331 @samp{ceil(log10(@var{n}))}, but much more efficient. Zero is
33332 considered to have zero digits.
33333 @end defun
33334
33335 @defun scale-int x n
33336 Shift integer @var{x} left @var{n} decimal digits, or right @mathit{-@var{n}}
33337 digits with truncation toward zero.
33338 @end defun
33339
33340 @defun scale-rounding x n
33341 Like @code{scale-int}, except that a right shift rounds to the nearest
33342 integer rather than truncating.
33343 @end defun
33344
33345 @defun fixnum n
33346 Return the integer @var{n} as a fixnum, i.e., a native Lisp integer.
33347 If @var{n} is outside the permissible range for Lisp integers (usually
33348 24 binary bits) the result is undefined.
33349 @end defun
33350
33351 @defun sqr x
33352 Compute the square of @var{x}; short for @samp{(* @var{x} @var{x})}.
33353 @end defun
33354
33355 @defun quotient x y
33356 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return an integer quotient
33357 and discard the remainder. If @var{x} or @var{y} is negative, the
33358 direction of rounding is undefined.
33359 @end defun
33360
33361 @defun idiv x y
33362 Perform an integer division; if @var{x} and @var{y} are both nonnegative
33363 integers, this uses the @code{quotient} function, otherwise it computes
33364 @samp{floor(@var{x}/@var{y})}. Thus the result is well-defined but
33365 slower than for @code{quotient}.
33366 @end defun
33367
33368 @defun imod x y
33369 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return the integer remainder
33370 and discard the quotient. Like @code{quotient}, this works only for
33371 integer arguments and is not well-defined for negative arguments.
33372 For a more well-defined result, use @samp{(% @var{x} @var{y})}.
33373 @end defun
33374
33375 @defun idivmod x y
33376 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return a cons cell whose
33377 @code{car} is @samp{(quotient @var{x} @var{y})} and whose @code{cdr}
33378 is @samp{(imod @var{x} @var{y})}.
33379 @end defun
33380
33381 @defun pow x y
33382 Compute @var{x} to the power @var{y}. In @code{defmath} code, this can
33383 also be written @samp{(^ @var{x} @var{y})} or
33384 @w{@samp{(expt @var{x} @var{y})}}.
33385 @end defun
33386
33387 @defun abs-approx x
33388 Compute a fast approximation to the absolute value of @var{x}. For
33389 example, for a rectangular complex number the result is the sum of
33390 the absolute values of the components.
33391 @end defun
33392
33393 @findex two-pi
33394 @findex pi-over-2
33395 @findex pi-over-4
33396 @findex pi-over-180
33397 @findex sqrt-two-pi
33398 @findex sqrt-e
33399 @findex e
33400 @findex ln-2
33401 @findex ln-10
33402 @defun pi
33403 The function @samp{(pi)} computes @samp{pi} to the current precision.
33404 Other related constant-generating functions are @code{two-pi},
33405 @code{pi-over-2}, @code{pi-over-4}, @code{pi-over-180}, @code{sqrt-two-pi},
33406 @code{e}, @code{sqrt-e}, @code{ln-2}, and @code{ln-10}. Each function
33407 returns a floating-point value in the current precision, and each uses
33408 caching so that all calls after the first are essentially free.
33409 @end defun
33410
33411 @defmac math-defcache @var{func} @var{initial} @var{form}
33412 This macro, usually used as a top-level call like @code{defun} or
33413 @code{defvar}, defines a new cached constant analogous to @code{pi}, etc.
33414 It defines a function @code{func} which returns the requested value;
33415 if @var{initial} is non-@code{nil} it must be a @samp{(float @dots{})}
33416 form which serves as an initial value for the cache. If @var{func}
33417 is called when the cache is empty or does not have enough digits to
33418 satisfy the current precision, the Lisp expression @var{form} is evaluated
33419 with the current precision increased by four, and the result minus its
33420 two least significant digits is stored in the cache. For example,
33421 calling @samp{(pi)} with a precision of 30 computes @samp{pi} to 34
33422 digits, rounds it down to 32 digits for future use, then rounds it
33423 again to 30 digits for use in the present request.
33424 @end defmac
33425
33426 @findex half-circle
33427 @findex quarter-circle
33428 @defun full-circle symb
33429 If the current angular mode is Degrees or HMS, this function returns the
33430 integer 360. In Radians mode, this function returns either the
33431 corresponding value in radians to the current precision, or the formula
33432 @samp{2*pi}, depending on the Symbolic mode. There are also similar
33433 function @code{half-circle} and @code{quarter-circle}.
33434 @end defun
33435
33436 @defun power-of-2 n
33437 Compute two to the integer power @var{n}, as a (potentially very large)
33438 integer. Powers of two are cached, so only the first call for a
33439 particular @var{n} is expensive.
33440 @end defun
33441
33442 @defun integer-log2 n
33443 Compute the base-2 logarithm of @var{n}, which must be an integer which
33444 is a power of two. If @var{n} is not a power of two, this function will
33445 return @code{nil}.
33446 @end defun
33447
33448 @defun div-mod a b m
33449 Divide @var{a} by @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. This returns @code{nil} if
33450 there is no solution, or if any of the arguments are not integers.
33451 @end defun
33452
33453 @defun pow-mod a b m
33454 Compute @var{a} to the power @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. If @var{a},
33455 @var{b}, and @var{m} are integers, this uses an especially efficient
33456 algorithm. Otherwise, it simply computes @samp{(% (^ a b) m)}.
33457 @end defun
33458
33459 @defun isqrt n
33460 Compute the integer square root of @var{n}. This is the square root
33461 of @var{n} rounded down toward zero, i.e., @samp{floor(sqrt(@var{n}))}.
33462 If @var{n} is itself an integer, the computation is especially efficient.
33463 @end defun
33464
33465 @defun to-hms a ang
33466 Convert the argument @var{a} into an HMS form. If @var{ang} is specified,
33467 it is the angular mode in which to interpret @var{a}, either @code{deg}
33468 or @code{rad}. Otherwise, the current angular mode is used. If @var{a}
33469 is already an HMS form it is returned as-is.
33470 @end defun
33471
33472 @defun from-hms a ang
33473 Convert the HMS form @var{a} into a real number. If @var{ang} is specified,
33474 it is the angular mode in which to express the result, otherwise the
33475 current angular mode is used. If @var{a} is already a real number, it
33476 is returned as-is.
33477 @end defun
33478
33479 @defun to-radians a
33480 Convert the number or HMS form @var{a} to radians from the current
33481 angular mode.
33482 @end defun
33483
33484 @defun from-radians a
33485 Convert the number @var{a} from radians to the current angular mode.
33486 If @var{a} is a formula, this returns the formula @samp{deg(@var{a})}.
33487 @end defun
33488
33489 @defun to-radians-2 a
33490 Like @code{to-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a degrees to
33491 radians conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*pi/180}.
33492 @end defun
33493
33494 @defun from-radians-2 a
33495 Like @code{from-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a radians to
33496 degrees conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*180/pi}.
33497 @end defun
33498
33499 @defun random-digit
33500 Produce a random base-1000 digit in the range 0 to 999.
33501 @end defun
33502
33503 @defun random-digits n
33504 Produce a random @var{n}-digit integer; this will be an integer
33505 in the interval @samp{[0, 10^@var{n})}.
33506 @end defun
33507
33508 @defun random-float
33509 Produce a random float in the interval @samp{[0, 1)}.
33510 @end defun
33511
33512 @defun prime-test n iters
33513 Determine whether the integer @var{n} is prime. Return a list which has
33514 one of these forms: @samp{(nil @var{f})} means the number is non-prime
33515 because it was found to be divisible by @var{f}; @samp{(nil)} means it
33516 was found to be non-prime by table look-up (so no factors are known);
33517 @samp{(nil unknown)} means it is definitely non-prime but no factors
33518 are known because @var{n} was large enough that Fermat's probabilistic
33519 test had to be used; @samp{(t)} means the number is definitely prime;
33520 and @samp{(maybe @var{i} @var{p})} means that Fermat's test, after @var{i}
33521 iterations, is @var{p} percent sure that the number is prime. The
33522 @var{iters} parameter is the number of Fermat iterations to use, in the
33523 case that this is necessary. If @code{prime-test} returns ``maybe,''
33524 you can call it again with the same @var{n} to get a greater certainty;
33525 @code{prime-test} remembers where it left off.
33526 @end defun
33527
33528 @defun to-simple-fraction f
33529 If @var{f} is a floating-point number which can be represented exactly
33530 as a small rational number. return that number, else return @var{f}.
33531 For example, 0.75 would be converted to 3:4. This function is very
33532 fast.
33533 @end defun
33534
33535 @defun to-fraction f tol
33536 Find a rational approximation to floating-point number @var{f} to within
33537 a specified tolerance @var{tol}; this corresponds to the algebraic
33538 function @code{frac}, and can be rather slow.
33539 @end defun
33540
33541 @defun quarter-integer n
33542 If @var{n} is an integer or integer-valued float, this function
33543 returns zero. If @var{n} is a half-integer (i.e., an integer plus
33544 @mathit{1:2} or 0.5), it returns 2. If @var{n} is a quarter-integer,
33545 it returns 1 or 3. If @var{n} is anything else, this function
33546 returns @code{nil}.
33547 @end defun
33548
33549 @node Vector Lisp Functions, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Computational Lisp Functions, Internals
33550 @subsubsection Vector Functions
33551
33552 @noindent
33553 The functions described here perform various operations on vectors and
33554 matrices.
33555
33556 @defun math-concat x y
33557 Do a vector concatenation; this operation is written @samp{@var{x} | @var{y}}
33558 in a symbolic formula. @xref{Building Vectors}.
33559 @end defun
33560
33561 @defun vec-length v
33562 Return the length of vector @var{v}. If @var{v} is not a vector, the
33563 result is zero. If @var{v} is a matrix, this returns the number of
33564 rows in the matrix.
33565 @end defun
33566
33567 @defun mat-dimens m
33568 Determine the dimensions of vector or matrix @var{m}. If @var{m} is not
33569 a vector, the result is an empty list. If @var{m} is a plain vector
33570 but not a matrix, the result is a one-element list containing the length
33571 of the vector. If @var{m} is a matrix with @var{r} rows and @var{c} columns,
33572 the result is the list @samp{(@var{r} @var{c})}. Higher-order tensors
33573 produce lists of more than two dimensions. Note that the object
33574 @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} is a vector of vectors not all the same size,
33575 and is treated by this and other Calc routines as a plain vector of two
33576 elements.
33577 @end defun
33578
33579 @defun dimension-error
33580 Abort the current function with a message of ``Dimension error.''
33581 The Calculator will leave the function being evaluated in symbolic
33582 form; this is really just a special case of @code{reject-arg}.
33583 @end defun
33584
33585 @defun build-vector args
33586 Return a Calc vector with @var{args} as elements.
33587 For example, @samp{(build-vector 1 2 3)} returns the Calc vector
33588 @samp{[1, 2, 3]}, stored internally as the list @samp{(vec 1 2 3)}.
33589 @end defun
33590
33591 @defun make-vec obj dims
33592 Return a Calc vector or matrix all of whose elements are equal to
33593 @var{obj}. For example, @samp{(make-vec 27 3 4)} returns a 3x4 matrix
33594 filled with 27's.
33595 @end defun
33596
33597 @defun row-matrix v
33598 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a row matrix, i.e.,
33599 a matrix whose single row is @var{v}. If @var{v} is already a matrix,
33600 leave it alone.
33601 @end defun
33602
33603 @defun col-matrix v
33604 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a column matrix, i.e., a
33605 matrix with each element of @var{v} as a separate row. If @var{v} is
33606 already a matrix, leave it alone.
33607 @end defun
33608
33609 @defun map-vec f v
33610 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the Calc vector @var{v}. For example,
33611 @samp{(map-vec 'math-floor v)} returns a vector of the floored components
33612 of vector @var{v}.
33613 @end defun
33614
33615 @defun map-vec-2 f a b
33616 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the two vectors @var{a} and @var{b}.
33617 If @var{a} and @var{b} are vectors of equal length, the result is a
33618 vector of the results of calling @samp{(@var{f} @var{ai} @var{bi})}
33619 for each pair of elements @var{ai} and @var{bi}. If either @var{a} or
33620 @var{b} is a scalar, it is matched with each value of the other vector.
33621 For example, @samp{(map-vec-2 'math-add v 1)} returns the vector @var{v}
33622 with each element increased by one. Note that using @samp{'+} would not
33623 work here, since @code{defmath} does not expand function names everywhere,
33624 just where they are in the function position of a Lisp expression.
33625 @end defun
33626
33627 @defun reduce-vec f v
33628 Reduce the function @var{f} over the vector @var{v}. For example, if
33629 @var{v} is @samp{[10, 20, 30, 40]}, this calls @samp{(f (f (f 10 20) 30) 40)}.
33630 If @var{v} is a matrix, this reduces over the rows of @var{v}.
33631 @end defun
33632
33633 @defun reduce-cols f m
33634 Reduce the function @var{f} over the columns of matrix @var{m}. For
33635 example, if @var{m} is @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4], [5, 6]]}, the result
33636 is a vector of the two elements @samp{(f (f 1 3) 5)} and @samp{(f (f 2 4) 6)}.
33637 @end defun
33638
33639 @defun mat-row m n
33640 Return the @var{n}th row of matrix @var{m}. This is equivalent to
33641 @samp{(elt m n)}. For a slower but safer version, use @code{mrow}.
33642 (@xref{Extracting Elements}.)
33643 @end defun
33644
33645 @defun mat-col m n
33646 Return the @var{n}th column of matrix @var{m}, in the form of a vector.
33647 The arguments are not checked for correctness.
33648 @end defun
33649
33650 @defun mat-less-row m n
33651 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th row deleted. The
33652 number @var{n} must be in range from 1 to the number of rows in @var{m}.
33653 @end defun
33654
33655 @defun mat-less-col m n
33656 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th column deleted.
33657 @end defun
33658
33659 @defun transpose m
33660 Return the transpose of matrix @var{m}.
33661 @end defun
33662
33663 @defun flatten-vector v
33664 Flatten nested vector @var{v} into a vector of scalars. For example,
33665 if @var{v} is @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} the result is @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
33666 @end defun
33667
33668 @defun copy-matrix m
33669 If @var{m} is a matrix, return a copy of @var{m}. This maps
33670 @code{copy-sequence} over the rows of @var{m}; in Lisp terms, each
33671 element of the result matrix will be @code{eq} to the corresponding
33672 element of @var{m}, but none of the @code{cons} cells that make up
33673 the structure of the matrix will be @code{eq}. If @var{m} is a plain
33674 vector, this is the same as @code{copy-sequence}.
33675 @end defun
33676
33677 @defun swap-rows m r1 r2
33678 Exchange rows @var{r1} and @var{r2} of matrix @var{m} in-place. In
33679 other words, unlike most of the other functions described here, this
33680 function changes @var{m} itself rather than building up a new result
33681 matrix. The return value is @var{m}, i.e., @samp{(eq (swap-rows m 1 2) m)}
33682 is true, with the side effect of exchanging the first two rows of
33683 @var{m}.
33684 @end defun
33685
33686 @node Symbolic Lisp Functions, Formatting Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Internals
33687 @subsubsection Symbolic Functions
33688
33689 @noindent
33690 The functions described here operate on symbolic formulas in the
33691 Calculator.
33692
33693 @defun calc-prepare-selection num
33694 Prepare a stack entry for selection operations. If @var{num} is
33695 omitted, the stack entry containing the cursor is used; otherwise,
33696 it is the number of the stack entry to use. This function stores
33697 useful information about the current stack entry into a set of
33698 variables. @code{calc-selection-cache-num} contains the number of
33699 the stack entry involved (equal to @var{num} if you specified it);
33700 @code{calc-selection-cache-entry} contains the stack entry as a
33701 list (such as @code{calc-top-list} would return with @code{entry}
33702 as the selection mode); and @code{calc-selection-cache-comp} contains
33703 a special ``tagged'' composition (@pxref{Formatting Lisp Functions})
33704 which allows Calc to relate cursor positions in the buffer with
33705 their corresponding sub-formulas.
33706
33707 A slight complication arises in the selection mechanism because
33708 formulas may contain small integers. For example, in the vector
33709 @samp{[1, 2, 1]} the first and last elements are @code{eq} to each
33710 other; selections are recorded as the actual Lisp object that
33711 appears somewhere in the tree of the whole formula, but storing
33712 @code{1} would falsely select both @code{1}'s in the vector. So
33713 @code{calc-prepare-selection} also checks the stack entry and
33714 replaces any plain integers with ``complex number'' lists of the form
33715 @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)}. This list will be displayed the same as a
33716 plain @var{n} and the change will be completely invisible to the
33717 user, but it will guarantee that no two sub-formulas of the stack
33718 entry will be @code{eq} to each other. Next time the stack entry
33719 is involved in a computation, @code{calc-normalize} will replace
33720 these lists with plain numbers again, again invisibly to the user.
33721 @end defun
33722
33723 @defun calc-encase-atoms x
33724 This modifies the formula @var{x} to ensure that each part of the
33725 formula is a unique atom, using the @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)} trick
33726 described above. This function may use @code{setcar} to modify
33727 the formula in-place.
33728 @end defun
33729
33730 @defun calc-find-selected-part
33731 Find the smallest sub-formula of the current formula that contains
33732 the cursor. This assumes @code{calc-prepare-selection} has been
33733 called already. If the cursor is not actually on any part of the
33734 formula, this returns @code{nil}.
33735 @end defun
33736
33737 @defun calc-change-current-selection selection
33738 Change the currently prepared stack element's selection to
33739 @var{selection}, which should be @code{eq} to some sub-formula
33740 of the stack element, or @code{nil} to unselect the formula.
33741 The stack element's appearance in the Calc buffer is adjusted
33742 to reflect the new selection.
33743 @end defun
33744
33745 @defun calc-find-nth-part expr n
33746 Return the @var{n}th sub-formula of @var{expr}. This function is used
33747 by the selection commands, and (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) treats
33748 sums and products as flat many-element formulas. Thus if @var{expr}
33749 is @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, calling @code{calc-find-nth-part} with
33750 @var{n} equal to four will return @samp{d}.
33751 @end defun
33752
33753 @defun calc-find-parent-formula expr part
33754 Return the sub-formula of @var{expr} which immediately contains
33755 @var{part}. If @var{expr} is @samp{a*b + (c+1)*d} and @var{part}
33756 is @code{eq} to the @samp{c+1} term of @var{expr}, then this function
33757 will return @samp{(c+1)*d}. If @var{part} turns out not to be a
33758 sub-formula of @var{expr}, the function returns @code{nil}. If
33759 @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, the function returns @code{t}.
33760 This function does not take associativity into account.
33761 @end defun
33762
33763 @defun calc-find-assoc-parent-formula expr part
33764 This is the same as @code{calc-find-parent-formula}, except that
33765 (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) it continues widening the selection
33766 to contain a complete level of the formula. Given @samp{a} from
33767 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, @code{calc-find-parent-formula} will
33768 return @samp{a + b} but @code{calc-find-assoc-parent-formula} will
33769 return the whole expression.
33770 @end defun
33771
33772 @defun calc-grow-assoc-formula expr part
33773 This expands sub-formula @var{part} of @var{expr} to encompass a
33774 complete level of the formula. If @var{part} and its immediate
33775 parent are not compatible associative operators, or if @kbd{j b}
33776 has been used, this simply returns @var{part}.
33777 @end defun
33778
33779 @defun calc-find-sub-formula expr part
33780 This finds the immediate sub-formula of @var{expr} which contains
33781 @var{part}. It returns an index @var{n} such that
33782 @samp{(calc-find-nth-part @var{expr} @var{n})} would return @var{part}.
33783 If @var{part} is not a sub-formula of @var{expr}, it returns @code{nil}.
33784 If @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, it returns @code{t}. This
33785 function does not take associativity into account.
33786 @end defun
33787
33788 @defun calc-replace-sub-formula expr old new
33789 This function returns a copy of formula @var{expr}, with the
33790 sub-formula that is @code{eq} to @var{old} replaced by @var{new}.
33791 @end defun
33792
33793 @defun simplify expr
33794 Simplify the expression @var{expr} by applying various algebraic rules.
33795 This is what the @w{@kbd{a s}} (@code{calc-simplify}) command uses. This
33796 always returns a copy of the expression; the structure @var{expr} points
33797 to remains unchanged in memory.
33798
33799 More precisely, here is what @code{simplify} does: The expression is
33800 first normalized and evaluated by calling @code{normalize}. If any
33801 @code{AlgSimpRules} have been defined, they are then applied. Then
33802 the expression is traversed in a depth-first, bottom-up fashion; at
33803 each level, any simplifications that can be made are made until no
33804 further changes are possible. Once the entire formula has been
33805 traversed in this way, it is compared with the original formula (from
33806 before the call to @code{normalize}) and, if it has changed,
33807 the entire procedure is repeated (starting with @code{normalize})
33808 until no further changes occur. Usually only two iterations are
33809 needed:@: one to simplify the formula, and another to verify that no
33810 further simplifications were possible.
33811 @end defun
33812
33813 @defun simplify-extended expr
33814 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, with additional rules enabled that
33815 help do a more thorough job, while not being entirely ``safe'' in all
33816 circumstances. (For example, this mode will simplify @samp{sqrt(x^2)}
33817 to @samp{x}, which is only valid when @var{x} is positive.) This is
33818 implemented by temporarily binding the variable @code{math-living-dangerously}
33819 to @code{t} (using a @code{let} form) and calling @code{simplify}.
33820 Dangerous simplification rules are written to check this variable
33821 before taking any action.
33822 @end defun
33823
33824 @defun simplify-units expr
33825 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, treating variable names as units
33826 whenever possible. This works by binding the variable
33827 @code{math-simplifying-units} to @code{t} while calling @code{simplify}.
33828 @end defun
33829
33830 @defmac math-defsimplify funcs body
33831 Register a new simplification rule; this is normally called as a top-level
33832 form, like @code{defun} or @code{defmath}. If @var{funcs} is a symbol
33833 (like @code{+} or @code{calcFunc-sqrt}), this simplification rule is
33834 applied to the formulas which are calls to the specified function. Or,
33835 @var{funcs} can be a list of such symbols; the rule applies to all
33836 functions on the list. The @var{body} is written like the body of a
33837 function with a single argument called @code{expr}. The body will be
33838 executed with @code{expr} bound to a formula which is a call to one of
33839 the functions @var{funcs}. If the function body returns @code{nil}, or
33840 if it returns a result @code{equal} to the original @code{expr}, it is
33841 ignored and Calc goes on to try the next simplification rule that applies.
33842 If the function body returns something different, that new formula is
33843 substituted for @var{expr} in the original formula.
33844
33845 At each point in the formula, rules are tried in the order of the
33846 original calls to @code{math-defsimplify}; the search stops after the
33847 first rule that makes a change. Thus later rules for that same
33848 function will not have a chance to trigger until the next iteration
33849 of the main @code{simplify} loop.
33850
33851 Note that, since @code{defmath} is not being used here, @var{body} must
33852 be written in true Lisp code without the conveniences that @code{defmath}
33853 provides. If you prefer, you can have @var{body} simply call another
33854 function (defined with @code{defmath}) which does the real work.
33855
33856 The arguments of a function call will already have been simplified
33857 before any rules for the call itself are invoked. Since a new argument
33858 list is consed up when this happens, this means that the rule's body is
33859 allowed to rearrange the function's arguments destructively if that is
33860 convenient. Here is a typical example of a simplification rule:
33861
33862 @smallexample
33863 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-arcsinh
33864 (or (and (math-looks-negp (nth 1 expr))
33865 (math-neg (list 'calcFunc-arcsinh
33866 (math-neg (nth 1 expr)))))
33867 (and (eq (car-safe (nth 1 expr)) 'calcFunc-sinh)
33868 (or math-living-dangerously
33869 (math-known-realp (nth 1 (nth 1 expr))))
33870 (nth 1 (nth 1 expr)))))
33871 @end smallexample
33872
33873 This is really a pair of rules written with one @code{math-defsimplify}
33874 for convenience; the first replaces @samp{arcsinh(-x)} with
33875 @samp{-arcsinh(x)}, and the second, which is safe only for real @samp{x},
33876 replaces @samp{arcsinh(sinh(x))} with @samp{x}.
33877 @end defmac
33878
33879 @defun common-constant-factor expr
33880 Check @var{expr} to see if it is a sum of terms all multiplied by the
33881 same rational value. If so, return this value. If not, return @code{nil}.
33882 For example, if called on @samp{6x + 9y + 12z}, it would return 3, since
33883 3 is a common factor of all the terms.
33884 @end defun
33885
33886 @defun cancel-common-factor expr factor
33887 Assuming @var{expr} is a sum with @var{factor} as a common factor,
33888 divide each term of the sum by @var{factor}. This is done by
33889 destructively modifying parts of @var{expr}, on the assumption that
33890 it is being used by a simplification rule (where such things are
33891 allowed; see above). For example, consider this built-in rule for
33892 square roots:
33893
33894 @smallexample
33895 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-sqrt
33896 (let ((fac (math-common-constant-factor (nth 1 expr))))
33897 (and fac (not (eq fac 1))
33898 (math-mul (math-normalize (list 'calcFunc-sqrt fac))
33899 (math-normalize
33900 (list 'calcFunc-sqrt
33901 (math-cancel-common-factor
33902 (nth 1 expr) fac)))))))
33903 @end smallexample
33904 @end defun
33905
33906 @defun frac-gcd a b
33907 Compute a ``rational GCD'' of @var{a} and @var{b}, which must both be
33908 rational numbers. This is the fraction composed of the GCD of the
33909 numerators of @var{a} and @var{b}, over the GCD of the denominators.
33910 It is used by @code{common-constant-factor}. Note that the standard
33911 @code{gcd} function uses the LCM to combine the denominators.
33912 @end defun
33913
33914 @defun map-tree func expr many
33915 Try applying Lisp function @var{func} to various sub-expressions of
33916 @var{expr}. Initially, call @var{func} with @var{expr} itself as an
33917 argument. If this returns an expression which is not @code{equal} to
33918 @var{expr}, apply @var{func} again until eventually it does return
33919 @var{expr} with no changes. Then, if @var{expr} is a function call,
33920 recursively apply @var{func} to each of the arguments. This keeps going
33921 until no changes occur anywhere in the expression; this final expression
33922 is returned by @code{map-tree}. Note that, unlike simplification rules,
33923 @var{func} functions may @emph{not} make destructive changes to
33924 @var{expr}. If a third argument @var{many} is provided, it is an
33925 integer which says how many times @var{func} may be applied; the
33926 default, as described above, is infinitely many times.
33927 @end defun
33928
33929 @defun compile-rewrites rules
33930 Compile the rewrite rule set specified by @var{rules}, which should
33931 be a formula that is either a vector or a variable name. If the latter,
33932 the compiled rules are saved so that later @code{compile-rules} calls
33933 for that same variable can return immediately. If there are problems
33934 with the rules, this function calls @code{error} with a suitable
33935 message.
33936 @end defun
33937
33938 @defun apply-rewrites expr crules heads
33939 Apply the compiled rewrite rule set @var{crules} to the expression
33940 @var{expr}. This will make only one rewrite and only checks at the
33941 top level of the expression. The result @code{nil} if no rules
33942 matched, or if the only rules that matched did not actually change
33943 the expression. The @var{heads} argument is optional; if is given,
33944 it should be a list of all function names that (may) appear in
33945 @var{expr}. The rewrite compiler tags each rule with the
33946 rarest-looking function name in the rule; if you specify @var{heads},
33947 @code{apply-rewrites} can use this information to narrow its search
33948 down to just a few rules in the rule set.
33949 @end defun
33950
33951 @defun rewrite-heads expr
33952 Compute a @var{heads} list for @var{expr} suitable for use with
33953 @code{apply-rewrites}, as discussed above.
33954 @end defun
33955
33956 @defun rewrite expr rules many
33957 This is an all-in-one rewrite function. It compiles the rule set
33958 specified by @var{rules}, then uses @code{map-tree} to apply the
33959 rules throughout @var{expr} up to @var{many} (default infinity)
33960 times.
33961 @end defun
33962
33963 @defun match-patterns pat vec not-flag
33964 Given a Calc vector @var{vec} and an uncompiled pattern set or
33965 pattern set variable @var{pat}, this function returns a new vector
33966 of all elements of @var{vec} which do (or don't, if @var{not-flag} is
33967 non-@code{nil}) match any of the patterns in @var{pat}.
33968 @end defun
33969
33970 @defun deriv expr var value symb
33971 Compute the derivative of @var{expr} with respect to variable @var{var}
33972 (which may actually be any sub-expression). If @var{value} is specified,
33973 the derivative is evaluated at the value of @var{var}; otherwise, the
33974 derivative is left in terms of @var{var}. If the expression contains
33975 functions for which no derivative formula is known, new derivative
33976 functions are invented by adding primes to the names; @pxref{Calculus}.
33977 However, if @var{symb} is non-@code{nil}, the presence of undifferentiable
33978 functions in @var{expr} instead cancels the whole differentiation, and
33979 @code{deriv} returns @code{nil} instead.
33980
33981 Derivatives of an @var{n}-argument function can be defined by
33982 adding a @code{math-derivative-@var{n}} property to the property list
33983 of the symbol for the function's derivative, which will be the
33984 function name followed by an apostrophe. The value of the property
33985 should be a Lisp function; it is called with the same arguments as the
33986 original function call that is being differentiated. It should return
33987 a formula for the derivative. For example, the derivative of @code{ln}
33988 is defined by
33989
33990 @smallexample
33991 (put 'calcFunc-ln\' 'math-derivative-1
33992 (function (lambda (u) (math-div 1 u))))
33993 @end smallexample
33994
33995 The two-argument @code{log} function has two derivatives,
33996 @smallexample
33997 (put 'calcFunc-log\' 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / dx
33998 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
33999 (put 'calcFunc-log\'2 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / db
34000 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34001 @end smallexample
34002 @end defun
34003
34004 @defun tderiv expr var value symb
34005 Compute the total derivative of @var{expr}. This is the same as
34006 @code{deriv}, except that variables other than @var{var} are not
34007 assumed to be constant with respect to @var{var}.
34008 @end defun
34009
34010 @defun integ expr var low high
34011 Compute the integral of @var{expr} with respect to @var{var}.
34012 @xref{Calculus}, for further details.
34013 @end defun
34014
34015 @defmac math-defintegral funcs body
34016 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of one argument;
34017 this macro is very similar in format to @code{math-defsimplify}.
34018 The main difference is that here @var{body} is the body of a function
34019 with a single argument @code{u} which is bound to the argument to the
34020 function being integrated, not the function call itself. Also, the
34021 variable of integration is available as @code{math-integ-var}. If
34022 evaluation of the integral requires doing further integrals, the body
34023 should call @samp{(math-integral @var{x})} to find the integral of
34024 @var{x} with respect to @code{math-integ-var}; this function returns
34025 @code{nil} if the integral could not be done. Some examples:
34026
34027 @smallexample
34028 (math-defintegral calcFunc-conj
34029 (let ((int (math-integral u)))
34030 (and int
34031 (list 'calcFunc-conj int))))
34032
34033 (math-defintegral calcFunc-cos
34034 (and (equal u math-integ-var)
34035 (math-from-radians-2 (list 'calcFunc-sin u))))
34036 @end smallexample
34037
34038 In the @code{cos} example, we define only the integral of @samp{cos(x) dx},
34039 relying on the general integration-by-substitution facility to handle
34040 cosines of more complicated arguments. An integration rule should return
34041 @code{nil} if it can't do the integral; if several rules are defined for
34042 the same function, they are tried in order until one returns a non-@code{nil}
34043 result.
34044 @end defmac
34045
34046 @defmac math-defintegral-2 funcs body
34047 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of two arguments.
34048 This is exactly analogous to @code{math-defintegral}, except that @var{body}
34049 is written as the body of a function with two arguments, @var{u} and
34050 @var{v}.
34051 @end defmac
34052
34053 @defun solve-for lhs rhs var full
34054 Attempt to solve the equation @samp{@var{lhs} = @var{rhs}} by isolating
34055 the variable @var{var} on the lefthand side; return the resulting righthand
34056 side, or @code{nil} if the equation cannot be solved. The variable
34057 @var{var} must appear at least once in @var{lhs} or @var{rhs}. Note that
34058 the return value is a formula which does not contain @var{var}; this is
34059 different from the user-level @code{solve} and @code{finv} functions,
34060 which return a rearranged equation or a functional inverse, respectively.
34061 If @var{full} is non-@code{nil}, a full solution including dummy signs
34062 and dummy integers will be produced. User-defined inverses are provided
34063 as properties in a manner similar to derivatives:
34064
34065 @smallexample
34066 (put 'calcFunc-ln 'math-inverse
34067 (function (lambda (x) (list 'calcFunc-exp x))))
34068 @end smallexample
34069
34070 This function can call @samp{(math-solve-get-sign @var{x})} to create
34071 a new arbitrary sign variable, returning @var{x} times that sign, and
34072 @samp{(math-solve-get-int @var{x})} to create a new arbitrary integer
34073 variable multiplied by @var{x}. These functions simply return @var{x}
34074 if the caller requested a non-``full'' solution.
34075 @end defun
34076
34077 @defun solve-eqn expr var full
34078 This version of @code{solve-for} takes an expression which will
34079 typically be an equation or inequality. (If it is not, it will be
34080 interpreted as the equation @samp{@var{expr} = 0}.) It returns an
34081 equation or inequality, or @code{nil} if no solution could be found.
34082 @end defun
34083
34084 @defun solve-system exprs vars full
34085 This function solves a system of equations. Generally, @var{exprs}
34086 and @var{vars} will be vectors of equal length.
34087 @xref{Solving Systems of Equations}, for other options.
34088 @end defun
34089
34090 @defun expr-contains expr var
34091 Returns a non-@code{nil} value if @var{var} occurs as a subexpression
34092 of @var{expr}.
34093
34094 This function might seem at first to be identical to
34095 @code{calc-find-sub-formula}. The key difference is that
34096 @code{expr-contains} uses @code{equal} to test for matches, whereas
34097 @code{calc-find-sub-formula} uses @code{eq}. In the formula
34098 @samp{f(a, a)}, the two @samp{a}s will be @code{equal} but not
34099 @code{eq} to each other.
34100 @end defun
34101
34102 @defun expr-contains-count expr var
34103 Returns the number of occurrences of @var{var} as a subexpression
34104 of @var{expr}, or @code{nil} if there are no occurrences.
34105 @end defun
34106
34107 @defun expr-depends expr var
34108 Returns true if @var{expr} refers to any variable the occurs in @var{var}.
34109 In other words, it checks if @var{expr} and @var{var} have any variables
34110 in common.
34111 @end defun
34112
34113 @defun expr-contains-vars expr
34114 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables, or @code{nil} if @var{expr}
34115 contains only constants and functions with constant arguments.
34116 @end defun
34117
34118 @defun expr-subst expr old new
34119 Returns a copy of @var{expr}, with all occurrences of @var{old} replaced
34120 by @var{new}. This treats @code{lambda} forms specially with respect
34121 to the dummy argument variables, so that the effect is always to return
34122 @var{expr} evaluated at @var{old} = @var{new}.
34123 @end defun
34124
34125 @defun multi-subst expr old new
34126 This is like @code{expr-subst}, except that @var{old} and @var{new}
34127 are lists of expressions to be substituted simultaneously. If one
34128 list is shorter than the other, trailing elements of the longer list
34129 are ignored.
34130 @end defun
34131
34132 @defun expr-weight expr
34133 Returns the ``weight'' of @var{expr}, basically a count of the total
34134 number of objects and function calls that appear in @var{expr}. For
34135 ``primitive'' objects, this will be one.
34136 @end defun
34137
34138 @defun expr-height expr
34139 Returns the ``height'' of @var{expr}, which is the deepest level to
34140 which function calls are nested. (Note that @samp{@var{a} + @var{b}}
34141 counts as a function call.) For primitive objects, this returns zero.
34142 @end defun
34143
34144 @defun polynomial-p expr var
34145 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable (or sub-expression)
34146 @var{var}. If so, return the degree of the polynomial, that is, the
34147 highest power of @var{var} that appears in @var{expr}. For example,
34148 for @samp{(x^2 + 3)^3 + 4} this would return 6. This function returns
34149 @code{nil} unless @var{expr}, when expanded out by @kbd{a x}
34150 (@code{calc-expand}), would consist of a sum of terms in which @var{var}
34151 appears only raised to nonnegative integer powers. Note that if
34152 @var{var} does not occur in @var{expr}, then @var{expr} is considered
34153 a polynomial of degree 0.
34154 @end defun
34155
34156 @defun is-polynomial expr var degree loose
34157 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable or sub-expression
34158 @var{var}, and, if so, return a list representation of the polynomial
34159 where the elements of the list are coefficients of successive powers of
34160 @var{var}: @samp{@var{a} + @var{b} x + @var{c} x^3} would produce the
34161 list @samp{(@var{a} @var{b} 0 @var{c})}, and @samp{(x + 1)^2} would
34162 produce the list @samp{(1 2 1)}. The highest element of the list will
34163 be non-zero, with the special exception that if @var{expr} is the
34164 constant zero, the returned value will be @samp{(0)}. Return @code{nil}
34165 if @var{expr} is not a polynomial in @var{var}. If @var{degree} is
34166 specified, this will not consider polynomials of degree higher than that
34167 value. This is a good precaution because otherwise an input of
34168 @samp{(x+1)^1000} will cause a huge coefficient list to be built. If
34169 @var{loose} is non-@code{nil}, then a looser definition of a polynomial
34170 is used in which coefficients are no longer required not to depend on
34171 @var{var}, but are only required not to take the form of polynomials
34172 themselves. For example, @samp{sin(x) x^2 + cos(x)} is a loose
34173 polynomial with coefficients @samp{((calcFunc-cos x) 0 (calcFunc-sin
34174 x))}. The result will never be @code{nil} in loose mode, since any
34175 expression can be interpreted as a ``constant'' loose polynomial.
34176 @end defun
34177
34178 @defun polynomial-base expr pred
34179 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in any variable that occurs in it;
34180 if so, return that variable. (If @var{expr} is a multivariate polynomial,
34181 this chooses one variable arbitrarily.) If @var{pred} is specified, it should
34182 be a Lisp function which is called as @samp{(@var{pred} @var{subexpr})},
34183 and which should return true if @code{mpb-top-expr} (a global name for
34184 the original @var{expr}) is a suitable polynomial in @var{subexpr}.
34185 The default predicate uses @samp{(polynomial-p mpb-top-expr @var{subexpr})};
34186 you can use @var{pred} to specify additional conditions. Or, you could
34187 have @var{pred} build up a list of every suitable @var{subexpr} that
34188 is found.
34189 @end defun
34190
34191 @defun poly-simplify poly
34192 Simplify polynomial coefficient list @var{poly} by (destructively)
34193 clipping off trailing zeros.
34194 @end defun
34195
34196 @defun poly-mix a ac b bc
34197 Mix two polynomial lists @var{a} and @var{b} (in the form returned by
34198 @code{is-polynomial}) in a linear combination with coefficient expressions
34199 @var{ac} and @var{bc}. The result is a (not necessarily simplified)
34200 polynomial list representing @samp{@var{ac} @var{a} + @var{bc} @var{b}}.
34201 @end defun
34202
34203 @defun poly-mul a b
34204 Multiply two polynomial coefficient lists @var{a} and @var{b}. The
34205 result will be in simplified form if the inputs were simplified.
34206 @end defun
34207
34208 @defun build-polynomial-expr poly var
34209 Construct a Calc formula which represents the polynomial coefficient
34210 list @var{poly} applied to variable @var{var}. The @kbd{a c}
34211 (@code{calc-collect}) command uses @code{is-polynomial} to turn an
34212 expression into a coefficient list, then @code{build-polynomial-expr}
34213 to turn the list back into an expression in regular form.
34214 @end defun
34215
34216 @defun check-unit-name var
34217 Check if @var{var} is a variable which can be interpreted as a unit
34218 name. If so, return the units table entry for that unit. This
34219 will be a list whose first element is the unit name (not counting
34220 prefix characters) as a symbol and whose second element is the
34221 Calc expression which defines the unit. (Refer to the Calc sources
34222 for details on the remaining elements of this list.) If @var{var}
34223 is not a variable or is not a unit name, return @code{nil}.
34224 @end defun
34225
34226 @defun units-in-expr-p expr sub-exprs
34227 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables which can be
34228 interpreted as units. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{t}, the entire
34229 expression is searched. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{nil}, this
34230 checks whether @var{expr} is directly a units expression.
34231 @end defun
34232
34233 @defun single-units-in-expr-p expr
34234 Check whether @var{expr} contains exactly one units variable. If so,
34235 return the units table entry for the variable. If @var{expr} does
34236 not contain any units, return @code{nil}. If @var{expr} contains
34237 two or more units, return the symbol @code{wrong}.
34238 @end defun
34239
34240 @defun to-standard-units expr which
34241 Convert units expression @var{expr} to base units. If @var{which}
34242 is @code{nil}, use Calc's native base units. Otherwise, @var{which}
34243 can specify a units system, which is a list of two-element lists,
34244 where the first element is a Calc base symbol name and the second
34245 is an expression to substitute for it.
34246 @end defun
34247
34248 @defun remove-units expr
34249 Return a copy of @var{expr} with all units variables replaced by ones.
34250 This expression is generally normalized before use.
34251 @end defun
34252
34253 @defun extract-units expr
34254 Return a copy of @var{expr} with everything but units variables replaced
34255 by ones.
34256 @end defun
34257
34258 @node Formatting Lisp Functions, Hooks, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Internals
34259 @subsubsection I/O and Formatting Functions
34260
34261 @noindent
34262 The functions described here are responsible for parsing and formatting
34263 Calc numbers and formulas.
34264
34265 @defun calc-eval str sep arg1 arg2 @dots{}
34266 This is the simplest interface to the Calculator from another Lisp program.
34267 @xref{Calling Calc from Your Programs}.
34268 @end defun
34269
34270 @defun read-number str
34271 If string @var{str} contains a valid Calc number, either integer,
34272 fraction, float, or HMS form, this function parses and returns that
34273 number. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}.
34274 @end defun
34275
34276 @defun read-expr str
34277 Read an algebraic expression from string @var{str}. If @var{str} does
34278 not have the form of a valid expression, return a list of the form
34279 @samp{(error @var{pos} @var{msg})} where @var{pos} is an integer index
34280 into @var{str} of the general location of the error, and @var{msg} is
34281 a string describing the problem.
34282 @end defun
34283
34284 @defun read-exprs str
34285 Read a list of expressions separated by commas, and return it as a
34286 Lisp list. If an error occurs in any expressions, an error list as
34287 shown above is returned instead.
34288 @end defun
34289
34290 @defun calc-do-alg-entry initial prompt no-norm
34291 Read an algebraic formula or formulas using the minibuffer. All
34292 conventions of regular algebraic entry are observed. The return value
34293 is a list of Calc formulas; there will be more than one if the user
34294 entered a list of values separated by commas. The result is @code{nil}
34295 if the user presses Return with a blank line. If @var{initial} is
34296 given, it is a string which the minibuffer will initially contain.
34297 If @var{prompt} is given, it is the prompt string to use; the default
34298 is ``Algebraic:''. If @var{no-norm} is @code{t}, the formulas will
34299 be returned exactly as parsed; otherwise, they will be passed through
34300 @code{calc-normalize} first.
34301
34302 To support the use of @kbd{$} characters in the algebraic entry, use
34303 @code{let} to bind @code{calc-dollar-values} to a list of the values
34304 to be substituted for @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on, and bind
34305 @code{calc-dollar-used} to 0. Upon return, @code{calc-dollar-used}
34306 will have been changed to the highest number of consecutive @kbd{$}s
34307 that actually appeared in the input.
34308 @end defun
34309
34310 @defun format-number a
34311 Convert the real or complex number or HMS form @var{a} to string form.
34312 @end defun
34313
34314 @defun format-flat-expr a prec
34315 Convert the arbitrary Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form,
34316 in the style used by the trail buffer and the @code{calc-edit} command.
34317 This is a simple format designed
34318 mostly to guarantee the string is of a form that can be re-parsed by
34319 @code{read-expr}. Most formatting modes, such as digit grouping,
34320 complex number format, and point character, are ignored to ensure the
34321 result will be re-readable. The @var{prec} parameter is normally 0; if
34322 you pass a large integer like 1000 instead, the expression will be
34323 surrounded by parentheses unless it is a plain number or variable name.
34324 @end defun
34325
34326 @defun format-nice-expr a width
34327 This is like @code{format-flat-expr} (with @var{prec} equal to 0),
34328 except that newlines will be inserted to keep lines down to the
34329 specified @var{width}, and vectors that look like matrices or rewrite
34330 rules are written in a pseudo-matrix format. The @code{calc-edit}
34331 command uses this when only one stack entry is being edited.
34332 @end defun
34333
34334 @defun format-value a width
34335 Convert the Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form, using the
34336 format seen in the stack buffer. Beware the string returned may
34337 not be re-readable by @code{read-expr}, for example, because of digit
34338 grouping. Multi-line objects like matrices produce strings that
34339 contain newline characters to separate the lines. The @var{w}
34340 parameter, if given, is the target window size for which to format
34341 the expressions. If @var{w} is omitted, the width of the Calculator
34342 window is used.
34343 @end defun
34344
34345 @defun compose-expr a prec
34346 Format the Calc number or formula @var{a} according to the current
34347 language mode, returning a ``composition.'' To learn about the
34348 structure of compositions, see the comments in the Calc source code.
34349 You can specify the format of a given type of function call by putting
34350 a @code{math-compose-@var{lang}} property on the function's symbol,
34351 whose value is a Lisp function that takes @var{a} and @var{prec} as
34352 arguments and returns a composition. Here @var{lang} is a language
34353 mode name, one of @code{normal}, @code{big}, @code{c}, @code{pascal},
34354 @code{fortran}, @code{tex}, @code{eqn}, @code{math}, or @code{maple}.
34355 In Big mode, Calc actually tries @code{math-compose-big} first, then
34356 tries @code{math-compose-normal}. If this property does not exist,
34357 or if the function returns @code{nil}, the function is written in the
34358 normal function-call notation for that language.
34359 @end defun
34360
34361 @defun composition-to-string c w
34362 Convert a composition structure returned by @code{compose-expr} into
34363 a string. Multi-line compositions convert to strings containing
34364 newline characters. The target window size is given by @var{w}.
34365 The @code{format-value} function basically calls @code{compose-expr}
34366 followed by @code{composition-to-string}.
34367 @end defun
34368
34369 @defun comp-width c
34370 Compute the width in characters of composition @var{c}.
34371 @end defun
34372
34373 @defun comp-height c
34374 Compute the height in lines of composition @var{c}.
34375 @end defun
34376
34377 @defun comp-ascent c
34378 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is on or
34379 above the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be one.
34380 @end defun
34381
34382 @defun comp-descent c
34383 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is below
34384 the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be zero.
34385 @end defun
34386
34387 @defun comp-first-char c
34388 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the first
34389 (leftmost) character of the composition as an integer. Otherwise,
34390 return @code{nil}.
34391 @end defun
34392
34393 @defun comp-last-char c
34394 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the last
34395 (rightmost) character, otherwise return @code{nil}.
34396 @end defun
34397
34398 @comment @node Lisp Variables, Hooks, Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
34399 @comment @subsubsection Lisp Variables
34400 @comment
34401 @comment @noindent
34402 @comment (This section is currently unfinished.)
34403
34404 @node Hooks, , Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
34405 @subsubsection Hooks
34406
34407 @noindent
34408 Hooks are variables which contain Lisp functions (or lists of functions)
34409 which are called at various times. Calc defines a number of hooks
34410 that help you to customize it in various ways. Calc uses the Lisp
34411 function @code{run-hooks} to invoke the hooks shown below. Several
34412 other customization-related variables are also described here.
34413
34414 @defvar calc-load-hook
34415 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc.el}, after the file has
34416 been loaded, before any functions in it have been called, but after
34417 @code{calc-mode-map} and similar variables have been set up.
34418 @end defvar
34419
34420 @defvar calc-ext-load-hook
34421 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc-ext.el}.
34422 @end defvar
34423
34424 @defvar calc-start-hook
34425 This hook is called as the last step in a @kbd{M-x calc} command.
34426 At this point, the Calc buffer has been created and initialized if
34427 necessary, the Calc window and trail window have been created,
34428 and the ``Welcome to Calc'' message has been displayed.
34429 @end defvar
34430
34431 @defvar calc-mode-hook
34432 This hook is called when the Calc buffer is being created. Usually
34433 this will only happen once per Emacs session. The hook is called
34434 after Emacs has switched to the new buffer, the mode-settings file
34435 has been read if necessary, and all other buffer-local variables
34436 have been set up. After this hook returns, Calc will perform a
34437 @code{calc-refresh} operation, set up the mode line display, then
34438 evaluate any deferred @code{calc-define} properties that have not
34439 been evaluated yet.
34440 @end defvar
34441
34442 @defvar calc-trail-mode-hook
34443 This hook is called when the Calc Trail buffer is being created.
34444 It is called as the very last step of setting up the Trail buffer.
34445 Like @code{calc-mode-hook}, this will normally happen only once
34446 per Emacs session.
34447 @end defvar
34448
34449 @defvar calc-end-hook
34450 This hook is called by @code{calc-quit}, generally because the user
34451 presses @kbd{q} or @kbd{M-# c} while in Calc. The Calc buffer will
34452 be the current buffer. The hook is called as the very first
34453 step, before the Calc window is destroyed.
34454 @end defvar
34455
34456 @defvar calc-window-hook
34457 If this hook exists, it is called to create the Calc window.
34458 Upon return, this new Calc window should be the current window.
34459 (The Calc buffer will already be the current buffer when the
34460 hook is called.) If the hook is not defined, Calc will
34461 generally use @code{split-window}, @code{set-window-buffer},
34462 and @code{select-window} to create the Calc window.
34463 @end defvar
34464
34465 @defvar calc-trail-window-hook
34466 If this hook exists, it is called to create the Calc Trail window.
34467 The variable @code{calc-trail-buffer} will contain the buffer
34468 which the window should use. Unlike @code{calc-window-hook},
34469 this hook must @emph{not} switch into the new window.
34470 @end defvar
34471
34472 @defvar calc-edit-mode-hook
34473 This hook is called by @code{calc-edit} (and the other ``edit''
34474 commands) when the temporary editing buffer is being created.
34475 The buffer will have been selected and set up to be in
34476 @code{calc-edit-mode}, but will not yet have been filled with
34477 text. (In fact it may still have leftover text from a previous
34478 @code{calc-edit} command.)
34479 @end defvar
34480
34481 @defvar calc-mode-save-hook
34482 This hook is called by the @code{calc-save-modes} command,
34483 after Calc's own mode features have been inserted into the
34484 Calc init file and just before the ``End of mode settings''
34485 message is inserted.
34486 @end defvar
34487
34488 @defvar calc-reset-hook
34489 This hook is called after @kbd{M-# 0} (@code{calc-reset}) has
34490 reset all modes. The Calc buffer will be the current buffer.
34491 @end defvar
34492
34493 @defvar calc-other-modes
34494 This variable contains a list of strings. The strings are
34495 concatenated at the end of the modes portion of the Calc
34496 mode line (after standard modes such as ``Deg'', ``Inv'' and
34497 ``Hyp''). Each string should be a short, single word followed
34498 by a space. The variable is @code{nil} by default.
34499 @end defvar
34500
34501 @defvar calc-mode-map
34502 This is the keymap that is used by Calc mode. The best time
34503 to adjust it is probably in a @code{calc-mode-hook}. If the
34504 Calc extensions package (@file{calc-ext.el}) has not yet been
34505 loaded, many of these keys will be bound to @code{calc-missing-key},
34506 which is a command that loads the extensions package and
34507 ``retypes'' the key. If your @code{calc-mode-hook} rebinds
34508 one of these keys, it will probably be overridden when the
34509 extensions are loaded.
34510 @end defvar
34511
34512 @defvar calc-digit-map
34513 This is the keymap that is used during numeric entry. Numeric
34514 entry uses the minibuffer, but this map binds every non-numeric
34515 key to @code{calcDigit-nondigit} which generally calls
34516 @code{exit-minibuffer} and ``retypes'' the key.
34517 @end defvar
34518
34519 @defvar calc-alg-ent-map
34520 This is the keymap that is used during algebraic entry. This is
34521 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-map}.
34522 @end defvar
34523
34524 @defvar calc-store-var-map
34525 This is the keymap that is used during entry of variable names for
34526 commands like @code{calc-store} and @code{calc-recall}. This is
34527 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-completion-map}.
34528 @end defvar
34529
34530 @defvar calc-edit-mode-map
34531 This is the (sparse) keymap used by @code{calc-edit} and other
34532 temporary editing commands. It binds @key{RET}, @key{LFD},
34533 and @kbd{C-c C-c} to @code{calc-edit-finish}.
34534 @end defvar
34535
34536 @defvar calc-mode-var-list
34537 This is a list of variables which are saved by @code{calc-save-modes}.
34538 Each entry is a list of two items, the variable (as a Lisp symbol)
34539 and its default value. When modes are being saved, each variable
34540 is compared with its default value (using @code{equal}) and any
34541 non-default variables are written out.
34542 @end defvar
34543
34544 @defvar calc-local-var-list
34545 This is a list of variables which should be buffer-local to the
34546 Calc buffer. Each entry is a variable name (as a Lisp symbol).
34547 These variables also have their default values manipulated by
34548 the @code{calc} and @code{calc-quit} commands; @pxref{Multiple Calculators}.
34549 Since @code{calc-mode-hook} is called after this list has been
34550 used the first time, your hook should add a variable to the
34551 list and also call @code{make-local-variable} itself.
34552 @end defvar
34553
34554 @node Installation, Reporting Bugs, Programming, Top
34555 @appendix Installation
34556
34557 @noindent
34558 As of Calc 2.02g, Calc is integrated with GNU Emacs, and thus requires
34559 no separate installation of its Lisp files and this manual.
34560
34561 @appendixsec The GNUPLOT Program
34562
34563 @noindent
34564 Calc's graphing commands use the GNUPLOT program. If you have GNUPLOT
34565 but you must type some command other than @file{gnuplot} to get it,
34566 you should add a command to set the Lisp variable @code{calc-gnuplot-name}
34567 to the appropriate file name. You may also need to change the variables
34568 @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} in
34569 order to get correct displays and hardcopies, respectively, of your
34570 plots.
34571
34572 @ifinfo
34573 @example
34574
34575 @end example
34576 @end ifinfo
34577 @appendixsec Printed Documentation
34578
34579 @noindent
34580 Because the Calc manual is so large, you should only make a printed
34581 copy if you really need it. To print the manual, you will need the
34582 @TeX{} typesetting program (this is a free program by Donald Knuth
34583 at Stanford University) as well as the @file{texindex} program and
34584 @file{texinfo.tex} file, both of which can be obtained from the FSF
34585 as part of the @code{texinfo} package.
34586
34587 To print the Calc manual in one huge 470 page tome, you will need the
34588 source code to this manual, @file{calc.texi}, available as part of the
34589 Emacs source. Once you have this file, type @kbd{texi2dvi calc.texi}.
34590 Alternatively, change to the @file{man} subdirectory of the Emacs
34591 source distribution, and type @kbd{make calc.dvi}. (Don't worry if you
34592 get some ``overfull box'' warnings while @TeX{} runs.)
34593
34594 The result will be a device-independent output file called
34595 @file{calc.dvi}, which you must print in whatever way is right
34596 for your system. On many systems, the command is
34597
34598 @example
34599 lpr -d calc.dvi
34600 @end example
34601
34602 @noindent
34603 or
34604
34605 @example
34606 dvips calc.dvi
34607 @end example
34608
34609 @c the bumpoddpages macro was deleted
34610 @ignore
34611 @cindex Marginal notes, adjusting
34612 Marginal notes for each function and key sequence normally alternate
34613 between the left and right sides of the page, which is correct if the
34614 manual is going to be bound as double-sided pages. Near the top of
34615 the file @file{calc.texi} you will find alternate definitions of
34616 the @code{\bumpoddpages} macro that put the marginal notes always on
34617 the same side, best if you plan to be binding single-sided pages.
34618 @end ignore
34619
34620 @appendixsec Settings File
34621
34622 @noindent
34623 @vindex calc-settings-file
34624 Another variable you might want to set is @code{calc-settings-file},
34625 which holds the file name in which commands like @kbd{m m} and @kbd{Z P}
34626 store ``permanent'' definitions. The default value for this variable
34627 is @code{"~/.calc.el"}. If @code{calc-settings-file} is not your user
34628 init file (typically @file{~/.emacs}) and if the variable
34629 @code{calc-loaded-settings-file} is @code{nil}, then Calc will
34630 automatically load your settings file (if it exists) the first time
34631 Calc is invoked.
34632
34633 @ifinfo
34634 @example
34635
34636 @end example
34637 @end ifinfo
34638 @appendixsec Testing the Installation
34639
34640 @noindent
34641 To test your installation of Calc, start a new Emacs and type @kbd{M-# c}
34642 to make sure the autoloads and key bindings work. Type @kbd{M-# i}
34643 to make sure Calc can find its Info documentation. Press @kbd{q} to
34644 exit the Info system and @kbd{M-# c} to re-enter the Calculator.
34645 Type @kbd{20 S} to compute the sine of 20 degrees; this will test the
34646 autoloading of the extensions modules. The result should be
34647 0.342020143326. Finally, press @kbd{M-# c} again to make sure the
34648 Calculator can exit.
34649
34650 You may also wish to test the GNUPLOT interface; to plot a sine wave,
34651 type @kbd{' [0 ..@: 360], sin(x) @key{RET} g f}. Type @kbd{g q} when you
34652 are done viewing the plot.
34653
34654 Calc is now ready to use. If you wish to go through the Calc Tutorial,
34655 press @kbd{M-# t} to begin.
34656 @example
34657
34658 @end example
34659 @node Reporting Bugs, Summary, Installation, Top
34660 @appendix Reporting Bugs
34661
34662 @noindent
34663 If you find a bug in Calc, send e-mail to Jay Belanger,
34664
34665 @example
34666 belanger@@truman.edu
34667 @end example
34668
34669 @noindent
34670 (In the following text, ``I'' refers to the original Calc author, Dave
34671 Gillespie).
34672
34673 While I cannot guarantee that I will have time to work on your bug,
34674 I do try to fix bugs quickly whenever I can.
34675
34676 The latest version of Calc is available from Savannah, in the Emacs
34677 CVS tree. See @uref{http://savannah.gnu.org/projects/emacs}.
34678
34679 There is an automatic command @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug} which helps
34680 you to report bugs. This command prompts you for a brief subject
34681 line, then leaves you in a mail editing buffer. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to
34682 send your mail. Make sure your subject line indicates that you are
34683 reporting a Calc bug; this command sends mail to the maintainer's
34684 regular mailbox.
34685
34686 If you have suggestions for additional features for Calc, I would
34687 love to hear them. Some have dared to suggest that Calc is already
34688 top-heavy with features; I really don't see what they're talking
34689 about, so, if you have ideas, send them right in. (I may even have
34690 time to implement them!)
34691
34692 At the front of the source file, @file{calc.el}, is a list of ideas for
34693 future work which I have not had time to do. If any enthusiastic souls
34694 wish to take it upon themselves to work on these, I would be delighted.
34695 Please let me know if you plan to contribute to Calc so I can coordinate
34696 your efforts with mine and those of others. I will do my best to help
34697 you in whatever way I can.
34698
34699 @c [summary]
34700 @node Summary, Key Index, Reporting Bugs, Top
34701 @appendix Calc Summary
34702
34703 @noindent
34704 This section includes a complete list of Calc 2.02 keystroke commands.
34705 Each line lists the stack entries used by the command (top-of-stack
34706 last), the keystrokes themselves, the prompts asked by the command,
34707 and the result of the command (also with top-of-stack last).
34708 The result is expressed using the equivalent algebraic function.
34709 Commands which put no results on the stack show the full @kbd{M-x}
34710 command name in that position. Numbers preceding the result or
34711 command name refer to notes at the end.
34712
34713 Algebraic functions and @kbd{M-x} commands that don't have corresponding
34714 keystrokes are not listed in this summary.
34715 @xref{Command Index}. @xref{Function Index}.
34716
34717 @iftex
34718 @begingroup
34719 @tex
34720 \vskip-2\baselineskip \null
34721 \gdef\sumrow#1{\sumrowx#1\relax}%
34722 \gdef\sumrowx#1\:#2\:#3\:#4\:#5\:#6\relax{%
34723 \leavevmode%
34724 {\smallfonts
34725 \hbox to5em{\sl\hss#1}%
34726 \hbox to5em{\tt#2\hss}%
34727 \hbox to4em{\sl#3\hss}%
34728 \hbox to5em{\rm\hss#4}%
34729 \thinspace%
34730 {\tt#5}%
34731 {\sl#6}%
34732 }}%
34733 \gdef\sumlpar{{\rm(}}%
34734 \gdef\sumrpar{{\rm)}}%
34735 \gdef\sumcomma{{\rm,\thinspace}}%
34736 \gdef\sumexcl{{\rm!}}%
34737 \gdef\sumbreak{\vskip-2.5\baselineskip\goodbreak}%
34738 \gdef\minus#1{{\tt-}}%
34739 @end tex
34740 @let@:=@sumsep
34741 @let@r=@sumrow
34742 @catcode`@(=@active @let(=@sumlpar
34743 @catcode`@)=@active @let)=@sumrpar
34744 @catcode`@,=@active @let,=@sumcomma
34745 @catcode`@!=@active @let!=@sumexcl
34746 @end iftex
34747 @format
34748 @iftex
34749 @advance@baselineskip-2.5pt
34750 @let@c@sumbreak
34751 @end iftex
34752 @r{ @: M-# a @: @: 33 @:calc-embedded-activate@:}
34753 @r{ @: M-# b @: @: @:calc-big-or-small@:}
34754 @r{ @: M-# c @: @: @:calc@:}
34755 @r{ @: M-# d @: @: @:calc-embedded-duplicate@:}
34756 @r{ @: M-# e @: @: 34 @:calc-embedded@:}
34757 @r{ @: M-# f @:formula @: @:calc-embedded-new-formula@:}
34758 @r{ @: M-# g @: @: 35 @:calc-grab-region@:}
34759 @r{ @: M-# i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
34760 @r{ @: M-# j @: @: @:calc-embedded-select@:}
34761 @r{ @: M-# k @: @: @:calc-keypad@:}
34762 @r{ @: M-# l @: @: @:calc-load-everything@:}
34763 @r{ @: M-# m @: @: @:read-kbd-macro@:}
34764 @r{ @: M-# n @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-next@:}
34765 @r{ @: M-# o @: @: @:calc-other-window@:}
34766 @r{ @: M-# p @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-previous@:}
34767 @r{ @: M-# q @:formula @: @:quick-calc@:}
34768 @r{ @: M-# r @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-rectangle@:}
34769 @r{ @: M-# s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
34770 @r{ @: M-# t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
34771 @r{ @: M-# u @: @: @:calc-embedded-update@:}
34772 @r{ @: M-# w @: @: @:calc-embedded-word@:}
34773 @r{ @: M-# x @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
34774 @r{ @: M-# y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
34775 @r{ @: M-# z @: @: @:calc-user-invocation@:}
34776 @r{ @: M-# : @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-down@:}
34777 @r{ @: M-# _ @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-across@:}
34778 @r{ @: M-# ` @:editing @: 30 @:calc-embedded-edit@:}
34779 @r{ @: M-# 0 @:(zero) @: @:calc-reset@:}
34780
34781 @c
34782 @r{ @: 0-9 @:number @: @:@:number}
34783 @r{ @: . @:number @: @:@:0.number}
34784 @r{ @: _ @:number @: @:-@:number}
34785 @r{ @: e @:number @: @:@:1e number}
34786 @r{ @: # @:number @: @:@:current-radix@t{#}number}
34787 @r{ @: P @:(in number) @: @:+/-@:}
34788 @r{ @: M @:(in number) @: @:mod@:}
34789 @r{ @: @@ ' " @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
34790 @r{ @: h m s @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
34791
34792 @c
34793 @r{ @: ' @:formula @: 37,46 @:@:formula}
34794 @r{ @: $ @:formula @: 37,46 @:$@:formula}
34795 @r{ @: " @:string @: 37,46 @:@:string}
34796
34797 @c
34798 @r{ a b@: + @: @: 2 @:add@:(a,b) a+b}
34799 @r{ a b@: - @: @: 2 @:sub@:(a,b) a@minus{}b}
34800 @r{ a b@: * @: @: 2 @:mul@:(a,b) a b, a*b}
34801 @r{ a b@: / @: @: 2 @:div@:(a,b) a/b}
34802 @r{ a b@: ^ @: @: 2 @:pow@:(a,b) a^b}
34803 @r{ a b@: I ^ @: @: 2 @:nroot@:(a,b) a^(1/b)}
34804 @r{ a b@: % @: @: 2 @:mod@:(a,b) a%b}
34805 @r{ a b@: \ @: @: 2 @:idiv@:(a,b) a\b}
34806 @r{ a b@: : @: @: 2 @:fdiv@:(a,b)}
34807 @r{ a b@: | @: @: 2 @:vconcat@:(a,b) a|b}
34808 @r{ a b@: I | @: @: @:vconcat@:(b,a) b|a}
34809 @r{ a b@: H | @: @: 2 @:append@:(a,b)}
34810 @r{ a b@: I H | @: @: @:append@:(b,a)}
34811 @r{ a@: & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(a) 1/a}
34812 @r{ a@: ! @: @: 1 @:fact@:(a) a!}
34813 @r{ a@: = @: @: 1 @:evalv@:(a)}
34814 @r{ a@: M-% @: @: @:percent@:(a) a%}
34815
34816 @c
34817 @r{ ... a@: @key{RET} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
34818 @r{ ... a@: @key{SPC} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
34819 @r{... a b@: @key{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b a}
34820 @r{. a b c@: M-@key{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b c a}
34821 @r{... a b@: @key{LFD} @: @: 1 @:@:... a b a}
34822 @r{ ... a@: @key{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:...}
34823 @r{... a b@: M-@key{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:... b}
34824 @r{ @: M-@key{RET} @: @: 4 @:calc-last-args@:}
34825 @r{ a@: ` @:editing @: 1,30 @:calc-edit@:}
34826
34827 @c
34828 @r{ ... a@: C-d @: @: 1 @:@:...}
34829 @r{ @: C-k @: @: 27 @:calc-kill@:}
34830 @r{ @: C-w @: @: 27 @:calc-kill-region@:}
34831 @r{ @: C-y @: @: @:calc-yank@:}
34832 @r{ @: C-_ @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
34833 @r{ @: M-k @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-as-kill@:}
34834 @r{ @: M-w @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-region-as-kill@:}
34835
34836 @c
34837 @r{ @: [ @: @: @:@:[...}
34838 @r{[.. a b@: ] @: @: @:@:[a,b]}
34839 @r{ @: ( @: @: @:@:(...}
34840 @r{(.. a b@: ) @: @: @:@:(a,b)}
34841 @r{ @: , @: @: @:@:vector or rect complex}
34842 @r{ @: ; @: @: @:@:matrix or polar complex}
34843 @r{ @: .. @: @: @:@:interval}
34844
34845 @c
34846 @r{ @: ~ @: @: @:calc-num-prefix@:}
34847 @r{ @: < @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-left@:}
34848 @r{ @: > @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-right@:}
34849 @r{ @: @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-down@:}
34850 @r{ @: @} @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-up@:}
34851 @r{ @: ? @: @: @:calc-help@:}
34852
34853 @c
34854 @r{ a@: n @: @: 1 @:neg@:(a) @minus{}a}
34855 @r{ @: o @: @: 4 @:calc-realign@:}
34856 @r{ @: p @:precision @: 31 @:calc-precision@:}
34857 @r{ @: q @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
34858 @r{ @: w @: @: @:calc-why@:}
34859 @r{ @: x @:command @: @:M-x calc-@:command}
34860 @r{ a@: y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
34861
34862 @c
34863 @r{ a@: A @: @: 1 @:abs@:(a)}
34864 @r{ a b@: B @: @: 2 @:log@:(a,b)}
34865 @r{ a b@: I B @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
34866 @r{ a@: C @: @: 1 @:cos@:(a)}
34867 @r{ a@: I C @: @: 1 @:arccos@:(a)}
34868 @r{ a@: H C @: @: 1 @:cosh@:(a)}
34869 @r{ a@: I H C @: @: 1 @:arccosh@:(a)}
34870 @r{ @: D @: @: 4 @:calc-redo@:}
34871 @r{ a@: E @: @: 1 @:exp@:(a)}
34872 @r{ a@: H E @: @: 1 @:exp10@:(a) 10.^a}
34873 @r{ a@: F @: @: 1,11 @:floor@:(a,d)}
34874 @r{ a@: I F @: @: 1,11 @:ceil@:(a,d)}
34875 @r{ a@: H F @: @: 1,11 @:ffloor@:(a,d)}
34876 @r{ a@: I H F @: @: 1,11 @:fceil@:(a,d)}
34877 @r{ a@: G @: @: 1 @:arg@:(a)}
34878 @r{ @: H @:command @: 32 @:@:Hyperbolic}
34879 @r{ @: I @:command @: 32 @:@:Inverse}
34880 @r{ a@: J @: @: 1 @:conj@:(a)}
34881 @r{ @: K @:command @: 32 @:@:Keep-args}
34882 @r{ a@: L @: @: 1 @:ln@:(a)}
34883 @r{ a@: H L @: @: 1 @:log10@:(a)}
34884 @r{ @: M @: @: @:calc-more-recursion-depth@:}
34885 @r{ @: I M @: @: @:calc-less-recursion-depth@:}
34886 @r{ a@: N @: @: 5 @:evalvn@:(a)}
34887 @r{ @: P @: @: @:@:pi}
34888 @r{ @: I P @: @: @:@:gamma}
34889 @r{ @: H P @: @: @:@:e}
34890 @r{ @: I H P @: @: @:@:phi}
34891 @r{ a@: Q @: @: 1 @:sqrt@:(a)}
34892 @r{ a@: I Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
34893 @r{ a@: R @: @: 1,11 @:round@:(a,d)}
34894 @r{ a@: I R @: @: 1,11 @:trunc@:(a,d)}
34895 @r{ a@: H R @: @: 1,11 @:fround@:(a,d)}
34896 @r{ a@: I H R @: @: 1,11 @:ftrunc@:(a,d)}
34897 @r{ a@: S @: @: 1 @:sin@:(a)}
34898 @r{ a@: I S @: @: 1 @:arcsin@:(a)}
34899 @r{ a@: H S @: @: 1 @:sinh@:(a)}
34900 @r{ a@: I H S @: @: 1 @:arcsinh@:(a)}
34901 @r{ a@: T @: @: 1 @:tan@:(a)}
34902 @r{ a@: I T @: @: 1 @:arctan@:(a)}
34903 @r{ a@: H T @: @: 1 @:tanh@:(a)}
34904 @r{ a@: I H T @: @: 1 @:arctanh@:(a)}
34905 @r{ @: U @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
34906 @r{ @: X @: @: 4 @:calc-call-last-kbd-macro@:}
34907
34908 @c
34909 @r{ a b@: a = @: @: 2 @:eq@:(a,b) a=b}
34910 @r{ a b@: a # @: @: 2 @:neq@:(a,b) a!=b}
34911 @r{ a b@: a < @: @: 2 @:lt@:(a,b) a<b}
34912 @r{ a b@: a > @: @: 2 @:gt@:(a,b) a>b}
34913 @r{ a b@: a [ @: @: 2 @:leq@:(a,b) a<=b}
34914 @r{ a b@: a ] @: @: 2 @:geq@:(a,b) a>=b}
34915 @r{ a b@: a @{ @: @: 2 @:in@:(a,b)}
34916 @r{ a b@: a & @: @: 2,45 @:land@:(a,b) a&&b}
34917 @r{ a b@: a | @: @: 2,45 @:lor@:(a,b) a||b}
34918 @r{ a@: a ! @: @: 1,45 @:lnot@:(a) !a}
34919 @r{ a b c@: a : @: @: 45 @:if@:(a,b,c) a?b:c}
34920 @r{ a@: a . @: @: 1 @:rmeq@:(a)}
34921 @r{ a@: a " @: @: 7,8 @:calc-expand-formula@:}
34922
34923 @c
34924 @r{ a@: a + @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:sum@:(a,i,l,h)}
34925 @r{ a@: a - @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:asum@:(a,i,l,h)}
34926 @r{ a@: a * @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:prod@:(a,i,l,h)}
34927 @r{ a b@: a _ @: @: 2 @:subscr@:(a,b) a_b}
34928
34929 @c
34930 @r{ a b@: a \ @: @: 2 @:pdiv@:(a,b)}
34931 @r{ a b@: a % @: @: 2 @:prem@:(a,b)}
34932 @r{ a b@: a / @: @: 2 @:pdivrem@:(a,b) [q,r]}
34933 @r{ a b@: H a / @: @: 2 @:pdivide@:(a,b) q+r/b}
34934
34935 @c
34936 @r{ a@: a a @: @: 1 @:apart@:(a)}
34937 @r{ a@: a b @:old, new @: 38 @:subst@:(a,old,new)}
34938 @r{ a@: a c @:v @: 38 @:collect@:(a,v)}
34939 @r{ a@: a d @:v @: 4,38 @:deriv@:(a,v)}
34940 @r{ a@: H a d @:v @: 4,38 @:tderiv@:(a,v)}
34941 @r{ a@: a e @: @: @:esimplify@:(a)}
34942 @r{ a@: a f @: @: 1 @:factor@:(a)}
34943 @r{ a@: H a f @: @: 1 @:factors@:(a)}
34944 @r{ a b@: a g @: @: 2 @:pgcd@:(a,b)}
34945 @r{ a@: a i @:v @: 38 @:integ@:(a,v)}
34946 @r{ a@: a m @:pats @: 38 @:match@:(a,pats)}
34947 @r{ a@: I a m @:pats @: 38 @:matchnot@:(a,pats)}
34948 @r{ data x@: a p @: @: 28 @:polint@:(data,x)}
34949 @r{ data x@: H a p @: @: 28 @:ratint@:(data,x)}
34950 @r{ a@: a n @: @: 1 @:nrat@:(a)}
34951 @r{ a@: a r @:rules @:4,8,38 @:rewrite@:(a,rules,n)}
34952 @r{ a@: a s @: @: @:simplify@:(a)}
34953 @r{ a@: a t @:v, n @: 31,39 @:taylor@:(a,v,n)}
34954 @r{ a@: a v @: @: 7,8 @:calc-alg-evaluate@:}
34955 @r{ a@: a x @: @: 4,8 @:expand@:(a)}
34956
34957 @c
34958 @r{ data@: a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:fit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
34959 @r{ data@: I a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:xfit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
34960 @r{ data@: H a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:efit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
34961 @r{ a@: a I @:v, l, h @: 38 @:ninteg@:(a,v,l,h)}
34962 @r{ a b@: a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeq@:(op,a,b)}
34963 @r{ a b@: I a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqr@:(op,a,b)}
34964 @r{ a b@: H a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqp@:(op,a,b)}
34965 @r{ a g@: a N @:v @: 38 @:minimize@:(a,v,g)}
34966 @r{ a g@: H a N @:v @: 38 @:wminimize@:(a,v,g)}
34967 @r{ a@: a P @:v @: 38 @:roots@:(a,v)}
34968 @r{ a g@: a R @:v @: 38 @:root@:(a,v,g)}
34969 @r{ a g@: H a R @:v @: 38 @:wroot@:(a,v,g)}
34970 @r{ a@: a S @:v @: 38 @:solve@:(a,v)}
34971 @r{ a@: I a S @:v @: 38 @:finv@:(a,v)}
34972 @r{ a@: H a S @:v @: 38 @:fsolve@:(a,v)}
34973 @r{ a@: I H a S @:v @: 38 @:ffinv@:(a,v)}
34974 @r{ a@: a T @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:table@:(a,i,l,h)}
34975 @r{ a g@: a X @:v @: 38 @:maximize@:(a,v,g)}
34976 @r{ a g@: H a X @:v @: 38 @:wmaximize@:(a,v,g)}
34977
34978 @c
34979 @r{ a b@: b a @: @: 9 @:and@:(a,b,w)}
34980 @r{ a@: b c @: @: 9 @:clip@:(a,w)}
34981 @r{ a b@: b d @: @: 9 @:diff@:(a,b,w)}
34982 @r{ a@: b l @: @: 10 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
34983 @r{ a n@: H b l @: @: 9 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
34984 @r{ a@: b n @: @: 9 @:not@:(a,w)}
34985 @r{ a b@: b o @: @: 9 @:or@:(a,b,w)}
34986 @r{ v@: b p @: @: 1 @:vpack@:(v)}
34987 @r{ a@: b r @: @: 10 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
34988 @r{ a n@: H b r @: @: 9 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
34989 @r{ a@: b t @: @: 10 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
34990 @r{ a n@: H b t @: @: 9 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
34991 @r{ a@: b u @: @: 1 @:vunpack@:(a)}
34992 @r{ @: b w @:w @: 9,50 @:calc-word-size@:}
34993 @r{ a b@: b x @: @: 9 @:xor@:(a,b,w)}
34994
34995 @c
34996 @r{c s l p@: b D @: @: @:ddb@:(c,s,l,p)}
34997 @r{ r n p@: b F @: @: @:fv@:(r,n,p)}
34998 @r{ r n p@: I b F @: @: @:fvb@:(r,n,p)}
34999 @r{ r n p@: H b F @: @: @:fvl@:(r,n,p)}
35000 @r{ v@: b I @: @: 19 @:irr@:(v)}
35001 @r{ v@: I b I @: @: 19 @:irrb@:(v)}
35002 @r{ a@: b L @: @: 10 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35003 @r{ a n@: H b L @: @: 9 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35004 @r{ r n a@: b M @: @: @:pmt@:(r,n,a)}
35005 @r{ r n a@: I b M @: @: @:pmtb@:(r,n,a)}
35006 @r{ r n a@: H b M @: @: @:pmtl@:(r,n,a)}
35007 @r{ r v@: b N @: @: 19 @:npv@:(r,v)}
35008 @r{ r v@: I b N @: @: 19 @:npvb@:(r,v)}
35009 @r{ r n p@: b P @: @: @:pv@:(r,n,p)}
35010 @r{ r n p@: I b P @: @: @:pvb@:(r,n,p)}
35011 @r{ r n p@: H b P @: @: @:pvl@:(r,n,p)}
35012 @r{ a@: b R @: @: 10 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35013 @r{ a n@: H b R @: @: 9 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35014 @r{ c s l@: b S @: @: @:sln@:(c,s,l)}
35015 @r{ n p a@: b T @: @: @:rate@:(n,p,a)}
35016 @r{ n p a@: I b T @: @: @:rateb@:(n,p,a)}
35017 @r{ n p a@: H b T @: @: @:ratel@:(n,p,a)}
35018 @r{c s l p@: b Y @: @: @:syd@:(c,s,l,p)}
35019
35020 @r{ r p a@: b # @: @: @:nper@:(r,p,a)}
35021 @r{ r p a@: I b # @: @: @:nperb@:(r,p,a)}
35022 @r{ r p a@: H b # @: @: @:nperl@:(r,p,a)}
35023 @r{ a b@: b % @: @: @:relch@:(a,b)}
35024
35025 @c
35026 @r{ a@: c c @: @: 5 @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35027 @r{ a@: c 0-9 @: @: @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35028 @r{ a@: H c c @: @: 5 @:clean@:(a,p)}
35029 @r{ a@: H c 0-9 @: @: @:clean@:(a,p)}
35030 @r{ a@: c d @: @: 1 @:deg@:(a)}
35031 @r{ a@: c f @: @: 1 @:pfloat@:(a)}
35032 @r{ a@: H c f @: @: 1 @:float@:(a)}
35033 @r{ a@: c h @: @: 1 @:hms@:(a)}
35034 @r{ a@: c p @: @: @:polar@:(a)}
35035 @r{ a@: I c p @: @: @:rect@:(a)}
35036 @r{ a@: c r @: @: 1 @:rad@:(a)}
35037
35038 @c
35039 @r{ a@: c F @: @: 5 @:pfrac@:(a,p)}
35040 @r{ a@: H c F @: @: 5 @:frac@:(a,p)}
35041
35042 @c
35043 @r{ a@: c % @: @: @:percent@:(a*100)}
35044
35045 @c
35046 @r{ @: d . @:char @: 50 @:calc-point-char@:}
35047 @r{ @: d , @:char @: 50 @:calc-group-char@:}
35048 @r{ @: d < @: @: 13,50 @:calc-left-justify@:}
35049 @r{ @: d = @: @: 13,50 @:calc-center-justify@:}
35050 @r{ @: d > @: @: 13,50 @:calc-right-justify@:}
35051 @r{ @: d @{ @:label @: 50 @:calc-left-label@:}
35052 @r{ @: d @} @:label @: 50 @:calc-right-label@:}
35053 @r{ @: d [ @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-up@:}
35054 @r{ @: d ] @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-down@:}
35055 @r{ @: d " @: @: 12,50 @:calc-display-strings@:}
35056 @r{ @: d @key{SPC} @: @: @:calc-refresh@:}
35057 @r{ @: d @key{RET} @: @: 1 @:calc-refresh-top@:}
35058
35059 @c
35060 @r{ @: d 0 @: @: 50 @:calc-decimal-radix@:}
35061 @r{ @: d 2 @: @: 50 @:calc-binary-radix@:}
35062 @r{ @: d 6 @: @: 50 @:calc-hex-radix@:}
35063 @r{ @: d 8 @: @: 50 @:calc-octal-radix@:}
35064
35065 @c
35066 @r{ @: d b @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-line-breaking@:}
35067 @r{ @: d c @: @: 50 @:calc-complex-notation@:}
35068 @r{ @: d d @:format @: 50 @:calc-date-notation@:}
35069 @r{ @: d e @: @: 5,50 @:calc-eng-notation@:}
35070 @r{ @: d f @:num @: 31,50 @:calc-fix-notation@:}
35071 @r{ @: d g @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-group-digits@:}
35072 @r{ @: d h @:format @: 50 @:calc-hms-notation@:}
35073 @r{ @: d i @: @: 50 @:calc-i-notation@:}
35074 @r{ @: d j @: @: 50 @:calc-j-notation@:}
35075 @r{ @: d l @: @: 12,50 @:calc-line-numbering@:}
35076 @r{ @: d n @: @: 5,50 @:calc-normal-notation@:}
35077 @r{ @: d o @:format @: 50 @:calc-over-notation@:}
35078 @r{ @: d p @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-plain@:}
35079 @r{ @: d r @:radix @: 31,50 @:calc-radix@:}
35080 @r{ @: d s @: @: 5,50 @:calc-sci-notation@:}
35081 @r{ @: d t @: @: 27 @:calc-truncate-stack@:}
35082 @r{ @: d w @: @: 12,13 @:calc-auto-why@:}
35083 @r{ @: d z @: @: 12,50 @:calc-leading-zeros@:}
35084
35085 @c
35086 @r{ @: d B @: @: 50 @:calc-big-language@:}
35087 @r{ @: d C @: @: 50 @:calc-c-language@:}
35088 @r{ @: d E @: @: 50 @:calc-eqn-language@:}
35089 @r{ @: d F @: @: 50 @:calc-fortran-language@:}
35090 @r{ @: d M @: @: 50 @:calc-mathematica-language@:}
35091 @r{ @: d N @: @: 50 @:calc-normal-language@:}
35092 @r{ @: d O @: @: 50 @:calc-flat-language@:}
35093 @r{ @: d P @: @: 50 @:calc-pascal-language@:}
35094 @r{ @: d T @: @: 50 @:calc-tex-language@:}
35095 @r{ @: d L @: @: 50 @:calc-latex-language@:}
35096 @r{ @: d U @: @: 50 @:calc-unformatted-language@:}
35097 @r{ @: d W @: @: 50 @:calc-maple-language@:}
35098
35099 @c
35100 @r{ a@: f [ @: @: 4 @:decr@:(a,n)}
35101 @r{ a@: f ] @: @: 4 @:incr@:(a,n)}
35102
35103 @c
35104 @r{ a b@: f b @: @: 2 @:beta@:(a,b)}
35105 @r{ a@: f e @: @: 1 @:erf@:(a)}
35106 @r{ a@: I f e @: @: 1 @:erfc@:(a)}
35107 @r{ a@: f g @: @: 1 @:gamma@:(a)}
35108 @r{ a b@: f h @: @: 2 @:hypot@:(a,b)}
35109 @r{ a@: f i @: @: 1 @:im@:(a)}
35110 @r{ n a@: f j @: @: 2 @:besJ@:(n,a)}
35111 @r{ a b@: f n @: @: 2 @:min@:(a,b)}
35112 @r{ a@: f r @: @: 1 @:re@:(a)}
35113 @r{ a@: f s @: @: 1 @:sign@:(a)}
35114 @r{ a b@: f x @: @: 2 @:max@:(a,b)}
35115 @r{ n a@: f y @: @: 2 @:besY@:(n,a)}
35116
35117 @c
35118 @r{ a@: f A @: @: 1 @:abssqr@:(a)}
35119 @r{ x a b@: f B @: @: @:betaI@:(x,a,b)}
35120 @r{ x a b@: H f B @: @: @:betaB@:(x,a,b)}
35121 @r{ a@: f E @: @: 1 @:expm1@:(a)}
35122 @r{ a x@: f G @: @: 2 @:gammaP@:(a,x)}
35123 @r{ a x@: I f G @: @: 2 @:gammaQ@:(a,x)}
35124 @r{ a x@: H f G @: @: 2 @:gammag@:(a,x)}
35125 @r{ a x@: I H f G @: @: 2 @:gammaG@:(a,x)}
35126 @r{ a b@: f I @: @: 2 @:ilog@:(a,b)}
35127 @r{ a b@: I f I @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35128 @r{ a@: f L @: @: 1 @:lnp1@:(a)}
35129 @r{ a@: f M @: @: 1 @:mant@:(a)}
35130 @r{ a@: f Q @: @: 1 @:isqrt@:(a)}
35131 @r{ a@: I f Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35132 @r{ a n@: f S @: @: 2 @:scf@:(a,n)}
35133 @r{ y x@: f T @: @: @:arctan2@:(y,x)}
35134 @r{ a@: f X @: @: 1 @:xpon@:(a)}
35135
35136 @c
35137 @r{ x y@: g a @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add@:}
35138 @r{ @: g b @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-border@:}
35139 @r{ @: g c @: @: @:calc-graph-clear@:}
35140 @r{ @: g d @: @: 41 @:calc-graph-delete@:}
35141 @r{ x y@: g f @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast@:}
35142 @r{ @: g g @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-grid@:}
35143 @r{ @: g h @:title @: @:calc-graph-header@:}
35144 @r{ @: g j @: @: 4 @:calc-graph-juggle@:}
35145 @r{ @: g k @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-key@:}
35146 @r{ @: g l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-x@:}
35147 @r{ @: g n @:name @: @:calc-graph-name@:}
35148 @r{ @: g p @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-plot@:}
35149 @r{ @: g q @: @: @:calc-graph-quit@:}
35150 @r{ @: g r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-x@:}
35151 @r{ @: g s @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-line-style@:}
35152 @r{ @: g t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-x@:}
35153 @r{ @: g v @: @: @:calc-graph-view-commands@:}
35154 @r{ @: g x @:display @: @:calc-graph-display@:}
35155 @r{ @: g z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-x@:}
35156
35157 @c
35158 @r{ x y z@: g A @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add-3d@:}
35159 @r{ @: g C @:command @: @:calc-graph-command@:}
35160 @r{ @: g D @:device @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-device@:}
35161 @r{ x y z@: g F @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast-3d@:}
35162 @r{ @: g H @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-hide@:}
35163 @r{ @: g K @: @: @:calc-graph-kill@:}
35164 @r{ @: g L @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-y@:}
35165 @r{ @: g N @:number @: 43,51 @:calc-graph-num-points@:}
35166 @r{ @: g O @:filename @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-output@:}
35167 @r{ @: g P @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-print@:}
35168 @r{ @: g R @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-y@:}
35169 @r{ @: g S @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-point-style@:}
35170 @r{ @: g T @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-y@:}
35171 @r{ @: g V @: @: @:calc-graph-view-trail@:}
35172 @r{ @: g X @:format @: @:calc-graph-geometry@:}
35173 @r{ @: g Z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-y@:}
35174
35175 @c
35176 @r{ @: g C-l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-z@:}
35177 @r{ @: g C-r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-z@:}
35178 @r{ @: g C-t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-z@:}
35179
35180 @c
35181 @r{ @: h b @: @: @:calc-describe-bindings@:}
35182 @r{ @: h c @:key @: @:calc-describe-key-briefly@:}
35183 @r{ @: h f @:function @: @:calc-describe-function@:}
35184 @r{ @: h h @: @: @:calc-full-help@:}
35185 @r{ @: h i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35186 @r{ @: h k @:key @: @:calc-describe-key@:}
35187 @r{ @: h n @: @: @:calc-view-news@:}
35188 @r{ @: h s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35189 @r{ @: h t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35190 @r{ @: h v @:var @: @:calc-describe-variable@:}
35191
35192 @c
35193 @r{ @: j 1-9 @: @: @:calc-select-part@:}
35194 @r{ @: j @key{RET} @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-selection@:}
35195 @r{ @: j @key{DEL} @: @: 27 @:calc-del-selection@:}
35196 @r{ @: j ' @:formula @: 27 @:calc-enter-selection@:}
35197 @r{ @: j ` @:editing @: 27,30 @:calc-edit-selection@:}
35198 @r{ @: j " @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-expand-formula@:}
35199
35200 @c
35201 @r{ @: j + @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-add-both-sides@:}
35202 @r{ @: j - @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-sub-both-sides@:}
35203 @r{ @: j * @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-mul-both-sides@:}
35204 @r{ @: j / @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-div-both-sides@:}
35205 @r{ @: j & @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-invert@:}
35206
35207 @c
35208 @r{ @: j a @: @: 27 @:calc-select-additional@:}
35209 @r{ @: j b @: @: 12 @:calc-break-selections@:}
35210 @r{ @: j c @: @: @:calc-clear-selections@:}
35211 @r{ @: j d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-selections@:}
35212 @r{ @: j e @: @: 12 @:calc-enable-selections@:}
35213 @r{ @: j l @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-less@:}
35214 @r{ @: j m @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-more@:}
35215 @r{ @: j n @: @: 4 @:calc-select-next@:}
35216 @r{ @: j o @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once@:}
35217 @r{ @: j p @: @: 4 @:calc-select-previous@:}
35218 @r{ @: j r @:rules @:4,8,27 @:calc-rewrite-selection@:}
35219 @r{ @: j s @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here@:}
35220 @r{ @: j u @: @: 27 @:calc-unselect@:}
35221 @r{ @: j v @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-evaluate@:}
35222
35223 @c
35224 @r{ @: j C @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-commute@:}
35225 @r{ @: j D @: @: 4,27 @:calc-sel-distribute@:}
35226 @r{ @: j E @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-jump-equals@:}
35227 @r{ @: j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@:}
35228 @r{ @: H j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@: (full)}
35229 @r{ @: j L @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-left@:}
35230 @r{ @: j M @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-merge@:}
35231 @r{ @: j N @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-negate@:}
35232 @r{ @: j O @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once-maybe@:}
35233 @r{ @: j R @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-right@:}
35234 @r{ @: j S @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here-maybe@:}
35235 @r{ @: j U @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-unpack@:}
35236
35237 @c
35238 @r{ @: k a @: @: @:calc-random-again@:}
35239 @r{ n@: k b @: @: 1 @:bern@:(n)}
35240 @r{ n x@: H k b @: @: 2 @:bern@:(n,x)}
35241 @r{ n m@: k c @: @: 2 @:choose@:(n,m)}
35242 @r{ n m@: H k c @: @: 2 @:perm@:(n,m)}
35243 @r{ n@: k d @: @: 1 @:dfact@:(n) n!!}
35244 @r{ n@: k e @: @: 1 @:euler@:(n)}
35245 @r{ n x@: H k e @: @: 2 @:euler@:(n,x)}
35246 @r{ n@: k f @: @: 4 @:prfac@:(n)}
35247 @r{ n m@: k g @: @: 2 @:gcd@:(n,m)}
35248 @r{ m n@: k h @: @: 14 @:shuffle@:(n,m)}
35249 @r{ n m@: k l @: @: 2 @:lcm@:(n,m)}
35250 @r{ n@: k m @: @: 1 @:moebius@:(n)}
35251 @r{ n@: k n @: @: 4 @:nextprime@:(n)}
35252 @r{ n@: I k n @: @: 4 @:prevprime@:(n)}
35253 @r{ n@: k p @: @: 4,28 @:calc-prime-test@:}
35254 @r{ m@: k r @: @: 14 @:random@:(m)}
35255 @r{ n m@: k s @: @: 2 @:stir1@:(n,m)}
35256 @r{ n m@: H k s @: @: 2 @:stir2@:(n,m)}
35257 @r{ n@: k t @: @: 1 @:totient@:(n)}
35258
35259 @c
35260 @r{ n p x@: k B @: @: @:utpb@:(x,n,p)}
35261 @r{ n p x@: I k B @: @: @:ltpb@:(x,n,p)}
35262 @r{ v x@: k C @: @: @:utpc@:(x,v)}
35263 @r{ v x@: I k C @: @: @:ltpc@:(x,v)}
35264 @r{ n m@: k E @: @: @:egcd@:(n,m)}
35265 @r{v1 v2 x@: k F @: @: @:utpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
35266 @r{v1 v2 x@: I k F @: @: @:ltpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
35267 @r{ m s x@: k N @: @: @:utpn@:(x,m,s)}
35268 @r{ m s x@: I k N @: @: @:ltpn@:(x,m,s)}
35269 @r{ m x@: k P @: @: @:utpp@:(x,m)}
35270 @r{ m x@: I k P @: @: @:ltpp@:(x,m)}
35271 @r{ v x@: k T @: @: @:utpt@:(x,v)}
35272 @r{ v x@: I k T @: @: @:ltpt@:(x,v)}
35273
35274 @c
35275 @r{ @: m a @: @: 12,13 @:calc-algebraic-mode@:}
35276 @r{ @: m d @: @: @:calc-degrees-mode@:}
35277 @r{ @: m f @: @: 12 @:calc-frac-mode@:}
35278 @r{ @: m g @: @: 52 @:calc-get-modes@:}
35279 @r{ @: m h @: @: @:calc-hms-mode@:}
35280 @r{ @: m i @: @: 12,13 @:calc-infinite-mode@:}
35281 @r{ @: m m @: @: @:calc-save-modes@:}
35282 @r{ @: m p @: @: 12 @:calc-polar-mode@:}
35283 @r{ @: m r @: @: @:calc-radians-mode@:}
35284 @r{ @: m s @: @: 12 @:calc-symbolic-mode@:}
35285 @r{ @: m t @: @: 12 @:calc-total-algebraic-mode@:}
35286 @r{ @: m v @: @: 12,13 @:calc-matrix-mode@:}
35287 @r{ @: m w @: @: 13 @:calc-working@:}
35288 @r{ @: m x @: @: @:calc-always-load-extensions@:}
35289
35290 @c
35291 @r{ @: m A @: @: 12 @:calc-alg-simplify-mode@:}
35292 @r{ @: m B @: @: 12 @:calc-bin-simplify-mode@:}
35293 @r{ @: m C @: @: 12 @:calc-auto-recompute@:}
35294 @r{ @: m D @: @: @:calc-default-simplify-mode@:}
35295 @r{ @: m E @: @: 12 @:calc-ext-simplify-mode@:}
35296 @r{ @: m F @:filename @: 13 @:calc-settings-file-name@:}
35297 @r{ @: m N @: @: 12 @:calc-num-simplify-mode@:}
35298 @r{ @: m O @: @: 12 @:calc-no-simplify-mode@:}
35299 @r{ @: m R @: @: 12,13 @:calc-mode-record-mode@:}
35300 @r{ @: m S @: @: 12 @:calc-shift-prefix@:}
35301 @r{ @: m U @: @: 12 @:calc-units-simplify-mode@:}
35302
35303 @c
35304 @r{ @: s c @:var1, var2 @: 29 @:calc-copy-variable@:}
35305 @r{ @: s d @:var, decl @: @:calc-declare-variable@:}
35306 @r{ @: s e @:var, editing @: 29,30 @:calc-edit-variable@:}
35307 @r{ @: s i @:buffer @: @:calc-insert-variables@:}
35308 @r{ a b@: s l @:var @: 29 @:@:a (letting var=b)}
35309 @r{ a ...@: s m @:op, var @: 22,29 @:calc-store-map@:}
35310 @r{ @: s n @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-neg@: (v/-1)}
35311 @r{ @: s p @:var @: 29 @:calc-permanent-variable@:}
35312 @r{ @: s r @:var @: 29 @:@:v (recalled value)}
35313 @r{ @: r 0-9 @: @: @:calc-recall-quick@:}
35314 @r{ a@: s s @:var @: 28,29 @:calc-store@:}
35315 @r{ a@: s 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-quick@:}
35316 @r{ a@: s t @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-into@:}
35317 @r{ a@: t 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-into-quick@:}
35318 @r{ @: s u @:var @: 29 @:calc-unstore@:}
35319 @r{ a@: s x @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-exchange@:}
35320
35321 @c
35322 @r{ @: s A @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-AlgSimpRules@:}
35323 @r{ @: s D @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Decls@:}
35324 @r{ @: s E @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-EvalRules@:}
35325 @r{ @: s F @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-FitRules@:}
35326 @r{ @: s G @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-GenCount@:}
35327 @r{ @: s H @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Holidays@:}
35328 @r{ @: s I @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-IntegLimit@:}
35329 @r{ @: s L @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-LineStyles@:}
35330 @r{ @: s P @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PointStyles@:}
35331 @r{ @: s R @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PlotRejects@:}
35332 @r{ @: s T @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-TimeZone@:}
35333 @r{ @: s U @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Units@:}
35334 @r{ @: s X @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-ExtSimpRules@:}
35335
35336 @c
35337 @r{ a@: s + @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-plus@: (v+a)}
35338 @r{ a@: s - @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-minus@: (v-a)}
35339 @r{ a@: s * @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-times@: (v*a)}
35340 @r{ a@: s / @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-div@: (v/a)}
35341 @r{ a@: s ^ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-power@: (v^a)}
35342 @r{ a@: s | @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-concat@: (v|a)}
35343 @r{ @: s & @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-inv@: (v^-1)}
35344 @r{ @: s [ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-decr@: (v-1)}
35345 @r{ @: s ] @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-incr@: (v-(-1))}
35346 @r{ a b@: s : @: @: 2 @:assign@:(a,b) a @t{:=} b}
35347 @r{ a@: s = @: @: 1 @:evalto@:(a,b) a @t{=>}}
35348
35349 @c
35350 @r{ @: t [ @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-first@:}
35351 @r{ @: t ] @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-last@:}
35352 @r{ @: t < @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-left@:}
35353 @r{ @: t > @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-right@:}
35354 @r{ @: t . @: @: 12 @:calc-full-trail-vectors@:}
35355
35356 @c
35357 @r{ @: t b @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-backward@:}
35358 @r{ @: t d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-trail-display@:}
35359 @r{ @: t f @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-forward@:}
35360 @r{ @: t h @: @: @:calc-trail-here@:}
35361 @r{ @: t i @: @: @:calc-trail-in@:}
35362 @r{ @: t k @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-kill@:}
35363 @r{ @: t m @:string @: @:calc-trail-marker@:}
35364 @r{ @: t n @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-next@:}
35365 @r{ @: t o @: @: @:calc-trail-out@:}
35366 @r{ @: t p @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-previous@:}
35367 @r{ @: t r @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-backward@:}
35368 @r{ @: t s @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-forward@:}
35369 @r{ @: t y @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-yank@:}
35370
35371 @c
35372 @r{ d@: t C @:oz, nz @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
35373 @r{d oz nz@: t C @:$ @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
35374 @r{ d@: t D @: @: 15 @:date@:(d)}
35375 @r{ d@: t I @: @: 4 @:incmonth@:(d,n)}
35376 @r{ d@: t J @: @: 16 @:julian@:(d,z)}
35377 @r{ d@: t M @: @: 17 @:newmonth@:(d,n)}
35378 @r{ @: t N @: @: 16 @:now@:(z)}
35379 @r{ d@: t P @:1 @: 31 @:year@:(d)}
35380 @r{ d@: t P @:2 @: 31 @:month@:(d)}
35381 @r{ d@: t P @:3 @: 31 @:day@:(d)}
35382 @r{ d@: t P @:4 @: 31 @:hour@:(d)}
35383 @r{ d@: t P @:5 @: 31 @:minute@:(d)}
35384 @r{ d@: t P @:6 @: 31 @:second@:(d)}
35385 @r{ d@: t P @:7 @: 31 @:weekday@:(d)}
35386 @r{ d@: t P @:8 @: 31 @:yearday@:(d)}
35387 @r{ d@: t P @:9 @: 31 @:time@:(d)}
35388 @r{ d@: t U @: @: 16 @:unixtime@:(d,z)}
35389 @r{ d@: t W @: @: 17 @:newweek@:(d,w)}
35390 @r{ d@: t Y @: @: 17 @:newyear@:(d,n)}
35391
35392 @c
35393 @r{ a b@: t + @: @: 2 @:badd@:(a,b)}
35394 @r{ a b@: t - @: @: 2 @:bsub@:(a,b)}
35395
35396 @c
35397 @r{ @: u a @: @: 12 @:calc-autorange-units@:}
35398 @r{ a@: u b @: @: @:calc-base-units@:}
35399 @r{ a@: u c @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-units@:}
35400 @r{ defn@: u d @:unit, descr @: @:calc-define-unit@:}
35401 @r{ @: u e @: @: @:calc-explain-units@:}
35402 @r{ @: u g @:unit @: @:calc-get-unit-definition@:}
35403 @r{ @: u p @: @: @:calc-permanent-units@:}
35404 @r{ a@: u r @: @: @:calc-remove-units@:}
35405 @r{ a@: u s @: @: @:usimplify@:(a)}
35406 @r{ a@: u t @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-temperature@:}
35407 @r{ @: u u @:unit @: @:calc-undefine-unit@:}
35408 @r{ @: u v @: @: @:calc-enter-units-table@:}
35409 @r{ a@: u x @: @: @:calc-extract-units@:}
35410 @r{ a@: u 0-9 @: @: @:calc-quick-units@:}
35411
35412 @c
35413 @r{ v1 v2@: u C @: @: 20 @:vcov@:(v1,v2)}
35414 @r{ v1 v2@: I u C @: @: 20 @:vpcov@:(v1,v2)}
35415 @r{ v1 v2@: H u C @: @: 20 @:vcorr@:(v1,v2)}
35416 @r{ v@: u G @: @: 19 @:vgmean@:(v)}
35417 @r{ a b@: H u G @: @: 2 @:agmean@:(a,b)}
35418 @r{ v@: u M @: @: 19 @:vmean@:(v)}
35419 @r{ v@: I u M @: @: 19 @:vmeane@:(v)}
35420 @r{ v@: H u M @: @: 19 @:vmedian@:(v)}
35421 @r{ v@: I H u M @: @: 19 @:vhmean@:(v)}
35422 @r{ v@: u N @: @: 19 @:vmin@:(v)}
35423 @r{ v@: u S @: @: 19 @:vsdev@:(v)}
35424 @r{ v@: I u S @: @: 19 @:vpsdev@:(v)}
35425 @r{ v@: H u S @: @: 19 @:vvar@:(v)}
35426 @r{ v@: I H u S @: @: 19 @:vpvar@:(v)}
35427 @r{ @: u V @: @: @:calc-view-units-table@:}
35428 @r{ v@: u X @: @: 19 @:vmax@:(v)}
35429
35430 @c
35431 @r{ v@: u + @: @: 19 @:vsum@:(v)}
35432 @r{ v@: u * @: @: 19 @:vprod@:(v)}
35433 @r{ v@: u # @: @: 19 @:vcount@:(v)}
35434
35435 @c
35436 @r{ @: V ( @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-parens@:}
35437 @r{ @: V @{ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-braces@:}
35438 @r{ @: V [ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-brackets@:}
35439 @r{ @: V ] @:ROCP @: 50 @:calc-matrix-brackets@:}
35440 @r{ @: V , @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-commas@:}
35441 @r{ @: V < @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-left-justify@:}
35442 @r{ @: V = @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-center-justify@:}
35443 @r{ @: V > @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-right-justify@:}
35444 @r{ @: V / @: @: 12,50 @:calc-break-vectors@:}
35445 @r{ @: V . @: @: 12,50 @:calc-full-vectors@:}
35446
35447 @c
35448 @r{ s t@: V ^ @: @: 2 @:vint@:(s,t)}
35449 @r{ s t@: V - @: @: 2 @:vdiff@:(s,t)}
35450 @r{ s@: V ~ @: @: 1 @:vcompl@:(s)}
35451 @r{ s@: V # @: @: 1 @:vcard@:(s)}
35452 @r{ s@: V : @: @: 1 @:vspan@:(s)}
35453 @r{ s@: V + @: @: 1 @:rdup@:(s)}
35454
35455 @c
35456 @r{ m@: V & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(m) 1/m}
35457
35458 @c
35459 @r{ v@: v a @:n @: @:arrange@:(v,n)}
35460 @r{ a@: v b @:n @: @:cvec@:(a,n)}
35461 @r{ v@: v c @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mcol@:(v,n)}
35462 @r{ v@: v c @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrcol@:(v,-n)}
35463 @r{ m@: v c @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
35464 @r{ v@: v d @: @: 25 @:diag@:(v,n)}
35465 @r{ v m@: v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m)}
35466 @r{ v m f@: H v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m,f)}
35467 @r{ v a@: v f @: @: 26 @:find@:(v,a,n)}
35468 @r{ v@: v h @: @: 1 @:head@:(v)}
35469 @r{ v@: I v h @: @: 1 @:tail@:(v)}
35470 @r{ v@: H v h @: @: 1 @:rhead@:(v)}
35471 @r{ v@: I H v h @: @: 1 @:rtail@:(v)}
35472 @r{ @: v i @:n @: 31 @:idn@:(1,n)}
35473 @r{ @: v i @:0 @: 31 @:idn@:(1)}
35474 @r{ h t@: v k @: @: 2 @:cons@:(h,t)}
35475 @r{ h t@: H v k @: @: 2 @:rcons@:(h,t)}
35476 @r{ v@: v l @: @: 1 @:vlen@:(v)}
35477 @r{ v@: H v l @: @: 1 @:mdims@:(v)}
35478 @r{ v m@: v m @: @: 2 @:vmask@:(v,m)}
35479 @r{ v@: v n @: @: 1 @:rnorm@:(v)}
35480 @r{ a b c@: v p @: @: 24 @:calc-pack@:}
35481 @r{ v@: v r @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mrow@:(v,n)}
35482 @r{ v@: v r @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrrow@:(v,-n)}
35483 @r{ m@: v r @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
35484 @r{ v i j@: v s @: @: @:subvec@:(v,i,j)}
35485 @r{ v i j@: I v s @: @: @:rsubvec@:(v,i,j)}
35486 @r{ m@: v t @: @: 1 @:trn@:(m)}
35487 @r{ v@: v u @: @: 24 @:calc-unpack@:}
35488 @r{ v@: v v @: @: 1 @:rev@:(v)}
35489 @r{ @: v x @:n @: 31 @:index@:(n)}
35490 @r{ n s i@: C-u v x @: @: @:index@:(n,s,i)}
35491
35492 @c
35493 @r{ v@: V A @:op @: 22 @:apply@:(op,v)}
35494 @r{ v1 v2@: V C @: @: 2 @:cross@:(v1,v2)}
35495 @r{ m@: V D @: @: 1 @:det@:(m)}
35496 @r{ s@: V E @: @: 1 @:venum@:(s)}
35497 @r{ s@: V F @: @: 1 @:vfloor@:(s)}
35498 @r{ v@: V G @: @: @:grade@:(v)}
35499 @r{ v@: I V G @: @: @:rgrade@:(v)}
35500 @r{ v@: V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,n)}
35501 @r{ v w@: H V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,w,n)}
35502 @r{ v1 v2@: V I @:mop aop @: 22 @:inner@:(mop,aop,v1,v2)}
35503 @r{ m@: V J @: @: 1 @:ctrn@:(m)}
35504 @r{ m@: V L @: @: 1 @:lud@:(m)}
35505 @r{ v@: V M @:op @: 22,23 @:map@:(op,v)}
35506 @r{ v@: V N @: @: 1 @:cnorm@:(v)}
35507 @r{ v1 v2@: V O @:op @: 22 @:outer@:(op,v1,v2)}
35508 @r{ v@: V R @:op @: 22,23 @:reduce@:(op,v)}
35509 @r{ v@: I V R @:op @: 22,23 @:rreduce@:(op,v)}
35510 @r{ a n@: H V R @:op @: 22 @:nest@:(op,a,n)}
35511 @r{ a@: I H V R @:op @: 22 @:fixp@:(op,a)}
35512 @r{ v@: V S @: @: @:sort@:(v)}
35513 @r{ v@: I V S @: @: @:rsort@:(v)}
35514 @r{ m@: V T @: @: 1 @:tr@:(m)}
35515 @r{ v@: V U @:op @: 22 @:accum@:(op,v)}
35516 @r{ v@: I V U @:op @: 22 @:raccum@:(op,v)}
35517 @r{ a n@: H V U @:op @: 22 @:anest@:(op,a,n)}
35518 @r{ a@: I H V U @:op @: 22 @:afixp@:(op,a)}
35519 @r{ s t@: V V @: @: 2 @:vunion@:(s,t)}
35520 @r{ s t@: V X @: @: 2 @:vxor@:(s,t)}
35521
35522 @c
35523 @r{ @: Y @: @: @:@:user commands}
35524
35525 @c
35526 @r{ @: z @: @: @:@:user commands}
35527
35528 @c
35529 @r{ c@: Z [ @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-if@:}
35530 @r{ c@: Z | @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-else-if@:}
35531 @r{ @: Z : @: @: @:calc-kbd-else@:}
35532 @r{ @: Z ] @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-if@:}
35533
35534 @c
35535 @r{ @: Z @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-kbd-loop@:}
35536 @r{ c@: Z / @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-break@:}
35537 @r{ @: Z @} @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-loop@:}
35538 @r{ n@: Z < @: @: @:calc-kbd-repeat@:}
35539 @r{ @: Z > @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-repeat@:}
35540 @r{ n m@: Z ( @: @: @:calc-kbd-for@:}
35541 @r{ s@: Z ) @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-for@:}
35542
35543 @c
35544 @r{ @: Z C-g @: @: @:@:cancel if/loop command}
35545
35546 @c
35547 @r{ @: Z ` @: @: @:calc-kbd-push@:}
35548 @r{ @: Z ' @: @: @:calc-kbd-pop@:}
35549 @r{ a@: Z = @:message @: 28 @:calc-kbd-report@:}
35550 @r{ @: Z # @:prompt @: @:calc-kbd-query@:}
35551
35552 @c
35553 @r{ comp@: Z C @:func, args @: 50 @:calc-user-define-composition@:}
35554 @r{ @: Z D @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define@:}
35555 @r{ @: Z E @:key, editing @: 30 @:calc-user-define-edit@:}
35556 @r{ defn@: Z F @:k, c, f, a, n@: 28 @:calc-user-define-formula@:}
35557 @r{ @: Z G @:key @: @:calc-get-user-defn@:}
35558 @r{ @: Z I @: @: @:calc-user-define-invocation@:}
35559 @r{ @: Z K @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define-kbd-macro@:}
35560 @r{ @: Z P @:key @: @:calc-user-define-permanent@:}
35561 @r{ @: Z S @: @: 30 @:calc-edit-user-syntax@:}
35562 @r{ @: Z T @: @: 12 @:calc-timing@:}
35563 @r{ @: Z U @:key @: @:calc-user-undefine@:}
35564
35565 @end format
35566
35567 @noindent
35568 NOTES
35569
35570 @enumerate
35571 @c 1
35572 @item
35573 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
35574 Negative prefix arguments apply to the @expr{-n}th stack entry.
35575 A prefix of zero applies to the entire stack. (For @key{LFD} and
35576 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, the meaning of the sign is reversed.)
35577
35578 @c 2
35579 @item
35580 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
35581 Negative prefix arguments apply to the top stack entry
35582 and the next @expr{-n} stack entries.
35583
35584 @c 3
35585 @item
35586 Positive prefix arguments rotate top @expr{n} stack entries by one.
35587 Negative prefix arguments rotate the entire stack by @expr{-n}.
35588 A prefix of zero reverses the entire stack.
35589
35590 @c 4
35591 @item
35592 Prefix argument specifies a repeat count or distance.
35593
35594 @c 5
35595 @item
35596 Positive prefix arguments specify a precision @expr{p}.
35597 Negative prefix arguments reduce the current precision by @expr{-p}.
35598
35599 @c 6
35600 @item
35601 A prefix argument is interpreted as an additional step-size parameter.
35602 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix means to prompt for the step size.
35603
35604 @c 7
35605 @item
35606 A prefix argument specifies simplification level and depth.
35607 1=Default, 2=like @kbd{a s}, 3=like @kbd{a e}.
35608
35609 @c 8
35610 @item
35611 A negative prefix operates only on the top level of the input formula.
35612
35613 @c 9
35614 @item
35615 Positive prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, unsigned.
35616 Negative prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, signed.
35617
35618 @c 10
35619 @item
35620 Prefix arguments specify the shift amount @expr{n}. The @expr{w} argument
35621 cannot be specified in the keyboard version of this command.
35622
35623 @c 11
35624 @item
35625 From the keyboard, @expr{d} is omitted and defaults to zero.
35626
35627 @c 12
35628 @item
35629 Mode is toggled; a positive prefix always sets the mode, and a negative
35630 prefix always clears the mode.
35631
35632 @c 13
35633 @item
35634 Some prefix argument values provide special variations of the mode.
35635
35636 @c 14
35637 @item
35638 A prefix argument, if any, is used for @expr{m} instead of taking
35639 @expr{m} from the stack. @expr{M} may take any of these values:
35640 @iftex
35641 {@advance@tableindent10pt
35642 @end iftex
35643 @table @asis
35644 @item Integer
35645 Random integer in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
35646 @item Float
35647 Random floating-point number in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
35648 @item 0.0
35649 Gaussian with mean 1 and standard deviation 0.
35650 @item Error form
35651 Gaussian with specified mean and standard deviation.
35652 @item Interval
35653 Random integer or floating-point number in that interval.
35654 @item Vector
35655 Random element from the vector.
35656 @end table
35657 @iftex
35658 }
35659 @end iftex
35660
35661 @c 15
35662 @item
35663 A prefix argument from 1 to 6 specifies number of date components
35664 to remove from the stack. @xref{Date Conversions}.
35665
35666 @c 16
35667 @item
35668 A prefix argument specifies a time zone; @kbd{C-u} says to take the
35669 time zone number or name from the top of the stack. @xref{Time Zones}.
35670
35671 @c 17
35672 @item
35673 A prefix argument specifies a day number (0-6, 0-31, or 0-366).
35674
35675 @c 18
35676 @item
35677 If the input has no units, you will be prompted for both the old and
35678 the new units.
35679
35680 @c 19
35681 @item
35682 With a prefix argument, collect that many stack entries to form the
35683 input data set. Each entry may be a single value or a vector of values.
35684
35685 @c 20
35686 @item
35687 With a prefix argument of 1, take a single
35688 @texline @var{n}@math{\times2}
35689 @infoline @mathit{@var{N}x2}
35690 matrix from the stack instead of two separate data vectors.
35691
35692 @c 21
35693 @item
35694 The row or column number @expr{n} may be given as a numeric prefix
35695 argument instead. A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix says to take @expr{n}
35696 from the top of the stack. If @expr{n} is a vector or interval,
35697 a subvector/submatrix of the input is created.
35698
35699 @c 22
35700 @item
35701 The @expr{op} prompt can be answered with the key sequence for the
35702 desired function, or with @kbd{x} or @kbd{z} followed by a function name,
35703 or with @kbd{$} to take a formula from the top of the stack, or with
35704 @kbd{'} and a typed formula. In the last two cases, the formula may
35705 be a nameless function like @samp{<#1+#2>} or @samp{<x, y : x+y>}, or it
35706 may include @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, etc. (where @kbd{$} will correspond to the
35707 last argument of the created function), or otherwise you will be
35708 prompted for an argument list. The number of vectors popped from the
35709 stack by @kbd{V M} depends on the number of arguments of the function.
35710
35711 @c 23
35712 @item
35713 One of the mapping direction keys @kbd{_} (horizontal, i.e., map
35714 by rows or reduce across), @kbd{:} (vertical, i.e., map by columns or
35715 reduce down), or @kbd{=} (map or reduce by rows) may be used before
35716 entering @expr{op}; these modify the function name by adding the letter
35717 @code{r} for ``rows,'' @code{c} for ``columns,'' @code{a} for ``across,''
35718 or @code{d} for ``down.''
35719
35720 @c 24
35721 @item
35722 The prefix argument specifies a packing mode. A nonnegative mode
35723 is the number of items (for @kbd{v p}) or the number of levels
35724 (for @kbd{v u}). A negative mode is as described below. With no
35725 prefix argument, the mode is taken from the top of the stack and
35726 may be an integer or a vector of integers.
35727 @iftex
35728 {@advance@tableindent-20pt
35729 @end iftex
35730 @table @cite
35731 @item -1
35732 (@var{2}) Rectangular complex number.
35733 @item -2
35734 (@var{2}) Polar complex number.
35735 @item -3
35736 (@var{3}) HMS form.
35737 @item -4
35738 (@var{2}) Error form.
35739 @item -5
35740 (@var{2}) Modulo form.
35741 @item -6
35742 (@var{2}) Closed interval.
35743 @item -7
35744 (@var{2}) Closed .. open interval.
35745 @item -8
35746 (@var{2}) Open .. closed interval.
35747 @item -9
35748 (@var{2}) Open interval.
35749 @item -10
35750 (@var{2}) Fraction.
35751 @item -11
35752 (@var{2}) Float with integer mantissa.
35753 @item -12
35754 (@var{2}) Float with mantissa in @expr{[1 .. 10)}.
35755 @item -13
35756 (@var{1}) Date form (using date numbers).
35757 @item -14
35758 (@var{3}) Date form (using year, month, day).
35759 @item -15
35760 (@var{6}) Date form (using year, month, day, hour, minute, second).
35761 @end table
35762 @iftex
35763 }
35764 @end iftex
35765
35766 @c 25
35767 @item
35768 A prefix argument specifies the size @expr{n} of the matrix. With no
35769 prefix argument, @expr{n} is omitted and the size is inferred from
35770 the input vector.
35771
35772 @c 26
35773 @item
35774 The prefix argument specifies the starting position @expr{n} (default 1).
35775
35776 @c 27
35777 @item
35778 Cursor position within stack buffer affects this command.
35779
35780 @c 28
35781 @item
35782 Arguments are not actually removed from the stack by this command.
35783
35784 @c 29
35785 @item
35786 Variable name may be a single digit or a full name.
35787
35788 @c 30
35789 @item
35790 Editing occurs in a separate buffer. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} (or
35791 @key{LFD}, or in some cases @key{RET}) to finish the edit, or kill the
35792 buffer with @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @key{LFD} key prevents evaluation
35793 of the result of the edit.
35794
35795 @c 31
35796 @item
35797 The number prompted for can also be provided as a prefix argument.
35798
35799 @c 32
35800 @item
35801 Press this key a second time to cancel the prefix.
35802
35803 @c 33
35804 @item
35805 With a negative prefix, deactivate all formulas. With a positive
35806 prefix, deactivate and then reactivate from scratch.
35807
35808 @c 34
35809 @item
35810 Default is to scan for nearest formula delimiter symbols. With a
35811 prefix of zero, formula is delimited by mark and point. With a
35812 non-zero prefix, formula is delimited by scanning forward or
35813 backward by that many lines.
35814
35815 @c 35
35816 @item
35817 Parse the region between point and mark as a vector. A nonzero prefix
35818 parses @var{n} lines before or after point as a vector. A zero prefix
35819 parses the current line as a vector. A @kbd{C-u} prefix parses the
35820 region between point and mark as a single formula.
35821
35822 @c 36
35823 @item
35824 Parse the rectangle defined by point and mark as a matrix. A positive
35825 prefix @var{n} divides the rectangle into columns of width @var{n}.
35826 A zero or @kbd{C-u} prefix parses each line as one formula. A negative
35827 prefix suppresses special treatment of bracketed portions of a line.
35828
35829 @c 37
35830 @item
35831 A numeric prefix causes the current language mode to be ignored.
35832
35833 @c 38
35834 @item
35835 Responding to a prompt with a blank line answers that and all
35836 later prompts by popping additional stack entries.
35837
35838 @c 39
35839 @item
35840 Answer for @expr{v} may also be of the form @expr{v = v_0} or
35841 @expr{v - v_0}.
35842
35843 @c 40
35844 @item
35845 With a positive prefix argument, stack contains many @expr{y}'s and one
35846 common @expr{x}. With a zero prefix, stack contains a vector of
35847 @expr{y}s and a common @expr{x}. With a negative prefix, stack
35848 contains many @expr{[x,y]} vectors. (For 3D plots, substitute
35849 @expr{z} for @expr{y} and @expr{x,y} for @expr{x}.)
35850
35851 @c 41
35852 @item
35853 With any prefix argument, all curves in the graph are deleted.
35854
35855 @c 42
35856 @item
35857 With a positive prefix, refines an existing plot with more data points.
35858 With a negative prefix, forces recomputation of the plot data.
35859
35860 @c 43
35861 @item
35862 With any prefix argument, set the default value instead of the
35863 value for this graph.
35864
35865 @c 44
35866 @item
35867 With a negative prefix argument, set the value for the printer.
35868
35869 @c 45
35870 @item
35871 Condition is considered ``true'' if it is a nonzero real or complex
35872 number, or a formula whose value is known to be nonzero; it is ``false''
35873 otherwise.
35874
35875 @c 46
35876 @item
35877 Several formulas separated by commas are pushed as multiple stack
35878 entries. Trailing @kbd{)}, @kbd{]}, @kbd{@}}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{"}
35879 delimiters may be omitted. The notation @kbd{$$$} refers to the value
35880 in stack level three, and causes the formula to replace the top three
35881 stack levels. The notation @kbd{$3} refers to stack level three without
35882 causing that value to be removed from the stack. Use @key{LFD} in place
35883 of @key{RET} to prevent evaluation; use @kbd{M-=} in place of @key{RET}
35884 to evaluate variables.
35885
35886 @c 47
35887 @item
35888 The variable is replaced by the formula shown on the right. The
35889 Inverse flag reverses the order of the operands, e.g., @kbd{I s - x}
35890 assigns
35891 @texline @math{x \coloneq a-x}.
35892 @infoline @expr{x := a-x}.
35893
35894 @c 48
35895 @item
35896 Press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see how to choose a model. Answer the
35897 variables prompt with @expr{iv} or @expr{iv;pv} to specify
35898 independent and parameter variables. A positive prefix argument
35899 takes @mathit{@var{n}+1} vectors from the stack; a zero prefix takes a matrix
35900 and a vector from the stack.
35901
35902 @c 49
35903 @item
35904 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, replace the current region of the
35905 destination buffer with the yanked text instead of inserting.
35906
35907 @c 50
35908 @item
35909 All stack entries are reformatted; the @kbd{H} prefix inhibits this.
35910 The @kbd{I} prefix sets the mode temporarily, redraws the top stack
35911 entry, then restores the original setting of the mode.
35912
35913 @c 51
35914 @item
35915 A negative prefix sets the default 3D resolution instead of the
35916 default 2D resolution.
35917
35918 @c 52
35919 @item
35920 This grabs a vector of the form [@var{prec}, @var{wsize}, @var{ssize},
35921 @var{radix}, @var{flfmt}, @var{ang}, @var{frac}, @var{symb}, @var{polar},
35922 @var{matrix}, @var{simp}, @var{inf}]. A prefix argument from 1 to 12
35923 grabs the @var{n}th mode value only.
35924 @end enumerate
35925
35926 @iftex
35927 (Space is provided below for you to keep your own written notes.)
35928 @page
35929 @endgroup
35930 @end iftex
35931
35932
35933 @c [end-summary]
35934
35935 @node Key Index, Command Index, Summary, Top
35936 @unnumbered Index of Key Sequences
35937
35938 @printindex ky
35939
35940 @node Command Index, Function Index, Key Index, Top
35941 @unnumbered Index of Calculator Commands
35942
35943 Since all Calculator commands begin with the prefix @samp{calc-}, the
35944 @kbd{x} key has been provided as a variant of @kbd{M-x} which automatically
35945 types @samp{calc-} for you. Thus, @kbd{x last-args} is short for
35946 @kbd{M-x calc-last-args}.
35947
35948 @printindex pg
35949
35950 @node Function Index, Concept Index, Command Index, Top
35951 @unnumbered Index of Algebraic Functions
35952
35953 This is a list of built-in functions and operators usable in algebraic
35954 expressions. Their full Lisp names are derived by adding the prefix
35955 @samp{calcFunc-}, as in @code{calcFunc-sqrt}.
35956 @iftex
35957 All functions except those noted with ``*'' have corresponding
35958 Calc keystrokes and can also be found in the Calc Summary.
35959 @end iftex
35960
35961 @printindex tp
35962
35963 @node Concept Index, Variable Index, Function Index, Top
35964 @unnumbered Concept Index
35965
35966 @printindex cp
35967
35968 @node Variable Index, Lisp Function Index, Concept Index, Top
35969 @unnumbered Index of Variables
35970
35971 The variables in this list that do not contain dashes are accessible
35972 as Calc variables. Add a @samp{var-} prefix to get the name of the
35973 corresponding Lisp variable.
35974
35975 The remaining variables are Lisp variables suitable for @code{setq}ing
35976 in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs} file.
35977
35978 @printindex vr
35979
35980 @node Lisp Function Index, , Variable Index, Top
35981 @unnumbered Index of Lisp Math Functions
35982
35983 The following functions are meant to be used with @code{defmath}, not
35984 @code{defun} definitions. For names that do not start with @samp{calc-},
35985 the corresponding full Lisp name is derived by adding a prefix of
35986 @samp{math-}.
35987
35988 @printindex fn
35989
35990 @summarycontents
35991
35992 @c [end]
35993
35994 @contents
35995 @bye
35996
35997
35998 @ignore
35999 arch-tag: 77a71809-fa4d-40be-b2cc-da3e8fb137c0
36000 @end ignore